TELETECH HOLDINGS INC
S-1/A, 1996-07-05
Previous: COLONIAL REALTY LIMITED PARTNERSHIP, S-3/A, 1996-07-05
Next: NUVEEN INVESTMENT TRUST, N-1A EL/A, 1996-07-05



<PAGE>
   
      AS FILED WITH THE SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION ON JULY 5, 1996
    
                                                      REGISTRATION NO. 333-04097
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                       SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
                             WASHINGTON, D.C. 20549
                              -------------------
   
                               AMENDMENT NO. 2 TO
                                    FORM S-1
    
                             REGISTRATION STATEMENT
                                     UNDER
                           THE SECURITIES ACT OF 1933
                              -------------------
                            TELETECH HOLDINGS, INC.
             (Exact name of registrant as specified in its charter)
 
<TABLE>
<S>                              <C>                            <C>
           DELAWARE                          7389                  84-1291044
 (State or other jurisdiction    (Primary Standard Industrial   (I.R.S. Employee
              of                 Classification Code Number)     Identification
incorporation or organization)                                        No.)
</TABLE>
 
                        1700 LINCOLN STREET, SUITE 1400
                             DENVER, COLORADO 80203
                                 (303) 894-4000
         (Address, including zip code, and telephone number, including
                 area code, of registrant's executive offices)
 
                               KENNETH D. TUCHMAN
                CHAIRMAN, PRESIDENT AND CHIEF EXECUTIVE OFFICER
                            TELETECH HOLDINGS, INC.
                        1700 LINCOLN STREET, SUITE 1400
                             DENVER, COLORADO 80203
                                 (303) 894-4000
 (Name, address, including zip code, and telephone number, including area code,
                             of agent for service)
                              -------------------
 
                                WITH COPIES TO:
 
<TABLE>
<S>                                       <C>
      CHARLES EVANS GERBER, ESQ.                 HOWARD S. LANZNAR, ESQ.
       HELEN N. KAMINSKI, ESQ.                      MARK D. WOOD, ESQ.
       Neal, Gerber & Eisenberg                   Katten Muchin & Zavis
       Two North LaSalle Street                   525 West Monroe Street
       Chicago, Illinois 60602                   Chicago, Illinois 60661
            (312) 269-8000                            (312) 902-5200
</TABLE>
 
                              -------------------
 
        APPROXIMATE DATE OF COMMENCEMENT OF PROPOSED SALE TO THE PUBLIC:
AS SOON AS PRACTICABLE AFTER THE EFFECTIVE DATE OF THIS REGISTRATION STATEMENT.
 
    If  any of the securities being registered on this Form are to be offered on
a delayed or continuous basis pursuant to  Rule 415 under the Securities Act  of
1933, check the following box. / /
 
    If  this Form  is filed  to register  additional securities  for an offering
pursuant to Rule 462(b) under the Securities Act, please check the following box
and list  the  Securities  Act  registration statement  number  of  the  earlier
effective registration statement for the same offering. / /
 
    If  this Form  is a post-effective  amendment filed pursuant  to Rule 462(c)
under the Securities Act,  check the following box  and list the Securities  Act
registration  statement number  of the earlier  effective registration statement
for the same offering. / /
 
    If delivery of the prospectus is expected  to be made pursuant to Rule  434,
please check the following box. / /
                              -------------------
 
    THE  REGISTRANT  HEREBY AMENDS  THIS  REGISTRATION ON  SUCH  DATE AS  MAY BE
NECESSARY TO DELAY ITS EFFECTIVE DATE UNTIL THE REGISTRANT SHALL FILE A  FURTHER
AMENDMENT  WHICH  SPECIFICALLY  STATES THAT  THIS  REGISTRATION  STATEMENT SHALL
THEREAFTER BECOME EFFECTIVE IN ACCORDANCE WITH SECTION 8(A) OF THE SECURITIES OF
1933 OR UNTIL THE REGISTRATION STATEMENT SHALL BECOME EFFECTIVE ON SUCH DATE  AS
THE  SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE  COMMISSION, ACTING PURSUANT  TO SAID SECTION 8(A),
MAY DETERMINE.
 
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<PAGE>
                            TELETECH HOLDINGS, INC.
                             CROSS REFERENCE SHEET
                   PURSUANT TO REGULATION S-K, SECTION 501(B)
 
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
           FORM S-1 ITEM                                                           LOCATION IN PROSPECTUS
           -------------------------------------------------------  -----------------------------------------------------
<S>        <C>                                                      <C>
 1.        Forepart of the Registration Statement and Outside
            Front Cover Page of Prospectus........................  Forepart of the Registration Statement and Outside
                                                                     Front Cover Page of Prospectus
 2.        Inside Front and Outside Back Cover Pages of
            Prospectus............................................  Inside   Front  and  Outside   Back  Cover  Pages  of
                                                                     Prospectus; Additional Information
 3.        Summary Information, Risk Factors and Ratio of Earnings
            to Fixed Charges......................................  Prospectus  Summary;  The   Company;  Risk   Factors;
                                                                     Business
 4.        Use of Proceeds........................................  Prospectus Summary; Use of Proceeds
 5.        Determination of Offering Price........................  Outside Front Cover Page of Prospectus; Underwriters
 6.        Dilution...............................................  Dilution
 7.        Selling Security Holders...............................  Principal and Selling Stockholders
 8.        Plan of Distribution...................................  Outside  and Inside Front  Cover Pages of Prospectus;
                                                                     Underwriters
 9.        Description of Securities to be Registered.............  Prospectus Summary;  Capitalization;  Description  of
                                                                     Capital Stock
10.        Interests of Named Experts and Counsel.................  Legal Matters; Experts; Change in Independent
                                                                     Accountants
11.        Information with Respect to the Registrant.............  Cover  Page  of Registration  Statement;  Outside and
                                                                     Inside Front Cover  Pages of Prospectus;  Prospectus
                                                                     Summary; The Company; Risk Factors; Use of Proceeds;
                                                                     Dividend  Policy; Capitalization; Dilution; Selected
                                                                     Financial Data; Management's Discussion and Analysis
                                                                     of Financial  Condition and  Results of  Operations;
                                                                     Business;   Management;  Certain  Relationships  and
                                                                     Related Party  Transactions; Principal  and  Selling
                                                                     Stockholders;  Description of  Capital Stock; Shares
                                                                     Eligible for  Future Sale;  Legal Matters;  Experts;
                                                                     Change   in   Independent   Accountants;   Financial
                                                                     Statements
12.        Disclosure of Commission Position on Indemnification
            for Securities Act Liabilities........................                            *
</TABLE>
    
 
- ---------
*Inapplicable
<PAGE>
   
                                EXPLANATORY NOTE
    
 
   
    This Registration Statement contains  two forms of  prospectuses: one to  be
used  in connection with an offering in  the United States and Canada (the "U.S.
Prospectus") and one to  be used in connection  with a concurrent  international
offering  (the "International Prospectus")  of the Common  Stock, par value $.01
per share, of TeleTech  Holdings, Inc. The form  of U.S. Prospectus is  included
herein  and  is followed  by the  outside front  cover  page to  be used  in the
International Prospectus, which is the only differing page of the  International
Prospectus.  The  outside  front  cover  page  of  the  International Prospectus
included herein is labeled "Alternative Page for International Prospectus."
    
<PAGE>
Information   contained  herein  is  subject   to  completion  or  amendment.  A
registration statement  relating to  these securities  has been  filed with  the
Securities  and Exchange  Commission. These securities  may not be  sold nor may
offers to buy be accepted prior  to the time the registration statement  becomes
effective.  This  prospectus  shall  not  constitute an  offer  to  sell  or the
solicitation of an offer to buy nor shall there be any sale of these  securities
in  any State in which such offer,  solicitation or sale would be unlawful prior
to registration or qualification under the securities laws of any such State.
<PAGE>
PROSPECTUS (SUBJECT TO COMPLETION)
ISSUED            , 1996
 
   
                                6,220,000 SHARES
    
 
                                     [LOGO]
                                  COMMON STOCK
                                 --------------
 
   
 OF THE 6,220,000 SHARES  OF COMMON STOCK BEING  OFFERED, 4,000,000 SHARES  ARE
 BEING  SOLD BY THE COMPANY AND 2,220,000 SHARES ARE BEING SOLD BY THE SELLING
  STOCKHOLDERS NAMED HEREIN. THE COMPANY WILL NOT RECEIVE ANY OF THE PROCEEDS
   FROM THE SALE OF  SHARES BY THE SELLING  STOCKHOLDERS. SEE "PRINCIPAL  AND
   SELLING STOCKHOLDERS." OF THE SHARES BEING OFFERED, 4,976,000 SHARES ARE
     BEING  OFFERED INITIALLY IN  THE UNITED STATES AND  CANADA BY THE U.S.
     UNDERWRITERS AND 1,244,000 SHARES ARE BEING OFFERED INITIALLY  OUTSIDE
     OF  THE UNITED STATES AND  CANADA BY THE INTERNATIONAL UNDERWRITERS.
       SEE "UNDERWRITERS."  PRIOR  TO THE  OFFERING,  THERE HAS  BEEN  NO
       PUBLIC MARKET FOR THE COMMON STOCK OF THE COMPANY. IT IS CURRENTLY
       ANTICIPATED  THAT  THE  INITIAL  PUBLIC  OFFERING  PRICE  WILL BE
        BETWEEN $14.50 AND $16.50.  SEE "UNDERWRITERS" FOR A  DISCUSSION
        OF  THE FACTORS  CONSIDERED IN  DETERMINING THE  INITIAL PUBLIC
         OFFERING PRICE. THE COMMON STOCK HAS BEEN APPROVED FOR LISTING
         ON   THE  NASDAQ NATIONAL  MARKET  UNDER THE  SYMBOL  "TTEC,"
                    SUBJECT TO OFFICIAL NOTICE OF ISSUANCE.
    
                            ------------------------
 
   
        THIS OFFERING INVOLVES A HIGH DEGREE OF RISK. SEE "RISK FACTORS"
                          COMMENCING ON PAGE 5 HEREOF.
    
                               -----------------
 
 THESE  SECURITIES HAVE NOT BEEN APPROVED  OR DISAPPROVED BY THE SECURITIES AND
  EXCHANGE  COMMISSION  OR  ANY  STATE  SECURITIES  COMMISSION  NOR  HAS   THE
    SECURITIES  AND EXCHANGE  COMMISSION OR ANY  STATE SECURITIES COMMISSION
     PASSED  UPON  THE  ACCURACY  OR  ADEQUACY  OF  THIS  PROSPECTUS.   ANY
      REPRESENTATION    TO   THE   CONTRARY   IS   A   CRIMINAL   OFFENSE.
                              -------------------
 
                             PRICE $       A SHARE
                              -------------------
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                             UNDERWRITING                           PROCEEDS TO
                                            PRICE TO         DISCOUNTS AND       PROCEEDS TO          SELLING
                                             PUBLIC         COMMISSIONS (1)      COMPANY (2)       STOCKHOLDERS
                                        -----------------  -----------------  -----------------  -----------------
<S>                                     <C>                <C>                <C>                <C>
PER SHARE.............................          $                  $                  $                  $
TOTAL (3).............................          $                  $                  $                  $
</TABLE>
 
- ---------
    (1) THE COMPANY AND  THE SELLING STOCKHOLDERS HAVE  AGREED TO INDEMNIFY  THE
       UNDERWRITERS AGAINST CERTAIN LIABILITIES, INCLUDING LIABILITIES UNDER THE
       SECURITIES ACT OF 1933, AS AMENDED.
    (2)   BEFORE  DEDUCTING  EXPENSES  PAYABLE   BY  THE  COMPANY  ESTIMATED  AT
       $          .  THE COMPANY HAS AGREED TO  PAY THE EXPENSES OF THE  SELLING
       STOCKHOLDERS, OTHER THAN UNDERWRITING DISCOUNTS AND COMMISSIONS.
   
    (3)  ONE OF  THE SELLING STOCKHOLDERS  HAS GRANTED THE  U.S. UNDERWRITERS AN
       OPTION, EXERCISABLE WITHIN 30 DAYS OF THE DATE HEREOF, TO PURCHASE UP  TO
       AN AGGREGATE OF 933,000 ADDITIONAL SHARES OF COMMON STOCK AT THE PRICE TO
       PUBLIC  LESS UNDERWRITING  DISCOUNTS AND  COMMISSIONS FOR  THE PURPOSE OF
       COVERING OVER-ALLOTMENTS, IF ANY. IF THE U.S. UNDERWRITERS EXERCISE  SUCH
       OPTION  IN FULL,  THE TOTAL PRICE  TO PUBLIC,  UNDERWRITING DISCOUNTS AND
       COMMISSIONS, PROCEEDS  TO COMPANY  AND PROCEEDS  TO SELLING  STOCKHOLDERS
       WILL  BE $       ,  $       , $        , AND $        , RESPECTIVELY. SEE
       "UNDERWRITERS."
    
                            ------------------------
 
    THE SHARES ARE OFFERED, SUBJECT TO PRIOR  SALE, WHEN, AS AND IF ACCEPTED  BY
THE  UNDERWRITERS NAMED HEREIN AND SUBJECT  TO APPROVAL OF CERTAIN LEGAL MATTERS
BY KATTEN MUCHIN  & ZAVIS,  COUNSEL FOR THE  UNDERWRITERS. IT  IS EXPECTED  THAT
DELIVERY  OF THE SHARES WILL BE MADE ON OR ABOUT         , 1996 AT THE OFFICE OF
MORGAN STANLEY & CO. INCORPORATED, NEW YORK, NEW YORK, AGAINST PAYMENT  THEREFOR
IN IMMEDIATELY AVAILABLE FUNDS.
                              -------------------
 
MORGAN STANLEY & CO.
   INCORPORATED
                               ALEX. BROWN & SONS
   
                                  INCORPORATED
    
                                                               SMITH BARNEY INC.
           , 1996
<PAGE>
INSIDE FRONT COVER OF PROSPECTUS:
 
   
    The  inside front cover  is a gatefold  which opens to  a multicolor graphic
layout   containing,    in   the    upper   right-hand    corner,   the    title
"TeleTech--integrated  customer  lifecycle  management."  Under  the  title  are
written the  words:  "engineered  and  executed  by  TeleTech"  and  "TeleTech's
solutions   integrate  all  phases   of  the  customer   lifecycle  --  customer
acquisition, service and retention, satisfaction and loyalty -- and are designed
to maximize the lifetime value of its client's customer relationships."
    
 
   
    The gatefold contains eight  photographs of the  Company's call centers  and
related  technology (in each of the  lower left-hand and upper left-hand corners
and along the right-hand margin with  the word "TeleTech" superimposed). In  the
center  of the gatefold, there is an oval  photograph of a woman speaking on the
telephone, labelled "Our  Client's Customer." This  photograph is surrounded  by
three  smaller oval  photographs of faces,  each of which  is labelled "TeleTech
representative." Radiating  outward  from  the center  oval  photograph  of  the
Client's  Customer are 16 curved lines, each of which terminates at a press-and-
click telephone  jack, adjacent  to which  is  a question  or request  that  the
client's  customer  might  have  regarding  a  particular  product  or  service.
Following this "customer lifecycle" clockwise from a point labelled "Start", the
questions or requests that a client's customer might ask appear as follows:
    
 
   
"Tell me about it."
"Where can I buy it?"
"I want to order it."
"How do I install it."
"Help me use and navigate it."
"Send someone to repair it."
"I want to upgrade it."
"My billing address has changed for it."
"How do I take care of it?"
"I want to complain about it."
"I want to rave about it."
"Make   me    a    preferred    customer   and    I'll    keep    buying    it."
"Register me for the event celebrating it."
"Contact my friend about trying it."
"I'd like to buy it again."
    
 
   
    These  questions or requests are classified  into the following three phases
of the customer  lifecycle: "CUSTOMER  ACQUISITION -  LIMITED VALUE,"  "CUSTOMER
SERVICE  +  RETENTION -  SUSTAINED VALUE,"  "CUSTOMER  SATISFACTION +  LOYALTY -
MAXIMUM VALUE."
    
 
   
    Centered along  the  lower edge  of  the  gatefold, is  an  ovaloid  graphic
containing  text that  lists under the  heading "TeleTech's  core strengths" the
following words: "People -- Infrastructure -- Technology -- Process --  Strategy
- --  Innovation." On either side of this text is an arrow, one of which points to
the left indicating "Customer Benefits" (listed as "Direct access to product and
service providers --  Rapid, single-call resolution  -- Personalized service  --
Knowledgeable  resources -- Flexibility"), and the  other of which points to the
right indicating "Client Benefits" (listed  as "Efficiency and effectiveness  in
Customer   Care  --   Controlled  operating  and   labor  costs   --  Access  to
state-of-the-art technology  -- Enhanced  service  quality --  Maximum  customer
value").
    
 
   
    TeleTech's  corporate logo  appears in  the lower  right-hand corner  of the
gatefold, under which are written the words: "COPYRIGHT 1996."
    
<PAGE>
    NO  PERSON IS AUTHORIZED IN CONNECTION WITH ANY OFFERING MADE HEREBY TO GIVE
ANY INFORMATION OR TO  MAKE ANY REPRESENTATION OTHER  THAN AS CONTAINED IN  THIS
PROSPECTUS AND, IF GIVEN OR MADE, SUCH INFORMATION OR REPRESENTATION MUST NOT BE
RELIED UPON AS HAVING BEEN AUTHORIZED BY THE COMPANY, BY ANY SELLING STOCKHOLDER
OR  BY ANY UNDERWRITER. THIS PROSPECTUS DOES  NOT CONSTITUTE AN OFFER TO SELL OR
THE SOLICITATION OF ANY OFFER TO BUY BY ANY PERSON IN ANY JURISDICTION IN  WHICH
IT IS UNLAWFUL TO MAKE SUCH AN OFFERING OR SOLICITATION. NEITHER THE DELIVERY OF
THIS  PROSPECTUS NOR ANY SALE MADE HEREUNDER SHALL UNDER ANY CIRCUMSTANCES IMPLY
THAT THE INFORMATION CONTAINED  HEREIN IS CORRECT AS  OF ANY TIME SUBSEQUENT  TO
THE DATE HEREOF.
                              -------------------
 
    UNTIL              , 1996 (25 DAYS AFTER COMMENCEMENT OF THIS OFFERING), ALL
DEALERS EFFECTING TRANSACTIONS IN COMMON STOCK, WHETHER OR NOT PARTICIPATING  IN
THIS  DISTRIBUTION, MAY BE REQUIRED TO DELIVER A PROSPECTUS. THIS IS IN ADDITION
TO THE OBLIGATION OF DEALERS TO DELIVER A PROSPECTUS WHEN ACTING AS UNDERWRITERS
AND WITH RESPECT TO THEIR UNSOLD ALLOTMENTS OR SUBSCRIPTIONS.
                              -------------------
 
    For investors outside of the  United States: No action  has been or will  be
taken in any jurisdiction by the Company or by any Underwriter that would permit
a  public offering  of the  Common Stock or  possession or  distribution of this
Prospectus in any jurisdiction where action for that purpose is required,  other
than  in the United States. Persons  into whose possession this Prospectus comes
are required by the Company and the Underwriters to inform themselves about  and
to  observe any  restrictions as  to the  offering of  the Common  Stock and the
distribution of this Prospectus.
 
    In this Prospectus  references to  "dollars" and  "$" are  to United  States
dollars,  and the  terms "United  States" and "U.S."  mean the  United States of
America, its states, its territories, its  possessions and all areas subject  to
its jurisdiction.
                              -------------------
 
                               TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                                                PAGE
                                                                                                             -----------
<S>                                                                                                          <C>
Prospectus Summary.........................................................................................           3
Risk Factors...............................................................................................           5
The Company................................................................................................          11
Use of Proceeds............................................................................................          11
Dividend Policy............................................................................................          11
Capitalization.............................................................................................          12
Dilution...................................................................................................          13
Selected Financial Data....................................................................................          14
Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations......................          17
Business...................................................................................................          24
Management.................................................................................................          36
Certain Relationships and Related Party Transactions.......................................................          43
Principal and Selling Stockholders.........................................................................          45
Description of Capital Stock...............................................................................          47
Shares Eligible for Future Sale............................................................................          49
Certain United States Federal Tax Consequences for Non-U.S. Holders of Common Stock........................          51
Underwriters...............................................................................................          53
Legal Matters..............................................................................................          55
Experts....................................................................................................          56
Change in Independent Accountants..........................................................................          56
Additional Information.....................................................................................          56
Index to Financial Statements..............................................................................         F-1
</TABLE>
    
 
                              -------------------
 
    The Company intends to furnish to its stockholders annual reports containing
consolidated financial
statements  audited by an independent accounting  firm and quarterly reports for
the first  three  quarters of  each  fiscal year  containing  interim  unaudited
financial information.
                              -------------------
 
    IN  CONNECTION WITH THIS OFFERING, THE UNDERWRITERS MAY OVER-ALLOT OR EFFECT
TRANSACTIONS WHICH STABILIZE OR MAINTAIN THE MARKET PRICE OF THE COMMON STOCK AT
A LEVEL  ABOVE THAT  WHICH MIGHT  OTHERWISE  PREVAIL IN  THE OPEN  MARKET.  SUCH
TRANSACTIONS  MAY BE EFFECTED  ON THE NASDAQ NATIONAL  MARKET OR OTHERWISE. SUCH
STABILIZING, IF COMMENCED, MAY BE DISCONTINUED AT ANY TIME.
 
                                       2
<PAGE>
                               PROSPECTUS SUMMARY
 
   
    THE  FOLLOWING SUMMARY  IS QUALIFIED  IN ITS  ENTIRETY BY  THE MORE DETAILED
INFORMATION AND FINANCIAL  STATEMENTS AND NOTES  THERETO APPEARING ELSEWHERE  IN
THIS   PROSPECTUS.  EXCEPT  AS  OTHERWISE  NOTED  HEREIN,  INFORMATION  IN  THIS
PROSPECTUS (I) ASSUMES NO EXERCISE  OF THE UNDERWRITERS' OVER-ALLOTMENT  OPTION,
(II)  REFLECTS A FIVE-FOR-ONE SPLIT OF THE COMPANY'S COMMON STOCK TO BE EFFECTED
BY A  STOCK  DIVIDEND IMMEDIATELY  PRIOR  AND SUBJECT  TO  THE CLOSING  OF  THIS
OFFERING  (THE "OFFERING") AND (III) REFLECTS  THE CONVERSION OF ALL OUTSTANDING
SHARES OF CONVERTIBLE PREFERRED STOCK, PAR VALUE $6.45 PER SHARE, OF THE COMPANY
("PREFERRED STOCK")  INTO  9,300,000  SHARES  OF COMMON  STOCK  TO  BE  EFFECTED
IMMEDIATELY  PRIOR AND  SUBJECT TO THE  CLOSING OF THE  OFFERING (THE "PREFERRED
STOCK CONVERSION").  SEE  "DESCRIPTION  OF CAPITAL  STOCK"  AND  "UNDERWRITERS."
UNLESS  OTHERWISE  INDICATED, REFERENCES  TO "TELETECH"  AND THE  "COMPANY" MEAN
TELETECH HOLDINGS, INC. AND ITS WHOLLY-OWNED SUBSIDIARIES OR, FOR PERIODS  PRIOR
TO   DECEMBER  1994,   MEAN  TELETECH  TELECOMMUNICATIONS,   INC.  AND  TELETECH
TELESERVICES, INC., COLLECTIVELY. SEE "THE COMPANY."
    
 
   
                                  THE COMPANY
    
 
   
    TeleTech is a leading provider of  customer care solutions for Fortune  1000
companies.  TeleTech's  customer  care  solutions  encompass  a  wide  range  of
telephone- and computer-based customer  acquisition, retention and  satisfaction
programs  designed to maximize the long-term  value of the relationships between
TeleTech's clients and their customers. Such programs involve all stages of  the
customer  relationship and consist of a  variety of customer service and product
support  activities,  such  as  providing  new  product  information,  enrolling
customers in client programs, providing 24-hour technical and help desk support,
resolving  customer  complaints  and conducting  satisfaction  surveys. TeleTech
works closely with  its clients  to rapidly  design and  implement large  scale,
tailored  customer care programs  that provide comprehensive  solutions to their
specific business needs.
    
 
   
    TeleTech   delivers   its   customer   care   services   primarily   through
customer-initiated  ("inbound")  telephone  calls and  also  over  the Internet.
Services   are    provided   by    trained   customer    care    representatives
("Representatives") in response to an inquiry that a customer makes by calling a
toll-free  telephone number or  by sending an  Internet message. Representatives
respond to these inquiries from TeleTech call centers ("Call Centers") utilizing
state-of-the-art workstations, which operate  on TeleTech's advanced  technology
platform, enabling the Representatives to provide rapid, single-call resolution.
This   technology   platform  incorporates   digital   switching,  client/server
technology, object-oriented  software  modules, relational  database  management
systems,  proprietary  call  tracking  management  software,  computer telephony
integration and interactive voice  response. TeleTech historically has  provided
services  from Call Centers leased and equipped by TeleTech ("fully outsourced")
and more  recently  from  Call  Centers  leased  and  equipped  by  its  clients
("facilities management").
    
 
   
    TeleTech   typically   establishes   long-term,   strategic   relationships,
formalized   by   multi-year   contracts,   with   selected   clients   in   the
telecommunications,   technology,  transportation,  health  care  and  financial
services industries. TeleTech  targets clients  in these  industries because  of
their  complex product  and service  offerings and  large customer  bases, which
require frequent, often sophisticated,  customer interactions. For example,  the
Company  recently entered into significant, multi-year contracts with CompuServe
and United Parcel Service and has obtained additional business from AT&T.
    
 
   
    The Company was founded in 1982 and has been providing inbound customer care
solutions since its inception. Between December 31, 1995 and March 31, 1996, the
Company opened, acquired or initiated management of six Call Centers. As of June
15, 1996, TeleTech  owned, leased or  managed seven Call  Centers in the  United
States  and  one in  each  of the  United  Kingdom, Australia  and  New Zealand,
equipped with a total of 4,660 state-of-the-art workstations. TeleTech currently
plans to expand an existing Call Center  and open one additional Call Center  by
the  end  of  1996. In  the  first quarter  of  1996, approximately  95%  of the
Company's call handling revenues were derived from inbound customer inquiries.
    
 
                                       3
<PAGE>
                                  THE OFFERING
 
   
<TABLE>
<S>                                            <C>
Common Stock offered.........................  6,220,000 shares
                                               4,000,000 shares by the Company
                                               2,220,000 shares by the Selling Stockholders
  U.S. offering..............................  4,976,000 shares
  International offering.....................  1,244,000 shares
Common Stock to be outstanding after the
 Offering....................................  55,046,240 shares(1)
Use of proceeds to the Company...............  For working capital and general corporate
                                               purposes and to repay outstanding short-term
                                               indebtedness.
Nasdaq National Market Symbol................  TTEC
</TABLE>
    
 
- ------------
 
   
(1) Includes 9,300,000 shares of Common  Stock to be issued upon the  conversion
    of  all  1,860,000 outstanding  shares of  Preferred  Stock pursuant  to the
    Preferred Stock  Conversion.  Excludes  4,797,345  shares  of  Common  Stock
    issuable  upon  exercise of  options  outstanding at  June  15, 1996  with a
    weighted average exercise  price of $4.58  per share. See  "Capitalization,"
    "Management-- Compensation of Directors," "Management--TeleTech Stock Option
    Plan," "Underwriters" and note 11 to the Company's Consolidated and Combined
    Financial Statements (the "Financial Statements").
    
 
                       SUMMARY FINANCIAL INFORMATION (1)
          (IN THOUSANDS, EXCEPT PER SHARE AMOUNTS AND OPERATING DATA)
 
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                         YEAR ENDED           ELEVEN            YEAR ENDED        THREE MONTHS ENDED
                                                         JANUARY 31,       MONTHS ENDED        DECEMBER 31,           MARCH 31,
                                                    ---------------------  DECEMBER 31,     ------------------    ------------------
                                                                   1993        1993          1994       1995       1995       1996
                                                                  -------  ------------     -------    -------    -------    -------
                                                       1992
                                                    -----------
                                                    (UNAUDITED)                                                      (UNAUDITED)
<S>                                                 <C>           <C>      <C>              <C>        <C>        <C>        <C>
STATEMENT OF OPERATIONS DATA:
Revenues..........................................    $ 5,751     $13,814    $19,520        $35,462    $50,467    $10,412    $22,019
Income (loss) from operations.....................       (332)        250        837          2,196      4,596        614      2,723
Net income........................................        214          52        548          1,695      4,156(2)   1,628(2)   1,258
Pro forma net income..............................        214          52        299(3)       1,037(3)   4,156(2)   1,628(2)   1,258
Pro forma net income per share of Common Stock and
 equivalents (4)..................................    $    --     $    --    $   .01(3)     $   .02(3) $   .08(2) $   .03(2) $   .02
Weighted average shares outstanding (4)...........     43,843      43,843     43,843         43,843     54,402     54,331     54,426
 
OPERATING DATA:
Number of Call Centers............................          1           1          2              2          3          3          9
Number of workstations............................        300         300        560            560        960        960      3,107
</TABLE>
    
 
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                         MARCH 31, 1996
                                                                           -------------------------------------------
                                                                                                          PRO FORMA
                                                                            ACTUAL     PRO FORMA (5)   AS ADJUSTED (6)
                                                                           ---------  ---------------  ---------------
                                                                                           (UNAUDITED)
<S>                                                                        <C>        <C>              <C>
BALANCE SHEET DATA:
Working capital..........................................................  $   5,380     $   5,380        $  61,792
Total assets.............................................................     49,454        49,454          102,367
Long-term debt, net of current portion...................................      6,536         6,536            6,536
Total stockholders' equity...............................................      9,829        22,908           79,321
</TABLE>
    
 
- ------------
 
(1)  The Summary Financial  Information presented in this  table is derived from
    the "Selected Financial Information"  and the Financial Statements  included
    elsewhere in this Prospectus.
 
(2) Includes the $2.4 million pre-tax net proceeds of a one-time payment made by
    a  former  client  to  TeleTech  in  connection  with  such  client's  early
    termination of a contract.
 
(3) During 1993 and 1994, the Company was an S corporation under Subchapter S of
    the  Internal  Revenue  Code  of   1986,  as  amended  (the  "Code"),   and,
    accordingly,  was not subject to federal  income taxes. Pro forma net income
    includes a provision for income taxes at an effective rate of 44.4% for  the
    11  months ended December 31, 1993 and 39.5% for the year ended December 31,
    1994.
 
(4) Calculated in the manner described in note 1 to the Financial Statements.
 
(5) Reflects  the  conversion  of  1,860,000  shares  of  Preferred  Stock  into
    9,300,000 shares of Common Stock pursuant to the Preferred Stock Conversion.
 
   
(6)  Reflects the  sale of  4,000,000 shares  of Common  Stock being  offered by
    TeleTech at an assumed initial price to  public of $15.50 per share (net  of
    approximately  $5.6 million of estimated  offering expenses and underwriting
    discounts and commissions) and the application of the estimated net proceeds
    therefrom, including  repayment  of  short-term indebtedness.  See  "Use  of
    Proceeds" and "Capitalization."
    
 
                                       4
<PAGE>
   
                                  RISK FACTORS
    
 
    IN EVALUATING THE COMPANY'S BUSINESS, PROSPECTIVE INVESTORS SHOULD CAREFULLY
CONSIDER THE FOLLOWING FACTORS IN ADDITION TO THE OTHER INFORMATION PRESENTED IN
THIS PROSPECTUS.
 
   
    RELIANCE  ON  MAJOR  CLIENTS.   The  Company has  strategically  focused its
marketing efforts  on  developing  long-term  relationships  with  Fortune  1000
companies  in targeted  industries. As  a result,  a substantial  portion of the
Company's revenues is  derived from  relatively few  clients. Collectively,  the
Company's  10 largest clients  in 1995 accounted for  approximately 82.1% of the
Company's 1995 revenues. The Company's three largest clients in 1995 were  AT&T,
Continental Airlines and Apple Computer, Inc., which accounted for approximately
31%  (including 11% from  AT&T's subsidiary McCaw  Communications d/b/a Cellular
One), 18% and 9%,  respectively, of the Company's  1995 revenues. The  Company's
three  largest  clients  in the  first  quarter  of 1996,  AT&T,  CompuServe and
Continental Airlines, accounted for approximately 22%, 13% and 6%, respectively,
of the Company's revenues.  The Company's program  for Continental Airlines  was
completed  in  March  1996 and  was  not  renewed. The  lost  revenues  from the
expiration of the  Continental Airlines  program were  more than  offset in  the
first  quarter of 1996 by revenues from  new clients. The Company received prior
notice that Continental Airlines  would not renew  its contract upon  expiration
and  redeployed to new programs all of the workstations that previously had been
dedicated to  the  Continental  Airlines program.  Consequently,  there  was  no
material  capacity underutilization due to the  loss of the Continental Airlines
program; however, there can be no  assurance that the Company's loss of  another
large client would not result in substantial underutilized capacity.
    
 
   
    The  Company expects that  its three largest  clients in 1996  will be AT&T,
CompuServe and United Parcel Service, which the Company anticipates collectively
will account for an even greater percentage of the Company's 1996 revenues  than
its  three largest clients in  1995. There can be  no assurance that the Company
will be able to retain its significant clients  or that, if it were to lose  one
or  more of its  significant clients, it  would be able  to replace such clients
with clients that generate  a comparable amount  of revenues. Consequently,  the
loss  of one or  more of its  significant clients could  have a material adverse
effect on the Company's business, results of operations or financial  condition.
See  "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of
Operations," "--Risks Associated with the Company's Contracts" and "--Dependence
on Key Industries."
    
 
   
    Substantially all of the Company's significant arrangements with its clients
generate revenues  based,  in  large part,  on  the  amount of  time  which  the
Company's personnel devotes to such clients' customers. Consequently, and due to
the  primarily inbound nature of the  Company's business, the amount of revenues
generated from  any particular  client is  generally dependent  upon  consumers'
interest  in, and use of, the  client's products and/or services. Furthermore, a
significant portion  of  the Company's  expected  revenues for  1996  relate  to
recently-introduced  product  or  service offerings  of  the  Company's clients,
including two significant programs developed for AT&T and CompuServe, two of the
Company's largest  clients.  There can  be  no assurance  as  to the  number  of
consumers  who will be attracted  to the products and  services of the Company's
clients and  who  will  therefore  need the  Company's  services,  or  that  the
Company's  clients will develop  new products or services  that will require the
Company's services. See "Business--Markets and Clients--Technology."
    
 
    MANAGEMENT OF GROWTH.   The Company  has experienced rapid  growth over  the
past  several years  and anticipates  continued future  growth. Continued growth
depends on a number of factors, including the Company's ability to (i) initiate,
develop  and  maintain  new  client  relationships  and  expand  its   marketing
operations,  (ii) recruit, motivate  and retain qualified  management and hourly
personnel, (iii)  rapidly  identify,  acquire  or  lease  suitable  Call  Center
facilities  on acceptable terms and complete  build-outs of such facilities in a
timely and economic fashion, and (iv) maintain the high quality of the  services
and  products that  it provides  to its  clients. The  Company's continued rapid
growth  can  be  expected  to  place  a  significant  strain  on  the  Company's
management,  operations, employees and resources. There can be no assurance that
the Company  will  be  able  to  maintain  or  accelerate  its  current  growth,
effectively manage its expanding
 
                                       5
<PAGE>
   
operations  or achieve planned  growth on a  timely or profitable  basis. If the
Company is  unable  to  manage  growth effectively,  its  business,  results  of
operations  or financial condition  could be materially  adversely affected. See
"Business--Growth Strategy."
    
 
   
    The Company's profitability is significantly  influenced by its Call  Center
capacity  utilization. Although the  Company seeks to  maximize utilization, the
inbound nature  of  the  Company's  business  results  in  significantly  higher
utilization  during  peak  (weekday)  periods than  during  off-peak  (night and
weekend) periods. In addition,  the Company has experienced,  and in the  future
may  experience, at least  short-term, excess capacity  during peak periods upon
the opening of a new Call Center  or the termination of a large client  program.
There  can be no assurance that the Company  will be able to achieve or maintain
optimal Call Center capacity utilization. See "Business-- Facilities."
    
 
   
    RISKS ASSOCIATED  WITH  THE  COMPANY'S  CONTRACTS.    Although  the  Company
currently  seeks to  sign multi-year contracts  with its  clients, the Company's
contracts do  not assure  the Company  a  specific level  of revenues  and  they
generally  do  not  designate  the Company  as  the  client's  exclusive service
provider. The Company believes  maintaining satisfactory relationships with  its
clients  has  a  more significant  impact  on  the Company's  revenues  than the
specific terms  of  its  client  contracts. Certain  of  the  Company's  current
contracts  (representing approximately 36% of  the Company's 1995 revenues) have
terms of one year or  less and there can be  no assurance that the clients  will
renew  or  extend  such  contracts. In  addition,  the  Company's  contracts are
terminable by its  clients on  relatively short  notice. Although  many of  such
contracts  require the client to pay a  contractually agreed amount in the event
of early termination, there can be no assurance that the Company will be able to
collect such  amount  or  that  such  amount,  if  received,  will  sufficiently
compensate  the Company for the investment it  has made to support the cancelled
program or for the revenues it may lose as a result of the early termination. In
addition, some of the Company's contracts limit the aggregate amount the Company
can charge for its services during the term of the contract and several prohibit
the Company from providing services to a direct competitor of a client that  are
similar  to the services the Company provides  to such client. Although a few of
the Company's more recently executed  contracts provide for annual increases  in
the  rates paid by  clients in the event  of increases in  certain cost or price
indices, most of the Company's contracts do not include such provisions and some
of the  contracts currently  in effect  provide that  the service  fees paid  by
clients may be adjusted downward if the performance objectives specified therein
are not attained or, at least in one case, in the event of a decrease in a price
index.  Furthermore, there can  be no assurance that  the adjustments based upon
increases in  cost  or price  indices  will  fully compensate  the  Company  for
increases  in labor  and other  costs that it  may experience  in fulfilling its
contractual obligations. Although several of the Company's clients have  elected
not  to renew  or extend short-term  contracts, or have  terminated contracts on
relatively short notice to the Company, to  date none of the foregoing types  of
contractual  provisions  has  had a  material  adverse effect  on  the Company's
business, results of operations or financial condition. See "Business--Sales and
Marketing"  and  "--Services"  and  "Management's  Discussion  and  Analysis  of
Financial Condition and Results of Operations."
    
 
   
    DEPENDENCE  ON LABOR FORCE.   The Company's success  is largely dependent on
its ability  to  recruit,  hire,  train  and  retain  qualified  employees.  The
Company's  industry is very  labor intensive and  has experienced high personnel
turnover. A significant increase in  the Company's employee turnover rate  could
increase  the  Company's recruiting  and training  costs and  decrease operating
effectiveness and productivity. Also, the addition of significant new clients or
the implementation  of  new large-scale  programs  may require  the  Company  to
recruit, hire and train qualified personnel at an accelerated rate. There can be
no assurance that the Company will be able to continue to hire, train and retain
sufficient  qualified personnel to adequately  staff new customer care programs.
Because a significant portion of the  Company's operating costs relate to  labor
costs,  an increase  in wages,  costs of  employee benefits  or employment taxes
could have  a material  adverse effect  on the  Company's business,  results  of
operations  or  financial  condition.  In  addition,  certain  of  the Company's
facilities are  located in  geographic areas  with relatively  low  unemployment
rates,  thus potentially making  it more difficult and  costly to hire qualified
personnel.  See  "--Management  of  Growth,"  "Business--Human  Resources"   and
"Management's  Discussion  and Analysis  of Financial  Condition and  Results of
Operations."
    
 
                                       6
<PAGE>
   
    DEPENDENCE ON KEY PERSONNEL.  The Company's success to date has depended  in
large  part  on the  skills and  efforts  of Kenneth  D. Tuchman,  the Company's
founder, Chairman of the Board, President and Chief Executive Officer. There can
be no assurance that the Company will be able to hire or retain the services  of
other  officers  or key  employees. The  loss  of Mr.  Tuchman or  the Company's
inability to hire or retain  such other officers or  key employees could have  a
material  adverse effect  on the  Company's business,  results of  operations or
financial condition. The Company's success  and achievement of its growth  plans
depend  on its ability to recruit, hire, train and retain other highly qualified
technical and  managerial  personnel,  including  individuals  with  significant
experience  in  the industries  targeted by  the Company.  The inability  of the
Company to attract and retain  the necessary technical and managerial  personnel
could  have  a material  adverse effect  on the  Company's business,  results of
operations  or   financial  condition.   See   "--Management  of   Growth"   and
"Management."
    
 
   
    DEPENDENCE  ON  KEY  INDUSTRIES.   The  Company's  clients  are concentrated
primarily in the  telecommunications, technology  and transportation  industries
and,  to a lesser extent, the health care and financial services industries. The
Company's business and growth is largely  dependent on the continued demand  for
the  Company's  services  from  these  industries  and  current  trends  in such
industries to  outsource  certain customer  care  services. A  general  economic
downturn  in any of these  industries or a slowdown or  reversal of the trend in
any of these industries to outsource certain customer care services could have a
material adverse  effect on  the Company's  business, results  of operations  or
financial  condition.  In  addition,  the Company's  health  care  and financial
services SBUs were  introduced only recently  and are still  in the  development
stage. There can be no assurance that the Company can successfully develop these
SBUs or that such development can occur in accordance with the Company's current
time  schedule. Additionally, a substantial percentage of the revenues generated
by clients in the telecommunications industry relate to the Company's  provision
of third-party verification of long-distance service sales, which is required by
the  rules of the Federal  Communications Commission. Such verification services
accounted for 19% and  11% of the  Company's total revenues in  1995 and in  the
first  quarter of 1996, respectively.  Although the Company is  not aware of any
proposed changes to these rules, the elimination of this requirement could  have
a  material adverse effect  on the Company's business,  results of operations or
financial condition. See "--Competition" and "Business-- Markets and Clients."
    
 
    RISK OF BUSINESS INTERRUPTION.  The Company's operations are dependent  upon
its  ability  to  protect  its  Call  Centers,  computer  and telecommunications
equipment  and  software   systems  against  damage   from  fire,  power   loss,
telecommunications  interruption or failure, natural  disaster and other similar
events.  In  the  event  the  Company  experiences  a  temporary  or   permanent
interruption  at one  or more of  its Call Centers,  through casualty, operating
malfunction or otherwise, the Company's  business could be materially  adversely
affected  and the  Company may  be required to  pay contractual  damages to some
clients or allow some clients to  terminate or renegotiate their contracts  with
the  Company.  While the  Company maintains  property and  business interruption
insurance, such  insurance may  not adequately  compensate the  Company for  all
losses that it may incur. See "Business--Operations."
 
   
    RISKS  ASSOCIATED  WITH  TECHNOLOGY.    The  Company's  business  is  highly
dependent on its computer and telecommunications equipment and software systems.
The  Company's  failure  to  maintain  the  superiority  of  its   technological
capabilities  or to  respond effectively to  technological changes  could have a
material adverse  effect on  the Company's  business, results  of operations  or
financial  condition. The Company's future success also will be highly dependent
upon its ability  to enhance  existing services  and introduce  new services  or
products  to respond  to changing  technological developments.  There can  be no
assurance that the Company can successfully develop and bring to market any  new
services  or products in a timely manner, that such services or products will be
commercially successful or that competitors'  technologies or services will  not
render  the  Company's  products  or services  noncompetitive  or  obsolete. See
"--Competition" and "Business--Technology."
    
 
    COMPETITION.  The market in which the Company competes is highly competitive
and fragmented. The Company expects competition to persist and intensify in  the
future.   The  Company's  competitors  include  small  firms  offering  specific
applications, divisions of  large entities,  large independent  firms and,  most
significantly, the in-house operations of clients or potential clients. A number
of competitors have or may
 
                                       7
<PAGE>
   
develop greater capabilities and resources than those of the Company. Similarly,
there  can be  no assurance that  additional competitors  with greater resources
than the Company  will not  enter the  Company's market.  Because the  Company's
primary  competitors  are  the  in-house  operations  of  existing  or potential
clients, the Company's performance  and growth could  be negatively impacted  if
its  existing clients  decide to  provide in-house  customer care  services that
currently are outsourced or  if potential clients retain  or increase their  in-
house   customer  service   and  product  support   capabilities.  For  example,
Continental Airlines, one of the Company's largest clients in 1995 and the first
quarter of 1996,  decided not to  renew a  program completed by  the Company  in
March 1996 due to Continental Airlines' excess in-house call center capacity. In
addition,  competitive pressures from current  or future competitors could cause
the Company's services to lose market acceptance or result in significant  price
erosion,  with a material adverse effect upon the Company's business, results of
operations or financial condition. See "Business--Competition."
    
 
   
    RISKS ASSOCIATED WITH ACQUISITIONS AND JOINT VENTURES.  One component of the
Company's growth strategy is to pursue strategic acquisitions of companies  that
have  services, products,  technologies, industry  specializations or geographic
coverage that extend or complement the Company's existing business. There can be
no assurance that the Company will be able successfully to identify, acquire  on
favorable  terms or integrate  such companies. If  any acquisition is completed,
there can  be no  assurance that  such acquisition  will enhance  the  Company's
business,  results of operations or financial  condition. The Company may in the
future face  increased  competition  for acquisition  opportunities,  which  may
inhibit  the  Company's ability  to  consummate suitable  acquisitions  on terms
favorable to  the  Company.  A  substantial portion  of  the  Company's  capital
resources, including proceeds from the Offering, could be used for acquisitions.
The  Company  may  require  additional  debt  or  equity  financing  for  future
acquisitions, which financing  may not be  available on terms  favorable to  the
Company,  if at all. As part of its growth strategy, the Company may also pursue
opportunities to undertake strategic  alliances in the  form of joint  ventures.
Joint  ventures  involve many  of the  same  risks as  acquisitions, as  well as
additional risks associated with possible lack of control of the joint ventures.
See "--Management of Growth."
    
 
   
    The Company recently acquired Access 24 Service Corporation Pty Limited,  an
Australian  company  ("Access 24"),  which provides  customer care  solutions to
Australian and New Zealand companies, primarily in the health care and financial
services industries. Certain of  Access 24's services, now  provided as part  of
the  Company's  health  care  and financial  services  strategic  business units
("SBUs"), differ  from the  traditional outsourcing  services of  the  Company's
United  States business. The Company also  recently entered into a joint venture
with PPP Healthcare Group plc ("PPP") to provide services in the United  Kingdom
and  Ireland similar  to those  provided by Access  24. Several  of the services
currently provided by  Access 24 and  the joint venture  in the United  Kingdom,
Australia  and  New  Zealand,  particularly services  provided  for  health care
clients, may be subject to extensive government regulation if introduced in  the
U.S. market. There can be no assurance that compliance with applicable U.S. laws
and  regulations will not limit the scope, or significantly increase the cost to
the Company, of  providing services in  the U.S. market  that are comparable  to
such  services currently provided by Access 24 and the joint venture outside the
U.S. The anticipated benefits of the Access 24 acquisition and the joint venture
with PPP, including  the successful offering  in the United  States of  services
similar  to those provided  by Access 24,  may not be  achieved. See "Business--
Markets and  Clients--Health  Care," "Business--Markets  and  Clients--Financial
Services" and "Business--International Operations."
    
 
   
    RISK ASSOCIATED WITH INTERNATIONAL OPERATIONS AND EXPANSION.  As a result of
the  recent acquisition of Access 24 and the joint venture with PPP, the Company
now conducts business  in the  United Kingdom,  Australia and  New Zealand.  The
Company's  international  operations  accounted  for  approximately  15%  of the
Company's revenues for  the first  quarter of  1996 and,  on a  pro forma  basis
reflecting  the Company's  acquisition of  Access 24  as if  it had  occurred on
January 1, 1995, approximately  16.9% of the Company's  revenues during 1995.  A
key  component of the  Company's growth strategy  is its continued international
expansion. There can be no assurance that the Company will be able  successfully
to  market, sell and deliver  its services in international  markets, or that it
will be able successfully to acquire companies, or integrate acquired companies,
to expand  international  operations.  In  addition,  there  are  certain  risks
inherent  in conducting  international business, including  exposure to currency
fluctuations, longer payment cycles,
    
 
                                       8
<PAGE>
   
greater  difficulties  in  accounts   receivable  collection,  difficulties   in
complying  with  a variety  of foreign  laws,  unexpected changes  in regulatory
requirements,  difficulties  in  staffing   and  managing  foreign   operations,
political  instability and potentially adverse tax consequences. There can be no
assurance that one  or more of  such factors  will not have  a material  adverse
effect  on  the Company's  international  operations and,  consequently,  on the
Company's  business,  results   of  operations  or   financial  condition.   See
"Business--International  Operations"  and  "Pro  Forma  Consolidated  Condensed
Financial Information."
    
 
    VARIABILITY OF QUARTERLY  OPERATING RESULTS.   The Company has  experienced,
and in the future could experience, quarterly variations in revenues as a result
of  a  variety of  factors, many  of  which are  outside the  Company's control,
including: the timing  of new contracts;  the timing of  new product or  service
offerings  or modifications in client  strategies; the expiration or termination
of existing contracts; the timing of  increased expenses incurred to obtain  and
support  new business;  changes in the  Company's revenue mix  among its various
service offerings;  and  the  seasonal  pattern of  certain  of  the  businesses
serviced  by the  Company. In addition,  the Company's  planned staffing levels,
investments and other operating expenditures are based on revenue forecasts.  If
revenues  are below expectations  in any given  quarter, the Company's operating
results would  likely be  materially adversely  affected for  that quarter.  See
"Management's  Discussion  and Analysis  of Financial  Condition and  Results of
Operations--Quarterly Results."
 
    GOVERNMENT REGULATION.   Because  the  Company's current  business  consists
primarily  of responding to inbound telephone calls, it is not highly regulated.
However, in  connection  with  the  limited  amount  of  outbound  telemarketing
services  that it provides, the  Company is required to  comply with the Federal
Communications  Commission's  rules   under  the   Federal  Telephone   Consumer
Protection  Act of 1991 and the Federal Trade Commission's regulations under the
Federal Telemarketing and Consumer Fraud and Abuse Prevention Act of 1994,  both
of which govern telephone solicitation. In the event that the Company decides to
expand  its outbound  telemarketing services,  such rules  and regulations would
apply to a larger percentage of  the Company's business. Furthermore, there  may
be   additional  federal  or   state  legislation,  or   changes  in  regulatory
implementation, that limit the activities of  the Company or its clients in  the
future  or  significantly increase  the  cost of  compliance.  Additionally, the
Company could be responsible for its failure, or the failure of its clients,  to
comply with regulations applicable to its clients.
 
   
    CONTROL  BY PRINCIPAL  STOCKHOLDER.   Following completion  of the Offering,
Kenneth D.  Tuchman,  the  Company's Chairman,  President  and  Chief  Executive
Officer,  will beneficially own approximately 72.1% of the outstanding shares of
Common  Stock  (approximately  70.4%  if  the  Underwriters'  over-allotment  is
exercised  in full). As a result, Mr. Tuchman  will continue to be able to elect
the entire Board of  Directors of the Company  and to control substantially  all
other  matters  requiring  action  by the  Company's  stockholders.  Such voting
concentration may  have the  effect of  discouraging, delaying  or preventing  a
change in control of the Company. See "Principal and Selling Stockholders."
    
 
    NO PRIOR PUBLIC MARKET AND POSSIBLE VOLATILITY OF STOCK PRICE.  Prior to the
Offering, there has been no public market for the Common Stock, and there can be
no  assurance that an active public market  for the Common Stock will develop or
be sustained after the Offering. The initial public offering price of the Common
Stock offered hereby was determined by negotiations between the Company and  the
Underwriters  based upon several factors. See "Underwriters" for a discussion of
the factors considered  in determining  the initial public  offering price.  The
market  price of the Common  Stock is likely to be  highly volatile and could be
subject to wide fluctuations  in response to  quarterly variations in  operating
results, announcements of new contracts or contract cancellations, announcements
of  technological innovations or new products or  services by the Company or its
competitors, changes  in financial  estimates by  securities analysts  or  other
events  or factors.  In addition, the  stock market  has experienced significant
price and volume fluctuations that have particularly affected the market  prices
of equity securities of many companies and that have often been unrelated to the
operating  performance of  such companies.  These broad  market fluctuations may
adversely affect the market  price of the Common  Stock. In the past,  following
periods  of volatility in the market price of a company's securities, securities
class action litigation has  often been instituted against  such a company.  Any
such litigation instigated against the Company could result in substantial costs
and  a diversion  of management's  attention and  resources, which  could have a
material adverse  effect on  the Company's  business, results  of operations  or
financial condition.
 
                                       9
<PAGE>
   
    SHARES ELIGIBLE FOR FUTURE SALE.  The sale of a substantial number of shares
of  Common Stock, or the perception that such sales could occur, could adversely
affect prevailing market prices  of the Common Stock.  The Company is unable  to
make  any prediction as to the effect, if any, that future sales of Common Stock
or the availability of Common Stock for sale may have on the market price of the
Common Stock prevailing from time  to time. In addition,  any such sale or  such
perception  could  make  it  more  difficult  for  the  Company  to  sell equity
securities or equity related securities in the  future at a time and price  that
the Company deems appropriate. Upon completion of the Offering, the Company will
have  outstanding an aggregate  of 55,046,240 shares  of Common Stock, excluding
shares of Common Stock issuable upon  exercise of options outstanding under  the
TeleTech  Holdings,  Inc.  Stock  Plan  (the  "Option  Plan")  and  the TeleTech
Holdings, Inc. Directors  Stock Option (the  "Directors Option Plan"),  together
with  additional options the Company plans to  grant under the Option Plan prior
to the closing of the Offering. The  Common Stock offered hereby will be  freely
tradeable  (other than by an "affiliate" of  the Company as such term is defined
under the Securities  Act of 1933,  as amended (the  "Securities Act"))  without
restriction  or registration under the Securities Act. All remaining outstanding
shares of Common Stock may  be sold under Rule  144 or Regulation S  promulgated
under  the Securities Act, subject to the holding period, volume, manner of sale
and other restrictions of Rule 144 or Regulation S and subject in certain  cases
to 180-day lock-up agreements with the Underwriters. See "Description of Capital
Stock," "Shares Eligible for Future Sale" and "Underwriters."
    
 
   
    DILUTION.   Purchasers of Common Stock  in the Offering will incur immediate
dilution of $14.17 per share in the net tangible book value per share of  Common
Stock (based upon an assumed initial offering price of $15.50 per share). To the
extent outstanding options to purchase the Company's Common Stock are exercised,
there will be further dilution. See "Dilution."
    
 
    ANTI-TAKEOVER PROVISIONS.  The Board of Directors has the authority to issue
up  to 10,000,000 shares of preferred stock  and to determine the price, rights,
preferences, privileges  and restrictions,  including  voting rights,  of  those
shares without any vote or action by the stockholders. The rights of the holders
of  the Common Stock will  be subject to, and may  be adversely affected by, the
rights of the holders of any preferred  stock that may be issued in the  future.
The  issuance of the  preferred stock, while  providing desirable flexibility in
connection with possible acquisitions and  other corporate purposes, could  have
the  effect of making it more difficult for  a third party to acquire a majority
of the outstanding voting stock of the Company. The Company has no present  plan
to  issue  any  additional  shares  of  preferred  stock.  Furthermore,  certain
provisions of the  Company's Restated Certificate  of Incorporation and  By-laws
and  of Delaware  law could delay  or make  difficult a merger,  tender offer or
proxy contest involving the Company. See "Description of Capital Stock."
 
                                       10
<PAGE>
   
                                  THE COMPANY
    
 
   
    TeleTech's principal executive offices are  located at 1700 Lincoln  Street,
Suite  1400, Denver, Colorado 80203 and  its telephone number is (303) 894-4000.
TeleTech was  incorporated  under the  laws  of  Delaware in  December  1994  in
connection with a restructuring of the ownership of TeleTech Telecommunications,
Inc.,  which was incorporated under the laws  of California in October 1982, and
TeleTech Teleservices, Inc., which was  incorporated under the laws of  Colorado
in  November 1992. As a result  of such restructuring, TeleTech Teleservices and
TeleTech Telecommunications became wholly-owned subsidiaries of TeleTech.
    
 
                                USE OF PROCEEDS
 
   
    The net proceeds to TeleTech from the sale of the 4,000,000 shares of Common
Stock being offered by TeleTech  are estimated to be approximately  $56,412,500,
assuming  an  initial  public  offering  price of  $15.50  per  share  and after
deducting  underwriting  discounts  and   commissions  and  estimated   offering
expenses.  TeleTech will  not receive  any proceeds from  the sale  of shares of
Common  Stock  by   the  Selling  Stockholders.   See  "Principal  and   Selling
Stockholders."  TeleTech intends  to use  a portion of  the net  proceeds of the
Offering to  repay  indebtedness outstanding  under  its $15  million  unsecured
revolving  line  of  credit, which  bears  interest  at various  rates  that are
selected by TeleTech at the time  a draw is made. On  June 15, 1996, a total  of
$8.5  million was  outstanding under  this line  of credit,  bearing interest at
rates ranging from 6.69%  to 6.75%. Such borrowings  have been used by  TeleTech
for general corporate purposes. See note 6 to the Financial Statements.
    
 
   
    One  of the  principal reasons  for the  Offering is  to generate sufficient
capital to enable the Company to respond rapidly to changing market demands  and
to  provide  it  with  the flexibility  necessary  to  maintain  its competitive
position. To enable it to respond to  market demand and provide new or  expanded
services  on short notice, TeleTech may require additional Call Center capacity.
During 1996,  TeleTech expects  to use  approximately $7.8  million of  the  net
proceeds  of the  Offering to purchase  computer hardware and  software and fund
leasehold improvements needed to equip and  open one additional Call Center  and
expand  an existing Call Center. A portion of  the net proceeds also may be used
for the  acquisition of  businesses, products  and technologies  that extend  or
complement TeleTech's existing business; however, TeleTech has no current plans,
agreements  or commitments and is not currently engaged in any negotiations with
respect to any such transaction. In addition, TeleTech intends to use a  portion
of  the net proceeds for working capital and general corporate purposes. Pending
any of such  uses, TeleTech plans  to invest  the net proceeds,  other than  net
proceeds  used to repay  short-term indebtedness, in  investment grade, interest
bearing securities.
    
 
                                DIVIDEND POLICY
 
    In 1995 TeleTech paid a dividend of approximately $452,000 to its  principal
stockholder.  TeleTech does not expect  to pay dividends on  its Common Stock in
1996 or in the foreseeable future.  The Board of Directors anticipates that  all
cash  flow generated from operations in  the foreseeable future will be retained
and used  to develop  and  expand TeleTech's  business.  Any future  payment  of
dividends   will  depend  upon  TeleTech's   results  of  operations,  financial
condition, cash requirements and other factors  deemed relevant by the Board  of
Directors.
 
                                       11
<PAGE>
                                 CAPITALIZATION
 
   
    The following table sets forth as of March 31, 1996 the Company's (i) actual
short-term debt and capitalization, (ii) short-term debt and capitalization on a
pro  forma basis after giving effect to the Preferred Stock Conversion and (iii)
short-term debt and  capitalization as adjusted  to reflect the  sale of  Common
Stock  offered hereby (at an assumed initial public offering price of $15.50 per
share and after deducting the  estimated underwriting discounts and  commissions
and the Offering expenses payable by the Company) and the application of the net
proceeds therefrom as described herein under "Use of Proceeds."
    
 
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                       MARCH 31, 1996
                                                                           --------------------------------------
                                                                                                      PRO FORMA
                                                                            ACTUAL      PRO FORMA    AS ADJUSTED
                                                                           ---------  -------------  ------------
                                                                                 (UNAUDITED, IN THOUSANDS)
<S>                                                                        <C>        <C>            <C>
Short-term borrowings and current portion of long-term debt..............  $   5,819    $   5,819    $   2,319(4)
                                                                           ---------  -------------  ------------
                                                                           ---------  -------------  ------------
Long-term debt, net of current portion (1)...............................  $   6,536    $   6,536    $   6,536
                                                                           ---------  -------------  ------------
Mandatorily redeemable convertible preferred stock, par value $6.45 per
 share (2)...............................................................     13,079           --           --
Stockholders' equity:
  Common stock, par value $.01 per share (3).............................        417          510          550
  Additional paid-in capital.............................................      7,067       20,053       76,425
  Cumulative translation adjustment......................................        141          141          141
  Unearned compensation--restricted stock................................       (380)        (380)        (380)
  Retained earnings......................................................      2,584        2,584        2,584
                                                                           ---------  -------------  ------------
    Total stockholders' equity...........................................      9,829       22,908       79,320
                                                                           ---------  -------------  ------------
      Total capitalization...............................................  $  29,444    $  29,444    $  85,856
                                                                           ---------  -------------  ------------
                                                                           ---------  -------------  ------------
</TABLE>
    
 
- ---------
(1)  See notes 4, 5 and 7 to the Financial Statements contained elsewhere herein
    for information regarding the Company's long-term debt.
 
(2) The 1,860,000 shares of mandatorily redeemable convertible preferred  stock,
    including  accrued dividends thereon of $1.1 million, will be converted into
    9,300,000 shares of Common  Stock. See note 11  to the Financial  Statements
    contained elsewhere herein.
 
   
(3)  Does not  include 7,750,000 shares  reserved for issuance  upon exercise of
    outstanding options, and additional options the Company plans to grant prior
    to the closing  of the  Offering, under the  Option Plan  and the  Directors
    Option  Plan. At  June 15,  1996, options  to acquire  4,559,845 shares were
    outstanding under the Option Plan and options to acquire 237,500 shares were
    outstanding under the Directors Option  Plan, which options have a  weighted
    average exercise price of $4.56 per share and $5.00 per share, respectively.
    See    "Management--Compensation   of   Directors,"   "Management--Executive
    Compensation," "--TeleTech Stock Option Plan."
    
 
   
(4) Reflects repayment of the March 31, 1996 balances outstanding under the line
    of credit.
    
 
                                       12
<PAGE>
                                    DILUTION
 
   
    The pro forma  net tangible book  value of  TeleTech as of  March 31,  1996,
after  giving effect  to the  five-for-one stock  split and  the Preferred Stock
Conversion, was $16,635,826, or $0.33 per  share of Common Stock. "Net  tangible
book value" per share is equal to the aggregate tangible assets of TeleTech less
its aggregate liabilities, divided by the total number of shares of Common Stock
outstanding on March 31, 1996. After giving effect to the estimated net proceeds
to  TeleTech of the Offering, the pro  forma net tangible book value of TeleTech
as of March  31, 1996 would  have been approximately  $73,048,326, or $1.33  per
share  of Common  Stock. This represents  an immediate increase  in net tangible
book value per share of $1.00 to existing stockholders and an immediate dilution
in net tangible book value per share of $14.17 to purchasers of Common Stock  in
the Offering, as illustrated in the following table:
    
 
   
<TABLE>
<S>                                                                            <C>        <C>
Assumed initial public offering price per share..............................             $   15.50
Net tangible book value per share at March 31, 1996..........................  $    0.33
Increase in net tangible book value per share attributable to new
 investors...................................................................       1.00
                                                                               ---------
Pro forma net tangible book value per share after the Offering...............             $    1.33
                                                                                          ---------
Dilution per share to new investors..........................................             $   14.17
                                                                                          ---------
                                                                                          ---------
</TABLE>
    
 
   
    TeleTech  has reserved an aggregate of  7,750,000 shares of Common Stock, as
adjusted to reflect the five-for-one stock split of the Company's Common  Stock,
for  issuance upon exercise  of outstanding options and  future awards under the
Option Plan and  the Directors  Option Plan.  As of  June 15,  1996, there  were
outstanding options to purchase an aggregate of 4,559,845 shares of Common Stock
under  the Option  Plan, at  a weighted  average price  of $4.56  per share, and
outstanding options to purchase an aggregate  of 237,500 shares of Common  Stock
under  the  Directors  Option  Plan, at  a  price  of $5.00  per  share.  Of the
foregoing, options to purchase  an aggregate of 753,125  shares of Common  Stock
were  exercisable as of  June 15, 1996. See  "Management--Stock Option Plan" and
"Management--Compensation of Directors."
    
 
   
    The following table sets forth as of June 15, 1996 the relative  investments
of the existing TeleTech stockholders and of the new investors, giving pro forma
effect  to (i)  the sale  by TeleTech of  4,000,000 shares  and the  sale by the
Selling Stockholders  of 2,220,000  shares  of the  Common Stock  being  offered
hereby,  at an assumed initial  public offering price of  $15.50 per share, (ii)
the five-for-one  stock split  and  (iii) consummation  of the  Preferred  Stock
Conversion:
    
 
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                        SHARES PURCHASED           TOTAL CONSIDERATION
                                                    -------------------------  ---------------------------  AVERAGE PRICE
                                                       NUMBER       PERCENT        AMOUNT        PERCENT      PER SHARE
                                                    ------------  -----------  --------------  -----------  -------------
<S>                                                 <C>           <C>          <C>             <C>          <C>
Existing stockholders.............................    48,826,240          89%  $   19,667,000          17%    $    0.40
New investors.....................................     6,220,000          11%      96,410,000          83%    $   15.50
                                                    ------------       -----   --------------       -----
    Total.........................................    55,046,240         100%  $  116,077,000         100%
                                                    ------------       -----   --------------       -----
                                                    ------------       -----   --------------       -----
</TABLE>
    
 
   
    The  foregoing table assumes no exercise of the Underwriters' over-allotment
option and no exercise of  options outstanding. To the  extent that any of  such
options are exercised, there will be further dilution to new investors.
    
 
                                       13
<PAGE>
                            SELECTED FINANCIAL DATA
 
    The  following selected  financial data should  be read  in conjunction with
"Management's Discussion  and Analysis  of Financial  Condition and  Results  of
Operations"  and  the  Financial  Statements  and  the  related  notes appearing
elsewhere  in  this  Prospectus.  The  following  table  presents  selected  (a)
consolidated  and combined  financial data for  TeleTech for (i)  the year ended
January 31, 1992, which  have been derived  from reviewed financial  statements;
(ii)  the year  ended January  31, 1993,  which have  been derived  from audited
financial statements; (iii)  the eleven  months ended December  31, 1993,  which
have been derived from financial statements (including those set forth elsewhere
in  this  Prospectus)  that  have  been  audited  by  Gumbiner,  Savett, Finkel,
Fingleson &  Rose,  Inc.,  independent public  accountants  (formerly  Gumbiner,
Savett, Friedman and Rose, Inc.); (iv) each of the two years in the period ended
December  31, 1995, which are derived from financial statements (including those
set forth  elsewhere  in this  Prospectus)  that  have been  audited  by  Arthur
Andersen  LLP, independent  public accountants; and  (v) the  three months ended
March 31, 1995 and 1996; and (b) unaudited pro forma consolidated financial data
for the year ended December 31, 1995. The selected financial data for the  three
months  ended  March 31,  1995  and 1996  are  derived from  unaudited financial
statements  that,  in  the  opinion  of  management,  include  all  adjustments,
consisting  principally  of  normal  recurring accruals,  necessary  for  a fair
presentation of such data. The results for the three months ended March 31, 1996
are not necessarily indicative of the results expected for the full fiscal year.
 
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                 ELEVEN
                                                                 MONTHS                                          THREE MONTHS
                                              YEAR ENDED         ENDED           YEAR ENDED                         ENDED
                                              JANUARY 31,       DECEMBER        DECEMBER 31,                      MARCH 31,
                                          -------------------  31,          --------------------               ----------------
                                                       1993       1993         1994       1995                  1995     1996
                                                      -------  ----------   ----------   -------               -------  -------
                                                                                                     PRO
                                                                                                  FORMA (1)
                                                                                                  YEAR ENDED
                                            1992                                                   DECEMBER
                                          ---------                                               31,
                                                                                                     1995
                                          (UNAUDITED)                                             ----------
                                                                                                  (UNAUDITED)    (UNAUDITED)
<S>                                       <C>         <C>      <C>          <C>          <C>      <C>          <C>      <C>
                                                                            (IN THOUSANDS, EXCEPT PER SHARE AND OPERATING DATA)
STATEMENT OF OPERATIONS DATA:
Revenues................................  $ 5,751     $13,814  $19,520      $   35,462   $50,467  $60,706      $10,412  $22,019
  Costs of services.....................    2,703       7,324   10,727          17,406    27,246   31,239      5,469     11,194
  SG&A expenses.........................    3,380       6,240    7,956          15,860    18,625   24,908      4,329      8,102
                                          ---------   -------  ----------   ----------   -------  ----------   -------  -------
Income (loss) from operations...........     (332)        250      837           2,196     4,596    4,559        614      2,723
Other income (expenses).................      707        (125)    (299)           (481)    2,489(2)   2,784(2) 2,338  (2)    (464)
Provision for (benefit of) income
 taxes..................................      161          73      (10)             20     2,929    3,353      1,324      1,001
                                          ---------   -------  ----------   ----------   -------  ----------   -------  -------
Net income..............................  $   214     $    52  $   548      $    1,695   $ 4,156(2) $ 3,990(2) $1,628 (2) $ 1,258
                                          ---------   -------  ----------   ----------   -------  ----------   -------  -------
                                          ---------   -------  ----------   ----------   -------  ----------   -------  -------
Pro forma net income....................  $   214     $    52  $   299(3)   $    1,037(3) $ 4,156(2) $ 3,990(2) $1,628 (2) $ 1,258
                                          ---------   -------  ----------   ----------   -------  ----------   -------  -------
                                          ---------   -------  ----------   ----------   -------  ----------   -------  -------
Pro forma net income per share of Common
 Stock and equivalents (4)..............  $    --     $    --  $   .01(3)   $      .02(3) $   .08(2) $   .07(2) $ .03  (2) $   .02
Weighted average shares outstanding
 (4)....................................   43,843      43,843   43,843          43,843    54,402   54,402      54,331    54,426
 
OPERATING DATA:
  Number of Call Centers................        1           1        2               2         3                   3          9
  Number of workstations................      300         300      560             560       960                 960      3,107
</TABLE>
    
 
   
                                                        (FOOTNOTES ON NEXT PAGE)
    
 
                                       14
<PAGE>
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                                      MARCH 31, 1996
                              JANUARY 31,                  DECEMBER 31,                           ----------------------
                        ------------------------  -------------------------------                                PRO
                                         1993       1993       1994       1995                     ACTUAL     FORMA (5)
                                       ---------  ---------  ---------  ---------                 ---------  -----------
                                                                                     PRO FORMA
                                                                                   DECEMBER 31,
                            1992                                                     1995 (1)
                        -------------                                              -------------
                         (UNAUDITED)                                                (UNAUDITED)        (UNAUDITED)
<S>                     <C>            <C>        <C>        <C>        <C>        <C>            <C>        <C>
BALANCE SHEET DATA:
Working capital
 (deficit)............    $     221    $    (250) $    (228) $    (780) $  11,305    $   8,340    $   5,380   $   5,380
Total assets..........        2,238        4,617     12,034     10,102     30,583       39,882       49,454      49,454
Long-term debt, net of
 current portion......          828        1,416      3,528      2,463      3,590        5,468        6,536       6,536
Total stockholders'
 equity...............          338          394        942      2,197      3,791        8,220        9,829      22,908
 
<CAPTION>
 
                        PRO FORMA AS
                        ADJUSTED (6)
                        -------------
 
<S>                     <C>
BALANCE SHEET DATA:
Working capital
 (deficit)............    $  61,792
Total assets..........      102,367
Long-term debt, net of
 current portion......        6,536
Total stockholders'
 equity...............       79,321
</TABLE>
    
 
- ------------
(1) Reflects the consolidated operating results and financial position of Access
    24 and  its  subsidiaries, which  were  acquired by  the  Company  effective
    January  1, 1996, as  if such acquisition  had been completed  on January 1,
    1995. Costs and expenses of Access  24 have been reflected, for purposes  of
    this presentation, as costs of services.
 
(2) Includes the $2.4 million pre-tax net proceeds of a one-time payment made by
    a  former  client  to  TeleTech  in  connection  with  such  client's  early
    termination of a contract.
 
(3) During 1993 and 1994, the Company was an S corporation and, accordingly, was
    not subject  to  federal income  taxes.  Pro  forma net  income  includes  a
    provision  for income taxes at an effective  rate of 44.4% for the 11 months
    ended December 31, 1993 and 39.5% for the year ended December 31, 1994.
 
(4) Calculated in the manner described in note 1 to the Financial Statements.
 
(5) Reflects  the  conversion  of  1,860,000  shares  of  Preferred  Stock  into
    9,300,000 shares of Common Stock pursuant to the Preferred Stock Conversion.
 
   
(6)  Reflects the  sale of  4,000,000 shares  of Common  Stock being  offered by
    TeleTech at an  assumed initial public  offering price of  $15.50 per  share
    (net  of  approximately  $5.6  million of  estimated  offering  expenses and
    underwriting discounts and commissions) and the application of the estimated
    net proceeds therefrom, including repayment of short-term indebtedness.  See
    "Use of Proceeds" and "Capitalization."
    
 
                                       15
<PAGE>
             PRO FORMA CONSOLIDATED CONDENSED FINANCIAL INFORMATION
 
    The  following unaudited  pro forma consolidated  condensed income statement
gives effect to the acquisition of Access 24 as if it had occurred on January 1,
1995 and does not purport to represent what the Company's results of  operations
actually would have been if such transactions had in fact occurred on such date.
See "Business--International Operations." The pro forma adjustments are based on
currently  available information  and upon  certain assumptions  that management
believes are reasonable  under current  circumstances. The  unaudited pro  forma
consolidated  financial  information and  accompanying notes  should be  read in
conjunction with the Financials  Statements and the  related notes thereto,  and
other  financial information pertaining  to the Company  and Access 24 including
"Management's Discussion  and Analysis  of Financial  Condition and  Results  of
Operations" and "Business--International Operations," included elsewhere in this
Prospectus.
 
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                          YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1995
                                                             ------------------------------------------------------
                                                             TELETECH
                                                             ---------   ACCESS 24      ADJUSTMENTS      PRO FORMA
                                                                        ------------  ----------------  -----------
                                                                        (UNAUDITED)     (UNAUDITED)     (UNAUDITED)
<S>                                                          <C>        <C>           <C>               <C>
INCOME STATEMENT DATA:                                               (IN THOUSANDS, EXCEPT PER SHARE DATA)
Revenues...................................................  $  50,467  $  10,239     $      --          $  60,706
Operating expenses.........................................     45,871     10,036(1)        240 (2)(3       56,147
                                                             ---------  ------------      -----         -----------
Income (loss) from operations..............................      4,596        203          (240)             4,559
Other income...............................................      2,489         295             --            2,784
Provision for income taxes.................................      2,929         424             --            3,353
                                                             ---------  ------------        -----       -----------
Net income (loss)..........................................  $   4,156  $       74           (240     ) $    3,990
                                                             ---------  ------------        -----       -----------
                                                             ---------  ------------        -----       -----------
Pro forma net income per share.............................  $     .08                                  $      .07
Shares used in computing pro forma net income per share
 (4).......................................................     54,402                                      54,402
</TABLE>
    
 
- ---------
   
(1) Includes approximately $300,000 associated with the opening of a Call Center
    in  the United  Kingdom and  a $141,000  write-off of  an unrecoverable loan
    associated with the disposition of an unrelated business.
    
 
   
(2) Includes $422,000  of amortization  of goodwill arising  from the  Company's
    acquisition  of Access 24. The Company acquired 100% of the capital stock of
    Access 24  on January  1,  1996 for  total  consideration of  $7.1  million,
    consisting  of $2.3 million in  cash and 970,240 shares  of Common Stock. In
    addition, the Company  incurred approximately  $255,000 of  legal and  other
    costs  related to the acquisition. The  Company allocated the purchase price
    based upon the fair market value of the assets acquired and the  liabilities
    assumed. The following is a summary of the purchase price allocation:
    
 
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
Assets acquired:
<S>                                                                           <C>
  Cash and cash investments.................................................  $  603,000
  Accounts receivable.......................................................   1,467,000
  Property, plant and equipment.............................................   3,119,000
  Goodwill..................................................................   6,380,000
  Other assets..............................................................     636,000
                                                                              ----------
                                                                              $12,205,000
                                                                              ----------
Liabilities assumed:
  Accounts payable and accrued liabilities..................................  (1,750,000)
  Debt and capital lease obligations........................................  (2,472,000)
  Other liabilities.........................................................    (612,000)
                                                                              ----------
                                                                              (4,834,000)
                                                                              ----------
                                                                              $7,371,000
                                                                              ----------
                                                                              ----------
</TABLE>
    
 
   
    The  Company is amortizing  goodwill arising from  the acquisition using the
    straight line method over an estimated life of 15 years.
    
 
   
(3) Includes a $182,000 credit to eliminate Access 24's historical  amortization
    of goodwill.
    
 
   
(4) Includes outstanding shares of common stock and common stock equivalents.
    
 
                                       16
<PAGE>
               MANAGEMENT'S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL
                      CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS
 
OVERVIEW
 
   
    TeleTech  generates its revenues by  providing customer care solutions, both
from TeleTech-owned  Call  Centers  (fully  outsourced)  and  client-owned  Call
Centers  (facilities management).  The Company  normally bills  for its services
based on the  amount of time  Representatives devote to  a client's program  and
revenues are typically recognized as services are provided. The Company seeks to
enter  into multi-year contracts that cannot be terminated early except upon the
payment of  a contractually  agreed amount.  In 1995,  revenues from  multi-year
contracts   represented  64%  of  total  revenues.  Approximately  60%  of  such
multi-year contract  revenues  were attributable  to  contracts that  contain  a
provision  requiring the client to pay the Company a contractually agreed amount
in the event of early termination of  the contract. In the second half of  1995,
the  Company signed large,  multi-year contracts with  United Parcel Service and
CompuServe and obtained  additional business from  AT&T for programs  commencing
principally  in  the  first  quarter of  1996.  Accordingly,  management expects
revenues from multi-year contracts to increase as a percentage of total revenues
in 1996.
    
 
   
    TeleTech's profitability  is significantly  influenced  by its  Call  Center
capacity utilization. The Company seeks to optimize new and existing Call Center
capacity utilization during both peak (weekday) and off-peak (night and weekend)
periods  to achieve maximum  fixed cost absorption.  The Company carefully plans
the development and opening of new Call Centers to minimize the financial impact
resulting from excess  capacity. To  enable the  Company to  respond rapidly  to
changing  market demands, implement  new programs and  expand existing programs,
TeleTech may require additional Call  Center capacity. TeleTech currently  plans
to open one additional Call Center and expand an existing Call Center by the end
of 1996. If, prior to the opening or expansion of a Call Center, the Company has
not  contracted  with clients  for  the provision  of  services that  will fully
utilize  peak  period  capacity,  TeleTech  may  experience,  at  least  in  the
short-term,  excess Call  Center capacity.  The Company's  results of operations
have  not  been   materially  adversely   affected  by   peak  period   capacity
underutilization,  other  than  for a  brief  period during  1995  following the
Company's opening of its Burbank Call Center. See "--1995 Compared to 1994"  and
"Risk Factors--Management of Growth."
    
 
    The  Company records costs  specifically associated with  client programs as
costs of services. These costs, which  include direct labor wages and  benefits,
telecommunication  charges, sales  commissions and  certain facility  costs, are
primarily variable  in  nature.  All other  expenses  of  operations,  including
expenses attributable to technology support, sales and marketing, human resource
management  and  other  administrative  functions  and  Call  Center operational
expenses that are not  allocable to specific programs  are recorded as  selling,
general  and administrative ("SG&A")  expenses. SG&A expenses  tend to be either
semi-variable or fixed in  nature. Historically, the  majority of the  Company's
operating  expenses have  consisted of labor  costs. Accordingly, Representative
wage rates, which comprise the majority of the Company's labor costs, have  been
and are expected to continue to be a key component of the Company's expenses.
 
   
    The  cost  characteristics of  TeleTech's  fully outsourced  programs differ
significantly  from  the  cost  characteristics  of  its  facilities  management
programs.  Under facilities management  programs, Call Centers  are owned by the
client  but  are  staffed  and  managed  by  TeleTech.  Accordingly,  facilities
management  programs have higher  costs of services as  a percentage of revenues
and lower  SG&A expenses  as  a percentage  of  revenues than  fully  outsourced
programs.  As a result, the  Company expects that its  overall gross margin will
fluctuate  as  revenues  attributable  to  fully  outsourced  programs  vary  in
proportion  to revenues attributable to facilities management programs. Based on
the foregoing, management believes that, for purposes of measuring profitability
on a period-to-period basis, operating  margin, which is income from  operations
expressed as a percentage of revenues, may be less subject to fluctuation as the
proportion  of the Company's business portfolio attributable to fully outsourced
programs versus facilities management programs changes. Because the Company  did
not  begin significant operations under its  first, and to date only, facilities
management agreement until  April 1996,  the Company did  not generate  material
revenues  from facilities management programs during  any periods covered by the
Financial Statements.
    
 
                                       17
<PAGE>
   
    TeleTech's revenues and income from operations have grown significantly over
the past three years. During this period, the Company's revenues have grown from
$19.5 million for the 11 months ended December 31, 1993 to $50.5 million for the
year ended December  31, 1995 and  operating margin has  increased from 4.3%  in
1993 to 9.1% in 1995. The significant growth in revenues and operating margin is
the result of increased revenues from new and existing contracts and utilization
of  additional capacity resulting from the  February 1995 opening of the Burbank
Call Center. In the first quarter  of 1996, the Company's operating margin  rose
to  12.4%. Management attributes this growth to the successful implementation of
the Company's  strategy of  developing  long-term strategic  relationships  with
large  corporate  clients in  targeted  industries and  the  Company's resulting
ability to spread its fixed costs over a larger revenue base.
    
 
   
    The Company acquired  Access 24  and its subsidiaries  effective January  1,
1996  for consideration  of $2.3  million in cash  and 970,240  shares of Common
Stock. Access  24's  consolidated results  of  operations are  included  in  the
Company's  operating  results  beginning with  the  first quarter  of  1996. The
operations of Access 24, which consist of inbound, client-branded customer  care
services,  have been substantially integrated into TeleTech's operations. Access
24 typically  bills  its clients  monthly,  based  on the  number  of  customers
enrolled  in a client's program, pursuant to multi-year agreements. Access 24 is
headquartered in  Sydney,  Australia with  Call  Centers in  Australia  and  New
Zealand.  On  April 30,  1996,  the Company  sold a  50%  interest in  Access 24
Limited, the Company's United Kingdom subsidiary  that owns and operates a  Call
Center  in London, for $3.8 million to PPP Healthcare Group plc, a large private
health insurer in the United Kingdom. The Company realized an after-tax gain  of
approximately  $1.6 million on this sale in the second quarter of 1996. TeleTech
will account  for its  investment  in Access  24  Limited as  an  unconsolidated
subsidiary.   See  "Business--International  Operations"  and  the  Consolidated
Financial Statements of Access 24 contained elsewhere in this Prospectus.
    
 
    During 1993 and 1994, the Company was an S corporation and, accordingly, was
not subject  to income  taxes. Pro  forma net  income includes  a provision  for
federal  income taxes  at an  effective rate  of 44.4%  for the  11 months ended
December 31, 1993 and 39.5% for the year ended December 31, 1994.
 
RESULTS OF OPERATIONS
 
    The following table sets forth certain income statement data as a percentage
of revenues:
 
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                                THREE MONTHS ENDED
                                                              YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31,                MARCH 31,
                                                        ------------------------------------  -----------------------
                                                          1993(1)      1994         1995          1995        1996
                                                        -----------  ---------  ------------  ------------  ---------
<S>                                                     <C>          <C>        <C>           <C>           <C>
Revenues..............................................       100.0%      100.0%     100.0%        100.0%        100.0%
  Costs of services...................................        54.9        49.1       54.0          52.5          50.8
  SG&A expenses.......................................        40.8        44.7       36.9          41.6          36.8
Income from operations................................         4.3         6.2        9.1           5.9          12.4
Other income (expenses)...............................        (1.5)       (1.4)       4.9(2)       22.5(2)       (2.1)
Provision for income taxes (3)........................          --          --        5.8          12.8           4.6
Net income (3)........................................         2.8         4.8        8.2(2)       15.6(2)        5.7
Pro forma net income (3)..............................         1.5         2.9        8.2(2)       15.6(2)        5.7
</TABLE>
    
 
- ---------
(1) Includes only eleven  months due to  a change in  the Company's fiscal  year
    end.
 
(2) Includes the $2.4 million pre-tax net proceeds of a one-time payment made by
    a  former client to TeleTech in the first quarter of 1995 in connection with
    such client's early termination of a contract (the "One-Time Payment").
 
(3) During 1993 and 1994, the Company was an S corporation and, accordingly, was
    not subject  to  federal income  taxes.  Pro  forma net  income  includes  a
    provision  for income taxes at an effective  rate of 44.4% for the 11 months
    ended December 31, 1993 and 39.5% for the year ended December 31, 1994.
 
                                       18
<PAGE>
THREE MONTHS ENDED MARCH 31, 1996 COMPARED TO THREE MONTHS ENDED MARCH 31, 1995
 
   
    REVENUES.  Revenues increased $11.6 million, or 111.5%, to $22.0 million for
the first quarter of 1996 from $10.4 million for the first quarter of 1995. This
increase resulted from revenues of $9.4  million generated from new clients  and
$3.3  million in revenues of Access 24,  which was acquired in the first quarter
of 1996. These increases were  partially offset by the  loss of $1.1 million  in
revenues  due to the expiration of  certain contracts. The Company's program for
Continental Airlines  was completed  in  March 1996  and, due  to  Continental's
excess  in-house call center  capacity, was not renewed.  The lost revenues from
the expiration of the Continental Airlines program were more than offset in  the
first  quarter of 1996 by revenues from  new clients. The Company received prior
notice that Continental Airlines  would not renew  its contract upon  expiration
and  redeployed to new programs all of the workstations that previously had been
dedicated to  the  Continental  Airlines program.  Consequently,  there  was  no
material  capacity underutilization due to the  loss of the Continental Airlines
program; however, there can be no  assurance that the Company's loss of  another
large  client would not  result in substantial  underutilized capacity. Revenues
for the first quarter of 1996 reflect the first period in which the Burbank Call
Center, which  opened  in  February  1995, was  fully  utilized  and  additional
capacity in the Denver Call Center, which was expanded in February 1996.
    
 
    COSTS  OF SERVICES.  Costs of services increased $5.7 million, or 104.7%, to
$11.2 million for  the first quarter  of 1996  from $5.5 million  for the  first
quarter  of 1995.  Costs of  services decreased as  a percentage  of revenues to
50.8% for the first quarter  of 1996 from 52.5% for  the first quarter of  1995.
This change was primarily due to increased productivity as revenues increased at
a faster rate than personnel costs.
 
    SELLING,  GENERAL AND ADMINISTRATIVE.  SG&A expenses increased $3.8 million,
or 87.2%, to $8.1 million  for the first quarter of  1996 from $4.3 million  for
the  first quarter of 1995. As a percentage of revenues, SG&A expenses decreased
to 36.8% for the first quarter of 1996 from 41.6% for the first quarter of  1995
reflecting  economies of scale associated with spreading fixed and semi-variable
costs over a larger revenue base.  This decrease primarily resulted from a  3.5%
decrease in wage expense as a percentage of revenues.
 
   
    INCOME FROM OPERATIONS.  Operating income increased $2.1 million, or 343.5%,
to  $2.7 million  in the first  quarter of  1996 from $614,000  during the first
quarter of 1995. Operating income as a percentage of revenues increased to 12.4%
in the first quarter of 1996 from 5.9% in the same period in 1995.
    
 
   
    OTHER INCOME (EXPENSES).  Other income (expenses) decreased $2.8 million, or
(119.8%), to ($464,000) for the first quarter of 1996 from $2.3 million for  the
first  quarter  of  1995. This  decrease  primarily resulted  from  the One-Time
Payment.
    
 
   
    NET INCOME.   As a  result of the  foregoing factors,  net income  decreased
$370,000,  or 22.7%,  to $1.3 million  for the  first quarter of  1996 from $1.6
million for  the first  quarter of  1995. Excluding  the One-Time  Payment,  net
income  for the  three months  ended March  31, 1995  would have  been $116,000.
Accordingly, net income  would have increased  $1.1 million, or  984.5%, in  the
first quarter of 1996 compared to the same period in 1995.
    
 
1995 COMPARED TO PRO FORMA 1995
 
   
    Pro  forma  1995 reflects  the combined  operating  results of  TeleTech and
Access 24, as if Access 24 had been acquired by TeleTech on January 1, 1995. For
the 12 months ended December 31, 1995, Access 24 had revenue of $10.2 million, a
loss from operations of  approximately $37,000 and a  net loss of $166,000.  The
results  for such  period reflect amortization  of $422,000  of goodwill arising
from the Company's acquisition of Access 24, approximately $300,000 of  expenses
associated  with  the opening  of  a Call  Center in  the  United Kingdom  and a
$141,000 write-off of an unrecoverable  loan associated with the disposition  of
an unrelated business. On April 30, 1996, the Company sold a 50% interest in the
London Call Center to PPP, a large private health insurer in the United Kingdom.
See "Business--International Operations."
    
 
                                       19
<PAGE>
1995 COMPARED TO 1994
 
   
    REVENUES.   Revenues increased $15.0 million,  or 42.3%, to $50.5 million in
1995 from  $35.5  million in  1994,  reflecting  an increase  in  revenues  from
existing  clients of approximately $6.4 million and revenues from new clients of
approximately $17.8  million.  These  increases were  partially  offset  by  the
expiration  without renewal of certain other client contracts. See "Other Income
(Expenses)" below.
    
 
   
    COSTS OF SERVICES.  Costs of  services increased $9.8 million, or 56.5%,  to
$27.2  million in  1995 from  $17.4 million  in 1994.  The increase  in costs of
services is primarily the result of the $15 million increase in revenues for the
period and  the  related  increase in  direct  costs.  Costs of  services  as  a
percentage  of  revenues increased  to 54.0%  in  1995 from  49.1% in  1994. The
majority of this percentage increase resulted  from the start-up of the  Burbank
Call  Center in  February 1995, which  was not fully  utilized immediately after
opening.  Consequently,  operating  costs  represented  a  comparatively  higher
percentage  of revenues. In  addition, during 1995 a  higher proportion of total
expenses were  classified  as costs  of  services as  the  Company was  able  to
allocate  to specific client  programs costs that  previously had been allocated
among multiple client programs as SG&A expenses. The Company's enhanced  ability
to identify costs related to specific programs resulted from improvements in the
Company's  systems as well as from the consolidation of accounting and financial
functions at the Company's headquarters in Denver.
    
 
    SELLING, GENERAL AND ADMINISTRATIVE.  SG&A expenses increased $2.8  million,
or  17.4%, to $18.6 million in 1995 from  $15.9 million in 1994. As a percentage
of revenues, SG&A  expenses decreased to  36.9% in  1995 from 44.7%  in 1994.  A
substantial  part of this change resulted from  a 4.0% reduction in wage expense
as a percentage of revenues.
 
    INCOME FROM OPERATIONS.  Income  from operations increased $2.4 million,  or
109.3%,  to $4.6 million in  1995 from $2.2 million  1994. Operating income as a
percentage of revenues increased to 9.1% in 1995 from 6.2% in 1994.
 
    OTHER INCOME (EXPENSES).  Other income (expenses) increased $3.0 million  to
$2.5  million in 1995 from  ($481,000) in 1994. This  increase resulted from the
One-Time Payment as well as increased interest income attributable to the  $12.0
million  proceeds received by  the Company from  the sale of  Preferred Stock in
1995.
 
   
    NET INCOME AND PRO FORMA NET INCOME.  Net income increased $2.5 million,  or
145.2%,  to $4.2 million in 1995  from $1.7 million in 1994.  As a result of the
foregoing factors, net income in 1995 increased $3.1 million, or 300.7%, to $4.2
million from pro forma net  income of $1.0 million  in 1994. Excluding the  One-
Time Payment, net income for 1995 would have been $2.6 million. Accordingly, net
income  for 1995 would  have increased $1.6  million, or 155.0%,  over pro forma
income of $1.0 million for 1994.
    
 
1994 COMPARED TO 1993
 
    During 1993,  the Company  changed its  fiscal  year to  December 31.  As  a
result,  the 1993 fiscal year  consists of the eleven  months ended December 31,
1993.
 
    REVENUES.  Revenues increased $15.9 million,  or 81.7%, to $35.5 million  in
1994  from $19.5  million in  1993. This  increase consisted  primarily of $14.2
million of  revenues generated  from new  clients, with  the remaining  increase
generated from existing clients. The increase reflects a full year of operations
of  the Denver  Call Center,  which generated $13.9  million of  revenue in 1994
versus $2.9 million of revenue in 1993.
 
   
    COSTS OF SERVICES.  Costs of  services increased $6.7 million, or 62.3%,  to
$17.4 million in 1994 from $10.7 million in 1993. Costs of services decreased as
a  percentage of  revenues to  49.1% in 1994  from 54.9%  in 1993.  Much of this
percentage decrease  resulted from  an increased  proportion of  services  being
performed in 1994 for higher-margin client programs compared to in 1993.
    
 
    SELLING,  GENERAL AND ADMINISTRATIVE.  SG&A expenses increased $7.9 million,
or 99.3%, to  $15.9 million in  1994 from  $8.0 million in  1993. SG&A  expenses
increased  as a percentage of revenues to 44.7% in 1994 from 40.8% in 1993. Much
of this increase  resulted from increased  compensation expense associated  with
growth in administrative functions necessary to support projected expansion.
 
                                       20
<PAGE>
   
    INCOME  FROM OPERATIONS.  Income from  operations increased $1.4 million, or
162.4%, to $2.2 million  in 1994 from  $837,000 in 1993.  Operating income as  a
percentage of revenues increased to 6.2% in 1994 from 4.3% in 1993.
    
 
   
    PRO  FORMA NET INCOME.  As a result of the foregoing factors, and a decrease
in the effective tax  rate to 39.5%  for the year ended  December 31, 1994  from
44.4%  for the 11 months ended December 31, 1993, pro forma net income increased
$738,000, or 246.8%, to $1.0 million in 1994 from $299,000 in 1993.
    
 
QUARTERLY RESULTS
 
    The  information  set  forth  below  is  derived  from  unaudited  quarterly
operating results of the Company for each quarter of 1994 and 1995 and the first
quarter of 1996. The data has been prepared by the Company on a basis consistent
with the Financial Statements included elsewhere in this Prospectus and includes
all  adjustments, consisting principally of  normal recurring accruals, that the
Company considers necessary  for a  fair presentation  thereof. These  operating
results are not necessarily indicative of the Company's future performance.
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                        THREE MONTHS ENDED
                                   --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                                        1994                                           1995
                                   ----------------------------------------------  --------------------------------------------
                                     MAR 31       JUN 30      SEP 30     DEC 31     MAR 31(1)    JUN 30     SEP 30     DEC 31
                                   -----------  -----------  ---------  ---------  -----------  ---------  ---------  ---------
                                                              (IN THOUSANDS, EXCEPT PER SHARE DATA)
<S>                                <C>          <C>          <C>        <C>        <C>          <C>        <C>        <C>
Revenues.........................   $   8,976    $   8,406   $   8,080  $  10,000  $  10,412    $  11,879  $  12,692  $  15,484
  Costs of services..............       4,715        4,314       3,719      4,658      5,469        6,407      6,899      8,471
  SG&A expenses..................       3,556        4,014       3,702      4,588      4,329        4,265      4,575      5,456
Income from operations...........         705           78         659        754        614        1,207      1,218      1,557
Other income (expenses)..........        (118)        (154)       (102)      (107)     2,338(1)        35         38         78
Provision for (benefit of) income
 taxes...........................          15           (3)          2          6      1,324          449        394        762
Net income.......................         572          (73)        555        641      1,628          793        862        873
Pro forma net income (2).........         359          (49)        336        391      1,628          793        862        873
Pro forma net income per share...         .01           --         .01        .01        .03          .01        .02        .02
Weighted average shares
 outstanding.....................      43,843       43,843      43,843     43,843     54,331       54,402     54,402     54,402
 
<CAPTION>
 
                                     1996
                                   ---------
                                    MAR 31
                                   ---------
 
<S>                                <C>
Revenues.........................  $  22,019
  Costs of services..............     11,194
  SG&A expenses..................      8,102
Income from operations...........      2,723
Other income (expenses)..........       (464)
Provision for (benefit of) income
 taxes...........................      1,001
Net income.......................      1,258
Pro forma net income (2).........      1,258
Pro forma net income per share...        .02
Weighted average shares
 outstanding.....................     54,426
</TABLE>
    
 
    The following table sets forth certain income statement data as a percentage
of revenues:
 
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                    THREE MONTHS ENDED
                            --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                               1994                                         1995                       1996
                            -------------------------------------------  ------------------------------------------  ---------
                             MAR 31     JUN 30     SEP 30      DEC 31     MAR 31     JUN 30     SEP 30     DEC 31     MAR 31
                            ---------  ---------  ---------  ----------  ---------  ---------  ---------  ---------  ---------
<S>                         <C>        <C>        <C>        <C>         <C>        <C>        <C>        <C>        <C>
Revenues..................      100.0%     100.0%     100.0%      100.0%     100.0%     100.0%     100.0%     100.0%     100.0%
  Costs of services.......       52.5       51.3       46.0        46.6       52.5       53.9       54.4       54.7       50.8
  SG&A expenses...........       39.6       47.8       45.8        45.9       41.6       35.9       36.0       35.2       36.8
Income from operations....        7.9        0.9        8.2         7.5        5.9       10.2        9.6       10.1       12.4
Other income (expenses)...       (1.3)      (1.8)      (1.3)       (1.0)      22.4(1)       0.3       0.3       0.5       (2.1)
Provision for (benefit of)
 income taxes.............        0.2         --         --          --       12.7        3.8        3.1        4.9        4.6
Net income................        6.4       (0.9)       6.9         6.5       15.6(1)       6.7       6.8       5.7        5.7
Pro Forma net income......        4.0       (0.6)       4.2(2)        3.9(2)      15.6       6.7       6.8       5.7       5.7
</TABLE>
    
 
- ------------
(1) Includes the One-Time Payment.
 
(2) During 1993 and 1994, the Company was an S corporation and, accordingly, was
    not  subject  to  federal income  taxes.  Pro  forma net  income  includes a
    provision for income taxes at an effective  rate of 44.4% for the 11  months
    ended December 31, 1993 and 39.5% for the year ended December 31, 1994.
 
    The  Company has  experienced and in  the future  could experience quarterly
variations in revenues as a  result of a variety of  factors, many of which  are
outside  the  Company's control,  including: the  timing  of new  contracts, the
timing  of  new  product  or  service  offerings  or  modifications  in   client
strategies;  the expiration or termination of  existing contracts; the timing of
increased expenses incurred to obtain and  support new business; changes in  the
Company's  revenue mix  among its  various service  offerings; and  the seasonal
pattern of certain of the businesses  serviced by the Company. In addition,  the
Company's planned staffing
 
                                       21
<PAGE>
   
levels,  investments  and  other  operating expenditures  are  based  on revenue
forecasts. If  revenues  are  below  expectations  in  any  given  quarter,  the
Company's  financial results would  likely be materially  adversely affected for
that quarter.
    
 
   
    For the quarterly periods in 1994, revenues fluctuated principally due to  a
reduction  in services  provided for, and  the ultimate termination  of, a large
client program in the  first half of  1994. The decrease  in revenues from  this
client  program was partially  offset in the  third quarter of  1994 by revenues
from programs for new  clients of $2.6  million and fully  offset in the  fourth
quarter  of 1994 by revenues relating to increased services for new and existing
clients, aggregating $3.4 million. The revenue increases throughout 1995 reflect
$6.3 million from  increased services  provided for existing  clients and  $17.8
million from the addition of certain new clients.
    
 
   
    In  1994, costs  of services  declined from 52.5%  of revenues  in the first
quarter to 46.6%  in the  fourth quarter due  to the  implementation of  certain
higher  margin programs. Costs of services as a percentage of revenues increased
from 46.6% in the fourth quarter of 1994 to 52.5% in the first quarter of  1995.
This  $590,000  increase  primarily  resulted from  the  increase  in  the costs
allocated to the specific client programs for which the costs were incurred. See
the discussion under "1995  Compared to 1994." For  the final three quarters  of
1995, costs of services ranged between 53.9% and 54.7% of revenues, but declined
to  50.8% in the first  quarter of 1996 due  to increased productivity resulting
from higher Call Center capacity utilization.
    
 
    SG&A expenses increased from 39.6% of revenues in the first quarter of  1994
to  47.8% in  the second  quarter of  1994 due  to a  lower revenue  base, costs
associated with the  relocation of  the Company's corporate  offices to  Denver,
Colorado and increased management staffing to support the Company's growth. SG&A
expenses  decreased  to 45.8%  of revenues  in  the third  quarter of  1994, due
principally to lower travel and advertising costs, and 45.9% of revenues in  the
fourth  quarter of  1994 as  fixed and  semi-variable costs  were spread  over a
larger revenue base.  Despite a  shift of certain  costs from  SG&A expenses  to
costs of services in the first quarter of 1995, SG&A expenses as a percentage of
revenues  were essentially unchanged due  to increased overhead costs associated
with establishing  the Company's  Burbank Call  Center without  a  corresponding
increase in revenues for the first quarter of 1995. Once the Burbank Call Center
became  fully operational  in the  second quarter  of 1995,  SG&A expenses  as a
percentage of revenues  ranged from 35.2%  to 36.8% from  the second quarter  of
1995 through the first quarter of 1996.
 
    Income  from operations  fluctuated within  the quarterly  periods primarily
based  on  the  factors  noted  above.  Additionally,  other  income  (expenses)
increased  to $2.3  million in  the first  quarter of  1995 due  to the One-Time
Payment. The provision for  income taxes in the  first quarter of 1995  reflects
the  impacts  of  the  One-Time  Payment and  the  Company's  change  from  an S
corporation to a C corporation.
 
LIQUIDITY AND CAPITAL RESOURCES
 
   
    Historically, TeleTech has  funded its operations  and capital  expenditures
primarily  through cash flow from operations,  borrowings under several lines of
credit and the sale  of $12.0 million  of Preferred Stock  in January 1995.  The
Company  has a $15.0 million unsecured revolving operating line of credit, which
expires on May  31, 1998. Borrowings  under this line  bear interest at  various
rates  that are selected by TeleTech each time a draw is made. At June 15, 1996,
outstanding borrowings  under  this facility  were  $8.5 million,  which  accrue
interest  at rates varying from 6.69% to  6.75%. Borrowings under this line have
been used primarily for general corporate  purposes. Under this line of  credit,
the Company has agreed to maintain certain financial ratios and has agreed that,
during any fiscal year during which the line remains in place, it will not incur
operating  lease  expenses or  make investments  in fixed  assets or  in capital
leases in excess of $15.0 million in the aggregate.
    
 
    In addition,  the  Company  has  two  master  lease  agreements.  Under  one
agreement,  the Company may  lease equipment up  to an aggregate  value of $15.0
million. As of  March 31, 1996,  amounts outstanding under  this agreement  were
approximately  $3.4 million. Lease  rates under this agreement  are based upon a
125 basis  points spread  over  3-year U.S.  Treasury  notes. Under  the  second
agreement, the Company's borrowings are approved, and specific terms are set, on
a  case-by-case basis. As of March 31,  1996, the total amount outstanding under
this agreement was approximately $921,855.
 
                                       22
<PAGE>
   
    Cash provided by operating activities was $3.1 million for the first quarter
of 1996, $3.3 million in  1995 and $3.2 million in  1994. From the beginning  of
1994  through the first quarter  of 1996, the Company  generated an aggregate of
$9.5 million in cash from operating  activities, consisting of $12.0 million  of
total  net income before depreciation,  amortization and other non-cash charges,
offset in part by $(2.5) million changes in working capital. Changes in  working
capital  consist  primarily  of fluctuations  in  accounts  receivable, accounts
payable and accruals arising from the growth of the Company's operations.
    
 
   
    The amount of  cash used  by the Company  in investing  activities was  $3.0
million  for the first  quarter of 1996  and $12.1 million  and $1.9 million for
1995 and 1994, respectively. In the first quarter of 1996, the Company's capital
expenditures were $3.3 million, the Company used $2.3 million for the Access  24
acquisition  and short-term investments decreased by  $2.5 million. In 1995, the
Company's capital expenditures  were $1.7 million  and the Company's  short-term
investments  increased by $10.4 million. In 1994, capital expenditures were $1.9
million. Historically,  capital  expenditures  have  been,  and  future  capital
expenditures are anticipated to be, primarily for the development of Call Center
facilities  and  the  acquisition  of  equipment  to  support  expansion  of the
Company's existing  Call  Centers  and  expansion of  and  improvements  to  the
Company's  call and data management  systems and management information systems.
Capital expenditures, including  new capital  leases, equaled  $5.8 million  and
$2.1  million in 1995  and 1994, respectively. The  Company currently expects to
make capital expenditures in 1996 of approximately $26 million, $3.3 million  of
which  was spent  during the  first quarter.  Although the  Company expects that
approximately $7.8 million of such capital expenditures will be used to purchase
computer hardware and software  and to fund  leasehold improvements required  in
connection  with the opening of one additional  Call Center and the expansion of
an existing Call Center during 1996, as of June 15, 1996 the Company had not yet
made any  commitments  to  incur  any  significant  capital  expenditures.  Such
expenditures  may be financed with internally  generated funds, a portion of the
net proceeds  of the  Offering or  through additional  borrowings. See  "Use  of
Proceeds."
    
 
   
    Cash provided by financing activities for the first quarter of 1996 was $0.5
million, representing borrowings on the Company's line of credit, net of capital
lease  payments. In 1995, cash provided  by financing activities of $8.8 million
resulted primarily from the sale of $12.0 million of Preferred Stock in  January
1995,  which  was  partially  offset  by $2.8  millon  of  loan  repayments, tax
distributions and dividends paid by the Company to its principal stockholder. In
1994, the  Company  used  $1.2  million  for  financing  activities,  consisting
primarily of repayments on the Company's bank line of credit and other long-term
debt.
    
 
   
    The  Company believes that  the net proceeds of  the Offering, together with
cash from operations, existing cash and  available borrowings under its line  of
credit  and master lease agreements, will be sufficient to finance the Company's
current operations, planned capital expenditures and anticipated growth at least
through 1997. However, if the Company were to make any significant  acquisitions
for  cash, it  may be  necessary for  the Company  to obtain  additional debt or
equity financing. The Company has  no current plans, agreements or  commitments,
and  is not  currently engaged  in any  negotiations, with  respect to  any such
acquisition; however any sale of additional equity or equity-related  securities
could result in additional dilution to the Company's stockholders.
    
 
                                       23
<PAGE>
   
                                    BUSINESS
    
 
   
    TeleTech  is a leading provider of  customer care solutions for Fortune 1000
companies.  TeleTech's  customer  care  solutions  encompass  a  wide  range  of
telephone-  and computer-based customer  acquisition, retention and satisfaction
programs designed to maximize the  long-term value of the relationships  between
TeleTech's  clients and their customers. Such programs involve all stages of the
customer relationship and consist of a  variety of customer service and  product
support  activities,  such  as  providing  new  product  information,  enrolling
customers in client programs, providing 24-hour technical and help desk support,
resolving customer  complaints  and conducting  satisfaction  surveys.  TeleTech
works  closely with  its clients  to rapidly  design and  implement large scale,
tailored customer care  programs that provide  comprehensive solutions to  their
specific business needs.
    
 
   
    TeleTech   delivers   its   customer   care   services   primarily   through
customer-initiated ("inbound")  telephone  calls  and also  over  the  Internet.
Services    are    provided   by    trained   customer    care   representatives
("Representatives") in response to an inquiry that a customer makes by calling a
toll-free telephone number  or by sending  an Internet message.  Representatives
respond to these inquiries from TeleTech call centers ("Call Centers") utilizing
state-of-the-art  workstations, which operate  on TeleTech's advanced technology
platform, enabling the Representatives to provide rapid, single-call resolution.
This  technology   platform   incorporates  digital   switching,   client/server
technology,  object-oriented  software modules,  relational  database management
systems, proprietary  call  tracking  management  software,  computer  telephony
integration  and interactive voice response.  TeleTech historically has provided
services from Call Centers leased and equipped by TeleTech ("fully  outsourced")
and  more  recently  from  Call  Centers  leased  and  equipped  by  its clients
("facilities management").
    
 
   
    TeleTech   typically   establishes   long-term,   strategic   relationships,
formalized   by   multi-year   contracts,   with   selected   clients   in   the
telecommunications,  technology,  transportation,  health  care  and   financial
services  industries. TeleTech  targets clients  in these  industries because of
their complex  product and  service offerings  and large  customer bases,  which
require  frequent, often sophisticated, customer  interactions. For example, the
Company recently entered into significant, multi-year contracts with  CompuServe
and United Parcel Service and obtained additional business from AT&T.
    
 
   
    The Company was founded in 1982 and has been providing inbound customer care
solutions since its inception. Between December 31, 1995 and March 31, 1996, the
Company opened, acquired or initiated management of six Call Centers. As of June
15,  1996, TeleTech owned,  leased or managed  seven Call Centers  in the United
States and one in each of the United Kingdom, Australia and New Zealand equipped
with a total of 4,660 state-of-the-art workstations. TeleTech currently plans to
expand an existing Call Center and open one additional Call Center by the end of
1996. In the  first quarter  of 1996, approximately  95% of  the Company's  call
handling revenues were derived from inbound customer inquiries.
    
 
INDUSTRY BACKGROUND
 
   
    Companies  today  are finding  it  increasingly difficult  to  satisfy their
customers' needs for service  and information. As  products and services  become
more  complex and product  and service choices  multiply, customers require more
information to  make intelligent  purchase  decisions and  to use  products  and
services  properly. In  addition, as  a result of  the growth  of consumer sales
through direct marketing channels (such  as cable television shopping  networks,
catalogs  and the Internet),  manufacturers are increasingly  required to assume
the customer service burden traditionally handled by full service retailers.  As
a  result  of  these and  other  factors,  the Company  believes  that consumers
consider the relative effectiveness, ease of use and responsiveness of  customer
service and product support when evaluating comparable products or services, and
that  superior customer  care can  provide a  competitive advantage.  Also, many
companies have realized  that retaining customers  generally is more  profitable
than  acquiring  new customers  and  that high  quality  customer service  is an
important factor in customer satisfaction and retention.
    
 
   
    Many companies find  it difficult to  provide high-quality customer  service
and product support without diverting significant resources away from their core
businesses.  Historically,  companies  have provided  customer  service in-house
because they  believed that  the "customer  interface" was  too critical  to  be
    
 
                                       24
<PAGE>
   
outsourced.  Many now acknowledge that they do not have the core competencies or
are  unwilling  to  invest  the  substantial  resources  necessary  to   provide
high-quality,  inbound customer care services on a timely, cost effective basis.
As a result, a large and rapidly growing customer care outsourcing industry  has
emerged.   Industry  sources  estimate  that  telephone-based  direct  marketing
expenditures were $80 billion in 1995 with roughly 95% of the industry comprised
of captive  (in-house)  telemarketing organizations.  Management  believes  that
large  corporations are increasingly outsourcing their telephone-based marketing
and customer service activities as part  of an overall effort to focus  internal
resources  on their core competencies, improve operating efficiencies and reduce
costs.
    
 
   
    The  teleservices  industry  is  highly  fragmented  with  the  majority  of
participants  providing a limited range of services. Based on conversations with
current and prospective  clients, TeleTech believes  that companies  considering
outsourcing  their customer care activities increasingly are seeking a strategic
partner that can understand their business, can provide a comprehensive range of
services,  and  has  the  flexibility,  management  expertise,  facilities   and
technological  and training resources to effectively and efficiently serve their
customers' long-term needs.
    
 
   
THE TELETECH SOLUTION
    
 
   
    TeleTech develops and implements strategic customer care solutions  designed
to  improve  the  long-term  value of  its  clients'  customer  relationships by
enhancing customer satisfaction and promoting  long-term loyalty, which in  turn
can  increase  each client's  revenues  and profitability.  The  Company devotes
significant resources to understanding a client's industry, products,  services,
processes  and culture and then  designs programs to (i)  improve the quality of
customer interactions, (ii) gather customer data and feedback, (iii) reduce  the
operating  costs associated  with the delivery  of customer  service and product
support, (iv) minimize the client's required investment in and technology  risks
associated with operating in-house call centers, (v) eliminate the client's need
to  manage large  numbers of  call center employees  and (vi)  enable clients to
focus on  their core  competencies.  These programs  enable TeleTech  to  manage
inbound  customer interactions  in a manner  that is seamless  with the client's
operations and gives  customers the  impression that they  are dealing  directly
with  the  client.  TeleTech  effectively  delivers  these  programs  by rapidly
deploying the technology and  human resources required  to implement and  manage
comprehensive customer care solutions.
    
 
   
    TeleTech  believes that its willingness to  invest resources to identify the
customer needs of a potential client  and its ability to quickly understand  the
fundamental  operations of a  client's business differentiate  TeleTech from its
competitors and enable it to offer unique and effective customer care  solutions
and  form  strategic partnerships  with its  clients.  By fully  understanding a
client's industry,  products,  services,  processes and  culture,  TeleTech  can
design customized solutions that add value to a client's day-to-day interactions
with its customers. Additionally, TeleTech's responsive and flexible technology,
which  can be easily expanded to meet demand, enables it to design customer care
programs that  can be  adapted quickly  and cost  effectively to  meet  changing
client and customer needs. TeleTech's open-systems, client/server technology can
be  connected with its clients' information systems, enabling data gathered from
customer interactions to be reviewed and analyzed by TeleTech and its clients on
a real-time basis.
    
 
BUSINESS STRATEGY
 
    Key elements of the Company's business strategy are to:
 
    ENHANCE CLIENTS' RELATIONSHIPS WITH THEIR CUSTOMERS THROUGH INNOVATIVE
CUSTOMER CARE SOLUTIONS
 
   
    The Company  believes  that enhancing  the  client's relationship  with  its
customers  at each stage of the customer  relationship is crucial to providing a
value-added solution to a client's  customer service and product support  needs.
TeleTech  works closely  with its  clients to  identify the  particular needs of
their customers, design  appropriate solutions and  implement tailored  customer
care  programs. TeleTech designs  solutions to be cost  effective and to improve
the quality of customer interactions  and foster long-term customer loyalty.  As
part  of  its comprehensive  solutions, TeleTech  collects  and provides  to its
clients customer  information that  enables its  clients to  analyze and  better
manage   their  customer   bases  while   identifying  new   revenue  generating
opportunities.
    
 
                                       25
<PAGE>
    DEVELOP LONG-TERM STRATEGIC RELATIONSHIPS WITH LARGE CLIENTS IN TARGETED
INDUSTRIES
 
   
    TeleTech seeks  to  develop  long-term strategic  relationships  with  large
corporate  clients  in targeted  industries. The  Company focuses  its marketing
efforts on  industries containing  companies with  complex product  and  service
offerings   and  with  large   customer  bases  that   require  frequent,  often
sophisticated,  customer   interactions.   To  establish   long-term   strategic
relationships  with  its  clients,  TeleTech  typically  enters  into multi-year
contracts  that  generate  recurring  revenues  for  TeleTech  and  utilize  its
technology, human resource and training investments. The Company has established
strategic   business  units   ("SBUs"),  with   dedicated  business  development
personnel,  that   target  clients   in  the   telecommunications,   technology,
transportation, health care and financial services industries.
    
 
    APPLY FLEXIBLE, INNOVATIVE TECHNOLOGICAL SOLUTIONS
 
   
    TeleTech's    technological    expertise   and    expandable   open-systems,
client/server architecture enable  it to rapidly  design tailored customer  care
programs,  effectively interface with its clients' information systems and adapt
quickly to  new technologies.  The Company  seeks to  differentiate itself  from
in-house  and independent competitive service  providers by creatively employing
hardware  configurations  and  software  applications  to  add  flexibility  and
responsiveness  to its clients' customer  service and product support processes.
TeleTech  uses  its  experience  in  the  development  of  customized   software
applications by combining industry-leading operating software with its extensive
library  of  proprietary  applications to  rapidly  and  cost-effectively design
user-friendly custom software applications.
    
 
    IMPLEMENT AND MAINTAIN SUPERIOR OPERATIONAL PROCESSES
 
   
    To manage its growth and provide high levels of client service, the  Company
is  committed  to implementing  and  maintaining superior  operational processes
capable of efficiently executing customer care programs. Recognizing that it  is
providing  one  of  the client's  most  important and  sensitive  functions, the
Company adheres to a rigorous framework of quality processes based on ISO  9002,
an   internationally  recognized  standard  for  quality  assurance,  to  ensure
successful, consistent  delivery of  client programs.  The Company  designs  and
builds  its  Call Centers  based on  a standardized  model to  provide efficient
operations while increasing employee productivity.  By linking its Call  Centers
together  into  a seamless  wide  area network  (WAN),  the Company  can rapidly
transfer voice  and data  information to  provide additional  call capacity  and
disaster recovery, as needed.
    
 
    MAINTAIN EXCELLENCE IN HUMAN RESOURCE AND CALL CENTER MANAGEMENT
 
   
    The Company believes that its ability to attract, hire, train and manage its
employees  and efficiently manage its Call Centers is critical to developing and
maintaining long-term client relationships.  TeleTech uses proprietary  software
to  automate  much  of  its hiring,  training,  quality  assurance  and staffing
management functions.  To  reduce  turnover  and  improve  the  quality  of  its
services,  the Company  devotes significant  resources to  attracting and hiring
skilled employees  and  provides  extensive initial  and  on-going  product  and
service  training.  The Company's  Representatives  generally are  full-time and
dedicated to a single client program.  Representatives receive from one to  five
weeks  of on-site  training in  TeleTech's or  the client's  training facilities
before interacting with  customers, plus  a minimum of  six to  eight hours  per
month  of ongoing training. Representatives  often receive supplemental training
as needed to provide a specific customer service successfully.
    
 
GROWTH STRATEGY
 
    The Company's growth strategy  is designed to  capitalize on the  increasing
demand  for outsourced  customer care solutions  and to maintain  and expand its
leadership position in its industry. The Company's primary growth strategies are
to:
 
    EXPAND SERVICES PROVIDED TO EXISTING CLIENTS AND ESTABLISH NEW RELATIONSHIPS
IN TARGETED INDUSTRIES
 
    The Company believes  it has  substantial opportunities  to expand  services
provided  to  existing  clients  and obtain  new  clients  within  its currently
targeted industries. Specifically, the Company  is focusing on opportunities  to
expand  existing  programs  while  cross-selling  TeleTech's  services  to other
divisions or operations within its existing clients' organizations. For example,
TeleTech implemented its initial program
 
                                       26
<PAGE>
   
for AT&T  in  1991 and  has  since expanded  its  relationship to  include  four
separate  programs for various AT&T products and services. Through its SBUs, the
Company also is focusing on  developing new relationships with companies  within
its targeted industries.
    
 
    DEVELOP NEW PRODUCTS AND SERVICES
 
   
    Continued  rapid technological advances,  coupled with the  growth of direct
marketing channels, will create new opportunities for TeleTech. TeleTech expects
that the introduction of new interactive media will result in more sophisticated
types of customer interactions  and additional opportunities  to provide a  wide
range  of services to customers. TeleTech  intends to capitalize on these trends
by developing  new  products  and  services,  such  as  database  marketing  and
real-time technical and product support for Web sites on the Internet.
    
 
    EXPAND INTO NEW INDUSTRIES AND GEOGRAPHIC MARKETS
 
   
    TeleTech  has identified additional industries that are experiencing many of
the same trends affecting  its currently targeted  industries and may  establish
new  SBUs  to focus  on evolving  market opportunities.  Based on  the Company's
conversations with current  and prospective clients,  the Company believes  that
trends  toward  increased  customer  care and  recognition  of  the  benefits of
outsourcing,  which  have  been  experienced  in  the  U.S.,  are  occurring  in
international   markets.  TeleTech   also  believes   that  many  multi-national
companies, including  several of  its  existing clients,  are seeking  a  single
provider   of  world-wide  customer  care  solutions.  To  capitalize  on  these
international  opportunities,  the  Company   intends  to  further  expand   its
operations outside of the United States.
    
 
    SELECTIVELY PURSUE COMPLEMENTARY ACQUISITIONS
 
    The  Company may selectively acquire complementary companies that extend its
presence into new geographic markets or industries, expand its client base,  add
new  product or service applications or provide substantial operating synergies.
The  Company  believes  that   there  will  be   many  potential  domestic   and
international   acquisition   opportunities   as   the   teleservices   industry
consolidates and  as large  corporations consider  selling their  existing  call
center  facilities  and  operations.  For  example,  the  Company  may  consider
acquiring  a  primarily  outbound  teleservices  provider  that  could   provide
substantial  operating synergies and improve  Call Center utilization during the
currently underutilized off-peak (night and weekend) periods resulting from  the
Company's focus on inbound interactions.
 
SERVICES
 
   
    TeleTech  offers  a  wide range  of  services designed  to  provide superior
customer care. An integral component of these services is process reengineering,
by which the Company develops and applies improved processes to make a  client's
customer  service or  product support processes  more cost-effective, productive
and valuable. At  the start  of a  potential new  client relationship,  TeleTech
assesses  the  client's existing  capabilities,  goals and  strategies, customer
service  or  product  support  processes  and  related  software,  hardware  and
telecommunications  systems and  training. After presenting  a proposed solution
and being awarded a contract, TeleTech works closely with the client to  further
develop, refine and implement more efficient and productive customer interaction
processes  and technological  solutions that link  the customer,  the client and
TeleTech. These  processes generally  include  the development  of  event-driven
software programs for telephone interactions, where the script being followed by
a  Representative changes depending  upon information contained  in the customer
file or on information gathered during the Representative's interaction with the
customer.
    
 
   
    After  the  Company   designs  and   develops  a   customer  care   program,
Representatives  provide a wide range of  on-going voice and data communications
services incorporating one or more  customer acquisition, service and  retention
and   satisfaction  and  loyalty   programs.  In  a   typical  inbound  customer
interaction, a customer calls a toll-free number to request product, service  or
technical  information  or  assistance.  TeleTech's  advanced telecommunications
system automatically identifies each  inbound call by  its telephone number  and
routes  the  call  to an  appropriate  Representative  who is  trained  for that
particular client  program.  Upon  receipt of  the  call,  the  Representative's
computer screen automatically displays the client's specific product, service or
technical information to enable the Representative to assist the customer.
    
 
                                       27
<PAGE>
   
    Each  customer interaction, even in its simplest form, presents TeleTech and
its clients  with  an  opportunity  to  gather  valuable  customer  information,
including  the customer's demographic profile  and preferences. This information
can prompt the Representative to  make logical, progressive inquiries about  the
customer's   interest  in  additional   services,  identify  additional  revenue
generating and  cross-selling opportunities  or  resolve other  customer  issues
relating  to  a  client's  products or  services.  TeleTech  frequently provides
several of the services  listed below in an  integrated program tailored to  its
clients' needs.
    
 
    CUSTOMER  ACQUISITION PROGRAMS.  Customer  acquisition programs are designed
to secure new  customers and can  include a wide  range of activities  depending
upon the customer inquiry. A sampling of these services includes:
 
    - providing pre-sales product or service education
 
    - processing  and  fulfilling information  requests  for product  or service
      offerings
 
    - verifying sales and activating services
 
    - directing callers to product or service sources
 
    - receiving orders for and processing purchases of products or services
 
    - providing initial post-sales support, including operating instructions for
      new product or service use
 
    TeleTech's current  customer acquisition  programs do  not include  outbound
"cold   calling,"  which  is  an   outsourcing  service  typically  provided  by
traditional telemarketing firms.
 
   
    CUSTOMER SERVICE AND  RETENTION PROGRAMS.   Customer  service and  retention
programs  are  designed to  maintain and  extend  the customer  relationship and
maximize the long-term  value of  a client's relationships  with its  customers.
These  programs are generally driven by the  customer's purchase of a product or
service, or  by  the  customer's  need for  on-going  help-desk  resources.  The
majority  of the Company's  revenues are generated by  the provision of customer
service and retention programs. A sampling of these services includes:
    
 
    - providing technical help desk, product or service support
 
    - activating product or service upgrades
 
    - responding to billing and other account inquiries
 
    - resolving complaints and product or service problems
 
    - registering warranty information
 
    - dispatching on-site service
 
   
    CUSTOMER SATISFACTION  AND  LOYALTY  PROGRAMS.   Customer  satisfaction  and
loyalty  programs  enable clients  to  learn from  their  customers, to  be more
responsive to the  customer's needs  and concerns  and to  reward customers  for
their continued patronage. A sampling of these services includes:
    
 
   
    - responding to client promotional, affinity-building programs
    
 
    - developing and implementing client-branded loyalty programs
 
    - conducting satisfaction assessments
 
    - confirming receipt of promised products or services
 
    - reserving and reconfirming space at product or service seminars
 
                                       28
<PAGE>
    An  example of a client-branded loyalty program is TeleTech's Emergency Home
Assist, which  it  implements  for  many of  Australia's  leading  insurers  and
financial  institutions. Under Emergency  Home Assist, if,  for example, a storm
damages the roof of a customer insured by a TeleTech client, the customer  calls
the  toll-free  number  provided by  the  client. A  Representative  answers the
telephone on the client's behalf and contacts, books and dispatches tradesmen to
the customer's home to make  repairs, while simultaneously opening an  insurance
claims  file.  TeleTech's  insurance  company client,  which  directly  pays the
tradesmen's invoices, is positioned as a caring, total solution provider, rather
than just a  reimbursement agent. In  addition, the insurer  is able to  control
costs  by  its  early intervention  and  contracting in  advance  with qualified
tradesmen to provide services at a reasonable price.
 
MARKETS AND CLIENTS
 
   
    TeleTech focuses  its marketing  efforts on  Fortune 1000  companies in  the
telecommunications,   technology,  transportation,  health  care  and  financial
services industries. To provide effective customer care solutions, TeleTech  has
developed  a  separate  SBU to  serve  each  of these  industries.  Each  SBU is
comprised  of  dedicated  business  development  personnel  and  client  service
specialists,  most  of  whom  have  prior  industry  experience.  The  SBUs  are
responsible  for  developing  and  implementing  customized,   industry-specific
customer  service and  product support  for clients  in their  respective target
industries. TeleTech's health care and  financial services SBUs were  introduced
only recently and are still in the development stage.
    
 
   
    The  Company's three largest clients in 1995 were AT&T, Continental Airlines
and Apple Computer, Inc., which  accounted for approximately 31% (including  11%
for  its  subsidiary McCaw  Communications  d/b/ a  Cellular  One), 18%  and 9%,
respectively, of  the  Company's  1995 revenues.  The  Company's  three  largest
clients in the first quarter of 1996, AT&T, CompuServe and Continental Airlines,
accounted  for approximately  22%, 13%  and 6%,  respectively, of  the Company's
revenues. The Company expects that its  three largest clients in 1996, which  it
anticipates  will be  AT&T, CompuServe  and United  Parcel Service, collectively
will account for an even greater percentage of the Company's 1996 revenues  than
its  three  largest  clients  in  1995.  See  "Risk  Factors--Reliance  on Major
Clients."
    
 
   
    TELECOMMUNICATIONS.     The   Telecommunications  SBU   primarily   services
long-distance,  local and  wireless telephone service  providers, including AT&T
and certain  regional  Bell  operating  companies.  Services  include  verifying
long-distance   service  sales,  responding  to  customer  inquiries,  providing
consumer  and  business  telephone  service  account  management  and  providing
on-going   product   and   service   support.   TeleTech   believes   that   the
Telecommunications Act of 1996, which has removed barriers to competition in and
between the local and  long-distance telephone markets,  and the development  of
new wireless products, including those utilizing personal communication services
(PCS) technology, is expanding the breadth of products and services that require
customer  service and support  and will create  additional demand for TeleTech's
services within the telecommunications market.
    
 
   
    TECHNOLOGY.  The growth of  high technology products and service,  including
Internet-related  products and services,  has increased demand  for consumer and
technical product  support services.  Clients  include AT&T,  CompuServe,  Apple
Computer,  Inc.  and  Novell.  The  Company  currently  provides  telephone  and
real-time, on-line  interactive  support  to subscribers  of  CompuServe's  WOW!
service and to customers of AT&T. TeleTech intends to leverage its technological
capabilities  on the Internet and is exploring business opportunities related to
new interactive media.
    
 
   
    TRANSPORTATION.    TeleTech's  Transportation  SBU  provides  a  variety  of
services  to clients in  the package delivery and  travel industries. In October
1995, TeleTech was awarded a contract to manage several Call Centers and provide
customer service and  support on  behalf of United  Parcel Service,  one of  the
nation's  largest  parcel  delivery  companies.  Under  its  five-year contract,
TeleTech provides  services to  United Parcel  Service from  three Call  Centers
leased  by United Parcel  Service but staffed and  managed by TeleTech. TeleTech
also provides  reservation  call  handling  services for  Reno  Air  and  Midway
Airlines. See "--Case Study."
    
 
    HEALTH  CARE.  TeleTech provides customer care solutions on behalf of health
care providers  in the  United  Kingdom, Australia  and New  Zealand,  including
Medical  Benefits Funds of Australia Limited,  Hospital Benefits Fund of Western
Australia,  Inc.,  Southern   Cross  Medical   Care  Society   and  PPP.   These
 
                                       29
<PAGE>
services  include emergency  and non-emergency medical  information and referral
services,  neonatal  information   and  assistance  to   parents  of   newborns,
information   about   drug   interventions,  referrals   to   community  support
organizations such as home care, child care and counseling options, and  medical
claims  review services.  The Company  provides these  services to  customers by
means of telephone access to registered nurses, counselors, pharmacists, medical
librarians, dieticians  and other  specially trained  Representatives.  TeleTech
believes  that  there  are  substantial  opportunities  to  introduce comparable
services in the U.S. market. See "--International Operations."
 
   
    FINANCIAL SERVICES.   From its Call  Centers in Australia  and New  Zealand,
TeleTech  provides customer care solutions to customers of insurance company and
automobile club clients,  such as Mercantile  Mutual Insurance (Australia)  Ltd,
Zurich  Australian Insurance  Ltd and Royal  Automobile Club  of Victoria (RACV)
Insurance Pty Ltd  ("RACV"). Solutions include  providing emergency home  repair
assistance,  responding  to  customer inquiries  regarding  property  damage and
insurance  coverage,  procuring  emergency   roadside  automobile  and   medical
assistance  and facilitating  motor vehicle insurance  claims. TeleTech believes
that many of these customer care solutions are readily transferable to the  U.S.
market.   TeleTech  also  is   developing  new  and   more  responsive  delivery
capabilities to satisfy the demands of financial institutions seeking to  reduce
customer reliance on face-to-face interactions and increase customer utilization
of   electronic  and  telephone  banking  and  automated  teller  machines.  See
"--International Operations."
    
 
CASE STUDY
 
    In 1994, United Parcel Service operated regional Customer Service  Telephone
Centers  across  the  United  States that  provided  customers  with information
regarding package pick-ups and deliveries, package tracking and tracing and rate
information. To  re-engineer its  telephone-based customer  service and  support
strategy,  United Parcel Service consolidated  these regional centers into seven
national centers and decided to outsource the facilities management and staffing
functions. United Parcel Service  benchmark studies led  to the conclusion  that
this  reengineering  would  result  in  significant  quality  improvements while
creating a more efficient and much less costly operation.
 
   
    In October 1995, after a competitive bidding process, TeleTech was awarded a
multi-year contract to  staff and  manage three United  Parcel Service  customer
service telephone centers and was granted the option to manage a fourth facility
if  United Parcel Service requires additional  capacity. By April 1996, TeleTech
began operating Call Centers in Tucson, Arizona and Greenville, South  Carolina.
In June 1996, TeleTech opened a third Call Center in Tampa, Florida.
    
 
    Telephone  calls from United  Parcel Service customers  primarily consist of
customer service and package tracking inquires. TeleTech Representatives  assist
customers  by  scheduling  package  pick  ups,  tracking  packages,  calculating
shipping rates,  explaining  package  insurance  options,  describing  types  of
service and rates and answering other types of inquires.
 
   
    TeleTech  recruits,  interviews, hires,  and  trains all  personnel  for the
United Parcel Service Call Centers.  To manage the considerable human  resources
and  facilities management  tasks associated  with a  customer care  and support
program of  this  magnitude and  complexity,  TeleTech identified  and  hired  a
separate  project management  team to  launch and  direct the  program. TeleTech
utilizes  automated   systems   to   electronically  screen   and   assess   the
qualifications  of job applicants  and is working in  concert with United Parcel
Service to develop innovative technology  to further optimize the call  handling
process.
    
 
SALES AND MARKETING
 
   
    As  most companies consider  the customer care function  to be critical, the
Company's business development personnel generally focus their marketing efforts
on potential  clients' senior  executives. TeleTech  hires business  development
personnel  for each SBU who have substantial industry expertise and can identify
and generate sales leads.
    
 
   
    TeleTech  employs  a  consultative  approach  to  assess  the  current   and
prospective  needs of a  potential client. Following  initial discussions with a
client, a carefully chosen TeleTech team, usually comprised of applications  and
systems specialists, operations experts, human resources professionals and other
appropriate  management personnel,  thoroughly studies  the client's operations.
The Company invests significant
    
 
                                       30
<PAGE>
resources during  the development  of a  client relationship  to understand  the
client's  existing customer service processes,  culture, decision parameters and
goals and strategies. TeleTech  assesses the client's  customer care needs  and,
with  input  from the  client, develops  and  implements tailored  customer care
solutions.
 
    As a result of its consultative approach, TeleTech can identify new  revenue
generating  opportunities, customer  communication possibilities  and product or
service improvements previously  overlooked or not  adequately addressed by  the
client.  TeleTech's  technological  capabilities enable  it  to  develop working
prototypes of proposed customer care programs and to rapidly implement strategic
customer care  solutions,  generally  with minimal  capital  investment  by  the
client.
 
   
    TeleTech  generally  provides customer  care  solutions pursuant  to written
contracts with terms ranging from one to five years, which often contain renewal
or extension  options. Under  substantially all  of its  significant  contracts,
TeleTech  generates revenues based on the  amount of time Representatives devote
to a client's program. In addition,  clients typically are required to pay  fees
relating  to TeleTech's  training of  Representatives to  implement the client's
program, set-up  and management  of  the program,  and development  of  computer
software  and technology. TeleTech  utilizes a standard  Form of Client Services
Agreement ("CSA") in contractual negotiations with its clients. The CSA contains
provisions that (i) allow TeleTech or the client to terminate the contract  upon
the occurrence of certain events, (ii) designate the manner by which TeleTech is
to receive payment for its services, (iii) limit TeleTech's maximum liability to
the  client thereunder,  and (iv) protect  the confidentiality  and ownership of
information and  materials owned  by TeleTech  or the  client that  are used  in
connection  with the performance  of the contract.  Many of TeleTech's contracts
also require the  client to pay  TeleTech a contractually  agreed amount in  the
event  of early  termination. TeleTech's  contracts generally  have terms  of at
least two years and, in some cases, contain contractual provisions adjusting the
amount of  TeleTech's fees  if there  are significant  variances from  estimated
implementation expenses.
    
 
OPERATIONS
 
   
    TeleTech  provides  its  customer  care services  through  the  operation of
state-of-the-art Call Centers located in the United States, the United  Kingdom,
Australia  and New  Zealand. As  of June  15, 1996,  TeleTech leased  seven Call
Centers and also managed three Call Centers on behalf of United Parcel  Service.
In  the second half of 1996, TeleTech plans to open a new Call Center and expand
an existing facility. See "-- Facilities."
    
 
   
    TeleTech uses its standardized development  procedures to minimize the  time
it  takes to  open a  new Call  Center. The  Company applies  predetermined site
selection criteria to  identify locations  conducive to  operating large  scale,
sophisticated  customer care facilities in a cost-effective manner. TeleTech can
establish a new, fully operational, inbound  Call Center containing 450 or  more
workstations within 90-150 days. In the last 16 months, TeleTech established two
Company-owned  Call Centers and three  United Parcel Service-owned Call Centers,
including a total of approximately 3,200 workstations.
    
 
   
    The Company's existing U.S. Call Centers range in size from 42,000 to 56,000
square  feet  and  contain  between  354  and  580  workstations.  Although  the
dimensions  of its existing Call Centers  currently are not uniform, the Company
has developed  a prototype  for TeleTech-owned  U.S. Call  Centers. The  Company
expects that new U.S. Call Centers will contain approximately 50,000 square feet
of space and approximately 450 workstations. Call Center capacity can vary based
on the complexity and type of customer care programs provided. All TeleTech Call
Centers  are designed  to operate 24  hours a  day, seven days  a week. TeleTech
received ISO  9002  certification  for  its Burbank  Call  Center  in  1995  and
currently  is involved  in a  Company-wide ISO  9002 certification  process. See
"--Facilities."
    
 
    CALL CENTER MANAGEMENT.  TeleTech manages its U.S. Call Centers through  its
Technology Command Center in Colorado (the "Command Center"). The Command Center
operates  24 hours per  day, 7 days  a week, and  is responsible for monitoring,
coordinating and managing TeleTech's U.S.  operations. Each U.S. Call Center  is
connected  to the Command Center and to other U.S. Call Centers through multiple
fiber optic voice/data  T-1 circuits to  form an integrated  and redundant  wide
area  network. This network  connectivity provides a high  level of security and
redundancy  that  is   integral  to  TeleTech's   ability  to  ensure   recovery
 
                                       31
<PAGE>
   
capabilities  in the event of a disaster or structural failure. If a Call Center
were to experience  extreme excess  call volume or  become non-operational,  the
Command  Center is configured to re-route  incoming calls to another Call Center
in a virtually uninterrupted manner.
    
 
   
    TeleTech also  has established  a set  of uniform  operational policies  and
procedures  to ensure  the consistent delivery  of high-quality  service at each
Call  Center.  These  policies   and  procedures  detail  specific   performance
standards,  productivity and  profitability objectives  and daily administrative
routines  designed  to  ensure  efficient  operation.  TeleTech  believes   that
recruiting, training and managing full-time Representatives who are dedicated to
a  single  client  facilitates integration  between  client  and Representative,
enhances service quality  and efficiency  and differentiates  TeleTech from  its
competitors.
    
 
   
    TeleTech  utilizes  a  number  of  sophisticated  applications  designed  to
minimize administrative  burdens and  maximize productivity.  Such  applications
include  a proprietary,  "agent performance  system" that  tracks Representative
activity at each workstation and a  proprietary billing system that tracks  time
spent on administration, training, data processing and other processes conducted
in support of client or internal tasks.
    
 
   
    QUALITY  ASSURANCE.  TeleTech monitors and measures the quality and accuracy
of its customer interactions through  a quality assurance department located  at
each Call Center. Each department evaluates, on a real-time basis, at least 1.5%
of  all calls per day. TeleTech also  has the capabilities to enable its clients
to monitor customer interactions as they occur. Quality assurance  professionals
monitor   customer  interactions  and  simultaneously  evaluate  Representatives
according to  criteria  mutually  determined  by the  Company  and  the  client.
Representatives are evaluated and provided with feedback on their performance on
a  weekly  basis and,  as appropriate,  recognized  for superior  performance or
scheduled for additional training and coaching.
    
 
TECHNOLOGY
 
    Utilizing industry standard tools,  the Company creates relational  database
management  systems customized for each client. These systems enable it to track
the details of each customer interaction and consolidate that information into a
customer file, which can be accessed and referred to by Representatives as  they
deliver  services. TeleTech Call Centers employ state-of-the-art technology that
incorporates digital  switching  technology, object-oriented  software  modules,
relational  database management systems, proprietary call tracking and workforce
management systems,  CTI  and  interactive voice  response.  TeleTech's  digital
switching   technology  enables  calls  to  be  routed  to  the  next  available
Representative with the  appropriate knowledge,  skill and  language sets.  Call
tracking  and workforce  management systems  generate and  track historical call
volumes by client,  enabling the  Company to schedule  personnel efficiently  to
accommodate  anticipated  fluctuations  in  call  volume.  This  technology base
enables TeleTech to provide  single call resolution  and decrease customer  hold
times, thereby enhancing customer satisfaction.
 
   
    TeleTech-owned  Call Centers utilize "Universal Representative" workstations
with inbound, outbound, Internet and faxback capabilities, the majority of which
run on  Pentium-Registered  Trademark--based  computers.  All  workstations  are
PC-based  and utilize CTI technology, which connects the computer to a telephone
switch allowing calls  and computer  data to be  transferred simultaneously.  By
using  simple, intuitive graphical user  interfaces (GUI), which substitute easy
to understand graphics for text,  TeleTech enables its Representatives to  focus
on  assisting the customer,  rather than on the  technology, and obtain customer
information using significantly  fewer keystrokes.  The user-friendly  interface
also helps to decrease training time and increase the speed of call handling.
    
 
   
    TeleTech's  applications  software  uses  products  developed  by Microsoft,
Oracle, Novell, IBM and others.  TeleTech has invested significant resources  in
designing,  developing and debugging industry-specific and open-systems software
applications and tools. As a result, TeleTech maintains an extensive library  of
reusable object-oriented software codes that are used by TeleTech's applications
development   professionals  to  develop   customized  customer  care  software.
TeleTech's systems capture and download a variety of information obtained during
each customer interaction into relational databases for real-time, daily, weekly
or
    
 
                                       32
<PAGE>
   
monthly reporting  to  clients.  TeleTech  runs  its  applications  software  on
open-systems,  client-server  architecture  that  utilizes  computer processors,
server components  and  hardware platforms  produced  by manufacturers  such  as
Compaq,  Hewlett  Packard,  IBM  and Sun  Microsystems.  TeleTech  has  and will
continue to  invest  significant  resources  into the  development  of  new  and
emerging customer care and technical support technologies.
    
 
HUMAN RESOURCES
 
   
    TeleTech's  success  in recruiting,  hiring  and training  large  numbers of
skilled employees is critical  to its ability  to provide high-quality  customer
care  solutions to its  clients. TeleTech generally locates  its Call Centers in
metropolitan  areas  that  have   access  to  higher   education  and  a   major
transportation  infrastructure.  TeleTech  generally  offers  a  competitive pay
scale, hires primarily full-time employees who are eligible to receive the  full
range  of employee benefits  and provides employees with  a clear, viable career
path.
    
 
    TeleTech is  committed to  the continued  education and  development of  its
employees  and believes  that providing  TeleTech employees  with access  to new
learning opportunities produces job satisfaction, ensures a higher quality labor
force and  fosters loyalty  between TeleTech's  employees and  the clients  they
serve.  Before taking customer  calls, Representatives receive  from one to five
weeks of on-site training in TeleTech's  or the client's training facilities  to
learn  about  the  client's  corporate  culture,  specific  product  or  service
offerings and the  customer care program  that TeleTech and  the client will  be
undertaking.  Representatives also  receive a minimum  of six to  eight hours of
on-going training per month and  often receive supplemental laboratory  training
as needed to provide high-quality customer service and product support.
 
   
    As  of June 15, 1996, TeleTech had  4,419 employees. Of its total employees,
2,815  were  full-time   Representatives,  constituting  85.4%   of  its   total
Representatives. Although the Company's industry is very labor intensive and has
experienced  significant  personnel  turnover,  the  Company  believes  that its
quality of life initiatives and its high percentage of full-time Representatives
has resulted in relative stability in its work force. A significant increase  in
the  Company's  employee turnover  rate, however,  could increase  the Company's
recruiting and  training costs  and decrease  operating effectiveness.  None  of
TeleTech's  employees  are  subject  to a  collective  bargaining  agreement and
TeleTech  believes  its  relations  with  its  employees  are  good.  See  "Risk
Factors--Dependence on Labor Force."
    
 
INTERNATIONAL OPERATIONS
 
   
    TeleTech  operates one Call Center in each of Australia and New Zealand, and
a third Call Center located in the  United Kingdom that is operated through  the
Company's  joint  venture with  PPP  Healthcare Group  plc  ("PPP"), one  of the
largest private  medical  insurers  in  the United  Kingdom.  In  January  1996,
TeleTech  acquired Access 24,  a leading provider of  customer care solutions to
Australian and New Zealand companies primarily in the health care and  financial
services  industries.  The  operations  of  Access  24  have  been substantially
integrated with TeleTech's operations through the standardization of Access 24's
technology, workstation configuration,  business processes  and operational  and
financial reporting with the Company's systems. The Company intends to introduce
in  the United States services  similar to those offered  by Access 24. TeleTech
operates one Call Center in each of Sydney, Australia and Auckland, New Zealand,
containing  an  aggregate  of  321  workstations,  and  intends  to  develop   a
traditional  customer care outsourcing business in Australia and New Zealand, as
well  as  the   United  Kingdom.  See   "Risk  Factors--Risks  Associated   with
Acquisitions and Joint Ventures."
    
 
   
    On  April 30, 1996,  TeleTech entered into  a joint venture  with PPP, which
currently serves more than 2.3  million customers throughout the United  Kingdom
and owns long-term health insurance, dental care and finance companies. TeleTech
and  PPP  have agreed  to  provide, exclusively  through  the joint  venture and
initially solely  in  the  United Kingdom  and  Ireland,  distinct,  value-added
customer  care  services.  Apart from  the  joint venture,  TeleTech  intends to
provide traditional outsourcing services, similar to the type TeleTech  provides
in  the United  States, in  the United  Kingdom. The  joint venture,  which will
operate initially  from  the  172-workstation Call  Center  located  in  London,
currently  provides services  only to  PPP customers  but intends  to eventually
offer its services to customers of other companies. See "Business--Services" and
"Risk Factors--Risks Associated with Acquisitions and Joint Ventures."
    
 
                                       33
<PAGE>
COMPETITION
 
   
    The  Company  believes  that  it   competes  primarily  with  the   in-house
teleservices  and  customer  service  operations of  its  current  and potential
clients. TeleTech also competes with certain companies that provide teleservices
and customer services  on an  outsourced basis, including  Access Health,  Inc.,
APAC  Teleservices, AT&T  American Transtech,  Electronic Data  Systems, MATRIXX
Marketing Inc., SITEL  Corporation, STREAM and  Sykes Enterprises  Incorporated.
TeleTech  competes  primarily on  the  basis of  quality  and scope  of services
provided, speed and flexibility  of implementation and technological  expertise.
Although  the teleservices  industry is  very competitive  and highly fragmented
with numerous small  participants, management believes  that TeleTech  generally
does  not  directly  compete  with  traditional  telemarketing  companies, which
provide primarily outbound "cold calling" services.
    
 
FACILITIES
 
   
    TeleTech's  corporate  headquarters  are  located  in  Denver,  Colorado  in
approximately 27,000 square feet of leased office space, with an adjacent 55,000
square  foot, 588 workstation Call Center. As  of June 15, 1996, TeleTech leased
(unless otherwise noted) and operated the following Call Centers, containing  an
aggregate of approximately 225,000 square feet:
    
 
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                 NUMBER OF                            TOTAL
                                              YEAR OPENED OR    PRODUCTION    NUMBER OF TRAINING    NUMBER OF
LOCATION                                         ACQUIRED      WORKSTATIONS    WORKSTATIONS(1)    WORKSTATIONS
- --------------------------------------------  ---------------  -------------  ------------------  -------------
<S>                                           <C>              <C>            <C>                 <C>
U.S. CALL CENTERS
Sherman Oaks, California....................          1985             504              76(2)             580
Denver, Colorado............................          1993             418             170                588
Burbank, California.........................          1995             354              66                420
Thornton, Colorado..........................          1996             456              58                514
INTERNATIONAL CALL CENTERS (3)
Sydney, Australia...........................          1996              94              10                104
London, United Kingdom (4)..................          1996             178              12                190
Auckland, New Zealand.......................          1996              24               3                 27
MANAGED ON BEHALF OF UNITED PARCEL SERVICE
Greenville, South Carolina..................          1996             660              90                750
Tucson, Arizona.............................          1996             648              95                743
Tampa, Florida..............................          1996             672              72                744
                                                                     -----             ---              -----
    Total number of workstations............                         4,008             652              4,660
                                                                     -----             ---              -----
                                                                     -----             ---              -----
</TABLE>
    
 
- ---------
   
(1)  The training  workstations are  fully operative  as production workstations
    when necessary.
    
 
   
(2) All of these training workstations are temporarily being used in production.
    
 
   
(3) Acquired January 1,  1996 through TeleTech's acquisition  of Access 24.  See
    "--International Operations."
    
 
   
(4)  Managed through the Company's joint  venture with PPP. See "--International
    Operations."
    
 
   
    The leases for TeleTech's U.S. Call  Centers have terms ranging from one  to
eight  years and generally contain renewal  options. The Company plans to expand
its Thornton Call Center  by 267 positions  by the end of  the third quarter  of
1996  and open another Call Center by the end of 1996. Pursuant to its agreement
with United Parcel Service, if United Parcel Service opens a fourth call center,
TeleTech has the option to staff and manage such Call Center.
    
 
   
    The Company  believes  that  its  existing Call  Centers  are  suitable  and
adequate  for  its current  operations and  that each  Call Center  currently is
substantially or  fully  utilized during  peak  (weekday) periods.  The  Company
believes  that additional  Call Center capacity,  including the  expansion of an
existing Call Center expected to occur by the end of the third quarter of  1996,
will be required to support continued growth. Due
    
 
                                       34
<PAGE>
   
to  the  inbound  nature  of the  Company's  business,  the  Company experiences
significantly higher  capacity  utilization  during  peak  periods  than  during
off-peak  (night and weekend) periods. The Company has been and will be required
to open or  expand Call Centers  to create the  additional peak period  capacity
necessary  to accommodate new or expanded customer care programs. The opening or
expansion of a Call  Center may result,  at least in  the short-term, in  excess
capacity  during  peak  periods  until  the new  or  expanded  program  is fully
implemented.  The  Company  may  consider  acquiring  a  complementary   service
provider,  such as a  company that provides  primarily outbound teleservices, to
improve  Call   Center   utilization   during  off-peak   periods.   See   "Risk
Factors--Management of Growth."
    
 
   
SEASONALITY
    
 
   
    The  Company's  business  historically  has  not  been  subject  to seasonal
fluctuations or risks related to weather;  however the businesses of certain  of
the  Company's  clients, especially  those in  the transportation  and financial
services industries, may be subject to such fluctuations and risks. Although the
seasonal nature and weather-dependency of its clients' businesses has not had  a
material  effect on  the Company's  revenues or  operating profits  to date, the
Company expects that  its contract  with United  Parcel Service  will result  in
quarterly  variations in  revenues, especially  in the  fourth and,  to a lesser
extent, the  first quarter  of each  year, due  to increased  demand for  United
Parcel Service's services during the holiday period.
    
 
   
INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY
    
 
   
    The  Company's customer care programs frequently incorporate proprietary and
confidential information. The Company  has adopted non-disclosure safeguards  to
protect  such information, such as requiring those of its employees, clients and
potential  clients  who  may  have   access  to  proprietary  and   confidential
information  to execute  confidentiality agreements  with the  Company. Although
there can be  no assurance  that the  safeguards taken  by the  Company will  be
adequate  to deter misappropriation of  its proprietary information, the Company
believes that the rapid pace of technological change and the knowledge,  ability
and  experience of its employees  are more significant to  the protection of its
proprietary   information   than    legal   or    business   protections.    See
"Business--Operations" and "Business--Technology."
    
 
LEGAL PROCEEDINGS
 
    From  time to time the  Company is involved in  litigation, most of which is
incidental to its business. In the Company's opinion, no litigation to which the
Company currently is a party is likely to have a material adverse effect on  the
Company's results of operations or financial condition.
 
                                       35
<PAGE>
                                   MANAGEMENT
 
EXECUTIVE OFFICERS AND DIRECTORS
 
    The  following  table sets  forth certain  information  with respect  to the
executive officers and directors of the Company:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
           NAME                 AGE                              POSITION
- --------------------------      ---      --------------------------------------------------------
<S>                         <C>          <C>
Kenneth D. Tuchman                  36   Chairman of the Board, President, Chief Executive
                                          Officer and Director
Joseph D. Livingston                51   Senior Vice President and Chief Operating Officer
Steven B. Coburn                    42   Chief Financial Officer
Alan Silverman (1)                  52   Director
Richard Weingarten (1)              45   Director
Samuel Zell                         53   Director
</TABLE>
 
- ---------
(1) Member of the Compensation and Audit Committees of the Board of Directors of
    the Company.
 
    MR. TUCHMAN founded TeleTech and has served as its Chairman of the Board  of
Directors,  President and Chief Executive  Officer since TeleTech's formation in
December 1994. Mr. Tuchman also is the  founder and has served as the  President
and  Chief Executive  Officer of each  of TeleTech  Telecommunications, Inc. and
TeleTech Teleservices, Inc., two operating subsidiaries of TeleTech, since their
formation in October 1982 and November 1992, respectively.
 
    MR. LIVINGSTON  has  served  the  Company since  February  1992  in  various
capacities,  including as Senior Vice President  and Chief Operating Officer and
previously as Vice President  of Operations and Technology.  From 1989 to  1992,
Mr.  Livingston  was  the Director  of  MIS  Systems &  Operations  of Livestone
Corporation, a division of American Eastern Securities, and from 1985 to 1989 he
was employed by Coopers & Lybrand, an international accounting firm, as Director
of West Region MIS and Strategic Management Services for International Business.
 
    MR. COBURN  has served  as  Chief Financial  Officer  of the  Company  since
October  1995. From October 1989 to September 1995, Mr. Coburn was employed by U
S West, a diversified telecommunications company, and various of its affiliates,
during which time he served as  Finance Director and Chief Financial Officer  of
Interactive  Video  Enterprises,  as  Finance Director  of  U  S  West Marketing
Resources Group and  as Finance Director  and Controller of  U S West  Marketing
Services.  In 1993, Mr.  Coburn established and  managed the finance, accounting
and treasury activities  of U S  West Polska,  a start up  operation in  Warsaw,
Poland.
 
    MR.  SILVERMAN, who has served as a director of TeleTech since January 1995,
is an  independent  investor  and  has  been  a  director  of  Exhibition  Video
International,  a company that is developing  technology for satellite and video
transmissions, since 1992. Mr. Silverman has served since 1970 as a director and
is President  of  Essaness  Theatres  Corporation  ("Essaness"),  an  investment
holding  company. Mr.  Silverman is a  director of Keystone  Biomedical, Inc., a
company that  develops, tests  and licenses  pharmaceutical agents,  and,  since
1980,  has  been a  director  of Video  44,  a Hispanic  television broadcasting
company.  Mr.  Silverman  also   serves  as  a   director  of  various   private
corporations.
 
    MR.  WEINGARTEN has served as a director of TeleTech since January 1995. Mr.
Weingarten founded Richard Weingarten &  Company, Inc., a company that  provides
investment  banking and financial  advisory services, in 1991  and has served as
its President since its formation. From 1988 through 1991, Mr. Weingarten was  a
Managing Director of Bear, Stearns & Co., Inc. and, from 1989 until 1991, served
as  Director of  Corporate Finance for  its Southeastern  region. Mr. Weingarten
currently serves as a director of Capsure Holdings Corp. ("Capsure"), a  holding
company  whose  principal  subsidiaries  are  specialty  property  and  casualty
insurers.
 
                                       36
<PAGE>
   
    MR. ZELL has served as a director  of TeleTech since January 1995. Mr.  Zell
serves  as Chairman of  the Board of Great  American Management and Investments,
Inc., a diversified holding company,  Anixter International Inc., a provider  of
integrated  network  and cabling  solutions, Falcon  Building Products,  Inc., a
manufacturer and supplier of building products, American Classic Voyages Co., an
owner and operator of cruise lines, Manufactured Home Communities, Inc., a  real
estate  investment  trust  specializing  in  the  ownership  and  management  of
manufactured home communities, Capsure.  Mr. Zell also is  a director of  Equity
Group  Investments, Inc. and other private corporations. Mr. Zell also serves as
Chairman of the  Board of Trustees  of Equity Residential  Properties Trust,  an
owner  and operator of multifamily residential properties, and as Co-Chairman of
the Board of Revco  D.S., Inc., a drug  store chain. Mr. Zell  is a director  of
Quality  Food  Centers,  Inc.,  an  independent  supermarket  chain,  and  Sealy
Corporation, a maker of bedding and related products. Mr. Zell was President  of
Madison  Management  Group, Inc.,  a holding  company of  low-tech manufacturing
companies ("Madison"), prior to  October 4, 1991. Madison  filed a petition  for
reorganization under the Federal bankruptcy laws in November 1991.
    
 
ARRANGEMENTS FOR NOMINATION AS DIRECTOR
 
   
    Directors  are elected at each annual meeting of stockholders of the Company
to serve for one-year  terms. After the closing  of the Offering, the  directors
intend to appoint one or more additional persons to the Board in accordance with
TeleTech's By-laws.
    
 
   
    In  connection with the sale of its Preferred Stock in January 1995, certain
stockholders of  TeleTech executed  an  agreement (the  "Investment  Agreement")
pursuant  to  which  they agreed  to  elect  each year  to  TeleTech's  Board of
Directors up  to  five individuals  designated  by Mr.  Tuchman  and up  to  two
individuals  nominated by Essaness and TeleTech Investors General Partnership, a
partnership comprised  of employees  and various  entities affiliated  with  Mr.
Zell,  and other  accredited investors  who have  historically invested together
("TIGP"). Of the current directors of TeleTech, Messrs. Weingarten and Zell were
elected as nominees of TIGP and Essaness, and Messrs. Tuchman and Silverman were
elected as nominees of Mr. Tuchman.  The rights and obligations of Mr.  Tuchman,
TIGP  and  Essaness  to  elect directors  under  the  Investment  Agreement will
terminate upon the closing of the Offering.
    
 
    TeleTech's Certificate of  Incorporation entitles the  holders of  Preferred
Stock,  as a class, to elect two individuals, and entitles the holders of Common
Stock, as a  class, to  elect five  individuals, to  the Board  of Directors  of
TeleTech.  The Restated  Certificate of  Incorporation, to  be filed immediately
prior to the closing of the Offering, provides that the holders of a majority of
the outstanding Common Stock will elect all directors.
 
COMMITTEES OF THE BOARD OF DIRECTORS
 
    The Board of Directors has standing Audit and Compensation Committees, which
assist the Board in the discharge of its responsibilities. Members of each  such
committee  are elected by  the Board at  its first meeting  following the annual
meeting and serve for one year terms.
 
    The Audit Committee reports  to the Board regarding  the appointment of  the
independent   public  accountants  of  TeleTech,  the  scope  and  fees  of  the
prospective annual audit  and the  results thereof,  compliance with  TeleTech's
accounting  and  financial  policies and  management's  procedures  and policies
relative to the adequacy of TeleTech's internal accounting controls. The current
members of  the  Audit Committee  are  Alan Silverman  and  Richard  Weingarten,
neither of whom is an employee of TeleTech.
 
    The  Compensation Committee reviews and approves the annual salary and bonus
for each  executive  officer  (consistent  with  the  terms  of  any  applicable
employment agreement), reviews, approves and recommends terms and conditions for
all employee benefit plans (and changes thereto) and administers the Option Plan
and such other employee benefit plans as may be adopted by TeleTech from time to
time.  The current members of the  Compensation Committee are Alan Silverman and
Richard Weingarten, each of whom is a non-employee director of TeleTech.
 
COMPENSATION OF DIRECTORS
 
    TeleTech does  not pay  its directors  a  fee for  their services  as  such;
however,  all directors are reimbursed for travel expenses incurred in attending
board and committee meetings.
 
                                       37
<PAGE>
   
    The TeleTech Holdings, Inc. Directors Stock Option Plan, which was  approved
by  the Board of Directors and the stockholders of the Company effective January
1996 (the "Directors Option Plan"), provides for the automatic annual grant,  to
each  director  who  is neither  an  employee  of the  Company  nor,  after this
Offering, the beneficial owner of 5% or more of the outstanding Common Stock, of
options to acquire shares of Common Stock.  A total of 750,000 shares of  Common
Stock  are reserved for issuance pursuant to options granted under the Directors
Option  Plan.  All  options  granted   under  the  Directors  Option  Plan   are
non-qualified  options that are not intended to qualify under Section 422 of the
Code.
    
 
   
    The Directors Option  Plan currently  provides that  each eligible  director
will  receive options  to acquire  (i) 12,500 shares  of Common  Stock upon such
director's initial election, after the effective date of the plan, to the  Board
of  Directors and (ii) on  the date of each  annual meeting of stockholders held
each year thereafter  at which  such director  is re-elected,  12,500 shares  of
Common Stock for services to be rendered as a director and 6,250 for services as
a  member on each committee of the Board  of Directors to which such director is
appointed. The exercise price of each option granted under the Directors  Option
Plan  shall be equal to the fair market value of the Common Stock on the date of
grant. Options granted under the Directors Option Plan (a) vest immediately, (b)
are not exercisable until six months after  the date of grant and (c) expire  on
the  earliest to occur of  the tenth anniversary of the  date of grant, one year
following the director's death or immediately upon the director's termination of
membership on the  Board of  Directors for Cause  (as defined  in the  Directors
Option Plan).
    
 
   
    As  of June 15, 1996,  options to acquire an  aggregate of 237,500 shares of
Common Stock, at an  exercise price of $5.00  per share, were outstanding  under
the  Directors Option Plan.  Each of Messrs. Silverman,  Weingarten and Zell has
been granted options under the Directors Option Plan to acquire 25,000 shares of
Common Stock in consideration for services rendered as a director of the Company
during 1995. In  addition, each  of Messrs.  Weingarten and  Silverman has  been
granted  options under the Directors Option Plan to acquire an additional 12,500
shares of Common Stock for services rendered during 1995 as members of the Audit
and Compensation  Committees  of the  Board  of Directors.  Messrs.  Weingarten,
Silverman  and  Zell have  been granted  options to  acquire 37,500,  37,500 and
25,000 shares of  Common Stock, respectively,  for services rendered  and to  be
rendered  as a  director of  the Company  and as  members of  committees thereof
during 1996.
    
 
INCENTIVE COMPENSATION PLAN
 
   
    In order to attract, retain and motivate qualified employees, align employee
interests with those of the stockholders and reward employees for enhancing  the
value of the Company, TeleTech established the TeleTech Holdings, Inc. Incentive
Compensation  Plan (the "Incentive  Plan") on May 14,  1996. Under the Incentive
Plan, certain management-level employees of the Company are eligible to  receive
annual  performance  bonuses based  upon  the Company's  achievement  of certain
predetermined financial  goals. Awards  under the  Incentive Plan  will be  paid
annually from an incentive pool, which is funded annually by a percentage of the
amount  by which the net income of the Company exceeds the established threshold
performance level for that year. From  this incentive pool, each SBU  executive,
manager  and key employee is entitled to receive a cash incentive award up to an
annual  bonus  limitation,  which  is  determined  each  year  based  upon   the
recipient's  base salary. No awards will be  made under the Incentive Plan until
1997.
    
 
COMPENSATION COMMITTEE INTERLOCKS AND INSIDER PARTICIPATION
 
    Alan Silverman  and  Richard  Weingarten  are the  current  members  of  the
Compensation Committee of the Board of Directors.
 
   
    Pursuant  to the  Amended and Restated  Investment Agreement  to take effect
upon the closing of the Offering,  certain existing stockholders of the  Company
(the  "Existing  Stockholders")  are  entitled,  by  majority  vote,  to require
TeleTech, at its sole expense, to register under the Securities Act all or  part
of  their Common Stock. In addition, if TeleTech proposes to register any of its
securities  under  the  Securities  Act  for  its  own  account,  the   Existing
Stockholders  may  require TeleTech,  at its  sole expense,  to include  in such
registration all or part of  the 8,300,000 shares of  Common Stock that will  be
owned  by  the  Existing Stockholders  after  the Offering.  Mr.  Silverman owns
258,330 shares of Common Stock. TIGP, a partnership of which Mr. Weingarten is a
general  partner,  owns   8,525,000  shares  of   Common  Stock;  however,   the
    
 
                                       38
<PAGE>
managing  general partner of  TIGP holds sole  power to vote  and dispose of all
shares owned by TIGP. The Company  has been advised that, immediately  following
the  closing of  the Offering,  TIGP will  be dissolved  and its  assets will be
distributed to its partners. See "Principal and Selling Stockholders."
 
EXECUTIVE COMPENSATION
 
    SUMMARY OF CASH AND  CERTAIN OTHER COMPENSATION.   The following table  sets
forth  information with respect  to all compensation  earned by TeleTech's chief
executive officer and TeleTech's two other executive officers as of December 31,
1995 (collectively, the  "Named Executive  Officers") for  services rendered  to
TeleTech during 1995.
 
                      SUMMARY COMPENSATION TABLE FOR 1995
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                  ANNUAL COMPENSATION
                                                      -------------------------------------------
                                                                                    OTHER ANNUAL     ALL OTHER
                                                         SALARY          BONUS      COMPENSATION   COMPENSATION
NAME AND PRINCIPAL POSITION                                ($)            ($)            ($)          ($) (1)
- ----------------------------------------------------  -------------  -------------  -------------  -------------
<S>                                                   <C>            <C>            <C>            <C>
Kenneth D. Tuchman, Chairman, President & Chief
 Executive Officer..................................  $  750,000     $  250,000      $  56,300(2)    $  10,830
Joseph D. Livingston, Senior Vice President & Chief
 Operating Officer..................................     174,090(3)     168,743(4)          --           4,500
Steven B. Coburn, Chief Financial Officer...........      28,000(5)          --             --              --
</TABLE>
 
- ---------
   
(1) Represents  the  full dollar  value  of premiums  paid  by the  Company with
    respect to life insurance for the benefit of Mr. Tuchman, Mr. Livingston and
    their respective beneficiaries.
    
 
(2) Includes $20,000 in aggregate membership  dues and initiation fees,  $17,500
    paid  as  a  car allowance,  $15,600  for  lease of  a  townhouse  and other
    perquisites and personal benefits paid by the Company to or on behalf of Mr.
    Tuchman.
 
(3) Includes approximately $11,340 paid to Mr. Livingston for accrued but unused
    vacation time.
 
(4) Includes a $75,000  annual performance  bonus and  an approximately  $93,700
    one-time  bonus  for  Mr.  Livingston's  assistance  in  obtaining  a client
    contract.
 
(5) Mr. Coburn  joined TeleTech  in October  1995 at  an annual  base salary  of
    $120,000. See "--Employment Agreements."
 
    OPTION  GRANTS.  The following table sets forth information regarding grants
of stock  options under  the Option  Plan  during 1995  to the  Named  Executive
Officers.
 
                             OPTION GRANTS IN 1995
 
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                                  POTENTIAL REALIZABLE
                                      NUMBER OF                                                 VALUE AT ASSUMED ANNUAL
                                       SHARES       PERCENTAGE OF                                 RATES OF STOCK PRICE
                                     UNDERLYING     TOTAL OPTIONS                               APPRECIATION FOR OPTION
                                       OPTIONS       GRANTED TO       EXERCISE                          TERM (3)
                                       GRANTED      EMPLOYEES IN      PRICE PER    EXPIRATION   ------------------------
NAME                                     (#)         FISCAL YEAR      SHARE (1)     DATE (2)        5%          10%
- -----------------------------------  -----------  -----------------  -----------  ------------  ----------  ------------
<S>                                  <C>          <C>                <C>          <C>           <C>         <C>
Kenneth D. Tuchman.................          --             --               --        --               --            --
Joseph D. Livingston...............     750,000             32%       $    1.29     1/1/2005    $  608,456  $  1,541,946
Steven B. Coburn...................     250,000             11%            2.00    9/15/2005       314,447       796,871
</TABLE>
    
 
- ---------
(1) Each  option has been granted pursuant to the Option Plan and expires on the
    date ten years after the date of  grant. The exercise price equals the  fair
    market  value of the  Common Stock on  the grant date,  as determined by the
    Board of Directors based upon the most recent price prior to the grant  date
    at  which the Company, in arms' length transactions, had issued Common Stock
    in connection  with acquisitions  or  had sold  Preferred Stock  in  capital
    raising transactions.
 
                                       39
<PAGE>
(2) Options  granted to  Messrs. Livingston  and Coburn  vest pro  rata over the
    three years and five years, respectively, following the date of grant.
 
   
(3) The potential realizable value is  calculated assuming that the fair  market
    value  on the date of grant, which equals the exercise price, appreciates at
    the indicated annual rate (set by the Commission), compounded annually,  for
    the  term of the option. Using the  assumed initial public offering price of
    $15.50 for  purposes of  this  calculation (pursuant  to  the rules  of  the
    Commission),  the potential realizable values of the options granted in 1995
    to each of Messrs. Livingston and Coburn are approximately $17.9 million and
    $5.8 million, respectively, at  a 5% assumed  annual appreciation rate,  and
    approximately $29.2 million and $9.6 million, respectively, at a 10% assumed
    annual appreciation rate.
    
 
    OPTION  HOLDINGS.  No options were  exercised by Named Executive Officers in
1995. The following table sets forth  information with respect to the  aggregate
number  and value of shares  underlying unexercised options held  by each of the
Named Executive Officers as of December 31, 1995.
 
                         FISCAL YEAR-END OPTION VALUES
 
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                           NUMBER OF SHARES
                                                        UNDERLYING UNEXERCISED       VALUE OF UNEXERCISED
                                                      OPTIONS AS OF DECEMBER 31,   IN-THE- MONEY OPTIONS AS
                                                                 1995              OF DECEMBER 31, 1995 (1)
                                                      --------------------------  --------------------------
NAME                                                  EXERCISABLE  UNEXERCISABLE  EXERCISABLE  UNEXERCISABLE
- ----------------------------------------------------  -----------  -------------  -----------  -------------
<S>                                                   <C>          <C>            <C>          <C>
Kenneth D. Tuchman..................................          --            --            --             --
Joseph D. Livingston................................     250,000       500,000(2)  $ 927,500    $ 1,855,000
Steven B. Coburn....................................          --       250,000            --        750,000
</TABLE>
    
 
- ---------
 
(1) The exercise price of each option was based on the deemed fair market  value
    of  the option shares at  fiscal year end ($5.00  per share as determined by
    the Board of Directors based on the most recent price prior to December  31,
    1995  at which the Company had issued  or agreed to issue Common Stock) less
    the exercise price payable for such shares.
 
   
(2) Mr.  Livingston received  an option  in May  1996 to  acquire an  additional
    75,000  shares, at an exercise price of  $9.00 per share, in connection with
    the amendment to his employment agreement. See "-- Employment Agreements."
    
 
   
TELETECH STOCK OPTION PLAN
    
 
   
    The Company's Option Plan was adopted by the Board of Directors in  December
1994  and by  the Company's  stockholders in  January 1995  and was  amended and
restated in  January 1996.  The Option  Plan authorizes  the issuance  of up  to
7,000,000  shares  of Common  Stock  through the  grant  of (i)  incentive stock
options ("ISOs")  within the  meaning of  Section 422  of the  Code, (ii)  stock
options  that are not intended to qualify  under Section 422 of the Code ("NSOs"
and together with  ISOs, "Options"), (iii)  stock appreciation rights  ("SARs"),
(iv)  restricted stock  and (v)  phantom stock.  Directors, officers, employees,
consultants and independent contractors of the Company or any subsidiary of  the
Company, as selected from time to time by the committee administering the Option
Plan,  are eligible  to participate  in the  Option Plan.  As of  June 15, 1996,
Options to acquire an aggregate of  4,559,845 shares of Common Stock and  76,000
shares  of  restricted  stock were  outstanding.  Prior  to the  closing  of the
Offering, the Company intends to grant options under the Option Plan to  acquire
an  aggregate of 264,485 shares  of Common Stock at  the initial public offering
price. No SARs or phantom stock have been issued under the Option Plan.
    
 
    The Option  Plan provides  that it  is  to be  administered by  a  committee
comprised  of  two or  more disinterested  directors appointed  by the  Board of
Directors  (the  "Committee").  The  Compensation  Committee  of  the  Board  of
Directors,  which is  comprised of two  disinterested directors  of the Company,
currently acts  as the  Committee  under the  Option  Plan. Subject  to  certain
limitations,  the Committee has complete  discretion to determine which eligible
individuals are to receive  awards under the Option  Plan, the form and  vesting
schedule  of awards, the number of shares subject to each award and the exercise
price, the manner of payment and expiration date applicable to each award.
 
                                       40
<PAGE>
    All awards under  the Option  Plan are  subject to  vesting and  forfeiture.
Unless  the Committee  establishes otherwise  at the  time of  award, all awards
under the Option Plan vest at an accelerating rate over a period of five years.
 
    Set forth  below is  a summary  of the  terms of  the Option  Plan that  are
applicable to each of the various types of awards covered thereby.
 
    OPTIONS.   All  Options expire  on the  date that  is the  earliest of three
months after the holder's termination of employment with the Company (other than
termination for Cause), six months after  the holder's death and 10 years  after
the  date of grant. Options  also are subject to  forfeiture upon termination of
employment or directorship for "Cause." The  exercise price per share of an  ISO
is  determined by the Committee at the time of grant but in no event may be less
than the  fair  market  value  of  the  Common  Stock  on  the  date  of  grant.
Notwithstanding  the foregoing, if an  ISO is granted to  a participant who owns
more than 10% of the  voting power of all classes  of stock of the Company,  the
exercise  price must  be at least  110% of the  fair market value  of the Common
Stock and the exercise period must not exceed five years from the date of grant.
The exercise price per  share of an  NSO is determined by  the Committee in  its
sole discretion.
 
    SARS.   SARs may  be issued independent  of an Option  or, alternatively, in
connection with  an  Option (a  "Tandem  SAR"), in  which  case the  Tandem  SAR
terminates  simultaneously upon the  expiration of the  related Option. A Tandem
SAR is only  exercisable if the  fair market value  of a share  of Common  Stock
exceeds the exercise price of the related Option.
 
    RESTRICTED   STOCK.    Restricted  stock  entitles  the  holder  thereof  to
participate as a stockholder of the  Company; however, the holder may not  sell,
transfer,  pledge or otherwise encumber such stock prior to the time it vests. A
holder of restricted  stock forfeits  all unpaid accumulated  dividends and  all
shares  of restricted  stock that have  not vested  prior to the  date that such
holder's employment with the Company is terminated for any reason.
 
    PHANTOM STOCK.  Phantom stock entitles  the holder thereof to surrender  any
vested  portion of such phantom  stock in exchange for  cash or shares of Common
Stock, as the Committee  may determine, in  an amount equal  to the fair  market
value of Common Stock on the date of surrender.
 
   
EMPLOYEE STOCK PURCHASE PLAN
    
 
   
    Prior  to  completion of  the  Offering, the  Company  intends to  adopt the
TeleTech Holdings, Inc. Employee  Stock Purchase Plan  (the "ESPP") covering  an
aggregate  of 200,000 shares of Common Stock. The ESPP is intended to qualify as
an "Employee Stock Purchase Plan" within the meaning of Section 423 of the  Code
and  will  be  administered  by  the  Compensation  Committee  of  the  Board of
Directors. Under  the ESPP,  shares of  Common Stock  will be  sold in  periodic
offerings to employees of the Company or its subsidiaries who meet the specified
eligibility requirements and who elect to participate in the ESPP. Each offering
will  be open for six consecutive months, or such other length of time as may be
established from  time to  time by  the Compensation  Committee. The  ESPP  will
commence  on September 30,  1996 and will  terminate ten years  thereafter or on
such earlier date as all of the shares reserved under the plan have been issued.
    
 
   
    Under the ESPP, participating employees can elect to have up to 10% of their
compensation withheld, up to a maximum of  $15,000 in any calendar year. On  the
last  business  day of  each  offering period,  the  Company will  sell  to each
participating employee as many full shares  of Common Stock as can be  purchased
with each such employee's aggregate payroll deductions made during such offering
period.  The price of Common Stock purchased under the ESPP will be equal to the
lower of (i)  90% of  the fair market  value of  the Common Stock  on the  first
business  day of any offering period or (ii) 90% of the fair market value of the
Common Stock on the last business day of such offering period, unless  otherwise
established by the Compensation Committee, in its discretion, in accordance with
the terms of the ESPP.
    
 
   
    In  the  event of  a merger,  reorganization or  consolidation in  which the
Company is not the surviving entity or a liquidation of substantially all of the
assets of the  Company, the ESPP  provides that the  Compensation Committee  may
require  that the surviving  entity provide participating  employees with rights
    
 
                                       41
<PAGE>
   
equivalent to  their  rights under  the  ESPP. Alternatively,  the  Compensation
Committee  may  elect  to  accelerate the  termination  of  the  offering period
immediately prior to the  consummation of such  merger, reorganization or  other
transaction  and issue shares of Common Stock to participating employees at such
time.
    
 
EMPLOYMENT AGREEMENTS
 
    TeleTech entered into  an employment  agreement with Kenneth  D. Tuchman  as
Chairman of the Board and President of TeleTech for a term commencing on January
1,  1995 and ending on  December 27, 1997 (the  "Term"). Subsequent thereto, Mr.
Tuchman also was elected as the Chief Executive Officer of TeleTech. Pursuant to
the agreement,  Mr. Tuchman  is entitled  to receive  an annual  base salary  of
$750,000,  as adjusted on January  1 of each year during  the Term by the annual
percentage increase  in the  Consumer Price  Index for  Urban Wage  Earners  and
Clerical  Workers for the  Denver metropolitan area  (the "CPI Percentage"). Mr.
Tuchman also is eligible  to receive an annual  performance bonus not to  exceed
$250,000,  as adjusted  annually by  the CPI  Percentage, based  upon TeleTech's
achievement of certain predetermined  performance goals. The agreement  requires
the  Company to maintain, on behalf of Mr. Tuchman, a $24 million life insurance
policy (half of which  is payable to  his beneficiaries), disability  insurance,
accident, death and dismemberment insurance, errors and omissions insurance with
a  policy limit of not less than $1  million and entitles Mr. Tuchman to receive
certain perquisites specified  therein. Under  the terms of  his agreement,  Mr.
Tuchman  is prohibited,  during his employment  and for  three years thereafter,
from disclosing any confidential information  or trade secrets of TeleTech.  Mr.
Tuchman  also is prohibited, during his employment and for three years after the
Company terminates his  employment for Good  Cause (as defined  therein) or  Mr.
Tuchman voluntarily terminates his employment with the Company, from engaging in
any  business, or  becoming employed by  or otherwise rendering  services to any
company (other  than TeleTech)  that  has as  its  primary business  inbound  or
outbound  teleservices. The agreement  provides that if  TeleTech terminates Mr.
Tuchman's employment for Good Cause, TeleTech will pay Mr. Tuchman his salary as
accrued through the date  of termination. If  TeleTech terminates Mr.  Tuchman's
employment  without Good Cause, TeleTech  will pay to him  the lesser of (i) the
sum of his salary  as accrued through the  date of termination, his  performance
bonus,  prorated for  any portion  of the  year remaining  and calculated  as if
TeleTech had  achieved its  performance  goals, and  the  present value  of  all
payments  that otherwise would have been made to him during the remainder of the
Term, calculated as  if TeleTech  had achieved  its performance  goals, or  (ii)
three  times the  aggregate salary  and performance bonus  earned by  him in the
immediately preceding year.
 
   
    TeleTech entered into an employment  agreement with Joseph D. Livingston  as
Senior  Vice President and Chief Operating Officer of TeleTech effective January
1, 1995. Pursuant to  the agreement, as amended,  Mr. Livingston is entitled  to
receive  an annual base  salary of $160,000  for 1995 and  $250,000 for 1996 and
thereafter and also  is eligible to  receive an annual  performance bonus  based
upon TeleTech's achievement of certain predetermined performance goals. TeleTech
also has granted Mr. Livingston options to purchase 750,000 and 75,000 shares of
Common  Stock at an exercise  price of $1.29 and  $8.00 per share, respectively,
which options vest  over three years  from the date  of grant. Mr.  Livingston's
employment  with TeleTech  is terminable  at any time  by either  party, with or
without cause. Upon termination of  employment, Mr. Livingston will be  entitled
to  unpaid compensation for  services rendered through  the date of termination,
together with employee benefits accrued  through the date of termination.  Under
the  terms of  his agreement, Mr.  Livingston is prohibited  from disclosing any
confidential information  or  trade  secrets of  TeleTech.  The  Agreement  also
prohibits  Mr.  Livingston,  for  the  three  years  after  termination  of  his
employment with TeleTech, from engaging in any business or becoming employed  or
otherwise  rendering services  to any company  engaging in,  inbound or outbound
teleservices, development or maintenance of voice or data communication, certain
software  applications,  customer   communications  services  or   technological
innovation or support for any of the foregoing.
    
 
    The  Company entered  into a three  year employment  agreement commencing on
October 2, 1995  with Steven B.  Coburn. Pursuant to  the agreement, Mr.  Coburn
serves  as Chief Financial Officer of the  Company and is entitled to receive an
annual base salary  of $120,000  for 1995 and,  commencing January  1, 1996,  an
annual base salary of $135,000. Mr. Coburn also is eligible to receive an annual
performance  bonus of not more  than twenty-five percent of  his salary upon the
Company's achievement of certain predetermined
 
                                       42
<PAGE>
performance goals.  The  Company has  granted  Mr. Coburn  options  to  purchase
250,000  shares of Common Stock  at an exercise price  of $2.00 per share, which
options vest over a period of five years beginning with the thirteenth month  of
his   employment.  The  agreement  prohibits  Mr.  Coburn  from  disclosing  any
confidential information or  trade secrets of  the Company. Mr.  Coburn also  is
prohibited,  during  his  employment  and  for  three  years  after  the Company
terminates his employment  for Good  Cause (as  defined therein)  or Mr.  Coburn
voluntarily  terminates his  employment with the  Company, from  engaging in any
business, or becoming employed by or otherwise rendering services to any company
(other than TeleTech),  that has  as its  primary business  inbound or  outbound
teleservices or technological innovation or support with respect thereto.
 
LIMITATION OF LIABILITY AND INDEMNIFICATION MATTERS
 
    TeleTech's  Restated Certificate  of Incorporation and  By-laws provide that
TeleTech  shall  indemnify  its  directors,  and  may  indemnify  its  officers,
employees and other agents, to the fullest extent permitted by Delaware law. The
Company  also is authorized  to secure insurance  on behalf of  any person it is
required or  permitted  to  indemnify.  Pursuant  to  this  provision,  TeleTech
maintains liability insurance for the benefit of its directors and officers.
 
    TeleTech  has entered into agreements to indemnify its directors and certain
of its officers, in addition to  the indemnification provided for in  TeleTech's
Restated  Certificate of  Incorporation and  By-laws. These  agreements provide,
among other things, that TeleTech will indemnify its directors and officers  for
all  direct and indirect expenses and  costs (including, without limitation, all
reasonable attorneys' fees and related disbursements, other out-of-pocket  costs
and  reasonable compensation for time  spent by such persons  for which they are
not otherwise compensated by  TeleTech or any third  person) and liabilities  of
any  type  whatsoever  (including, but  not  limited to,  judgements,  fines and
settlement fees) actually and reasonably  incurred by such person in  connection
with  either the investigation, defense, settlement or appeal of any threatened,
pending or completed action, suit or  other proceeding, including any action  by
or  in the right of the corporation, arising  out of such person's services as a
director, officer,  employee  or other  agent  of TeleTech,  any  subsidiary  of
TeleTech  or  any  other company  or  enterprise  to which  the  person provides
services at the request of TeleTech. TeleTech believes that these provisions and
agreements  are  necessary  to  attract  and  retain  talented  and  experienced
directors and officers.
 
              CERTAIN RELATIONSHIPS AND RELATED PARTY TRANSACTIONS
 
   
    In   addition  to  transactions  described  under  "Management--Compensation
Committee Interlocks and Insider Participation," the following transactions have
been effected,  or  are  being  contemplated,  involving  the  Company  and  its
directors, executive officers or stockholders.
    
 
   
    During 1995, TeleTech provided reservations call handling services to Midway
Airlines  Corporation ("Midway"),  a majority-owned  subsidiary of Zell/Chilmark
Fund, L.P. Samuel Zell, a director of TeleTech, is an affiliate of Zell/Chilmark
Fund, L.P. During the twelve months ended December 31, 1995 and the three months
ended March 31,  1996, TeleTech charged  Midway an aggregate  of $1,291,862  and
$600,904,  respectively, for services  rendered by TeleTech.  As of December 31,
1995 and March 31, 1996, the total amounts due from Midway for services rendered
by TeleTech  were $535,845  and $570,274,  respectively, of  which $354,526  and
$462,958,  respectively,  were  past  due.  TeleTech  has  continued  to provide
reservations call handling services to Midway in the current fiscal year.
    
 
    In April 1996, TeleTech agreed to  accept from Midway, and Midway  delivered
to  the  Company, a  promissory  note in  the  principal amount  of  $500,000 to
evidence a portion of the total amount due and owing. The note bears interest at
a rate of 8%  per annum and  is payable in 12  equal installments of  principal,
together with interest, commencing May 1, 1996.
 
   
    TeleTech  has agreed to pay, prior to the  closing of the Offering, a fee of
$1.0 million to  Equity Group  Investments, Inc.  ("EGI"), an  affiliate of  Sam
Zell,  a  director  of  the Company,  for  certain  financial  advisory services
rendered by  EGI  in  connection  with  the  Offering  and  certain  merger  and
acquisition advisory
    
 
                                       43
<PAGE>
   
services,  including transaction structuring and negotiation, rendered by EGI in
connection with the acquisition of Access 24 and the joint venture with PPP. The
fee, which was negotiated  between the Board of  Directors of the Company  (with
Messrs.  Zell  and Weingarten  abstaining  from its  vote  thereon) and  EGI, is
believed to be  substantially equivalent  to fees of  other advisors  performing
comparable  services, such as  investment banks. Of the  $1.0 million payable to
EGI, approximately $500,000 relate to  services rendered in connection with  the
Offering and are included as expenses thereof.
    
 
   
    TeleTech  has  utilized  the  services  of  The  Riverside  Agency,  Inc. in
reviewing, obtaining  or  renewing  various insurance  policies.  The  Riverside
Agency, Inc. is a wholly-owned subsidiary of EGI. During the twelve months ended
December  31, 1995  and the  three months  ended March  31, 1996,  The Riverside
Agency,  Inc.  invoiced   TeleTech  an   aggregate  of   $23,965  and   $47,930,
respectively, for services rendered.
    
 
   
    On  January 1,  1996, the  Company acquired  all of  the outstanding capital
stock of  Access 24.  As consideration  for such  stock, the  Company issued  an
aggregate  of 712,520 shares of  Common Stock to, and  such shares are now owned
by, an affiliate of Dr.  John E. Kendall and an  affiliate of Louis T.  Carroll,
and  paid $2.3  million in  cash and  issued 257,720  shares of  Common Stock to
Access 24  Holdings  Pty  Limited  ("Access Holdings"  and,  together  with  the
affiliates  of Dr. Kendall  and Mr. Carroll,  the "Common Stockholders"). Access
Holdings is an affiliate of RACV, a financial services client of the Company. In
connection with this transaction, the Company entered into a Stock Transfer  and
Registration  Rights  Agreement with  the  Common Stockholders  (the  "Access 24
Agreement"), pursuant to  which (i) the  Company was granted  certain rights  of
first  refusal to acquire shares of Common Stock sought to be sold by the Common
Stockholders, and (b)  the Company  granted to the  Common Stockholders  certain
rights  to include in certain  registration statements that may  be filed by the
Company following the Offering all or part of the shares of Common Stock held by
the Common Stockholders.
    
 
   
    In  June  1996,  Access  Holdings  notified  the  Company  of  its   planned
disposition  of  its  remaining  248,810  shares  of  Common  Stock  and,  after
negotiations and consistent with the provisions of the Access 24 Agreement,  the
following  agreements were reached and will be effected immediately prior to the
closing of the Offering: (i) Access Holdings will sell 98,810 and 100,000 shares
of Common Stock to the Company and Hinsdale Corporation Sdn Berhad ("Hinsdale"),
an affiliate of Mr. Carroll, respectively, at  a price of $10.00 per share,  and
(ii)  the remaining 50,000 shares  of Common Stock owned  by Access Holdings are
included in, and  will be  sold to  the public  pursuant to,  the Offering.  See
"Principal and Selling Stockholders."
    
 
   
    In  1993 and 1994, Mr. Tuchman made loans to the Company that were evidenced
by subordinated promissory notes with an interest rate of 8% per annum. In 1995,
the Company paid interest of $11,000 to Mr. Tuchman on such notes. In connection
with the Company's restructuring and sale of $12.0 million of Preferred Stock in
January 1995,  the Company  repaid the  approximately $1.2  million  outstanding
balance  of such notes. Also in 1995,  TeleTech paid a dividend of approximately
$452,000 to Mr. Tuchman.
    
 
    TeleTech believes  that  all transactions  disclosed  above have  been,  and
TeleTech's  Board of  Directors intends  that any  future transactions  with its
officers, directors, affiliates or principal stockholders will be, on terms that
are no less favorable to TeleTech than those that are obtainable in arms' length
transactions with unaffiliated third parties.
 
   
    Certain directors of the Company are entitled, under certain  circumstances,
to  require the Company  to register under  the Securities Act  shares of Common
Stock owned  by them.  See  "Management--Compensation Committee  Interlocks  and
Insider Participation."
    
 
                                       44
<PAGE>
                       PRINCIPAL AND SELLING STOCKHOLDERS
 
   
    The  following  table sets  forth certain  information  with respect  to the
beneficial ownership of the Company's Common Stock  as of June 15, 1996, and  as
adjusted  to reflect the sale of shares of Common Stock being offered hereby, by
(i) each stockholder who is known by  the Company to beneficially own more  than
5%  of  the currently  outstanding  shares of  Common  Stock, (ii)  each  of the
Company's directors and the  Named Executive Officers,  (iii) all directors  and
executive officers of the Company as a group and (iv) the Selling Stockholders.
    
 
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                 SHARES BENEFICIALLY OWNED PRIOR                    SHARES BENEFICIALLY OWNED
                                                         TO THE OFFERING             NUMBER OF          AFTER THE OFFERING
DIRECTORS, EXECUTIVE OFFICERS                    -------------------------------   SHARES BEING    ----------------------------
AND CERTAIN STOCKHOLDERS (1)                           NUMBER          PERCENT      OFFERED (2)        NUMBER         PERCENT
- -----------------------------------------------  ------------------  -----------  ---------------  ---------------  -----------
<S>                                              <C>                 <C>          <C>              <C>              <C>
Kenneth D. Tuchman.............................    40,700,000(3)          79.7%      1,000,000       39,700,000          72.1%
Joseph D. Livingston...........................       375,000(4)             *              --          375,000             *
Steven B. Coburn...............................            --                *              --               --             *
Alan Silverman.................................       333,330(5)(6)          *              --          333,330             *
Richard Weingarten.............................        75,000(6)(7)          *              --          243,333(7)          *
Samuel Zell....................................     8,575,000(8)          16.8         950,000(9)     2,514,400(8)        4.6
All directors and executive officers as a group
 (6 persons)...................................    50,058,330             97.0       1,950,000(10)   43,166,063          77.6
Jack Silverman.................................       258,340(11)            *          50,000          208,340             *
TeleTech Investors General Partnership
c/o Equity Group Investments, Inc.
Two North Riverside Plaza
Chicago, Illinois 60606........................     8,525,000(12)         16.7         950,000               --             *
Hinsdale Corporation Sdn Berhad (13)...........       170,000                *         170,000               --             *
Access 24 Holdings Pty Limited.................        50,000                *          50,000               --             *
</TABLE>
    
 
- ---------
 *  Less than one percent
 
 (1)The  address  of each  director  and executive  officer  is in  care  of the
    Company, 1700 Lincoln Street, Suite 1400, Denver, Colorado 80203.
 
   
 (2)Assumes no  exercise  of the  Underwriters'  over-allotment option.  If  the
    Underwriters'  over-allotment option is exercised,  Mr. Tuchman will sell up
    to 933,000 additional shares and, assuming all such shares are sold, he will
    beneficially own 38,767,000 shares or 70.4% of the total outstanding shares.
    
 
 (3)Mr. Tuchman is the  founder, Chairman of the  Board of Directors,  President
    and Chief Executive Officer of TeleTech. See "Management."
 
   
 (4)Includes 375,000 shares of Common Stock subject to options granted under the
    Option  Plan, which are exercisable  as of the date  of this Prospectus. Mr.
    Livingston is the Senior Vice President  and Chief Operating Officer of  the
    Company. See "Management."
    
 
   
 (5)Includes  258,330 shares of Common Stock  issuable upon conversion of 51,666
    shares of Preferred  Stock owned by  Mr. Silverman, which  he has agreed  to
    convert  into Common Stock  pursuant to the  Preferred Stock Conversion, and
    75,000 shares  subject  to  options  exercisable as  of  the  date  of  this
    Prospectus. See note (6) below.
    
 
   
 (6)Includes 75,000 shares of Common Stock subject to options granted to each of
    Messrs.  Silverman  and  Weingarten  under the  Directors  Option  Plan. See
    "Management--Compensation of Directors."
    
 
 (7) Mr.  Weingarten,  as  a  general  partner  of  TeleTech  Investors  General
    Partnership  ("TIGP"), owns an undivided interest in the 8,525,000 shares of
    Common Stock issuable upon conversion of TIGP's
 
                                       45
<PAGE>
   
    1,705,000 shares  of Preferred  Stock. Zell  General Partnership,  Inc.,  an
    affiliate  of  Mr.  Zell  and  the managing  general  partner  of  TIGP (the
    "Managing General Partner"), has the sole power to vote and dispose of these
    shares. Upon dissolution of TIGP (see  note (8) below), Mr. Weingarten  will
    receive  a distribution of his proportionate  share of the net proceeds from
    TIGP's sale of  Common Stock and  the remaining shares  of Common Stock  not
    sold  by TIGP in  the Offering. Following  such distribution, Mr. Weingarten
    will own 243,333  shares of Common  Stock, which includes  75,000 shares  of
    Common Stock subject to options granted under the Directors Option Plan.
    
 
   
 (8)  Includes 50,000 shares of  Common Stock subject to  options granted to Mr.
    Zell under the Directors  Option Plan and, prior  to the Offering  8,525,000
    shares  of Common Stock issuable upon  conversion of the 1,705,000 shares of
    Preferred  Stock  owned  by   TIGP.  See  note   (10)  below  and   "Certain
    Relationships  and Related Party Transactions." The Managing General Partner
    has agreed to convert,  pursuant to the Preferred  Stock Conversion, all  of
    its  shares of Preferred Stock into shares  of Common Stock. The Company has
    been advised that, immediately after the closing of the Offering, TIGP  will
    be  dissolved and the net proceeds from TIGP's sale of Common Stock, and the
    remaining shares of Common Stock not sold  by TIGP in the Offering, will  be
    distributed  to  its partners.  Following such  distribution, Mr.  Zell will
    beneficially own 2,514,400  shares of  Common Stock,  which includes  50,000
    shares of Common Stock subject to options granted under the Directors Option
    Plan.   See  "Management"  and  "Certain  Relationships  and  Related  Party
    Transactions."
    
 
 (9) Represents the shares being sold by TIGP.
 
(10) Represents the shares being sold by Mr. Tuchman and TIGP.
 
(11) The shares reflected in the table are issuable upon conversion of, and  Mr.
    Silverman  has  agreed to  convert in  the  Preferred Stock  Conversion, his
    51,668 shares of Preferred Stock into shares of Common Stock.
 
(12) Includes 8,525,000 shares of Common Stock issuable upon the conversion,  to
    occur  immediately prior and subject to consummation of the Offering, of the
    1,705,000 shares of  Preferred Stock  owned by  TIGP. The  Company has  been
    advised  that, immediately after  the closing of the  Offering, TIGP will be
    dissolved and its assets will be distributed to its partners. See notes  (7)
    and (8) above.
 
   
(13)  Hinsdale is a Malaysian corporation owned by Louis T. Carroll. Mr. Carroll
    is the founder  of Access 24  and previously served  as its Chief  Executive
    Officer. Since January 1996, Mr. Carroll has served as the Managing Director
    of Access 24. See "Certain Relationships and Related Party Transactions."
    
 
                                       46
<PAGE>
                          DESCRIPTION OF CAPITAL STOCK
 
   
    Pursuant  to  the Company's  Certificate of  Incorporation, the  Company has
authority  to  issue  an  aggregate  of  51,860,000  shares  of  capital  stock,
consisting  of 50,000,000 shares of Common Stock,  par value $.01 per share, and
1,860,000 shares of Preferred Stock, par value  $6.45 per share. As of June  15,
1996,  after giving effect to the five-for-one  stock split by a stock dividend,
the Company's  issued  and outstanding  capital  stock consisted  of  51,046,240
shares  of Common Stock, held by eleven  holders of record, and 1,860,000 shares
of Preferred Stock, held  by four holders of  record. Pursuant to the  Preferred
Stock  Conversion, the holders  of all of  the issued and  outstanding shares of
Preferred Stock have  agreed to convert,  immediately prior and  subject to  the
closing of the Offering, all of the 1,860,000 shares of Preferred Stock owned by
them into an aggregate of 9,300,000 shares of Common Stock. Thus, no information
regarding the currently outstanding Preferred Stock is set forth below.
    
 
   
    Concurrently  with the closing of the Offering, officers of the Company will
cause to be  filed in  Delaware and  to take  effect a  Restated Certificate  of
Incorporation  of the Company  (the "Restated Certificate").  Under the Restated
Certificate,  the  Company  will  have  authority  to  issue  an  aggregate   of
160,000,000  shares of capital stock, consisting of 150,000,000 shares of Common
Stock, par value $.01 per share, and 10,000,000 shares of preferred stock.
    
 
    Set forth below is a description of the Common Stock, and of preferred stock
that may be issued, under the Restated Certificate.
 
COMMON STOCK
 
    The rights of the holders of the Common Stock discussed below are subject to
such rights as the Board of Directors may hereafter confer on the holders of the
preferred stock; accordingly,  rights conferred  on holders  of preferred  stock
issued under the Restated Certificate may adversely affect the rights of holders
of the Common Stock.
 
    Subject  to  the  right  of  holders  of  Preferred  Stock,  the  holders of
outstanding shares of  Common Stock  are entitled  to receive  dividends out  of
assets  legally available  therefor, at  such times and  in such  amounts as the
Board of Directors may from time  to time determine. See "Dividend Policy."  The
shares  of Common Stock  are neither redeemable nor  convertible and the holders
thereof have no preemptive or subscription rights to purchase any securities  of
the  Company. Upon  liquidation, dissolution or  winding up of  the Company, the
holders of Common Stock  are entitled to  receive, PRO RATA,  the assets of  the
Company  that are legally available for distribution, after payment of all debts
and other  liabilities  and  subject to  the  prior  rights of  any  holders  of
Preferred  Stock then  outstanding. Each  outstanding share  of Common  Stock is
entitled to one vote on all matters  submitted to a vote of stockholders.  There
is no cumulative voting in the election of directors.
 
PREFERRED STOCK
 
    The  Restated  Certificate  authorizes  the  Board  of  Directors  to  issue
preferred stock  in  classes  or  series  and  to  establish  the  designations,
preferences,  qualifications, limitations or restrictions of any class or series
with respect  to, among  other things,  the rate  and nature  of dividends,  the
price,  terms and  conditions on  which shares  may be  redeemed, the  terms and
conditions for conversion  or exchange  into any other  class or  series of  the
stock  and voting rights.  The Company will have  authority, without approval of
the holders of Common Stock, to issue preferred stock that has voting,  dividend
or liquidation rights superior to the Common Stock and that may adversely affect
the  rights of holders of  Common Stock. The issuance  of preferred stock, while
providing  flexibility  in  connection  with  possible  acquisitions  and  other
corporate purposes, could, among other things, adversely affect the voting power
of  the holders of Common Stock and could have the effect of delaying, deferring
or preventing a change in control of  the Company. The Company currently has  no
plans to issue any shares of preferred stock.
 
DELAWARE STATUTORY BUSINESS COMBINATION PROVISION
 
    Section  203 of the Delaware General  Corporation Law ("DGCL") is applicable
to corporate  takeovers in  Delaware. Subject  to certain  exceptions set  forth
therein, Section 203 of the DGCL provides that a corporation shall not engage in
any  business  combination with  any "interested  stockholder" for  a three-year
 
                                       47
<PAGE>
period  following  the  date  that   such  stockholder  becomes  an   interested
stockholder  unless  (a) prior  to  such date,  the  board of  directors  of the
corporation approved either  the business  combination or  the transaction  that
resulted  in  the  stockholder  becoming  an  interested  stockholder,  (b) upon
consummation of the  transaction that  resulted in the  stockholder becoming  an
interested  stockholder, the  interested stockholder owned  at least  85% of the
voting stock  of  the  corporation  outstanding  at  the  time  the  transaction
commenced  (excluding certain specified shares) or  (c) on or subsequent to such
date, the business  combination is  approved by the  board of  directors of  the
corporation  and by the affirmative vote of  at least 66 2/3% of the outstanding
voting stock  that  is  not  owned by  the  interested  stockholder.  Except  as
specified  therein, an "interested stockholder" is defined to include any person
that is (i)  the owner of  15% or more  of the outstanding  voting stock of  the
corporation,  (ii) an  affiliate or  associate of  that corporation  and was the
owner of 15% or more of the outstanding voting stock of the corporation, at  any
time  within three years  immediately prior to  the relevant date,  and (iii) an
affiliate or associate of the persons described in the foregoing clauses (i)  or
(ii).  Under  certain  circumstances, Section  203  of  the DGCL  makes  it more
difficult  for   an  "interested   stockholder"  to   effect  various   business
combinations   with  a  corporation  for   a  three-year  period,  although  the
stockholders may, by adopting an  amendment to the corporation's certificate  of
incorporation  or  By-laws, elect  for  the corporation  not  to be  governed by
Section 203, effective twelve months after adoption. None of the Certificate  of
Incorporation,  the Restated Certificate and the By-laws exempt the Company from
the restrictions imposed under Section 203  of the DGCL. It is anticipated  that
the  provisions of Section 203 of the DGCL may encourage companies interested in
acquiring the Company to negotiate in advance with the Board of Directors of the
Company because  the stockholder  approval  requirement would  be avoided  if  a
majority of the directors then in office approve either the business combination
or  the  transaction  that results  in  the stockholder  becoming  an interested
stockholder.
 
TRANSFER AGENT AND REGISTRAR
 
   
    The Transfer Agent  and Registrar  for the  Common Stock  is American  Stock
Transfer & Trust Company.
    
 
                                       48
<PAGE>
                        SHARES ELIGIBLE FOR FUTURE SALE
 
   
    Sales  of substantial amounts of  Common Stock in the  public market, or the
perception that such sales  could occur, could  adversely affect the  prevailing
market  price of the Common Stock and the ability of the Company to raise equity
capital in the future. The Company cannot predict the effect, if any, that sales
of shares of Common Stock, or the availability of such shares for future  sales,
will  have on future market prices of the Common Stock. Such sales also may make
it more difficult for  the Company to sell  equity securities or  equity-related
securities in the future at the time and price it deems appropriate.
    
 
   
    Upon  completion of the Offering, the  Compay will have 55,046,240 shares of
Common Stock outstanding, assuming no exercise of outstanding options. Of  these
shares,  the 6,220,000  shares sold  in the  Offering will  be freely tradeable,
without restriction, under the Securities  Act. The remaining 48,826,240  shares
will be "restricted securities" within the meaning of Rule 144 promulgated under
the  Securities Act.  Of these  restricted securities,  approximately 48,451,280
will be subject to a 180-day  lock-up period, as described below. Following  the
180-day  lock-up period,  all of the  restricted securities  will be immediately
eligible for sale, subject to the  volume limitations and other restrictions  of
Rule  144 (but  not the holding  period requirement),  except that approximately
26,000 of the  restricted securities  will not  become eligible  for sale  until
expiration of applicable holding periods.
    
 
   
    In  general, under  Rule 144  as currently in  effect, a  person (or persons
whose shares are aggregated) who has beneficially owned Restricted Shares for at
least two years (including,  in certain circumstances, the  holding period of  a
prior owner) would be entitled to sell within any three-month period a number of
shares  that does not  exceed the greater of:  (i) one percent  of the number of
shares of Common Stock then outstanding (which will equal approximately  550,462
shares  immediately  after the  Offering); or  (ii)  the average  weekly trading
volume of the Common Stock during  the four calendar weeks preceding the  filing
of  a Form 144 with respect to such  sale. Sales under Rule 144 are also subject
to certain  "manner of  sale"  provisions and  notice  requirements and  to  the
availability  of current public information about TeleTech. Under Rule 144(k), a
person who is  not deemed  to have  been an affiliate  of TeleTech  at any  time
during  the 90 days preceding a sale,  and who has beneficially owned the shares
proposed  to  be  sold  for  at   least  three  years  (including,  in   certain
circumstances,  the holding period of  a prior owner), is  entitled to sell such
shares without complying  with the  manner of sale,  public information,  volume
limitation  or  notice  provisions  of  Rule  144;  therefore,  unless otherwise
restricted, "144(k) shares" may be sold  immediately upon the completion of  the
Offering.
    
 
    In  addition, any employee, officer or director of or consultant to TeleTech
who purchased  his or  her shares  pursuant to  a written  compensatory plan  or
contract  may be entitled to rely on the resale provisions of Rule 701. Rule 701
permits affiliates  to  sell  their  Rule 701  shares  under  Rule  144  without
complying  with the  holding period requirements  of Rule 144.  Rule 701 further
provides that  non-affiliates may  sell  such shares  in  reliance on  Rule  144
without  having  to comply  with the  public  information, volume  limitation or
notice provisions of Rule 144.
 
   
    Following the Offering, the Company intends to file under the Securities Act
one or more registration statements on Form S-8 to register all of the shares of
Common Stock (i) subject to outstanding  options and reserved for future  option
grants  under the Option  Plan and the  Directors Option Plan  and (ii) that the
Company intends to offer for sale to  its employees pursuant to the ESPP.  These
registration  statements are expected to become effective upon filing and shares
covered by these registration statements will be eligible for sale, subject,  in
the  case of affiliates  only, to the  restrictions of Rule  144, other than the
holding period requirement, and subject to expiration of the lock-up  agreements
with  the Underwriters. As of  June 15, 1996, outstanding  options to acquire an
aggregate of 753,125 shares of Common Stock were currently exercisable.
    
 
   
    Pursuant to the  Amended and  Restated Investment Agreement  to take  effect
upon the closing of the Offering, the Existing Stockholders will be entitled, by
majority  vote, to require TeleTech, at its  sole expense, to register under the
Securities Act  all or  part of  their Common  Stock. In  addition, if  TeleTech
proposes  to register any of its securities under the Securities Act for its own
account, the Existing Stockholders may require TeleTech, at its sole expense, to
include  in  such  registration  all  or   part  of  the  7,625,000  shares   of
    
 
                                       49
<PAGE>
   
Common Stock that will be owned by the Existing Stockholders after the Offering.
These  registration rights will continue in effect following the Preferred Stock
Conversion and the closing of the Offering. An aggregate of 1,000,000 shares are
being registered by the Existing  Stockholders in connection with the  Offering.
See "Compensation Committee Interlocks and Insider Participation."
    
 
   
    Under  the terms of the Amended and Restated Stock Transfer and Registration
Rights Agreement to take  effect upon the closing  of the Offering, if  TeleTech
proposes  to register any of its securities under the Securities Act for its own
account, the Common Stockholders may require  TeleTech, at its sole expense,  to
include  in such registration all or part  of the 633,610 shares of Common Stock
that will be held by the Common Stockholders after the Offering. An aggregate of
220,000 shares are being registered by the Common Stockholders in the  Offering.
See "Certain Relationships and Related Party Transactions."
    
 
                                       50
<PAGE>
                CERTAIN UNITED STATES FEDERAL TAX CONSIDERATIONS
                      FOR NON-U.S. HOLDERS OF COMMON STOCK
 
    The  following discussion concerns the material United States federal income
and estate tax consequences of the ownership and disposition of shares of Common
Stock applicable to Non-U.S. Holders of such shares of Common Stock. In general,
a "Non-U.S. Holder" is any  holder other than (i) a  citizen or resident of  the
United  States, (ii)  a corporation or  partnership created or  organized in the
United States or under  the law of the  United States or any  State or (iii)  an
estate  or trust whose  income is includible  in gross income  for United States
federal income tax purposes regardless of its source. The discussion is based on
current law, which is subject to  change retroactively or prospectively, and  is
for  general information  only. The discussion  does not address  all aspects of
federal income and estate  taxation and does not  address any aspects of  state,
local  or non-U.S. tax laws. The discussion does not consider any specific facts
or circumstances that may apply to  a particular Non-U.S. Holder (including  the
fact  that in the  case of a Non-U.S.  Holder that is  a partnership, the United
States tax consequences of holding and  disposing of shares of Common Stock  may
be  affected by certain determinations made  at the partner level). Accordingly,
prospective investors  are urged  to consult  their tax  advisors regarding  the
United   States  federal,  state,  local  and  non-U.S.  income  and  other  tax
consequences of holding and disposing of shares of Common Stock.
 
    DIVIDENDS.  Dividends, if  any (see "Dividend Policy"),  paid to a  Non-U.S.
Holder  generally will be subject to United States withholding tax at a 30% rate
(or a lower rate as  may be prescribed by an  applicable tax treaty) unless  the
dividends  are effectively  connected with a  trade or business  of the Non-U.S.
Holder within the United States. Dividends effectively connected with a trade or
business will generally not  be subject to withholding  (if the Non-U.S.  Holder
properly  files an executed United States  Internal Revenue Service ("IRS") Form
4224 with the payor  of the dividend)  and generally will  be subject to  United
States  federal income tax on a net  income basis at regular graduated rates. In
the case of a Non-U.S. Holder which is a corporation, such effectively connected
income also may be subject to the branch profits tax (which is generally imposed
on a  foreign  corporation  on  the  repatriation  from  the  United  States  of
effectively  connected earnings  and profits).  The branch  profits tax  may not
apply if the recipient is a  qualified resident of certain countries with  which
the  United States has an income tax treaty. To determine the applicability of a
tax treaty  providing for  a lower  rate  of withholding,  dividends paid  to  a
stockholder's  address of  record in a  foreign country are  presumed, under the
current IRS position, to be paid to a resident of that country, unless the payor
has knowledge that such presumption is not warranted or an applicable tax treaty
(or United States  Treasury Regulations thereunder)  requires some other  method
for  determining a non-U.S. Holder's  residence. However, recently proposed U.S.
Treasury Regulations, if adopted, would modify the forms and procedures for this
certification.
 
    SALE OF COMMON STOCK.  Generally, a  Non-U.S. Holder will not be subject  to
United  States federal income tax  on any gain realized  upon the disposition of
such holder's  shares  of  Common  Stock unless  (i)  the  gain  is  effectively
connected  with a trade or  business carried on by  the Non-U.S. Holder with the
United States  (in  which case  the  branch profits  tax  may apply);  (ii)  the
Non-U.S.  Holder is  an individual  who holds  the shares  of Common  Stock as a
capital asset and is present  in the United States for  183 days or more in  the
taxable  year of the disposition and to  whom such gain is United States source;
(iii) the Non-U.S. Holder is subject to  tax pursuant to the provisions of  U.S.
tax  law applicable  to certain former  United States citizens  or residents; or
(iv) the Company is or has been  a "U.S. real property holding corporation"  for
federal income tax purposes (which the Company does not believe that it is or is
likely  to become) at any time during the five year period ending on the date of
disposition (or such shorter period that such shares were held) and, subject  to
certain  exceptions, the Non-U.S. Holder held, directly or indirectly, more than
five percent of the Common Stock.
 
    ESTATE TAX.    Shares of  Common  Stock owned  or  treated as  owned  by  an
individual  who is not a citizen or resident (as specifically defined for United
States federal estate tax purposes)  of the United States  at the time of  death
may be subject to United States federal estate tax.
 
                                       51
<PAGE>
BACKUP WITHHOLDING AND INFORMATION REPORTING
 
    DIVIDENDS.  The Company must report annually to the IRS and to each Non-U.S.
Holder  the  amount of  dividends paid  to and  the tax  withheld, if  any, with
respect  to  such  holder.   These  information  reporting  requirements   apply
regardless  of  whether withholding  was reduced  by  an applicable  tax treaty.
Copies of these information returns may  also be available under the  provisions
of  a specific treaty  or agreement with  the tax authorities  in the country in
which the Non-U.S. Holder resides. Dividends  that are subject to United  States
withholding  tax at the 30%  statutory rate or at a  reduced tax treaty rate and
dividends that are effectively connected with the conduct of a trade or business
in the United States (if  certain certification and disclosure requirements  are
met)  are exempt from backup withholding of U.S. federal income tax. In general,
backup withholding at  a rate  of 31% and  information reporting  will apply  to
other  dividends paid on shares of Common  Stock to holders that are not "exempt
recipients" and  fail to  provide  in the  manner required  certain  identifying
information  (such  as the  holder's name,  address and  taxpayer identification
number). Generally, individuals are not exempt recipients, whereas  corporations
and certain other entities generally are exempt recipients.
 
    DISPOSITIONS  OF  COMMON  STOCK.    The payment  of  the  proceeds  from the
disposition of shares  of Common  Stock through the  United States  office of  a
broker  will be subject  to information reporting  and backup withholding unless
the holder,  under penalties  of  perjury, certifies,  among other  things,  its
status  as a Non-U.S. Holder, or  otherwise establishes an exemption. Generally,
the payment of the proceeds from the disposition of shares of Common Stock to or
through a non-U.S. office of a broker will not be subject to backup  withholding
and  will not be subject to information reporting. In the case of the payment of
proceeds from  the disposition  of shares  of Common  Stock through  a  non-U.S.
office  of a broker that  is a U.S. person  or a "U.S.-related person," existing
regulations require information  reporting (but not  backup withholding) on  the
payment  unless the  broker receives  a statement  from the  owner, signed under
penalties of perjury, certifying, among other  things, its status as a  Non-U.S.
Holder,  or the broker has documentary evidence in its files that the owner is a
Non-U.S. Holder and the broker has no actual knowledge to the contrary. For  tax
purpose,  a "U.S.-related person" is (i)  a "controlled foreign corporation" for
United States federal income tax purposes or  (ii) a foreign person 50% or  more
of whose gross income from all sources for the three year period ending with the
close  of its taxable year preceding the payment (or for such part of the period
that the  broker has  been in  existence) is  derived from  activities that  are
effectively connected with the conduct of a United States trade or business.
 
    Any  amount withheld from  a payment to  a Non-U.S. Holder  under the backup
withholding rules  will be  allowed as  a credit  against such  holder's  United
States  federal income tax  liability and may  entitle such holder  to a refund,
provided that the required information is furnished to the IRS. Non-U.S. Holders
should consult their tax  advisors regarding the application  of these rules  to
their  particular situations, the availability of an exemption therefrom and the
procedures for obtaining such an exemption, if available.
 
                                       52
<PAGE>
                                  UNDERWRITERS
 
    Under the  terms and  subject  to conditions  contained in  an  Underwriting
Agreement  dated the  date hereof, the  U.S. Underwriters named  below, for whom
Morgan Stanley &  Co. Incorporated, Alex.  Brown & Sons  Incorporated and  Smith
Barney  Inc.  are  serving as  U.S.  Representatives, have  severally  agreed to
purchase, and the Company and the Selling Stockholders have severally agreed  to
sell,  and the International Underwriters named below, for whom Morgan Stanley &
Co. International Limited, Alex. Brown & Sons Incorporated and Smith Barney Inc.
are  serving  as  International  Representatives  (collectively  with  the  U.S.
Representatives,  the "Representatives"), have severally agreed to purchase, and
the Company and  the Selling  Stockholders have  severally agreed  to sell,  the
respective  number of  shares of  Common Stock that  in the  aggregate equal the
number of shares set forth opposite the names of such Underwriters below:
 
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                               NUMBER
NAME                                                                                         OF SHARES
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------  ----------
<S>                                                                                          <C>
U.S. Underwriters:
    Morgan Stanley & Co. Incorporated......................................................
    Alex. Brown & Sons Incorporated........................................................
    Smith Barney Inc.......................................................................
 
        Subtotal...........................................................................  4,976,000
                                                                                             ----------
International Underwriters:
    Morgan Stanley & Co. International Limited.............................................
    Alex. Brown & Sons Incorporated........................................................
    Smith Barney Inc.......................................................................
                                                                                             ----------
        Subtotal...........................................................................  1,244,000
                                                                                             ----------
        Total..............................................................................  6,220,000
                                                                                             ----------
                                                                                             ----------
</TABLE>
    
 
    The U.S. Underwriters  and the International  Underwriters are  collectively
referred  to as the "Underwriters." The Underwriting Agreement provides that the
obligations of the several  Underwriters to pay for  and accept delivery of  the
shares  of Common Stock  offered hereby are  subject to the  approval of certain
legal matters  by  counsel  and  to  certain  other  conditions,  including  the
conditions  that no stop order suspending  the effectiveness of the Registration
Statement is in effect and no proceedings for such purpose are pending before or
threatened by the Securities and Exchange Commission and that there has been  no
material  adverse  change or  any development  involving a  prospective material
adverse change in the earnings, results of operations or financial condition  of
the  Company and its subsidiaries, taken as a  whole, from that set forth in the
Registration Statement. The Underwriters are obligated  to take and pay for  all
of  the shares of Common  Stock offered hereby (other  than those covered by the
over-allotment option described below) if any are taken.
 
    Pursuant to the Agreement Between U.S. and International Underwriters,  each
U.S.  Underwriter has represented  and agreed that,  with certain exceptions set
forth below, (i) it is not purchasing any U.S. Shares (as defined below) for the
account of anyone  other than  a United States  or Canadian  Person (as  defined
below) and (ii) it has not offered or sold, and will not offer or sell, directly
or  indirectly, any U.S. Shares or distribute this Prospectus outside the United
States or Canada or  to anyone other  than a United  States or Canadian  Person.
Pursuant  to  the Agreement  Between U.S.  and International  Underwriters, each
International  Underwriter  has  represented  and  agreed  that,  with   certain
exceptions  set forth below,  (a) it is not  purchasing any International Shares
(as defined below) for the account of  any United States or Canadian Person  and
(b)  it  has not  offered  or sold,  and  will not  offer  or sell,  directly or
indirectly, any International  Shares or distribute  this Prospectus within  the
United  States  or  Canada or  to  any  United States  or  Canadian  Person. The
foregoing limitations do not apply  to stabilization transactions or to  certain
other  transactions specified  in the  Agreement Between  U.S. and International
Underwriters. With respect to Smith Barney Inc.
 
                                       53
<PAGE>
and Alex. Brown & Sons Incorporated, the foregoing representations or agreements
(a) made by  them in their  capacity as  U.S. Underwriters shall  apply only  to
shares of Common Stock purchased by them in their capacity as U.S. Underwriters,
(b)  made by  them in their  capacity as International  Underwriters shall apply
only to  shares  of  Common  Stock  purchased  by  them  in  their  capacity  as
International   Underwriters  and  (c)  shall  not  restrict  their  ability  to
distribute this Prospectus  to any  person. As  used herein,  "United States  or
Canadian  Person" means any national or resident  of the United States or Canada
or any  corporation, pension,  profit-sharing  or other  trust or  other  entity
organized  under the  laws of the  United States  or Canada or  of any political
subdivision thereof (other than  a branch located outside  of the United  States
and  Canada of  any United  States or Canadian  Person) and  includes any United
States or Canadian branch of  a person who is not  otherwise a United States  or
Canadian  Person, and  "United States" means  the United States  of America, its
territories, its  possessions and  all areas  subject to  its jurisdiction.  All
shares  of Common Stock to be offered by the U.S. Underwriters and International
Underwriters under  the Underwriting  Agreement are  referred to  herein as  the
"U.S. Shares" and the "International Shares," respectively.
 
    Pursuant to the Agreement Between U.S. and International Underwriters, sales
may  be made between the U.S. Underwriters and the International Underwriters of
any  number  of  shares  of  Common  Stock  to  be  purchased  pursuant  to  the
Underwriting  Agreement  as may  be  mutually agreed.  The  per share  price and
currency settlement of any shares  of Common Stock so  sold shall be the  public
offering  price  range set  forth on  the  cover page  hereof, in  United States
dollars, less an amount not greater than the per share amount of the  concession
to dealers set forth below.
 
    Pursuant  to the Agreement Between U.S. and International Underwriters, each
U.S. Underwriter has represented that it has not offered or sold, and has agreed
not to offer or  sell, any shares  of Common Stock,  directly or indirectly,  in
Canada  in contravention  of the  securities laws of  Canada or  any province or
territory thereof and has  represented that any offer  of such shares in  Canada
will  be  made only  pursuant to  an exemption  from the  requirement to  file a
prospectus in the province or territory of  Canada in which such offer is  made.
Each  U.S. Underwriter has  further agreed to  send to any  dealer who purchases
from it any  shares of  Common Stock  a notice  starting in  substance that,  by
purchasing  such  shares, such  dealer  represents and  agrees  that it  has not
offered or sold, and will not offer or sell, directly or indirectly, any of such
shares in  Canada in  contravention of  the  securities laws  of Canada  or  any
province  or territory thereof and  that any offer of  shares of Common Stock in
Canada will be made only pursuant to an exemption from the requirement to file a
prospectus in the province or territory of  Canada in which such offer is  made,
and  that such dealer will deliver  to any other dealer to  whom it sells any of
such shares a notice to the foregoing effect.
 
    Pursuant to the Agreement Between U.S. and International Underwriters,  each
International  Underwriter has represented  that (i) it has  not offered or sold
and will not offer or sell any shares  of Common Stock to persons in the  United
Kingdom  except to persons whose ordinary  activities involve them in acquiring,
holding, managing or disposing  of investments (as principal  or agent) for  the
purposes  of  their  businesses or  otherwise  in circumstances  which  have not
resulted and will not  result in an  offer to the public  in the United  Kingdom
within  the meaning  of the  Public Offers  of Securities  Regulations 1995 (the
"Regulations"); (ii)  it  has  complied  and will  comply  with  all  applicable
provisions  of the Financial Services Act  1986 and the Regulations with respect
to anything  done  by it  in  relation to  such  shares in,  from  or  otherwise
involving the United Kingdom; and (iii) it has only issued or passed on and will
only  issue or pass on to any person in the United Kingdom any document received
by it in connection with the issue of  such shares, if that person is of a  kind
described  in  Article  11(3) of  the  Financial Services  Act  1986 (Investment
Advertisements) (Exemptions) Order 1995,  or is a person  to whom such  document
may otherwise lawfully be issued or passed on.
 
    Pursuant  to the Agreement Between U.S. and International Underwriters, each
International Underwriter has represented and agreed that it has not offered  or
sold,  and will not offer or sell, directly or indirectly, in Japan or to or for
the account of  any resident  thereof, any shares  of Common  Stock acquired  in
connection   with  the  Offering,  except  for   offers  or  sales  of  Japanese
International Underwriters or dealers and except pursuant to any exemption  from
the  registration requirements of the Securities and Exchange Law of Japan. Each
International Underwriter has further agreed to send to any dealer who purchases
from it any of such  shares of Common Stock a  notice stating in substance  that
such dealer may not offer or sell any
 
                                       54
<PAGE>
of such shares, directly or indirectly, in Japan or to or for the account of any
resident  thereof,  except  pursuant  to  any  exemption  from  the registration
requirements of the Securities and Exchange  Law of Japan, and that such  dealer
will  send to any other dealer  to whom it sells any  of such shares a notice to
the foregoing effect.
 
    The Underwriters propose to offer part of the shares of Common Stock offered
hereby directly to  the public at  the public  offering price set  forth in  the
cover  page hereof  and part to  certain dealers  at a price  which represents a
concession not in excess of $    per share under the public offering price.  The
Underwriters  may  allow, and  such dealers  may re-allow,  a concession  not in
excess of $      per share to  other Underwriters or  to certain other  dealers.
After the initial offering of the shares of Common Stock, the offering price and
other selling terms may from time to time be varied by the Representatives.
 
   
    Pursuant  to the  Underwriting Agreement,  Mr. Tuchman,  one of  the Selling
Stockholders, has granted to the U.S. Underwriters an option, exercisable for 30
days from the date of this Prospectus,  to purchase up to an additional  933,000
shares  of Common Stock at the public offering price set forth on the cover page
hereof, less underwriting discounts and  commissions. The U.S. Underwriters  may
exercise   such  option  to   purchase  solely  for   the  purpose  of  covering
over-allotments, if any,  incurred in  the sale of  the shares  of Common  Stock
offered  hereby. To the  extent such option is  exercised, each U.S. Underwriter
will become obligated, subject to certain conditions, to purchase  approximately
the  same percentage of such  additional shares as the  number set forth next to
such U.S. Underwriters' name in the preceding table bears to the total number of
shares of Common Stock offered hereby to the U.S. Underwriters.
    
 
    The Representatives have informed the  Company and the Selling  Stockholders
that the Underwriters do not intend to confirm sales to accounts over which they
exercise discretionary authority.
 
    The  Company, the Selling  Stockholders and the  Underwriters have agreed to
indemnify each other  against certain liabilities,  including liabilities  under
the Securities Act.
 
   
    See  "Shares  Eligible  for  Future  Sale"  for  a  description  of  certain
arrangements by which all officers and directors of the Company have agreed  not
to  sell or otherwise dispose  of Common Stock or  convertible securities of the
Company for up to 180 days after  the date of this Prospectus without the  prior
consent  of  Morgan Stanley  &  Co. Incorporated.  The  Company and  the Selling
Stockholders have  agreed in  the  Underwriting Agreement  that they  will  not,
directly  or indirectly, without  the prior written consent  of Morgan Stanley &
Co. Incorporated, offer,  pledge, sell,  contract to  sell, sell  any option  or
contract to purchase, purchase any option or contract to sell, grant any option,
right  or warrant to purchase or otherwise  transfer or dispose of any shares of
Common Stock  or any  securities  convertible into  or exchangeable  for  Common
Stock,  for a period of 180 days after the date of this Prospectus, except under
certain circumstances. TIGP, one  of the Selling  Stockholders, is permitted  to
distribute  its remaining shares of Common  Stock to its partners, provided that
all of such partners have agreed to be bound by the 180-day lock-up arrangement.
    
 
PRICING OF THE OFFERING
 
    Prior to the  Offering, there has  been no public  market for the  Company's
Common   Stock.  The  initial  public  offering  price  will  be  determined  by
negotiation between the Company and the Representatives. Among the factors to be
considered in determining the initial public  offering price will be the  future
prospects  of the  Company and its  industry in general,  revenues, earnings and
certain other  financial and  operating  information of  the Company  in  recent
periods  and the price-earnings ratios,  price-revenues ratios, market prices of
securities and certain financial and operating information of companies  engaged
in  activities similar  to those  of the  Company. The  estimated initial public
offering price range set forth on the cover page of this Preliminary  Prospectus
is subject to change as a result of market conditions and other factors.
 
                                 LEGAL MATTERS
 
   
    The  validity of the  shares of Common  Stock offered hereby  will be passed
upon for TeleTech by Neal, Gerber & Eisenberg, Chicago, Illinois. In  connection
with the Offering, certain attorneys of Neal, Gerber &
    
 
                                       55
<PAGE>
   
Eisenberg  intend  to purchase  shares  of Common  Stock  at the  initial public
offering price,  which  constitute a  portion  of  the shares  reserved  by  the
Underwriters  for sale at the initial public offering price to certain employees
and other  persons  associated  with  the  Company.  Certain  legal  matters  in
connection  with the Offering will be passed upon for the Underwriters by Katten
Muchin & Zavis, Chicago, Illinois.
    
 
                                    EXPERTS
 
    The financial statements of TeleTech as  of December 31, 1994 and 1995,  and
for  each  of the  two  years in  the  period ended  December  31, 1995  and the
financial statements Access 24 for the 10 months ended December 31, 1995 and for
the year ended February  28, 1995 included in  this Prospectus and elsewhere  in
the Registration Statement have been audited by Arthur Andersen LLP, independent
public  accountants, as indicated in their reports with respect thereto, and are
included herein  in reliance  upon the  authority  of said  firm as  experts  in
accounting and auditing in giving said reports.
 
    The  financial statements of TeleTech as of December 31, 1993 and for the 11
month period ended December 31, 1993  included in this Prospectus and  elsewhere
in  the Registration  Statement have been  audited by  Gumbiner, Savett, Finkel,
Fingleson &  Rose, Inc.  (formerly  Gumbiner, Savett,  Friedman &  Rose,  Inc.),
independent  public accountants,  and are included  herein in  reliance upon the
authority of said firm as experts in giving said reports.
 
   
                       CHANGE IN INDEPENDENT ACCOUNTANTS
    
 
   
    In December 1994, Gumbiner, Savett, Finkel, Fingelson & Rose, Inc. resigned,
and Arthur  Andersen  LLP was  retained,  as the  Company's  independent  public
accountants.  The reports of Gumbiner, Savett, Finkel, Fingelson & Rose, Inc. on
the combined  financial  statements  of TeleTech  Telecommunications,  Inc.  and
TeleTech  Teleservices, Inc. as of December 31, 1993 and for the 11 month period
ended December 31, 1993 included herein contain no adverse opinion or disclaimer
of opinion and were not qualified or modified as to uncertainty, audit scope  or
application of accounting principles. During the engagement of Gumbiner, Savett,
Finkel,  Fingelson  & Rose,  Inc. by  the Company,  there were  no disagreements
between the Company  and such  firm on any  matter of  accounting principles  or
practices, financial statement disclosure or auditing scope or procedure.
    
 
                             ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
 
   
    TeleTech   has  filed  with  the  Commission  under  the  Securities  Act  a
Registration Statement on  Form S-1  with respect  to the  Common Stock  offered
hereby. This Prospectus, which constitutes a part of the Registration Statement,
omits certain of the information contained in the Registration Statement and the
exhibits  and  schedules thereto  on file  with the  Commission pursuant  to the
Securities Act and the rules and  regulations of the Commission thereunder.  For
further  information with respect to TeleTech and the Common Stock, reference is
made to the Registration Statement and  the exhibits and schedules thereto.  The
Registration  Statement,  including  exhibits  and  schedules  thereto,  may  be
inspected and  copied  at the  public  reference facilities  maintained  by  the
Commission,  including  at the  Commission's  Public Reference  Room,  450 Fifth
Street, N.W., Judiciary Plaza, Washington,  D.C. 20549, and at the  Commission's
Regional  Offices at 7 World Trade Center,  Suite 1300, New York, New York 10048
and Citicorp  Center, 500  West Madison  Street, Suite  1400, Chicago,  Illinois
60661.  Copies may  be obtained  at prescribed  rates from  the Public Reference
Section of  the Commission  as its  principal office  in Washington,  D.C.  Such
materials  also may be accessed electronically by means of the Commission's home
page on the Internet at http://www.sec.gov.
    
 
    Statements contained in this Prospectus as  to the contents of any  contract
or  other document referred to are not necessarily complete and in each instance
reference is made to the  copy of such contract or  other documents filed as  an
exhibit  to the Registration  Statement, each such  statement being qualified in
its entirety by such reference.
 
                                       56
<PAGE>
                         INDEX TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
                            TELETECH HOLDINGS, INC.
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                                               PAGE
                                                                                                             ---------
<S>                                                                                                          <C>
Report of Gumbiner, Savett, Finkel, Fingleson & Rose, Inc. (formerly Gumbiner, Savett, Friedman & Rose,
 Inc.).....................................................................................................        F-2
Report of Arthur Andersen LLP..............................................................................        F-3
Consolidated and Combined Balance Sheets as of December 31, 1994 and 1995, and
 March 31, 1996............................................................................................        F-4
Consolidated and Combined Statements of Income for the eleven months ended December 31, 1993, the years
 ended December 31, 1994 and 1995 and the three months ended March 31, 1995 and 1996.......................        F-6
Consolidated and Combined Statements of Stockholders' Equity for the years ended December 1994 and 1995....        F-7
Consolidated and Combined Statements of Cash Flows for the eleven months ended December 31, 1993, the years
 ended December 31, 1994 and 1995 and the three months ended March 31, 1995 and 1996.......................        F-8
Notes to Consolidated and Combined Financial Statements for the years ended December 31, 1994 and 1995 and
 for the eleven months ended December 31, 1993 and for the three months ended March 31, 1995 and 1996......       F-10
</TABLE>
 
   
                   ACCESS 24 SERVICE CORPORATION PTY LIMITED
                            AND CONTROLLED ENTITIES
              (ALL AMOUNTS PRESENTED IN AUSTRALIAN DOLLARS, "A$")
    
 
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                                               PAGE
                                                                                                             ---------
<S>                                                                                                          <C>
Report of Arthur Andersen Chartered Accountants............................................................       F-26
Consolidated Balance Sheets as of February 28, 1995 and December 31, 1995..................................       F-27
Consolidated Profit and Loss Accounts for the year ended February 28, 1995 and the ten months ended
 December 31, 1995.........................................................................................       F-28
Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows for the year ended February 28, 1995 and the ten months ended
 December 31, 1995.........................................................................................       F-29
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements for the years ended February 28, 1995 and the ten months
 ended December 31, 1995...................................................................................       F-30
</TABLE>
    
 
                                      F-1
<PAGE>
                          INDEPENDENT AUDITOR'S REPORT
 
The Board of Directors
TeleTech Holdings, Inc.
Denver, Colorado
 
    We  have audited  the accompanying  combined statements  of income  and cash
flows of TeleTech Telecommunications, Inc. and TeleTech Teleservices, Inc. ("the
Companies") (see Note 1)  for the eleven months  ended December 31, 1993.  These
combined  statements  of income  and cash  flows are  the responsibility  of the
Companies' management.  Our responsibility  is to  express an  opinion on  these
combined statements of income and cash flows based on our audit.
 
    We  conducted  our  audit  in accordance  with  generally  accepted auditing
standards. Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to  obtain
reasonable  assurance about whether  the combined statements  of income and cash
flows are free of material misstatement. An audit includes examining, on a  test
basis,   evidence  supporting  the  amounts  and  disclosures  in  the  combined
statements of  income and  cash  flows. An  audit  also includes  assessing  the
accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well
as  evaluating the overall presentation of the combined statements of income and
cash flows.  We believe  that our  audit  provides a  reasonable basis  for  our
opinion.
 
    In our opinion, the combined statements of income and cash flows referred to
above  present fairly, in  all material respects, the  results of the Companies'
operations and cash flows for the eleven months ended
December 31, 1993 in conformity with generally accepted accounting principles.
 
                             GUMBINER, SAVETT, FINKEL, FINGLESON & ROSE, INC.
                             (formerly Gumbiner, Savett, Friedman & Rose, Inc.)
 
   
Santa Monica, California
April 13, 1994.
    
 
                                      F-2
<PAGE>
                    REPORT OF INDEPENDENT PUBLIC ACCOUNTANTS
 
To TeleTech Holdings, Inc.:
 
    We have audited the accompanying consolidated and combined balance sheets of
TELETECH HOLDINGS,  INC.  (a  Delaware  corporation)  and  subsidiaries,  as  of
December 31, 1994 and 1995, and the related consolidated and combined statements
of  income, stockholders' equity and cash flows  for the years then ended. These
financial statements are  the responsibility  of the  Company's management.  Our
responsibility  is to express an opinion  on these financial statements based on
our audits.
 
    We conducted  our  audits in  accordance  with generally  accepted  auditing
standards.  Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain
reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material
misstatement. An audit includes examining, on a test basis, evidence  supporting
the  amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. An audit also includes
assessing the  accounting  principles used  and  significant estimates  made  by
management,  as well as evaluating the overall financial statement presentation.
We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.
 
    In our opinion, the consolidated and combined financial statements  referred
to above present fairly, in all material respects, the consolidated and combined
financial  position of TeleTech  Holdings, Inc. and  subsidiaries as of December
31, 1994 and 1995, and the results of their operations and their cash flows  for
the   years  then  ended  in   conformity  with  generally  accepted  accounting
principles.
 
                                                             ARTHUR ANDERSEN LLP
 
Denver, Colorado,
February 10, 1996.
 
                                      F-3
<PAGE>
                            TELETECH HOLDINGS, INC.
                                AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
                    CONSOLIDATED AND COMBINED BALANCE SHEETS
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                              DECEMBER 31
                                                      ----------------------------
                       ASSETS                             1994           1995
- ----------------------------------------------------  -------------  -------------    MARCH 31,      PRO FORMA
                                                                                        1996         MARCH 31,
                                                                                    -------------      1996
                                                                                     (UNAUDITED)   -------------
                                                                                                    (UNAUDITED)
                                                                                                     (NOTE 1)
<S>                                                   <C>            <C>            <C>            <C>
CURRENT ASSETS:
  Cash and cash equivalents.........................  $      37,733  $      42,304  $     728,403
  Short-term investments............................             --     10,361,213      8,203,527
  Accounts receivable, net of allowance for doubtful
   accounts of $172,512, $788,907 and $896,685,
   respectively.....................................      4,298,147      9,786,123     14,280,609
  Prepaids and other assets.........................        201,439        238,022        608,896
  Deposits..........................................        123,883        220,243        432,010
  Deferred tax asset (Note 8).......................             --        485,742        637,720
                                                      -------------  -------------  -------------
    Total current assets............................      4,661,202     21,133,647     24,891,165
                                                      -------------  -------------  -------------
PROPERTY AND EQUIPMENT, net of accumulated
 depreciation of $3,935,136, $6,059,424 and
 $6,987,766, respectively...........................      5,386,456      9,103,701     16,308,351
                                                      -------------  -------------  -------------
OTHER ASSETS:
  Deposits..........................................         53,968             --             --
  Deferred contract costs (Note 1)..................             --        345,978      1,731,234
  Goodwill (net of amortization of $108,000) (Note
   1)...............................................             --             --      6,272,193
  Other assets......................................             --             --        251,297
                                                      -------------  -------------  -------------
    Total assets....................................  $  10,101,626  $  30,583,326  $  49,454,240
                                                      -------------  -------------  -------------
                                                      -------------  -------------  -------------
</TABLE>
 
      The accompanying notes are an integral part of these balance sheets.
 
                                      F-4
<PAGE>
                            TELETECH HOLDINGS, INC.
                                AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
                    CONSOLIDATED AND COMBINED BALANCE SHEETS
 
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                  DECEMBER 31
                                                           --------------------------
          LIABILITIES AND STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY                 1994          1995
- ---------------------------------------------------------  ------------  ------------   MARCH 31,     PRO FORMA
                                                                                           1996       MARCH 31,
                                                                                       ------------      1996
                                                                                       (UNAUDITED)   ------------
                                                                                                     (UNAUDITED)
                                                                                                       (NOTE 1)
<S>                                                        <C>           <C>           <C>           <C>
CURRENT LIABILITIES:
  Bank overdraft.........................................  $    560,490  $  1,427,017  $         --
  Short term borrowings (Note 6).........................       638,635     1,000,000     3,500,000
  Current portion of capital lease obligations
   (Note 4)..............................................       401,001     1,255,966     2,129,440
  Current portion of other long-term debt (Note 5).......       624,483       195,660       189,443
  Current portion of subordinated notes payable to
   stockholder (Note 7)..................................       145,299            --            --
  Accounts payable.......................................     1,442,503     2,604,297     4,820,221
  Accrued employee compensation..........................       962,664     1,742,915     3,452,438
  Other accrued expenses.................................       475,142     1,261,984     4,322,239
  Customer advances and deposits.........................       165,756       292,626       537,282
  Deferred income........................................        25,683        47,699       560,215
                                                           ------------  ------------  ------------
    Total current liabilities............................     5,441,656     9,828,164    19,511,278
DEFERRED TAX LIABILITIES (Note 8)........................            --       507,365       498,790
LONG-TERM DEBT, net of current portion:
  Capital lease obligations (Note 4).....................       911,578     3,192,997     5,408,307
  Subordinated note payable to stockholder
   (Note 7)..............................................       959,038            --            --
  Other debt (Note 5)....................................       592,282       396,618     1,127,846
                                                           ------------  ------------  ------------
    Total liabilities....................................     7,904,554    13,925,144    26,546,221
                                                           ------------  ------------  ------------
COMMITMENTS AND CONTINGENCIES (Note 9)
MANDATORILY REDEEMABLE CONVERTIBLE PREFERRED STOCK (Notes
 1 and 11):
  $6.45 par value, 1,860,000 shares authorized, zero,
   1,860,000, 1,860,000, and zero shares respectively
   issued and outstanding (including accrued dividends of
   zero, $867,430, $1,078,645 and zero)..................            --    12,867,430    13,078,645            --
                                                           ------------  ------------  ------------  ------------
STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY (Note 1):
  Common stock, $.01 par value, 150,000,000 shares
   authorized, zero, 40,700,000, 41,746,240 and
   51,046,240 shares, respectively issued and
   outstanding...........................................            --       407,000       417,462       510,462
  Common stock of combined entities, no par value
   10,000,000 shares authorized, 127,500, zero, zero and
   zero shares, respectively, issued and outstanding.....        25,000            --            --            --
  Additional paid-in capital.............................            --     1,846,472     7,067,210    20,052,855
  Cumulative translation adjustment......................            --            --       141,095       141,095
  Unearned compensation-restricted stock.................            --            --      (380,000)     (380,000)
  Retained earnings......................................     2,172,072     1,537,280     2,583,607     2,583,607
                                                           ------------  ------------  ------------  ------------
    Total stockholders' equity...........................     2,197,072     3,790,752     9,829,374    22,908,019
                                                           ------------  ------------  ------------  ------------
    Total liabilities and stockholders' equity...........  $ 10,101,626  $ 30,583,326  $ 49,454,240
                                                           ------------  ------------  ------------
                                                           ------------  ------------  ------------
</TABLE>
    
 
      The accompanying notes are an integral part of these balance sheets.
 
                                      F-5
<PAGE>
                            TELETECH HOLDINGS, INC.
                                AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
                 CONSOLIDATED AND COMBINED STATEMENTS OF INCOME
 
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                 ELEVEN                                  THREE MONTHS ENDED MARCH
                                              MONTHS ENDED   YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31,               31,
                                              DECEMBER 31,  --------------------------  --------------------------
                                                  1993          1994          1995          1995          1996
                                              ------------  ------------  ------------  ------------  ------------
                                                                                               (UNAUDITED)
<S>                                           <C>           <C>           <C>           <C>           <C>
REVENUES....................................  $ 19,519,593  $ 35,462,172  $ 50,467,490  $ 10,412,306  $ 22,019,345
                                              ------------  ------------  ------------  ------------  ------------
OPERATING EXPENSES:
  Costs of services.........................    10,726,189    17,405,789    27,245,961     5,468,962    11,194,498
  Selling, general and administrative
   expenses.................................     7,956,176    15,860,157    18,625,431     4,328,934     8,102,020
                                              ------------  ------------  ------------  ------------  ------------
    Total operating expenses................    18,682,365    33,265,946    45,871,392     9,797,896    19,296,518
                                              ------------  ------------  ------------  ------------  ------------
INCOME FROM OPERATIONS......................       837,228     2,196,226     4,596,098       614,410     2,722,827
                                              ------------  ------------  ------------  ------------  ------------
OTHER INCOME (EXPENSES):
  Interest expense..........................      (299,552)     (481,516)     (459,589)     (102,912)     (234,013)
  Interest income...........................            --            --       577,350       152,400       111,308
  Other (Note 14)...........................            --            --     2,371,221     2,288,390      (341,278)
                                              ------------  ------------  ------------  ------------  ------------
                                                  (299,552)     (481,516)    2,488,982     2,337,878      (463,983)
                                              ------------  ------------  ------------  ------------  ------------
    Income before income taxes..............       537,676     1,714,710     7,085,080     2,952,288     2,258,844
PROVISION (BENEFIT) FOR INCOME TAXES........       (10,000)       19,736     2,928,996     1,324,463     1,001,302
                                              ------------  ------------  ------------  ------------  ------------
    Net income..............................  $    547,676  $  1,694,974  $  4,156,084  $  1,627,825  $  1,257,542
                                              ------------  ------------  ------------  ------------  ------------
                                              ------------  ------------  ------------  ------------  ------------
SHARES USED IN COMPUTING PRO FORMA NET
 INCOME PER COMMON AND COMMON EQUIVALENT
 SHARE......................................                                54,402,103    54,330,530    54,425,960
                                                                          ------------  ------------  ------------
                                                                          ------------  ------------  ------------
PRO FORMA NET INCOME PER COMMON AND COMMON
 EQUIVALENT SHARE...........................                                      $.08          $.03          $.02
                                                                          ------------  ------------  ------------
                                                                          ------------  ------------  ------------
PRO FORMA NET INCOME AND EARNINGS PER COMMON
 SHARE (UNAUDITED)
  (Notes 1 and 8):
    Historical net income before income
     taxes..................................  $    537,676  $  1,714,710
    Historical provision (benefit) for
     income taxes...........................       (10,000)       19,736
    Pro forma income tax effects............       248,996       657,866
                                              ------------  ------------
    Pro forma net income....................  $    298,680  $  1,037,108
                                              ------------  ------------
                                              ------------  ------------
    Pro forma common shares outstanding.....    43,842,557    43,842,557
                                              ------------  ------------
                                              ------------  ------------
    Pro forma earnings per common share.....          $.01          $.02
                                              ------------  ------------
                                              ------------  ------------
</TABLE>
    
 
        The accompanying notes are an integral part of these statements.
 
                                      F-6
<PAGE>
                            TELETECH HOLDINGS, INC.
                                AND SUBSIDIARIES
          CONSOLIDATED AND COMBINED STATEMENTS OF STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                MANDATORILY
                                                REDEEMABLE,                           STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY
                                                CONVERTIBLE        ----------------------------------------------------------
                                                 PREFERRED                                 COMMON
                                                   STOCK               COMMON STOCK       STOCK OF    ADDITIONAL  CUMULATIVE
                                           ----------------------  --------------------   COMBINED     PAID-IN    TRANSLATION
                                            SHARES      AMOUNT      SHARES     AMOUNT     ENTITIES     CAPITAL    ADJUSTMENT
                                           ---------  -----------  ---------  ---------  -----------  ----------  -----------
<S>                                        <C>        <C>          <C>        <C>        <C>          <C>         <C>
BALANCES, January 1, 1994................                                                 $  25,000   $       --   $      --
  Distribution to stockholder............                                                        --           --          --
  Net income.............................                                                        --           --          --
                                                                                         -----------  ----------  -----------
BALANCES, December 31, 1994..............         --  $        --         --  $      --      25,000           --          --
  Issue of Preferred Stock (Note 11).....  1,860,000   12,000,000         --         --          --           --          --
  Adjustment to reclassify retained
   earnings to additional paid in capital
   upon termination of S corporation
   election
   (Note 11).............................         --           --         --         --          --    2,172,072          --
  Stock exchange (Note 1)................         --           --  40,700,000   407,000     (25,000)    (325,600)         --
  Distribution to stockholder............         --           --         --         --          --           --          --
  Net Income.............................         --           --         --         --          --           --          --
  Dividends accrued on Preferred Stock
   (Note 11).............................         --      867,430         --         --          --           --          --
                                           ---------  -----------  ---------  ---------  -----------  ----------  -----------
BALANCES, December 31, 1995..............  1,860,000   12,867,430  40,700,000   407,000          --    1,846,472          --
  Purchase of Access 24 (Note 16)........         --           --    970,240      9,702          --    4,841,498          --
  Cumulative translation adjustments.....         --           --         --         --          --           --     141,095
  Net income.............................         --           --         --         --          --           --          --
  Dividends accrued on Preferred Stock
   (Note 11).............................         --      211,215         --         --          --           --          --
  Issuance of restricted stock for
   compensation..........................         --           --     76,000        760          --      379,240          --
                                           ---------  -----------  ---------  ---------  -----------  ----------  -----------
BALANCES, March 31, 1996 (unaudited).....  1,860,000   13,078,645  41,746,240   417,462          --    7,067,210     141,095
  Pro Forma adjustment to reflect
   conversion of Mandatorily Redeemable
   Preferred Stock to Common Stock (Note
   11)...................................  (1,860,000) (13,078,645) 9,300,000    93,000          --   12,985,645          --
                                           ---------  -----------  ---------  ---------  -----------  ----------  -----------
BALANCES, Pro Forma March 31, 1996
 (unaudited).............................         --  $        --  51,046,240 $ 510,462   $      --   $20,052,855  $ 141,095
                                           ---------  -----------  ---------  ---------  -----------  ----------  -----------
 
<CAPTION>
 
                                              UNEARNED
                                           COMPENSATION-                 TOTAL
                                             RESTRICTED    RETAINED   STOCKHOLDERS'
                                               STOCK       EARNINGS      EQUITY
                                           --------------  ---------  ------------
<S>                                        <C>             <C>        <C>
BALANCES, January 1, 1994................    $       --    $ 917,098   $  942,098
  Distribution to stockholder............            --     (440,000)    (440,000)
  Net income.............................            --    1,694,974    1,694,974
                                           --------------  ---------  ------------
BALANCES, December 31, 1994..............            --    2,172,072    2,197,072
  Issue of Preferred Stock (Note 11).....            --           --           --
  Adjustment to reclassify retained
   earnings to additional paid in capital
   upon termination of S corporation
   election
   (Note 11).............................            --    (2,172,072)          --
  Stock exchange (Note 1)................            --      (56,400)          --
  Distribution to stockholder............            --    (1,694,974)  (1,694,974)
  Net Income.............................            --    4,156,084    4,156,084
  Dividends accrued on Preferred Stock
   (Note 11).............................            --     (867,430)    (867,430)
                                           --------------  ---------  ------------
BALANCES, December 31, 1995..............            --    1,537,280    3,790,752
  Purchase of Access 24 (Note 16)........            --           --    4,851,200
  Cumulative translation adjustments.....            --           --      141,095
  Net income.............................            --    1,257,542    1,257,542
  Dividends accrued on Preferred Stock
   (Note 11).............................            --     (211,215)    (211,215)
  Issuance of restricted stock for
   compensation..........................      (380,000)          --           --
                                           --------------  ---------  ------------
BALANCES, March 31, 1996 (unaudited).....      (380,000)   2,583,607    9,829,374
  Pro Forma adjustment to reflect
   conversion of Mandatorily Redeemable
   Preferred Stock to Common Stock (Note
   11)...................................            --           --   13,078,645
                                           --------------  ---------  ------------
BALANCES, Pro Forma March 31, 1996
 (unaudited).............................    $ (380,000)   $2,583,607  $22,908,019
                                           --------------  ---------  ------------
</TABLE>
    
 
        The accompanying notes are an integral part of these statements.
 
                                      F-7
<PAGE>
                            TELETECH HOLDINGS, INC.
                                AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
               CONSOLIDATED AND COMBINED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS
 
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                             ELEVEN                                  THREE MONTHS ENDED MARCH
                                          MONTHS ENDED   YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31,               31,
                                          DECEMBER 31,  --------------------------  --------------------------
                                              1993          1994          1995          1995          1996
                                          ------------  ------------  ------------  ------------  ------------
                                                                                           (UNAUDITED)
<S>                                       <C>           <C>           <C>           <C>           <C>
CASH FLOWS FROM OPERATING ACTIVITIES:
  Net income............................  $    547,676  $  1,694,974  $  4,156,084  $  1,627,825  $  1,257,542
  Adjustments to reconcile net income to
   net cash provided by (used in)
   operating activities--
    Depreciation and amortization.......       722,753     1,164,696     2,124,287       435,998     1,047,383
    Allowance for doubtful accounts.....       302,408       (20,381)      616,395        46,545       107,778
    Deferred taxes on income............       (22,000)           --        21,623       212,500      (160,553)
    Changes in assets and liabilities--
      Accounts receivable...............    (4,804,330)    2,288,110    (6,104,371)   (1,466,617)   (3,135,533)
      Prepaids and other assets.........      (162,599)       75,774       (36,583)      (16,080)     (169,594)
      Deposits..........................      (125,144)      (26,327)      (42,392)      (39,872)     (129,853)
      Deferred costs....................            --            --      (345,978)           --    (1,385,256)
      Other assets......................            --            --            --            --       101,871
      Accounts payable..................     2,298,421    (1,860,500)    1,161,794      (234,569)    1,941,473
      Accrued expenses..................       133,076       200,925       786,842     1,725,434     2,012,477
      Accrued employee compensation.....      (129,094)      328,371       780,251     1,122,634     1,344,802
      Customer advances and deposits....       309,863      (213,933)      126,870      (118,868)      244,656
      Deferred income...................       492,350      (466,667)       22,016       675,796       (16,255)
                                          ------------  ------------  ------------  ------------  ------------
      Net cash provided by (used in)
       operating activities.............      (436,620)    3,165,042     3,266,838     3,970,726     3,060,938
                                          ------------  ------------  ------------  ------------  ------------
CASH FLOWS FROM INVESTING ACTIVITIES:
  Purchase of property and equipment....    (1,589,609)   (1,932,312)   (1,735,206)     (243,469)   (3,301,426)
  Purchase of Access 24, net of cash
   acquired.............................            --            --            --            --    (2,218,149)
(Increase) decrease in short-term
 investments............................            --            --   (10,361,213)  (11,840,569)    2,499,017
                                          ------------  ------------  ------------  ------------  ------------
      Net cash used in investing
       activities.......................    (1,589,609)   (1,932,312)  (12,096,419)  (12,084,038)   (3,020,558)
                                          ------------  ------------  ------------  ------------  ------------
</TABLE>
    
 
        The accompanying notes are an integral part of these statements.
 
                                      F-8
<PAGE>
                            TELETECH HOLDINGS, INC.
                                AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
               CONSOLIDATED AND COMBINED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS
 
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                ELEVEN                                  THREE MONTHS ENDED MARCH
                                             MONTHS ENDED   YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31,                31,
                                             DECEMBER 31,  --------------------------  ---------------------------
                                                 1993          1994          1995          1995          1996
                                             ------------  ------------  ------------  ------------  -------------
                                                                                               (UNAUDITED)
<S>                                          <C>           <C>           <C>           <C>           <C>
CASH FLOWS FROM FINANCING ACTIVITIES:
  Net increase (decrease) in bank
   overdraft...............................  $     81,277  $    479,213  $    866,527  $   (540,490) $  (1,572,294)
  Net increase (decrease) in short-term
   borrowings..............................       832,000      (840,365)      361,365      (388,635)     2,500,000
  Payments on long-term debt...............      (157,756)     (418,241)     (624,487)     (113,121)       (47,829)
  Proceeds from long-term debt
   borrowings..............................     1,042,374       475,000            --            --             --
  Payments under capital lease
   obligations.............................       (99,984)     (324,924)     (969,942)     (149,522)      (356,895)
  Payments under subordinated notes payable
   to stockholder..........................       (49,695)     (125,680)   (1,104,337)   (1,104,337)            --
  Distributions to stockholder                         --      (440,000)   (1,694,974)   (1,210,000)            --
  Issuance of preferred stock..............            --            --    12,000,000    12,000,000             --
                                             ------------  ------------  ------------  ------------  -------------
      Net cash provided by (used in)
       financing activities................     1,648,216    (1,194,997)    8,834,152     8,493,895        522,982
                                             ------------  ------------  ------------  ------------  -------------
Effect of exchange rate changes on cash....            --            --            --            --        122,737
NET INCREASE (DECREASE) IN CASH AND CASH
 EQUIVALENTS...............................      (378,013)       37,733         4,571       360,583        686,099
CASH AND CASH EQUIVALENTS, beginning of
 period....................................       378,013            --        37,733        37,733         42,304
                                             ------------  ------------  ------------  ------------  -------------
CASH AND CASH EQUIVALENTS, end of period...  $         --  $     37,733  $     42,304  $    398,316  $     728,403
                                             ------------  ------------  ------------  ------------  -------------
                                             ------------  ------------  ------------  ------------  -------------
SUPPLEMENTAL DISCLOSURES OF CASH FLOW
 INFORMATION:
  Cash paid for interest...................  $    299,552  $    455,375  $    464,551  $    101,403  $     155,904
                                             ------------  ------------  ------------  ------------  -------------
                                             ------------  ------------  ------------  ------------  -------------
  Cash paid for income taxes...............  $    108,085  $     13,506  $  2,423,591  $         --  $     525,000
                                             ------------  ------------  ------------  ------------  -------------
                                             ------------  ------------  ------------  ------------  -------------
SUPPLEMENTAL SCHEDULE OF NONCASH INVESTING
 AND FINANCING ACTIVITIES:
  Assets acquired through capital leases...  $  2,137,884  $    211,194  $  4,106,326  $  1,589,799  $   1,712,887
                                             ------------  ------------  ------------  ------------  -------------
                                             ------------  ------------  ------------  ------------  -------------
  Stock issued in purchase of Access 24....  $         --  $         --  $         --  $         --  $   4,851,200
                                             ------------  ------------  ------------  ------------  -------------
                                             ------------  ------------  ------------  ------------  -------------
</TABLE>
    
 
        The accompanying notes are an integral part of these statements.
 
                                      F-9
<PAGE>
                            TELETECH HOLDINGS, INC.
                                AND SUBSIDIARIES
            NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED AND COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
                 FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1994 AND 1995
               AND FOR THE ELEVEN MONTHS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1993
       AND FOR THE THREE MONTHS ENDED MARCH 31, 1995 AND 1996 (UNAUDITED)
 
    TeleTech Holdings, Inc. ("THI" or the "Company") is a provider of outsourced
strategic  customer  care solutions  for Fortune  1000 corporations  in targeted
industries in  the United  States, United  Kingdom, Australia  and New  Zealand.
Customer  care encompasses a  wide range of  customer acquisition, retention and
satisfaction  programs  designed   to  maximize  the   lifetime  value  of   the
relationship between the Company's clients and their customers.
 
(1) SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES
 
    BASIS OF PRESENTATION
 
    The  consolidated financial statements are comprised  of the accounts of THI
and  its  wholly  owned  subsidiaries,  TeleTech  Telecommunications,  Inc.,   a
California   corporation  ("TTC"),  TeleTech   Teleservices,  Inc.,  a  Colorado
corporation ("TTS") and effective  January 1, 1996,  Access 24 and  subsidiaries
(Note  16), (jointly "the Group"). Prior to January 1, 1995, the Group comprised
TTC and  TTS,  held under  the  common ownership  of  a sole  stockholder  ("the
Stockholder").  Financial statements  for 1993  and 1994  represent the combined
financial statements of TTC and TTS.
 
    In January  1995, a  Preferred Stock  Purchase Agreement  and an  Investment
Agreement  (collectively the  "Agreements") were executed  by TeleTech Investors
General Partnership ("TIGP"), Essaness Theaters Corporation ("Essaness") and the
Stockholder. The Stockholder of  TTC and TTS contributed  100% of his shares  in
these  companies to  THI, a newly  formed Delaware corporation,  in exchange for
40,700,000 shares  of  THI's  common  stock, which  constituted  100%  of  THI's
outstanding  stock.  Concurrent  with  this stock  exchange,  TIGP  and Essaness
purchased an aggregate of 1,860,000 shares of THI's convertible preferred  stock
("Preferred   Stock")  for  $12  million.   The  Preferred  Stock  is  initially
convertible into 9,300,000  shares of  THI's common  stock (Note  11). TIGP  and
Essaness  purchased  1,705,000  and  155,000  shares  of  the  Preferred  Stock,
respectively.  The  Agreements  also  required  THI  to  enter  into  employment
agreements  with key executives, to obtain key man life and disability insurance
policies and to adopt a stock option plan for key employees.
 
    The exchange of stock constituted a reorganization of entities under  common
control  and the  assets and  liabilities of  TTC and  TTS are  reflected in the
consolidated financial statements of THI based  on their historical cost to  TTC
and TTS.
 
    All  intercompany  balances and  transactions  have been  eliminated  in the
consolidated and combined financial statements.
 
    UNAUDITED PRO FORMA INFORMATION
 
    If the offering contemplated by this  Prospectus is consummated, all of  the
Preferred Stock outstanding at the closing date will be converted into shares of
Common Stock ("Common Stock"). The unaudited pro forma balance sheet as of March
31,  1996, reflects the  conversion of outstanding Preferred  Stock at March 31,
1996 into 9,300,000 shares of Common Stock.
 
    INTERIM FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
 
    The consolidated financial statements of THI  as of March 31, 1995 and  1996
presented  herein have been prepared by THI without audit, pursuant to the rules
and regulations  of  the  Securities  and  Exchange  Commission.  The  financial
statements   reflect  all  adjustments  (consisting  of  only  normal  recurring
accruals) which, in the opinion of  management, are necessary to present  fairly
the  financial  position,  results  of  operations and  cash  flows  of  THI and
subsidiaries as of March 31, 1995 and 1996, and for the periods then ended.
 
                                      F-10
<PAGE>
                            TELETECH HOLDINGS, INC.
                                AND SUBSIDIARIES
            NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED AND COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
                 FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1994 AND 1995
               AND FOR THE ELEVEN MONTHS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1993
       AND FOR THE THREE MONTHS ENDED MARCH 31, 1995 AND 1996 (UNAUDITED)
                                  (CONTINUED)
 
(1) SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (CONTINUED)
    FOREIGN CURRENCY TRANSLATION
 
    The assets  and  liabilities of  the  Company's foreign  subsidiaries  whose
functional currency is other than the U.S. Dollar are translated at the exchange
rates in effect on the reporting date, and income and expenses are translated at
the  weighted  average  exchange  rate  during the  period.  The  net  effect of
translation gains and losses are not included in determining net income, but are
accumulated as a  separate component of  shareholders' equity. Foreign  currency
transaction  gains and losses are included in determining net income. Such gains
and losses were not material for any period presented.
 
    PROPERTY AND EQUIPMENT
 
    Property and equipment  are stated  at cost  less accumulated  depreciation.
Additions,  improvements,  and  major  renewals  are  capitalized.  Maintenance,
repairs, and minor renewals are expensed as incurred. Amounts paid for  software
licenses  and third-party packaged  software are capitalized.  Costs relating to
the internal development of software are expensed as incurred.
 
    Depreciation is computed on the straight-line method based on the  estimated
useful lives of the assets, as follows:
 
<TABLE>
<S>                                                                         <C>
Computer equipment and software...........................................    5 years
Telephone equipment.......................................................    5 years
Furniture and fixtures....................................................  5-7 years
Leasehold improvements....................................................  5-7 years
Vehicles..................................................................    5 years
</TABLE>
 
    Assets  acquired under capital lease obligations are amortized over the life
of the applicable lease of four to seven years (or the estimated useful lives of
the assets, of four to seven years,  where title to the leased assets passes  to
the Company on termination of the lease).
 
    REVENUE RECOGNITION
 
    The  Company recognizes  revenues at  the time  services are  performed. The
Company has certain contracts which are billed in advance. Accordingly,  amounts
billed  but  not earned  under these  contracts are  excluded from  revenues and
included in deferred income.
 
    RESEARCH AND DEVELOPMENT
 
    Research and development costs are  charged to operations when incurred  and
are  included in operating expenses. Research  and development costs amounted to
approximately $430,000, $684,000,  $458,000, $108,000  (unaudited) and  $102,000
(unaudited)  for  the eleven  months ended  December 31,  1993, the  years ended
December 31, 1994 and 1995, and the three-month periods ended March 31, 1995 and
1996, respectively.
 
    DEFERRED CONTRACT COST
 
   
    The Company defers certain incremental  direct costs incurred in  connection
with  preparing  to  provide  services  under  long-term  facilities  management
agreements. Costs that have been deferred include the costs of hiring  dedicated
personnel  to manage  client-owned facilities,  their related  payroll and other
directly  associated  costs  from  the  time  long-term  facilities   management
agreements  are entered  into until  the beginning  of providing  services. Such
costs  are   amortized  over   twelve  months.   Deferred  contract   costs   at
    
 
                                      F-11
<PAGE>
                            TELETECH HOLDINGS, INC.
                                AND SUBSIDIARIES
            NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED AND COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
                 FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1994 AND 1995
               AND FOR THE ELEVEN MONTHS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1993
       AND FOR THE THREE MONTHS ENDED MARCH 31, 1995 AND 1996 (UNAUDITED)
                                  (CONTINUED)
 
(1) SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (CONTINUED)
December  31, 1995  and March  31, 1996 include  costs incurred  in preparing to
provide services under  a five  year agreement  entered into  in October,  1995,
under which the Company began providing services during April 1996.
 
    INTANGIBLE ASSETS
 
    The  excess of cost  over the fair  market value of  tangible net assets and
trademarks of acquired businesses is amortized on a straight-line basis over the
periods of expected benefit of 15 years. Accumulated amortization of  intangible
assets   for  the  three-month  period  ended   March  31,  1996,  was  $108,000
(unaudited). No amortization expense was recorded in prior periods.
 
    Subsequent to an acquisition, the corporation continually evaluates  whether
later  events  and  circumstances  have  occurred  that  indicate  the remaining
estimated useful life of  an intangible asset may  warrant revision or that  the
remaining  balance of an  intangible asset may not  be recoverable. When factors
indicate that an intangible asset  should be evaluated for possible  impairment,
the  corporation uses an  estimate of the  related business' undiscounted future
cash flows  over  the remaining  life  of the  asset  in measuring  whether  the
intangible asset is recoverable. Management does not consider that any provision
for impairment of intangible assets is required.
 
    INCOME TAXES
 
    The  Company accounts for income taxes  under the provisions of Statement of
Financial Accounting Standards  No. 109,  "Accounting for  Income Taxes"  ("SFAS
109")  which requires recognition of deferred tax assets and liabilities for the
expected future income tax consequences of transactions which have been included
in the financial  statements or  tax returns.  Under this  method, deferred  tax
assets  and  liabilities  are determined  based  on the  difference  between the
financial statement and tax  bases of assets and  liabilities using enacted  tax
rates  in effect for the year in  which the differences are expected to reverse.
Net deferred tax assets  are then reduced by  a valuation allowance for  amounts
which do not satisfy the realization criteria of SFAS 109.
 
    During  1993 and 1994, TTC and TTS  were S corporations and their income was
taxable to the Stockholder rather than the companies. Effective January 1, 1995,
S corporation status terminated and THI  and its domestic subsidiaries began  to
file  consolidated corporate  Federal and state  income tax  returns (Access 24,
(Note 16) will file separate tax returns in Australia). As required by SFAS 109,
this change in tax status was recognized by establishing deferred tax assets and
liabilities for temporary differences between the tax basis and amounts reported
in the accompanying consolidated balance sheet (Note 8).
 
    EARNINGS PER SHARE
 
    Earnings per share are  computed based upon the  weighted average number  of
common   shares  and  common  share   equivalents  outstanding.  The  shares  of
convertible Preferred Stock are considered  common stock equivalents due to  the
mandatory  conversion provision (Note  11). Pursuant to  Securities and Exchange
Commission Staff  Accounting Bulletin  No.  83, common  stock and  common  stock
equivalent  shares  issued by  the Company  at prices  below the  assumed public
offering price during  the twelve month  period prior to  the proposed  offering
date  (using the treasury stock method) have been included in the calculation as
if they were  outstanding for all  the periods presented  regardless of  whether
they  are antidilutive.  On May 14,  1996, the  Company approved a  five for one
share  common  stock  split  to  be  effective  immediately  prior  and  subject
 
                                      F-12
<PAGE>
                            TELETECH HOLDINGS, INC.
                                AND SUBSIDIARIES
            NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED AND COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
                 FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1994 AND 1995
               AND FOR THE ELEVEN MONTHS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1993
       AND FOR THE THREE MONTHS ENDED MARCH 31, 1995 AND 1996 (UNAUDITED)
                                  (CONTINUED)
 
(1) SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (CONTINUED)
to  the closing  of the  offering contemplated  by this  Registration Statement.
Common stock amounts, equivalent share amounts  and per share amounts have  been
adjusted retroactively to give effect to the stock split.
 
    The  weighted average number  of common shares  and common share equivalents
was calculated as follows assuming the anticipated five-for-one stock split:
 
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                      THREE MONTHS ENDED MARCH
                                                                        YEAR ENDED              31,
                                                                       DECEMBER 31,  --------------------------
                                                                           1995          1995          1996
                                                                       ------------  ------------  ------------
                                       PRO FORMA ELEVEN   PRO FORMA
                                         MONTHS ENDED     YEAR ENDED
                                         DECEMBER 31,    DECEMBER 31,
                                             1993            1994
                                       ----------------  ------------
                                         (UNAUDITED)     (UNAUDITED)                        (UNAUDITED)
<S>                                    <C>               <C>           <C>           <C>           <C>
Common shares outstanding............      40,700,000     40,700,000    40,700,000     40,700,000    41,746,240
Convertible preferred stock..........              --             --     9,300,000      9,300,000     9,300,000
Common equivalent shares.............       3,142,557      3,142,557     4,402,103      4,330,530     3,379,720
                                       ----------------  ------------  ------------  ------------  ------------
Shares used in computing pro forma
 net income per common and common
 equivalent share....................      43,842,557     43,842,557    54,402,103     54,330,530    54,425,960
                                       ----------------  ------------  ------------  ------------  ------------
                                       ----------------  ------------  ------------  ------------  ------------
</TABLE>
    
 
    For comparative purposes, the earnings per share for 1993 and 1994 have been
calculated on a  pro-forma basis  as the historical  earnings per  share is  not
meaningful due to the Company reorganization on January 1, 1995.
 
    A  portion of the proceeds from the proposed public offering will be used to
repay short-term borrowings.  If this reduction  had taken place  at January  1,
1995  or  January 1,  1996, the  effect on  pro forma  earnings would  have been
immaterial.
 
    INCREASE IN AUTHORIZED SHARES
 
    On May  14, 1996,  the Board  of Directors  authorized an  amendment to  the
Company's  Certificate of Incorporation that will  be effective upon the closing
of the proposed  public offering of  the Company's Common  Stock. The  amendment
increases  the  authorized shares  of Common  Stock  to 150,000,000  shares. The
amendment also  authorizes the  Company  to issue  up  to 10,000,000  shares  of
preferred stock.
 
    RESTRICTED STOCK AWARDS
 
    In  January  1996,  the  Company awarded  76,000  restricted  shares  of the
Company's common stock to  certain employees as compensation  to be earned  over
the  term of  the employees'  related employment  agreements (three  years). The
market value of the  stock at the  date of award was  $380,000. This amount  has
been  recorded  as  unearned compensation-restricted  stock  and is  shown  as a
separate component of stockholders' equity.
 
    CASH AND CASH EQUIVALENTS
 
    For the purposes of the statement  of cash flows, the Company considers  all
cash  and investments with  an original maturity of  90 days or  less to be cash
equivalents.
 
    USE OF ESTIMATES
 
    The  preparation  of  financial  statements  in  conformity  with  generally
accepted  accounting  principles  requires  management  to  make  estimates  and
assumptions   that    affect    the    reported   amounts    of    assets    and
 
                                      F-13
<PAGE>
                            TELETECH HOLDINGS, INC.
                                AND SUBSIDIARIES
            NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED AND COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
                 FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1994 AND 1995
               AND FOR THE ELEVEN MONTHS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1993
       AND FOR THE THREE MONTHS ENDED MARCH 31, 1995 AND 1996 (UNAUDITED)
                                  (CONTINUED)
 
(1) SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (CONTINUED)
liabilities  and disclosure of contingent assets  and liabilities at the date of
the financial statements and the reported amounts of revenue and expenses during
the reporting period. Actual results could differ from those estimates.
 
    NEW ACCOUNTING STANDARDS
 
    In March 1995, the Financial Accounting Standards Board issued SFAS No. 121,
"Accounting for the Impairment of Long-Lived Assets and for Long-Lived Assets to
be  Disposed  Of."  SFAS  121  requires  that  long-lived  assets  and   certain
identifiable  intangibles  to be  held and  used  by an  entity be  reviewed for
impairment whenever  events  or  changes  in  circumstances  indicate  that  the
carrying  amount of an asset  may not be recoverable.  SFAS 121 is effective for
financial statements for  fiscal years  beginning after December  15, 1995.  The
adoption  of  SFAS  121  on January  1,  1996  had no  impact  on  the Company's
consolidated financial position or results of operations.
 
    In October 1995, the  Financial Accounting Standards  Board issued SFAS  No.
123.  "Accounting for Stock  Based Compensation." With  respect to stock options
granted to  employees, SFAS  No. 123  permits companies  to continue  using  the
accounting  method promulgated by the Accounting Principles Board Opinion No. 25
("APB  No.  25"),  "Accounting  for  Stock  Issued  to  Employees,"  to  measure
compensation or to adopt the fair value based method prescribed by SFAS No. 123.
If  APB No. 25's method  is continued, pro forma  disclosures are required as if
SFAS No. 123 accounting provisions were followed. Management has determined  not
to adopt SFAS No. 123's accounting recognition provisions (Note 12).
 
(2) CONCENTRATIONS
    The  Company's revenues from  major customers (revenues in  excess of 10% of
total sales) are from entities  involved in the telecommunications,  technology,
transportation, healthcare and financial services industries and for the periods
ended December 31, 1993, 1994 and 1995 are as follows:
 
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                     THREE MONTHS
                                   ELEVEN         YEAR ENDED             ENDED
                                MONTHS ENDED     DECEMBER 31,          MARCH 31,
                                DECEMBER 31,   -----------------   -----------------
                                    1993        1994      1995      1995      1996
                                ------------   -------   -------   -------   -------
                                                                      (UNAUDITED)
<S>                             <C>            <C>       <C>       <C>       <C>
Customer A....................          23%       18%       31%       33%       22%
Customer B....................          --         5%       18%       24%        6%
Customer C....................          21%       17%        9%       13%        6%
Customer D....................          --        13%       --        --        --
Customer E....................          18%       --        --        --        --
Customer F....................           0%        0%        3%        0%       13%
                                        --        --        --        --        --
                                        62%       53%       61%       70%       47%
                                        --        --        --        --        --
                                        --        --        --        --        --
</TABLE>
    
 
    The  loss of one or more of  its significant customers could have a material
adverse effect  on  the  Company's  business,  operating  results  or  financial
condition.
 
    To  limit  the Company's  credit  risk, management  performs  ongoing credit
evaluations  of  its   customers  and  maintains   allowances  for   potentially
uncollectible    accounts.   Although   the   Company   is   directly   impacted
 
                                      F-14
<PAGE>
                            TELETECH HOLDINGS, INC.
                                AND SUBSIDIARIES
            NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED AND COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
                 FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1994 AND 1995
               AND FOR THE ELEVEN MONTHS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1993
       AND FOR THE THREE MONTHS ENDED MARCH 31, 1995 AND 1996 (UNAUDITED)
                                  (CONTINUED)
 
(2) CONCENTRATIONS (CONTINUED)
by economic conditions  in the  telecommunications, technology,  transportation,
healthcare  and  financial  services  industries,  management  does  not believe
significant credit risk exists at December 31, 1995 or at March 31, 1996.
 
    GEOGRAPHIC AREA INFORMATION
 
    Prior to the acquisition of Access 24 in January 1996 (Note 16), the Company
operated  exclusively  within  the  United  States.  Unaudited  geographic  area
information for the three months ended March 31, 1996 is as follows:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                        UNITED STATES     EUROPE     ASIA PACIFIC       TOTAL
                                                        -------------  ------------  -------------  -------------
<S>                                                     <C>            <C>           <C>            <C>
Revenues..............................................  $  18,680,313  $    476,576  $   2,862,456  $  22,019,345
Income (loss) before income taxes.....................      2,054,659       (86,676)       290,861      2,258,844
Assets................................................     37,317,780     1,794,743     10,341,717     49,454,240
</TABLE>
 
(3) PROPERTY AND EQUIPMENT
    Property  and equipment consisted of the  following at December 31, 1994 and
1995, and March 31, 1996:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                              DECEMBER 31,
                                                                      ----------------------------
                                                                          1994           1995
                                                                      -------------  -------------    MARCH 31,
                                                                                                        1996
                                                                                                    -------------
                                                                                                     (UNAUDITED)
<S>                                                                   <C>            <C>            <C>
Computer equipment and software.....................................  $   5,848,105  $   9,807,113  $  11,197,300
Telephone equipment.................................................      1,105,246      1,219,642      1,851,831
Furniture and fixtures..............................................      1,507,171      2,938,478      5,307,555
Leasehold improvements..............................................        861,070      1,197,892      4,915,141
Vehicles............................................................             --             --         24,290
                                                                      -------------  -------------  -------------
                                                                          9,321,592     15,163,125     23,296,117
Less--Accumulated depreciation......................................     (3,935,136)    (6,059,424)    (6,987,766)
                                                                      -------------  -------------  -------------
                                                                      $   5,386,456  $   9,103,701  $  16,308,351
                                                                      -------------  -------------  -------------
                                                                      -------------  -------------  -------------
</TABLE>
 
    Included in the cost of property  and equipment above is equipment  obtained
through  capitalized  leases.  The following  is  a summary  of  equipment under
capital leases as of December 31, 1994 and 1995, and March 31, 1996:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                               DECEMBER 31,
                                                                        ---------------------------
                                                                            1994          1995
                                                                        ------------  -------------    MARCH 31,
                                                                                                         1996
                                                                                                     -------------
                                                                                                      (UNAUDITED)
<S>                                                                     <C>           <C>            <C>
Computer equipment and software.......................................  $    726,569  $   3,227,113  $   4,166,995
Telephone equipment...................................................       282,969        310,295        737,314
Furniture and fixtures................................................       847,984      2,038,597      3,854,957
Vehicles..............................................................            --             --          1,811
                                                                        ------------  -------------  -------------
                                                                           1,857,522      5,576,005      8,761,077
Less--Accumulated depreciation........................................      (556,704)    (1,291,704)    (1,073,018)
                                                                        ------------  -------------  -------------
                                                                        $  1,300,818  $   4,284,301  $   7,688,059
                                                                        ------------  -------------  -------------
                                                                        ------------  -------------  -------------
</TABLE>
 
                                      F-15
<PAGE>
                            TELETECH HOLDINGS, INC.
                                AND SUBSIDIARIES
            NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED AND COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
                 FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1994 AND 1995
               AND FOR THE ELEVEN MONTHS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1993
       AND FOR THE THREE MONTHS ENDED MARCH 31, 1995 AND 1996 (UNAUDITED)
                                  (CONTINUED)
 
(3) PROPERTY AND EQUIPMENT (CONTINUED)
    Depreciation expense related  to leased equipment  under capital leases  was
$109,556,  $409,518, $984,597, $77,947 (unaudited)  and $312,265 (unaudited) for
the eleven months ended December 31, 1993, the years ended December 31, 1994 and
1995, and the three-month periods ended March 31, 1995 and 1996, respectively.
 
(4) CAPITAL LEASE OBLIGATIONS
    On July 11,  1995, the Company  negotiated a master  lease agreement with  a
bank  under which it may lease equipment up  to a value of $8,000,000. As of May
13, 1996,  the master  lease has  been amended  to increase  the lease  line  to
$15,000,000. The term of the leases are 48 months and interest is payable at the
then  most recent  weekly average  of three-year  Treasury notes  plus 125 basis
points. In August 1995, the Company entered into another master lease  agreement
with  a bank under which it may lease equipment. Under the agreement, individual
lease terms are negotiated on a lease by lease basis. Subsequent to December 31,
1995, the Company  entered into several  leases under this  agreement which  are
being accounted for as operating leases (See Note 9).
 
    The  Company finances  a substantial portion  of its  property and equipment
under noncancelable capital  lease obligations. Accordingly,  the fair value  of
the  equipment has  been capitalized  and the  related obligation  recorded. The
average implicit interest rate  on these leases was  8.9% at December 31,  1995.
Interest  is charged to expense  at a level rate  applied to declining principal
over the period of the obligation.
 
    The future minimum lease payments under capitalized lease obligations as  of
December 31, 1995 and March 31, 1996 are as follows:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                      DECEMBER 31,
                                                                                          1995
                                                                                      -------------    MARCH 31,
                                                                                                         1996
                                                                                                     -------------
                                                                                                      (UNAUDITED)
<S>                                                                                   <C>            <C>
Year ending December 31--
  1996..............................................................................  $   1,658,828  $   2,159,825
  1997..............................................................................      1,594,470      2,608,577
  1998..............................................................................      1,246,793      2,116,303
  1999..............................................................................        570,519      1,217,108
  2000..............................................................................         54,875        211,443
                                                                                      -------------  -------------
                                                                                          5,125,485      8,313,256
  Less--Amount representing interest................................................       (676,522)      (775,509)
                                                                                      -------------  -------------
                                                                                          4,448,963      7,537,747
  Less--Current portion of capital lease obligations................................     (1,255,966)    (2,129,440)
                                                                                      -------------  -------------
                                                                                      $   3,192,997  $   5,408,307
                                                                                      -------------  -------------
                                                                                      -------------  -------------
</TABLE>
 
    Interest  expense  on  the  outstanding obligations  under  such  leases was
$39,981, $160,483, $312,653,  $73,350 (unaudited) and  $135,524 (unaudited)  for
the eleven months ended December 31, 1993, the years ended December 31, 1994 and
1995, and the three-month periods ended March 31, 1995 and 1996, respectively.
 
                                      F-16
<PAGE>
                            TELETECH HOLDINGS, INC.
                                AND SUBSIDIARIES
            NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED AND COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
                 FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1994 AND 1995
               AND FOR THE ELEVEN MONTHS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1993
       AND FOR THE THREE MONTHS ENDED MARCH 31, 1995 AND 1996 (UNAUDITED)
                                  (CONTINUED)
 
(5) LONG-TERM DEBT
    As  of  December  31, 1994  and  1995  and March  31,  1996,  long-term debt
consisted of the following (unsecured unless otherwise stated):
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                 DECEMBER 31,
                                                                          --------------------------
                                                                              1994          1995
                                                                          ------------  ------------   MARCH 31,
                                                                                                          1996
                                                                                                      ------------
                                                                                                      (UNAUDITED)
<S>                                                                       <C>           <C>           <C>
Note payable, interest at 8% per annum, principal and interest payable
 monthly at $3,594, maturing May 2000...................................  $    189,177  $    160,131  $    152,500
Note payable, collateralized by all of the assets of TTS, interest
 payable monthly at 6% per annum, principal due July 1995...............       350,000            --            --
Note payable, interest at 6% per annum, principal and interest payable
 monthly at $4,563, maturing January 1997...............................       106,989        57,297        44,403
Note payable, interest at 13% per annum, principal and interest payable
 monthly at $9,266, maturing April 1995.................................        95,599            --            --
Note payable, interest at 6% per annum, principal and interest payable
 monthly at $3,598, maturing June 1997..................................       100,000        61,786        51,869
Note payable, interest at 5% per annum, principal and interest payable
 monthly at $7,077, maturing January 2000...............................       375,000       313,064       295,675
Note payable to a bank, interest at 8-9% per annum, principal payable
 annually at $154,568 maturing September 2000, secured by an equitable
 mortgage over all assets and uncalled capital of Access 24.............            --            --       772,842
                                                                          ------------  ------------  ------------
                                                                             1,216,765       592,278     1,317,289
  Less--Current portion.................................................      (624,483)     (195,660)     (189,443)
                                                                          ------------  ------------  ------------
                                                                          $    592,282  $    396,618  $  1,127,846
                                                                          ------------  ------------  ------------
                                                                          ------------  ------------  ------------
</TABLE>
 
    Annual maturities of the long-term debt described above are as follows:
 
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                       DECEMBER 31,
                                                                                           1995
                                                                                       ------------   MARCH 31,
                                                                                                         1996
                                                                                                     ------------
                                                                                                     (UNAUDITED)
<S>                                                                                    <C>           <C>
Year ended December 31--
  1996 (March 31, 1996 - 9 months)...................................................   $  195,660   $    147,831
  1997...............................................................................      134,324        288,892
  1998...............................................................................      115,210        269,778
  1999...............................................................................      122,278        276,846
  2000...............................................................................       24,806        179,372
  Thereafter.........................................................................           --        154,570
                                                                                       ------------  ------------
                                                                                        $  592,278   $  1,317,289
                                                                                       ------------  ------------
                                                                                       ------------  ------------
</TABLE>
    
 
                                      F-17
<PAGE>
                            TELETECH HOLDINGS, INC.
                                AND SUBSIDIARIES
            NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED AND COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
                 FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1994 AND 1995
               AND FOR THE ELEVEN MONTHS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1993
       AND FOR THE THREE MONTHS ENDED MARCH 31, 1995 AND 1996 (UNAUDITED)
                                  (CONTINUED)
 
(6) SHORT-TERM BORROWINGS
    On June 23, 1994, TTC entered into a revolving line of credit agreement (the
"Credit Agreement") with  a bank under  which it could  borrow up to  $3,000,000
through June 30, 1995. Initial borrowings under this line of credit were used to
retire  TTC's previous line of credit. Interest is payable monthly at the bank's
prime rate plus 1.75% (10.25% at December 31, 1994).
 
    On April 12, 1995, the Company negotiated a new unsecured revolving line  of
credit  agreement with  the bank  under which  it may  borrow up  to $5,000,000.
Interest is payable at various interest rates. The borrowings can be made at (1)
the bank's prime rate, (2) a CD rate  plus 125 basis points for periods of 7  to
90  days with  minimum advances of  $500,000 with $100,000  increments, (3) LIBO
rate plus 125 basis points for borrowing periods of 1, 2, 3 or 6 months, or  (4)
agreed  upon  rates.  At  December  31, 1995  and  March  31,  1996,  the amount
outstanding under this facility was $1,000,000 and $3,500,000, respectively, and
is classified as short-term.
 
    In April  1996, the  Company was  granted  an increased  line of  credit  of
$15,000,000  through  May  1998.  The  terms of  this  line  of  credit remained
unchanged from the previous $5,000,000 line of credit.
 
    The Company  is required  to comply  with certain  minimum financial  ratios
under covenants in connection with the borrowings described above.
 
(7) SUBORDINATED NOTES PAYABLE TO COMMON STOCKHOLDER
    At  December 31,  1994 subordinated  notes payable  to the  Stockholder with
interest at  8% per  annum amounted  to $1,104,337,  of which  $145,299 was  due
within one year.
 
    These notes payable were subordinated to the long-term debt (Note 5) and the
short-term  borrowings (Note 6) as specified  in the credit agreements. Interest
incurred on indebtedness to the  stockholder amounted to approximately  $91,000,
$96,000,  $11,000, $11,000 (unaudited) and $0  (unaudited) for the eleven months
ended December 31, 1993,  the years ended  December 31, 1994  and 1995, and  the
three months ended March 31, 1995 and 1996, respectively.
 
    In February 1995, in conjunction with the Company's reorganization and stock
sale (Note 1), the Company paid in full these subordinated notes payable.
 
(8) INCOME TAXES
    As  stated in  Note 1,  TTC and  TTS terminated  their S  corporation status
effective January  1,  1995.  This  change  in  tax  status  was  recognized  by
establishing net deferred tax liabilities of approximately $212,000 on that date
for  temporary  differences  between  tax  basis  and  amounts  reported  in the
accompanying combined balance sheets of TTC  and TTS. The current provision  for
income  taxes for 1994 and  for the 11 months  ended December 31, 1993, reflects
only amounts payable to certain state tax jurisdictions that do not recognize  S
corporation  status. Beginning in  1995, THI and  its domestic subsidiaries will
file consolidated  corporate federal  and state  income tax  returns. Access  24
(Note  17) will file separate  tax returns in the  various countries in which it
provides services.
 
                                      F-18
<PAGE>
                            TELETECH HOLDINGS, INC.
                                AND SUBSIDIARIES
            NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED AND COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
                 FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1994 AND 1995
               AND FOR THE ELEVEN MONTHS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1993
       AND FOR THE THREE MONTHS ENDED MARCH 31, 1995 AND 1996 (UNAUDITED)
                                  (CONTINUED)
 
(8) INCOME TAXES (CONTINUED)
    The components of income before income taxes are as follows:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                              THREE MONTHS
                                                                   YEAR ENDED                    ENDED
                                                                  DECEMBER 31,                 MARCH 31,
                                                           --------------------------  --------------------------
                                                               1994          1995          1995          1996
                                                           ------------  ------------  ------------  ------------
                                               ELEVEN
                                            MONTHS ENDED
                                            DECEMBER 31,
                                                1993
                                            -------------
                                             (UNAUDITED)                                      (UNAUDITED)
<S>                                         <C>            <C>           <C>           <C>           <C>
Domestic..................................   $   537,676   $  1,714,710  $  7,085,080  $  2,952,288  $  2,054,659
Foreign...................................            --             --            --            --       204,185
                                            -------------  ------------  ------------  ------------  ------------
Total.....................................   $   537,676   $  1,714,710  $  7,085,080  $  2,952,288  $  2,258,844
                                            -------------  ------------  ------------  ------------  ------------
                                            -------------  ------------  ------------  ------------  ------------
</TABLE>
 
    The components of the provision for income taxes are as follows:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                        THREE MONTHS ENDED MARCH
                                                                          YEAR ENDED              31,
                                                                         DECEMBER 31,  --------------------------
                                                                             1995          1995          1996
                                                                         ------------  ------------  ------------
                                                                                              (UNAUDITED)
<S>                                                                      <C>           <C>           <C>
Current provision:
  Federal..............................................................   $2,472,925   $    952,940  $    942,658
  State................................................................      433,813        159,023       145,691
  Foreign..............................................................           --             --        73,506
                                                                         ------------  ------------  ------------
                                                                           2,906,738      1,111,963     1,161,855
                                                                         ------------  ------------  ------------
Deferred provision:
  Federal..............................................................     (153,610)            --      (132,761)
  State................................................................      (36,632)            --       (27,792)
                                                                         ------------  ------------  ------------
                                                                            (190,242)            --      (160,553)
Change in tax status from S corporation to C corporation...............      212,500        212,500            --
                                                                         ------------  ------------  ------------
                                                                          $2,928,996   $  1,324,463  $  1,001,302
                                                                         ------------  ------------  ------------
                                                                         ------------  ------------  ------------
</TABLE>
 
    The following reconciles  the Company's  effective tax rate  to the  federal
statutory  rate for the  year ended December  31, 1995 and  for the three months
ended March 31, 1995 and 1996:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                        THREE MONTHS ENDED MARCH
                                                                          YEAR ENDED              31,
                                                                         DECEMBER 31,  --------------------------
                                                                             1995          1995          1996
                                                                         ------------  ------------  ------------
                                                                                              (UNAUDITED)
<S>                                                                      <C>           <C>           <C>
Income tax expense per federal statutory rate..........................   $2,408,927   $  1,003,778  $    768,007
State income taxes, net of federal deduction...........................      262,139         98,687       111,813
Effect of change in tax status from S corporation to C corporation.....      212,500        212,500            --
Permanent differences..................................................       37,210          9,498       114,482
Environmental tax......................................................        8,220             --            --
Foreign income taxed at higher rate....................................           --             --         7,000
                                                                         ------------  ------------  ------------
                                                                          $2,928,996   $  1,324,463  $  1,001,302
                                                                         ------------  ------------  ------------
                                                                         ------------  ------------  ------------
</TABLE>
 
                                      F-19
<PAGE>
                            TELETECH HOLDINGS, INC.
                                AND SUBSIDIARIES
            NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED AND COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
                 FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1994 AND 1995
               AND FOR THE ELEVEN MONTHS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1993
       AND FOR THE THREE MONTHS ENDED MARCH 31, 1995 AND 1996 (UNAUDITED)
                                  (CONTINUED)
 
(8) INCOME TAXES (CONTINUED)
    The Company's deferred income tax  assets and liabilities are summarized  as
follows:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                       YEAR ENDED
                                                                                      DECEMBER 31,
                                                                                          1995
                                                                                      ------------  THREE MONTHS
                                                                                                     ENDED MARCH
                                                                                                      31, 1996
                                                                                                    -------------
                                                                                                     (UNAUDITED)
<S>                                                                                   <C>           <C>
Deferred tax assets:
  Allowance for doubtful accounts...................................................   $  178,068    $   292,496
  Vacation accrual..................................................................      307,674        345,224
                                                                                      ------------  -------------
                                                                                          485,742        637,720
Deferred tax liabilities:
  Excess depreciation for tax.......................................................     (507,365)      (498,790)
                                                                                      ------------  -------------
Net deferred income tax (liability) asset...........................................   $  (21,623)   $   138,930
                                                                                      ------------  -------------
                                                                                      ------------  -------------
</TABLE>
 
    A  valuation allowance has not been recorded as the Company expects that all
deferred tax assets will be realized in the future.
 
    The combined statement of income for 1993 and 1994 presents, on an unaudited
pro forma  basis,  net  income  as  if the  Company  had  filed  consolidated  C
corporation  federal and state income  tax returns for that  year. The pro forma
tax effects assume that the deferred tax assets established effective January 1,
1995, as described above, would have been provided for as the related  temporary
differences arose. The pro forma provision for income taxes for 1993 and 1994 is
reconciled  to the amount computed by applying the statutory federal tax rate to
income before taxes as follows:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                                 UNAUDITED
                                                                                          ------------------------
                                                                                             1993         1994
                                                                                          (PRO FORMA)  (PRO FORMA)
                                                                                          -----------  -----------
                                                                                            AMOUNT       AMOUNT
                                                                                          -----------  -----------
<S>                                                                                       <C>          <C>
Income tax expense per federal statutory rate...........................................   $ 182,810    $ 583,001
State income taxes, net of federal deduction............................................      23,410       81,491
Permanent differences...................................................................      32,776       13,110
                                                                                          -----------  -----------
  Total pro forma provision for income taxes............................................     238,996      677,602
Historical provision (benefit) for income taxes.........................................     (10,000)      19,736
                                                                                          -----------  -----------
Pro forma tax effects...................................................................   $ 248,996    $ 657,866
                                                                                          -----------  -----------
                                                                                          -----------  -----------
</TABLE>
 
(9) COMMITMENTS AND CONTINGENCIES
    The Company leases its premises in Sherman Oaks and Burbank, California  and
Denver, Colorado pursuant to agreements expiring through 2003. The monthly rents
are subject to certain operating expenses and real estate taxes.
 
    The  Company has  various operating leases  for equipment  and office space.
Lease expense  under operating  leases was  approximately $626,000,  $1,366,000,
$442,000,  $88,000 (unaudited) and  $118,000 (unaudited), for  the eleven months
ended December 31, 1993,  the years ended  December 31, 1994  and 1995, and  the
three months ended March 31, 1995 and 1996, respectively.
 
                                      F-20
<PAGE>
                            TELETECH HOLDINGS, INC.
                                AND SUBSIDIARIES
            NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED AND COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
                 FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1994 AND 1995
               AND FOR THE ELEVEN MONTHS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1993
       AND FOR THE THREE MONTHS ENDED MARCH 31, 1995 AND 1996 (UNAUDITED)
                                  (CONTINUED)
 
(9) COMMITMENTS AND CONTINGENCIES (CONTINUED)
    The  future minimum  rental payments required  under noncancelable operating
leases as of December 31, 1995, and March 31, 1996, are as follows:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                       DECEMBER 31,
                                                                                           1995
                                                                                       -------------   MARCH 31,
                                                                                                          1996
                                                                                                      ------------
                                                                                                      (UNAUDITED)
<S>                                                                                    <C>            <C>
Year ended December 31--
  1996...............................................................................  $   2,611,341  $  1,494,490
  1997...............................................................................      2,202,442     1,982,791
  1998...............................................................................      1,877,301     1,946,135
  1999...............................................................................      1,773,350     1,645,375
  2000...............................................................................        768,452       347,356
  Thereafter.........................................................................      1,974,493       302,900
                                                                                       -------------  ------------
                                                                                       $  11,207,379  $  7,719,047
                                                                                       -------------  ------------
                                                                                       -------------  ------------
</TABLE>
 
(10) EMPLOYEE BENEFIT PLAN
    The Company has a 401(k) Profit Sharing Plan which covers all employees  who
have  completed  one  year  of  service,  as  defined,  and  are  21  or  older.
Participants may  defer up  to 19%  of their  gross pay  up to  a maximum  limit
determined by law. Participants are always 100% vested in their contributions.
 
    The  Company  may make  discretionary contributions  to  the plan  which are
distributed to participants in accordance with the plan. Participants are vested
in these contributions at a  rate of 20% per year.  For the eleven months  ended
December  31, 1993 and the years ended December 31, 1994 and 1995, the Company's
contributions to  the plan  were $40,000,  $64,000 and  $131,000,  respectively.
There  were no contributions  made during the  periods ended March  31, 1995 and
1996.
 
(11) MANDATORILY REDEEMABLE CONVERTIBLE PREFERRED STOCK
    In January,  1995,  the  Company  issued  1,860,000  shares  of  convertible
preferred  stock, $6.45  par value,  at $6.45  per share  for gross  proceeds of
$12,000,000. The Company used  the funds for the  repayment of certain notes  as
well as for working capital requirements.
 
    Preferred  Stock is  initially convertible  at the  option of  the preferred
stockholders, into 9,300,000 shares  of common stock. This  number of shares  of
common  stock is  subject to  adjustment in  the event  of certain  issuances of
common stock,  excluding up  to 7,000,000  shares of  common stock  that may  be
issued  upon exercise  of stock options,  to ensure  that preferred stockholders
maintain ownership of 16.9%  of the common  stock on a  fully diluted basis  (as
adjusted pursuant to the Company's Certificate of Incorporation).
 
    In  the event that  preferred stockholders do  not exercise their conversion
rights set out above, the preferred stock  converts to common stock at the  rate
set  out  above, at  the  earlier of  the  consummation of  a  qualified initial
offering of shares  to the public  (as defined in  the Company's Certificate  of
Incorporation) or May 18, 2002.
 
    In  the event that the  holders of Preferred Stock  have not exercised their
conversion rights prior  to May 18,  2002, they are  entitled to either  convert
their Preferred Stock to shares of common stock or redeem their shares for cash.
Such  conversion  is to  provide an  internal  rate of  return to  the Preferred
Stockholders of 7% per annum. Accordingly, dividends are accrued cumulatively at
the rate of 0.5833% per month.
 
                                      F-21
<PAGE>
                            TELETECH HOLDINGS, INC.
                                AND SUBSIDIARIES
            NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED AND COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
                 FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1994 AND 1995
               AND FOR THE ELEVEN MONTHS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1993
       AND FOR THE THREE MONTHS ENDED MARCH 31, 1995 AND 1996 (UNAUDITED)
                                  (CONTINUED)
 
(12) STOCK OPTION PLANS
    The Company adopted a stock option plan during 1995 and amended and restated
the plan in January  1996, for directors,  officers, employees, consultants  and
independent  contractors. The plan reserves 7,000,000 shares of common stock and
permits the  award  of incentive  stock  options ("ISOs"),  other  non-qualified
options ("NSOs"), stock appreciation rights ("SARs") and restricted stock. Under
the terms of this plan, the purchase price of shares subject to each ISO granted
must  not  be  less  than the  fair  market  value  on the  date  of  grant. The
compensation committee of the Board of  Directors has complete discretion as  to
exercise  prices of all  other awards, including  NSOs. Outstanding options vest
over a three or five-year period and are exercisable for ten years from the date
of grant.
 
   
    In January, 1996, the Company adopted  a stock option plan for  non-employee
directors  (the "Director Plan"),  covering 750,000 shares  of common stock. All
options are to be  granted at fair  market value at the  date of grant.  Options
vest as of the date of the option and are not exercisable until six months after
the  option date. Options granted are exercisable for ten years from the date of
grant unless  a  participant  is  terminated  for cause  or  one  year  after  a
participant's  death.  Options to  purchase 237,500  shares were  outstanding at
March 31, 1996.
    
 
    STATEMENT OF FINANCIAL ACCOUNTING STANDARDS NO. 123 ("SFAS 123")
 
    During 1995,  the  Financial Accounting  Standards  Board issued  SFAS  123,
"Accounting  for Stock  Based Compensation,"  which defines  a fair  value based
method of accounting for an employee  stock option or similar equity  instrument
and  encourages all entities to adopt that method of accounting for all of their
employee stock compensation plans. However, it also allows an entity to continue
to measure compensation  cost for  those plans  using the  method of  accounting
prescribed  by  the  Accounting  Principles Board  Opinion  No.  25  ("APB 25"),
"Accounting for Stock Issued to Employees." Entities electing to remain with the
accounting in APB 25 must make pro forma disclosures of net income and  earnings
per  share, as  if the  fair value  based method  of accounting  defined in this
Statement has been applied.
 
    The Company has elected  to account for  its stock-based compensation  plans
under  APB  25;  however,  the Company  has  computed  for  pro-forma disclosure
purposes the value of all options granted  during 1995 and in the quarter  ended
March  31, 1996, using  the Black-Scholes option pricing  model as prescribed by
SFAS 123 and the following weighted average assumptions used for grants:
 
<TABLE>
<S>                                                                       <C>
Risk-free interest rate.................................................       6.34%
Expected dividend yield.................................................          0%
Expected lives..........................................................  4.48 years
Expected volatility.....................................................         59%
</TABLE>
 
    Options were assumed to  be exercised upon vesting  for the purpose of  this
valuation.  Adjustments are  made for  options forfeited  prior to  vesting. The
total value of  options granted  was computed  to be  the following  approximate
amounts,  which would  be amortized  on a straight  line basis  over the vesting
period of the options:
 
<TABLE>
<S>                                                                         <C>
Year ended December 31, 1995..............................................  $ 340,727
Three months ended March 31, 1996 (unaudited).............................  $ 335,010
</TABLE>
 
    If the Company had  accounted for these plans  in accordance with SFAS  123,
the  Company's net  income and pro  forma net  income per share  would have been
reported as follows:
 
                                      F-22
<PAGE>
                            TELETECH HOLDINGS, INC.
                                AND SUBSIDIARIES
            NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED AND COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
                 FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1994 AND 1995
               AND FOR THE ELEVEN MONTHS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1993
       AND FOR THE THREE MONTHS ENDED MARCH 31, 1995 AND 1996 (UNAUDITED)
                                  (CONTINUED)
 
(12) STOCK OPTION PLANS (CONTINUED)
    NET INCOME
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                       YEAR ENDED
                                                                      DECEMBER 31,
                                                                          1995
                                                                      ------------  THREE MONTHS ENDED
                                                                                      MARCH 31, 1996
                                                                                    -------------------
                                                                                        (UNAUDITED)
<S>                                                                   <C>           <C>
As Reported.........................................................   $4,156,084      $   1,257,542
Pro Forma...........................................................    3,815,357            922,532
</TABLE>
 
    PRO FORMA NET INCOME PER COMMON AND COMMON EQUIVALENT SHARE
 
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                        YEAR ENDED
                                                                       DECEMBER 31,
                                                                           1995
                                                                      ---------------    THREE MONTHS ENDED
                                                                                           MARCH 31, 1996
                                                                                       -----------------------
                                                                                             (UNAUDITED)
<S>                                                                   <C>              <C>
As Reported.........................................................     $     .08            $     .02
Pro Forma...........................................................     $     .07            $     .02
</TABLE>
    
 
    A summary of the status of the Company's two stock option plans at March 31,
1996 and December 31, 1995 together  with changes during the periods then  ended
are presented in the following table:
 
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                YEAR ENDED           THREE MONTHS ENDED
                                                             DECEMBER 31, 1995         MARCH 31, 1996
                                                          -----------------------  -----------------------
                                                                       WEIGHTED                 WEIGHTED
                                                                        AVERAGE                  AVERAGE
                                                                       PRICE PER                PRICE PER
                                                            SHARES       SHARE       SHARES       SHARE
                                                          ----------  -----------  ----------  -----------
<S>                                                       <C>         <C>          <C>         <C>
Outstanding at beginning of period......................          --                2,355,000   $    1.90
Grants during period....................................   2,355,000   $    1.90      803,440   $    5.25
                                                          ----------               ----------
Outstanding at end of period............................   2,355,000   $    1.90    3,158,440   $    2.75
                                                          ----------               ----------
                                                          ----------               ----------
</TABLE>
    
 
    The  following table sets forth the  exercise price range, number of shares,
weighted average exercise  price and  remaining contractual lives  by groups  of
similar price and grant date:
 
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                WEIGHTED
                                                 AVERAGE
   EXERCISE     NUMBER OF      WEIGHTED        CONTRACTUAL
 PRICE RANGE      SHARES     AVERAGE PRICE        LIFE
- --------------  ----------  ---------------  ---------------
<S>             <C>         <C>              <C>
$ 1.29 - $1.30   1,400,000     $    1.29               10
$            2     405,000     $    2.00               10
$       3 - $5   1,303,440     $    4.31               10
$            9      50,000     $    9.00               10
</TABLE>
    
 
   
    Subsequent to March 31, 1996, THI granted an additional 1,638,905 options at
a weighted average price of $8.17.
    
 
(13) FAIR VALUE OF FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS
    Fair  values of  cash equivalents and  other current  amounts receivable and
payable approximate  the  carrying  amounts  due  to  their  short-term  nature.
Short-term  investments  consist of  overnight deposits  in mutual  funds. These
funds hold  short-term  investments  which  include  primarily  U.S.  Government
Treasury
 
                                      F-23
<PAGE>
                            TELETECH HOLDINGS, INC.
                                AND SUBSIDIARIES
            NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED AND COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
                 FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1994 AND 1995
               AND FOR THE ELEVEN MONTHS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1993
       AND FOR THE THREE MONTHS ENDED MARCH 31, 1995 AND 1996 (UNAUDITED)
                                  (CONTINUED)
 
(13) FAIR VALUE OF FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS (CONTINUED)
Bills,  bankers'  acceptance  notes,  commercial  paper  and  Master  notes with
maturities of  90 days  or less.  Interest  accrues daily  on these  funds,  and
accordingly,  the carrying  values of  these investments  approximate their fair
values.
 
    Debt carried on  the Company's  consolidated balance sheet  of $592,278  and
$1,317,289  at December 31, 1995 and March 31, 1996, has an estimated fair value
of $626,478  and  $1,173,339, respectively.  The  fair value  of  the  long-term
portion  of the Company's debt  is based on discounting  future cash flows using
current interest rates adjusted for risk. The fair value of the short-term  debt
approximates its recorded value due to its short-term nature.
 
(14) OTHER INCOME
    Other  income (expense)  for the  year ended December  31, 1995  and for the
three months ended March 31, 1995 includes $2,400,000 received in settlement  of
a premature termination of a contract.
 
(15) RELATED PARTY TRANSACTIONS
    During fiscal 1995, the Company provided reservations call handling services
to  Midway  Airlines  Corporation  ("Midway"),  a  majority-owned  subsidiary of
Zell/Chilmark Fund, L.P. Samuel Zell, a director of the Company, is an affiliate
of Zell/Chilmark Fund, L.P. During the twelve months ended December 31, 1995 and
the three months ended March 31,  1996, the Company charged Midway an  aggregate
of  $1,291,862 and $600,904, respectively, for services rendered by the Company.
As of December  31, 1995 and  March 31, 1996,  the amounts due  from Midway  for
services  rendered  by  the  Company  was  $535,845  and  $570,274  (unaudited),
respectively, of which $354,526 and $462,958 (unaudited), respectively, was past
due.
 
    In April  1996,  the  Company  agreed to  accept  from  Midway,  and  Midway
delivered  to the Company, a promissory note in the principal amount of $500,000
to evidence a portion of the total amount due. The note bears interest at a rate
of 8% per annum and is payable  in 12 equal installments of principal,  together
with interest, commencing May 1, 1996. The Company is continuing to provide call
handling services to Midway.
 
    The  Company  utilizes  the  services  of  The  Riverside  Agency,  Inc. for
reviewing, obtaining and/or renewing  various insurance policies. The  Riverside
Agency,  Inc. is a wholly owned subsidiary of Equity Group Investments, Inc., of
which Samuel Zell, a director of the  Company, is Chairman of the Board.  During
the  twelve months ended December 31, 1995  and the three months ended March 31,
1996, the Company incurred $23,965 and $47,930, respectively, for such services.
 
(16) ACQUISITIONS
    On January 1, 1996, the Company acquired 100% of the common stock of  Access
24  Services Corporation Pty  Limited (with its  subsidiaries, "Access 24"), for
consideration of $7.1 million, consisting of  cash of $2.27 million and  970,240
shares  of common stock  in the Company.  Access 24 provides  inbound, toll free
customer service, primarily to the  healthcare and financial services sector  in
Australia, the United Kingdom and New Zealand.
 
    This  acquisition has been accounted for using the purchase method. Goodwill
of $6.3 million arising on the acquisition is being amortized over 15 years on a
straight line basis.
 
                                      F-24
<PAGE>
                            TELETECH HOLDINGS, INC.
                                AND SUBSIDIARIES
            NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED AND COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
                 FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1994 AND 1995
               AND FOR THE ELEVEN MONTHS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1993
       AND FOR THE THREE MONTHS ENDED MARCH 31, 1995 AND 1996 (UNAUDITED)
                                  (CONTINUED)
 
(16) ACQUISITIONS (CONTINUED)
    The following unaudited pro forma consolidated income statement gives effect
to the consummation of the acquisition as if it had occurred on January 1, 1995:
 
                  CONSOLIDATED CONDENSED STATEMENTS OF INCOME
                                 (IN THOUSANDS)
 
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                     YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1995
                                                                                  -----------------------------------
                                                                                     THI      ACCESS 24    PRO FORMA
                                                                                  ---------  -----------  -----------
                                                                                                   (UNAUDITED)
<S>                                                                               <C>        <C>          <C>
Revenue.........................................................................  $  50,467   $  10,239    $  60,706
                                                                                  ---------  -----------  -----------
                                                                                  ---------  -----------  -----------
Net income (loss)...............................................................  $   4,156   $    (166)   $   3,990
                                                                                  ---------  -----------  -----------
                                                                                  ---------  -----------  -----------
Pro forma net income per common and common equivalent share.....................  $     .08                $     .07
                                                                                  ---------               -----------
                                                                                  ---------               -----------
Shares used in computing pro forma net income per common and common equivalent
 share..........................................................................     54,402                   54,402
                                                                                  ---------               -----------
                                                                                  ---------               -----------
</TABLE>
    
 
    Pro forma  net loss  for Access  24 for  the year  ended December  31,  1995
reflects   a  charge  of  $422,000  for  amortization  of  goodwill  arising  on
acquisition.
 
(17) SUBSEQUENT EVENTS (UNAUDITED)
    SALE OF STOCK
    As of April 30, 1996, the Company sold 50% of the common stock of Access 24,
Limited (the Company's United Kingdom subsidiary that operates a call center  in
London,  England) to PPP Healthcare Group  plc ("PPP") for cash consideration of
$3.8 million. This transaction  resulted in an  after-tax gain of  approximately
$1.6 million.
 
    In  addition,  Access  24,  Limited  also  issued  1,000,000  Cumulative  7%
Preference Shares at a par value of 1 pound each, redeemable in 2006, to PPP for
consideration of $1.5 million.
 
    Access 24,  Limited  did not  contribute  significantly to  the  results  of
operations of the Company for any of the periods presented herein.
 
    BONUS PLAN
    In  May, 1996,  the Company adopted  the 1996 Management  Bonus Plan ("Bonus
Plan") to  provide a  performance-based incentive  for the  Company's  executive
officers and key employees. The compensation committee of the Board of Directors
administers  the  Bonus Plan  and determines  which  employees are  eligible for
anticipation. Bonuses are based on the Company's results of operations.
 
    TRANSACTION FEES
    In May 1996,  the Board of  Directors approved  the payment of  fees to  the
Equity  Group Investments, Inc., an affiliate of  Samuel Zell, a director of the
Company, for advice and assistance in consummating the following transactions:
 
<TABLE>
<S>        <C>                                                          <C>
i)         Access 24 purchase (Note 16)...............................  $ 300,000
ii)        The Company's proposed initial public offering of stock....    500,000
iii)       Sale of Access 24, Limited stock to PPP....................    200,000
                                                                        ---------
                                                                        $1,000,000
                                                                        ---------
                                                                        ---------
</TABLE>
 
    Fees associated  with  the Access  24  purchase  will be  allocated  to  the
purchase  price. Fees  associated with  the proposed  public offering  of common
stock will be  netted against the  offering proceeds. Fees  associated with  the
sale of stock to PPP will be netted of against the gain arising on this sale.
 
                                      F-25
<PAGE>
                    REPORT OF INDEPENDENT PUBLIC ACCOUNTANTS
 
To the members of
Access 24 Service Corporation Pty Limited
 
    We  have audited the accompanying financial  statements of Access 24 Service
Corporation Pty Limited and Controlled Entities  and of the economic entity  for
the  periods  ended 28  February  1995 and  December  31, 1995.  These financial
statements  are   the   responsibility   of  the   Company's   management.   Our
responsibility  is to express an opinion  on those financial statements based on
our audit.
 
    We conducted our  audit in  accordance with  Australian Auditing  Standards,
which  do not differ substantially from generally accepted auditing standards in
the United States of America. Those  standards require that we plan and  perform
the  audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements
are free from  material misstatements. An  audit includes examining,  on a  test
basis,  evidence supporting amounts and disclosures in the financial statements.
An audit also includes assessing the accounting principles used and  significant
estimates  made  by  management, as  well  as evaluating  the  overall financial
statement presentation. We believe  that our audit  provides a reasonable  basis
for our opinion.
 
    In  our opinion, the financial statements  referred to above present fairly,
in  all  material  respects,  the  financial  position  of  Access  24   Service
Corporation  Pty  Limited and  Controlled Entities  as of  28 February  1995 and
December 31, 1995, and the results of the group's operations and cash flows  for
the periods then ended in accordance with Australian Accounting Standards.
 
    There  are certain  differences between Australian  Accounting Standards and
those generally accepted  in the United  States of America.  Application of  the
generally  accepted accounting principles in the  United States of America would
not result in material differences to these financial statements.
 
                                          ARTHUR ANDERSEN
   
                                          Chartered Accountants
    
 
Sydney, Australia,
May 21, 1996
 
                                      F-26
<PAGE>
       ACCESS 24 SERVICE CORPORATION PTY LIMITED AND CONTROLLED ENTITIES
                          CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEETS
 
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                   NOTE
                                                                                   -----                   DECEMBER 31,
                                                                                                               1995
                                                                                                           ------------
                                                                                                                A$
                                                                                             FEBRUARY 28,   (NOTE 22)
                                                                                                 1995
                                                                                             ------------
                                                                                                  A$
<S>                                                                             <C>          <C>           <C>
CURRENT ASSETS
  Cash........................................................................           5     1,837,982       816,220
  Receivables.................................................................           6     1,340,978     1,976,041
  Other.......................................................................           7       165,432       401,173
                                                                                             ------------  ------------
TOTAL CURRENT ASSETS..........................................................                 3,344,392     3,193,434
                                                                                             ------------  ------------
NON-CURRENT ASSETS
  Property, plant and equipment...............................................           8     2,170,050     4,217,281
  Intangibles.................................................................           9     2,163,362     1,964,360
  Other.......................................................................          10       366,517       466,726
                                                                                             ------------  ------------
TOTAL NON-CURRENT ASSETS......................................................                 4,699,929     6,648,367
                                                                                             ------------  ------------
TOTAL ASSETS..................................................................                 8,044,321     9,841,801
                                                                                             ------------  ------------
CURRENT LIABILITIES
  Creditors and borrowings....................................................          11     2,230,026     3,042,545
  Provisions..................................................................          12     1,586,870       802,176
                                                                                             ------------  ------------
TOTAL CURRENT LIABILITIES.....................................................                 3,816,896     3,844,721
                                                                                             ------------  ------------
NON-CURRENT LIABILITIES
  Creditors and borrowings....................................................          13       791,276     2,521,226
  Provisions..................................................................          14        97,216       169,943
                                                                                             ------------  ------------
TOTAL NON-CURRENT LIABILITIES.................................................                   888,492     2,691,169
                                                                                             ------------  ------------
TOTAL LIABILITIES.............................................................                 4,705,388     6,535,890
                                                                                             ------------  ------------
  NET ASSETS..................................................................                 3,338,933     3,305,911
                                                                                             ------------  ------------
                                                                                             ------------  ------------
SHAREHOLDERS' EQUITY
  Share capital...............................................................          15           212           212
  Reserves....................................................................          16     3,007,188     3,017,136
  Retained profits............................................................                   331,533       288,563
                                                                                             ------------  ------------
TOTAL SHAREHOLDERS' EQUITY....................................................                 3,338,933     3,305,911
                                                                                             ------------  ------------
                                                                                             ------------  ------------
</TABLE>
    
 
      The accompanying notes form an integral part of this balance sheet.
 
                                      F-27
<PAGE>
       ACCESS 24 SERVICE CORPORATION PTY LIMITED AND CONTROLLED ENTITIES
                     CONSOLIDATED PROFIT AND LOSS ACCOUNTS
 
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                   NOTE
                                                                                   -----                    TEN MONTHS
                                                                                                              ENDED
                                                                                                           DECEMBER 31,
                                                                                                               1995
                                                                                                           ------------
                                                                                                                A$
                                                                                              YEAR ENDED    (NOTE 22)
                                                                                             FEBRUARY 28,
                                                                                                 1995
                                                                                             ------------
                                                                                                  A$
<S>                                                                             <C>          <C>           <C>
Operating revenue.............................................................           2     12,726,187   12,208,051
                                                                                             ------------  ------------
                                                                                             ------------  ------------
Operating profit..............................................................           2      1,611,910      463,916
Income tax attributable to operating profit...................................           3        612,820      492,351
                                                                                             ------------  ------------
Operating profit/(loss) after income tax......................................                    999,090      (28,435)
Retained profits at the beginning of the period...............................                    118,101      331,533
Adjustment to retained profits at the beginning of the period re AASB 1028:
 Accounting for Employee Entitlements.........................................           1             --      (14,535)
                                                                                             ------------  ------------
Adjusted retained profits at the beginning of the financial period............                         --      316,998
                                                                                             ------------  ------------
Total available for appropriation.............................................                  1,117,191      288,563
Dividends provided for........................................................                    785,658           --
                                                                                             ------------  ------------
Retained profits at the end of the financial period...........................                    331,533      288,563
                                                                                             ------------  ------------
                                                                                             ------------  ------------
</TABLE>
    
 
 The accompanying notes form an integral part of this profit and loss account.
 
                                      F-28
<PAGE>
       ACCESS 24 SERVICE CORPORATION PTY LIMITED AND CONTROLLED ENTITIES
                      CONSOLIDATED STATEMENT OF CASH FLOWS
 
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                  NOTE
                                                                              ------------                 TEN MONTHS
                                                                                                              ENDED
                                                                                                          DECEMBER 31,
                                                                                                              1995
                                                                                                          -------------
                                                                                                               A$
                                                                                             YEAR ENDED     (NOTE 22)
                                                                                            FEBRUARY 28,
                                                                                                1995
                                                                                            ------------
                                                                                                 A$
<S>                                                                           <C>           <C>           <C>
Cash flows from operating activities
  Receipts from customers...................................................                  12,451,360     11,936,094
  Payments to suppliers and employees.......................................                  (9,938,953)   (10,749,686)
  Interest paid.............................................................                          --        (10,972)
  Interest received.........................................................                      87,747         82,708
  Advances to related parties...............................................                          --        (68,591)
  Repayment of advances to related parties..................................                      78,855             --
  Interest paid (leases)....................................................                     (70,192)      (128,958)
  Income taxes paid.........................................................                    (209,093)      (578,105)
                                                                                            ------------  -------------
  Net operating cash flows..................................................         21(b)     2,399,724        482,490
                                                                                            ------------  -------------
Cash flows from investing activities
  Cash paid for acquisition of property, plant and equipment................                    (684,091)    (1,510,622)
  Payments for investments..................................................                          --             --
  Proceeds from sale of fixed assets........................................                      54,187         60,079
  Acquisition of intangibles................................................                      (1,547)            --
                                                                                            ------------  -------------
  Net investing cash flows..................................................                    (631,451)    (1,450,543)
                                                                                            ------------  -------------
Cash flows from financing activities
  Proceeds from borrowings..................................................                          --      1,000,000
  Repayment of hire purchase and lease liabilities..........................                    (260,613)      (456,043)
  Advances to controlled entities...........................................                          --             --
  Repayment of advances to controlled entities..............................                          --             --
  Dividends paid............................................................                          --       (785,658)
                                                                                            ------------  -------------
Net financing cash flows....................................................                    (260,613)      (241,701)
                                                                                            ------------  -------------
Net increase/(decrease) in cash held........................................                   1,507,660     (1,209,754)
Cash at the beginning of the financial period...............................                     327,538      1,837,982
Exchange rate variations on foreign cash balances...........................                       2,784         (8,461)
                                                                                            ------------  -------------
Cash at the end of the financial period.....................................         21(a)     1,837,982        619,767
                                                                                            ------------  -------------
                                                                                            ------------  -------------
</TABLE>
    
 
 The accompanying notes form an integral part of this statement of cash flows.
 
                                      F-29
<PAGE>
       ACCESS 24 SERVICE CORPORATION PTY LIMITED AND CONTROLLED ENTITIES
                 NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
                      FOR THE YEAR ENDED FEBRUARY 28, 1995
                   AND THE TEN MONTHS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1995
 
NOTE 1.  STATEMENT OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES:
 
(a)  BASIS OF THE PREPARATION OF THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
 
    The   financial  statements  have  been  prepared  in  accordance  with  the
historical cost convention using the accounting policies described below and  do
not take account of changes in either the general purchasing power of the dollar
or in the prices of specific assets.
 
    The  carrying  amounts  of  all non-current  assets  are  reviewed  at least
annually  to  determine  whether  they  exceed  their  recoverable  amount.  The
recoverable  amounts of  all non-current assets  have been  determined using net
cash flows which have not been discounted to their present value.
 
    All amounts are in Australian dollars.
 
(b)  PRINCIPLES OF CONSOLIDATION
 
    The consolidated financial  statements include the  financial statements  of
the  parent entity, Access 24 Service Corporation Pty Limited and its controlled
entities. The term "Economic Entity" used throughout these financial  statements
means the parent entity and its controlled entities.
 
    Where  a controlled entity has been  acquired during the period, its results
are included in the consolidated result from the date of acquisition. Similarly,
where a controlled entity is sold, its results are included in the  consolidated
result until the date of disposal.
 
    All inter-entity balances and transactions have been eliminated.
 
(c)  OPERATING REVENUE
 
    Sales  revenue represents revenue  earned (net of  discounts and allowances)
from the sale of services. Other revenue includes interest income on short  term
deposits and gross proceeds from the sale of non-current assets.
 
(d)  PLANT AND EQUIPMENT
 
    (i)  ACQUISITION
 
    Items  of  plant  and equipment  are  recorded  at cost  and  depreciated as
outlined below.
 
    (ii)  DISPOSALS OF ASSETS
 
    The gain  or loss  on disposal  of assets  is calculated  as the  difference
between  the  carrying amount  of  the asset  at the  time  of disposal  and the
proceeds on disposal, and is  included in the result  of the economic entity  in
the period of disposal.
 
    (iii)  DEPRECIATION AND AMORTIZATION
 
    Items    of   plant    and   equipment,   and    leasehold   property,   are
depreciated/amortized over their  estimated useful  lives ranging from  3 to  30
years.  The straight line  method is used  except in the  case of one controlled
entity where the reducing  balance method is  used in respect  of all plant  and
equipment.
 
    (iv)  LEASED PLANT AND EQUIPMENT
 
    Assets of the economic entity acquired under finance leases are capitalized.
The  initial amount  of the leased  asset and corresponding  lease liability are
recorded at  the present  value of  minimum lease  payments. Leased  assets  are
amortized  over  the life  of  the relevant  lease or,  where  it is  likely the
economic entity will obtain ownership of  the asset on expiration of the  lease,
the  expected useful  life of  the asset. Lease  liabilities are  reduced by the
principal component of lease payments. The interest component is charged against
operating profit.
 
                                      F-30
<PAGE>
       ACCESS 24 SERVICE CORPORATION PTY LIMITED AND CONTROLLED ENTITIES
                 NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
                      FOR THE YEAR ENDED FEBRUARY 28, 1995
                   AND THE TEN MONTHS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1995
                                  (CONTINUED)
 
NOTE 1.  STATEMENT OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES: (CONTINUED)
    Operating leases are not capitalized and rental payments are charged against
operating profit in the period in which they are incurred.
 
(e)  INCOME TAX
 
    The economic entity adopts the liability method of tax effect accounting.
 
    Income tax expense is calculated on operating profit adjusted for  permanent
differences  between taxable  and accounting  income. The  tax effect  of timing
differences which arise from items being brought to account in different periods
for income tax and accounting purposes, is carried forward in the balance  sheet
as a future income tax benefit or a deferred tax liability.
 
    Future  income  tax benefits  relating  to tax  losses  are only  brought to
account when their realization is virtually certain.
 
(f)  FOREIGN CURRENCY
 
    TRANSACTIONS
 
    Foreign currency transactions are translated  to Australian currency at  the
rates  of exchange ruling  at the dates of  the transactions. Amounts receivable
and payable in foreign currencies at balance date are translated at the rates of
exchange ruling on that date.
 
    TRANSLATION OF FINANCIAL STATEMENTS OF OVERSEAS OPERATIONS
 
    All overseas operations  are deemed self-sustaining  as each is  financially
and  operationally independent of Access 24 Service Corporation Pty Limited. The
financial statements of  overseas operations  are translated  using the  current
rate  method  and any  exchange differences  are taken  directly to  the foreign
currency translation reserve.
 
(g)  PROVISIONS
 
    EMPLOYEE ENTITLEMENTS
 
    Provision has been made in the financial statements for benefits accruing to
employees in relation to  such matters as annual  leave and long service  leave.
Long  service  leave  provisions  are calculated  based  on  the  probability of
employee's service continuity, even  though in some cases  such amounts are  not
currently vesting.
 
    From  this  financial year,  all on-costs,  including payroll  tax, workers'
compensation premiums and fringe benefits tax are included in the  determination
of  provisions for  annual leave and  long service leave.  Provisions for annual
leave and current long  service leave are measured  at their nominal value.  Non
current  long service  leave is measured  at its present  value where materially
different from  the nominal  value. All  provision where  previously measure  at
their  nominal value.  This represents  a change in  accounting policy  so as to
satisfy the requirements of AASB 1028--Accounting for Employee Entitlements.
 
   
    The impact of this  change in policy  for the economic  entity is to  reduce
opening retained profits by A$14,535.
    
 
    DOUBTFUL DEBTS
 
    The  collectibility of debts is assessed  at year end and specific provision
is made for any doubtful accounts.
 
                                      F-31
<PAGE>
       ACCESS 24 SERVICE CORPORATION PTY LIMITED AND CONTROLLED ENTITIES
                 NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
                      FOR THE YEAR ENDED FEBRUARY 28, 1995
                   AND THE TEN MONTHS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1995
                                  (CONTINUED)
 
NOTE 1.  STATEMENT OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES: (CONTINUED)
(h)  SUPERANNUATION FUND
 
    Contributions to a defined contribution superannuation fund are expensed  in
the  year  they are  paid  or become  payable. No  amount  is recognized  in the
accounts or group accounts in respect of  the net surplus or deficiency of  each
plan.
 
(i)  INTANGIBLES
 
    Goodwill  represents the excess of the  purchase consideration over the fair
value of  identifiable net  assets acquired  at  the time  of acquisition  of  a
business or shares in a controlled entity.
 
    Goodwill  is amortized  by the straight  line method over  the period during
which benefits are expected to be received. This is taken as being 10 years.
 
(j)  COMPARATIVE BALANCES
 
    Certain prior year  comparatives have  been amended to  accord with  current
year disclosure.
 
                                      F-32
<PAGE>
       ACCESS 24 SERVICE CORPORATION PTY LIMITED AND CONTROLLED ENTITIES
                 NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
                      FOR THE YEAR ENDED FEBRUARY 28, 1995
                   AND THE TEN MONTHS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1995
                                  (CONTINUED)
 
NOTE 2.  REVENUE AND EXPENSES:
 
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                  TEN MONTHS
                                                                    YEAR ENDED      ENDED
                                                                   FEBRUARY 28,  DECEMBER 31,
                                                                       1995          1995
                                                                   ------------  ------------
<S>                                                                <C>           <C>
                                                                        A$            A$
Operating revenues include the following:
  Fees received..................................................    12,316,889   11,783,312
  Interest from:
    --other persons..............................................        87,747       84,986
  Other revenue..................................................       321,551      339,753
                                                                   ------------  ------------
Total operating revenue..........................................    12,726,187   12,208,051
                                                                   ------------  ------------
                                                                   ------------  ------------
EXPENSES:
Deductions from (additions to) operating revenue in arriving at
 operating profit include the following:
Abnormal item:
  Write off of non recoverable loan..............................            --      188,952
                                                                   ------------  ------------
Other expenses:
  Provision for doubtful debts...................................        35,255      (42,135)
  Provision for annual leave.....................................       389,223      408,906
  Provision for long service leave...............................        25,230       16,203
  Rental expense on operating leases.............................       216,506      466,083
  Depreciation of plant and equipment............................       346,420      547,589
  Interest paid
    --Other persons..............................................            --       19,203
    --Finance leases and hire purchases..........................        70,192      130,408
  Amortization of goodwill.......................................       237,668      210,048
  Amortization of finance lease assets...........................       203,335      196,086
  Foreign exchange (gains)/losses................................       (36,841)       9,128
  (Gain)/loss on disposal of fixed assets (a)....................        71,733      (28,929)
                                                                   ------------  ------------
                                                                   ------------  ------------
  (a) Proceeds on the disposal of fixed assets were:.............        54,187       60,079
                                                                   ------------  ------------
                                                                   ------------  ------------
</TABLE>
    
 
                                      F-33
<PAGE>
       ACCESS 24 SERVICE CORPORATION PTY LIMITED AND CONTROLLED ENTITIES
                 NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
                      FOR THE YEAR ENDED FEBRUARY 28, 1995
                   AND THE TEN MONTHS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1995
                                  (CONTINUED)
 
NOTE 3.  INCOME TAX:
 
    (a)  The difference  between income  tax expense  provided in  the financial
statements and the prima facie income tax expense is reconciled as follows.
 
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                                       TEN MONTHS
                                                                                         YEAR ENDED      ENDED
                                                                                        FEBRUARY 28,  DECEMBER 31,
                                                                                            1995          1995
                                                                                        ------------  ------------
<S>                                                                                     <C>           <C>
                                                                                             A$            A$
Operating profit......................................................................    1,611,910       463,916
                                                                                        ------------  ------------
                                                                                        ------------  ------------
Prima facie tax expense thereon at 36% (February 28, 1995: 33%).......................      531,930       167,010
Increase/ (decrease) in prima facie tax expense arising from:
  Amortization of goodwill............................................................       78,430        57,830
  Entertaining........................................................................        2,724         3,833
  Fringe benefit tax..................................................................        2,141            --
  Write-off of non-recoverable loan...................................................           --        68,023
  Other non-deductible items..........................................................       (3,667)       21,585
  Effects of lower rates of tax on overseas income....................................           --        (5,537)
  Prior year adjustment...............................................................        1,262        10,708
  Tax losses not brought to account...................................................           --       168,899
                                                                                        ------------  ------------
Total income tax attributable to operating profit.....................................      612,820       492,351
                                                                                        ------------  ------------
                                                                                        ------------  ------------
Total income tax expense comprises movements in:
  Provision for income tax............................................................      656,627       445,758
  Provision for deferred income tax...................................................       47,045        52,246
  Future income tax benefit...........................................................      (90,852)       (5,653)
                                                                                        ------------  ------------
                                                                                            612,820       492,351
                                                                                        ------------  ------------
                                                                                        ------------  ------------
</TABLE>
    
 
    (b) As at 31 December 1995,  there are companies within the economic  entity
which  have income tax losses available  to offset against future years' taxable
income. The  benefit  of  these  losses  has not  been  brought  to  account  as
realization is not virtually certain.
 
                                      F-34
<PAGE>
       ACCESS 24 SERVICE CORPORATION PTY LIMITED AND CONTROLLED ENTITIES
                 NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
                      FOR THE YEAR ENDED FEBRUARY 28, 1995
                   AND THE TEN MONTHS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1995
                                  (CONTINUED)
 
NOTE 4.  PARENT ENTITY INVESTMENT IN CONTROLLED ENTITIES AND CONTRIBUTION TO
         CONSOLIDATED RESULT:
 
    (a) Particulars in relation to controlled entities
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                       % OF SHARES HELD
                              -----------------------------------
                                FEBRUARY 28,                                                             CONTRIBUTION
                                    1995                                                                      TO
                              ----------------                           BOOK VALUE OF INVESTMENT        CONSOLIDATED
                                                                   ------------------------------------  PROFIT/(LOSS)
                                                DECEMBER 31 1995   FEBRUARY 28, 1995  DECEMBER 31 1995   -------------
                                                -----------------  -----------------  -----------------
                                                    (NOTE 22)             A$                 A$          FEBRUARY 28,
                                                                                          (NOTE 22)          1995
                                                                                                         -------------
                                                                                                              A$
<S>                           <C>               <C>                <C>                <C>                <C>
Access 24 Service
 Corporation Pty Limited....            --                --                  --                 --          852,890
Access 24 (Service
 Corporation) Limited
 (incorporated in New
 Zealand)...................           100%              100%                 83                 83          146,200
Controlled entities acquired
 during the period:
  Support 24 Pty Limited
   (incorporated in
   Australia) (iii)(vi).....            --                --                  --                 --               --
  Access 24 Limited
   (incorporated in the
   United Kingdom)
   (iii)(iv)................            --               100%                 --                  4               --
  High Performance
   Healthcare Pty Limited
   (incorporated in
   Australia) (v)...........            --               100%                 --                 99               --
                                                                             ---                ---      -------------
                                                                              83                186          999,090
                                                                             ---                ---      -------------
                                                                             ---                ---      -------------
 
<CAPTION>
 
                               DECEMBER 31
                              -------------
 
                                   A$
 
<S>                           <C>
Access 24 Service
 Corporation Pty Limited....      343,285
Access 24 (Service
 Corporation) Limited
 (incorporated in New
 Zealand)...................       99,021
Controlled entities acquired
 during the period:
  Support 24 Pty Limited
   (incorporated in
   Australia) (iii)(vi).....           --
  Access 24 Limited
   (incorporated in the
   United Kingdom)
   (iii)(iv)................     (440,535)
  High Performance
   Healthcare Pty Limited
   (incorporated in
   Australia) (v)...........      (30,206)
                              -------------
                                  (28,435)
                              -------------
                              -------------
</TABLE>
    
 
- ------------
(i)  All entities operate solely in their place of incorporation.
 
(ii) The  financial year ends of each controlled  entity are the same as that of
     the parent entity.
 
(iii)This company  is  not  audited  by  the  parent  entity  auditor  or  their
     affiliates.
 
   
(iv) The  parent entity acquired this company for cash consideration of A$4. The
     company did not trade prior to the acquisition by the parent entity.
    
 
   
(v)  The parent entity acquired this company for cash consideration of A$99. The
     company did not trade prior to the acquisition by the parent entity.
    
 
   
(vi) A 51% shareholding in  this company was acquired  for nil consideration  on
     July  1, 1995 and was  sold for A$1 consideration  on December 22, 1995. At
     the date of  acquisition, the net  deficiency of Support  24 was  A$145,983
     made  up  of the  following  assets and  liabilities  by major  class: Cash
     balances A$2,089, Receivables A$10,522, Fixed Assets A$10,875 and Creditors
     & Borrowings  A$(169,469). At  the  date of  disposal,  the net  assets  of
     Support  24  were  A$892 and  were  made  up of:  Receivables  A$59,967 and
     Creditors & Borrowings A$(59,075).  A loss of  A$42,078 had been  generated
     from  trading activities  during the  period the  company was  a controlled
     entity and Access  24 Service  Corporation Pty  Limited forgave  a loan  of
     A$188,952  resulting  in  an operating  profit  of A$146,874  for  the same
     period.
    
 
                                      F-35
<PAGE>
       ACCESS 24 SERVICE CORPORATION PTY LIMITED AND CONTROLLED ENTITIES
                 NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
                      FOR THE YEAR ENDED FEBRUARY 28, 1995
                   AND THE TEN MONTHS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1995
                                  (CONTINUED)
 
NOTE 4.  PARENT ENTITY INVESTMENT IN CONTROLLED ENTITIES AND CONTRIBUTION TO
         CONSOLIDATED RESULT: (CONTINUED)
    (b) Segment information
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                          TEN MONTHS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1995
                                               ---------------------------------------------------------
                                               EXTERNAL   INTERGROUP     TOTAL      SEGMENT     SEGMENT
                                                REVENUE     REVENUE     REVENUE     RESULT      ASSETS
                                               ---------  -----------  ---------  -----------  ---------
                                                  A$          A$          A$          A$          A$
<S>                                            <C>        <C>          <C>        <C>          <C>
Australia....................................  10,085,045    251,754   10,336,799    313,079   8,080,913
New Zealand..................................  1,645,502          --   1,645,502      99,021   1,203,597
United Kingdom...............................    477,504          --     477,504    (438,957)  2,170,657
Eliminations.................................         --    (251,754)   (251,754)     (1,578)  (1,613,366)
                                               ---------  -----------  ---------  -----------  ---------
Consolidated.................................  12,208,051         --   12,208,051    (28,435)  9,841,801
                                               ---------  -----------  ---------  -----------  ---------
                                               ---------  -----------  ---------  -----------  ---------
 
<CAPTION>
 
                                                             YEAR ENDED FEBRUARY 28, 1995
                                               ---------------------------------------------------------
                                               EXTERNAL   INTERGROUP     TOTAL      SEGMENT     SEGMENT
                                                REVENUE     REVENUE     REVENUE     RESULT      ASSETS
                                               ---------  -----------  ---------  -----------  ---------
                                                  A$          A$          A$          A$          A$
<S>                                            <C>        <C>          <C>        <C>          <C>
Australia....................................  11,228,111    169,891   11,398,002    852,890   7,440,308
New Zealand..................................  1,498,076          --   1,498,076     146,200   1,137,691
Eliminations.................................         --    (169,891)   (169,891)         --    (533,678)
                                               ---------  -----------  ---------  -----------  ---------
Consolidated.................................  12,726,187         --   12,726,187    999,090   8,044,321
                                               ---------  -----------  ---------  -----------  ---------
                                               ---------  -----------  ---------  -----------  ---------
</TABLE>
    
 
    The  group  derives  income  by   providing  emergency  medical  and   trade
assistance.
 
    (c) Ultimate Parent Entity
 
    The  ultimate parent entity of Access  24 Service Corporation Pty Limited is
the Royal Automobile Club of Victoria (RACV) Limited, a company incorporated  in
the state of Victoria.
 
NOTE 5.  CASH:
 
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                    FEBRUARY 28,  DECEMBER 31,
                                                                        1995          1995
                                                                    ------------  ------------
                                                                         A$            A$
                                                                                   (NOTE 22)
<S>                                                                 <C>           <C>
Cash at bank and in hand..........................................    1,797,191       807,875
Cash held in trust................................................       40,791         8,345
                                                                    ------------  ------------
                                                                      1,837,982       816,220
                                                                    ------------  ------------
                                                                    ------------  ------------
</TABLE>
    
 
                                      F-36
<PAGE>
       ACCESS 24 SERVICE CORPORATION PTY LIMITED AND CONTROLLED ENTITIES
                 NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
                      FOR THE YEAR ENDED FEBRUARY 28, 1995
                   AND THE TEN MONTHS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1995
                                  (CONTINUED)
 
NOTE 6.  RECEIVABLES:
 
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                   FEBRUARY 28,  DECEMBER 31,
                                                                       1995          1995
                                                                   ------------  ------------
                                                                        A$            A$
                                                                                  (NOTE 22)
<S>                                                                <C>           <C>
Trade debtors....................................................       801,326    1,288,033
Provision for doubtful trade debtors.............................       (43,665)      (1,530)
                                                                   ------------  ------------
                                                                        757,661    1,286,503
Trade balances receivable from related parties...................       117,882      186,474
Amounts receivable from controlled entities......................            --           --
Accrued fees.....................................................       462,059      499,624
Other debtors....................................................         3,376        3,440
                                                                   ------------  ------------
                                                                      1,340,978    1,976,041
                                                                   ------------  ------------
                                                                   ------------  ------------
</TABLE>
    
 
NOTE 7.  OTHER CURRENT ASSETS:
 
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                    FEBRUARY 28,  DECEMBER 31,
                                                                        1995          1995
                                                                    ------------  ------------
                                                                         A$            A$
                                                                                   (NOTE 22)
<S>                                                                 <C>           <C>
Other assets......................................................       96,348       121,621
Prepayments.......................................................       69,084       279,552
                                                                    ------------  ------------
                                                                        165,432       401,173
                                                                    ------------  ------------
                                                                    ------------  ------------
</TABLE>
    
 
NOTE 8.  PLANT AND EQUIPMENT:
 
    Plant and equipment and leasehold improvements:
 
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                    FEBRUARY 28,  DECEMBER 31,
                                                                        1995          1995
                                                                    ------------  ------------
                                                                         A$            A$
                                                                                   (NOTE 22)
 
<S>                                                                 <C>           <C>
At cost (a).......................................................    2,124,874     4,285,965
Less accumulated depreciation.....................................     (375,932)     (924,807)
                                                                    ------------  ------------
                                                                      1,748,942     3,361,158
                                                                    ------------  ------------
Leased plant and equipment:
  Capitalized value of leased plant and equipment.................      667,753     1,236,861
  Less accumulated amortization...................................     (246,645)     (380,738)
                                                                    ------------  ------------
                                                                        421,108       856,123
                                                                    ------------  ------------
                                                                      2,170,050     4,217,281
                                                                    ------------  ------------
                                                                    ------------  ------------
</TABLE>
    
 
   
(a)  A charge has been  registered by a finance  company, over assets under hire
    purchase of a controlled entity, to the value of A$83,584.
    
 
                                      F-37
<PAGE>
       ACCESS 24 SERVICE CORPORATION PTY LIMITED AND CONTROLLED ENTITIES
                 NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
                      FOR THE YEAR ENDED FEBRUARY 28, 1995
                   AND THE TEN MONTHS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1995
                                  (CONTINUED)
 
NOTE 9.  INTANGIBLES:
 
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                    FEBRUARY 28,  DECEMBER 31,
                                                                        1995          1995
                                                                    ------------  ------------
                                                                         A$            A$
                                                                                   (NOTE 22)
<S>                                                                 <C>           <C>
Goodwill at cost..................................................    2,443,866     2,455,393
Accumulated amortization..........................................     (280,504)     (491,033)
                                                                    ------------  ------------
                                                                      2,163,362     1,964,360
                                                                    ------------  ------------
                                                                    ------------  ------------
</TABLE>
    
 
NOTE 10.  OTHER NON-CURRENT ASSETS:
 
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                    FEBRUARY 28,  DECEMBER 31,
                                                                        1995          1995
                                                                    ------------  ------------
                                                                         A$            A$
                                                                                   (NOTE 22)
<S>                                                                 <C>           <C>
Investments
  --Controlled entities (Note 4(a))...............................           --            --
Security deposits.................................................       82,895       110,770
Future income tax benefit.........................................      276,523       270,871
Amount receivable from a controlled entity........................           --            --
Other non-current assets..........................................        7,099        85,085
                                                                    ------------  ------------
                                                                        366,517       466,726
                                                                    ------------  ------------
                                                                    ------------  ------------
</TABLE>
    
 
NOTE 11.  CREDITORS AND BORROWINGS (CURRENT):
 
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                    FEBRUARY 28,  DECEMBER 31,
                                                                        1995          1995
                                                                    ------------  ------------
                                                                         A$            A$
                                                                                   (NOTE 22)
<S>                                                                 <C>           <C>
Bank overdraft....................................................           --       196,453
Trade creditors...................................................      294,785       357,306
Sundry creditors..................................................      928,507       948,329
Lease and hire purchase liabilities (Note 18(a))..................      607,080       821,968
Prepaid fees and claims:
  --Trade.........................................................      322,548       710,527
  --Trust accounts................................................       41,316         7,962
Amounts due to related parties....................................       35,790            --
                                                                    ------------  ------------
                                                                      2,230,026     3,042,545
                                                                    ------------  ------------
                                                                    ------------  ------------
</TABLE>
    
 
NOTE 12.  PROVISIONS (CURRENT):
 
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                    FEBRUARY 28,  DECEMBER 31,
                                                                        1995          1995
                                                                    ------------  ------------
                                                                         A$            A$
                                                                                   (NOTE 22)
<S>                                                                 <C>           <C>
Dividend..........................................................      785,657            --
Taxation..........................................................      567,220       423,680
Employee entitlements.............................................      233,993       378,496
                                                                    ------------  ------------
                                                                      1,586,870       802,176
                                                                    ------------  ------------
                                                                    ------------  ------------
</TABLE>
    
 
                                      F-38
<PAGE>
       ACCESS 24 SERVICE CORPORATION PTY LIMITED AND CONTROLLED ENTITIES
                 NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
                      FOR THE YEAR ENDED FEBRUARY 28, 1995
                   AND THE TEN MONTHS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1995
                                  (CONTINUED)
 
NOTE 13.  CREDITORS AND BORROWINGS (NON-CURRENT):
 
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                    FEBRUARY 28,  DECEMBER 31,
                                                                        1995          1995
                                                                    ------------  ------------
                                                                         A$            A$
                                                                                   (NOTE 22)
<S>                                                                 <C>           <C>
Bank Loan (a).....................................................           --     1,000,000
Lease and hire purchase liabilities (Note 18(a))..................      791,276     1,521,226
                                                                    ------------  ------------
                                                                        791,276     2,521,226
                                                                    ------------  ------------
                                                                    ------------  ------------
</TABLE>
    
 
   
    (a) The bank loan is secured by a registered mortgage debenture over all the
assets/undertakings of the parent entity and by a letter of support to the value
of A$3.77 million from the ultimate parent entity, the RACV.
    
 
NOTE 14.  PROVISIONS (NON-CURRENT):
 
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                   FEBRUARY 28,  DECEMBER 31,
                                                                       1995          1995
                                                                   ------------  ------------
                                                                        A$            A$
                                                                                  (NOTE 22)
<S>                                                                <C>           <C>
Deferred income tax..............................................        59,099      111,345
Employee entitlements............................................        38,117       58,598
                                                                   ------------  ------------
                                                                         97,216      169,943
                                                                   ------------  ------------
                                                                   ------------  ------------
</TABLE>
    
 
NOTE 15.  SHARE CAPITAL:
 
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                 FEBRUARY 28,   DECEMBER 31,
                                                                     1995           1995
                                                                 -------------  -------------
                                                                      A$             A$
                                                                                  (NOTE 22)
<S>                                                              <C>            <C>
Authorized capital:
  --10,000,000 ordinary shares of A$1 each.....................     10,000,000     10,000,000
                                                                 -------------  -------------
Issued and fully paid:
  --212 ordinary shares of A$1 each............................            212            212
                                                                 -------------  -------------
                                                                 -------------  -------------
</TABLE>
    
 
NOTE 16.  RESERVES:
 
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                   FEBRUARY 28,  DECEMBER 31,
                                                                       1995          1995
                                                                   ------------  ------------
                                                                        A$            A$
                                                                                  (NOTE 22)
<S>                                                                <C>           <C>
Share premium account............................................     2,999,900    2,999,900
Foreign currency translation.....................................         7,288       17,236
                                                                   ------------  ------------
                                                                      3,007,188    3,017,136
                                                                   ------------  ------------
                                                                   ------------  ------------
Foreign currency translation
  --Balance at beginning of year.................................          (273)       7,288
  --Gain on translation of overseas controlled entities..........         7,561        9,948
                                                                   ------------  ------------
  --Balance at end of period.....................................         7,288       17,236
                                                                   ------------  ------------
                                                                   ------------  ------------
</TABLE>
    
 
                                      F-39
<PAGE>
       ACCESS 24 SERVICE CORPORATION PTY LIMITED AND CONTROLLED ENTITIES
                 NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
                      FOR THE YEAR ENDED FEBRUARY 28, 1995
                   AND THE TEN MONTHS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1995
                                  (CONTINUED)
 
NOTE 17.  REMUNERATION OF AUDITORS:
 
    Amounts received or due and receivable by the auditors of the company for:
 
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                   FEBRUARY 28,  DECEMBER 31,
                                                                       1995          1995
                                                                   ------------  ------------
                                                                        A$            A$
                                                                                  (NOTE 22)
<S>                                                                <C>           <C>
- --Audit services.................................................        20,418       43,363
- --Other services.................................................        20,250           --
                                                                   ------------  ------------
                                                                         40,668       43,363
                                                                   ------------  ------------
                                                                   ------------  ------------
</TABLE>
    
 
NOTE 18.  COMMITMENTS:
 
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                   FEBRUARY 28,  DECEMBER 31,
                                                                       1995          1995
                                                                   ------------  ------------
                                                                        A$            A$
                                                                                  (NOTE 22)
<S>                                                                <C>           <C>
(a) Finance lease and hire purchase expenditure contracted for is
 payable as follows:
  Not later than one year........................................       623,191      852,954
  Later than one year and not later than two years...............       423,010      727,574
  Later than two years and not later than five years.............       463,396      771,673
                                                                   ------------  ------------
                                                                      1,509,597    2,352,201
Deduct future finance charges (i)................................      (111,241)      (9,007)
                                                                   ------------  ------------
Net lease and hire purchase liability............................     1,398,356    2,343,194
                                                                   ------------  ------------
                                                                   ------------  ------------
Reconciled to:
  Current liability (Note 11)....................................       607,080      821,968
  Non-current liability (Note 13)................................       791,276    1,521,226
                                                                   ------------  ------------
                                                                      1,398,356    2,343,194
                                                                   ------------  ------------
                                                                   ------------  ------------
</TABLE>
    
 
    (i) In the current period, assets under hire purchase have been recorded  on
a  gross basis, resulting in the recognition of a liability and equivalent asset
equal to the amount  of future interest payable.  The finance charges  disclosed
for  the  current year  relate solely  to  finance leases  while the  prior year
comparatives include interest on assets under hire purchase.
 
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                   FEBRUARY 28,  DECEMBER 31,
                                                                       1995          1995
                                                                   ------------  ------------
                                                                        A$            A$
                                                                                  (NOTE 22)
<S>                                                                <C>           <C>
b) Operating leases
  expenditure contracted for is payable as follows:
  Not later than one year........................................       238,429      302,129
  Later than one year and not later than two years...............       243,739      320,008
  Later than two year and not later than five years..............       517,833      361,031
                                                                   ------------  ------------
                                                                      1,000,001      983,168
                                                                   ------------  ------------
                                                                   ------------  ------------
</TABLE>
    
 
    The above operating lease commitments  include amounts for rental  operating
leases which are gross of amounts received for subleases of various premises.
 
                                      F-40
<PAGE>
       ACCESS 24 SERVICE CORPORATION PTY LIMITED AND CONTROLLED ENTITIES
                 NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
                      FOR THE YEAR ENDED FEBRUARY 28, 1995
                   AND THE TEN MONTHS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1995
                                  (CONTINUED)
 
NOTE 19.  REMUNERATION OF DIRECTORS:
    The  number of directors of  the parent entity who  received, or were due to
receive, remuneration  (including  brokerage, commissions,  bonuses,  retirement
payments and salaries, but excluding prescribed benefits) directly or indirectly
from  the company or any related body corporate, as shown in the following bands
were:
 
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                             PARENT ENTITY
                                                                                       --------------------------
                                                                                       FEBRUARY 28,  DECEMBER 31,
                                                                                           1995          1995
                                                                                       ------------  ------------
<S>                                                                                    <C>           <C>
A$     0 - A$  9,999.................................................................             2           --
   20,000 -    29,999................................................................            --            1
   50,000 -    59,999................................................................            --            1
  110,000 -   119,999................................................................            --            1
  210,000 -   219,999................................................................            --            2
  250,000 -   259,999................................................................             2           --
  260,000 -   269,999................................................................             1           --
  270,000 -   279,999................................................................            --            1
 
The aggregate remuneration of the directors referred to in the above bands was:        A$   776,821   A$ 904,589
                                                                                       ------------  ------------
                                                                                       ------------  ------------
</TABLE>
    
 
   
    The total of all remuneration received,  or due and receivable, directly  or
indirectly,  from the respective  corporations of which they  are a director, or
any related body  corporate, by  all the directors  of each  corporation in  the
economic  entity  of  December 31,  1995  and  February 28,  1995  A$904,589 and
A$839,301, respectively.
    
 
   
<TABLE>
<S>                                                                   <C>         <C>
Amounts paid to or on behalf of directors of the company in respect
 of retirement benefits and superannuation contributions were:        A$  67,043   A$ 53,071
                                                                      ----------  -----------
                                                                      ----------  -----------
</TABLE>
    
 
NOTE 20.  RELATED PARTY DISCLOSURES:
 
    (a) The directors of  Access 24 Service Corporation  Pty Limited during  the
financial period were:
 
       Dr. John Eric Kendall
       Mr. Louis Thomas Carroll
       Mr. Nigel Alexander Dick
       Mr. John Norman Isaac
       Mr. Keith William Blyth (resigned August 1, 1995)
       Mr. Edmund Christopher Johnson (appointed September 8, 1995)
 
                                      F-41
<PAGE>
       ACCESS 24 SERVICE CORPORATION PTY LIMITED AND CONTROLLED ENTITIES
                 NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
                      FOR THE YEAR ENDED FEBRUARY 28, 1995
                   AND THE TEN MONTHS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1995
                                  (CONTINUED)
 
NOTE 20.  RELATED PARTY DISCLOSURES: (CONTINUED)
    (b)  The following related party  transactions occurred during the financial
period:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                      NATURE OF RELATIONSHIP WITH ACCESS 24 SERVICE       OWNERSHIP
            IDENTITY OF RELATED PARTY                            CORPORATION PTY LIMITED                   INTEREST
- --------------------------------------------------  --------------------------------------------------  --------------
<S>                                                 <C>                                                 <C>
RACV Insurance Pty Limited                          Commonly controlled entity                                  --
Access 24 (Service Corporation) Limited (NZ)        Controlled entity                                          100%
Access 24 Limited (UK)                              Controlled entity                                          100%
High Performance Healthcare Pty Ltd                 Controlled entity                                          100%
Support 24 Pty Limited                              Controlled entity                                           51%
Auto 24 Pty Limited                                 Commonly controlled entity                                  --
Dataview Solutions Pty Limited                      Director related entity                                     --
</TABLE>
 
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                               TERMS & CONDITIONS OF EACH
IDENTITY OF RELATED PARTY           TYPE OF TRANSACTION                TRANSACTION
- -----------------------------  -----------------------------  -----------------------------     VOLUME        VOLUME
                                                                                             FEBRUARY 28,  DECEMBER 31,
                                                                                                 1995          1995
                                                                                             ------------  ------------
                                                                                                  A$            A$
                                                                                                            (NOTE 22)
<S>                            <C>                            <C>                            <C>           <C>
RACV Insurance Pty Limited     Sales                          Commercial terms and               693,039       779,467
                                                              conditions
 
Auto 24 Pty Limited            Staff services fees            Commercial terms and               448,863       877,093
                                                              conditions
 
                               Loans advanced                 Interest charged at                545,000       651,050
                                                              commercial bank rates
 
                               Loan repayments                                                   427,118       632,459
 
                               Interest receipts                                                      --        18,392
 
High Performance Healthcare    Loans advanced                 Nil interest                            --        34,933
 Pty Limited
 
Access 24 (Service             Management fees                Commercial terms and               169,891       251,754
 Corporation) Limited                                         conditions
 
                               Loans advanced                 Nil interest                       555,000            --
 
                               Loan repayments                                                    42,000       220,708
 
Support 24 Pty Limited         Loans advanced                 Nil interest                            --       313,952
 
                               Loan repayments                                                        --        75,000
 
Dataview Solutions Pty         Rent and related costs,        Commercial terms and               133,906       100,329
 Limited                       software development, and      conditions
                               accounts preparation
 
Access 24 Limited              Loan advance                   Nil interest                            --     1,256,206
</TABLE>
    
 
    (c) During  the current  financial period,  the parent  entity entered  into
certain contracts on behalf of a controlled entity. These contracts are for:
 
                                      F-42
<PAGE>
       ACCESS 24 SERVICE CORPORATION PTY LIMITED AND CONTROLLED ENTITIES
                 NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
                      FOR THE YEAR ENDED FEBRUARY 28, 1995
                   AND THE TEN MONTHS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1995
                                  (CONTINUED)
 
NOTE 20.  RELATED PARTY DISCLOSURES: (CONTINUED)
    - the provision of services to third parties,
 
    - operating lease for premises,
 
    - finance lease for equipment.
 
    The  assets,  liabilities,  revenues  and  expenses  associated  with  these
contracts have  been  reflected in  the  financial statements  of  the  economic
entity.  They have not been reflected in  the financial statements of the parent
entity as, in substance, the transactions relate solely to the operations of the
controlled entity.
 
    (d) Interests in the shares of  entities within the economic entity held  by
directors  of the  reporting entity and  their director related  entities, as at
December 31, 1995:
 
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                        ACCESS 24 SERVICE CORPORATION
                                                                   PTY LTD
                                                       --------------------------------
                                                       A$1 ORDINARY SHARES, FULLY PAID
                                                       --------------------------------
                                                        FEBRUARY 28,     DECEMBER 31,
                                                            1995             1995
                                                       ---------------  ---------------
<S>                                                    <C>              <C>
J. E. Kendall........................................            70               70
L. T. Carroll........................................            36               36
</TABLE>
    
 
NOTE 21.  CASH FLOWS:
 
    (a) Reconciliation of cash
 
    For the purposes of the statement of cash flows, cash includes cash on  hand
and  in banks and deposits at call,  net of outstanding bank overdrafts. Cash at
the end of  the financial  period as  shown in the  statement of  cash flows  is
reconciled to the related items in the balance sheet as follows:
 
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                   FEBRUARY 28,  DECEMBER 31,
                                                                       1995          1995
                                                                   ------------  ------------
                                                                        A$            A$
<S>                                                                <C>           <C>
Cash balance comprises:
  Cash at bank and on hand.......................................     1,797,191      807,875
  Cash held in trust.............................................        40,791        8,345
                                                                   ------------  ------------
                                                                      1,837,982      816,220
  Bank overdraft.................................................            --     (196,453)
                                                                   ------------  ------------
                                                                      1,837,982      619,767
                                                                   ------------  ------------
                                                                   ------------  ------------
</TABLE>
    
 
                                      F-43
<PAGE>
       ACCESS 24 SERVICE CORPORATION PTY LIMITED AND CONTROLLED ENTITIES
                 NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
                      FOR THE YEAR ENDED FEBRUARY 28, 1995
                   AND THE TEN MONTHS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1995
                                  (CONTINUED)
 
NOTE 21.  CASH FLOWS: (CONTINUED)
    (b) Reconciliation of operating profit/loss after tax to net cash flows from
operating activities:
 
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                    YEAR ENDED    TEN MONTHS
                                                                   FEBRUARY 28,     ENDED
                                                                       1995      DECEMBER 31,
                                                                   ------------      1995
                                                                        A$       ------------
                                                                                      A$
                                                                                  (NOTE 22)
<S>                                                                <C>           <C>
Operating profit/(loss) after tax................................       999,090      (28,435)
Depreciation and amortization:
  --Property, plant and equipment................................       346,420      547,589
  --Intangibles..................................................       237,668      210,048
  --Leased assets................................................       203,335      196,086
Gain/(loss) on sale of non-current assets........................        70,736      (28,929)
Bad and doubtful debts...........................................        35,255      (42,135)
 
Changes in assets and liabilities:
Trade receivables................................................      (128,396)    (486,706)
Other receivables................................................         2,662          (64)
Advances to related parties......................................            --      (68,592)
Intercompany trade receivables...................................            --           --
Security deposits................................................            --      (27,875)
Accrued fees.....................................................            --      (37,565)
Future income tax benefit........................................       (90,852)       5,652
Prepayments......................................................       (65,178)    (210,468)
Other assets.....................................................            --       (6,449)
Trade creditors..................................................         4,359       62,521
Sundry creditors and accruals....................................       225,978       19,822
Prepaid fees and claims:
  --Trade creditors..............................................            --      387,979
  --Trust accounts...............................................        (4,498)     (33,354)
Amounts due to related parties...................................            --      (35,790)
Repayment of advances to related parties.........................        78,855           --
Tax provision....................................................       447,534     (143,540)
Deferred income tax liability....................................        47,045       52,246
Adjustment to retained earnings (re AASB 1028: Accounting for
 Employee Entitlements)..........................................            --      (14,535)
Employee provisions..............................................       (10,289)     164,984
                                                                   ------------  ------------
Net cash flows from operating activities.........................     2,399,724      482,490
                                                                   ------------  ------------
                                                                   ------------  ------------
</TABLE>
    
 
    (c) Non-cash financing and investing activities:
 
   
    Purchases  of certain plant and equipment has been conducted through finance
leases and hire purchase  agreements. These transactions do  not result in  cash
outflows  until  the  lease payments  occur  as per  the  individual agreements.
Purchases of  property, plant  and equipment  financed in  this way  for the  10
months  ended December 31, 1995 totalled A$630,789 for Access 24 and A$1,304,100
for the economic entity (A$826,505 and A$787,960 for the year ended February 28,
1995). The total  value of  property, plant and  equipment under  lease and  the
resulting lease liabilities are disclosed in the financial statements.
    
 
                                      F-44
<PAGE>
       ACCESS 24 SERVICE CORPORATION PTY LIMITED AND CONTROLLED ENTITIES
                 NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
                      FOR THE YEAR ENDED FEBRUARY 28, 1995
                   AND THE TEN MONTHS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1995
                                  (CONTINUED)
 
NOTE 22.  FINANCIAL PERIOD:
    The  parent entity and  its controlled entities  have changed financial year
end from February  28 to December  31. As a  result, these financial  statements
cover  the  ten  month  period from  March  1  1995 to  December  31,  1995. The
comparative figures relate to the year ended February 28, 1995.
 
                                      F-45
<PAGE>
   
INSIDE BACK COVER OF PROSPECTUS
    
 
   
    The  inside  back  cover  is a  multicolor  graphic  layout  containing five
photographs  surrounding  the  words  "TELETECH  --  innovative  Customer   Care
solutions."  Starting  in  the  upper right  hand  corner,  the  photographs, in
counterclockwise order,  are  as  follows: a  black-and-white  photograph  of  a
TeleTech  representative with a computer terminal  in the background; a close-up
color photograph of the wall insert portion of a press-and-click telephone jack;
a black-and-white  photograph  of  a TeleTech  representative  with  a  computer
terminal in the background; a close-up cropped color photograph of portable flip
telephone  with  illuminated  buttons;  and a  color  photograph  of  a TeleTech
representative at  a  workstation  in  a  TeleTech  call  center.  The  TeleTech
corporate logo appears in the lower right-hand corner.
    
<PAGE>
OUTSIDE BACK COVER OF PROSPECTUS
 
                                     [LOGO]
<PAGE>
Information   contained  herein  is  subject   to  completion  or  amendment.  A
registration statement  relating to  these securities  has been  filed with  the
Securities  and Exchange  Commission. These securities  may not be  sold nor may
offers to buy be accepted prior  to the time the registration statement  becomes
effective.  This  prospectus  shall  not  constitute an  offer  to  sell  or the
solicitation of an offer to buy nor shall there be any sale of these  securities
in  any State in which such offer,  solicitation or sale would be unlawful prior
to registration or qualification under the securities laws of any such State.
<PAGE>
                [ALTERNATIVE PAGE FOR INTERNATIONAL PROSPECTUS]
PROSPECTUS (SUBJECT TO COMPLETION)
ISSUED            , 1996
 
   
                                6,220,000 SHARES
    
 
                                     [LOGO]
                                  COMMON STOCK
                                 --------------
 
   
 OF THE 6,220,000 SHARES  OF COMMON STOCK BEING  OFFERED, 4,000,000 SHARES  ARE
 BEING  SOLD BY THE COMPANY AND 2,220,000 SHARES ARE BEING SOLD BY THE SELLING
  STOCKHOLDERS NAMED HEREIN. THE COMPANY WILL NOT RECEIVE ANY OF THE PROCEEDS
   FROM THE SALE OF  SHARES BY THE SELLING  STOCKHOLDERS. SEE "PRINCIPAL  AND
   SELLING STOCKHOLDERS." OF THE SHARES BEING OFFERED, 1,244,000 SHARES ARE
     BEING OFFERED INITIALLY OUTSIDE OF THE UNITED STATES AND CANADA BY THE
     INTERNATIONAL  UNDERWRITERS  AND  4,976,000 SHARES  ARE  BEING OFFERED
     INITIALLY IN THE UNITED STATES AND CANADA BY THE U.S.  UNDERWRITERS.
       SEE  "UNDERWRITERS."  PRIOR TO  THE  OFFERING, THERE  HAS  BEEN NO
       PUBLIC MARKET FOR THE COMMON STOCK OF THE COMPANY. IT IS CURRENTLY
       ANTICIPATED THAT  THE  INITIAL  PUBLIC  OFFERING  PRICE  WILL  BE
        BETWEEN  $14.50 AND $16.50. SEE  "UNDERWRITERS" FOR A DISCUSSION
        OF THE  FACTORS CONSIDERED  IN DETERMINING  THE INITIAL  PUBLIC
         OFFERING PRICE. THE COMMON STOCK HAS BEEN APPROVED FOR LISTING
         ON    THE NASDAQ  NATIONAL  MARKET UNDER  THE  SYMBOL "TTEC,"
                    SUBJECT TO OFFICIAL NOTICE OF ISSUANCE.
    
                            ------------------------
 
   
        THIS OFFERING INVOLVES A HIGH DEGREE OF RISK. SEE "RISK FACTORS"
                          COMMENCING ON PAGE 5 HEREOF.
    
                               -----------------
 
 THESE SECURITIES HAVE NOT BEEN APPROVED  OR DISAPPROVED BY THE SECURITIES  AND
  EXCHANGE   COMMISSION  OR  ANY  STATE  SECURITIES  COMMISSION  NOR  HAS  THE
    SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE  COMMISSION OR ANY  STATE SECURITIES  COMMISSION
     PASSED   UPON  THE  ACCURACY  OR  ADEQUACY  OF  THIS  PROSPECTUS.  ANY
      REPRESENTATION   TO   THE   CONTRARY   IS   A   CRIMINAL    OFFENSE.
                              -------------------
 
                             PRICE $       A SHARE
                              -------------------
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                             UNDERWRITING                           PROCEEDS TO
                                            PRICE TO         DISCOUNTS AND       PROCEEDS TO          SELLING
                                             PUBLIC         COMMISSIONS (1)      COMPANY (2)       STOCKHOLDERS
                                        -----------------  -----------------  -----------------  -----------------
<S>                                     <C>                <C>                <C>                <C>
PER SHARE.............................          $                  $                  $                  $
TOTAL (3).............................          $                  $                  $                  $
</TABLE>
 
- ---------
    (1)  THE COMPANY AND  THE SELLING STOCKHOLDERS HAVE  AGREED TO INDEMNIFY THE
       UNDERWRITERS AGAINST CERTAIN LIABILITIES, INCLUDING LIABILITIES UNDER THE
       SECURITIES ACT OF 1933, AS AMENDED.
    (2)  BEFORE  DEDUCTING  EXPENSES  PAYABLE   BY  THE  COMPANY  ESTIMATED   AT
       $           . THE  COMPANY HAS AGREED TO PAY  THE EXPENSES OF THE SELLING
       STOCKHOLDERS, OTHER THAN UNDERWRITING DISCOUNTS AND COMMISSIONS.
   
    (3) ONE OF  THE SELLING STOCKHOLDERS  HAS GRANTED THE  U.S. UNDERWRITERS  AN
       OPTION,  EXERCISABLE WITHIN 30 DAYS OF THE DATE HEREOF, TO PURCHASE UP TO
       AN AGGREGATE OF 933,000 ADDITIONAL SHARES OF COMMON STOCK AT THE PRICE TO
       PUBLIC LESS UNDERWRITING  DISCOUNTS AND  COMMISSIONS FOR  THE PURPOSE  OF
       COVERING  OVER-ALLOTMENTS, IF ANY. IF THE U.S. UNDERWRITERS EXERCISE SUCH
       OPTION IN FULL,  THE TOTAL  PRICE TO PUBLIC,  UNDERWRITING DISCOUNTS  AND
       COMMISSIONS,  PROCEEDS TO  COMPANY AND  PROCEEDS TO  SELLING STOCKHOLDERS
       WILL BE $        , $       ,  $       , AND  $       , RESPECTIVELY.  SEE
       "UNDERWRITERS."
    
                            ------------------------
 
    THE  SHARES ARE OFFERED, SUBJECT TO PRIOR  SALE, WHEN, AS AND IF ACCEPTED BY
THE UNDERWRITERS NAMED HEREIN AND SUBJECT  TO APPROVAL OF CERTAIN LEGAL  MATTERS
BY  KATTEN MUCHIN  & ZAVIS,  COUNSEL FOR THE  UNDERWRITERS. IT  IS EXPECTED THAT
DELIVERY OF THE SHARES WILL BE MADE ON OR ABOUT         , 1996 AT THE OFFICE  OF
MORGAN  STANLEY & CO. INCORPORATED, NEW YORK, NEW YORK, AGAINST PAYMENT THEREFOR
IN IMMEDIATELY AVAILABLE FUNDS.
                              -------------------
 
MORGAN STANLEY & CO.
       INTERNATIONAL
                      ALEX. BROWN & SONS
   
                                           INCORPORATED
    
                                                               SMITH BARNEY INC.
<PAGE>
           , 1996
<PAGE>
                                    PART II
                     INFORMATION NOT REQUIRED IN PROSPECTUS
 
ITEM 13. OTHER EXPENSES OF ISSUANCE AND DISTRIBUTION.
 
    The  following are the  estimated expenses (other  than the SEC registration
fee, NASD filing  fee and  the Nasdaq National  Market application  fee) of  the
issuance  and distribution of the securities being registered, all of which will
be paid by TeleTech Holdings, Inc. ("TeleTech").
 
   
<TABLE>
<S>                                                               <C>
SEC registration fee............................................  $  42,000
Nasdaq National Market application fee..........................     50,000
Printing expenses...............................................     85,000
Fees and expenses of counsel....................................    200,000
Fees and expenses of accountants................................    200,000
Advisory fee to Equity Group Investments, Inc...................    500,000
Transfer agent and registrar fees...............................      7,500
Blue sky fees and expenses......................................     25,000
Miscellaneous...................................................    290,500
                                                                  ---------
    Total.......................................................  $1,400,000
                                                                  ---------
                                                                  ---------
</TABLE>
    
 
TeleTech will bear all of the foregoing expenses. In addition, TeleTech  intends
to  pay  all  expenses  of registration,  issuance  and  distribution, excluding
underwriters' discounts and commissions, with  respect to the shares being  sold
by the Selling Stockholders.
 
ITEM 14.  INDEMNIFICATION OF DIRECTORS AND OFFICERS.
 
    Under  Delaware law, a corporation may indemnify  any person who was or is a
party or is threatened to be made a party to an action (other than an action  by
or  in the  right of the  corporation) by reason  of such person's  service as a
director of  officer  of the  corporation,  or  such person's  service,  at  the
corporation's  request, as  a director,  officer, employee  or agent  of another
corporation or other  enterprise, against expenses  (including attorneys'  fees)
that  are  actually and  reasonably incurred  by  such person  ("Expenses"), and
judgments, fines and amounts paid in settlement that are actually and reasonably
incurred by such person,  in connection with the  defense or settlement of  such
action;  provided that  such person  acted in  good faith  and in  a manner such
person reasonably believed  to be in  or not opposed  to the corporation's  best
interests  and,  with  respect to  any  criminal  action or  proceeding,  had no
reasonable cause to believe  that such person's  conduct was unlawful.  Although
Delaware  law permits  a corporation to  indemnify any person  referred to above
against Expenses in connection with the defense or settlement of an action by or
in the right of the corporation, provided  that such person acted in good  faith
and  in a manner such person reasonably believed  to be in or not opposed to the
corporation's best  interests, if  such person  has been  judged liable  to  the
corporation,   indemnification  is  only  permitted   to  the  extent  that  the
adjudicating court (or  the court in  which the action  was brought)  determines
that,  despite  the  adjudication  of  liability,  such  person  is  entitled to
indemnity for such Expenses as the  court deems proper. The determination as  to
whether  a  person  seeking indemnification  has  met the  required  standard of
conduct is  to be  made (1)  by a  majority vote  of a  quorum of  disinterested
members  of the  board of directors,  or (2)  by independent legal  counsel in a
written opinion,  if  such a  quorum  does not  exist  or if  the  disinterested
directors  so direct, or (3) by the stockholders. The General Corporation Law of
Delaware also provides for mandatory  indemnification of any director,  officer,
employee or agent against Expenses to the extent such person has been successful
in  any proceeding covered by the  statute. In addition, the General Corporation
Law of  Delaware provides  for the  general authorization  of advancement  of  a
director's   or  officer's  litigation   expenses  in  lieu   of  requiring  the
authorization of such advancement by the  board of directors in specific  cases,
and  that indemnification  and advancement of  expenses provided  by the statute
shall not  be  deemed exclusive  of  any other  rights  to which  those  seeking
indemnification  or advancement  of expenses  may be  entitled under  any bylaw,
agreement or otherwise.
 
                                      II-1
<PAGE>
    TeleTech's Restated Certificate  of Incorporation and  By-laws provide  that
TeleTech  shall indemnify its directors, officers, employees and other agents to
the fullest extent permitted by Delaware law.
 
    TeleTech has also  entered into  agreements to indemnify  its directors  and
certain  of its  officers, in  addition to  the indemnification  provided for in
TeleTech's Restated Certificate of  Incorporation and By-laws. These  agreements
provide,  among other  things, that  TeleTech will  indemnify its  directors and
officers for  all direct  and indirect  expenses and  costs (including,  without
limitation,  all  reasonable attorneys'  fees  and related  disbursements, other
out-of-pocket costs and reasonable compensation  for time spent by such  persons
for  which they are not  otherwise compensated by TeleTech  or any third person)
and  liabilities  of  any  type  whatsoever  (including,  but  not  limited  to,
judgements,  fines and settlement fees) actually and reasonably incurred by such
person in  connection  with either  the  investigation, defense,  settlement  or
appeal of any threatened, pending or completed action, suit or other proceeding,
including  any action by or in the right of the corporation, arising out of such
person's services as a director, officer,  employee or other agent of  TeleTech,
any  subsidiary of  TeleTech or  any other  company or  enterprise to  which the
person provides  services at  the request  of TeleTech.  TeleTech believes  that
these provisions and agreements are necessary to attract and retain talented and
experienced directors and officers.
 
    TeleTech  maintains liability insurance for the benefit of its directors and
officers.
 
    Under the terms of the Underwriting Agreement, the Underwriters have  agreed
to  indemnify, under certain conditions, TeleTech, its directors, certain of its
officers and persons who control TeleTech  within the meaning of the  Securities
Act of 1933, as amended (the "Securities Act") against certain liabilities.
 
ITEM 15.  RECENT SALES OF UNREGISTERED SECURITIES.
 
   
    The  shares of common stock, par value  $.01 per share (the "Common Stock"),
issued in the transactions described below  reflect a five-for-one split of  the
Common  Stock to be  effected immediately prior  to the closing  of the Offering
contemplated by this Registration Statement.
    
 
    Pursuant to the terms  of, and as a  condition precedent to consummation  of
the   transactions  contemplated  by,  that  certain  Preferred  Stock  Purchase
Agreement dated as  of December  22, 1994  by and  among TeleTech  Teleservices,
Inc.,  a  Colorado  corporation ("TTS"),  TeleTech  Telecommunications,  Inc., a
California   corporation   ("TTC"),   TeleTech,   TeleTech   Investors   General
Partnership,  an Illinois general partnership  (the "Partnership"), and Essaness
Theaters Corporation, a Delaware corporation ("Essaness"), TeleTech, on  January
17,  1995, issued (a)  40,700,000 shares of  Common Stock to  Kenneth D. Tuchman
("Tuchman") in exchange for all of the issued and outstanding shares of  capital
stock of TTS and TTC then owned by Tuchman, and (b) and 1,705,000 and 155,000 of
its  convertible preferred stock, par value $6.45 per share ("Preferred Stock"),
to the Partnership and Essaness,  respectively, in exchange for $11,000,000  and
$1,000,000  respectively. Each share of Preferred Stock is convertible into five
shares of  Common  Stock,  subject to  adjustment  under  various  anti-dilution
provisions.
 
   
    Between  January 1, 1995 and  June 15, 1996, TeleTech  granted to certain of
its officers,  employees, consultants  and  independent contractors  options  to
acquire  an aggregate of 4,968,500  shares of Common Stock.  All of such options
were granted  pursuant to  option agreements  between TeleTech  and each  option
holder  and are subject to  the terms of the  TeleTech Holdings, Inc. Stock Plan
("Option Plan").
    
 
   
    On January 1, 1996, TeleTech acquired  all of the outstanding capital  stock
of  Access 24 Service Corporation Pty  Limited, a corporation incorporated under
the laws of New South Wales, Australia ("Access 24"). As consideration for  such
capital  stock, TeleTech  issued 712,520  shares of  Common Stock  to Bevero Pty
Limited and paid  $2.27 million  and issued 257,720  shares of  Common Stock  to
Access 24 Holdings Pty Limited.
    
 
    In  connection with the  acquisition of Access 24,  TeleTech entered into an
employment agreement dated as of  January 1, 1996 with  Dr. John E. Kendall,  as
Vice  President,  Strategic  Planning,  of  TeleTech.  In  connection  with  Dr.
Kendall's execution  of the  agreement, TeleTech  issued to  Dr. Kendall  38,000
shares  of Common Stock, which shares constitute restricted stock subject to the
terms of the  Option Plan and  vest proportionately over  the three year  period
commencing on the date of issuance.
 
                                      II-2
<PAGE>
    Also in connection with the acquisition of Access 24, TeleTech caused Access
24  to enter into an employment agreement dated as of January 1, 1996 with Louis
T. Carroll, as Managing Director of Access 24. In connection with Mr.  Carroll's
execution  of the  agreement, TeleTech  issued to  Mr. Carroll  38,000 shares of
Common Stock, which shares constitute restricted  stock subject to the terms  of
the  Option Plan and vest proportionately  over the three year period commencing
on the date of issuance.
 
   
    During 1996,  TeleTech has  granted  options to  acquire 237,500  shares  of
Common  Stock to its former and  current non-executive directors, at an exercise
price of $5.00  per share,  pursuant to  the TeleTech  Holdings, Inc.  Directors
Stock Option Plan (the "Directors Plan"). All of such options are subject to the
terms  of  the Directors  Plan and  were granted  pursuant to  option agreements
between TeleTech and each director who received such options.
    
 
    No underwriters were involved  in the transactions  described above. All  of
the  shares  and options  issued in  the foregoing  transactions were  issued or
granted by  the  Company  in  reliance upon  the  exemptions  from  registration
available  under  Section  4(2)  of  the  Securities  Act,  including  Rule 701,
Regulation D or Regulation S promulgated thereunder.
 
ITEM 16.  EXHIBITS AND FINANCIAL STATEMENT SCHEDULES.
 
    (a) Exhibits
       See attached Exhibit Index.
 
   
    (b) Financial Statement Schedules:
       See attached Financial Statement Schedule.
    
 
ITEM 17.  UNDERTAKINGS.
 
    (a)  The  undersigned  Registrant  hereby  undertakes  to  provide  to   the
Underwriters   at  the   closings  specified   in  the   Underwriting  Agreement
certificates in such denominations and registered  in such names as required  by
the Underwriters to permit prompt delivery to each purchaser.
 
    (b)  Insofar as indemnification for liabilities arising under the Securities
Act may  be permitted  to directors,  officers and  controlling persons  of  the
Registrant  pursuant to the  foregoing provisions, or  otherwise, the Registrant
has been advised that in the  opinion of the Securities and Exchange  Commission
such indemnification is against public policy as expressed in the Securities Act
and  is, therefore, unenforceable. In the event that a claim for indemnification
against such liabilities (other than the  payment by the Registrant of  expenses
incurred  or paid by a director, officer or controlling person of the Registrant
in the successful defense of any action, suit or proceeding) is asserted by such
director, officer or controlling person in connection with the securities  being
registered  hereunder, the Registrant will, unless in the opinion of its counsel
the matter  has been  settled by  controlling precedent,  submit to  a court  of
appropriate  jurisdiction  the question  whether such  indemnification by  it is
against public policy as expressed in the Securities Act and will be governed by
the final adjudication of such issue.
 
    (c) The  undersigned  Registrant  hereby undertakes  that  for  purposes  of
determining  any liability under the Securities Act, (i) the information omitted
from the form  of prospectus  filed as part  of this  Registration Statement  in
reliance  upon Rule  430A and  contained in  a form  of prospectus  filed by the
Registrant pursuant to Rule 424(b)(1) or (4) or 497(h) under the Securities  Act
shall  be deemed to be part of this Registration Statement as of the time it was
declared effective and (ii) each  post-effective amendment that contains a  form
of prospectus shall be deemed to be a new registration statement relating to the
securities  offered therein,  and the offering  of such securities  at that time
shall be deemed to be the initial bona fide offering thereof.
 
                                      II-3
<PAGE>
                                   SIGNATURES
 
   
    Pursuant  to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, the
registrant has duly caused this Amendment No. 2 to the Registration Statement to
be signed  on its  behalf  by the  undersigned,  thereunto duly  authorized,  in
Denver, Colorado on July 5, 1996.
    
 
                                          By:       /s/ KENNETH D. TUCHMAN
 
                                             -----------------------------------
                                                     Kenneth D. Tuchman
                                             CHAIRMAN OF THE BOARD OF DIRECTORS,
                                                PRESIDENT AND CHIEF EXECUTIVE
                                                           OFFICER
 
   
    PURSUANT TO THE REQUIREMENTS OF THE SECURITIES ACT OF 1933, AS AMENDED, THIS
AMENDMENT NO. 2 TO THE REGISTRATION STATEMENT HAS BEEN SIGNED ON JULY 5, 1996 BY
THE FOLLOWING PERSONS IN THE CAPACITIES INDICATED:
    
 
<TABLE>
<C>                                                     <S>
                      SIGNATURE                                                   TITLE
- ------------------------------------------------------  ---------------------------------------------------------
 
                /s/ KENNETH D. TUCHMAN
     -------------------------------------------        Chairman of the Board, President and Chief Executive
                  Kenneth D. Tuchman                     Officer (Principal Executive Officer)
 
                  * STEVEN B. COBURN
     -------------------------------------------        Chief Financial Officer (Principal Financial and
                   Steven B. Coburn                      Accounting Officer)
 
                   * ALAN SILVERMAN
     -------------------------------------------        Director
                    Alan Silverman
 
                 * RICHARD WEINGARTEN
     -------------------------------------------        Director
                  Richard Weingarten
 
                    * SAMUEL ZELL
     -------------------------------------------        Director
                     Samuel Zell
 
          *By:        /s/ KENNETH D. TUCHMAN
        --------------------------------------
                  Kenneth D. Tuchman
                 As Attorney-in-Fact
</TABLE>
 
                                      II-4
<PAGE>
                                 EXHIBIT INDEX
 
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
 EXHIBIT
   NO.                                                   DESCRIPTION
- ---------  -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>        <C>
1.1        Form of Underwriting Agreement
3.1        Form of Restated Certificate of Incorporation of TeleTech
3.2        Form of Amended and Restated By-laws of TeleTech
4.1*       Amended  and Restated Investment Agreement dated as of May    , 1996 among TeleTech, TeleTech Investors
            General Partnership, Alan Silverman, Susan Silverman and Jack Silverman
4.2        Stock Transfer and Registration Rights Agreement dated as of January 1, 1996 among TeleTech, Access  24
            Holdings Pty Limited, Bevero Pty Limited and Access 24 Service Corporation Pty Limited
4.3*       Specimen Common Stock Certificate
5.1        Opinion of Neal, Gerber & Eisenberg, counsel to TeleTech
10.1**     Employment Agreement dated as of January 1, 1995 between Kenneth D. Tuchman and TeleTech
10.2**     Employment  Agreement  dated as  of January  1, 1995  between  Joseph D.  Livingston and  TeleTech (the
            "Livingston Employment Agreement")
10.3       Amendment to the Livingston Employment Agreement dated May 14, 1996
10.4*      Employment Agreement dated as of September 30, 1995 between Steven B. Coburn and TeleTech
10.5**     Preferred Stock Purchase Agreement  dated as of  December 22, 1994  among TeleTech Teleservices,  Inc.,
            TeleTech  Telecommunications,  Inc., TeleTech,  TeleTech  Investors General  Partnership  and Essaness
            Theaters Corporation
10.6       Subscription and Shareholders  Agreement dated April  30, 1996  among TeleTech, Access  24 Limited  and
            Priplan Investments Limited
10.7**     TeleTech Holdings, Inc. Stock Plan
10.8       TeleTech Holdings, Inc. Directors Stock Option Plan
10.9**     Sublease  Agreement dated  September 26, 1994  between International Business  Machines Corporation and
            TeleTech Telecommunications, Inc.
10.10**    Agreement dated March 16, 1993 between 1700  Lincoln Limited and TeleTech Telecommunications, Inc.  and
            TeleTech Teleservices, Inc.
10.11**    Lease  dated September  21, 1995  between First  Union Management,  Inc. and  TeleTech Teleservices and
            TeleTech
10.12**    Form of Client Services Agreement
10.13      Agreement for Call Center Management between United Parcel General Services Co. and TeleTech
10.14**    Office Lease  dated                       between  Sam  Menlo, d/b/a  Menlo  Enterprises  and  TeleTech
            Telecommunications
10.15**    Business  Loan  Agreement  dated  March  29, 1996  among  TeleTech  Telecommunications,  Inc., TeleTech
            Teleservices, Inc. and  TeleTech, as Borrower,  and First  Interstate Bank of  California, as  Lender;
            Addendum dated March 29, 1996
10.16**    Stock  Purchase Agreement dated as of January 1, 1996  among Access 24 Holdings Pty Limited, Bevero Pty
            Limited, Access 24 Service Corporation Pty Limited and TeleTech
10.17      Master Lease Agreement dated as of July 11,  1995 among First Interstate Bank of California,  TeleTech,
            TeleTech Telecommunications, Inc. and TeleTech Teleservices, Inc.
10.18**    Master  Equipment Lease Agreement dated  as of August 16,  1995 between NationsBanc Leasing Corporation
            and TeleTech
10.19      Sublease dated  as of  September 28,  1995 between  Norwest Bank  Colorado, National  Association,  and
            TeleTech Teleservices, Inc., TeleTech Telecommunications, Inc. and TeleTech Holdings, Inc.
</TABLE>
    
<PAGE>
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
 EXHIBIT
   NO.                                                   DESCRIPTION
- ---------  -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
10.20      Sublease  dated  as of  September 28,  1995 between  Norwest Bank  Colorado, National  Association, and
            TeleTech Teleservices, Inc., TeleTech Telecommunications, Inc. and TeleTech Holdings, Inc.
<S>        <C>
16.1       Letter regarding change in independent accountants
21.1       List of subsidiaries
23.1       Consent of Arthur Anderson LLP, independent public accountants
23.2       Consent of Gumbiner,  Savett, Finkel, Fingleson  & Rose,  Inc. (formerly Gumbiner,  Savett, Friedman  &
            Rose, Inc.), independent public accountants
23.3       Consent of Neal, Gerber & Eisenberg (included in Exhibit 5.1)
24.1**     Power of Attorney (previously included on the signature page to the Registration Statement)
27**       Financial Data Schedule
</TABLE>
    
 
- ---------
 *To be filed by amendment.
**Previously filed

<PAGE>

                                6,100,000 Shares

                             TELETECH HOLDINGS, INC.

                         COMMON STOCK, $.01 PAR VALUE

                                    FORM OF

                            UNDERWRITING AGREEMENT





<PAGE>

                                                         ____________, 1996
                                                              ________ ___, 1996



Morgan Stanley & Co. Incorporated
Alex. Brown & Sons Incorporated
Smith Barney Inc.
   c/o  Morgan Stanley & Co. Incorporated
        1585 Broadway
        New York, New York 10036

Morgan Stanley & Co. International Limited
Alex. Brown & Sons Incorporated
Smith Barney Inc.
   c/o  Morgan Stanley & Co. International Limited
        25 Cabot Square
        Canary Wharf
        London E 14 4 Q A
        England


Dear Sirs:

     TeleTech Holdings, Inc., a Delaware corporation (the "Company"), 
proposes to issue and sell to the several Underwriters (as defined below), 
and Kenneth D. Tuchman ("Tuchman"), TeleTech Investors General Partnership 
("TIGP"), Hinsdale Corporation Sdn Berhard ("Hinsdale"), a Malaysian 
corporation, and Jack Silverman ("Silverman" and, together with 
Tuchman, TIGP and Hinsdale the "Selling Stockholders") severally propose to 
sell to the several Underwriters, an aggregate of 6,100,000 shares of the 
common stock, $.01 par value per share, of the Company (the "Firm Shares"), 
of which 4,000,000 shares are to be issued and sold by the Company and 
2,100,000 shares are to be sold by the  Selling Stockholders, each Selling 
Stockholder selling the amount set forth opposite such Selling Stockholder's 
name in Schedule III hereto.  Hinsdale and Silverman are hereinafter 
sometimes collectively referred to as the "Outside Selling Stockholders", and 
Tuchman, Hinsdale and Silverman are hereinafter sometimes collectively 
referred to as the "Non-TIGP Selling Stockholders." All share amounts in this 
Agreement reflect (i) a five-for-one split of the Company's common stock, by 
a 400% stock dividend (the "Split"), and (ii) the conversion of all 
outstanding shares of the Company's preferred stock, $6.45 par value per 
share (the "Preferred Stock"), into 9,300,000 shares of the Company's common 
stock (the "Conversion"), each of which shall be effected immediately prior 
to the consummation of the transactions contemplated hereby.

     It is understood that, subject to the conditions hereinafter stated, 
4,880,000 Firm Shares (the "U.S. Firm Shares") will be sold to the several 
U.S. Underwriters named in Schedule I hereto (the "U.S. Underwriters") in 
connection with the offering and sale of such U.S. Firm

<PAGE>

Shares in the United States and Canada to United States and Canadian Persons 
(as such terms are defined in the Agreement Between U.S. and International 
Underwriters of even date herewith (the "International Agreement")), and 
1,220,000 Firm  Shares (the "International Shares") will be sold to the 
several International Underwriters named in Schedule II hereto (the 
"International Underwriters") in connection with the offering and sale of 
such International Shares outside the United States and Canada to persons 
other than United States and Canadian Persons. Morgan Stanley & Co. 
Incorporated, Alex. Brown & Sons Incorporated and Smith Barney Inc. shall act 
as representatives (the "U.S. Representatives") of the several U.S. 
Underwriters, and Morgan Stanley & Co. International Limited, Alex. Brown & 
Sons Incorporated and Smith  Barney Inc. shall  act as representatives (the 
"International Representatives") of the several International Underwriters. 
The U.S. Underwriters and the  International  Underwriters are  hereinafter 
collectively referred to as the "Underwriters."

     Tuchman also proposes to sell to the several U.S. Underwriters not more 
than an additional 915,000 shares of the Company's common stock, $.01 par 
value per share (the "Additional Shares"), if and to the extent that the 
U.S. Representatives shall have determined to exercise, on behalf of the U.S. 
Underwriters, the right to purchase such shares of common stock granted to 
the U.S. Underwriters in Section 3 hereof.  The Firm Shares and the 
Additional Shares are hereinafter collectively referred to as the "Shares." 
The shares of common stock, $.01 par value per share, of the Company to be 
outstanding after giving effect to the sales contemplated hereby are 
hereinafter referred to as the "Common Stock."  The Company and the Selling 
Stockholders are hereinafter sometimes collectively referred to as the 
"Sellers."

     The Company has filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission (the 
"Commission") a registration statement relating to the Shares. The 
registration statement contains two prospectuses to be used in connection 
with the offering and sale of the Shares: the U.S. prospectus, to be used in 
connection with the offering and sale of Shares in the United States and 
Canada to United States and Canadian Persons, and the international 
prospectus, to be used in connection with the offering and sale of Shares 
outside the United States and Canada to persons other than United States and 
Canadian Persons.  The international prospectus is identical to the U.S. 
prospectus except for the outside front cover page.  The registration 
statement as amended at the time it becomes effective, including the 
information (if any) deemed to be part of the registration statement at the 
time of effectiveness pursuant to Rule 430A under the Securities Act of 1933, 
as amended (the "Securities Act"), is hereinafter referred to as the 
"Registration Statement;" the U.S. prospectus and the international 
prospectus in the respective forms first used to confirm sales of Shares are 
hereinafter collectively referred to as the "Prospectus." If the Company 
has filed an abbreviated registration statement to register additional shares 
of Common Stock pursuant to Rule 462(b) under the Securities Act (the "Rule 
462 Registration Statement"), then any reference herein to the term 
"Registration Statement" shall be deemed to include such Rule 462 
Registration Statement.

     1.   REPRESENTATIONS AND WARRANTIES OF THE COMPANY.  The Company represents
and warrants to and agrees with each of the Underwriters that:

                                       2

<PAGE>

          (a)  The Registration  Statement has  become effective, no  stop order
     suspending the effectiveness of the Registration Statement is in effect and
     no proceedings  for such purpose are pending before or, to the knowledge of
     the Company, threatened by the Commission.

          (b) (i) Each part of the Registration Statement, when such part became
     effective, did not contain and each  such part, as amended or supplemented,
     if applicable, will not contain any  untrue statement of a material fact or
     omit to state a material fact required to be stated therein or necessary to
     make the statements therein not misleading, (ii) the Registration Statement
     and the Prospectus comply  and, as amended or supplemented,  if applicable,
     will  comply in  all  material respects  with the  Securities  Act and  the
     applicable rules and regulations of the Commission thereunder and (iii) the
     Prospectus does not contain and, as amended or supplemented, if applicable,
     will not contain any untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state a
     material fact necessary to make the statements therein, in the light of the
     circumstances under which they  were made, not misleading, except  that the
     representations and warranties set forth in this  Section 1(b) do not apply
     to statements or omission  in the Registration Statement or  the Prospectus
     based upon information relating to any Underwriter furnished to the Company
     in writing by such Underwriter through you expressly for use therein.

          (c)  The  Company has been duly incorporated, is validly existing as a
     corporation in good  standing under  the laws  of the  jurisdiction of  its
     incorporation,  has the corporate power  and authority to  own its property
     and to  conduct its  business as  described in the  Prospectus and  is duly
     qualified to transact business and is in good standing in each jurisdiction
     in  which  the conduct  of  its business  or  its ownership  or  leasing of
     property requires such qualification, except to the extent that the failure
     to be so qualified or be in good standing would not have a material adverse
     effect on the Company and its subsidiaries, taken as a whole.

          (d)  Each subsidiary  of the  Company has  been duly  incorporated, is
     validly existing  as a corporation in  good standing under the  laws of the
     jurisdiction of its incorporation, has the corporate power and authority to
     own its property and to conduct its business as described in the Prospectus
     and  is duly qualified to transact business and is in good standing in each
     jurisdiction  in which  the conduct  of its  business or  its ownership  or
     leasing  of property requires such qualification, except to the extent that
     the failure to  be so  qualified or be  in good standing  could not have  a
     material adverse  effect on the  Company and its  subsidiaries, taken as  a
     whole.

          (e)  As  of  the Closing  Date, the  authorized  capital stock  of the
     Company  will  conform  as to  legal  matters  to  the description  thereof
     contained in the Prospectus.

          (f)  The  shares  of  Common  Stock  and  shares  of  Preferred  Stock
     outstanding  on the  date  of  this  Agreement  (including  the  shares  of
     Preferred  Stock  and  shares   of  Common  Stock  owned  by   the  Selling
     Stockholders)  have been duly authorized and are validly issued, fully paid
     and  non-assessable, and upon consummation of the Split and the Conversion,

                                       3

<PAGE>

     the shares of Common Stock outstanding prior to the issuance  of the Shares
     by  the  Company   (including  the  Shares  to  be  sold   by  the  Selling
     Stockholders)  will be duly authorized, validly issued, fully paid and non-
     assessable.

          (g)  As of  the Closing Date, the  Split and the  Conversion will have
     been consummated  and the Company's Restated  Certificate of Incorporation,
     as described in the Prospectus, will  have been duly adopted and filed with
     the State of Delaware.

          (h)  The  Shares to be sold  by the Company  have been duly authorized
     and,  when  issued and  delivered  in  accordance with  the  terms of  this
     Agreement, will be validly  issued, fully paid and non-assessable,  and the
     issuance of  such Shares will not  be subject to any  preemptive or similar
     rights.

          (i)  This Agreement  has been duly authorized,  executed and delivered
     by the Company.

          (j)  The execution and delivery by the Company of, and the performance
     by the Company of its obligations under, this Agreement will not contravene
     any  provision of applicable law or the certificate of incorporation or by-
     laws of the  Company or any agreement or other  instrument binding upon the
     Company  or any of its subsidiaries that is material to the Company and its
     subsidiaries, taken as  a whole, or  any judgment, order  or decree of  any
     governmental  body, agency or court having jurisdiction over the Company or
     any  subsidiary, and  no consent,  approval, authorization  or order  of or
     qualification  with any  governmental body  or agency  is required  for the
     performance  by the Company of its obligations under this Agreement, except
     such as  may be required by the securities or  Blue Sky laws of the various
     states in connection with the offer and sale of the Shares.

          (k)  There  has  not occurred  any  material  adverse  change, or  any
     development  involving  a  prospective  material  adverse  change,  in  the
     condition,  financial  or  otherwise,  or  in  the  earnings,  business  or
     operations of the Company and its subsidiaries, taken as a whole, from that
     set forth in  the Prospectus  (exclusive of any  amendments or  supplements
     thereto subsequent to the date of this Agreement).

          (l)  There are no legal or governmental proceedings pending or, to the
     knowledge of the  Company, threatened to  which the Company  or any of  its
     subsidiaries is a party or to which any of the properties of the Company or
     any of its subsidiaries is subject that are required to be described in the
     Registration Statement  or the Prospectus and  are not so described  or any
     statutes, regulations, contracts or other documents that are required to be
     described in the Registration Statement or the Prospectus or to be filed as
     exhibits to the  Registration Statement that are not  described or filed as
     required.

                                       4

<PAGE>
          (m)  Each  preliminary prospectus  filed as  part of  the registration
     statement as originally filed or as part of any amendment thereto, or filed
     pursuant to  Rule 424 under the  Securities Act, complied when  so filed in
     all material respects with the Securities Act and the rules and regulations
     of the Commission thereunder.

          (n)  The  Company  is  not  an  "investment  company" or an entity
     "controlled" by an "investment company" as such terms are defined in 
     the Investment Company Act of 1940, as amended.

          (o)  The Company and its  subsidiaries are (i) in compliance  with any
     and all applicable foreign,  federal, state and local laws  and regulations
     relating to the protection of  human health and safety, the environment  or
     hazardous  or  toxic  substances  or  wastes,  pollutants  or  contaminants
     ("Environmental Laws"), (ii) have received  all permits, licenses or 
     other approvals required  of them under applicable Environmental Laws to 
     conduct their respective businesses and (iii) are  in compliance with all
     terms and conditions of any such permit, license or approval, except where
     such noncompliance with Environmental Laws, failure to receive required 
     permits, licenses or other approvals or failure to comply with the terms 
     and conditions of such permits, licenses or approvals would not, singly or 
     in the aggregate, have a material adverse effect on the Company and its
     subsidiaries, taken as a whole.

          (p)  The Company  has complied with all provisions of Section 517.075
     Florida Statutes relating to doing business with the Government of Cuba or
     with any person or affiliate located in Cuba.

          (q)  There are no contracts, agreements or understandings between the
     Company  and any  person  granting such  person  the right  to require the
     Company  to file  a registration  statement under the Securities Act with
     respect  to any  securities of  the Company or to  require the Company to
     include  such  securities  with  the  Shares  registered  pursuant to the
     Registration Statement, except in each case as described in the 
     Prospectus.

          (r)  Subsequent to  the respective  dates as  of which information is
     given in the Registration Statement and the Prospectus, (i)the Company and
     its subsidiaries  have not incurred  any material liability or obligation,
     direct or contingent, nor entered into any material transaction not in the
     ordinary course of business; (ii) the Company has not purchased any of its
     outstanding  capital  stock,  nor  declared, paid  or otherwise made  any
     dividend or  distribution  of any  kind  on its  capital  stock other than
     ordinary and customary dividends; and (iii)there has not been any material
     change  in the  capital stock,  short-term debt or long-term  debt  of the
     Company and its consolidated subsidiaries, except in each case as 
     described in or contemplated by the Prospectus.

          (s)  The Company and  its subsidiaries have good and marketable title
     in  fee simple to  all real property  and good and marketable title to all
     personal property  owned by them which  is material to the business of the

                                       5

<PAGE>

     Company  and its subsidiaries,  in each case  free and clear  of all liens,
     encumbrances and defects except such as are described in  the Prospectus or
     such as  do not  materially affect the  value of such  property and  do not
     interfere with the use made and proposed to be made of such property by the
     Company and its  subsidiaries; and  any real property  and facilities  held
     under  lease by  the Company and  its subsidiaries  are held  by them under
     valid,  subsisting and enforceable leases  with such exceptions  as are not
     material and do not interfere with the use made and proposed  to be made of
     such property  and buildings by the  Company and its subsidiaries,  in each
     case except as described in or contemplated by the Prospectus.

          (t)  The Company and it subsidiaries own or possess, or can acquire on
     reasonable   terms,  all   material   patents,  patent   rights,  licenses,
     inventions,  copyrights,  know-how  (including   trade  secrets  and  other
     unpatented  and/or  unpatentable proprietary  or  confidential information,
     systems or procedures), trademarks, service marks and trade names currently
     employed by  them in connection with the business now operated by them, and
     neither the Company nor any of its subsidiaries has received  any notice of
     infringement of or  conflict with asserted rights of others with respect to
     any of  the foregoing which, singly or in  the aggregate, if the subject of
     an  unfavorable decision, ruling or  finding, would result  in any material
     adverse  change in  the  condition,  financial  or  otherwise,  or  in  the
     earnings, business or operations of the Company and its subsidiaries, taken
     as a whole.

          (u)  No  material labor dispute with  the employees of  the Company or
     any of its subsidiaries exists,  except as described in or contemplated  by
     the Prospectus, or, to the knowledge of the Company, is imminent.

          (v)  The  Company and each of its subsidiaries are insured by insurers
     of recognized financial responsibility against such losses and risks and in
     such  amounts  as management  of  the Company  believes to  be  prudent and
     customary  in the businesses in which  the Company and its subsidiaries are
     engaged; neither the  Company nor any such subsidiary  has been refused any
     insurance coverage sought or applied  for; and neither the Company  nor any
     such subsidiary has any reason to believe that it will not be able to renew
     its existing  insurance coverage as  and when  such coverage expires  or to
     obtain  similar coverage  from  similar insurers  as  may be  necessary  to
     continue its business  at a cost  that would not  materially and  adversely
     affect  the condition, financial or otherwise, or the earnings, business or
     operations of the Company and its subsidiaries, taken as a whole, except as
     described in or contemplated by the Prospectus.

          (w)  The   Company   and  its   subsidiaries   possess   all  material
     certificates, authorizations and permits issued by the appropriate federal,
     state  or  foreign  regulatory   authorities  necessary  to  conduct  their
     respective  businesses, and neither the Company nor any such subsidiary has
     received  any   notice  of  proceedings  relating  to   the  revocation  or
     modification of any such certificate, authorization or permit which, singly
     or in the aggregate, if  the subject of an unfavorable decision,  ruling or
     finding,  would result  in  a material  adverse  change in  the  condition,

                                       6

<PAGE>


     financial or otherwise, or in the  earnings, business or operations of  the
     Company and its subsidiaries, taken  as a whole, except as described  in or
     contemplated by the Prospectus.

          (x)  The Company and  each of  its subsidiaries maintain  a system  of
     internal accounting  controls sufficient  to  provide reasonable  assurance
     that (i)  transactions are executed in accordance with management's general
     or specific authorizations; (ii) transactions  are recorded as necessary to
     permit  preparation of  financial statements  in conformity  with generally
     accepted accounting principles and  to maintain asset accountability; (iii)
     access  to assets is permitted only in accordance with management's general
     or specific authorization;  and (iv) the recorded accountability for assets
     is  compared  with   the  existing  assets  at   reasonable  intervals  and
     appropriate action is taken with respect to any differences.

     2.   REPRESENTATIONS AND WARRANTIES OF  THE SELLING STOCKHOLDERS.  Each  of
the  Selling Stockholders, severally and not jointly, represents and warrants to
and agrees with each of the Underwriters that:

          (a)  This Agreement  has been duly authorized,  executed and delivered
     by or on behalf of such Selling Stockholder.

          (b)  The execution and  delivery by such  Selling Stockholder of,  and
     the  performance of such Selling Stockholder of its obligations under, this
     Agreement,  the Custody Agreement  signed by  such Selling  Stockholder and
     ___________, as Custodian, relating to the deposit of the Shares to be sold
     by such Selling  Stockholder (the  "Custody Agreement"), and  the Power  of
     Attorney  appointing  certain  individuals as  such  Selling  Stockholder's
     attorneys-in-fact  to  the  extent  set  forth  therein,  relating  to  the
     transactions  contemplated hereby  and by  the Registration  Statement (the
     "Power  of Attorney"), will not contravene any provision of applicable law,
     the articles or  certificate of  incorporation or by-laws  of such  Selling
     Stockholder (if such Selling Stockholder is a corporation), the partnership
     agreement of such  Selling Stockholder  (if such Selling  Stockholder is  a
     partnership), or the trust  agreement of such Selling Stockholder  (if such
     Selling  Stockholder  is a  trust), or  any  other agreement  or instrument
     binding upon such  Selling Stockholder or any judgment,  order or decree of
     any  governmental  body,  agency or  court  having  jurisdiction over  such
     Selling  Stockholder, and no consent, approval,  authorization or order of,
     or qualification with, any governmental body  or agency is required for the
     performance  by  such Selling  Stockholder  of its  obligations  under this
     Agreement or the  Custody Agreement or  Power of Attorney  of such  Selling
     Stockholder,  except such as may be required by the federal securities laws
     of the  United  States  or the  Blue  Sky laws  of  the various  states  in
     connection with the offer and sale of the Shares.

          (c)  Such  Selling Stockholder has valid title to the shares of Common
     Stock or shares of Preferred Stock which will split in the Split or convert
     in  the  Conversion (as  applicable) into  the Shares  to  be sold  by such

                                       7

<PAGE>

     Selling  Stockholder; and on the Closing Date such Selling Stockholder will
     have valid title to the Shares to be sold by such Selling  Stockholder; and
     such Selling  Stockholder has, and on the Closing Date will have, the legal
     right and power,  and all authorization  and approval required  by law,  to
     enter  into this Agreement, the Custody Agreement and the Power of Attorney
     and to  sell, transfer and  deliver the Shares to  be sold by  such Selling
     Stockholder;  provided, however,  that  such Selling  Stockholder makes  no
     representation with respect to authorization or approval required under the
     federal securities  laws of the United States or the securities or Blue Sky
     laws of  the various states  in connection with  the offer and  sale of the
     Shares.

          (d)  The  Custody Agreement and the  Power of Attorney  have been duly
     authorized, executed  and delivered  by such  Selling  Stockholder and  are
     valid and binding agreements of such Selling Stockholder.

          (e)  Assuming the Underwriters purchase such Shares for value, in good
     faith and without notice of any adverse claim, delivery of the Shares to be
     sold by such Selling Stockholder pursuant to this Agreement will pass title
     to such  Shares free and  clear of any  security interests,  claims, liens,
     equities and other encumbrances.

     2A.  ADDITIONAL  REPRESENTATIONS  AND  WARRANTIES  OF   TUCHMAN.    Tuchman
represents and warrants to and agrees with each of the underwriters that (i) the
Registration  Statement, when  it  became effective,  did  not contain  and,  as
amended or supplemented, if applicable, will not contain any untrue statement of
a material fact or omit to state  a material fact required to be stated  therein
or  necessary  to make  the  statements  therein not  misleading,  and (ii)  the
Prospectus does not contain and, as amended or supplemented, if applicable, will
not  contain any untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state a material
fact necessary to make the statements therein, in the light of the circumstances
under which they were made, not misleading, except that the representations  and
warranties set forth in this Section 2A do not apply to  statements or omissions
in  the Registration Statement or the Prospectus based upon information relating
to any  Underwriter furnished  to  the Company  in writing  by such  Underwriter
through  you, or information relating to any other Selling Stockholder furnished
to  the  Company in  writing  by  such Selling  Stockholder,  expressly for  use
therein.

     2B.  ADDITIONAL REPRESENTATIONS  AND WARRANTIES  OF TIGP.   TIGP represents
and warrants to and agrees with each of the Underwriters that (i) such  parts of
the Registration Statement as specifically  refer to TIGP and, to  the knowledge
of TIGP, all other  parts of the Registration  Statement, when the  Registration
Statement became effective, did not contain  and, as amended or supplemented, if
applicable, will not contain any untrue statement of a material fact  or omit to
state  a material fact required  to be stated  therein or necessary  to make the
statements  therein not  misleading, and  (ii) such parts  of the  Prospectus as
specifically refer to TIGP and, to the knowledge of TIGP, all other parts of the
Prospectus do not  contain and, as amended or supplemented,  if applicable, will
not contain any untrue statement of a  material fact or omit to state a material
fact necessary to make the statements therein, in the light of the circumstances
under which they were made, not misleading, except that the representations  and

                                       8

<PAGE>

warranties set forth in this Section 2B do not apply to statements  or omissions
in  the Registration Statement or the Prospectus based upon information relating
to  any Underwriter  furnished to  the Company  in writing  by such  Underwriter
through you expressly  for use therein.   For purposes  of this Section  2B, the
"knowledge of  TIGP" means the  actual knowledge of  Tim Callahan, Rod Dammeyer,
William  Pate,  Gregory Robtaille, Sheli Rosenberg, Richard Weingarten or Samuel
Zell.

     2C.  ADDITIONAL  REPRESENTATIONS AND  WARRANTIES  OF  THE  OUTSIDE  SELLING
STOCKHOLDERS.    Each of  the Outside  Selling  Stockholders, severally  and not
jointly, represents  and warrants to  and agrees with  each of  the Underwriters
that (i) such parts of the  Registration Statement as specifically refer to such
Outside Selling  Stockholder, when the Registration  Statement became effective,
did not contain and, as amended or supplemented, if applicable, will not contain
any  untrue statement  of a  material  fact or  omit to  state  a material  fact
required to  be stated therein or  necessary to make the  statements therein not
misleading, and (ii) such parts of the Prospectus as specifically  refer to such
Outside Selling Stockholder do  not contain and, as amended  or supplemented, if
applicable, will not contain any untrue statement  of a material fact or omit to
state a material fact necessary to make the statements therein, in  the light of
the circumstances under which they were made, not misleading.

     3.   AGREEMENTS  TO  SELL AND  PURCHASE.   Each  Seller, severally  and not
jointly,  hereby  agrees  to   sell  to  the  several  Underwriters,   and  each
Underwriter,  upon  the  basis  of  the  representations and  warranties  herein
contained, but subject  to the conditions  hereinafter stated, agree,  severally
and not jointly, to purchase from such Seller at $_______ a share (the "Purchase
Price")  the number  of Firm Shares  (subject to  such adjustments  to eliminate
fractional shares as  you may determine)  that bears the  same proportion to  be
sold by such Seller as the number of Firm Shares set forth in Schedules I and II
hereto opposite the name  of such Underwriter bears to the total  number of Firm
Shares.

     On  the basis  of  the representations  and  warranties contained  in  this
Agreement, and  subject to its terms  and conditions, Tuchman agrees  to sell to
the U.S. Underwriters  the Additional  Shares, and the  U.S. Underwriters  shall
have a  one-time right to  purchase, severally  and not jointly,  up to  937,500
Additional  Shares at the  Purchase Price.   Such  date may be  the same  as the
Closing Date  (as defined below) but not earlier than the Closing Date nor later
than ten business days after the date  written notice of an election to purchase
Additional Shares is given.  If the U.S. Representatives, on behalf of  the U.S.
Underwriters, elect to exercise  such option, the U.S. Representatives  shall so
notify  the Company in  writing not later  than 30 days  after the date  of this
Agreement  which notice  shall  specify the  number of  Additional Shares  to be
purchased by the U.S. Underwriters and  the date on which such Additional Shares
are to be purchased.  Additional Shares may be purchased as  provided in Section
5 hereof solely for  the purpose of covering  overallotments made in  connection
with  the offering  of the  Firm Shares.   If  any Additional  Shares are  to be
purchased,  each U.S. Underwriter agrees, severally and not jointly, to purchase
the  number of  Additional  Shares (subject  to  such adjustments  to  eliminate
fractional shares as the U.S. Representatives may determine) that bears the same
proportion  to the  total number  of Additional  Shares to  be purchased  as the
number of U.S. Firm Shares set  forth in Schedule I hereto opposite the  name of
such U.S.  Underwriter bears  to the  total number  of U.S.  Firm  Shares.   The
Additional  Shares to  be purchased by  the U.S. Underwriters  hereunder and the
U.S. Firm Shares are hereinafter collectively referred to as the "U.S. Shares."

                                       9

<PAGE>

     Each Seller hereby agrees that, without the prior written consent of Morgan
Stanley & Co. Incorporated, it will not, during the period ending 180 days after
the date of the Prospectus, (i) offer, pledge,  sell, contract to sell, sell any
option or contract  to purchase, purchase any option or  contract to sell, grant
any option,  right or warrant to  purchase or otherwise transfer  or dispose of,
directly or indirectly, any shares of Common Stock or any securities convertible
into or  exercisable or exchangeable  for Common Stock  (whether such  shares of
Common  Stock or any  such securities are  now owned or  hereafter acquired), or
(ii)  enter into  any swap or  other arrangement  that transfers  to another, in
whole or in part,  any of the economic  consequences of ownership of the  Common
Stock, whether any such transaction described in clause (i)  or (ii) above is to
be  settled by delivery  of Common  Stock or such  other securities,  in cash or
otherwise.  The foregoing sentence shall not  apply to (A) the Shares to be sold
hereunder, (B)  the issuance by the Company  of shares of Common  Stock upon the
exercise of an  option or warrant or the conversion of a security outstanding on
the date hereof of which the Underwriters have  been advised in writing, (C) the
grant by  the Company of options  pursuant to the TeleTech  Holdings, Inc. Stock
Plan  and the TeleTech Holdings, Inc. Directors Stock Option Plan (collectively,
the  "Plans"),  as  the  Plans  are  described in  the  Prospectus  or  (D)  the
distribution by TIGP on the  Closing Date (as hereinafter defined) of  shares of
Common Stock to its  partners (the "TIGP Distribution"), provided that, prior to
the date of the TIGP Distribution,  all such partners shall have executed "lock-
up" agreements substantially in the form of Exhibit A hereto.  In addition, each
Selling Stockholder, agrees that, without the prior written consent of  the U.S.
Representatives, it will  not, during the period ending 180  days after the date
of the Prospectus, make  any demand for, or exercise any  right with respect to,
the registration  of any shares  of Common  Stock or any  securities convertible
into or exercisable or exchangeable for Common Stock.

     4.   TERMS OF PUBLIC  OFFERING.  The  Sellers are advised  by you that  the
Underwriters propose to make a  public offering of their respective  portions of
the Shares  as soon  after the  Registration Statement  and this Agreement  have
become  effective as  in your judgment  is advisable.   The  Sellers are further
advised by  you that the  Shares are  to be offered  to the public  initially at
U.S.$________  a  share (the  "Public Offering  Price")  and to  certain dealers
selected by  you  at a  price  that represents  a concession  not  in excess  of
U.S.$_______ a share under the Public  Offering Price, and that any  Underwriter
may  allow,  and such  dealers  may  reallow, a  concession,  not  in excess  of
U.S.$______ a share, to any Underwriter or to certain other dealers.

     Each U.S.  Underwriter  hereby makes  to,  and with,  the  Company and  the
Selling Stockholders the representations and agreements of such U.S. Underwriter
contained in the fifth and sixth  paragraphs of Article III of the International
Agreement.  Each International Underwriter hereby  makes to and with the Company
and  the  Selling  Stockholders  the  representations  and  agreements  of  such
International  Underwriter contained  in  the seventh,  eighth, ninth  and tenth
paragraphs of Article III of the International Agreement.

                                       10

<PAGE>

     5.   PAYMENT AND DELIVERY.   Payment for the Firm Shares to be sold by each
Seller  shall  be made  to such  Seller in  Federal  or other  funds immediately
available  in  New York  City  against  delivery of  such  Firm  Shares for  the
respective  accounts of the  several Underwriters at  10:00 A.M., New  York City
time, on __________, 1996, or at such other time on the same or such other date,
not later than                , 1996, as shall be designated in writing  by you.

                                        8
The time and date  of such payment are hereinafter  referred to as the  "Closing
Date."

     Payment for  any Additional Shares shall  be made to Tuchman  in Federal or
other funds immediately  available in  New York  City against  delivery of  such
Additional Shares for  the respective  accounts of the  several Underwriters  at
10:00 A.M., New York City time, on the date specified in the notice described in
Section 3 or on such  other date, in any  event not later than,  ______________,
1996, as shall be  designated in writing by the U.S. Representatives.   The time
and  date of  such payment are  hereinafter referred  to as  the "Option Closing
Date."

     Certificates  for the  Firm  Shares  and  Additional  Shares  shall  be  in
definitive form  and registered in such  names and in such  denominations as you
shall request  in writing not  later than two  full business  days prior to  the
Closing Date or the  Option Closing Date, as the case may  be.  The certificates
evidencing the  Firm Shares and Additional  Shares shall be delivered  to you on
the  Closing  Date or  the Option  Closing Date,  as  the case  may be,  for the
respective accounts of the several Underwriters, with any transfer taxes payable
in connection  with the transfer  of the Shares  to the Underwriters  duly paid,
against payment of the Purchase Price therefor.

     6.   CONDITIONS TO THE  UNDERWRITERS' OBLIGATIONS.  The  obligations of the
Sellers to  sell the Shares to  the Underwriters and the  several obligations of
the  Underwriters  to purchase  and  pay  for the  Shares  on  the Closing  Date
hereunder are subject  to the  condition that the  Registration Statement  shall
have become  effective not later  than __________  (New York time)  on the  date
hereof.

     The  several obligations of the  Underwriters hereunder are  subject to the
following further conditions:

          (a)  Subsequent  to the execution  and delivery of  this Agreement and
     prior to the Closing Date:

               (i)  there shall not have occurred any change, or any development
          involving  a  prospective  change,  in  the  condition,  financial  or
          otherwise,  or in the earnings, business or operations, of the Company
          and  its subsidiaries, taken  as a whole,  from that set  forth in the
          Prospectus  (exclusive   of  any  amendments  or  supplements  thereto
          subsequent to  the date of this Agreement), that, in your judgment, is
          material   and  adverse  and   that  makes   it,  in   your  judgment,
          impracticable to  market the  Shares on  the terms  and in  the manner
          contemplated in the Prospectus; and

                                       11

<PAGE>

              (ii)  there shall not have occurred any downgrading, nor shall any
          notice have been  given of any intended or potential downgrading or of
          any review of  a possible change that does  not indicate the direction
          of the possible  change, in the rating  accorded any of  the Company's
          securities   by   any   "nationally  recognized   statistical   rating
          organization," as such term is defined for purposes of Rule 436(g) (2)
          under the Securities Act.

          (b)   The Underwriters  shall have received on  the Closing Date (x) a
     certificate, dated the Closing Date  and signed by an executive officer  of
     the Company, to the effect  set forth in clause (ii) of Section  6(a) above
     and  to the effect that  the representations and  warranties of the Company
     contained in this Agreement are true and correct as of the Closing Date and
     that the Company has complied with  all of the agreements and satisfied all
     of the conditions on its part to be performed  or satisfied hereunder on or
     before the Closing Date, and (y) a certificate of  each Selling Stockholder
     to  the  effect that  the representations  and  warranties of  such Selling
     Stockholder contained  in this  Agreement are  true and correct  as of  the
     Closing Date and that such Selling Stockholder has complied with all of the

                                        9
     agreements and satisfied all of the conditions on its part  to be performed
     or satisfied hereunder on or before the Closing Date.

          The  executive officer signing and  delivering the certificate for the
     Company  may  rely  upon  the  best  of his  knowledge  as  to  proceedings
     threatened.

          (c)   The Underwriters  shall  have received  on  the Closing Date  an
     opinion  of Neal,  Gerber &  Eisenberg, counsel  for the  Company  and (for
     purposes  of such opinion and certain other deliveries to the Underwriters)
     the  Non-TIGP Selling Stockholders, dated  the Closing Date,  to the effect
     that:

               (i)  the Company has been  duly incorporated, is validly existing
          as a corporation  in good standing under the  laws of the jurisdiction
          of its incorporation, has the corporate power and authority to own its
          property  and to conduct its  business as described  in the Prospectus
          and, to  the knowledge of such counsel, is  duly qualified to transact
          business  and is  in good standing  in each jurisdiction  in which the
          conduct  of its  business  or its  ownership  or leasing  of  property
          requires  such qualification, except to the extent that the failure to
          be  so qualified  or be  in good  standing would  not have  a material
          adverse effect on the Company and its subsidiaries taken as a whole;

              (ii)  each subsidiary  of the Company has  been duly incorporated,
          is validly existing  as a corporation in good  standing under the laws
          of  the jurisdiction of its incorporation, has the corporate power and
          authority to own its property and to conduct its business as described
          in  the Prospectus  and,  to the  knowledge of  such counsel,  is duly
          qualified  to  transact  business and  is  in  good  standing in  each

                                       12

<PAGE>

          jurisdiction in which the  conduct of its business or its ownership or
          leasing of property requires such  qualification, except to the extent
          that  the failure to be so qualified  or be in good standing would not
          have a material  adverse effect  on the Company  and its  subsidiaries
          taken as a whole;

             (iii)  the authorized capital stock  of the Company conforms  as to
          legal matters to the description thereof contained in the Prospectus;

              (iv)  the shares of Common  Stock outstanding immediately prior to
          the issuance of the Shares by  the Company (including the Shares to be
          sold by the Selling  Stockholders and the other shares of Common Stock
          issued in the Split and the  Conversion) have been duly authorized and
          are validly issued, fully paid and non-assessable;

               (v)  the  Shares to  be  sold  by  the  Company  have  been  duly
          authorized and, when issued and delivered in accordance with the terms
          of  this  Agreement,  will be  validly  issued,  fully  paid and  non-
          assessable, and the issuance of such Shares will not be subject to any
          preemptive or similar rights;

              (vi)  this  Agreement  has  been  duly  authorized,  executed  and
          delivered by the Company;

             (vii)  the  execution  and  delivery by  the  Company  of, and  the
          performance by  the Company of  its obligations under,  this Agreement
          will not contravene any provision of applicable law or the certificate
          of incorporation or  by-laws of the  Company or, to  the best of  such
          counsel's knowledge,  any agreement  or other instrument  binding upon
          the Company or any of its subsidiaries that is material to the Company
          and its  subsidiaries, taken  as  a whole,  or, to  the  best of  such
          counsel's knowledge,  any judgment or decree of any governmental body,
          agency  or  court   having  jurisdiction  over  the   Company  or  any
          subsidiary, and no  consent, approval,  authorization or  order of  or
          qualification with any governmental body or agency is required for the
          performance by  the Company of  its obligations under  this Agreement,
          except such as may be required by  the securities or Blue Sky laws  of
          the various states in connection with the offer and sale of the Shares
          by the U.S. Underwriters;

            (viii)  the  statements (A)  in  the Prospectus  under the  captions
          "Description of  Capital Stock," and "Shares Eligible for Future Sale"
          and,  "Underwriters" and (B) in the Registration Statement in Items 14
          and 15, in each  case insofar as such statements  constitute summaries
          of the legal matters, documents or proceedings referred to therein and
          in  the case of the  statements under the  caption "Underwriters" only
          insofar as such  statements relate to  this Agreement, fairly  present
          the  information  called  for  with respect  to  such  legal  matters,
          documents and proceedings and fairly summarize the matters referred to
          therein;

                                       13

<PAGE>

              (ix)  after due inquiry, such  counsel does not know of  any legal
          or governmental proceeding pending or threatened  to which the Company
          or  any  of  its subsidiaries  is  a  party  or to  which  any  of the
          properties of the  Company or any of its  subsidiaries is subject that
          are  required to  be described  in the  Registration Statement  or the
          Prospectus and are not  so described or of any  statutes, regulations,
          contracts  or other documents that are required to be described in the
          Registration Statement or the Prospectus or to be filed as exhibits to
          the  Registration  Statement  that  are  not  described  or  filed  as
          required;

               (x)  the  Company is  not  an "investment  company" or  an entity
          "controlled"  by an "investment company," as such terms are defined in
          the Investment Company Act of 1940, as amended;

              (xi)  to the knowledge of such  counsel, the Company and  TeleTech
          Communications,  Inc.,  TeleTech  Teleservices,  Inc.  and  Access  24
          Service Corporation  Pty Limited ("Access  24") (A) are  in compliance
          with  any and all applicable Environmental Laws, (B) have received all
          permits, licenses or other approvals required of them under applicable
          Environmental Laws to conduct their respective businesses and  (C) are
          in  compliance with  all  terms and  conditions  of any  such  permit,
          license   or  approval,   except   where   such   noncompliance   with
          Environmental Laws,  failure to receive required  permits, licenses or
          other approvals or failure  to comply with the terms and conditions of
          such  permits, licenses  or  approvals would  not,  singly or  in  the
          aggregate,  have  a material  adverse effect  on  the Company  and its
          subsidiaries, taken as a whole; and

             (xii)  this  Agreement  has  been  duly  authorized,  executed  and
          delivered   by  or  on  behalf   of  each  of   the  Non-TIGP  Selling
          Stockholders;

            (xiii)  the  execution   and  delivery  by  each   Non-TIGP  Selling
          Stockholder  of,   and  the  performance  by   such  Non-TIGP  Selling
          Stockholder of its obligations  under, this Agreement and the  Custody
          Agreement and Powers of Attorney  of such Non-TIGP Selling Stockholder
          will not contravene any  provision of applicable law, or  the articles
          or certificate  of incorporation or  by-laws of such  Non-TIGP Selling
          Stockholder (if such Non-TIGP Selling Stockholder is a corporation) or
          the trust agreement of such Non-TIGP Selling Stockholder (if such Non-
          TIGP  Selling  Stockholder is  a  trust),  or,  to  the best  of  such
          counsel's knowledge,  any agreement  or other instrument  binding upon
          such  Non-TIGP Selling Stockholder or,  to the best  of such counsel's
          knowledge,  any judgment,  order or  decree of any  governmental body,
          agency  or  court  having  jurisdiction  over  such  Non-TIGP  Selling
          Stockholder, and no consent,  approval, authorization or order  of, or

                                       14

<PAGE>

          qualification with, any  governmental body or  agency is required  for
          the  performance   by  such   Non-TIGP  Selling  Stockholder   of  its
          obligations  under this Agreement or the Custody Agreement or Power of
          Attorney of such Non-TIGP  Selling Stockholder, except such as  may be
          required by the  securities or Blue Sky laws of  the various states in
          connection with the offer and sale of the Shares;

             (xiv)  each  of  the  Non-TIGP  Selling Stockholders  is  the  sole
          registered owner of  the Shares  to be sold  by such Non-TIGP  Selling
          Stockholder and has the  legal right and power, and  all authorization
          and  approval required by  law, to enter  into this  Agreement and the
          Custody Agreement  and  Power of  Attorney  of such  Non-TIGP  Selling
          Stockholder and to sell, transfer and deliver the Shares to be sold by
          such Non-TIGP Selling Stockholder;

              (xv)  the Custody Agreement and the Power of Attorney of each Non-
          TIGP  Selling  Stockholder have  been  duly  authorized, executed  and
          delivered  by such  Non-TIGP  Selling Stockholder  and  are valid  and
          binding agreements of such Non-TIGP Selling Stockholder;

             (xvi)  assuming the Underwriters purchase such Shares for value, in
          good faith and without notice  of any adverse claim, upon  delivery of
          the Shares to be sold by each Non-TIGP Selling Stockholder pursuant to
          this Agreement, the  Underwriters will  acquire all of  the rights  of
          such Non-TIGP Selling Stockholder in such Shares free and clear of any
          security interests,  claims, liens,  equities and other  encumbrances;
          and

            (xvii)  such counsel  (A) is of  the opinion  that the  Registration
          Statement  and   Prospectus  (except  for  financial   statements  and
          schedules and other financial and statistical data included therein as
          to which such counsel need not  express any opinion) comply as to form
          in  all material respects  with the Securities  Act and  the rules and
          regulations of  the Commission  thereunder, (B) believes  that (except
          for  financial  statements  and  schedules  and  other  financial  and
          statistical  data  as  to which  such  counsel  need  not express  any
          opinion)  the  Registration  Statement  and  the  Prospectus  included
          therein, at the time the Registration Statement became  effective, did
          not contain any untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state a
          material fact  required to be stated therein or  necessary to make the
          statements therein not  misleading and  (C) has no  reason to  believe
          that  (except  for  financial   statements  and  schedules  and  other
          financial  and  statistical data  as to  which  such counsel  need not
          express  any belief) the Prospectus contains any untrue statement of a
          material fact  or omits to state a material fact necessary in order to
          make the statements therein, in light of the circumstances under which
          they were made, not misleading.

                                       15

<PAGE>

          (d)   The  Underwriters shall  have  received on  the  Closing Date an
     opinion of Rosenberg & Liebentritt PC, counsel for TIGP,  dated the Closing
     Date, to the effect that:

               (i)  this  Agreement  has  been  duly  authorized,  executed  and
          delivered by or on behalf of TIGP;

              (ii)  the  execution and delivery by TIGP  of, and the performance
          by  TIGP  of its  obligations under,  this  Agreement and  the Custody
          Agreement  and  Powers of  Attorney of  TIGP  will not  contravene any
          provision of applicable law, or the partnership agreement of TIGP, or,
          to  the best  of  such counsel's  knowledge,  any agreement  or  other
          instrument  binding  upon  TIGP or,  to  the  best  of such  counsel's
          knowledge,  any judgment,  order or  decree of any  governmental body,
          agency  or  court  having  jurisdiction  over  TIGP  and  no  consent,
          approval,  authorization  or  order  of, or  qualification  with,  any

                                       12
          governmental body or agency is required for the performance by TIGP of
          its obligations under this Agreement or the Custody Agreement or Power
          of  Attorney of TIGP,  except such as  may be required  by the federal
          securities laws  of the United  States or  the securities or  Blue Sky
          laws of  the various states in  connection with the offer  and sale of
          the Shares;

             (iii)  TIGP is the sole registered  owner of the Shares to  be sold
          by TIGP and has the  legal right and power, and all  authorization and
          approval required by law, to enter into this Agreement and the Custody
          Agreement  and Power of  Attorney of  TIGP and  to sell,  transfer and
          deliver the  Shares to be sold  by TIGP; provided, however,  that such
          counsel  need not opine as to authorization or approval required under
          the federal securities  laws of the United States or the securities or
          Blue Sky laws of the  various states in connection with the  offer and
          sale of the Shares;

              (iv)  the Custody Agreement and the Power of Attorney of TIGP have
          been duly authorized, executed and delivered by TIGP and are valid and
          binding agreements of TIGP;

               (v)  assuming the Underwriters purchase such Shares for value, in
          good  faith and without notice of any  adverse claim, upon delivery of
          the  Shares  to  be sold  by  TIGP  pursuant  to this  Agreement,  the
          Underwriters will  acquire all  of the rights  of TIGP in  such Shares
          free  and clear of any security interests, claims, liens, equities and
          other encumbrances created by, through or under TIGP; and

              (vi)  such counsel (A) has  no reason to believe that  (except for
          financial statements and schedules and other financial and statistical
          data as to which such counsel need not express any  belief) such parts
          of the Registration Statement  as specifically refer to TIGP  and such
          parts  of the  Prospectus included  therein as  specifically refer  to
          TIGP,  at  the  time  the  Registration  Statement  became  effective,
          contained  any untrue statement of a material fact or omitted to state
          a material fact required to be stated therein or necessary to make the
          statements therein not  misleading and  (B) has no  reason to  believe
          that  (except  for  financial   statements  and  schedules  and  other
          financial  and  statistical data  as to  which  such counsel  need not
          express any belief) such parts of the Prospectus as specifically refer
          to TIGP  contain any untrue  statement of a  material fact or  omit to
          state  a material  fact  necessary in  order  to make  the  statements
          therein, in the light of the circumstances under which they were made,
          not misleading.

                                       16

<PAGE>

          (e)   The  Underwriters  shall have  received on  the  Closing Date an
     opinion of Katten  Muchin &  Zavis, special counsel  for the  Underwriters,
     dated the  Closing Date, covering the  matters referred to in  clauses (v),
     (vi)  (with  regards  to  authorization,  execution  and  delivery  by  the
     Underwriters),  (viii) (but  only as  to the  statements in  the Prospectus
     under "Description  of  Capital Stock"  and "Underwriters")  and (xvii)  of
     Section 6(c) above.

          With respect  to clause (xvii) of  Section 6(c) above,  Neal, Gerber &
     Eisenberg and Katten  Muchin & Zavis,  and with respect  to clause (vi)  of
     Section  6(d) above,  Rosenberg  & Liebentritt  PC,  may state  that  their
     opinion and belief are based upon their participation in the preparation of
     the Registration Statement and Prospectus and any amendments or supplements
     thereto and review and discussion of  the contents thereof, but are without
     independent check or  verification except  as specified.   With respect  to
     Section 6(c)  above, Neal, Gerber  & Eisenberg  may rely,  with respect  to
     matters involving the application  of laws of any jurisdictions  other than
     the laws  of the State  of New York  or the United  States or  the Delaware
     General Corporation Law, to the extent such counsel deems appropriate, upon
     an opinion or opinions of local counsel, provided that (A)  each such local
     counsel  is reasonably  satisfactory to  your counsel, (B)  a copy  of each
     opinion so  relied upon is  delivered to you  and is in form  and substance
     reasonably satisfactory to your  counsel, and (C) Neal, Gerber  & Eisenberg
     shall  state  in their  opinion  that they  believe they  are  justified in
     relying on each other opinion.   With respect to Section 6(c)  above, Neal,
     Gerber  & Eisenberg, and  with respect to  Section 6(d) above,  Rosenberg &
     Liebentritt PC, may rely, with respect to factual matters and to the extent
     such counsel  deems appropriate, upon  the representations of  each Selling
     Stockholder  contained herein  and in  the Custody  Agreement and  Power of
     Attorney  of   such  Selling  Stockholder   and  in  other   documents  and
     instruments;  provided that copies of such Custody Agreements and Powers of
     Attorney and of any such other documents and instruments shall be delivered
     to you and shall be in form and substance satisfactory to your counsel.  In
     addition, with respect to Section 6(c)  above, Neal, Gerber & Eisenberg may
     rely  upon  an opinion  or  opinions of  counsel for  any  Non-TIGP Selling
     Stockholders,  provided that (A) each such counsel for the Non-TIGP Selling
     Stockholders is reasonably satisfactory to your counsel, (B) a copy of each
     opinion  so relied upon  is delivered to  you and is  in form and substance
     reasonably satisfactory to your counsel, and (D) Neal, Gerber and Eisenberg
     shall  state in  their  opinion that  they believe  they  are justified  in
     relying on each other opinion.

                                       17

<PAGE>

          The  opinion of  Neal, Gerber  & Eisenberg  described in  Section 6(c)
     above and the  opinion of Rosenberg &  Liebentritt PC described  in Section
     6(d)  above  (and  any  other  opinions  of  counsel  referred  to  in  the
     immediately preceding paragraph)  shall be rendered to  the Underwriters at
     the request of the Company and/or one or more of  the Selling Stockholders,
     as the case may be, and shall so state therein.

          (f)   The Underwriters shall have received, on each of the date hereof
     and the  Closing Date, a letter dated the date  hereof or the Closing Date,
     as the case may  be, in form and substance satisfactory to you, from Arthur
     Andersen LLP,  independent  public accountants,  containing statements  and
     information  of  the  type  ordinarily included  in  accountants'  "comfort
     letters"  to underwriters  with  respect to  the  financial statements  and
     certain financial  information contained in the  Registration Statement and
     the  Prospectus; provided  that the  letter delivered  on the  Closing Date
     shall use a "cut-off date" not earlier than the date hereof.

          (g)   The Underwriters shall have received, on each of the date hereof
     and the Closing Date, a letter dated  the date hereof or the Closing  Date,
     as the case may be, in form and substance satisfactory to you, of Gumbiner,
     Savett, Finkel, Fingleson & Rose, Inc. (formerly Gumbiner, Savett, Friedman
     & Rose,  Inc.), independent  public accountants, containing  statements and
     information  of  the  type  ordinarily included  in  accountants'  "comfort
     letters"  to underwriters  with  respect to  the  financial statements  and
     certain financial  information contained in the  Registration Statement and
     the Prospectus for  the Company's fiscal years  ended January 31, 1992  and
     1993 and the 11 month period ended December 31, 1993.

          (h)   The  "lock-up" agreements,  each  substantially in the  form  of
     Exhibit  A  hereto,  between you  and  certain  stockholders,  officers and
     directors  of the Company  relating to sales  of shares of  Common Stock or
     certain  other securities, delivered  to you on or  before the date hereof,
     shall be in full force and effect on the Closing Date.

     The several  obligations of  the U.S.  Underwriters to purchase  Additional
Shares hereunder are subject to the  delivery to the U.S. Representatives on the
Option  Closing  Date of  such  documents as  they may  reasonably  request with
respect to the good standing of the Company, the due  authorization and issuance
of  the Additional  Shares and  other  matters related  to the  issuance of  the
Additional Shares.


     7.   COVENANTS  OF THE COMPANY.  In further consideration of the agreements
of   the  Underwriters  herein  contained,  the   Company  covenants  with  each
Underwriter as follows:

          (a)   To  furnish to you,  without charge, seven signed  copies of the
     Registration  Statement (including  exhibits thereto)  and for  delivery to

                                       18

<PAGE>


     each  other  Underwriter a  conformed  copy of  the  Registration Statement
     (without exhibits thereto) and to furnish  to you in New York City, without
     charge, prior  to 10:00 a.m. local time on the business day next succeeding
     the date of this Agreement and during the period mentioned in paragraph (c)
     below, as many copies of the Prospectus and  any supplements and amendments
     thereto or to the Registration Statement as you may reasonably request.

          (b)   Before amending  or supplementing the  Registration Statement or
     the Prospectus, to furnish to you a copy of each such proposed amendment or
     supplement and not  to file any  such proposed  amendment or supplement  to
     which you  reasonably object, and  to file with  the Commission  within the
     applicable period specified  in Rule  424(b) under the  Securities Act  any
     prospectus required to be filed pursuant to such rule.

          (c)   If,  during  such period  after  the  first  date  of the public
     offering of  the Shares as in  the opinion of counsel  for the Underwriters
     the Prospectus is required by law  to be delivered in connection with sales
     by an Underwriter or dealer, any event shall occur or condition  exist as a
     result of  which it is necessary  to amend or supplement  the Prospectus in
     order to  make the statements  therein, in  the light of  the circumstances
     when the  Prospectus is delivered to a purchaser, not misleading, or if, in
     the opinion of  your counsel, it  is necessary to  amend or supplement  the
     Prospectus  to comply  with  law,  forthwith  to  prepare,  file  with  the
     Commission and  furnish, at its own expense, to the Underwriters and to the
     dealers (whose  names and  addresses you  will furnish  to the Company)  to
     which Shares may have been sold by you on behalf of the Underwriters and to
     any other dealers  upon request,  either amendments or  supplements to  the
     Prospectus  so  that the  statements  in the  Prospectus  as so  amended or
     supplemented  will  not,  in  the  light  of  the  circumstances  when  the
     Prospectus  is delivered  to a  purchaser,  be misleading  or  so that  the
     Prospectus, as amended or supplemented, will comply with law.

          (d)   To endeavor to  qualify the Shares  for offer and sale under the
     securities or Blue  Sky laws of such jurisdictions  as you shall reasonably
     request; PROVIDED, HOWEVER, that the Company shall not be obligated to file
     any  general  consent to  service of  process or  to  qualify as  a foreign
     corporation in any jurisdiction in which it is not currently so qualified.

          (e)   To make  generally available  to the  Company's security holders
     and to you as soon as practicable an earning statement covering the twelve-
     month period ending  September 30,  1997 that satisfies  the provisions  of
     Section 11(a)  of the Securities Act  and the rules and  regulations of the
     Commission thereunder.

                                       19

<PAGE>

          (f)   Whether or  not the transactions  contemplated in this Agreement
     are consummated or this Agreement  is terminated and except as  provided in
     Section 8 entitled "Expenses of  Selling Stockholders," to pay or  cause to
     be paid  all expenses incident to the performance of the obligations of the
     Company and the Selling  Stockholders under this Agreement,  including: (i)
     the  fees,  disbursements and  expenses of  the  Company's counsel  and the
     Company's accountants in  connection with the registration and  delivery of
     the  Shares under  the Securities  Act and  all other  fees or  expenses in
     connection with the  preparation and filing of  the Registration Statement,
     any preliminary  prospectus, the Prospectus and  amendments and supplements
     to any of the foregoing, including all printing costs associated therewith,
     and the mailing and  delivering of copies  thereof to the Underwriters  and
     dealers,  in  the quantities  hereinabove  specified,  (ii) all  costs  and
     expenses related  to  the  transfer  and  delivery of  the  Shares  to  the

                                       15
     Underwriters, including any transfer or other  taxes payable thereon, (iii)
     the  cost  of  printing or  producing  any  Blue  Sky or  Legal  Investment
     memorandum in  connection with the offer and sale of the Shares under state
     securities  laws and all expenses  in connection with  the qualification of
     the Shares  for offer and sale  under state securities laws  as provided in
     Section  7(d) hereof,  including filing  fees and  the reasonable  fees and
     disbursements  of  counsel for  the  Underwriters in  connection  with such
     qualification  and  in connection  with the  Blue  Sky or  Legal Investment
     memorandum, (iv) all filing fees and reasonable disbursements of counsel to
     the Underwriters incurred in  connection with the review  and qualification
     of  the offering of  the Shares by  the National  Association of Securities
     Dealers, Inc., (v) all fees and expenses in connection with the preparation
     and filing of the registration statement on Form 8-A relating to the Common
     Stock and  all costs  and expenses  incident to listing  the Shares  on the
     Nasdaq National Market and other national securities  exchanges and foreign
     stock exchanges, (vi)  the cost of  printing certificates representing  the
     Shares, (vii)  the costs and  charges of any  transfer agent,  registrar or
     depositary,  (viii) the  costs  and expenses  of  the Company  relating  to
     investor presentations on any "road show" undertaken in connection with the
     marketing of  the offering of  the Shares,  including, without  limitation,
     expenses associated with the  production of road show slides  and graphics,
     reasonable  fees and expenses of any consultants engaged in connection with
     the road show presentations with the prior approval of the  Company, travel
     and lodging expenses of the representatives and officers of the Company and
     any such consultants,  and the cost of any aircraft chartered in connection
     with  the road  show,  and (ix)  all other  reasonable  costs and  expenses
     incident  to  the performance  of the  obligations of  the Company  and the
     Selling Stockholders hereunder for which provision is not otherwise made in
     this  Section or  Section 8.   It  is understood,  however, that  except as
     provided  in this Section, Section 9 entitled "Indemnity and Contribution",
     and  the last paragraph of Section 11  below, the Underwriters will pay all
     of  their costs  and expenses,  including fees  and disbursements  of their
     counsel,  stock transfer taxes  payable on resale  of any of  the Shares by
     them and any advertising expenses connected with any offers they may make.

     8.   EXPENSES OF SELLING STOCKHOLDERS.  Each Selling Stockholder, severally
and not jointly, agrees to pay or cause to be paid (i) all taxes, if any, on the
transfer and sale of the Shares being sold by such Selling Stockholder, and (ii)
the fees, disbursements and expenses of counsel for such Selling Shareholder, if
other than Neal, Gerber & Eisenberg.

                                       20

<PAGE>

     9.   INDEMNITY AND CONTRIBUTION.

          (a)   The Company, Tuchman  and TIGP agree, jointly and  severally, to
     indemnify and  hold harmless each Underwriter and  each person, if any, who
     controls any  Underwriter within the  meaning of either  Section 15 of  the
     Securities Act  or Section 20  of the Securities  Exchange Act of  1934, as
     amended (the "Exchange Act"), from and  against any and all losses, claims,
     damages and liabilities  (including, without limitation, any legal or other
     expenses reasonably incurred in  connection with defending or investigating
     any such  action or claim) caused by any untrue statement or alleged untrue
     statement of a material fact contained in the Registration Statement or any
     amendment thereof, any preliminary prospectus or the Prospectus (as amended
     or  supplemented  if the  Company shall  have  furnished any  amendments or
     supplements  thereto), or  caused by  any omission  or alleged  omission to
     state therein a material fact required to be stated therein or necessary to
     make  the statements therein not misleading, except insofar as such losses,
     claims, damages or liabilities are caused  by any such untrue statement  or
     omission or  alleged untrue  statement or  omission based  upon information
     relating to any  Underwriter furnished to  the Company  in writing by  such
     Underwriter through you expressly for use therein; PROVIDED, HOWEVER, that,
     with  respect  to  any untrue  statement  or  alleged  untrue statement  or
     omission  or  alleged omission  made  in  any preliminary  prospectus,  the
     foregoing  indemnity  agreement  shall not  inure  to  the  benefit of  any

                                       16
     Underwriter from whom the person asserting any such losses, claims, damages
     or liabilities  purchased the Shares  concerned, or any  person controlling
     such  Underwriter, to  the extent  that  any such  loss,  claim, damage  or
     liability  of such  Underwriter results from  the fact  that a  copy of the
     Prospectus (or Prospectus as amended or supplemented) was not sent or given
     to  such  person,  if  required  by the  Securities  Act  so  to  have been
     delivered,  at or  prior to the  written confirmation  of the  sale of such
     Shares to  such person and the untrue statement or alleged untrue statement
     or  omission or  alleged  omission was  corrected  in such  Prospectus  (or
     Prospectus  as  amended or  supplemented),  if the  Company  had previously
     furnished   copies  of  such  Prospectus  (or   Prospectus  as  amended  or
     supplemented)  to such  Underwriter.   Notwithstanding the  foregoing, TIGP
     shall  not be required to  provide indemnification under  this Section 9(a)
     with respect to  any losses, claims, damages  or liabilities, unless  (i) a
     court of competent jurisdiction  shall determine that any of  Tim Callahan,
     Rod Dammeyer, William Pate, Gregory Robitaille, Sheli Rosenberg and  Samuel
     Zell had  actual knowledge of  the untrue statement or  omission or alleged
     untrue statement or omission  which caused such losses, claims,  damages or
     liabilities  or (ii) such losses, claims, damages or liabilities are caused
     by an untrue statement  or omission or alleged untrue statement or omission
     in such parts of  the Registration Statement or Prospectus  as specifically
     refer to TIGP.

          (b)   Each  Outside  Selling  Stockholder agrees,  severally  and  not
     jointly, to indemnify and  hold harmless each Underwriter and  each person,
     if any, who  controls any Underwriter within the meaning  of either Section
     15 of  the Securities  Act or  Section  20 of  the Exchange  Act, from  and
     against any and  all losses,  claims, damages  and liabilities  (including,

                                       21

<PAGE>

     without  limitation, any  legal  or other  expenses reasonably  incurred in
     connection with defending or investigating any such action or claim) caused
     by any  untrue statement  or alleged  untrue statement  of a material  fact
     contained  in the  Registration  Statement or  any  amendment thereof,  any
     preliminary prospectus or the Prospectus (as amended or supplemented if the
     Company  shall have  furnished any amendments  or supplements  thereto), or
     caused by any omission or alleged omission to state therein a material fact
     required to be stated therein or  necessary to make the statements  therein
     not misleading, but  only with  reference to information  relating to  such
     Outside Selling Stockholder  furnished in writing by  or on behalf of  such
     Outside  Selling   Stockholder  expressly  for  use   in  the  Registration
     Statement, any preliminary  prospectus, the Prospectus or any amendments or
     supplements thereto;  PROVIDED, HOWEVER, that,  with respect to  any untrue
     statement  or alleged untrue statement or omission or alleged omission made
     in any preliminary prospectus, the foregoing indemnity agreement shall  not
     inure to the benefit of any  Underwriter from whom the person asserting any
     such losses, claims, damages or liabilities purchased the Shares concerned,
     or any  person controlling such  Underwriter, to the  extent that any  such
     loss, claim, damage  or liability of such Underwriter results from the fact
     that a  copy of the Prospectus  (or Prospectus as amended  or supplemented)
     was not sent or given to such person, if required by the Securities  Act so
     to have been delivered, at or prior to the written confirmation of the sale
     of such  Shares to such person  and the untrue statement  or alleged untrue
     statement  or omission or alleged omission was corrected in such Prospectus
     (or Prospectus as amended  or supplemented), if the Company  had previously
     made  available  copies of  such Prospectus  (or  Prospectus as  amended or
     supplemented) to such Underwriter.

          (c)   Each Selling  Stockholder agrees, severally and not jointly,  in
     proportion  to the number of Shares to  be sold by such Selling Stockholder
     hereunder, to indemnify and  hold harmless the Company, its  directors, its
     officers who sign the  Registration Statement and each person, if  any, who
     controls  the Company  within  the meaning  of  either  Section 15  of  the
     Securities Act or Section 20 of the  Exchange Act, from and against any and
     all losses, claims, damages and liabilities (including, without limitation,
     any  legal  or  other  expenses  reasonably  incurred  in  connection  with
     defending or  investigating any such action or  claim) caused by any untrue
     statement or alleged untrue  statement of a material fact  contained in the
     Registration Statement or any amendment thereof, any preliminary prospectus
     or the  Prospectus (as amended  or supplemented  if the Company  shall have
     furnished any amendments or supplements thereto), or caused by any omission
     or alleged  omission to state therein a material fact required to be stated
     therein or necessary  to make  the statements therein  not misleading,  but
     only  with reference  to information  relating to such  Selling Stockholder
     furnished in writing by  or on behalf of such Selling Stockholder expressly
     for  use  in the  Registration Statement,  any preliminary  prospectus, the
     Prospectus or any amendments or supplements thereto.

                                       22

<PAGE>

          (d)   Each Underwriter agrees, severally and not jointly, to indemnify
     and hold  harmless the  Company, its directors,  its officers who  sign the
     Registration Statement,  each  person, if  any,  who controls  the  Company
     within the meaning of either Section 15 of the Securities Act or Section 20
     of the Exchange Act, and the  Selling Stockholders from and against any and
     all losses, claims, damages and liabilities (including, without limitation,
     any  legal  or  other  expenses  reasonably  incurred  in  connection  with
     defending  or investigating any such action or  claim) caused by any untrue
     statement or alleged  untrue statement of a material fact  contained in the
     Registration Statement or any amendment thereof, any preliminary prospectus
     or the Prospectus  (as amended or  supplemented if the  Company shall  have
     furnished any amendments or supplements thereto), or caused by any omission
     or alleged omission to state therein a material fact required  to be stated
     therein or necessary  to make  the statements therein  not misleading,  but
     only with reference  to information relating to  such Underwriter furnished
     to the Company in writing by such Underwriter through you expressly for use
     in the  Registration Statement, any preliminary  prospectus, the Prospectus
     or any amendments or supplements thereto

          (e)   In   case    any   proceeding    (including   any   governmental
     investigation) shall be instituted involving any person in respect of which
     indemnity may be  sought pursuant to  Section 9(a), (b),  (c) or (d),  such
     person (the "Indemnified Party")  shall promptly notify the person  against
     whom such indemnity may be sought (the "Indemnifying Party") in writing and
     the Indemnifying Party, upon request of the Indemnified Party, shall retain
     counsel  reasonably satisfactory to the Indemnified  Party to represent the
     Indemnified  Party and any others  the Indemnifying Party  may designate in
     such proceeding and shall pay the reasonable fees and disbursements of such
     counsel   related  to  such  proceeding.    In  any  such  proceeding,  any
     Indemnified Party shall have the  right to retain its own counsel,  but the
     fees  and expenses  of  such  counsel  shall  be at  the  expense  of  such
     Indemnified  Party unless  (i) the  Indemnifying Party and  the Indemnified
     Party shall have mutually agreed  to the retention of such counsel  and the
     payment of  its fees  or  (ii) the  named parties  to  any such  proceeding
     (including  any impleaded parties) include both  the Indemnifying Party and
     the  Indemnified Party  and  representation of  both  parties by  the  same
     counsel  would  be inappropriate  due  to  actual  or  potential  differing
     interests between them.  It is understood that the Indemnifying Party shall
     not,  in  respect  of  the  legal  expenses  of  any  Indemnified  Party in
     connection  with  any  proceeding  or  related  proceedings  in  the   same
     jurisdiction, be liable for the fees and expenses of more than one separate
     firm (in  addition to any local  counsel) for (i) all  Underwriters and all
     persons, if any, who control  any Underwriter within the meaning of  either
     Section 15  of the Securities Act  or Section 20 of the  Exchange Act, (ii)
     the  Company,  its  directors,  its  officers  who  sign  the  Registration
     Statement  and each  person, if  any, who  controls the Company  within the
     meaning of either  such Section and (iii) all Selling  Stockholders and all
     persons, if any, who control any Selling  Stockholder within the meaning of
     either such  Sections of  the  Exchange Act,  and that  all  such fees  and
     expenses shall be reimbursed as they are incurred.  In the case of any such
     separate  firm   for  the   Underwriters  and   such  control   persons  of
     Underwriters, such firm shall  be designated in writing by Morgan Stanley &
     Co. Incorporated.   In the case of any such separate  firm for the Company,

                                       23

<PAGE>

     and  such directors, officers and control persons of the Company, such firm
     shall be designated  in writing by  the Company.  In  the case of  any such
     separate  firm for the Selling Stockholders and such controlling persons of
     the Selling Stockholders, such  firm shall be designated in writing  by the
     persons named as attorneys-in-fact for  the Selling Stockholders under  the
     Powers of Attorney.   The Indemnifying  Party shall not  be liable for  any
     settlement of any proceeding  effected without its written consent,  but if
     settled  with  such  consent  or  if there  be  a  final  judgment  for the
     plaintiff, the Indemnifying Party agrees to indemnify the Indemnified Party
     from and  against any  loss or  liability by reason  of such  settlement or
     judgment.   Notwithstanding  the  foregoing sentence,  if  at any  time  an
     Indemnified  Party shall have requested  an Indemnifying Party to reimburse
     the Indemnified Party for fees and  expenses of counsel as contemplated  by
     the  second and third sentences  of this paragraph,  the Indemnifying Party
     agrees  that  it shall  be  liable  for any  settlement  of  any proceeding
     effected without its written consent if (i) such settlement is entered into
     more than 30 days after receipt by such Indemnifying Party of the aforesaid
     request  and (ii)  such Indemnifying  Party shall  not have  reimbursed the
     Indemnified Party in accordance with such request prior to the date of such
     settlement.  No Indemnifying Party shall, without the prior written consent
     of  the  Indemnified  Party,  effect  any  settlement  of  any  pending  or
     threatened proceeding in respect of which any Indemnified Party is or could
     have been  a party and indemnity  could have been sought  hereunder by such
     Indemnified Party, unless such settlement includes an unconditional release
     of such Indemnified Party from all liability on claims that are the subject
     matter of such proceeding.

          (f)   If the indemnification provided for in Section 9(a), (b), (c) or
     (d) is  unavailable to an Indemnified  Party or insufficient  in respect of
     any losses, claims, damages  or liabilities referred to therein,  then each
     Indemnifying  Party under  such  paragraph, in  lieu  of indemnifying  such
     Indemnified  Party  thereunder,  shall  contribute to  the  amount  paid or
     payable by  such Indemnified  Party  as a  result of  such losses,  claims,
     damages  or liabilities (i) in such proportion as is appropriate to reflect
     the relative benefits  received by the Indemnifying Party or Parties on the
     one hand  and the Indemnified Party or  Parties on the other  hand from the
     offering of  the Shares or  (ii) if the  allocation provided by  clause (i)
     above is  not  permitted  by  applicable law,  in  such  proportion  as  is
     appropriate to reflect not only the relative benefits referred to in clause
     (i) above but also the relative  fault of the Indemnifying Party or Parties
     on the one  hand and of the Indemnified Party or  Parties on the other hand
     in  connection with  the  statements or  omissions  that resulted  in  such
     losses,  claims,  damages or  liabilities, as  well  as any  other relevant
     equitable considerations.  The relative benefits received by the Sellers on
     the one hand and  the Underwriters on the other hand in connection with the
     offering  of the  Shares  shall be  deemed  to be  in  the same  respective
     proportions as  the net proceeds  from the  offering of the  Shares (before
     deducting  expenses) received  by each  Seller and  the  total underwriting
     discounts and commissions received by the Underwriters, in each case as set
     forth in the  table on the cover  of the Prospectus, bear to  the aggregate
     Public Offering Price of the Shares.  The  relative fault of the Sellers on
     the one hand and the Underwriters on the other hand shall be determined  by
     reference  to, among  other things,  whether the  untrue or  alleged untrue
     statement of a material fact or the omission or alleged omission to state a
     material  fact relates  to information supplied  by the  Sellers or  by the
     Underwriters  and  the  parties'  relative  intent,  knowledge,  access  to
     information  and  opportunity to  correct  or  prevent  such  statement  or
     omission.  The Underwriters'  respective obligations to contribute pursuant
     to  this Section 9  are several in  proportion to the  respective number of
     Shares they have purchased hereunder, and not joint.

                                       24

<PAGE>

          (g)   The Sellers and the Underwriters agree that it would not be just
     or equitable if contribution  pursuant to this Section 9 were determined by

                                       19
     PRO RATA allocation  (even if the  Underwriters were treated as  one entity
     for such  purpose) or by any other method  of allocation that does not take
     account of the equitable considerations referred  to in Section 9(f).   The
     amount paid or payable by  an Indemnified Party as a result of  the losses,
     claims, damages  and liabilities referred  to in the  immediately preceding
     paragraph shall be deemed to include, subject to the  limitations set forth
     above,  any legal or other expenses reasonably incurred by such Indemnified
     Party  in connection  with investigating  or defending  any such  action or
     claim.   Notwithstanding the provisions  of this Section  9, no Underwriter
     shall be required to contribute any amount in excess of the amount by which
     the total price  at which the Shares underwritten by  it and distributed to
     the  public were offered  to the public  exceeds the amount  of any damages
     that such Underwriter has otherwise been required to pay by  reason of such
     untrue or  alleged untrue  statement or omission  or alleged omission.   No
     person  guilty  of  fraudulent  misrepresentation (within  the  meaning  of
     Section 11(f) of the Securities Act) shall be entitled to contribution from
     any person  who was not  guilty of such fraudulent  misrepresentation.  The
     remedies  provided for in  this Section 9  are not exclusive  and shall not
     limit any  rights or  remedies  which may  otherwise  be available  to  any
     Indemnified Party at law or in equity.

          (h)   The  indemnity  and  contribution  provisions contained in  this
     Section 9 and  the representations and  warranties of the  Company and  the
     Selling Stockholders contained in this Agreement shall remain operative and
     in  full  force  and  effect  regardless of  (i)  any  termination  of this
     Agreement, (ii) any  investigation made by or on behalf  of any Underwriter
     or any person controlling  any Underwriter, any Selling Stockholder  or any
     person controlling any Selling Stockholder, or the Company, its officers or
     directors or any person controlling the Company and (iii) acceptance of and
     payment for any of the Shares.

          (i)   Notwithstanding  anything to  the contrary contained herein, the
     aggregate liability of any Selling  Stockholder pursuant to the  provisions
     of this Section 9 and with respect to any breaches  of the representations,
     warranties  and  agreements  contained  in  Sections  2A,  2B  and  2C  (as
     applicable), except for liability resulting  from the willful misconduct or
     intentional  action of such Selling Stockholder, shall not exceed an amount
     equal  to  the  total price  at  which  the  Shares  sold by  such  Selling
     Stockholder  hereunder were  offered  to  the  public.    In  addition,  an
     Underwriter  or person controlling an Underwriter shall not bring any claim
     against any Selling Stockholder under this Section 9 or with respect to any
     breach  of a representation, warranty or agreement contained in Section 2A,

                                       25

<PAGE>

     2B or 2C (as applicable), except for a claim caused by or arising out of an
     untrue statement or  omission or  alleged untrue statement  or omission  in
     such  parts of  the Registration  Statement or  Prospectus as  specifically
     refer  to  such  Selling  Stockholder,  unless   (a)  such  Underwriter  or
     controlling person shall have first submitted such claim to the Company and
     (b) the Company shall not, within 45 days, (i) have paid such claim in full
     or (ii) be  otherwise fully satisfying its indemnification obligations with
     respect to  such claim (by  assuming the defense  of any  proceeding giving
     rise to such  claim or otherwise as set forth in this Section 9); provided,
     however,  that if  at any time  thereafter the  Company is  no longer fully
     satisfying its indemnification obligations with respect to such claim, such
     Underwriter or controlling person may  immediately bring such claim against
     such Selling Stockholder.

     10.  TERMINATION.  This Agreement shall be subject to termination by notice
given by  you to the Company,  if (a) after  the execution and delivery  of this
Agreement and  prior to the Closing  Date (i) trading generally  shall have been
suspended or  materially limited on or  by, as the case  may be, any  of the New
York  Stock Exchange, the American  Stock Exchange, the  National Association of
Securities Dealers, Inc.,  the Chicago  Board of Options  Exchange, the  Chicago
Mercantile  Exchange or  the  Chicago  Board  of  Trade,  (ii)  trading  of  any
securities of the  Company shall have been  suspended on any exchange or  in any

                                       20
over-the-counter  market,  (iii)  a  general moratorium  on  commercial  banking
activities  in New York shall  have been declared by  either Federal or New York
State authorities or (iv) there shall  have occurred any outbreak or  escalation
of  hostilities or  any change in  financial markets  or any  calamity or crisis
that, in your judgment,  is material and adverse and  (b) in the case of  any of
the  events specified in  clauses (a)(i) through  (iv) of this  Section 10, such
event  singly or together with any other  such event makes it, in your judgment,
impracticable to market  the Shares on the terms and  in the manner contemplated
in the Prospectus.

     11.  EFFECTIVENESS; DEFAULTING UNDERWRITERS.   This Agreement shall  become
effective upon the execution and delivery hereof by the parties hereto.

     If, on the Closing Date or the Option Closing Date, as the case may be, any
one or more  of the Underwriters shall fail or refuse to purchase Shares that it
or they have agreed to purchase hereunder on such date, and the aggregate number
of Shares which such defaulting Underwriter or Underwriters agreed but failed or
refused to purchase  is not more than  one-tenth of the aggregate  number of the
Shares  to be purchased on such date,  the other Underwriters shall be obligated
severally in the  proportions that the number of Firm  Shares set forth opposite
their  respective names  in Schedule  I or  Schedule II  bears to  the aggregate
number of Firm  Shares set forth  opposite the names  of all such  nondefaulting
Underwriters, or in  such other proportions as you may  specify, to purchase the
Shares  which such defaulting Underwriter  or Underwriters agreed  but failed or
refused  to purchase on such date; PROVIDED that in no event shall the number of
Shares that any Underwriter has agreed to purchase pursuant to this Agreement be
increased pursuant  to this Section  11 by an  amount in excess  of one-ninth of
such number  of Shares without the written consent  of such Underwriter.  If, on
the Closing Date or the Option Closing Date, as the case may be, any Underwriter
or Underwriters shall fail or  refuse to purchase Firm Shares and  the aggregate
number of  Firm Shares with  respect to which such  default occurs is  more than
one-tenth of  the aggregate number of Firm Shares to  be purchased on such date,
and arrangements satisfactory to  you, the Company and the  Selling Stockholders
for  the purchase of  such Firm Shares are  not made within  36 hours after such
default, this  Agreement shall terminate  without liability on  the part of  any

                                       26

<PAGE>

non-defaulting Underwriter, the  Company or  the Selling Stockholders.   In  any
such case  either you or the relevant  Sellers shall have the  right to postpone
the Closing Date or the Option Closing Date, as the case may be, but in no event
for longer than seven days,  in order that the required changes, if  any, in the
Registration Statement  and  in the  Prospectus  or in  any  other documents  or
arrangements  may  be effected.    If,  on the  Option  Closing  Date, any  U.S.
Underwriter or Underwriters shall  fail or refuse to purchase  Additional Shares
and the aggregate number of Additional Shares with respect to which such default
occurs is more than one-tenth of the aggregate number of Additional Shares to be
purchased, the non-defaulting  U.S. Underwriters  shall have the  option to  (i)
terminate  their  obligation hereunder  to  purchase Additional  Shares  or (ii)
purchase not less  than the number of Additional Shares that such non-defaulting
U.S. Underwriters would have been  obligated to purchase in the absence  of such
default.   Any  action  taken  under  this  Section 11  shall  not  relieve  any
defaulting  Underwriter from  liability  in  respect  of  any  default  of  such
Underwriter under this Agreement.

     If this Agreement shall be terminated  by the Underwriters, or any of them,
because of any failure or refusal on the  part of any Seller to comply with  the
terms  or to fulfill  any of  the conditions  of this Agreement,  or if  for any
reason  any Seller  shall  be  unable  to perform  its  obligations  under  this
Agreement, the Company will  reimburse the Underwriters or such  Underwriters as
have so terminated this Agreement with respect to themselves, severally, for all
out-of-pocket expenses (including  the fees and disbursements  of their counsel)
reasonably  incurred by such Underwriters  in connection with  this Agreement or
the offering contemplated hereunder.

     12.  COUNTERPARTS.    This  Agreement   may  be  signed  in  two   or  more
counterparts, each of which shall be an original, with the same effect as if the
signatures thereto and hereto were upon the same instrument.

     13.  APPLICABLE LAW.   This Agreement shall be governed by and construed in
accordance with the internal laws of the State of New York.

     14.  HEADINGS.   The Headings of  the Sections of this  Agreement have been
inserted for  convenience of reference only  and shall not  be deemed a  part of
this Agreement.

                                       27

<PAGE>

                         Very truly yours,

                         TELETECH HOLDINGS, INC.


                         By___________________________________
                                   a duly authorized signatory

                         The Selling Stockholders named in
                         Schedule III hereto, acting severally


                         By___________________________________
                                        Attorney-in-fact

Accepted, as of the date hereof

MORGAN STANLEY & CO. INCORPORATED
ALEX. BROWNS & SONS INCORPORATED
SMITH BARNEY INC.

Acting severally on behalf of themselves
and the several U.S. Underwriters named
in Schedule I hereto.

     By   Morgan Stanley & Co. Incorporated


          By  ______________________________
                a duly authorized signatory

MORGAN STANLEY & CO. INTERNATIONAL LIMITED
ALEX. BROWN & SONS INCORPORATED
SMITH BARNEY INC.

Acting on behalf of themselves and the
several International Underwriters
named in Schedule II hereto.

     By   Morgan Stanley & Co. International Limited


          By  ______________________________
                a duly authorized signatory


                                       28

<PAGE>


                                   Schedule I

                               U.S. UNDERWRITERS


                                              NUMBER OF
                                             FIRM SHARES
               UNDERWRITER                 TO BE PURCHASED
               -----------                 ---------------
 Morgan Stanley & Co. Incorporated
 Alex. Brown & Sons Incorporated
 Smith Barney Inc.




                                             -------------
      Total U.S. Firm Shares . . . . . . . .     4,880,000
                                             -------------
                                             -------------



<PAGE>

                                Schedule II

                       INTERNATIONAL UNDERWRITERS

                                                   Number of
                                                  Firm Shares
                  Underwriter                   To Be Purchased
                  -----------                   ---------------
 Morgan Stanley & Co. International Limited
 Alex. Brown & Sons Incorporated
 Smith Barney Inc.








                                                   -------------
           Total International Firm Shares. . .        1,220,000
                                                   -------------
                                                   -------------



<PAGE>


                              Schedule III

                          SELLING STOCKHOLDERS

                                                         Number of
                                                        Firm Shares
                     Selling Stockholder                To Be Sold
                     -------------------                ------------
            Kenneth D. Tuchman                             1,000,000

            TeleTech Investors General
            Partnership                                      950,000


            Hinsdale Corporation Sdn Berhard                 100,000


            Jack Silverman                                    50,000
                                                   -----------------
                 Total  . . . . . . . . . . . . .          2,100,000
                                                   -----------------
                                                   -----------------



<PAGE>
                                                                     EXHIBIT 3.1
                                     Form of
                                    RESTATED
                          CERTIFICATE OF INCORPORATION
                                       OF
                             TELETECH HOLDINGS, INC.


     TELETECH HOLDINGS, INC., a Delaware corporation, for the purposes
hereinafter stated, under and pursuant to the provisions of the General
Corporation Law of the State of Delaware, as amended, does hereby certify as
follows:

     1.   The name of the corporation (the "Corporation") is TeleTech Holdings,
Inc.

     2.   The original Certificate of Incorporation was filed with the Secretary
of State of the State of Delaware on December 22, 1994.

     3.   Pursuant to Sections 242 and 245 of the General Corporation Law of the
State of Delaware, as amended, this Restated Certificate of Incorporation
restates and integrates and further amends the provisions of the original
Certificate of Incorporation of the Corporation.

     4.   This Restated Certificate of Incorporation was duly adopted by written
consents of the stockholders in accordance with the applicable provisions of
Sections 228, 242 and 245 of the General Corporation Law of the State of
Delaware, as amended, and written notice of the adoption of this Restated
Certificate of Incorporation has been given as provided by Section 228 of the
General Corporation Law of the State of Delaware, as amended, to every
stockholder entitled to such notice.

     5.   The text of the Certificate of Incorporation of the Corporation is
hereby restated and further amended to read in its entirety as follows:

                                   ARTICLE ONE
                               NAME OF CORPORATION

     The name of the Corporation is TeleTech Holdings, Inc.

                                   ARTICLE TWO
                           ADDRESS OF REGISTERED AGENT

     The address of the Corporation's registered office in the State of Delaware
is Corporation Trust Center, 1209 Orange Street, in the City of Wilmington,
County of New Castle.  The name of its registered agent at such address is The
Corporation Trust Company.

<PAGE>

                                  ARTICLE THREE
                                     PURPOSE

     The nature of the business or purposes to be conducted or promoted is to
engage in any lawful act or activity for which corporations may be organized
under the General Corporation Law of the State of Delaware, as amended.  The
Corporation shall have perpetual existence.

                                  ARTICLE FOUR
                                      STOCK

     A.   AUTHORIZED STOCK.  The total number of shares of stock which the
Corporation shall have authority to issue is 160,000,000, of which 150,000,000
shares with $0.01 per share par value are designated as Common Stock and
10,000,000 shares of $0.01 per share par value are designated as Preferred
Stock.

     B.   RIGHT TO DESIGNATE PREFERRED STOCK.  The board of directors of the
Corporation is authorized, subject to limitations prescribed by law, to provide
by resolution or resolutions for the issuance of the shares of Preferred Stock
as a class or in series and, by filing a certificate of designations, pursuant
to the General Corporation Law of the State of Delaware, as amended, setting
forth a copy of such resolution or resolutions to establish from time to time
the number of shares to be included in each such series, and to fix the
designation, powers, preferences, and rights of the shares of the class or of
each such series and the qualifications, limitations, and restrictions thereof.
The authority of the board of directors with respect to the class or each series
shall include, but not be limited to, determination of the following:

          1.   the number of shares constituting any series and the distinctive
designation of that series;

          2.   the dividend rate on the shares of the class or of any series,
whether dividends shall be cumulative, and, if so, from which date or dates, and
the relative rights of priority, if any, of payment of dividends on shares of
the class or of that series;

          3.   whether the class or any series shall have voting rights, in
addition to the voting rights provided by law, and, if so, the terms of such
voting rights;

          4.   whether the class or any series shall have conversion privileges
and, if so, the terms and conditions of conversion, including provision for
adjustment of the conversion rate in such events as the board of directors shall
determine;

          5.   whether or not the shares of the class or of any series shall be
redeemable, and, if so, the terms and conditions of such redemption, including
the date or date upon or after which they shall be redeemable and the amount per
share payable in case of redemption, which amount may vary under different
conditions and at different redemption dates;

                                        2

<PAGE>

          6.   whether the class or any series shall have a sinking fund for the
redemption or purchase of shares of the class or of that series, and, if so, the
terms and amount of such sinking fund;

          7.   the rights of the shares of the class or of any series in the
event of voluntary or involuntary dissolution or winding up of the Corporation,
and the relative rights of priority, if any, of payment of shares of the class
or of that series; and

          8.   any other powers, preferences, rights, qualifications,
limitations, and restrictions of the class or of any series.

                                  ARTICLE FIVE
                                     BY-LAWS

     In furtherance and not in limitation of the powers conferred by statute,
the board of directors shall have the power, both before and after receipt of
any payment for any of the Corporation's capital stock, to adopt, amend, repeal
or otherwise alter the By-laws of the Corporation without any action on the part
of the stockholders; provided, however, that the grant of such power to the
board of directors shall not divest the stockholders of nor limit their power to
adopt, amend, repeal or otherwise alter the By-laws.

                                   ARTICLE SIX
                              ELECTION OF DIRECTORS


     Elections of directors need not be by written ballot except and to the
extent provided in the By-laws of the Corporation.

                                  ARTICLE SEVEN
                             LIABILITY OF DIRECTORS

     To the fullest extent permitted by the General Corporation Law of the State
of Delaware, as amended from time to time, a director of the Corporation shall
not be liable to the Corporation or its stockholders for monetary damages for
breach of fiduciary duty as a director.  No amendment to or repeal of this
Article Seven shall apply to or have any effect on the liability or alleged
liability of any director of the Corporation for or with respect to any acts or
omission of such director occurring prior to such amendment.

                                  ARTICLE EIGHT
                                 INDEMNIFICATION

     The Corporation shall indemnify all directors, officers, employees and
agents of the Corporation, and shall advance expenses reasonably incurred by
such directors, officers, employees and agents in defending any civil, criminal,
administrative or investigative action, suit or proceeding, in accordance with
and to the fullest extent permitted by Section 145 of the

                                        3

<PAGE>

General Corporation Law of the State of Delaware, as amended from time to time.
Any repeal or modification of the provisions of this Article Eight shall not
adversely affect any right or protection hereunder of any person in respect of
any act or omission occurring prior to the time of such repeal or modification.

                                  ARTICLE NINE
                            DISSOLUTION; LIQUIDATION

     Whenever a compromise or arrangement is proposed between the Corporation
and its creditors or any class of them and/or between the Corporation and its
stockholders or any class of them, any court of equitable jurisdiction within
the State of Delaware may, on the application in a summary way of the
Corporation or of any creditor or stockholder thereof or on the application of
any receiver or receivers appointed for the Corporation under the provisions of
Section 291 of Title 8 of the Delaware Code or on the application of trustees in
dissolution or of any receiver or receivers appointed for the Corporation under
the provisions of Section 279 of Title 8 of the Delaware Code order a meeting of
the creditors or class of creditors, and/or of the stockholders or class of
stockholders of the Corporation, as the case may be, to be summoned in such
manner as the said court directs.  If a majority in number representing three-
fourths (3/4) in value of the creditors or class of creditors, and/or of the
stockholders or class of stockholders of the Corporation, as the case may be,
agree to any compromise or arrangement and to any reorganization of the
Corporation as consequence of such compromise or arrangement, the said
compromise or arrangement and the said reorganization shall, if sanctioned by
the court to which the said application has been made, be binding on all the
creditors or class of creditors, and/or on all the stockholders or class of
stockholders of the Corporation, as the case may be, and also on the
Corporation.

     IN WITNESS WHEREOF, TeleTech Holdings, Inc. has caused this Certificate to
be signed by the President and the Secretary on _____________ ___, 1996.

                              TELETECH HOLDINGS, INC., a Delaware corporation


                              By:  _______________________________________
                                   Kenneth Tuchman, Chairman of the Board,
                                   President and Chief Executive Officer

ATTEST:


By:  ___________________________________
     Jo-Nell Labbienti,
     Secretary

                                        4

<PAGE>
                                                                     EXHIBIT 3.2


                                     FORM OF
                              AMENDED AND RESTATED
                                     BY-LAWS
                                       OF
                            TELETECH  HOLDINGS, INC.


                                    ARTICLE I
                                     OFFICES

     Section 1.     REGISTERED OFFICE.  The registered office of the Corporation
in the State of Delaware shall be located at the Corporation Trust Center, 1209
Orange Street, City of Wilmington, County of New Castle.  The name of the
Corporation's registered agent at such address shall be The Corporation Trust
Company.  The registered office and/or agent of the Corporation may be changed
from time to time by action of the Board of Directors.

     Section 2.     OTHER OFFICES.  The Corporation also may have offices at
such other places, either within or without the State of Delaware, as from time
to time the Board of Directors may determine or the business of the Corporation
may require.

                                   ARTICLE II
                                  STOCKHOLDERS

     Section 1.     PLACE AND TIME OF MEETING.  An annual meeting of the
stockholders shall be held each year within one hundred twenty (120) days after
the close of the immediately preceding fiscal year of the Corporation for the
purpose of electing directors and for the transaction of such other business as
may properly come before the meeting.  The date, time and place of the annual
meeting shall be determined by the Board of Directors of the Corporation.  If
the election of directors shall not be held on the day designated for any annual
meeting, or at any adjournment thereof, the Board of Directors shall cause the
election to be held at a meeting of stockholders on a day as soon thereafter as
may be convenient.

     Section 2.     SPECIAL MEETINGS.  Special meetings of stockholders may be
called for any purpose and may be held at such time and place, within or without
the State of Delaware, as shall be stated in a notice of meeting or in a duly
executed waiver of notice thereof.  Such meetings may be called by the Chairman
of the Board, the President, or any Vice President or by the Secretary upon the
request of a majority of the Board of Directors.

     Section 3.     PLACE OF MEETING.  The Board of Directors may designate any
place, either within or without the State of Delaware, as the place of meeting
for any annual meeting or for any special meeting of stockholders called by the
Board of Directors. If no designation is made, or if a special meeting be
otherwise

<PAGE>

called, the place of meeting shall be the Corporation's principal place of
business.

     Section 4.     NOTICE OF MEETINGS.  Written or printed notice stating the
place, day and hour of the meeting, and in the case of a special meeting, the
purpose or purposes for which the meeting is called, shall be delivered, unless
otherwise provided by statute, not less than ten (10) nor more than sixty (60)
days before the date of the meeting, or in the case of a merger or
consolidation, not less than twenty (20) nor more than sixty (60) days before
the meeting or as otherwise provided by statute, either personally or by mail,
by or at the direction of the Board of Directors or persons calling the meeting
or as otherwise provided by statute, to each stockholder of record entitled to
vote at such meeting.  If mailed, such notice is given when deposited in the
United States mail, postage prepaid, directed to the stockholder at his address
as it appears on the records of the Corporation.

     Section 5.     RECORD DATE.  For the purpose of determining stockholders
entitled to notice of or to vote at any meeting of stockholders, or stockholders
entitled to receive payment of any dividend or other distribution, or in order
to make a determination of stockholders for any other proper purpose, the Board
of Directors may fix in advance a date as the record date for any such
determination of stockholders, such date in any case to be not more than sixty
(60) days and, unless otherwise provided by statute, in the case of a meeting of
stockholders, not less than ten (10) days immediately preceding such meeting, or
in the case of a merger or consolidation, not less than twenty (20) days
immediately preceding such meeting.  When a determination of stockholders
entitled to vote at any meeting of stockholders has been made as provided in
this Section 5, such determination shall apply to any adjournment thereof;
provided, however, that the Board of Directors may fix a new record date for the
adjourned meeting.

     Section 6.     VOTING LISTS.  The officer or agent having charge of the
transfer books for shares of stock of the Corporation shall make, at least ten
(10) days before each meeting of stockholders, a complete list of stockholders
entitled to vote at such meeting, arranged in alphabetical order, showing the
address of each stockholder, the number of shares registered in the name of each
stockholder and the number of votes each stockholder is entitled to cast.  Such
list shall be open to the examination of any stockholder, for any purpose
germane to the meeting, during ordinary business hours, for a period of at least
ten (10) days prior to the meeting, either at a place within the city where the
meeting is to be held, which place shall be specified in the notice of the
meeting or, if not so specified, at the place where the meeting is to be held.
The list shall also be produced and kept at the time and place of the meeting
during the whole time thereof, and may be inspected by any stockholder present
at the meeting.

                                       -2-

<PAGE>

     Section 7.     QUORUM AND MANNER OF ACTING.  Unless otherwise provided by
the Certificate of Incorporation, holders of a majority of the voting power of
the stock issued and outstanding and entitled to vote at a meeting thereof,
present in person or represented by proxy, shall constitute a quorum at all
meetings of the stockholders.  In the event a quorum is not present or
represented by proxy at any meeting of the stockholders, a majority of the
stockholders entitled to vote thereat, present in person or represented by
proxy, shall have the power to adjourn the meeting from time to time, without
notice other than announcement at the meeting at which adjournment is taken, of
the time and place of the adjourned meeting.  At the adjourned meeting, the
Corporation may transact any business which may have been transacted at the
original meeting.  If the adjournment is for more than thirty days, or if after
the adjournment a new record date is fixed for the adjourned meeting, a notice
of the adjourned meeting shall be given to each stockholder of record entitled
to vote at the meeting.

     Section 8.     VOTE REQUIRED.  If a quorum is present, the affirmative vote
of the holders of a majority of the voting power of the stock represented at
such meeting, whether present or by proxy, shall be the act of the stockholders,
unless the matter to be voted upon is one upon which, by express provision of
the Delaware General Corporation Law or of the Certificate of Incorporation, a
different vote is required, in which case such express provision shall determine
the vote required to effect such action.

     Section 9.     VOTING RIGHTS.  Each stockholder shall be entitled to one
vote for each share of voting capital stock held by such stockholder, except as
otherwise provided in the Certificate of Incorporation.  Each stockholder
entitled to vote shall be entitled to vote in person, or may authorize another
person or persons to act for him by proxy executed in writing by such
stockholder or by his duly authorized attorney-in-fact, but no such proxy shall
be voted or acted upon after three years from its date, unless the proxy
provides for a longer period.

     Section 10.    INFORMAL ACTION BY STOCKHOLDERS.  Any action required or
permitted to be taken at any annual or special meeting of stockholders may be
taken without a meeting thereof, without prior notice and without a vote, if a
consent in writing, setting forth the action so taken, shall be signed by the
holders of outstanding shares having not less than the minimum number of votes
that would be necessary to authorize or take such action at a meeting at which
all shares entitled to vote thereon were present and voted.  Prompt notice of
the taking of any action without a meeting by less than unanimous written
consent shall be given to those stockholders who have not consented in writing.

                                       -3-

<PAGE>

                                   ARTICLE III
                                    DIRECTORS

     Section 1.     POWERS.  The business and affairs of the Corporation shall
be managed by the Board of Directors, subject to such limitations as are imposed
by law, the Certificate of Incorporation or these By-laws.

     Section 2.     NUMBER, ELECTION AND TERM OF OFFICE.  The number of
directors which shall constitute the whole Board of Directors shall be not less
than two (2) nor more than nine (9) and shall be fixed from time to time, within
such minimum and maximum, by resolution adopted by a majority of the Board of
Directors.  Each director shall serve for a term ending on the date of the first
annual meeting following the annual meeting at which such director was elected
or until his successor is elected and qualified or until his earlier resignation
or removal.  Directors need not be stockholders.

     Section 3.     ANNUAL MEETING; REGULAR MEETINGS.  The annual meeting of the
Board of Directors shall be held, without notice other than this Section 3,
immediately after and at the same place as the annual meeting of stockholders.
The Board of Directors may provide, by resolution, the time and place, either
within or without the State of Delaware, for the holding of additional regular
meetings without notice other than such resolution.

     Section 4.     SPECIAL MEETINGS.  Special meetings of the Board of
Directors may be called at any time by the Chairman of the Board, the President
or a majority of directors.  The person or persons who call a special meeting of
the Board of Directors may designate any place, either within or without the
State of Delaware, as the place for holding such special meeting.  In the
absence of a designated meeting place, the place of meeting shall be the
Corporation's principal place of business.

     Section 5.     NOTICE OF SPECIAL MEETINGS.  A notice stating the place,
date and hour of a special meeting shall be mailed not less than five (5) days
before the date of the meeting, or shall be sent by telegram or facsimile or be
delivered personally or by telephone not less than two (2) days before the date
of the meeting, to each director, by or at the direction of the person or
persons calling the meeting.  Whenever notice is required to be given by law or
any provision of the Certificate of Incorporation or these By-laws, a written
waiver thereof, signed by the person entitled to notice, whether before or after
the time stated therein, shall be deemed equivalent to notice.  Attendance of a
director at any meeting shall constitute a waiver of notice of such meeting
except where a director attends a meeting for the express purpose of objecting
(which objection shall occur at the beginning of such meeting) to the
transaction of any business at such meeting because the meeting is not lawfully
called or convened.  Neither


                                       -4-

<PAGE>

the business to be transacted at, nor the purpose of, any meeting of the Board
of Directors or members of a committee of directors need by specified in the
waiver of notice of such meeting unless otherwise required by the Certificate of
Incorporation or these By-laws.

      Section 6.    QUORUM AND MANNER OF ACTION.  A majority of the number of
directors then in office shall constitute a quorum for the transaction of
business at any meeting of the Board of Directors; provided, that if less than a
majority of such number of directors are present at said meeting, a majority of
the directors present may adjourn the meeting from time to time without further
notice.  The act of the majority of the directors present at a meeting at which
a quorum is present shall be the act of the Board of Directors unless otherwise
provided in the Delaware General Corporation Law, the Certificate of
Incorporation or these By-laws.

     Section 7.     ACTION WITHOUT A MEETING BY DIRECTORS.  Any action which is
required by law or by these By-laws to be taken at a meeting of the Board of
Directors, or any other action which may be taken at a meeting of the Board of
Directors or any committee thereof, may be taken without a meeting if a consent
in writing, setting forth the action to be taken, shall be signed by all of the
directors entitled to vote with respect to the subject matter thereof, or by all
members of such committee, as the case may be.  Such consent shall have the same
force and effect as a unanimous vote of all directors or committee members, as
the case may be, at a duly called meeting thereof, and shall be filed with the
minutes of the proceedings of the Board of Directors or such committee, as
appropriate.

     Section 8.     TELEPHONIC MEETINGS.  Unless otherwise restricted by the
Certificate of Incorporation or these By-laws, members of the Board of Directors
or of any committee designated by the Board may participate in a meeting of the
Board or such committee, as the case may be, by means of conference telephone or
similar communications equipment by means of which all persons participating in
the meeting can hear each other.  Participation in a meeting pursuant to this
Section 8 shall constitute presence at such meeting.

     Section 9.     RESIGNATIONS.  Any director may resign at any time by giving
written notice to the Board of Directors, the Chairman of the Board or the
Secretary.  Such resignation shall take effect at the time specified therein.
The acceptance by the Board of Directors of such resignation shall not be
necessary to make it effective unless such resignation specifically states that
it shall take effect upon acceptance.

     Section 10.    VACANCIES.  Vacancies and newly-created directorships
resulting from any increase in the authorized number of directors may be filled
by a majority of the directors then in

                                       -5-

<PAGE>

office, although less than a quorum, or by a sole remaining director, and the
director(s) so chosen shall hold office until their successor(s) are elected and
qualified or until their earlier resignation or removal.

     Section 11.    REMOVAL.  Any director or the entire Board of Directors may
be removed, with or without cause, by the holders of a majority of the
outstanding shares of the Corporation then entitled to vote at an election of
directors.  Whenever the holders of any class or series are entitled to elect
one or more directors by the provisions of the Certificate of Incorporation, the
provisions of this Section shall apply, in respect of the removal without cause
of a director or directors so elected, to the vote of the holders of the
outstanding shares of that class or series and not to the vote or the
outstanding shares of the Corporation as a whole.

     Section 12.    INTERESTED DIRECTORS.

     (a)  No contract or transaction between the Corporation and one or more of
its directors or officers, or between the Corporation and any other Corporation,
partnership, association, or other organization in which one or more of the
Corporation's directors or officers are directors or officers, or have a
financial interest, shall be void or voidable solely because of the existence
thereof, or solely because a director or officer is present at or participates
in the meeting of the Board or a committee thereof which authorizes such a
contract or transaction, or solely because his or their votes are counted for
such purpose, if:

          (i)  the material facts as to such relationship or interest and as to
     the contract or transaction(s) are disclosed or are known to the Board of
     Directors or a committee thereof, as the case may be, and the Board or
     committee, as appropriate, in good faith authorizes the contract or
     transaction(s) by affirmative votes of a majority of the disinterested
     directors, even though the disinterested directors be less than a quorum;
     or

          (ii) the material facts as to the relationship or interest and as to
     the contract or transaction(s) are disclosed or are known to the
     stockholders entitled to vote thereon, and the contract or transaction(s)
     is specifically approved in good faith by vote of the stockholders; or

          (iii) the contract or transaction is fair as to the Corporation as of
     the time it is authorized, approved or ratified, by the Board of Directors,
     a committee thereof or the stockholders.

                                       -6-

<PAGE>

     (b)  Common or interested directors may be counted in determining the
presence of a quorum at a meeting of the Board of Directors or of a committee
thereof which authorizes a contract or transaction described in this Section 12.

                                   ARTICLE IV
                                   COMMITTEES

     Section 1.     APPOINTMENT AND POWERS.  The Board of Directors may, by
resolution passed by a majority of the whole Board, designate one or more
committees, each committee to consist of one or more of the directors of the
Corporation which, to the extent provided in said resolution or in these By-
laws, shall have and may exercise all the powers and authority of the Board of
Directors in the management of the business and affairs of the Corporation, and
may authorize the seal of the Corporation to be affixed to all papers which may
require it; provided, however, that (a) no such committee shall have the power
or authority in reference to (i) amend the Certificate of Incorporation (except
that any such committee may, to the extent authorized in the resolution or
resolutions providing for the issuance of shares of stock adopted by the Board
of Directors, fix the designations and any of the preferences or rights of such
shares relating to dividends, redemption, dissolution, any distribution of
assets of the Corporation or the conversion into, or the exchange of such shares
for, shares of any other class or classes or any other series of the same or any
other class or classes of stock of the Corporation or fix the number of shares
of any series of stock or authorize the increase or decease of the shares of any
series), (ii) adopt an agreement of merger or consolidation, (iii) recommend to
the stockholders the sale, lease or exchange of all or substantially all of the
Corporation's property and assets, (iv) recommend to the stockholders a
dissolution of the Corporation or a revocation thereof or (v) amend these By-
laws; and (b) unless the resolution, By-laws or Certificate of Incorporation
expressly so provides, no such committee shall have the power or authority to
declare a dividend, to authorize the issuance of stock, or to adopt a
certificate of ownership and merger pursuant to Section 253 of the Delaware
General Corporation Law.

     Section 2.     ABSENCE OR DISQUALIFICATION OF COMMITTEE MEMBER.  In the
absence or disqualification of any member of such committee, the member or
members thereof present at any meeting and not disqualified from voting, whether
or not they constitute a quorum, may unanimously appoint another member of the
Board of Directors to act at the meeting in the place of any such absent or
disqualified member.

     Section 3.     RECORD OF PROCEEDINGS.  Each committees shall keep regular
minutes of its proceedings and when required by the Board of Directors, report
the same to the Board of Directors.

                                       -7-

<PAGE>

                                    ARTICLE V
                                    OFFICERS

     Section 1.     NUMBER AND TITLES.  The officers of the Corporation shall be
elected by the Board of Directors and shall include a Chairman of the Board,
President, Chief Operating Officer, Secretary and Treasurer.  The Board of
Directors may also elect additional officers of the Corporation, including one
or more Vice Presidents and one or more Assistant Secretaries and Assistant
Treasurers.  The Board of Directors may elect such other officers and agents as
it shall deem necessary, who shall hold their offices for such terms and shall
exercise such powers and perform such duties as shall be determined from time to
time by the Board.  Any number of offices may be held by the same person.  The
officer designated as the Chief Financial Officer of the Corporation shall be
the Treasurer unless another officer is chosen to be the Treasurer.

     Section 2.     ELECTION, TERM OF OFFICE AND QUALIFICATIONS.  The officers
shall be elected annually by the Board of Directors at the first meeting of the
Board of Directors held after the annual meeting of stockholders or as soon
thereafter as may be convenient.  Vacancies may be filled or new offices created
and filled at any meeting of the Board of Directors.  Each officer shall be
elected to hold office until his successor shall have been elected and
qualified, or until his earlier death, resignation or removal.

     Section 3.     COMPENSATION.  The compensation, if any, of all officers of
the Corporation shall be fixed by the Board of Directors or, if created, the
Compensation Committee thereof.

     Section 4.     REMOVAL.  Any officer may be removed by the Board of
Directors whenever in its judgment the best interests of the Corporation will be
served thereby, but such removal shall be without prejudice to the contract
rights, if any, of the person so removed.

     Section 5.     RESIGNATION.  Any officer may resign at any time by giving
written notice to the Board of Directors, the President or the Secretary.  Such
resignation shall take effect at the time specified therein and, unless tendered
to take effect upon acceptance thereof, the acceptance of such resignation shall
not be necessary to make it effective.

     Section 6.     DUTIES OF OFFICERS.  The duties and powers of the officers
shall be as follows:

     (a)  CHAIRMAN OF THE BOARD.  Subject to the control of the Board of
Directors, the Chairman of the Board shall, in general, supervise and manage the
business and affairs of the Corporation and shall see that the resolutions and
directions of the Board of Directors are carried into effect.  Except in those
instances in

                                       -8-

<PAGE>

which the authority to execute is expressly delegated to another officer or
agent of the Corporation, or a different mode of execution is expressly
prescribed by the Board of Directors or these By-laws or otherwise required by
law, the Chairman may execute for the Corporation any contracts, agreements,
deeds, conveyances or other obligations or instruments of the Corporation which
the Board of Directors has authorized to be executed or the execution of which
is in the ordinary course of the Corporation's business, and the Chairman may
accomplish such execution either under or without the seal of the Corporation
and either individually or with the Secretary, any Assistant Secretary, or any
other officer thereunto authorized by the Board of Directors or these By-laws.
The Chairman shall preside at all meetings of the stockholders and of the Board
of Directors (and of any executive committee thereof), and shall perform such
other duties as from time to time shall be prescribed by the Board of Directors.

     (b)  PRESIDENT.  The President shall be the chief executive officer of the
Corporation and shall supervise the carrying out of the policies adopted or
approved by the Board of Directors.  The President shall have general executive
powers and shall have and may exercise any and all other powers and duties
pertaining by law, regulation or practice, to the office of President, or
imposed by these By-laws.  The President shall cause to be called regular and
special meetings of the stockholders and Board of Directors in accordance with
these By-laws and he shall preside at all such meetings.  The President also
shall have such further powers and duties as from time to time may be conferred
upon or assigned to the President by the Board of Directors.  The President
shall have the power and authority to execute all duly authorized contracts,
agreements, deeds, conveyances or other obligations or instruments of the
Corporation, except where required or permitted by law to be otherwise signed
and executed and except where the signing and execution thereof shall be
expressly delegated by the Board of Directors to some other officer or agent of
the Corporation.

     (c)  CHIEF OPERATING OFFICER.  The Chief Operating Officer shall be
responsible for formulating general policies and programs for the Corporation
for submission to the Board of Directors and for carrying out the programs and
policies approved by the Board of Directors.  He shall be responsible for the
administration and operation of the business and affairs of the Corporation.
The Chief Operating Officer shall have the power and authority to execute all
duly authorized contracts, agreements, deeds, conveyances or other obligations
or instruments of the Corporation, except where required or permitted by law to
be otherwise signed and executed and except where the signing and execution
thereof shall be expressly delegated by the Board of Directors to some other
officer or agent of the Corporation.  The Chief Operating Officer shall perform
such other duties and have such other powers as the President or the Board of
Directors may from time to time prescribe.

                                       -9-

<PAGE>

     (d)  VICE PRESIDENT.  The Board of Directors may appoint one or more Vice
Presidents, who may be designated as Executive Vice Presidents, Senior Vice
Presidents or Vice Presidents.  Each Vice President shall have such powers and
duties as may be assigned to him or her by the Board of Directors.  In the
absence or disability of the President, the Vice President (or in the event
there are more than one Vice Presidents, the Vice Presidents in the order
designated by the Board of Directors) shall perform the duties of the President
and, when so acting, shall have all the powers of and be subject to all the
restrictions upon the President.

     (e)  SECRETARY.  The Secretary shall attend all meetings of the Board of
Directors and all meetings of the stockholders and record all the proceedings of
the meetings of the Corporation and of the Board of Directors in a book to be
kept for that purpose and shall perform like duties for any committees if
required.  The Secretary shall give, or cause to be given, notice of all
meetings of the stockholders and of the Board of Directors, and shall perform
such other duties and have such other powers as the Board of Directors or the
President may from time to time prescribe.  The Secretary shall have custody of
the corporate seal of the Corporation, if any, and he or she, or an Assistant
Secretary, shall have authority to affix the same to any instrument requiring it
and, when so affixed, it may be attested by the Secretary's signature or by the
signature of such Assistant Secretary.  The Board of Directors may give general
authority to any other officer to affix the seal of the Corporation and to
attest the affixing by his or her signature.

     (f)  TREASURER.  The Treasurer shall have custody of the Corporation's
funds and securities and shall keep full and accurate accounts of receipts and
disbursements in books belonging to the Corporation and shall deposit all monies
and other valuable effects in the name and to the credit of the Corporation in
such depositories as may be designated by the Board of Directors.  The Treasurer
shall disburse the funds of the Corporation as may be ordered by the Board of
Directors, taking proper vouchers for such disbursements, and shall render to
the President and the Board of Directors at its regular meetings, or when the
Board of Directors so requires, an account of all his or her transactions as
Treasurer and the financial condition of the Corporation.

     If required by the Board of Directors, the Treasurer shall give the
Corporation and maintain a bond in such sum and with such surety or sureties as
shall be satisfactory to the Board of Directors for the faithful performance of
the duties of his or her office and for the restoration to the Corporation, in
case of his or her death, resignation, retirement or removal from office, of all
books, papers, vouchers, money and other property of whatever kind in his or her
possession or under his or her control belonging to the Corporation.

                                      -10-

<PAGE>

     (g)  ASSISTANT TREASURERS AND ASSISTANT SECRETARIES.  In the absences of
the Treasurer or Secretary or in the event of the inability of the Treasurer or
Secretary to act, the Assistant Treasurer and the Assistant Secretary (or in the
event there is more than one of either, in the order designated by the Board of
Directors or in the absence of such designation, in the order of their election)
shall perform the duties of the Treasurer and Secretary, respectively, and when
so acting, shall have all the authority of, and be subject to all restrictions
upon, such office.  The Assistant Treasurers and Assistant Secretaries shall
also perform such duties as from time to time may be prescribed by the Treasurer
or the Secretary, respectively, or by the President or the Board of Directors.
If required by the Board of Directors, an Assistant Treasurer shall give a bond
for the faithful discharge of his or her duties in such sum and with such surety
or sureties as the Board of Directors shall determine.

                                   ARTICLE VI
                              CERTIFICATES OF STOCK
                               AND THEIR TRANSFER

     Section 1.     STOCK CERTIFICATES.  Stock certificates shall be in such
form as determined by the Board of Directors and shall be signed by, or in the
name of the Corporation by, the President or a Vice President, and by the
Treasurer or an Assistant Treasurer, or the Secretary or and Assistant Secretary
of the Corporation.  Any or all of the signatures on the certificates may be a
facsimile.

     Section 2.     TRANSFER OF SHARES.  The shares of the Corporation shall be
transferable only on the books of the Corporation by the holder, in person or by
duly authorized attorney, on the surrender of the certificate or certificates
for such shares properly endorsed.  The Board of Directors shall have the power
to make all such rules and regulations, consistent with applicable law, as the
Board of Directors may deem appropriate concerning the issue, transfer and
registration of certificates for shares of the Corporation.  No new certificate
shall be issued until the former certificate or certificates for a like number
of shares shall have been surrendered and canceled, except that in the case of a
lost, wrongfully taken or mutilated certificate, a new one may be issued
therefor upon such terms and indemnity to the Corporation as the Board of
Directors or the President may prescribe consistent with applicable law.

                                   ARTICLE VII
                                    DIVIDENDS

     Subject to the provisions of the Delaware General Corporation Law and the
Certificate of Incorporation, the Board of Directors may declare and pay
dividends upon the shares of its capital stock.

                                      -11-

<PAGE>

Dividends may be paid in cash, in property, or in shares of the Corporation's
capital stock.

                                  ARTICLE VIII
                                   FISCAL YEAR

     The fiscal year of the Corporation shall be fixed by the Board of
Directors.

                                   ARTICLE IX
                                      SEAL

     The corporate seal shall have inscribed thereon the name of the Corporation
and the words "Corporate Seal" and "Delaware."  The seal may be used by causing
it or a facsimile thereof to be impressed or affixed or in any manner
reproduced.

                                    ARTICLE X
                            MISCELLANEOUS PROVISIONS

     Section 1.     CONTRACTS.     The Board of Directors or the President may
authorize any officer or agent to enter into any contract or execute and deliver
any instrument in the name of and on behalf of the Corporation in the ordinary
course of the Corporation's business and such authority may be general or
confined to a specific instance.

     Section 2.     LOANS.    No loan shall be contracted on behalf of the
Corporation and no evidence of indebtedness shall be issued in its name unless
authorized by the Board of Directors.  Such authority may be general or confined
to a specific instance.

     Section 3.     CHECKS, DRAFTS, ETC.,    All checks, drafts or other orders
for the payment of money, or notes or other evidences of indebtedness issued in
the name of the Corporation shall be signed by such officer or agent as shall
from time to time be authorized by the Board of Directors.

     Section 4.     DEPOSITS. The Board of Directors may select the banks, trust
companies or other depositaries of the funds of the Corporation.

     Section 5.     STOCK IN OTHER CORPORATIONS.  Shares of any other
Corporation which may from time to time be held by the Corporation may be
represented and voted by the President, or by any proxy appointed in writing by
the President, or by any other person or persons thereunto authorized by the
Board of Directors, at any meeting of stockholders of such Corporation or by
executing written consents with respect to such shares where stockholder action
may be taken by written consent.  Shares represented by certificates standing in
the name of the Corporation may be endorsed for sale or transfer in the name of
the Corporation by the

                                      -12-

<PAGE>

President or by any other officer thereunto authorized by the Board of
Directors.  Shares belonging to the Corporation need not stand in the name of
the Corporation, but may be held for the benefit of the Corporation in the name
of any nominee designated for such purpose by the Board of Directors.

                                   ARTICLE XI
                INDEMNIFICATION OF DIRECTORS, OFFICERS AND OTHERS

     Any person who was or is a party or is threatened to be made a party to any
threatened, pending or completed action, suit or proceeding, whether civil,
criminal, administrative or investigative, by reason of the fact that such
person is or was a director, officer, employee or agent of the Corporation, or
is or was serving at the request of the Corporation as a director, officer,
employee or agent of another corporation, partnership, joint venture, trust or
other enterprises, shall be indemnified by the Corporation to the fullest extent
permitted by law.

                                   ARTICLE XII
                                    AMENDMENT

     These By-laws may be altered, amended or repealed and new By-laws adopted
by the stockholders by vote at a meeting or by written consent without a meeting
and, subject to the power of the stockholders as aforesaid, by the Board of
Directors.


                                      -13-



<PAGE>


                                                                     EXHIBIT 4.2


                   STOCK TRANSFER AND REGISTRATION RIGHTS AGREEMENT


    THIS STOCK TRANSFER AND REGISTRATION RIGHTS AGREEMENT (this "AGREEMENT"),
dated as of January 1, 1996, among TeleTech Holdings, Inc., a Delaware
corporation (the "COMPANY"), Access 24 Holdings Pty Limited, an Australian
corporation ("ACCESS"), Bevero Pty Limited, an Australian corporation
("BEVERO"), and, solely for purposes of Section 3.6, Kenneth Tuchman, majority
stockholder of the Company ("TUCHMAN").

                                 W I T N E S S E T H:

    WHEREAS, as of the date hereof, after giving effect to the issuance of the
shares of common stock, par value $.01 per share, of the Company ("COMMON
STOCK") set forth on SCHEDULE A, 50,000,000 shares of Common Stock are
authorized, of which 8,140,000 shares are issued and outstanding and 2,860,000
shares are reserved for issuance upon conversion of convertible preferred stock
or stock options; 

    WHEREAS, pursuant to that certain Stock Purchase Agreement dated as of
January 1, 1996, the Company has purchased from Access and Bevero all of the
outstanding capital stock of Access 24 Service Corporation Pty Limited, a
corporation incorporated under the laws of New South Wales, Australia (the
"SUBSIDIARY");

    WHEREAS,  as part of the purchase price paid by the Company for the
Subsidiary, the Company has issued to Bevero and Access, pursuant to Section
3.4(a)(ii)(B) of the Investment Agreement (as defined herein), an aggregate of
194,048 shares of Common Stock; and 

    WHEREAS, in order to assure the harmonious management of the affairs of the
Company, each of Access, Bevero, the Company and, to the extent herein provided,
Tuchman desires to enter into this Agreement upon the terms and conditions
hereinafter set forth.

    NOW THEREFORE, in consideration of the premises, the mutual covenants,
representations, warranties and agreements set forth in this Agreement, and of
other good and valuable consideration, the receipt, sufficiency and adequacy of
which is hereby acknowledged, the parties hereto, intending legally to be bound,
hereby covenant and agree as follows:

                                      ARTICLE I
                                  DEFINITIONS; ETC.

    1.1  DEFINITIONS.  Except as otherwise herein expressly provided, the
following terms and phrases shall have the meanings set forth below:

         "AFFILIATE" means any Person who or which, directly or indirectly,
through one or more intermediaries, controls, is controlled by, or is under
common control with, such entity

<PAGE>

(the term "CONTROL" for these purposes meaning the ability, whether by ownership
of shares or other equity interests, by contract or otherwise, to elect a
majority of the directors of a corporation, to select the managing or general
partner of a partnership, or otherwise to select, or have the power to remove
and then select, a majority of those Persons exercising governing authority over
an entity).

         "BONA FIDE PURCHASER" means any Person (other than Affiliates of the
Stockholder proposing to Transfer its Common Stock) who or which has delivered a
good faith written offer to purchase for cash or cash equivalents a
Stockholder's Common Stock; PROVIDED, HOWEVER, that such Person has the
requisite financial resources necessary, in the reasonable opinion of the board
of directors of the Company, to purchase and acquire such Stockholder's Stock.

         "CAUSE" means (a) the commission by a director of an act of fraud or
embezzlement against the Subsidiary or the Company, (b) a conviction for a
felony (or a plea of NOLO CONTENDERE thereto) or guilty plea thereto of such
director, or (c) the failure by a director to discharge faithfully his fiduciary
and other duties as a director.

         "DAMAGES" means any losses, claims, damages, liabilities and expenses
whatsoever (including but not limited to reasonable attorneys' fees) and any and
all reasonable expenses whatsoever incurred in investigating, preparing or
defending against any litigation, commenced or threatened, or any claim
whatsoever and any and all amounts paid (with the approval of any indemnifying
party) in settlement of any claim or litigation).

         "EQUITY SECURITIES" means collectively (a) Common Stock, (b)
convertible preferred stock, par value $6.45 per share, of the Company
("Preferred Stock"), (c) any other equity securities issued by the Company,
whether now or hereafter authorized for issuance by the Company's Certificate of
Incorporation, (d) rights, options or warrants to subscribe for, purchase or
otherwise acquire Common Stock or any securities convertible into Common Stock,
and (e) any debt, hybrid or other securities issued by the Company that are
convertible into, exercisable for or exchangeable for any of the foregoing,
whether now or hereafter authorized for issuance by the Company's Certificate of
Incorporation.

         "INVESTMENT AGREEMENT" means that certain Investment Agreement dated
as of January 17, 1995 among Tuchman, the Company, Teletech Investors General
Partnership and Essaness Theatres Corporation, as the same may be amended from
time to time.

         "IPO" means an initial offering of Common Stock by the Company to the
public for cash pursuant to an effective registration statement under the
Securities Act (other than a registration on Form S-8 or S-4, or any successor
or similar form).

         "LAWS" means any statute, law, rule or regulation or any order, writ,
injunction or decree of any court or governmental authority resulting in or
relating to Damages.


                                         -2-

<PAGE>

         "LIEN" means any mortgage or deed of trust, pledge, hypothecation,
assignment, deposit arrangement, security interest, lien, charge, easement
(other than any easement not materially impairing usefulness or marketability),
encumbrance, preference, priority or other security agreement or preferential
arrangement of any kind or nature whatsoever (including, without limitation, any
conditional sale or other title retention agreement having substantially the
same economic effect as any of the foregoing).

         "OFFERED STOCK" means, as the case may be, all (a) Common Stock held
of record or beneficially by a Stockholder that is offered for Transfer by such
Stockholder (other than to an Affiliate pursuant to Section 3.3) or (b) Equity
Securities, now or hereafter held of record or beneficially by Tuchman, that are
offered for Transfer by Tuchman and that (i) are not offered for Transfer to a
Permitted Transferee (as defined in the Investment Agreement) of Tuchman and
(ii) have not been acquired by other holders of Priority Stock pursuant to
Section 3.3 of the Investment Agreement.

         "PERSON" means any individual, partnership, limited liability company,
corporation, trust or any other entity.

         "PRIORITY STOCK" means any Equity Securities held by Tuchman, Teletech
Investors General Partnership or Essaness Theatres Corporation (or any Permitted
Transferee (as defined in the Investment Agreement) of any of the foregoing),
which securities are covered by the terms of the Investment Agreement.

         "REGISTRABLE SECURITIES" means all Common Stock issued to the
Stockholders and any additional Common Stock issued to the Stockholders pursuant
to stock splits, stock dividends, recapitalizations and similar events.  As to
any particular Registrable Securities, once issued, Registrable Securities shall
cease to be Registrable Securities (a) when such Registrable Securities have
been registered under the Securities Act, the registration statement in
connection therewith has been declared effective and such Registrable Securities
have been disposed of pursuant to such effective registration statement, or (b)
when such Registrable Securities are distributed to the public pursuant to Rule
144 (or any similar provision then in force) under the Securities Act or can be
sold in accordance with paragraph (k) of Rule 144 and the requirements of
paragraphs (c), (e), (f) and (h) of Rule 144 shall not be applicable pursuant to
such paragraph (k) of Rule 144, or (c) when such Registrable Securities have
been purchased by the Company or shall cease to be outstanding.  For purposes of
this Agreement, the registered holder or, if the registered holder is a nominee,
the beneficial owner shall be deemed to be a holder of Registrable Securities.

         "SECURITIES ACT" means the United States Securities Act of 1933, as
amended, or any similar federal statute then in force.

         "STOCKHOLDER" or "STOCKHOLDERS" mean, individually and collectively,
as appropriate, Access and Bevero and each of their respective permitted
successors and assigns which become Stockholders pursuant to this Agreement.


                                         -3-

<PAGE>

         "TRANSFER" (and any derivatives thereof) means and refers to (a) a
voluntary or involuntary sale, assignment, transfer, conveyance, pledge,
hypothecation or other disposition of Equity Securities, and (b) any agreement,
contract or commitment to do any of the foregoing.

    1.2  OTHER DEFINED TERMS.  Other terms defined elsewhere in this Agreement
have the meanings so specified herein.


                                      ARTICLE II
                                ELECTION OF DIRECTORS

    2.1  NOMINATION OF DIRECTORS.

         (a)  The Board of Directors of the Subsidiary shall consist of five
members.  So long as he (directly or through his Affiliates) owns Common Stock,
each of John Kendall and Louis Carroll (the "NOMINEES") shall be nominated as
directors to the board of directors of the Subsidiary.  Bevero shall be entitled
to nominate a new, replacement director to take the place of any Nominee who
vacates office for any reason.  The Company agrees to vote (or cause to be
voted) all voting securities of the Subsidiary owned or controlled by the
Company for the election as a director of the Subsidiary, at any annual or
special meeting called for such purpose, or to take action by written consent in
lieu of such meeting, of the Nominees or other individuals selected and
nominated by Bevero in accordance with this Section 2.1(a).

         (b)  In the event that Bevero is entitled but fails to select and
nominate an individual for election to the board of directors of the Subsidiary
at or prior to any annual or special meeting called for the election of
directors, then such vacancy or vacancies shall be filled by the vote of a
majority of the voting securities present at a meeting duly called for such
purpose at which a quorum is present; PROVIDED, HOWEVER, that if at any time
after such event (while Bevero continues to be so entitled), Bevero then
nominates a director, the Company agrees to call or take any actions necessary
to call a special meeting of stockholders of the Subsidiary and to vote (or
cause to be voted) all voting securities of the Subsidiary owned or controlled
by the Company for the election of the individual so nominated by Bevero as a
director of the Subsidiary.

    2.2  REMOVAL OF DIRECTORS.  Bevero shall at all times have the right to
cause the removal from the Board of Directors of the Subsidiary, with or without
Cause, any director selected and nominated by it (other than a Nominee).  Bevero
hereby agrees that any Nominee or other person selected and nominated by it to
be a director may be removed for Cause by the affirmative vote of the holders of
a majority of the outstanding voting securities of the Subsidiary.

    2.3  INVALID VOTES.  No director who is elected Chairman of any meeting of
the Board of Directors, or of any annual or special meeting of the stockholders,
of the Subsidiary, and no director or officer of the Subsidiary who counts votes
pursuant to any action by written consent


                                         -4-

<PAGE>

in lieu of any such meeting, shall record the vote of any stockholder or
director of the Subsidiary if such stockholder or director votes contrary to the
voting agreement provisions of this Article II.

    2.4  BOARD ACTION.  Notwithstanding anything contained in the Subsidiary's
Articles of Association or Memorandum of Association to the contrary, a quorum
of the Board of Directors of the Subsidiary shall require the presence of at
least one director not designated by the Stockholders and any action of the
Board of Directors of the Subsidiary, whether at a duly called and convened
meeting, by written consent or otherwise, shall require the affirmative vote of
at least one director not designated by the Stockholders.


                                     ARTICLE III
                              TRANSFERS OF COMMON STOCK

    3.1  GENERAL.  From and after the date hereof and until the consummation of
an IPO, the Stockholders and the Company shall have the rights and obligations
set forth in this Article III.

    3.2  TRANSFER RESTRICTION.  Each Stockholder covenants and agrees that it
will not, and will not cause or allow any of its Affiliates to, Transfer or
cause the Transfer of Common Stock or any interest therein except in accordance
with the terms and conditions of this Article III.  The Company shall not
register any Transfer of Common Stock until such time as the Company is
satisfied that the transferor thereof has complied with all the relevant
provisions of this Article III.  Any attempted Transfer not in accordance with
the terms and conditions of this Article III shall be null and void and of no
force or effect.

    3.3 TRANSFERS TO AFFILIATES.  Notwithstanding anything to the contrary
contained in this Article III, any Stockholder, other than an Affiliate of a
Stockholder that acquired Common Stock pursuant to this Section 3.3, may
Transfer all or a portion of its Common Stock to an Affiliate of such
Stockholder; PROVIDED, HOWEVER, that (i) such Common Stock shall remain subject
to all of the terms and conditions of this Agreement in the hands of such
Affiliate, and (ii) such Affiliate shall first deliver to the Company and the
other Stockholder(s) a written agreement, reasonably satisfactory in form and
substance to the Company, (A) assuming and agreeing to be bound by all the terms
and conditions of this Agreement and to be a Stockholder hereunder,(B) providing
that such Affiliate will Transfer all of its right, title and interest in the
Common Stock back to the Transferring Stockholder, free and clear of all Liens,
prior to the time at which it ceases to be an Affiliate of such Transferring
Stockholder, and (C) containing a power of attorney from such Affiliate granting
to the Transferring Stockholder the power, on behalf of such Affiliate, to vote
such Common Stock for all purposes and to make any election on behalf of such
Affiliate under this Agreement, and agreeing that such Affiliate will be legally
bound by such elections and agreements as if it had made or executed the same. 
A Transfer pursuant to this Section 3.3 shall not relieve the Transferring
Stockholder of any of its obligations under this Agreement.


                                         -5-

<PAGE>

    3.4  TRANSFER TO BONA FIDE PURCHASER.

         (a)  RIGHT OF FIRST REFUSAL.  In the event a Stockholder desires to
Transfer Offered Stock to a Bona Fide Purchaser, such Stockholder shall first
notify the Company in writing of the identity of the Bona Fide Purchaser, the
purchase price for the Offered Stock and all other material terms of such Bona
Fide Purchaser's offer (a "TRANSFER NOTICE").  Under no circumstances shall a
Stockholder sell or offer to sell less than all of its Common Stock to any Bona
Fide Purchaser.  Upon receipt of a Transfer Notice, the Company shall have a
right of first refusal (exercisable by written notice to the Transferring
Stockholder within 30 days after the Company's receipt of the Transfer Notice)
to purchase the Offered Stock at the purchase price and on the other terms
specified in the Transfer Notice.  In the event that the Company does not
exercise its right of first refusal to purchase all but not less than all of the
Offered Stock, the Transferring Stockholder may Transfer the Offered Stock to
the Bona Fide Purchaser at the purchase price and on other terms no more
favorable to the Transferring Stockholder than those specified in the Transfer
Notice.  In the event the Transferring Stockholder does not Transfer the Offered
Stock within the 60-day period immediately after the earlier of (i) the date the
Transferring Stockholder receives written notice from the Company that the
Company elects not to exercise its right of first refusal or (ii) expiration of
the 30-day period immediately after the Company's receipt of the Transfer
Notice, the Offered Stock shall be subject to the provisions of this Section
3.4(a) with respect to any subsequent Transfer.

         (b)  CONSUMMATION OF THE COMPANY'S PURCHASE.

              (i)  In the event the Company exercises its right of first
    refusal pursuant to Section 3.4(a), the purchase price for the Offered
    Stock shall be payable in an amount of cash equal to the amount, and shall
    be paid in the manner, set forth in the Bona Fide Purchaser's offer.  In
    connection with such Transfer, the Transferring Stockholder shall be
    required to make representations or warranties to the Company as to (A)
    good and valid title to the Common Stock being Transferred, (B) the absence
    of Liens with respect to the Common Stock, (C) such Stockholder's legal
    capacity, valid existence and good standing (if applicable), (D) the
    authority for, and validity and binding effect of (as against such
    Transferring Stockholder), any agreement entered into by such Transferring
    Stockholder in connection with such sale, (E) all required material
    consents to the Transferring Stockholder's sale and material governmental
    approvals having been obtained and (F) the fact that no broker's commission
    is payable by or on behalf of the Company as a result of the Transferring
    Stockholder's conduct in connection with the sale.

              (ii) The Transferring Stockholder shall pay and shall indemnify
    the Company from and against (A) any breach of the representations or
    warranties made pursuant to Section 3.4(b)(i) and (B) any stamp, transfer
    or similar tax that is payable in respect of the Transfer of the Offered
    Stock pursuant to this Section 3.4.  The amount of any such tax that has
    not been paid by the Transferring Stockholder may be deducted from any
    amount otherwise payable to the Transferring Stockholder.


                                         -6-

<PAGE>

    3.5  ADDITIONAL TRANSFER RESTRICTIONS.  Notwithstanding any other provision
in this Agreement, no Stockholder may Transfer or attempt to Transfer any of its
Common Stock:

         (a)  if any requisite consent or approval of any governmental
authority having jurisdiction over such Transfer, or of any other Person party
to the Transfer, shall not have been obtained;

         (b)  if in the opinion of counsel to the Company, registration of such
Common Stock under the Securities Act or under any blue sky, state or other
applicable securities law is required in connection therewith and such
registration has not been duly effected; 

         (c)  unless the transferee of such Common Stock shall expressly assume
in writing the obligations of a Stockholder under this Agreement;

         (d)  if, in the event the Common Stock is being Transferred other than
pursuant to Section 3.3, the proposed transferee is not a Bona Fide Purchaser;

         (e)  if, in the event the Common Stock is being Transferred in
accordance with Section 3.4, the beneficial owner of the Bona Fide Purchaser is
other than the Person(s) disclosed in the Transfer Notice; or

         (f)  to any Person engaged in a business that (in the determination of
the board of directors of the Company) is primarily competitive, directly or
indirectly, with the business of the Company.

    3.6  CO-SALE RIGHTS.  

         (a)  In the event Tuchman desires to Transfer Offered Stock, Tuchman
shall first notify each Stockholder and each holder of Priority Stock
(collectively, the "Participants") in writing of the identity of the proposed
transferee(s), the number and class of Offered Stock and the proposed purchase
price (whether payable in cash, other securities or other property) and other
terms of the Transfer (a "TUCHMAN NOTICE").  Upon receipt of a Tuchman Notice,
each Participant shall have the right (exercisable by written notice to Tuchman
within 30 days after receipt of the Tuchman Notice (the "NOTICE PERIOD")) to
participate in such Transfer at the purchase price and other terms specified in
the Tuchman Notice, as follows:

         (i)  Each Participant shall have the right to Transfer to the proposed
    transferee(s) specified in the Tuchman Notice (the "PROPOSED TRANSFEREE")
    all or any portion of such Participant's Co-Sale Shares.  A Participant's
    Co-Sale shares shall mean the number of shares of Equity Securities that
    are either of (A) the same class as those that are the subject of the
    Tuchman Notice, or (B) a different class than those that are the subject of
    the Tuchman Notice but that are convertible into, immediately exercisable
    for or exchangeable into the same class of Equity Securities as those that
    are the subject of the Tuchman Notice, equal to the product of:


                                         -7-

<PAGE>

              (1)  the aggregate number of Equity Securities that are the
         subject of the Tuchman Notice, multiplied by

              (2)  a fraction (the "CO-SALE FRACTION"),

                   (x)  the numerator of which is the sum of (aa) the number of
              shares of the class of Equity Securities that are the subject of
              the Tuchman Notice held by such Participant, plus (bb) the number
              of shares of Equity Securities that are the subject of the
              Tuchman Notice issuable upon conversion, exercise or exchange of
              a different class than those that are the subject of the Tuchman
              Notice held by such Participant, and 

                   (y)  the denominator of which is the sum of (aa) the
              aggregate number of shares of the class of Equity Securities that
              are the subject of the Tuchman Notice held by all of the
              Participants and Tuchman, plus (bb) the aggregate number of
              shares of the class of Equity Securities that are the subject of
              the Tuchman Notice issuable upon conversion, exercise or exchange
              of a different class of Equity Securities than those that are the
              subject of the Tuchman Notice held by all of the Participants and
              Tuchman.

         (ii) Unless the number of Equity Securities to be Transferred to the
    Proposed Transferee is equal to all of the Equity Securities held by the
    Participants and Tuchman, to the extent any Participant(s) exercises its
    rights to participate in such Transfer pursuant to this Section 3.6, the
    number of shares of Equity Securities subject to this Section 3.6 that
    Tuchman may Transfer to the Proposed Transferee shall be correspondingly
    reduced by the number of the Participants' Co-Sale Shares to be Transferred
    by such Participant(s) pursuant to Section 3.6(a).

         (b) Each Participant shall effect its participation in the Transfer by
delivering the notice specified in Section 3.6(a) above and agreeing to deliver
to Tuchman:

         (i)  for Transfer to the Proposed Transferee, one or more stock
    certificates, properly endorsed for Transfer or accompanied by properly
    executed stock powers, which represent the number of such Participant's Co-
    Sale Shares that are of the same class as those Equity Securities that are
    the subject of the Tuchman Notice at or prior to the closing of such
    Transfer; and/or 

         (ii) one or more stock certificates, which represent the number of
    such Participant's Co-Sale Shares that are of a different class of Equity
    Securities than those that are the subject of the Tuchman Notice but that
    are convertible into, exchangeable with or immediately exercisable for
    Equity Securities of the class that are the subject of the Tuchman Notice. 
    If conversion, exercise or exchange, as the case may be, of the Equity
    Securities so delivered to Tuchman by a Participant is required by the
    Proposed


                                         -8-

<PAGE>

    Transferee, delivery made pursuant to this Section 3.6(b)(ii) shall
    constitute the delivering Participant's conditional notice of the exercise
    of its rights to convert, exercise or exchange the Equity Securities so
    delivered into or for the class of Equity Securities that are the subject
    of the Tuchman Notice, and the Company agrees to effect the required
    conversion, exercise or exchange subject to and immediately prior to the
    closing of the Transfer pursuant to which such Participant's Co-Sale Shares
    are to be purchased; such Participant agrees to properly endorse for
    Transfer stock certificates issued by the Company in respect of such
    Participant's Co-Sale Shares or shares issuable upon such conversion,
    exercise or exchange or properly execute stock powers therefor in order to
    Transfer the appropriate number of shares of Equity Securities to the
    Proposed Transferee; and

         (iii)a certificate of such Participant containing representations and
    warranties made by such Participant to Tuchman regarding (A) such
    Participant's lawful ownership of, and good and marketable title to, its
    Co-Sale Shares, (B) the absence of any Liens with respect to such
    Participant's Co-Sale Shares, (C) such Participant's legal right, power and
    authority to sell its Co-Sale Shares, as contemplated by this Section 3.6,
    (D) such Participant's agreement to pay any stamp duties, transfer taxes
    relating to the Transfer of its Co-Sale Shares, and (E) to such
    Participant's knowledge, without any inquiry, such Participant is not aware
    of any material fact or any failure to state a material fact which would
    render the representations and warranties of Tuchman with respect to such
    Participant's Co-Sale Shares materially false or misleading.

         (c)  Tuchman shall cause the Proposed Transferee to remit to each
Participant, upon closing of the Transfer, the proceeds to which such
Participant is entitled by reason of its participation in such Transfer, less an
amount equal to the product of the Co-Sale Fraction multiplied by the sum of any
reasonable out-of-pocket costs, fees and expenses, including, without
limitation, attorneys' or accountants' fees, but excluding any wages payable to
employees of the Company or any of its subsidiaries, actually incurred by
Tuchman and the Company in connection with the Transfer or the exercise of each
Participant's rights under this Section 3.6, which shall be payable to Tuchman;
PROVIDED THAT prior to any such payment or deduction, Tuchman and/or the Company
delivers copies of the invoices for each such cost, fee and expense, together
with a certificate of Tuchman and the Company indicating that all such costs,
fees and expenses were actually incurred in connection with the Transfer or the
exercise of the Participants' rights under this Section 3.6; PROVIDED, FURTHER
that any such costs, fees or expenses attributable to one but not any other
Participant shall be paid only by that Participant.

         (d)  In the event that no Participant exercises rights to sell all or
any part of its Co-Sale Shares pursuant to this Section 3.6, Tuchman may
Transfer as many shares of his Offered Stock that are the subject of the Tuchman
Notice held of record or beneficially by Tuchman or any of his Permitted
Transferees (as defined in the Investment Agreement) to the Proposed Transferee
at a price (including the form of payment, E.G., cash, other securities or other
property) and on other terms no more favorable to Tuchman than those specified
in the Tuchman Notice any time during the 90-day period immediately following
the expiration of the


                                         -9-

<PAGE>

Notice Period or such longer period as may be required to comply with the Hart-
Scott-Rodino Antitrust Improvement Act of 1976 (or any similar law then in
force).  Any Offered Stock held by Tuchman that is not sold or transferred
within the foregoing period shall be subject again to the provisions of this
Section 3.6 with respect to any subsequent Transfer thereof.


                                      ARTICLE IV
                                 REGISTRATION RIGHTS

    4.1  GENERAL.  From and after the date of consummation of an IPO, the
Stockholders and the Company shall have the rights and obligations set forth in
this Article IV.

    4.2  RIGHT TO PARTICIPATE IN REGISTRATION.

         (a)  If the Company proposes to register Common Stock under the
Securities Act (other than a registration on Form S-8 or S-4, or any successor
or similar forms) for sale to the public in a manner that would permit
registration under the Securities Act of Registrable Securities, then the
Company shall give written notice of such proposed filing to each Stockholder at
least 30 days before the anticipated filing date of such registration statement.
Such notice shall state the Company's intended method of disposition and offer
to each Stockholder the opportunity to include in the registration statement
such Registrable Securities owned at that time by such Stockholder as it may
request in writing within 15 days after receipt of the Company's notice. 
Subject to Section 4.2(b), the Company shall include in its registration
statement all Registrable Securities requested to be included therein by the
Stockholders.

         (b)  Notwithstanding the provisions of Section 4.2(a), if the managing
underwriter or underwriters of any offering of Common Stock advise the Company
in writing that the total number of shares of Common Stock that the Company, the
Stockholders, the holders of Priority Stock and any other Persons entitled to
offer Common Stock in such registration intend to include in such offering is
sufficiently large to affect, materially and adversely, the success of such
offering, then the number of shares of Common Stock to be offered may be reduced
and there shall be excluded from such registration and underwriting, to the
extent necessary in the underwriters' sole discretion, (i) first, shares held by
the Stockholders requesting registration, PRO RATA between them, (ii) second,
shares of Priority Stock, PRO RATA among the holders thereof, and (iii)
thereafter, shares that the Company wishes to register for its own account.

    4.3  OBLIGATIONS OF THE COMPANY AND THE STOCKHOLDERS.  

         (a)  The Company may require each of the Stockholders to furnish to
the Company information regarding itself, its Affiliates and its disposition of
Registrable Securities.  Each Stockholder agrees to furnish to the Company,
promptly upon request, such information and any other information as the Company
may reasonably request.


                                         -10-

<PAGE>

         (b)  The Company may require each of the Stockholders to make
representations and warranties to, or agreements with, the underwriters of the
kind and to the extent customarily given or entered into by selling stockholders
to underwriters in connection with public offerings of securities as
contemplated by this Article IV.  Each Stockholder agrees to make such
representations and warranties to, and agreements with, the underwriters.

         (c)  Each Stockholder agrees not to effect any public sale or
distribution of Common Stock during the 90-day period beginning on the effective
date of any registration statement filed with respect to an offering of Common
Stock.

         (d)  The Company shall (i) notify the Stockholders of the happening of
any event as a result of which any prospectus relating to the Registrable
Securities, which is included in a registration statement covered by this
Article IV and is required to be delivered under the Securities Act, contains an
untrue statement of a material fact or omits to state any material fact required
to be stated therein or necessary to make the statements therein not misleading
and (ii) promptly prepare a supplement or amendment to such prospectus so that,
as thereafter delivered to the purchasers of Registrable Securities, such
prospectus will not contain an untrue statement of a material fact or omits to
state any material fact required to be stated therein or necessary to make the
statements therein not misleading.  Each Stockholder agrees that, upon receipt
of any notice from the Company described in the foregoing clause (i), such
Stockholder will forthwith discontinue disposition of Registrable Securities
pursuant to the registration statement or statements covering such Registrable
Securities until such Stockholder's receipt of the copies of the supplemented or
amended prospectus contemplated by this Section 4.3(d) and, if so directed by
the Company, such Stockholder will deliver to the Company (at the Company's
expense) all copies then in its possession of any prospectus covering such
Registrable Securities current at the time of receipt of such notice.  

         (e)  No registration statement shall refer to any Stockholder by name
or otherwise as the holder(s) of the Registrable Securities unless (i) such
information is required to be disclosed by law or regulation, or (ii) such
Stockholder has had a reasonable opportunity to review such references and shall
have granted their prior approval of the content of such references, which
approval shall not be unreasonably withheld or delayed.

    4.4  INDEMNIFICATION AND CONTRIBUTION.  

         (a)  INDEMNIFICATION BY COMPANY.  The Company agrees to indemnify, to
the full extent permitted by law, each Stockholder and all officers, directors,
employees and Affiliates of each Stockholder against any and all joint or
several Damages to which they or any of them may become subject:  (i) under the
Securities Act, the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, or any similar
federal law then in force (the "Exchange Act"), or otherwise, insofar as such
Damages (or actions in respect thereof) arise out of or are based upon any
untrue or alleged untrue statement of a material fact contained in any
registration statement, prospectus, preliminary prospectus or any amendment to
any of the foregoing, or arise out of or are based upon any omission or alleged
omission to state therein a material fact required to be stated


                                         -11-

<PAGE>

therein or necessary to make the statements therein not misleading; or (ii) as a
result of or in connection with any violation of applicable Laws by the Company
(other than as a result of any act committed by or omission of such Stockholder)
or any of the Company's employees or officers; PROVIDED, HOWEVER, that the
Company will not be liable if any such Damages arise out of or are based upon
any such untrue statement or alleged untrue statement or omission or alleged
omission made therein in reliance upon and in conformity with information
furnished in writing to the Company by or on behalf of a Stockholder
specifically for use therein; and PROVIDED FURTHER, that the foregoing indemnity
is subject to the condition that, insofar as it relates to any untrue statement,
alleged untrue statement, omission or alleged omission made in a preliminary
prospectus but eliminated or remedied in the final prospectus (filed pursuant to
Rule 424(b) under the Securities Act), such indemnity shall not inure to the
benefit of a Stockholder or its Affiliates from whom the Person asserting any
Damages purchased the Registrable Securities that are the subject thereof if
copies of such final prospectus were delivered to such Stockholder on a timely
basis and such Stockholder or its Affiliates did not deliver to such Person the
final prospectus with or prior to the written confirmation for the sale of such
Registrable Securities to such Person.  In connection with an underwritten
offering, the Company will indemnify the underwriters thereof, their officers,
directors, employees and partners and each Person who controls such underwriters
within the meaning of Section 15 of the Securities Act and Section 20(a) of the
Exchange Act to the same extent as provided above with respect to the
indemnification of the Stockholders and use its reasonable best efforts to
obtain a reciprocal and mutual indemnity from the underwriters.  Such
indemnification shall be effective notwithstanding any investigation made by or
on behalf of any Stockholder, underwriter or any such officer, director,
partner, employee or controlling Person and shall survive any transfer by the
same of the Registrable Securities.  This indemnity will be in addition to any
liability that the Company otherwise may have, including any under this
Agreement.

         (b)  INDEMNIFICATION BY THE STOCKHOLDERS.  Each Stockholder, severally
and not jointly, agrees to indemnify to the full extent permitted by law, the
Company, each Person who signs the registration statement and each Person who
controls the Company within the meaning of Section 15 of the Securities Act or
Section 20(a) of the Exchange Act against joint or several Damages to which they
or any of them may become subject:  (i) under the Securities Act, the Exchange
Act or otherwise, insofar as such Damages (or actions in respect thereof) arise
out of or are based upon any untrue or alleged untrue statement of a material
fact contained in any registration statement, prospectus, preliminary prospectus
or any amendment thereof or supplement thereto, or arise out of or are based
upon any omission or alleged omission to state therein a material fact required
to be stated therein or necessary to made the statements therein not misleading,
in each case to the extent, but only to the extent, that any Damages arise out
of or are based upon any such untrue statement or alleged untrue statement or
omission or alleged omission made therein in reliance upon and in conformity
with information furnished in writing by or on behalf of such Stockholder to the
Company specifically for use therein; or (ii) as a result of or in connection
with any violation of applicable Laws by such Stockholder (other than as a
result of any act committed by or omission of the Company).  This indemnity will
be in addition to any liability that such Stockholder otherwise may have,
including any under this Agreement.  Notwithstanding the foregoing, the
liability of each Stockholder, except for any


                                         -12-

<PAGE>

liability resulting from the willful misconduct or intentional action of such
Stockholder, shall not exceed an amount equal to the proceeds of the Registrable
Securities of such Stockholder sold as contemplated herein.

         (c)  CONDUCT OF INDEMNIFICATION PROCEEDINGS.  Promptly after receipt
by an indemnified party under subsection (a) or (b) above of notice of the
commencement of any action, such indemnified party shall, if a claim in respect
thereof is to be made against the indemnifying party under such subsection,
notify each party against whom indemnification is to be sought in writing at the
commencement thereof (but the failure so to notify an indemnifying party shall
not relieve it from any liability that such party may have under this Section
4.4 except to the extent that the indemnifying party has been prejudiced in any
material respect by such failure or from any liability that such party may have
otherwise avoided).  In case any such action is brought against any indemnified
party, and the indemnified party notifies an indemnifying party of the
commencement thereof, the indemnifying party will be entitled to assume the
defense thereof with counsel reasonably satisfactory to such indemnified party. 
Notwithstanding the foregoing, the indemnified party shall have the right to
employ its own counsel in any such case, but the fees and expenses of such
counsel shall be the sole expense of such indemnified party unless (i) the
employment of such counsel shall have been authorized in writing by the
indemnifying party in connection with the defense of such action, or (ii) the
indemnifying party shall not have employed counsel to take charge of the defense
of such action within a reasonable time after notice of the commencement of the
action.  Anything in this subsection to the contrary notwithstanding, an
indemnifying party shall not be liable for any settlement of any claim or action
effected without its written consent (which shall not be unreasonably withheld
or delayed).

         (d)  CONTRIBUTION.  In order to provide for contribution in
circumstances in which the indemnification provided for in this Section 4.4 is
for any reason held to be unavailable or is insufficient to hold harmless a
party indemnified hereunder, then the indemnifying party and the indemnified
party shall contribute to the aggregate Damages of the nature contemplated by
such indemnification provision (including any investigative, legal and other
expenses incurred in connection with, and any amount paid in settlement of, any
action, suit or proceeding or any claims asserted, but after deducting from
Damages suffered by the indemnifying party any contribution received by the
indemnifying party from Persons, other than the indemnified party, who may also
be liable for contribution, including Persons who control the indemnifying party
within the meaning of Section 15 of the Securities Act or Section 20(a) of the
Exchange Act) to which the indemnifying party, on the one hand, and the
indemnified party, on the other hand, may be subject, in such proportions as is
appropriate to reflect the relative fault of the indemnifying party, on the one
hand, and the indemnified party, on the other hand, in connection with the
statements or omissions that resulted in Damages, as well as any other relevant
equitable considerations.  The relative fault of the parties shall be determined
by reference to, among other things, whether the untrue or alleged untrue
statement of a material fact or omission or alleged omission to state a material
fact relates to information supplied by a party and the parties' relative
intent, knowledge, access to information and opportunity to correct or prevent
such statement or omission.  The parties agree that it would not be just and


                                         -13-

<PAGE>

equitable if contribution pursuant to this Section 4.4(d) was determined by PRO
RATA allocation or by any other method of allocation that does not take into
account the equitable considerations referred to above.  Notwithstanding the
foregoing, (i) any underwriting agreement entered into pursuant hereto may
provide that in no case shall any underwriter (except as may be provided in any
agreement among underwriters) be liable or responsible for any amount in excess
of the underwriting discount applicable to the Registrable Securities purchased
by such underwriters, and (ii) no Person guilty of fraudulent misrepresentation
(within the meaning of Section 11(f) of the Securities Act) shall be entitled to
contribution from any Person who was not guilty of such fraudulent
misrepresentation.  Any party entitled to contribution will, promptly after
receipt of notice of commencement of any action, suit or proceeding against such
party in respect of which a claim for contribution may be made against another
party or parties under this Section 4.4(d), notify such party or parties from
which contribution may be sought of any obligation it or they may have under
this Section 4.4(d) or otherwise.  No party shall be liable for contribution
with respect to any action or claim settled without its consent, which consent
shall not be unreasonably withheld or delayed.  Notwithstanding the foregoing,
the liability of a Stockholder, except for any liability resulting from the
willful misconduct or intentional action of such Stockholder, shall not exceed
an amount equal to the proceeds from Registrable Securities of such Stockholder
sold as contemplated herein.

    4.5  SPECIAL COUNSEL.  In connection with any registration statement
covering Registrable Securities pursuant to this Agreement, the Stockholders
jointly may engage one special counsel to represent them in connection with any
such registration statement.  The Company agrees to cooperate with such counsel.
Fees and expenses of any such special counsel retained by the Stockholders in
connection with a registration under this Agreement shall be borne by the
Stockholders.


                                      ARTICLE V
                                    MISCELLANEOUS

    5.1  RESTRICTIONS ON OTHER AGREEMENTS.  No Stockholder shall grant any
proxy or enter into or agree to be bound by any voting trust, and no Stockholder
shall enter into any agreement or arrangement of any kind with any person, with
respect to Common Stock on terms that are inconsistent with the provisions of
this Agreement (whether or not such agreements and arrangements are with other
holders of Common Stock that are not parties to this Agreement), including,
without limitation, agreements or arrangements with respect to the acquisition,
Transfer or voting of Common Stock.

    5.2  ENDORSEMENT ON CERTIFICATES.  Each of the Stockholders agrees that the
following legend shall be placed on every certificate evidencing ownership of
Common Stock owned by it:

    THE SHARES REPRESENTED BY THIS CERTIFICATE HAVE NOT BEEN REGISTERED
    UNDER THE FEDERAL SECURITIES ACT OF 1933, AS


                                         -14-


<PAGE>

    AMENDED, OR ANY STATE LAWS OF ANY JURISDICTION.  NO SALE, OFFER TO SELL,
    ASSIGNMENT, PLEDGE, HYPOTHECATION, GIFT, TRANSFER OR OTHER DISPOSITION OF
    THE SHARES REPRESENTED BY THIS CERTIFICATE MAY BE MADE UNLESS A
    REGISTRATION STATEMENT UNDER THE FEDERAL SECURITIES ACT OF 1933, AS
    AMENDED, WITH RESPECT TO SUCH SHARES IS THEN IN EFFECT OR AN EXEMPTION FROM
    THE REGISTRATION REQUIREMENTS OF SAID ACT IS AVAILABLE WITH RESPECT TO SAID
    TRANSFER AND THE REQUIREMENTS OF APPLICABLE STATE LAWS ARE SATISFIED.

    THE SALE, ASSIGNMENT, PLEDGE, HYPOTHECATION, GIFT, TRANSFER OR OTHER
    DISPOSITION OF THE SHARES REPRESENTED BY THIS CERTIFICATE IS SUBJECT
    TO CERTAIN RESTRICTIONS PURSUANT TO A STOCK TRANSFER AND REGISTRATION
    RIGHTS AGREEMENT BY AND AMONG THE CERTIFICATE HOLDER, TELETECH
    HOLDINGS, INC. AND CERTAIN OTHER STOCKHOLDERS OF TELETECH HOLDINGS,
    INC., COPIES OF WHICH MAY BE OBTAINED FROM THE CORPORATION UPON
    REQUEST.

The Company promptly shall instruct its transfer agent, if any, to impose
transfer restrictions on the shares represented by certificates bearing the
legend referred to above in order to enforce the provisions of this Agreement.

    5.3  TERMINATION.  This Agreement shall be effective as to each Stockholder
for so long as such Stockholder shall own any Common Stock.

    5.4  COMMON STOCK SUBJECT TO THIS AGREEMENT.  This Agreement shall apply to
(a) Common Stock held by the Stockholders on the date hereof,(b) any Common
Stock issued to a Stockholder as a result of stock splits, stock dividends,
recapitalizations and similar events, or in addition to or upon exchange for
Common Stock, and (c) any Common Stock otherwise purchased, acquired or issued
to any Stockholder.  All certificates evidencing Common Stock subject to this
Agreement shall contain the restrictive legend set forth in Section 5.2.

    5.5  FURTHER ASSURANCES.  From time to time after the date hereof, the
parties will, at their own expense and without further consideration, execute
and deliver such other documents and instruments and take such other actions as
may be reasonably requested to effect the purposes and intent of this Agreement.

    5.6  NOTICES.  All notices, requests, claims, demands and other
communications hereunder shall be in writing and shall be given or made (and
shall be deemed to have been duly given or made) upon the earliest to occur of
(a) receipt, if made by personal service, (b) five days after delivery to a
reputable overnight courier service, (c) upon the delivering party's receipt of
a written confirmation of a transmission made by cable, telecopy, telegram, or
telex or (d) ten days after being mailed by registered or certified air mail
(postage prepaid, return


                                         -15-

<PAGE>

receipt requested) to the respective parties at the following addresses (or at
such other address for a party as shall be specified in a notice given in
accordance with this Section 5.6):

         (A)  if to the Company:

              Teletech Holdings, Inc.
              1700 Lincoln Street, Suite 1400
              Denver, Colorado 80203
              Attention: President
              Telecopy: (303) 894-4203

              with a copy to:

              Neal, Gerber & Eisenberg
              Two North LaSalle Street, Suite 2200
              Chicago, Illinois  60602
              Attention:  Charles Evans Gerber
              Telecopy: (312) 269-1747

         (B)  if to Sellers:

              Access 24 Holdings Pty Limited
              c/o Royal Automobile Club of Victoria (RACV) Ltd.
              422 Little Collins Street
              Melbourne Victoria 3000
              Australia
              Attention:  Pearl Dreier
              Telecopy: (61-2) 9670-3780

              and

              Bevero Pty Limited
              c/o Access 24 Service Corporation Pty Limited
              Level 3, 154 Pacific Highway
              St. Leonards, New South Wales 2065
              Attention:  President
              Telecopy: (61-2) 9930-1132


                                         -16-

<PAGE>

              with a copy to:

              Gardner, Carton & Douglas
              Suite 3400 - Quaker Tower
              321 North Clark Street
              Chicago, IL 60610
              Attention: Stephen M. Gatlin
              Telecopy: (312) 644-3381

or to such other address as any party may from time to time designate to the
other in the manner provided in this Section.

    5.7  PRONOUNS AND HEADINGS.  As used herein, all pronouns shall include the
masculine, feminine, neuter, singular and plural wherever the context and facts
require such construction.

    5.8  HEADINGS.  The descriptive headings contained in this Agreement are
for convenience of reference only and shall not affect in any way the meaning or
interpretation of this Agreement.

    5.9  SEVERABILITY.  The invalidity of any provision of this Agreement or
portion of a provision shall not affect the validity of any other provision of
this Agreement or the remaining portion of the applicable provision.

    5.10 ENTIRE AGREEMENT.  This Agreement constitutes the entire agreement of
the parties hereto with respect to the subject matter hereof and supersedes all
prior agreements and undertakings, both written and oral, between the Company
and the Stockholders with respect to the subject matter hereof.

    5.11 ASSIGNMENT.  This Agreement and the rights and duties hereunder may
not be assigned or assumed by operation of law or otherwise without the express
prior written consent of the other parties hereto.

    5.12 AMENDMENT; WAIVER.  This Agreement may not be amended or modified
except by an instrument in writing signed by, or on behalf of, each party
hereto.  Each party to this Agreement may (a) extend the time for the
performance of any of the obligations or other acts of the other parties, (b)
waive any inaccuracies in the representations and warranties of the other
parties contained herein or in any document delivered by the other party
pursuant hereto or (c) waive compliance with any of the agreements or conditions
of the other parties contained herein.  Any such extension or waiver shall be
valid only if set forth in an instrument in writing signed by all of the other
parties to be bound thereby.  Any waiver of any term or condition shall not be
construed as a waiver of any subsequent breach or a subsequent waiver of the
same term or condition, or a waiver of any other term or condition, of this
Agreement.  The failure of any party to assert any of its rights hereunder shall
not constitute a waiver of any of such rights.


                                         -17-

<PAGE>

    5.13 CONDITIONS TO EXERCISE OF RIGHTS.  The exercise of each parties'
respective rights hereunder shall be subject to and conditioned upon, and each
party shall use its or his reasonable best efforts to assist such other parties
in, compliance with all applicable laws.

    5.14 GOVERNING LAW.  This Agreement shall be governed by, and construed in
accordance with, the laws of the State of Delaware that are applicable to
contracts executed in and to be performed entirely within that jurisdiction
(without regard to its principals regarding conflicts of law).

    5.15 JURISDICTION; SERVICE OF PROCESS.  Each of the parties hereto agrees
that all actions or proceedings initiated by any party hereto and arising
directly or indirectly out of this Agreement which are brought to judicial
proceedings shall be litigated in the United States District Court covering
Wilmington, Delaware or, in the event such court cannot or will not exercise
jurisdiction, in the state courts of the State of Delaware (the "DELAWARE
COURTS").  Each Seller agrees that any order or judgment rendered by the
Delaware Courts may be enforced against such Seller in any federal or state
court sitting in Australia.  Each Seller agrees that it will not oppose in any
way any application to enforce in Australia a judgment rendered by the Delaware
Courts including, without limitation, an application to register a judgment at
common law.  This Agreement may be pleaded as a bar to any opposition to any
application to enforce a judgment in Australia rendered by the Delaware Courts
on any grounds whatsoever including, without limitation, service permitted by
the Delaware Courts but not permitted by any federal or state court sitting in
Australia or a lack of jurisdiction of the Delaware Courts based on a failure to
appear.  Each of the parties hereto expressly submits to the jurisdiction of the
Delaware Courts and consents to process being served in any suit, action or
proceeding of the nature referred to above either (a) by the mailing of a copy
thereof by registered or certified mail, postage prepaid, return receipt
requested, to its address as set forth herein or (b) by serving a copy thereof
upon such party's authorized agent for service of process (to the extent
permitted by applicable law, regardless whether the appointment of such agent
for service of process for any reason shall prove to be ineffective or such
agent for service of process shall accept or acknowledge such service); PROVIDED
that, to the extent lawful and practicable, written notice of said service upon
said agent shall be mailed by registered or certified mail, postage prepaid,
return receipt requested, to the party at its address as set forth herein.  Each
party hereto agrees that such service, to the fullest extent permitted by law,
(i) shall be deemed in every respect effective service of process upon it in any
such suit, action or proceeding and (ii) shall be taken and held to be valid
personal service upon and personal delivery to it.  Each party hereto waives any
claim that any Delaware Court is an inconvenient forum or an improper forum
based on lack of venue or jurisdiction.

    5.16 TRIAL BY JURY.  EACH STOCKHOLDER AND THE COMPANY HEREBY WAIVES ITS
RIGHTS TO A JURY TRIAL OF ANY CLAIM OR CAUSE OF ACTION BASED UPON OR ARISING OUT
OF THIS AGREEMENT OR ANY DEALINGS BETWEEN THE PARTIES HERETO RELATING TO THE
SUBJECT MATTER HEREOF.  EACH STOCKHOLDER AND THE COMPANY ALSO WAIVES ANY BOND OR
SURETY OR SECURITY UPON SUCH BOND THAT MIGHT, BUT FOR THIS WAIVER, BE REQUIRED


                                         -18-

<PAGE>

OF THE OTHER PARTY.  THE SCOPE OF THIS WAIVER IS INTENDED TO BE ALL-ENCOMPASSING
OF ANY AND ALL DISPUTES THAT MAY BE FILED IN ANY COURT AND THAT RELATE TO THE
SUBJECT MATTER OF THIS AGREEMENT, INCLUDING WITHOUT LIMITATION, CONTRACT CLAIMS,
TORT CLAIMS, BREACH OF DUTY CLAIMS, AND ALL OTHER COMMON LAW AND STATUTORY
CLAIMS.  EACH STOCKHOLDER AND THE COMPANY ACKNOWLEDGES THAT THIS WAIVER IS A
MATERIAL INDUCEMENT TO ENTER INTO A BUSINESS RELATIONSHIP, THAT EACH HAS ALREADY
RELIED ON THE WAIVER IN ENTERING INTO THIS AGREEMENT AND THAT EACH WILL CONTINUE
TO RELY ON THE WAIVER IN THEIR RELATED FUTURE DEALINGS.  EACH STOCKHOLDER AND
THE COMPANY FURTHER WARRANTS AND REPRESENTS THAT IT HAS REVIEWED THIS WAIVER
WITH ITS LEGAL COUNSEL, AND THAT HE OR IT KNOWINGLY AND VOLUNTARILY WAIVES HIS
OR ITS JURY TRIAL RIGHTS FOLLOWING CONSULTATION WITH LEGAL COUNSEL.  THIS WAIVER
IS IRREVOCABLE, MEANING THAT IT MAY NOT BE MODIFIED EITHER ORALLY OR IN WRITING,
AND THE WAIVER SHALL APPLY TO ANY SUBSEQUENT AMENDMENTS, RENEWALS, SUPPLEMENTS
OR MODIFICATIONS TO THIS AGREEMENT.  IN THE EVENT OF LITIGATION, THIS AGREEMENT
MAY BE FILED AS A WRITTEN CONSENT TO A TRIAL BY THE COURT.

    5.17 THIRD PARTY BENEFICIARIES.  Nothing herein expressed or implied is
intended or shall be construed to confer upon or give to any Person (other than
the parties hereto) any rights or remedies under or by reason of this Agreement.

    5.18 BINDING EFFECT.  This Agreement shall be binding upon and shall inure
to the benefit of the parties hereto and their successors and permitted assigns.

    5.19 COUNTERPARTS.  This Agreement may be executed in one or more
counterparts, and by the different parties hereto in separate counterparts, each
of which when executed shall be deemed to be an original but all of which taken
together shall constitute one and the same agreement.

                              *    *    *    *    *    *


                                         -19-

<PAGE>

    IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the parties have executed this Agreement as of the day
and year first above written.

                             TELETECH HOLDINGS, INC.




                             By:  /S/ Steve Coburn
                                -------------------------------------------
                                 Name: Steven B. Coburn
                                 Title: Chief Financial Officer


                             ACCESS 24 HOLDINGS PTY LIMITED




                             By:  /S/ Ted Johnson
                                -------------------------------------------
                                 Name: Ted Johnson
                                 Title: 


                             BEVERO PTY LIMITED




                             By: /S/ Louis Carroll
                                -------------------------------------------
                                 Name: Louis Carroll
                                 Title: 



                               /S/ Kenneth Tuchman
                             ----------------------------------------------
                             Kenneth Tuchman


                                         -20-


<PAGE>
                            Neal, Gerber & Eisenberg
                        Two N. LaSalle Street, Suite 2200
                             Chicago, Illinois 60602







                                  July 5, 1996


Securities and Exchange Commission
450 Fifth Street N.W.
Washington, D.C. 20549

     Re:  TELETECH HOLDINGS, INC.
          REGISTRATION STATEMENT ON FORM S-1 (NO. 333-04097)

Gentlemen:

     We are counsel to TeleTech Holdings, Inc., a Delaware corporation (the 
"Company"), and in such capacity we have assisted in the preparation and 
filing with the Securities and Exchange Commission under the Securities Act 
of 1933, as amended, of the Company's Registration Statement on Form S-1 (No. 
333-04097), and amendments thereto (the "Registration Statement"), relating 
to the proposed offering by the Company and certain stockholders of the 
Company (the "Selling Stockholders") of up to 7,153,000 shares (including 
933,000 shares that may be issued under the underwriters' over-allotment 
option) of the common stock, $.01 par value per share (the "Common Stock"), 
of the Company.

     As such counsel, we have examined the Registration Statement, and such
other papers, documents and certificates of public officials and certificates of
officers of the Company as we have deemed necessary and appropriate as the basis
for the opinions hereinafter expressed.  In such examinations, we have assumed
the genuineness of all signatures, the legal capacity of natural persons, and
the authenticity of all documents submitted to us as originals and the
conformity to original documents of all documents submitted to us as conformed
or photostatic copies.  As to any facts material to this opinion, we have relied
upon statements and representations (a) of the Company and its officers and
other representatives, (b) of the Selling Stockholders and, if applicable, their
officers and other representatives, and (c) of public officials.

     Based upon the foregoing, and subject to the limitations, qualifications,
exceptions, and assumptions set forth herein, we are of the opinion that the
shares of Common Stock covered by the Registration Statement to be issued by the
Company and to be sold by the Company and the Selling Stockholders, when issued
and

<PAGE>

Securities and Exchange Commission
July 5, 1996
Page 2

delivered in accordance with the terms described in the Registration Statement,
will be duly and validly issued, fully paid and nonassessable.

     We hereby consent to the filing of this opinion as an exhibit to the
Registration Statement and to the reference to our firm under the caption "Legal
Matters" in the prospectus contained therein.


                                   Very truly yours,

                                   /s/ Neal, Gerber & Eisenberg


                                   Neal, Gerber & Eisenberg



<PAGE>
                                                                    EXHIBIT 10.3

                        AMENDMENT TO EMPLOYMENT AGREEMENT

     THIS AMENDMENT TO EMPLOYMENT AGREEMENT  ("Agreement") is entered into on
the date set forth on the last page of this Agreement and is made effective as
of that date between JOE LIVINGSTON  ("Livingston"), on the one hand, and
TELETECH HOLDINGS, INC. ("the Company"), TOGETHER WITH TELETECH TELESERVICES,
INC., TELETECH TELECOMMUNICATIONS, INC. AND KENNETH TUCHMAN (collectively
referred to as "TeleTech"), on the other hand.  Livingston and TeleTech shall be
collectively referred to as "the Parties."

                                    RECITALS

     THIS AGREEMENT is entered into with reference to  the following facts:

     Livingston and the Company entered into a written employment agreement on
or about January 1, 1995 ("the Employment Agreement").  The Employment Agreement
is attached hereto as Exhibit A.

     Issues have arisen between the Parties regarding the terms and conditions
of Livingston's employment with the Company.

     It is the intention of the Parties to resolve, settle and dispose of, fully
and completely, any and all issues, claims, demands or causes of action that
either Party may have against the other Party related to, connected with, or
incidental to the acts of, relationships between and dealings between the
Parties, including, without limitation, all claims arising from the employment
of Livingston.

                                    AGREEMENT

     THEREFORE, by their signatures to this Agreement and in consideration of
the mutual covenants contained herein and for other good and valuable
consideration, the Parties agree as follows:

     1.   INCORPORATION OF RECITALS. The Parties hereby incorporate into this
Agreement all of the recitals set forth above.

     2.   INCORPORATION OF EMPLOYMENT AGREEMENT.  The Parties hereby incorporate
into this Agreement all of the terms and conditions of the Employment Agreement.
Except for the Employment Agreement Changes as defined herein and as otherwise
provided in this Agreement, the written provisions of the Employment Agreement
set forth the complete and sole terms and conditions of Livingston's employment,
and Livingston is not entitled to any compensation, rights, stock, stock
interests, ownership rights or other compensation or rights related to his
employment other than as specifically set forth in the Employment Agreement and
this Agreement.  In addition, except as otherwise reserved under Paragraph 4(B)
hereof,  the Parties acknowledge and agree that, as of the date of this
Agreement, there have not been

<PAGE>

and are not presently any breaches of the Employment Agreement by either Party.

     For purposes of this Agreement, "the Employment Agreement Changes" shall be
deemed to mean the following:

          A.   For 1996 and the remaining term of the Employment Agreement,
     Livingston's Base Compensation under Paragraph 3(A) shall be Two Hundred
     Fifty Thousand Dollars ($250,000.00) rather than One Hundred Sixty Thousand
     Dollars ($160,000.00).

     3.   ADDITIONAL STOCK OPTIONS GRANTED TO LIVINGSTON.  TeleTech shall grant
to Livingston Nonqualified Stock Options, under, and subject to the provisions
of, the TeleTech Holdings, Inc. Stock Plan ("the Stock Plan"), exercisable for
Fifteen Thousand (15,000) shares of TeleTech common stock at an option price of
Forty Dollars ($40.00) per share.  Such options shall be in addition to the
Nonqualified Stock Options granted to Livingston under the terms and conditions
of Paragraph 5 of the Employment Agreement and the Stock Plan.  The additional
stock options granted under this Agreement are and shall be subject to exactly
the same terms and conditions as the other stock options granted to Livingston
by Paragraph 5 of the Employment Agreement and subject to the terms and
conditions of the Nonqualified Stock Option Agreement which is attached as
Exhibit B hereto and hereby incorporated by reference.   In the event of any
conflict between the provisions of this Agreement, the Employment Agreement
and/or the Nonqualified Stock Option Agreement, the terms and conditions of the
Nonqualified Stock Option Agreement shall prevail.

     Except for the stock options referred to above, Livingston agrees that he
has no rights whatsoever of any nature to any stock, stock rights, Stock Plan
benefits, profits, debt, equity or ownership interests in TeleTech or any of its
affiliated or related companies.

     4.   IPO.   At the time of the first public offering of TeleTech shares,
subject to the approval of the underwriters and the Board of Directors,
Livingston shall have the following rights:

          A.   To include Donald Livingston on his "friends and family list"
related to the offering.  Nothing contained herein shall constitute a promise or
guarantee that  any  person shall have the right to purchase any stock which may
ultimately become available to "friends or family."

          B.   To exercise and sell at or about the time of the first offering
up to Ten Thousand (10,000) shares of stock after the proposed 5 for 1 stock
split at the same price offered to the public (as the shares being offered by
the Company and the other selling stockholder).


                                        2

<PAGE>

     5.   GENERAL RELEASES.  In consideration of the mutual releases contained
herein and for other good and valuable consideration, the receipt of which is
acknowledged by the Parties, the Parties promise, agree, and release each other
as follows:

          A.   Except as to the obligations and the rights of the Parties as
are created by this  Agreement, the Employment Agreement and the Nonqualified
Stock Option Agreements, Livingston hereby releases and forever discharges
TeleTech and its officers, employees, shareholders (including but not limited to
Kenneth Tuchman), directors, servants, administrators, parent, subsidiary and
affiliated companies, successors, assigns, attorneys and agents from any and all
claims, demands, damages, actions, causes of action, costs, expenses of suit at
law or in equity, known or unknown, which Livingston now has or may hereafter
have which arise, or have arisen, out of any acts or omissions which took place
prior to the date of this Agreement.

          B.   Except as to the obligations and the rights of the Parties as are
created by this Agreement, the Employment Agreement and the Nonqualified Stock
Option Agreements, TeleTech hereby releases and forever discharges Livingston
from any and all claims, demands, damages, actions, causes of action, costs,
expenses or suits at law or in equity, known or unknown, which TeleTech  now has
or may hereafter have which arise, or have arisen,  out of any acts or omissions
which took place prior to the date of this Agreement.  Notwithstanding the
above, the release of Livingston shall not extend to any unknown or unsuspected
claims of TeleTech which arise out of facts that could be adjudicated as theft,
fraud, embezzlement or a crime under federal, state or local law.

          C.   Each party specifically waives the benefit of the provisions of
Section 1542 of the California Civil Code, which reads as follows:

     "A GENERAL RELEASE DOES NOT EXTEND TO CLAIMS WHICH THE CREDITOR DOES NOT
     KNOW OR SUSPECT TO EXIST IN ITS FAVOR AT THE TIME OF EXECUTING THE RELEASE,
     WHICH IF KNOWN BY HIM MUST HAVE MATERIALLY AFFECTED HIS SETTLEMENT WITH THE
     DEBTOR."

     Each Party waives and releases any rights or benefits that he or she may
have under Section 1542 to the full extent that he or she may lawfully waive
such rights and benefits, and each Party acknowledges that he or she understands
the significance and consequences of the waiver of the provisions of California
Civil Code Section 1542 and that he or she has been advised by his or her own
attorney as to the significance and consequences of this waiver.

     6.   REPRESENTATIONS BY PARTIES AND THEIR AGENTS.   Except as expressly
provided herein, the Parties agree that, in connection with this Agreement, the
Parties and their agents have made no warranties or representations related to
any matter whatsoever, express or implied, including but not limited to the
Parties' claims, demands, damages,


                                        3

<PAGE>

actions, causes of action, costs, expenses or suits at law or in equity whether
as to their validity, probable value, probability of success or otherwise.  Each
of the Parties to this Agreement states that this  Agreement is made without
reliance upon any statement or representation of any other Party, his or her
representative or agent, except as expressly provided herein.

     7.   SUCCESSORS AND ASSIGNS.  This Agreement shall be binding upon and
inure to the benefit of  the Parties hereto, their respective heirs, executors,
administrators, successors, assigns, employees, owners, officers, directors,
subsidiaries, affiliates, predecessors, agents, attorneys and representatives,
and each of them.

     8.   AGREEMENT DRAFTED JOINTLY.  It is the intent of the Parties that no
part of this  Agreement be construed in favor of or against any of the Parties
hereto because of the identity of the drafter.

     9.   AUTHORITY TO ENTER THIS AGREEMENT.  Each of the Parties represents and
warrants on its own behalf that the individual signing this Agreement on its
behalf is fully authorized to sign on behalf of and bind it, and that it has the
power and authority to enter into this Agreement.

     10.  INDEMNIFICATION.  Each Party agrees to indemnify and hold the other
Party harmless from and against any liability, loss, judgment, settlement,
costs, or expense (including without limitation reasonable attorney's fees)
resulting from, arising out of, or occasioned by that Party's breach of the
warranties and representations contained in this  Agreement.

     11.  ARM'S LENGTH NEGOTIATIONS AND REPRESENTATION BY COUNSEL.  Each of the
Parties acknowledges and warrants on his or her own behalf that this Agreement
was negotiated by the Parties hereto at arm's length.   TeleTech and Livingston
each acknowledge that Berman, Blanchard, Mausner, Kindem & Resser ("BBMKR") has
drafted this Agreement and has represented both Parties on other matters.
Despite this representation, both Parties consent to BBMKR drafting this
Agreement and waive any conflict of interest related to having BBMKR do so.  The
Parties also agree that, in the event of any dispute between TeleTech and
Livingston, BBMKR shall have the right to represent TeleTech in such dispute.
The Parties acknowledge and agree that they have been advised by BBMKR that each
of them should have this Agreement reviewed and approved by independent legal
counsel before signing it, and, if they fail to do so, they each voluntarily
accept the risks of such failure.  With respect to representation by independent
counsel, TeleTech acknowledges and agrees that it has legal counsel in Chicago,
Illinois who could review this Agreement.  Livingston acknowledges and agrees
that he has legal counsel in Dallas, Texas who could review this Agreement.  The
Parties acknowledge and agree that they each have read this Agreement, that they
fully


                                        4

<PAGE>

understand the final and binding effect of this Agreement, that this Agreement
is fair and reasonable, that they are signing this Agreement after independent
investigation, voluntarily and without coercion, fraud, duress or undue
influence.

     12.  WARRANTY REGARDING OWNERSHIP OF CLAIMS RELEASED.  Each Party
represents and warrants that he, she or it is the sole owner of all rights,
claims, damages, actions, causes of action, and suits at law or in equity that
he, she or it may have against the other or arising out of the actions referred
to in this Agreement or any of the above-mentioned facts and that neither they
nor their respective predecessors, principals, agents, subsidiary, parent or
affiliated corporations have assigned or transferred or purported to assign or
transfer to any other person or entity any claim, demand, cause of action or
other matter herein released under the terms of this  Agreement.

     13.  EXECUTION IN COUNTERPARTS.  This Agreement may be executed in one or
more counterparts, all of which counterparts shall be deemed to be one
instrument and shall constitute one agreement with the same force and effect as
if all signatures had been entered on one document.

     14.  GOVERNING LAW.  This Agreement was entered into in the State of
California and is to be governed by and construed under and in accordance with
the laws of the State of California.  The Parties agree that any disputes
related to this Agreement shall be adjudicated exclusively by the Superior Court
of the State of California for the County of Los Angeles.

     15.  EXECUTION OF OTHER DOCUMENTS AND FURTHER ACTS.  In addition to the
acts described in this Agreement to be performed by each of the Parties, each
Party agrees to perform or cause to be performed all further acts and to execute
or cause to be executed promptly all documents and instruments necessary to give
effect to each term of this  Agreement.

     16.  NON-WAIVER.  No waiver of the breach of any of the provisions of this
Agreement shall be a waiver of any preceding or succeeding breach of this
Agreement or any other provisions of it.

     17.  CONSTRUCTION.  As used herein, the masculine gender shall include the
feminine and neuter and vice versa, and the singular shall include the plural,
wherever the context and facts require such construction.

     18.  MERGER AND MODIFICATION.  This Agreement by and among the Parties is
in lieu of and, except as otherwise expressly provided herein, in the Employment
Agreement or in the Nonqualified Stock Option Agreements, extinguishes all other
agreements which may have been entered into by, between or among the Parties,
and each of them and comprises the entire understanding of the Parties and may
only be modified, supplemented or amended by mutual agreement of the Parties in
a writing which specifically refers to


                                        5

<PAGE>

this Agreement. The Parties acknowledge and agree that there are no collateral
oral agreements between them with respect to the subject matter of this
Agreement, the Employment Agreement, the Nonqualified Stock Option Agreements or
any other agreement between the parties.

     19.  NO ADMISSION OF LIABILITY OR WRONGDOING.   Each of the Parties
acknowledges and agrees that the execution and delivery of this Agreement shall
not constitute or be construed as an admission of any liability or wrongdoing on
the part of any Party.

     IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the Parties hereto have executed this Agreement as of
the day and year set forth below.

Date: May 14, 1996

                           /s/ Joseph Livingston
                         -------------------------------------------------
                         JOE LIVINGSTON

                         TELETECH HOLDINGS, INC.


                           /s/ Kenneth Tuchman
                         ------------------------------------------------
                         BY: KENNETH TUCHMAN,
                         ITS CHIEF EXECUTIVE OFFICER


                         TELETECH TELESERVICES, INC.


                           /s/ Kenneth Tuchman
                         -----------------------------------------------
                         BY: KENNETH TUCHMAN,
                         ITS CHIEF EXECUTIVE OFFICER


                         TELETECH TELECOMMUNICATIONS, INC.


                           /s/ Kenneth Tuchman
                         -----------------------------------------------
                         BY: KENNETH TUCHMAN,
                         ITS CHIEF EXECUTIVE OFFICER


                           /s/ Kenneth Tuchman
                         -----------------------------------------------
                         KENNETH TUCHMAN, INDIVIDUALLY


                                        6

<PAGE>
                                                                    EXHIBIT 10.6
                                                                    ------------

DATED                                                             April 30, 1996
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------




                     SUBSCRIPTION AND SHAREHOLDERS AGREEMENT

                                  (relating to)

                                ACCESS 24 LIMITED           (1)

                             TELETECH HOLDINGS, INC.        (2)

                           PRIPLAN INVESTMENTS LIMITED      (3)





                                 LAWRENCE GRAHAM
                                   190 Strand
                                 London WC2R 1JN
                               Tel: 0171-379 0000

                                 Ref: 0245091.02

<PAGE>

CLAUSE NO.                                                              PAGE NO.
- ----------                                                              --------
                                    AGREEMENT


1.   DEFINITIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   1

2.   COMPLETION. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   7

3.   POST COMPLETION OBLIGATIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   7

4.   BUSINESS OF THE COMPANY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   9

5.   EXPANSION OF THE BUSINESS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  10

6.   DEVELOPMENT OF THE BUSINESS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  11

7.   INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY RIGHTS. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  11

8.   FUTURE FUNDING AND PUBLIC OFFERS. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  12

9.   BOARD OF DIRECTORS. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  13

10.  APPROVAL OF CERTAIN ACTIVITIES. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  14

11.  FINANCIAL STATEMENTS AND ACCOUNTS OF THE COMPANY. . . . . . . . . . . .  14

12.  CHARGING OF THE SHARES. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  15

13.  TRANSFER OF SHARES. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  15

14.  TELETECH PUT OPTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  16

15.  EVENTS OF DEFAULT OPTION. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  16

16.  NON-COMPETITION/CONFIDENTIALITY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  18

17.  GROUP GOVERNANCE. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  21

18.  ANNOUNCEMENTS. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  21

19.  WAIVERS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  22

20.  EXPIRATION. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  22



                                       -i-
<PAGE>


21.  COUNTERPARTS. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  22

22.  WHOLE AGREEMENT AND CONFLICT. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  22

23.  INVALIDITY AND SEVERABILITY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  22

24.  NO PARTNERSHIP. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  23

25.  NOTICES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  23

26.  PROPER LAW. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  24

27.  ASSIGNMENT. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  24

SCHEDULE 1     PART A - DETAILS OF THE COMPANY PRIOR TO AND
                POST COMPLETION. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  25

               PART B - DETAILS OF NEWCO POST
                COMPLETION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  26

SCHEDULE 2     RESOLUTIONS/ORDINARY RESOLUTIONS. . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  27

SCHEDULE 3     Development of the Business . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  29

SCHEDULE 4     Matters for Approval. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  32

SCHEDULE 5     DEED OF ADHERENCE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  34

SCHEDULE 6     Valuation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  35


                                  AGREED DRAFTS

Acquisition Agreement
Business Plan
New Articles of Association
Loan Agreement
Fixed and Floating Charges
Intra Group Agreement
Equipment Sub-Lease
Secondment Agreements
Guarantee



                                      -ii-
<PAGE>

THIS DEED is made the  30th day of April 1996

BETWEEN:-

(1)  ACCESS 24 LIMITED whose registered office is at Access 24 House, Bancroft
     Road, Reigate, Surrey RH2 7RP in the United Kingdom ("the Company");

(2)  TELETECH HOLDINGS, INC. a company registered in the State of Delaware in
     the United States of America whose registered office is at 1700 Lincoln
     Street, Suite 1400, Denver, Colorado, 80203 ("TeleTech");

(3)  PRIPLAN INVESTMENTS LIMITED whose registered office is at PPP House, Vale
     Road, Tunbridge Wells, Kent TN1 1BJ in the United Kingdom ("PPP").

WHEREAS:-

(A)  The Company was incorporated on 27 June 1995 and at present has an issued
     share capital of 2 ordinary shares held as to 2 Shares of L1 by TeleTech
     and has one subsidiary, Newco.

(B)  The Company leases certain assets for the purpose of operating services
     which provide information services to customers of the Company's clients.

(C)  The Company is in need of additional equity and loan capital in order to
     expand its operations and for this purpose PPP has agreed to purchase a
     shareholding in the Company, to subscribe for additional shares in the
     Company and to lend funds to the Company upon the terms and conditions
     hereinafter appearing.

(D)  Following completion of this Deed the Company will transfer its business
     and certain assets to Newco.

(E)  The parties hereto have agreed to govern their relations with each other
     upon the terms and the conditions hereinafter appearing.

IT IS AGREED as follows:-

1.   DEFINITIONS

1.1    In this Deed and the Schedules hereto the following expressions shall 
       have the meanings set out below, unless the context otherwise requires:-

       "Access 24"            means Access 24 Service Corporation Pty Limited a
                              company registered under the laws of Australia;


                                       -1-
<PAGE>

       "Accounts"              means an audited balance sheet and audited 
                               profit and loss account for each year ended on 
                               31 December of the Company to be prepared in 
                               accordance with recognized UK accounting 
                               standards and such other principles as the 
                               Shareholders may agree from time to time and 
                               insofar as is consistent with the Companies Acts
                               and such standards, the accounts shall be 
                               prepared on a basis which, to the extent agreed 
                               by the Board, takes account of TeleTech's group 
                               reporting policies from time to time;

       "Acquisition Agreement" means the agreement for the purchase by PPP of 
                               50% of the issued ordinary share capital of the 
                               Company in the form of the agreed draft;

       " "A" Director"         means any director of the Company appointed by 
                               PPP in accordance with the provisions of 
                               Clause 9.2;

       "agreed draft"          means in relation to any document the draft of 
                               that document which has been initialled for the 
                               purpose of identification by or on behalf of the
                               parties hereto or their respective solicitors; 

       "Agreement for Lease"   an agreement for the grant of the Lease in 
                               respect of the Property dated 19th August 1995 
                               between Invesco Group Limited (1) and Access 24 
                               (2) together with the License to Sub-let and the
                               License to Carry Out Alterations attached thereto
                               in the agreed form;

       "Associate"             means any person or company who is a connected 
                               person as that expression is defined by section
                               839 of the Taxes Act; 

       "AT&T Guarantee"        a guarantee issued by Access 24 in favor of AT&T
                               whereby Access 24 has guaranteed the payments 
                               due to AT&T by the Company pursuant to an 
                               agreement for leasing certain computer and 
                               telecommunication equipment dated 28 November 
                               1995 between the Company and AT&T which was 
                               novated in favor of the
                               Company on 30 April 1996;

                                       -2-
<PAGE>

       " "B" Director"         means any director of the Company appointed by 
                               TeleTech in accordance with the provisions of 
                               Clause 9.2;

       "Board"                 the board of directors of the Company as from 
                               time to time constituted;

       "Business"              means the business of the Company as set out in 
                               detail in Clause 4;

       "Business Day"          means any day (other than a Saturday or Sunday) 
                               on which banks are open for business in London; 

       "Business Plan"         means the business plan in the form of the 
                               agreed draft as prepared by TeleTech and PPP for
                               the development of the Business to be formally 
                               adopted at the first meeting of the Board 
                               following Completion as amended or updated from 
                               time to time;

       "Companies Act"         means the Companies Acts 1985 and 1989;

       "Completion"            means completion of the obligations of the 
                               parties hereunder in accordance with the 
                               provisions of Clause 2 hereof;

       "Completion Date"       the date of this Deed;

       "Connected Person"      means in relation to any person or company, a 
                               person or company who is connected with them or 
                               it within the meaning of Section 839 of the 
                               Taxes Act;

       "Director(s)"           means dependant on the context the directors of 
                               the Company from time to time;

       "Equipment SubLease"    means an agreement between Newco and the Company
                               whereby certain assets will be leased by the 
                               Company to Newco in the form of the agreed draft;

       "Events of Default"     means the events of default set out in clause 
                               15.1;


                                       -3-
<PAGE>


       "financial year"        means a year or other financial period ending 
                               on December 31 in respect of which the Company 
                               prepares its accounts for audit in accordance 
                               with the relevant provisions of the Companies 
                               Act;

       "Group"                 means in the applicable context of either 
                               Shareholder any company which at the relevant 
                               time, is the ultimate holding company of the 
                               Shareholder, another subsidiary of such holding 
                               company or a subsidiary of such Shareholder (as 
                               such expressions are defined in Section 736 of 
                               the Companies Act);

       "Healthline Agreement"  means an agreement between Access 24 and Private
                               Patients Plan Limited dated 24 July 1995 
                               relating to the provision of information services
                               which was novated in favor of the Company on 
                               30 April 1996;

       "Intra-Group Agreement" means the sale agreement between the Company 
                               and Newco in the form of the agreed draft 
                               whereby the staff, the business and certain 
                               assets of the Company (including the Healthline 
                               Agreement) are to be transferred to Newco;

       "Intellectual Property
         Rights"               patents, trade marks and service marks, rights 
                               in designs, trade or business names, copyrights 
                               and topography rights (whether or not any of 
                               these is registered and including applications 
                               for registration of any such thing) and rights 
                               under licenses and consents in relation to any 
                               such thing and all rights or forms of protection
                               of a similar nature or having equivalent or 
                               similar effect to any of these which may subsist
                               anywhere in the world;

       "Lease"                 means the agreed form lease attached to the 
                               Agreement for Lease; 

       "Loan Agreement"        means a loan facility agreement between the 
                               Company and PPP, the fixed and floating charges 
                               to be entered into by the Company and Newco and 
                               the guarantee to be provided by Newco to PPP in 
                               support of the Company's obligations under the 
                               Loan Agreement; 


                                       -4-
<PAGE>


       "New Articles"          means the new Articles of Association to be 
                               adopted by the Company concurrently with and 
                               subject to Completion in the form of the agreed 
                               draft as amended from time to time; 

       "Newco"                 means Makecents Limited a wholly owned 
                               subsidiary of the Company details of which are 
                               set out in Part B of Schedule 1;

       "Novation Agreement"    means an agreement between the Company Newco, 
                               Access 24 and Private Patients Plan Limited to 
                               novate the Healthline Agreement in favor of 
                               Newco;

       "Ordinary Shares"       means the 1 "A" Ordinary Share of L1 in the 
                               Company to be held by PPP and 1 "B" Ordinary 
                               Shares of L1 to be held by TeleTech upon 
                               reclassification of its holdings of ordinary 
                               shares in the Company following completion of 
                               the Acquisition Agreement and to be created by 
                               the Resolutions;

       "PPP's Solicitors"      means Lawrence Graham, 190 Strand, London WC2R 
                               1JN; 
       "Preference 
          Shareholders"        means PPP in its capacity as holder of 
                               Preference Shares; 

       "Preference Shares"     means the 1,000,000 2006 Cumulative Redeemable 7%
                               Preference Shares of L1 each in the capital of 
                               the Company to be created by the Resolutions; 

       "Property"              means the leasehold property at Reigate which is
                               the subject of the Agreement for Lease; 

       "Resolutions"           means the resolutions of the Company in the form
                               set out in Schedule 2; 

       "Shareholders"          means TeleTech and PPP in their capacity as 
                               holders of Ordinary Shares; 


                                       -5-
<PAGE>


       "Shares"                means any or all as the context requires of the 
                               "A" and "B" Ordinary Shares and the Preference 
                               Shares; 

       "Secondment Agreements" means agreements between Access 24 and Newco in 
                               respect of Messrs John Kendall and Louis Carroll
                               in the forms of the agreed drafts; 

       "subsidiary"            means a subsidiary as that expression is defined
                               by Section 736(1) of the Companies Act; 

       "Taxation"              all forms of taxation, duties, imposts, levies 
                               and rates whenever created or imposed and 
                               whether of the United Kingdom or elsewhere and 
                               all penalties and interest payable in respect 
                               thereof;

       "Taxes Act"             the Income and Corporation Taxes Act 1988; 

       "London Stock Exchange" means London Stock Exchange Limited; 

       "Value Added Services"  means the services to be provided by the Company
                               as set out in detail in Clause 4; 

1.2    Any reference express or implied to an enactment (including any 
       subordinate legislation) includes references to:-

       1.2.1     that enactment as from time to time modified or re-enacted 
                 (with or without modification);

       1.2.2     any enactment which that enactment re-enacts (with or without
                 modification); and

       1.2.3     any subordinate legislation made under that enactment or under
                 any enactment referred to in paragraph 1.2.1 or 1.2.2 above; 

1.3    Words denoting the singular shall include the plural and vice versa; 
       reference to the masculine includes a reference to the feminine and 
       neuter and bodies corporate.

1.4    In this Deed, unless the context otherwise requires, references to 
       Schedules are to Schedules in this Deed and references to Clauses are to
       Clauses in this Deed and, references to paragraphs are to paragraphs of 
       the Clause in which such reference appears. The Schedules form part of 
       this Deed.


                                       -6-
<PAGE>


1.5      The headings in this Deed are for ease of reference only and shall not
         affect its interpretation.

1.6      Any date or period mentioned in any Clause may be extended with the 
         approval of the Shareholders but otherwise time shall be of the 
         essence.

1.7      In this Deed words and phrases the definition of which is contained or
         referred to in Part XXVI of the Companies Act shall be construed as 
         defined therein.

2.       COMPLETION

2.1      Completion shall take place on the Completion Date at the offices of 
         PPP's Solicitors or such other offices as the parties may subsequently
         agree when:-

         2.1.1     The parties to the extent applicable shall complete this 
                   Deed, the Acquisition Agreement and the Loan Agreement in 
                   accordance with their terms.

         2.1.2     The Company shall pass the Resolutions. 

         2.1.3     PPP shall subscribe in cash for, and the Company shall allot
                   the number of Preference Shares for the consideration of 
                   L1,000,000.

         2.1.4     PPP shall pay in full for the Preference Shares by delivery 
                   to the Company of a bankers draft for, or a telex transfer 
                   in the amount of L1,000,000 and unless otherwise agreed in 
                   writing the subscription monies shall be solely applied by 
                   the Company for the purpose of repaying the amount of 
                   inter-company debt owed by the Company to Access 24 as at 
                   the date hereof being not more than L710,132.22 and for the 
                   balance to be used as working capital in accordance with 
                   the Business Plan.

         2.1.5     TeleTech will appoint the "B" Directors and PPP will appoint
                   the "A" Directors, all of whom will be elected to the Board.

         2.1.6     The Company shall issue under its seal a certificate for the
                   Preference Shares so allotted to PPP and shall register it 
                   as the holder thereof.

         2.1.7     The Company shall file all the requisite forms and returns. 

3.       POST COMPLETION OBLIGATIONS

3.1      The Shareholders undertake and covenant with each other that 
         immediately following Completion that:-


                                       -7-
<PAGE>


       3.1.1     they will procure the repayment of the inter company 
                 indebtedness in the amount owed by the Company to 
                 Access 24.; and

       3.1.2     they will procure that Newco applies for VAT Registration 
                 and applies to join the existing VAT Group of which PPP 
                 healthcare group limited is the representative member or such 
                 other VAT Grouping as PPP may from time to time determine. 

       3.1.3     thereafter they will procure the execution and completion of 
                 the following agreements in accordance with their respective 
                 terms and conditions:-

                 (a)  the Intra-Group Agreement;

                 (b)  the Novation Agreement;

                 (c)  the Equipment Sub-Lease

                 (d)  such security documentation as is required to be entered 
                      into under the Loan Agreement.

       3.1.4     the Company will, on behalf of Access 24, complete the Works 
                 and the Fitting Out Works and carry out and complete the 
                 Entrance Works (all as defined in the Agreement for Lease) in 
                 full compliance with the terms of the Agreement for Lease (as 
                 such agreement may be varied from time to time by parties 
                 thereto, save that Access 24 shall not agree to vary the terms
                 thereof without the prior consent in writing of the Company, 
                 such consent not to be unreasonably withheld), and the Company
                 shall indemnify and keep indemnified Access 24 against any 
                 losses, damages, costs (including reasonable and properly 
                 incurred professional fees) expenses or other liabilities 
                 suffered or incurred by it as a result of the failure by the 
                 Company to perform its obligations under this sub-clause.

3.2    PPP will indemnify and keep indemnified Teletech (for itself and as 
       trustee for Access 24) against 50% of any losses, damages costs 
       (including reasonable and properly incurred professional fees) expenses 
       or other liabilities suffered by Access 24 as a result of a demand being
       made against it under the AT&T Guarantee save in respect of any demand 
       which is caused by any breach of the contract with AT&T for which the 
       AT&T Guarantee is provided.

3.3    Teletech will use its reasonable endeavors to procure that upon 
       completion of the Lease to Access 24 in accordance with the Agreement 
       for Lease and conditional upon obtaining all necessary consents pursuant
       to Clause 5.1 of the Agreement for Lease, Access 24 will assign the 
       Lease to the Company.


                                       -8-
<PAGE>

3.4    If in any respect the provisions of sub-clause 3.1 are not complied with
       in full by all parties the Shareholders acknowledge and accept that such
       a failure would constitute a fundamental breach of this Deed.

4.     BUSINESS OF THE COMPANY

4.1    The business of the Company shall unless and until the parties otherwise
       agree be confined to the provision of customer-care communications 
       services using integrated voice and data communications technology which
       provide Value Added Services to clients of the Company ("Client(s)"). 
       The Shareholders agree that Value Added Services are services that both:-

       4.1.1     are not a routine transactional interaction between a Client 
                 and its customers (but may be combined with or connected to 
                 such a routine transactional interaction); and

       4.1.2     are capable of being publicly advertised as a distinct value 
                 added service. 

       In addition to these two core principles the services shall also meet 
       one or more of the following criteria in order to constitute Value Added
       Services:-

       (a)  they are services for which a customer of a Client might be willing
            to pay additional fees;

       (b)  they are provided by experts (such as nurses, nutritionists, etc) or
            specially trained personnel of the Company utilizing specially 
            developed software packages for information storage and retrieval; 

       (c)  are services that enable a Client to differentiate itself from its 
            competitors; 

       (d)  they are services that enhance an integral part of a Client's 
            business; or 

       (e)  they are services that constitute information services and/or 
            assistance services. 

4.2    In the event that the Directors are not able to agree on whether a 
       certain service falls within the above criteria the issue shall be put 
       to a specially designated "A" Director, or such other "A" Director 
       designated by PPP from time to time and a specially designated "B" 
       Director, or such other "B" Director designated by TeleTech from time 
       to time (collectively the "Designated Directors");  To initiate this 
       resolution process, either Shareholder shall be entitled to deliver 
       written notice to the other Shareholder and the Company specifying, in 
       reasonable detail, the facts supporting its position that a specified 
       proposed service is or is not a Value Added Service.  During the 14 
       Business Days following the date of service by a Shareholder of the 
       foregoing notice the Designated Directors shall attempt in good faith 
       to resolve the dispute.  Provided


                                       -9-
<PAGE>

       that if TeleTech submits that a service to be provided from within the 
       territory described in Clause 5 is one that (a) TeleTech performed for 
       its clients prior to the date on which it acquired Access 24 AND (b) it 
       is a routine transactional service that constitutes one or more of the 
       following: (i) providing technical "help desk" product or service support
       or operating instructions/assistance relating to the installation or use 
       by a customer of a client's product or service, (ii) processing and 
       fulfilling requests for the purchase of or subscription to a client's 
       product or service offerings, (iii) tracking package delivery and 
       answering inquiries or resolving complaints relating thereto, 
       (iv) answering billing or account queries, (v) reserving or confirming 
       space, such as at seminars or on airline flights, (vi) activating product
       or service upgrades, or (vii) confirming receipt of products or services 
       previously ordered; or (viii) equipping, staffing and managing call 
       centers pursuant to a contract with a client in connection with 
       TeleTech's provision of any of the services described in sub-clauses (i)
       to (vii) then the Specially Designated "A" Directors shall not be able 
       to insist or maintain that such a service is a Value Added Service.  If 
       the dispute is resolved, the Designated Directors shall submit a joint 
       letter to the Company informing it of the resolution.  Any resolution 
       agreed to by the Designated Directors will be binding on the 
       Shareholders and the Company.

4.3    If the Designated Directors are unable, within the said 14 Business Day 
       period, to resolve a dispute on whether a specified proposed service is 
       or is not a Value Added Service, the dispute shall be submitted to a 
       neutral third party, selected jointly by the Designated Directors, who is
       not affiliated with either Shareholder or the Company.  If the Designated
       Directors are unable, within 7 Business Days, to agree upon the selection
       of a neutral third party, either or both of the Designated Directors may
       request that such party be chosen by the President of the Law Society, in
       London, England.  The neutral third party, upon selection and upon 
       execution of an appropriate confidentiality agreement, shall be supplied
       with any information which he may reasonably request in connection with 
       the dispute.  The neutral third party shall act as an expert, not as an 
       arbitrator, and his decision shall not be binding on the Designated 
       Directors.  If the Designated Directors are unable to resolve the dispute
       based on the decision of the neutral third party, the Designated 
       Directors shall advise the Shareholders in writing of such decision and 
       the Shareholders then shall determine how the dispute should be resolved.

4.4    Any costs incurred in the operation of the resolution process provided 
       for in Clauses 4.2 and 4.3 shall be borne by the Company. 

5.     EXPANSION OF THE BUSINESS

5.1    The Business shall be carried on by Newco through branches or other 
       subsidiary companies established in the United Kingdom and Ireland. 


                                      -10-
<PAGE>


5.2    The Company and Newco will not set up premises, facilities or branches 
       to expand the Business in new territories outside of the UK and Ireland 
       without the prior written consent of both PPP and TeleTech. 

6.     DEVELOPMENT OF THE BUSINESS

6.1    In the promotion of the Business and development of the facilities at the
       Property or such other properties as the Shareholders may agree to during
       the term of this Agreement PPP and TeleTech undertake to each other as 
       follows:- 

       6.1.1     PPP or members of its Group will provide the services and 
                 manpower detailed in Schedule 3; 

       6.1.2     TeleTech or members of its Group will provide the services and
                 manpower detailed in Schedule 3; 

       6.1.3     the development of the Business and the facilities at the 
                 Property (and at any future properties) will be phased in 
                 accordance with the Business Plan; 

       6.1.4     except to the extent otherwise specifically provided herein and
                 to the maximum extent feasible, the Shareholders agree that the
                 Company will operate as a stand alone business, including with 
                 respect to its marketing, sales, human resources, training, 
                 operations and financial functions, and that TeleTech and PPP 
                 will participate equally and actively to establish and manage 
                 the business on an ongoing basis;

       6.1.5     the model for development of the facilities at the Property 
                 will, as appropriate, be based upon the TeleTech facility in 
                 Burbank, California, or as otherwise provided for in the 
                 Business Plan; and

       6.1.6     that each of them will use its best endeavors to promote and 
                 develop the Business to the best advantage of the Company. 

7.     INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY RIGHTS

7.1    Subject to the provisions of this clause, the ownership of any 
       Intellectual Property Rights developed or created by the Company during 
       the term of this Agreement shall vest in the Company Provided that the 
       Company will grant perpetual licenses to each Shareholder to use the 
       same on a royalty free, unlimited seat and unlimited geographic basis. 

7.2    Each of PPP and TeleTech will grant licenses to the Company to use any 
       Intellectual Property Rights owned by it and which are applicable to the
       Business,  on a royalty free unlimited seat basis which licenses will 
       include rights to modify and/or enhance 


                                      -11-
<PAGE>

       such Intellectual Property Rights.  Any enhancements or modifications 
       to such licensed Intellectual Property Rights by the Company or TeleTech
       or PPP automatically will be owned by the owner of the licensed original
       Intellectual Property Rights with the Company automatically obtaining a
       license to such modifications and enhancements on the same terms as the
       Company's original license in respect of such Intellectual Property 
       Rights.

7.3    In the event that either PPP (or any member of its Group) or TeleTech 
       (or any member of its Group) ceases to be a holder of its Shares (the 
       "Departing Shareholder"):-

       7.3.1     all licenses of Intellectual Property Rights granted to the 
                 Company (or to any Associate of the Company) by the Departing 
                 Shareholder or any Associate of the Departing Shareholder and 
                 in effect at such date (the "Termination Date") shall continue
                 to have effect, but solely in respect of any service agreements
                 between the Company and its Clients in existence at the
                 Termination Date, until such service agreements expire or are
                 terminated.

       7.3.2     the Departing Shareholder shall offer to provide, or continue 
                 to provide, following the Termination Date service and 
                 maintenance of Intellectual Property Rights licensed to the 
                 Company at the commercial rates then charged by it, as the 
                 same may be amended from time to time; and

       7.3.3     subject to clause 7.3.1, after the Termination Date, the 
                 Departing Shareholder may grant new licenses to the Company or
                 renew existing licenses upon expiration of the same, in its 
                 sole discretion and on such commercial terms as the parties 
                 may negotiate on an arms length basis.

8.     FUTURE FUNDING AND PUBLIC OFFERS

8.1    In addition to the shares to be subscribed for under Clause 2.1.3 the 
       Shareholders undertake to subscribe in equal proportions for any shares 
       offered by the Company by way of any rights issue, approved unanimously 
       by the Board, in the event that the monies raised by the issue of the 
       Preference Shares and the monies advanced under the Loan Agreement have 
       been fully utilized by the Company but additional sums of money are 
       required by the Company.

8.2    If any rent deposit and/or guarantee of the performance of the 
       obligations of the Company is required by the landlord in respect of the
       Property in order for it to give its consent to an assignment of the 
       lease either such rent deposit shall be contributed on an equal basis or
       such guarantee shall be given jointly and severally by the Shareholders 
       PROVIDED THAT each Shareholder shall indemnify the other Shareholder to 
       the extent that the other Shareholder is required to pay more than one 
       half of the total sum (including costs, interest and other charges) 
       required to be paid


                                      -12-
<PAGE>

       under such guarantee to the intent that each Shareholder shall only bear
       one half of the liability under such guarantee.  FURTHER PROVIDED THAT 
       in the event that either Shareholder disposes of its shares to the other
       Shareholder then the Shareholder acquiring such shares will use all
       reasonable endeavors to obtain the release of that Shareholder from any
       rent deposit, guarantees and indemnities which it may have given pursuant
       to this Deed in respect of any of the liabilities or obligations of the
       Company to third parties and pending the obtaining of such release the
       other Shareholder and shall keep that Shareholder fully and effectively
       indemnified against any liability pursuant to any such guarantees or
       indemnities.

8.3    In the event that the Company by way of unanimous decision of the Board
       decides to make an application for admission of all or any part of its
       share capital to the Official List of the London Stock Exchange, or the
       grant of permission to deal in the same on the alternative investments
       market, or any other recognized stock exchange in the United Kingdom or 
       in the United States of America, the Company hereby undertakes and  
       covenants with the Shareholders that it will upon receipt of written 
       notice from any Shareholder procure to include all the Ordinary Shares 
       owned by it (or such portion as shall be designated by such Shareholder)
       in such application.

9.     BOARD OF DIRECTORS

9.1    Unless otherwise agreed by the parties hereto, the number of Directors of
       the Company shall not exceed eight.

9.2    The Shareholders shall each be entitled to appoint up to four Directors 
       to the Board and to appoint a new director to take the place of any 
       Director appointed by it who vacates office for any cause.  A Director 
       shall be removed either at the request of the Shareholder who requested 
       his appointment upon such Shareholder serving written notice on the 
       Director and copying the same to the Board, or by a resolution of the 
       majority of the Board (exclusive of the Director whose conduct is at 
       issue) for Cause. Directors appointed by PPP shall be "A" Directors and 
       Directors appointed by TeleTech shall be "B" Directors.  For purposes of
       this Clause 9.2, "Cause" shall mean a Director's (i) breach of, or 
       wilful and continued failure to perform his duties as a director of the 
       Company, (ii) wilful conduct which, upon the unanimous determination of 
       the Board, reached in good faith, (exclusive of the director whose 
       conduct is at issue), is significantly injurious or detrimental to the 
       Company, (iii) conviction for or a plea of guilty to any serious material
       criminal offence.

9.3    In addition to their powers to appoint Directors each Shareholder will be
       entitled to appoint one observer who will be entitled to receive notice 
       of board meetings and attend the same but will have no right to vote on 
       any issues put before such meetings.

9.4    Any Director appointed under Clause 9.2 shall be entitled to pass to the
       Shareholder appointing him full details of any information which may 
       come into his possession as


                                      -13-
<PAGE>


       such Director and the Company shall ensure that each Director is fully 
       and regularly informed of the trading and financial position of the 
       Company and is supplied with whatever information relating to the 
       Company as he may reasonably require to fulfil his duties as a Director.

9.5    Each Director shall be entitled to appoint an alternate pursuant to the 
       New Articles.

9.6    Each of the Shareholders undertakes that there will be at all times a
       Director appointed by him pursuant to Clause 9.2 able and willing to 
       act as such Director.

9.7    The Chairman of any Meeting of the Board shall not have a casting vote.

9.8    Save unless the Shareholders or the Directors shall unanimously consent 
       in writing each Director shall be given reasonable notice of all Board 
       Meetings (being not less than fourteen Business Days) in accordance with
       the New Articles and shall be entitled to inspect any documents or assets
       of the Company. 

9.9    The Company Secretary of the Company shall be Edward Davis. 

10.    APPROVAL OF CERTAIN ACTIVITIES

10.1   The matters set out in Schedule 4 shall only be undertaken by the Company
       if all the Directors unanimously shall have voted in favor of the 
       proposed course of action and save as required by law no meeting of the 
       Shareholder shall be convened by the Directors or any Shareholders' 
       resolution be put to the Shareholders unless the Directors shall have 
       voted unanimously to convene such proposed meeting or voted unanimously 
       in favor of the proposed resolution.

10.2   A meeting of the Board or a meeting of the Shareholders shall not be 
       quorate unless in the case of a Board Meeting at least one "A" Director 
       and one "B" Director (or their designated alternate directors) is 
       present and in the case of a Shareholders' Meeting the duly authorized 
       representative or proxy of each Shareholder and the Preference 
       Shareholders is present in each case throughout the Meeting. 

10.3   The Shareholders undertake to each other not to requisition meetings of 
       the Shareholders pursuant to the Companies Act. 

11.    FINANCIAL STATEMENTS AND ACCOUNTS OF THE COMPANY

11.1   The Company and the Shareholders shall procure that management reports 
       including financial statements showing the trading position of the 
       Company, a profit and loss account for the year to date and balance 
       sheet shall be prepared and circulated to all Shareholders and 
       Directors at least once every 3 months. 


                                      -14-
<PAGE>

11.2   The Accounts of the Company shall be made up to 31st December in each 
       year or such other date as may be resolved by the Board.

11.3   The Auditors of the Company shall be Messrs Coopers & Lybrand. 

11.4   All books of account daily income and expenditure records and bank 
       paying in books shall be kept open for inspection by each of the 
       Shareholders or its directors.

11.5   The Company's bank mandate shall require the signature of one "A" 
       Director and one "B" Director (or any other designated signatories as 
       the directors unanimously appoint) for all transactions in excess of 
       L100,000.

12.    CHARGING OF THE SHARES

       None of the Shareholders shall, except with the prior written consent 
       of the others, create or permit or subsist any pledge, lien or charge 
       over, or grant any option or other rights to dispose of any interest in,
       all or any of the Shares held by it (otherwise than by a transfer of 
       such Shares in accordance with the provisions of the New Articles).

13.    TRANSFER OF SHARES

13.1   No Shareholder shall be entitled to transfer its shares in the Company, 
       or any interest therein, except in accordance with the provision of the 
       New Articles and the Company shall not recognize or accept for 
       registration any transfer or purported transfer in contravention of the 
       New Articles.

13.2   The parties shall procure that before any person (other than a person 
       who is already a Shareholder) is registered as a holder of any share in 
       the Company such person shall enter into a deed of adherence in the form
       set out in Schedule 5 to this Deed.  The Company shall not register any 
       such person as the holder of any share until such a deed has been 
       executed and upon being so registered that person shall be deemed to be 
       a party to this Deed.

13.3   The Company shall not register any transfer made in breach of sub-clause
       13.1 and the shares comprised in any transfer so made shall carry no 
       rights whatsoever unless and until in each case the breach is rectified.

14.    TELETECH PUT OPTION

14.1   If it is alleged that Private Patients Plan Limited is in breach, other 
       than a breach caused solely or predominantly by the breach of the 
       Company or TeleTech, of any material obligation which it owes to the 
       Company under the Healthline Contract, PPP agrees that the prosecution 
       of any right of action which the Company may have in respect thereof 
       shall be passed to the "B" Directors who shall have full authority on 


                                      -15-
<PAGE>

       behalf of the Company to negotiate, litigate and settle any claim arising
       therewith and PPP shall take all steps within its power to give effect to
       the provisions of this sub-clause;

14.2   The provisions of sub-clause 14.1 shall apply mutatis mutandis in 
       relation to any such breach of the Healthline Contract caused solely or 
       predominantly by TeleTech as a result of its failure to provide the 
       Company with the Intellectual Property Rights and support detailed in 
       Schedule Three and the conduct of any claim by the Company in respect 
       thereof shall be passed to the "A" Directors; 

14.3   In the event of any breach by Private Patients Plan Limited of its 
       obligations under the Healthline Contract, other than by reason of the 
       Company's breach of the Healthline Contract in accordance with its terms
       and specifications, which the Shareholders are unable to resolve and 
       which:-

       14.3.1    occurs within eighteen months of the date of this Deed; and 

       14.3.2    is not remedied within 30 days of written notice having been 
                 given by the "B" Directors detailing the breach; and 

       14.3.3    gives rise to a loss to the Company of Service Fees due under 
                 the Healthline Contract for four months or more; 

       then notwithstanding the provisions of sub-clause 14.1 TeleTech shall 
       have the option to require PPP to purchase all of its Ordinary Shares by
       giving written notice, on the exercise of which PPP shall become bound 
       to purchase and Teletech shall become bound to complete the sale of 
       such shares for a price equal to the total valuation price per share 
       which shall be the value as determined in accordance with the provisions
       of Schedule 6.

15.    EVENTS OF DEFAULT OPTION

15.1   The following shall be Events of Default in relation to either 
       Shareholder:-

       (a)  any breach by such Shareholder of its material obligations under 
            this Deed if such default is incapable of remedy or, if capable of 
            remedy, such default continues unremedied for 30 days after notice 
            thereof has been given by the other Shareholder to the said 
            Shareholder and the Company;

       (b)  the Shareholder whilst insolvent compounds or proposes or enters 
            into any re-organization or other special arrangement with its 
            creditors or is unable to pay its debts within the meaning of S.123
            Insolvency Act 1986 or in respect of TeleTech the Bankruptcy Reform
            Act 1978;


                                      -16-
<PAGE>


       (c)  an encumbrancer lawfully takes possession (and does not relinquish
            possession within 30 days) or an administrative receiver or receiver
            is validly appointed of the whole or a substantial part of the
            undertaking, property or assets of the Shareholder or an
            administration order is made in respect of the Shareholder (and such
            appointment is not vacated or administration order dismissed within
            30 days);

       (d)  an order is made or an effective resolution is passed or any 
            analogous proceedings are taken for the winding up of the 
            Shareholder other than a members' voluntary liquidation solely for 
            the purpose of a solvent amalgamation or reconstruction on terms 
            previously notified in writing to the Other Shareholder; 

       (e)  any of the matters referred to in paragraphs (b), (c) and (d) above
            occurs in relation to any holding company for the time being of the
            Shareholder; 

15.2   Upon the occurrence of an Event of Default in relation to one Shareholder
       (the "Defaulting Shareholder") the other Shareholder ("Other 
       Shareholder") shall be at liberty whilst such default continues 
       unremedied to give notice (a "Default Notice") to the Defaulting 
       Shareholder requiring the Defaulting Shareholder to sell its shares in 
       the Company ("the Shares") to the Other Shareholder for a price equal 
       to the total valuation price for such Shares which shall be the value 
       as determined in accordance with the provisions of Schedule 6 ("the 
       Valuation Price").

15.3   Any Preference Shares owned by a Defaulting Shareholder shall be 
       transferred to the Other Shareholder concurrently with the transfer, 
       pursuant to this Clause 15, of the Defaulting Shareholder's Ordinary 
       Shares and upon payment by the Other Shareholder of consideration equal 
       to the issue price per Preference Share plus any dividends accrued up 
       to the date of purchase but unpaid thereon.

15.4   Once the Valuation Price has been determined as provided in Clause 15.2,
       the said Shares shall be transferred to the Other Shareholder within a
       period of fourteen days after such valuation and each Shareholder hereby
       appoints the Other Shareholder as its attorney to execute such transfer 
       on its behalf and in its name in default of its doing so within such 
       period and to receive the Valuation Price on its behalf, such 
       appointment being irrevocable and by way of security for its obligations
       hereunder.

16.    NON-COMPETITION/CONFIDENTIALITY

16.1   Each of the Shareholders undertakes and covenants that while it continues
       to hold shares in the Company and for a period of 18 months following the
       date of its ceasing to be a Shareholder it will not provide and will
       procure that no member of its Group (except the Company) will provide 
       Value Added Services that emanate or originate from within the United 
       Kingdom or Ireland or such other jurisdictions as the Company 


                                      -17-
<PAGE>


       may subsequently operate out of in accordance with this Deed 
       (collectively, the "Territory") without the prior written consent of the
       other Shareholder, except for any such services that are merely 
       incidental to a multinational services agreement pursuant to which such 
       Shareholder provides such services to a client predominantly from a call
       center located outside the Territory.  PROVIDED THAT nothing in this 
       Clause shall prevent any of the Shareholders from holding up to 5% of 
       any class of the stocks shares or debentures in any public limited 
       company whose stocks shares or debentures are listed or quoted on a 
       stock exchange or dealt in on an unlisted securities market.

16.2   Each Shareholder acknowledges that it may be furnished with or may 
       otherwise obtain or have access to proprietary or confidential 
       information regarding the Company or its subsidiaries or Clients, the 
       other Shareholder and/or other businesses of the other Shareholder, 
       which information may include business ideas, plans or concepts, 
       financial plans or projections, marketing plans and know-how, trade 
       secrets, customer and supplier names, and other confidential and 
       proprietary technical, financial or business information (collectively, 
       "Confidential Information").  Each Shareholder acknowledges that all 
       Confidential Information, whether in oral, written, encoded, graphic or 
       other tangible or intangible form, is subject to the terms of this Deed.

16.3   Notwithstanding the foregoing, the following shall not be considered 
       Confidential Information subject to the duty of protection imposed by 
       this Deed:

       16.3.1    information that is or becomes generally available to and 
                 known by the public other than as a result of an unauthorized
                 disclosure by a Shareholder; 

       16.3.2    information which is received by a Shareholder on a non- 
                 confidential basis from a third person who is not under any 
                 obligation to maintain the confidentiality thereof; or 

       16.3.3    information that a Shareholder can prove was independently 
                 developed by it without breaching its confidentiality 
                 obligations under this Deed.

16.4   So long as it is a shareholder of the Company and at all times 
       thereafter, each Shareholder agrees to:

       16.4.1    hold all Confidential Information in confidence and protect it
                 from disclosure with at least the same degree of care by which
                 such Shareholder protects its own propriety or confidential
                 information, but in no event less than a reasonable degree of
                 care;

       16.4.2    restrict disclosure of Confidential Information solely to 
                 those directors, officers, employees or representatives of 
                 Shareholder or any member of the Shareholders Group 
                 (collectively, "Representatives") who have a need to know 
                 such Confidential Information in connection with such 
                 Shareholder's


                                      -18-
<PAGE>


       performance of services on behalf and for the benefit of the Company; 
       provided that such Representatives first are informed of the 
       confidential nature of the subject matter of such disclosure; 

       16.4.3    use Confidential Information relating to the Company only in 
                 connection with the performance of services on behalf and for 
                 the benefit of the Company;

16.5   Notwithstanding Clause 16.4, a Shareholder is permitted to disclose 
       Confidential Information to the extent that, in the opinion of such 
       Shareholder's outside legal counsel, such disclosure is required pursuant
       to applicable law, rule or regulation, including without limitation in 
       the case of TeleTech the United States Securities Act of 1933, as 
       amended, or is legally compelled by judicial or administrative order, 
       deposition, interrogatory, request for documents, subpoena, 
       investigative demand or other process or otherwise is necessary in 
       connection with any claim or litigation arising under or with respect 
       to this Deed.  In the event that a Shareholder or its Representatives 
       becomes subject to a demand for discovery or other request for 
       disclosure of Confidential Information, such Shareholder, on its own or 
       on its Representative's behalf, shall give prompt notice of such demand 
       or request to the Company or the other Shareholder, as appropriate, and 
       shall cooperate, as reasonably requested, in seeking a protective order 
       or other appropriate remedy and/or, to the extent permitted by law, with
       respect to the form of such required disclosure.

16.6   The Confidential Information shall be and remain the property of the 
       Company or the applicable Shareholder, as appropriate.  Within 10 days 
       after a Shareholder ceases to be a shareholder of the Company, such 
       Shareholder shall (a) return to the Company or the other Shareholder, as
       appropriate, or at the Company's or other Shareholder's sole discretion,
       destroy (and confirm such destruction in writing) all Confidential
       Information in its possession that relates to the Company or the other
       Shareholder and (b) destroy all studies, analyses, reports or other
       documents prepared by such Shareholder or its Representatives which 
       contain or are based, in whole or in part, on the Confidential 
       Information, which destruction shall be confirmed in writing within such
       time period; provided that the Company or the other Shareholder shall 
       provide such information and documentation as the departing Shareholder 
       may reasonably request in relation to matters required by it for the 
       purposes of preparing its own accounts or in respect of its taxation 
       affairs.

16.7   Each Shareholder acknowledges that the Confidential Information it may 
       receive or obtain in the course of its association with the Company would
       give such Shareholder an unfair competitive advantage.  In light thereof,
       and in consideration for entering into this Deed and the Acquisition
       Agreement, each Shareholder agrees that, for so long as it is associated
       with the Company and for 18 months thereafter, such Shareholder shall not
       solicit, attempt to solicit or cause the solicitation or attempted
       solicitation, and shall procure that no member of its Group shall 
       solicit, attempt to solicit or cause the solicitation or attempted 
       solicitation, of:


                                      -19-
<PAGE>

       16.7.1    any Client of the Company to cease doing business with the 
                 Company or any of its subsidiaries; or 

       16.7.2    any employee of the Company to leave his or her employment with
                 the Company or its subsidiaries and accept employment 
                 elsewhere; provided that such restrictions do not apply to any 
                 solicitation for employment directed at the public in general 
                 (I.E., through advertisements in publications of general 
                 circulation) or with respect to any employee of the Company 
                 who is also an employee of such Shareholder or any of its 
                 affiliates.

16.8   If either PPP or TeleTech or any member of their respective Groups wish 
       to conduct business similar to the Business through its own premises and
       facilities located in the Territory, it shall do so only with the prior
       written consent of the other.

16.9   If either PPP or TeleTech or any member of their respective Groups 
       proposes to set up premises, facilities or branches in any European 
       country other than the countries in the Territory for the purposes of 
       providing services similar to the Business it undertakes to notify and 
       discuss its plans with the other Shareholder and the Company prior to 
       doing so.  Provided that such an obligation to notify and discuss does 
       not impose any further obligation to conduct such business through the 
       Company or with the other party.

16.10  Each of the Shareholders undertakes to the other to take all such steps 
       as shall from time to time be necessary to ensure compliance with the 
       provisions of Clause 16.4-16.7 by its employees, agents and 
       sub-contractors.

16.11  While the restrictions in Clause 16.7 are considered by the 
       Shareholders to be reasonable in all the circumstances, if any one or 
       more of such restrictions shall either taken by itself or themselves 
       together be adjudged to go beyond what is reasonable in all the 
       circumstances for the protection of the Company's legitimate interest 
       but would be adjudged reasonable if any particular restriction or 
       restrictions were deleted or any part or parts of the wording thereof 
       were deleted, restricted or limited in any particular manner, then the 
       said restrictions shall apply with such deletions, restrictions or 
       limitations as the case may be.

16.12  No provision of this Deed, by virtue of which this Deed is subject to 
       registration (if such be the case) under the Restrictive Trade 
       Practices Act 1976, shall take effect until the day after particulars 
       of this Deed have been furnished to the Director General of Fair 
       Trading pursuant to Section 24 of that Act.  For this purpose the 
       expression "this Deed" includes any agreement or arrangement of which 
       this Deed forms part and which is registrable or by virtue of which 
       this Deed is registrable. 

16.13  The costs of any registration pursuant to clause 16.12 and the 
       Healthline Contract shall be borne by the Company. 


                                      -20-
<PAGE>


16.14  Each Shareholder acknowledges and agrees that any breach of this 
       Clause 16 would cause irreparable damage to the Company and/or the 
       other Shareholder, as appropriate, for which damages would not be an 
       appropriate remedy or would not be ascertainable.  The non-breaching 
       Shareholder, therefore, shall be entitled to specific performance 
       and/or injunctive relief with respect to any actual or threatened 
       breach of this Clause 16 by the other Shareholder, in addition to any 
       other remedies that may be available at law or in equity.  Each 
       Shareholder agrees not to oppose the granting of such equitable relief 
       and to waive any requirement for the securing or posting of any bond 
       in connection with such remedy. 

17.    GROUP GOVERNANCE

       The expression "the Company" where used in clauses 4, 6, 7, 8.2, 9, 10, 
       11, 16, 17, Schedule 3 and Schedule 4 shall be deemed by the parties to 
       apply to include Newco and each of the other companies which are 
       subsidiaries of the Company (if any) from time to time to the intent and
       effect that the parties covenant and undertake to each other to control 
       and manage Newco and any subsequent subsidiaries in accordance with the 
       principles of the provisions of clauses 4, 6, 7, 8.2, 9, 10, 11, 16, 17,
       Schedule 3 and Schedule 4 unless otherwise agreed.

18.     ANNOUNCEMENTS

       No announcement concerning this Deed or any ancillary matter or any 
       information concerning either party's involvement with or interest in the
       Company including (without limitation) any of the terms set forth in this
       Deed shall be made disclosed or divulged before or after Completion by 
       any party hereto without the prior written approval of the other parties
       (such approval not to be unreasonably withheld) provided that TeleTech 
       or PPP shall be entitled to make any of such disclosures, after 
       consultation with the other, to the extent it believes in good faith 
       that such disclosures are required by applicable law, including, in the 
       case of TeleTech, the United States Securities Act of 1933, as amended, 
       or the laws or regulations of any recognized stock exchange.

19.    WAIVERS

19.1   No delay or omission of any party in exercising any right, power or
       privilege under this Deed shall impair such right, power or privilege, or
       be construed as a waiver of such right, power or privilege, nor shall any
       single or partial exercise of any such right, power or privilege preclude
       any further exercise of such right, power or privilege, or the exercise 
       of any other rights, powers or privileges.  The rights and remedies 
       provided in this Deed are cumulative and not exclusive of any rights or 
       remedies provided by law.


                                      -21-
<PAGE>

19.2   Save as otherwise expressly stated herein no provision of this Deed may 
       be amended, waived, discharged or terminated nor may any breach of the 
       provisions of this Deed be waived or discharged except (in each case) by 
       an instrument in writing signed by or on behalf of each party against 
       which enforcement of the amendment, waiver, discharge or termination is 
       sought.

20.    EXPIRATION

       This Deed shall commence on the date hereof and shall expire and (save 
       for pre-existing breaches and the provisions of Clauses 7.3, 16, 18, 19,
       and 21 through 27) be of no further force or effect upon either PPP or 
       TeleTech ceasing to hold any Shares.

21.    COUNTERPARTS

       This Deed may be executed in any number of counterparts and by the 
       different parties in different counterparts and all such counterparts 
       shall be deemed to constitute one and the same instrument.

22.    WHOLE AGREEMENT AND CONFLICT

22.1   This Deed contains the whole agreement between the parties hereto 
       relating to the transactions herein provided for and supersedes previous
       agreements between the parties hereto (if any) relating thereto.

22.2   In the event of any conflict between the provisions of this Deed and the
       New Articles the provisions of this Deed shall prevail.

23.    INVALIDITY AND SEVERABILITY

       If any provision of this Deed shall be found by any court or 
       administrative body of competent jurisdiction to be invalid or 
       unenforceable the invalidity or unenforceability of such provision shall
       not affect the other provisions of this Deed and all provisions not 
       affected by such invalidity or unenforceability shall remain in full 
       force and effect.  The parties hereby agree to substitute for any 
       invalid or unenforceable provision a valid or enforceable provision 
       which achieves to the greatest extent possible the economic legal and 
       commercial objectives of the invalid or unenforceable provision.

24.    NO PARTNERSHIP

       Nothing contained in this Deed shall be deemed to constitute a 
       partnership between the parties hereto or any of them and no party 
       shall hold himself out as an agent for any other party save with the 
       prior consent of such other party.

25.    NOTICES


                                      -22-
<PAGE>


25.1   Any notice to be given by any party to this Deed shall be in writing and
       shall be deemed duly received if delivered personally or sent by telex 
       or by prepaid registered post (airmail in the case of an address for 
       service outside the United Kingdom) to the addressee and at the address 
       or (as the case may be) the telex or facsimile number of that party set 
       opposite its name below:-

       PARTY                           ADDRESS                TELEX NO.
       -----                           -------                ---------
       PPP healthcare group limited    PPP House
       Attn: Group Secretary           Vale Road
                                       Tunbridge Wells
                                       Kent TN1 1BJ.
                                       Fax:   01892 505678

       TeleTech Holdings, Inc.         1700 Lincoln Street
                                       Suite 1400
                                       Denver, Colorado 80203
       Attn: Chief Executive Officer   Fax: 303 894 4203
       Attn: Chief Financial Officer   Fax: 303 894 7321

       with a copy to:
       Neal, Gerber & Eisenberg
       Two North Lasalle Street
       Chicago
       Illinois  60602
       Attn: Charles E. Gerber         (312) 269 1747

       (or at such other address (or telex) as the party to be served may have
       notified in accordance with the provisions of this clause) for the 
       purposes of this Deed.

25.2   Any notice sent by telex or facsimile shall be deemed served when
       dispatched and any notice served from within the United Kingdom by 
       prepaid registered post shall be deemed served 48 hours after posting 
       to an address in the United Kingdom, or 7 days after posting by air 
       mail from one jurisdiction to an address in another jurisdiction.

25.3   In proving service of any notice it shall be sufficient:-

       25.3.1    in the case of a telex, to prove only the dispatch of such 
                 telex and the receipt of the correct answerback code or 
                 transmission report as the case may be;

       25.3.2    in the case of delivery in person, to prove that the notice 
                 was delivered or left at the correct address;


                                      -23-
<PAGE>

       25.3.3    in the case of delivery by prepaid registered post, to produce
                 the relevant certificate of posting.

26.    PROPER LAW

       The parties hereto hereby submit to the non-exclusive jurisdiction of 
       the High Court of Justice in England in relation to any claim, dispute or
       difference which may arise hereunder and hereby agree for the purpose of
       Order 10, Rule 3 of the Rules of the Supreme Court of England (or any
       modification or re-enactment thereof), and in any legal proceeding in any
       other jurisdiction, that any process may be served on any of them by
       leaving a copy thereof or by posting a copy addressed to them at their
       address as provided in this Deed.

27.    ASSIGNMENT

       This Deed shall not be assignable by any party hereto without the prior
       written consent of the other save that in the event such assignee ceases 
       to be a member of a Shareholders Group it shall re-assign this Deed to an
       assignee within such Shareholders Group.  Further provided that PPP may
       novate its rights and obligations under this Agreement (provided that all
       other agreements which evidence the joint venture to which PPP is a party
       (the "ancillary agreements") are also novated or assigned) to PPP
       healthcare limited or PPP healthcare group plc without any further 
       consent of TeleTech by delivering to TeleTech a written notice of 
       novation executed by PPP and PPP healthcare limited or PPP healthcare 
       group plc under which PPP healthcare limited or PPP healthcare group plc
       agrees to assume all rights and obligations of PPP under this Agreement 
       and the ancillary agreements and to which the Company and TeleTech will 
       be a party and execute the same. 

AS WITNESS whereof this Deed has been executed by or on behalf of each of the
parties hereto the day and year first above written.

                                      -24-
<PAGE>

                                   SCHEDULE 1

                                     PART A

               DETAILS OF THE COMPANY PRIOR TO AND POST COMPLETION

                                 (1)                        (2)
                           PRIOR TO COMPLETION        POST COMPLETION
                           -------------------        ---------------
Name                       Access 24 Limited          Access 24 UK Limited
*Registered Number         3074552                    -
Date of Incorporation      27th June 1995             -

Authorized Share Capital:  100                        1,000,100
Ordinary                   100                        -
A - Ordinary               None                       50
B- Ordinary                None                       50
Preference                 None                       1,000,000

Issued Share Capital:

Ordinary                   2
A - Ordinary               None                       1
B - Ordinary               None                       1
Preference                 None                       1,000,000

Shareholders/Number/
Class of Shares held

TeleTech                   Two                        One
PPP                        None                       One

Directors                  Louis Carroll              A - Peter Owen
                                                      A - Ian Riley
                           John Kendall               B - Louis Carroll
                                                      B - Ken Tuchman

Secretary                  Annette Louise Heywood     Edward Davis

Auditors                   Arthur Andersen            Coopers & Lybrand

Registered Office          Access 24 House,           Same
                           Barncroft Road,
                           Reigate, Surrey, RH2 7RP

Accounting Reference Date  31/12                      31/12
Mortgages, Debentures      None                       PPP
and other Charges



                                      -25-
<PAGE>


                                     PART B

                        DETAILS OF NEWCO POST COMPLETION

                           PRIOR TO COMPLETION        POST COMPLETION
                           -------------------        ---------------
Name                       Makecents Limited          Access 24 Limited
*Registered Number         3167020                    -
Date of Incorporation      4 March 1996               -

Authorized Share Capital:  L1,000                     -

Ordinary                   1,000                      -

Issued Share Capital:      L2                         -

Ordinary                   2                          -

Shareholders/Number/Class 
of Shares held

Access 24 Limited          2                          -

Directors                  Louis Carroll              A. Peter Owen
                           Ken Daryl Tuchman          A. Ian Riley
                                                      B. Louis Carroll
                                                      B. Ken Tuchman

Secretary                  Louise Annette Heywood     Edward Davis

Auditors                   Arthur Andersen            Coopers & Lybrand

Registered Office          Access 24 House
                           Bancroft Road
                           Reigate
                           Surrey RH2 7RP

Accounting Reference Date  31/12                      31/12

Mortgages, Debentures and
other Charges              None                       In favor of PPP

                                      -26-
<PAGE>

                                   SCHEDULE 2

                                   RESOLUTIONS

                              ORDINARY RESOLUTIONS

We, the undersigned, being the Sole Member for the time being of the above-named
Company entitled to receive notice of, and to attend and vote at, General
Meetings of the Company HEREBY PASS the following written resolution and agree
that the said resolution shall, pursuant to Clause 53 in Table A (which Clause
is embodied in the Articles of Association of the Company), for all purposes be
as valid and effective as if the same had been passed at a General Meeting of
the Company duly convened and held.

It is hereby resolved:

1.   THAT the terms of the Subscription and Shareholders' Agreement to be
     entered into between (1) the Company, (2) TeleTech Holdings, Inc. and (3)
     Priplan Investments Limited, (a copy of which is attached hereto as Annexe
     "A") be and are hereby approved notwithstanding the interests of the
     directors of the Company in such agreement and the Company or its duly
     authorized attorney be and is hereby authorized to execute the Subscription
     and Shareholders' Agreement and all related documentation pursuant to an
     authority of the Board of Directors of the Company.

2.   THAT the authorized share capital of the Company be increased by L1,000,000
     to L1,000,100 by the creation of 1,000,000 7% per cent Cumulative
     Redeemable Preference Shares of L1 each having the rights and being subject
     to the restrictions as set forth in the New Articles of Association
     referred to in Resolution 3 below.

3.   THAT the regulations contained in the document marked "New Articles of
     Association of Access 24 Limited" (a copy of which is annexed hereto as
     Annexe "B") be and the same are hereby adopted as the Articles of
     Association of the Company to the exclusion of, and in substitution for,
     the existing Articles of Association and all regulations incorporated
     therein.

4.   THAT pursuant to Section 80 of the Companies Act 1985 ("the Act") the
     Directors be unconditionally authorized to allot, grant options over, offer
     or otherwise deal with or dispose of any relevant securities (as defined in
     Section 80 of the Act) of the Company to such persons at such times and
     generally on such terms and conditions as the Directors may determine
     provided that:-

4.   the authority hereby conferred shall be for a period expiring on 30 June
     1996 (unless previously renewed, varied or revoked by the Company in
     General Meeting);

4.2  the maximum amount of such relevant securities as aforesaid which may be
     allotted pursuant to such authority shall be the authorized but as yet
     unissued share capital of the Company as increased by Resolution 2 above;


                                      -27-
<PAGE>


4.3  the Directors may allot relevant securities pursuant to this authority
     after 30 June 1996 pursuant to an offer or agreement made by the Company on
     or before that date as if such authority had not expired.

5.   THAT the two ordinary shares of the Company in issue at the date hereof be
     and are hereby re-classified as "A" and "B" ordinary shares and that the 98
     authorized but unissued ordinary shares of the Company as at the date
     hereof be and are hereby re-classified as 49 "A" ordinary shares and 49 "B"
     ordinary shares.

6.   THAT the Company's name be changed to Access 24 UK Limited.

Dated this        day of April 1996

                      -------------------------------------------------------
                      Teletech Holdings, Inc.


                                       -28-

<PAGE>
                                   SCHEDULE 3

                           DEVELOPMENT OF THE BUSINESS

1.   In the event there is unused capacity at the Property, both PPP and
     TeleTech agree to cooperate with each other and the Company to utilize such
     capacity.  Each of PPP and TeleTech shall be entitled to enter into short-
     term leases on an "arms length" basis to allow either of PPP or TeleTech to
     utilize equipment and facilities; provided that open seats each seat being
     a space for one person equipped with a computer terminal, telephone linkup
     and appropriate office equipment will not be leased for less than L4,650
     plus VAT per annum per seat and that each such lease will be terminable on
     notice of six months by either party to such lease.  PPP and TeleTech agree
     that no more than 50% of the available capacity of the Property at any time
     will be leased to PPP and/or TeleTech.  Each of PPP and TeleTech also
     agrees that should it terminate (other than for cause) any such short-term
     lease to which it is a party on less than six months notice it will be
     required to pay the agreed rental for the unexpired period of the 6 month
     notice period.  In the event that the Company terminates such short term
     lease on less than 6 months notice there shall be no damages payable to
     either PPP or TeleTech for such termination, subject to the Company giving
     not less than 90 days written notice.

2.   So long as it is a Shareholder, TeleTech will provide the Company with the
     following services and support at NO cost:-

     (i)  technological know how and expertise to develop the facilities at the
          Property or such other properties as the Company operates out of in
          accordance with the terms of this Agreement as promptly as
          commercially practicable in accordance with a phased program (to be
          agreed);

    (ii)  with respect to technology owned by TeleTech on the Completion Date
          technology upgrades and additions as appropriate, including access to
          TeleTech information technology and intellectual property developments
          for the Business for example CTI Applications Software Predictive
          Dialing Systems and Database Dialling Systems provided however that if
          any such technology is owned by a third party TeleTech shall endeavor
          to procure from such third party a license for the Company to use such
          technology, the fees and expenses for which shall be borne by the
          Company;

   (iii)  exclusive use of the name "Access 24" within the Territory pursuant to
          a license in perpetuity;

    (iv)  access to TeleTech quantity purchasing benefits to the extent
          practicable;

     (v)  marketing and sales support from TeleTech personnel as appropriate;

    (vi)  management support through the active participation of TeleTech
          personnel on the board of directors and day-to-day as appropriate; and


                                      -29-
<PAGE>


   (vii)  any and all new agreements for Value Added Services to be delivered
          from within the Territory.
3.   The services of John Kendall on the basis of 44 days per annum for the
     period from the date of Completion to 31 December 1997 at the cost of
     L24,000 per annum, and Louis Carroll on the basis of 33 days per annum for
     the period of from the date of Completion to 31 December 1996 at the cost
     of L18,000 per annum.

4.   So long as it is a Shareholder TeleTech will provide the Company with the
     support of its programmers and other appropriate personnel to develop new
     products for the Business, as requested which for the avoidance of doubt
     shall mean developments undertaken in accordance with the Business Plan
     and shall not mean programming required for the purposes of paragraph
     2(ii) above.  This support will be provided at cost, which is deemed to be
     an individual employee's salaried hourly rate multiplied by two plus
     direct expenses such as expenses for travel and accommodation.

5.   So long as it is a Shareholder, PPP will provide the Company with the
     following services and support, at no cost:-

     (i)  marketing and sales co-operation by way of introductions on an ongoing
          basis;

    (ii)  management support through active participation of PPP personnel on
          the Board of Directors and day-to-day as appropriate;

   (iii)  access by way of introductions to PPP quantity purchasing benefits to
          the extent practicable; and

6.   PPP will contract with the Company in respect of any and all new
     agreements for Value Added Services for PPP within the Territory on an
     arm's length basis.  Provided that PPP agrees that any new agreement
     described in this clause 6 to be performed by the Company will be priced
     so that the Company will earn a 60% - 65% gross margin.  For the purposes
     of this clause gross margin shall be calculated by the use of the
     following equation:

     R - C     x    100  =    gross margin
     -----
       R

     where

     R -  is total sales revenue from a contract

     C -  is variable expenses of direct labor, national insurance, pensions and
          communication expenses relating to such contract.

7.   PPP will grant the Company a right to first refusal for all existing
     contracts of PPP for Value Added Services as they come up for renewal, at
     commercial market rates and on terms that match the quality and
     specifications of a competitor's bid.

8.   PPP will grant the Company a right to match third party non-Value Added
     Services which are similar to services offered under PPP's SOS contract
     or, Stressline contract;


                                      -30-
<PAGE>


     Provided however that if the Company offers to provide such third party
     non-Value Added Services at competitive rates and on terms that match the
     quality and specifications of the chosen competitor bid, PPP will grant to
     the Company the right to provide such non-Value Added Services.

9.   PPP also agrees to refer its corporate clients to TeleTech for outsourcing
     services as circumstances allow.

10.  PPP will provide the Company with:-

10.1 dedicated PPP personnel (to be specified from time to time) at actual cost
     to PPP;

10.2 the support of its programmers and other appropriate personnel to develop
     new Value Added Services products for the Business, as requested, which
     for the avoidance of doubt, shall not mean programming required for the
     purposes of paragraph 2(ii) above.

10.3 The support to be provided under this Clause 10.2 will be provided at
     "cost," which is deemed to be an individual employee's salaried hourly
     rate multiplied by two, plus direct expenses, such as expenses for travel
     and accommodation.


                                      -31-
<PAGE>


                                   SCHEDULE 4

                              MATTERS FOR APPROVAL


The following matters shall only be undertaken by the Company in accordance with
Clause 10.

MATTERS REQUIRING UNANIMOUS DIRECTORS' APPROVAL

1.   any sale, lease, transfer or other disposition of the assets or
     undertaking of the Company or of any substantial part thereof whether by
     one or more transactions whose individual or aggregate value exceeds
     L100,000;

2.   any consolidation or amalgamation with or the acquisition of any interest
     in any other company, association, partnership or legal entity;

3.   any making of loans or any entering into guarantees or indemnities in
     excess of L25,000;

4.   any change in the nature of the business of the Company or any significant
     increase in the level of business activity requiring capital expenditure
     in excess of L100,000 to be made;

5.   any acquisition or disposal of land or any interest in land of a value in
     excess of L25,000;

6.   any closure of any business operation;

7.   the entering into any transaction, arrangement or agreement with or for
     the benefit of any director or Shareholder or any Connected Person;

8.   the acquisition or disposal of any subsidiary company;

9.   the entering into a contract or other arrangement or commitment involving
     expenditure on or the realization of assets of a capital nature in excess
     of L50,000;

10.  the declaration, paying or making of any dividends, bonuses or other
     distributions out of profits or in respect of its share capital or loan
     capital or the purchasing or redeeming any part of the Company's share
     capital;

11.  the raising of any loan or credit facilities (including overdraft, leasing
     and hire purchase facility) in excess of L100,000;

12.  the borrowing or raising of any sum or sums in excess of the facility
     amount available under the Loan Agreement provided that the "A" Directors
     shall not unreasonably withhold their consent to borrowing by the Company
     if it is for the purpose of repaying (by way of a complete refinancing)
     all amounts due under the Loan


                                      -32-
<PAGE>


     Agreement and such new borrowing is on terms at least as favorable as
     those of the Loan Agreement;

13.  the annual review of the Business Plan and approval of the financial year
     operating and capital expenditure budgets contained therein; provided that
     if the directors do not reach agreement on any such budget for a specified
     financial year, the budget that was in effect for the immediately
     preceding financial year shall remain in effect until the directors
     approve a new budget;

14.  any increase in share capital;

15.  authorizing the issue of additional shares;

16.  the amendment or modification (including any renewal of the term) of any
     of this Agreement, the Healthline Agreement, the Assets Sale Agreement and
     the Assets Leaseback Agreement, the Acquisition Agreement, the Loan
     Agreement or the New Articles;

17.  the entering into of any service agreement with any employee or director
     which is not terminable without payment of compensation on not more than 3
     months notice or whose annual salary is in excess of L50,000;

18.  the creation or allowing to subsist of any mortgage, charge, pledge, lien
     or other encumbrance over any of the Company's assets;

19.  the payment of any remuneration or expenses to any person in other than as
     proper remuneration for work done or services provided or as proper
     reimbursement for expenses incurred in connection with the Company's
     business;

20.  the redemption of the Preference Shares and/or payment of any divided on
     the Preference Shares except as otherwise provided for or specified in the
     New Articles or this Deed;

21.  any prepayment of monies due under the Loan Agreement in advance of their
     repayment date save as provided in paragraph 12 of this Schedule.


                                      -33-
<PAGE>


                                   SCHEDULE 5

                                DEED OF ADHERENCE


THIS DEED OF ADHERENCE is made the       day of              19 by
       of                          (hereinafter called "the Covenantor")
SUPPLEMENTAL to a Shareholders' Agreement dated               199  and made
between [          ], [          ], [          ] [          ] Limited ("the
Company") ("the Shareholders Agreement")

WITNESSES as follows:

26.2 The Covenantor hereby confirms that [he][it] has been supplied with a copy
     of the Shareholders Agreement and hereby covenants with each of the
     persons named in the Schedule hereto to observe perform and be bound by
     all the terms of the Shareholders' Agreement which are capable of applying
     to the Covenantor and which have not been performed at the date hereof to
     the intent and effect that the Covenantor shall be deemed with effect from
     the date on which the Covenantor is registered as a member of the Company
     to be a party to the Shareholders' Agreement and to be a Shareholder (as
     defined in the Shareholders' Agreement).

26.3 This Deed shall be governed by and construed in accordance with the laws
     of England

EXECUTED as a Deed the day and year first before written

THE FIRST SCHEDULE

[insert the names and addresses of the other continuing parties to the
Shareholders' Agreement]

SIGNED and DELIVERED as a Deed     )
by the said                        )
in the presence of:                )

THE COMMON SEAL of                 )
                                   )
LIMITED was hereunto affixed       )
in the presence of:                Director

                                   Secretary


                                      -34-
<PAGE>


                                   SCHEDULE 6

                                    VALUATION

(1)  The purchase price of the Shares which are the subject of a call option
     pursuant to clause 15.2 ("the Option") will be determined in accordance
     with the following provisions of this Schedule.

(2)  Following the exercise of an Option the Other Shareholder and the
     Defaulting Shareholder shall attempt to agree the amount of the purchase
     price for the Shares within 30 days of the service of the Default Notice
     failing which the Other Shareholder or the Defaulting Shareholder may
     refer the matter to [an independent chartered accountant] to be agreed by
     them within seven days or failing agreement, a chartered accountant
     selected on the application of either Shareholder by the President from
     time to time of the Institute of Chartered Accountants in England and
     Wales for final determination (the "Valuers").

(3)  The Shareholders shall use their respective best endeavors to procure that
     the Valuers shall as soon as possible after a reference has been made to
     them under Clause (2) determine the purchase price of the Shares and
     notify the Shareholders in writing of their determination.

(4)  The Valuers will act as experts, not as arbitrators, but may in their
     absolute discretion afford the Other Shareholder and the Defaulting
     Shareholder the opportunity to make such written and oral representations
     to the Valuers as they wish, subject to such reasonable time and other
     limits as the Valuers may prescribe, and the Valuers shall have regard to
     any such representations but not be bound by them.

(5)  The Valuers may call upon the Auditors and any other professional advisers
     who act or have acted for the Company for such documents and information
     as they may reasonably require from them for the purposes of their
     determination and the Shareholders will give or (so far as they are able)
     procure that there is given appropriate authority to such professional
     advisers to make such disclosures and will (so far as they are able) give
     to the Valuers all such other facilities and information as they may
     reasonably require for the purposes of their determination.

(6)  The Valuers will determine what in their opinion was the fair price per
     Share at the date of service of the Default Notice on the following
     assumptions:

     (a)  valuing the Shares as on an arm's length sale between a willing vendor
          and a willing purchaser;

     (b)  the Company was then carrying on business as a going concern, on the
          assumption that it will continue to do so; and

     (c)  valuing each class of the Shares as a rateable proportion of the total
          value of the class in question which value shall not be discounted or
          enhanced by reference to their number or amount thereof.


                                      -35-
<PAGE>


(7)  The Valuers will give notice of the fair price to the Other Shareholder
     and the Defaulting Shareholder by sending to them a copy of their written
     determination.

(8)  The Valuers determination will be final and binding upon the Other
     Shareholder and the Defaulting Shareholder in the absence of clerical or
     manifest error appearing within 14 days of notice of such determination
     being served.

(9)  The Valuers', the Company's Auditors' and any other professional advisers'
     charges including disbursements and value added tax in connection with the
     determination will be paid by the Defaulting Shareholder.




                                      -36-
<PAGE>


EXECUTED AND DELIVERED                  )
AS A DEED by its                        )
duly authorized attorney                )
for and on behalf of                    )
ACCESS 24 LIMITED                       )
in the presence of:-                    )  /s/ (signature illegible)


EXECUTED AND DELIVERED                  )
AS A DEED by                            )
for and on behalf of                    )
TELETECH HOLDINGS, INC.                 )


                                        Director  /s/ Kenneth Tuchman

                                        Secretary  /s/ Jo-Nell Labbienti


EXECUTED AND DELIVERED                  )
AS A DEED by                            )
for and on behalf of                    )
PRIPLAN INVESTMENTS LIMITED             )

                                        Director  /s/ (signature illegible)

                                        Secretary  /s/ (signature illegible)



                                      -37-



<PAGE>
                                                                    EXHIBIT 10.8

                             TELETECH HOLDINGS, INC.
                           DIRECTORS STOCK OPTION PLAN

1.   PREAMBLE.

     TeleTech Holdings, Inc., a Delaware corporation (the "Company"), hereby
establishes the TeleTech Holdings, Inc. Directors' Stock Plan (the "Plan") as a
means whereby the Company may, through automatic grants of non-qualified stock
options provide Directors of the Company with an additional incentive to promote
the success of the Company's business.

     The provisions of this Plan do not apply to or affect any option, stock
appreciation right, or stock heretofore or hereafter granted under any other
stock plan of the Company or any subsidiary, and all such options, stock
appreciation right or stock continue to be governed by and subject to the
applicable provisions of the plan or agreement under which they were granted.

 2.  DEFINITIONS.

     2.01 "BOARD" or "BOARD OF DIRECTORS" means the board of directors of the
Company.

     2.02 "CAUSE" means, as determined in the sole discretion of the Board, a
Participant's (a) commission of a felony; (b) dishonesty or misrepresentation
involving the Company or any Subsidiary; (c) serious misconduct in the
performance or non-performance of Participant's responsibilities as a Director;
(d) unauthorized use of trade secrets or confidential information; or (e) aiding
a competitor of the Company or any Subsidiary.

     2.03 "CODE" means the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as it exists now and
as it may be amended from time to time.

     2.04 "COMMITTEE" means the committee comprised of two or more outside
Directors appointed by the Board to administer the Plan.  Each member of the
Committee shall be a member of the Board of Directors who has not at any time
within one year prior thereto, or at any time during such member's term of
service on the Committee, received any stock options, stock appreciation rights
or allocations of any equity securities under the Plan or any other plan
maintained by the Company or any of its affiliates, except as permitted pursuant
to the provisions of Rule 16b-3(c)(2)(i) of the Exchange Act or any successor
rule thereof.  Once appointed, the Committee shall continue to serve until
otherwise directed by the Board of Directors.

     2.05 "COMMON STOCK" means the common stock of the Company, $0.01 par value.

     2.06 "COMPANY" means TeleTech Holdings, Inc., a Delaware corporation, and
any successor thereto.

     2.07 "DIRECTOR" means a member of the Board.

<PAGE>

     2.08 "EXCHANGE ACT"  means the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as it
exists now or from time to time may hereafter be amended.

     2.09 "FAIR MARKET VALUE" means for the relevant day:

          (a)  If shares of Common Stock are listed or admitted to unlisted
          trading privileges on any national or regional securities exchange,
          the last reported sale price, regular way, on the composite tape of
          that exchange on the day Fair Market Value is to be determined;

          (b)  If the Common Stock is not listed or admitted to unlisted trading
          privileges as provided in paragraph (a), and if sales prices for
          shares of Common Stock are reported by the National Association of
          Securities Dealers, Inc. Automated Quotations, Inc. National Market
          System ("NASDAQ System"), then the last sale price for Common Stock
          reported as of the close of business on the day Fair Market Value is
          to be determined, or if no such sale takes place on that day, the
          average of the high bid and low asked prices so reported; if Common
          Stock is not traded on that day, the next preceding day on which such
          stock was traded; or

          (c) If trading of the Common Stock is not reported by the NASDAQ
          System or on a stock exchange, Fair Market Value will be determined by
          the Committee in its discretion based upon the best available data.

     2.10 "OPTION" means the right of a Participant to purchase a specified
number of shares of Common Stock, subject to the terms and conditions of the
Plan.

     2.11 "OPTION DATE" means the date upon which an Option is awarded to a
Participant under the Plan.

     2.12 "OPTION PRICE" means the price per share at which an Option may be
exercised.

     2.13 "PARTICIPANT" means an individual to whom an Option has been granted
under the Plan.

     2.14 "PLAN" means the TeleTech Holdings, Inc. Directors' Stock Option Plan,
as set forth herein and as from time to time amended.

     2.15 "SECURITIES ACT" means the Securities Act of 1933, as it exists now or
from time to time may hereinafter be amended.

     2.16 "SUBSIDIARY" means any corporation or other entity of which the
majority voting power or equity interest is owned directly or indirectly by the
Company.


                                       -2-

<PAGE>


     2.17 RULES OF CONSTRUCTION.

          (a)  GOVERNING LAW.  The construction and operation of this Plan are
     governed by the laws of the State of Delaware.

          (b)  UNDEFINED TERMS.  Unless the context requires another meaning,
     any term not specifically defined in this Plan has the meaning given to it
     by the Code.

          (c)  HEADINGS.  All headings in this Plan are for reference only and
     are not to be utilized in construing the Plan.

          (d)  GENDER.  Unless clearly appropriate, all nouns of whatever gender
     refer indifferently to persons of any gender.

          (e)  SINGULAR AND PLURAL.  Unless clearly inappropriate, singular
     terms refer also to the plural and VICE VERSA.

          (f)  SEVERABILITY.  If any provision of this Plan is determined to be
     illegal or invalid for any reason, the remaining provisions shall continue
     in full force and effect and shall be construed and enforced as if the
     illegal or invalid provision did not exist, unless the continuance of the
     Plan in such circumstances is not consistent with its purposes.

3.   STOCK SUBJECT TO THE PLAN.

     Except as otherwise provided in Section 9, the aggregate number of shares
of Common Stock that may be issued under Options under this Plan may not exceed
150,000 shares of Common Stock.  Reserved shares may be either authorized but
unissued shares or treasury shares, in the Board's discretion.  If any awards
hereunder shall terminate or expire, as to any number of shares, new Options may
thereafter be awarded with respect to such shares.

4.   ADMINISTRATION.

     The Plan shall be administered by the Committee.  In addition to any other
powers set forth in this Plan, the Committee has the exclusive authority:

          (a)  to construe and interpret the Plan, and to remedy any ambiguities
     or inconsistencies therein;

          (b)  to establish, amend and rescind appropriate rules and regulations
     relating to the Plan;

          (c)  subject to the express provisions of the Plan, to determine
     payment terms and payment method applicable to each Option;


                                       -3-

<PAGE>

          (d)  to contest on behalf of the Company or Participants, at the
     expense of the Company, any ruling or decision on any matter relating to
     the Plan or to any Options;

          (e)  generally, to administer the Plan, and to take all such steps and
     make all such determinations in connection with the Plan and the awards of
     Options granted thereunder as it may deem necessary or advisable;

          (f)  to determine the form in which tax withholding under Section 12
     of this Plan will be made; and

          (g)  to take any action necessary, including amendment of the Plan or
     any Option, as required in order for a transaction to qualify for pooling
     of interest accounting treatment.

5.   DIRECTOR STOCK OPTIONS.

          (a)  Each Director who is not otherwise an employee of the Company
     and, after the Company registers shares of Common Stock under either the
     Securities Act or Exchange Act, is not a beneficial owner of 5% or more of
     the outstanding Common Stock (as determined in accordance with Rule 13d-3
     of the Exchange Act) shall be granted automatically Options to purchase (i)
     on the effective date of the Plan 5,000 shares of Common Stock for service
     as a Director for 1995, (ii) 5,000 shares of Common Stock for service as a
     Director during 1996, if such Director is elected as such at the Annual
     Meeting of Stockholders held between January 1, 1996 and May 11, 1996 or is
     still serving as a Director on May 11, 1996, (iii) on the effective date of
     the Plan 1,250 shares of Common Stock for each Board committee upon which a
     Director served during 1995, (iv) 1,250 shares of Common Stock for each
     Board Committee upon which a Director served on May 11, 1996, (v) 2,500
     shares of Common Stock upon the Director's initial election to the Board;
     provided such Director is elected after the effective date of the Plan, and
     (vi) 2,500 shares of Common Stock for service as a Director and 1,250
     shares of Common Stock for each Board Committee upon which a Director
     serves for each year thereafter on the date of each annual meeting of the
     Stockholders of the Company; provided, however, that a Director who is not
     re-elected as a Director at the annual meeting of Stockholders shall not
     receive a grant of Options on that date.

          (b)  Options granted pursuant to Sections 5(a)(i), (ii), (iii) and
     (iv) shall have an exercise price of $25 per share.  Options granted
     pursuant to Sections 5(a)(v) and (vi) shall have an exercise price per
     share equal to 100% of the Fair Market Value of the Common Stock on the
     Option Date.

          (c)  An Option shall be granted hereunder only if, as of each Option
     Date, the Director (i) is not otherwise an employee of the Company or any
     Subsidiary, (ii) has


                                       -4-

<PAGE>

     not been an employee of the Company or any Subsidiary for any part of the
     preceding fiscal year, and (iii) has served on the Board continuously since
     the commencement of his or her term.

          (d)  In the event that the number of shares of Common Stock available
     for future grant under the Plan is insufficient to make all automatic
     grants required to be made on such date, then all Directors entitled to a
     grant on such date shall share ratably in the number of Options on shares
     available for grant under the Plan.

6.   OPTION PERIOD.

     An Option may not be exercised until six months after the Option Date.
Each Option will expire as of the earliest of:

          (a)  the date the Participant's membership on the Board is terminated
     for Cause;

          (b)  the date one year after the Participant's death; or

          (c)  ten years from the Option Date.

7.   MANNER OF EXERCISE OF OPTIONS.

     To exercise an Option in whole or in part, a Participant (or, after his
death, his executor or administrator) must give written notice to the Committee,
stating the number of shares to which he intends to exercise the Option.  The
Company will issue the shares with respect to which the Option is exercised upon
payment in full of the Option Price.  The Option Price may be paid (i) in cash,
(ii) in shares of Common Stock having an aggregate Fair Market Value, as
determined on the date of delivery, equal to the Option Price, or (iii) by
delivery of irrevocable instructions to a broker to promptly deliver to the
Company the amount of sale or loan proceeds necessary to pay for all Common
Stock acquired through such exercise and any tax withholding obligations
resulting from such exercise.

8.   VESTING.

     Each Option granted pursuant to Section 5(a)(ii) and (iv) shall be 100%
vested on May 11, 1996; provided the Participant is a Director on such date.  If
the Participant is not a Director on May 11, 1996, then he shall forfeit any
Options granted pursuant to Section 5(a)(ii) and (iv).  Each Option granted
pursuant to Section 5(a)(i) and (iii) shall be 100% vested as of the Option
Date.

9.   ADJUSTMENTS TO REFLECT CHANGES IN CAPITAL STRUCTURE.

     If there is any change in the corporate structure or shares of the Company,
the Board of Directors may, in its discretion, make any adjustments necessary to
prevent accretion, or to



                                       -5-
<PAGE>

protect against dilution, in the number and kind of shares authorized by the
Plan and, with respect to outstanding Options, in the number and kind of shares
covered thereby and in the applicable Option Price; provided, however, no
adjustment will be made for the issuance of preferred stock or the conversion of
convertible preferred stock.  For the purpose of this Section 9, a change in the
corporate structure or shares of the Company includes, without limitation, any
change resulting from a recapitalization, stock split, stock dividend,
consolidation, rights offering, spin-off, reorganization, or liquidation and any
transaction in which shares of Common Stock are changed into or exchanged for a
different number or kind of shares of stock or other securities of the Company
or another corporation.

10.  NON-TRANSFERABILITY OF OPTIONS.

     The Options granted under the Plan are not transferable, voluntarily or
involuntarily, other than by will or the laws of descent and distribution.
During a Participant's lifetime, his Options may be exercised only by him.

11.  RIGHTS AS STOCKHOLDER.

     A Participant has no rights whatsoever as a stockholder with respect to any
shares covered by an Option until the date of the issuance of a stock
certificate for the shares.  No Common Stock may be delivered upon the exercise
of any Option until full payment has been made and all income tax withholding
requirements thereon, if any, have been satisfied.

12.  WITHHOLDING TAX.

     The Company shall have the right to withhold in cash or shares of Common
Stock with respect to any payments made to Participants under the Plan any taxes
required by law to be withheld because of such payments.  With respect to a
Participant subject to Section 16(a) or 16(b), withholding made in Common Stock
upon the exercise of an Option, which the Participant had the discretion
regarding the timing of exercise, must be made or take effect during the period
beginning on the third business day following the release of quarterly or annual
statements of sales and earnings by the Company and ending on the twelfth
business day after such release of statements.

13.  AMENDMENT OF THE PLAN.

     The Committee may from time to time amend or revise the terms of this Plan
in whole or in part and may without limitation, adopt any amendment deemed
necessary; provided, however, that (a) unless, necessary to comply with any
pooling of interest requirements, no change in any award previously granted to a
Participant may be made that would impair the rights of the Participant without
the Participant's consent, (b) the provisions of paragraph (a) of Section 5 may
not be amended more often than once every six months, other than to comport with
changes in the Code, the Employee Retirement Income Security Act of 1974, as
amended, or the rules thereunder and (c) the Committee may not (i) change the
aggregate number of shares that may be issued upon exercise of Options granted
under the Plan (except in accordance with


                                       -6-

<PAGE>

the provisions of Section 9), (ii) change the class of eligible individuals who
may receive Options under the Plan, (iii) adopt any amendment affecting the
Option Price at which Options may be granted, or (iv) materially increase
benefits accruing to participants under the Plan without approval of the
Company's stockholders.  Approval of the Company's stockholders to any amendment
under part (c)(i) shall require a favorable vote by the majority of the shares
of the Company's Common Stock and preferred stock voting separately as a class,
and to all other amendments requiring stockholder approval shall require a vote
of the majority of the shares of the Company's Common Stock and preferred stock
voting together as one class, present in person or by proxy at a duly held
stockholders meeting or by written consent.  If any amendment requiring
stockholder approval for the Committee to act under part (c) of the previous
sentence is made subsequent to the first registration of any class of equity
securities by the Company under Section 12 of the Exchange Act, such stockholder
approval shall be solicited as described in Section 14.  All amendments shall be
in writing and consented to by a majority of the members of the Committee.

14.  STOCKHOLDER APPROVAL.

     The Plan shall be subject to approval by the stockholders of the Company.
Such approval shall be obtained in accordance with Rule 16b-3(b) of the Exchange
Act.

15.  CONDITIONS UPON ISSUANCE OF SHARES.

     An Option shall not be exercisable and a share of Common Stock shall not be
issued pursuant to the exercise of an Option, until such time as the Plan has
been approved by the stockholders of the Company.  The exercise of any Option
and the issuance and delivery of such share pursuant thereto shall comply with
all relevant provisions of law, including, without limitation, the Securities
Act, the Exchange Act, the rules and regulations promulgated thereunder, and the
requirements of any stock exchange upon which the shares of Common Stock may
then be listed, and shall be further subject to the approval of counsel for the
Company with respect to such compliance.  As a condition to the exercise of an
Option, the Company may require the person exercising such Option to represent
and warrant at the time of any such exercise that the Common Stock is being
purchased only for investment and without any present intention to sell or
distribute such shares if, in the opinion of counsel for the Company, such a
representation is required by any of the aforementioned relevant provisions of
law.

16.  EFFECTIVE DATE.  This Plan shall not become effective and no Option shall
be granted pursuant hereto until the later of (a) the date of its adoption by
the Committee, or (b) the date it is approved by the stockholders of the
Company, pursuant to Section 14.

17.  TERMINATION OF THE PLAN.  The Committee may terminate the Plan at any time
with respect to any shares that are not then subject to Options. Termination of
the Plan will not affect the rights and obligations of any Participant with
respect to Options, awarded before termination.


                                       -7-

<PAGE>

                                                                   EXHIBIT 10.13

                      AGREEMENT FOR CALL CENTER MANAGEMENT


This Agreement made on October 16, 1995 and effective on October 16, 1995, by
and between United Parcel Service General Services Co. a Delaware corporation,
on behalf of itself and its affiliates, having its principal place of business
at 55 Glenlake Parkway, NE, Atlanta, Georgia 30328 ("UPS") and TeleTech
Holdings, Inc., a Delaware corporation, on behalf of itself and its subsidiaries
and affiliates, having its principal place of business at 1700 Lincoln Street,
14th Floor, Denver, Colorado  80203 ("TI") is for in-bound teleservices and
services ancillary thereto.

WHEREAS, TI is in the business of providing in-bound teleservices on behalf of
its clients; and

WHEREAS, UPS provides services and/or goods which require in-bound teleservices;
and

WHEREAS, pursuant to the terms and conditions set forth below and in the
Attachments hereto, UPS desires to engage TI to perform in-bound teleservices on
its behalf and TI desires to accept such engagement;

NOW, THEREFORE, in consideration of the premises, the mutual covenants and
agreements contained herein and other good and valuable considerations, the
receipt and sufficiency of which are hereby mutually acknowledged, the parties
hereto agree as follows:

SECTION 1 - SCOPE OF WORK

     A.   Services

          During the Term (as hereinafter defined), TI shall perform the
          Services (as hereinafter defined) pursuant to the requirements set
          forth on Attachment A hereto.  For purposes of this Agreement,
          "Services" shall mean the receipt and handling by TI employees
          functioning as customer service representatives, administrative
          support employees and package information associates ("CSRs") of
          telephone calls initiated by third parties for the purpose of
          responding to UPS' marketing of certain services and/or products or
          otherwise communicating with UPS.  Attachment A consists of  "UPS'
          Explanation and Requirements" and such other documents as the parties
          shall agree and initial.  TI shall be solely responsible for all
          personnel related matters and expenses thereof regarding the rendition
          of Services, including but not limited, to employment, hiring,
          training except as otherwise provided herein, attendance, quantity and
          quality of work, discipline and termination of employment.  From time
          to time hereafter, TI and UPS may mutually agree upon additional
          services to be performed by TI or modifications to the requirements
          set forth in this Agreement and on Attachment A.  Any such additional
          services or modified requirements shall

<PAGE>

          be approved in writing and thereafter all references in this Agreement
          to Services shall be deemed to include such additional services or
          modified requirements.

          TI will interview, test, conduct criminal and employment references
          background checks, select and hire personnel to perform services at
          the Centers as hereafter defined.  Drug testing is not required.

          TI will supply and maintain photocopiers, facsimile machines, TI
          letterhead stationery supplies and mail room equipment (excluding the
          cost of postage).  UPS will be responsible for supplying and
          maintaining all other equipment required for use in the operation of
          the Call Centers as hereinafter defined, including, but not limited to
          stationery supplies, printing supplies, office supplies, janitorial
          supplies, facilities and other types of equipment.  UPS management
          will not counsel or discipline any TI employees.

     B.    TI's Responsibilities

     1.   TI shall provide to UPS the services as defined in Attachment A and as
          set forth below.  In addition, TI shall be responsible at its expense
          to provide a temporary employment facility at each center city
          location at each site during the ramp up period.

     2.   TI will work in good faith with UPS to re-engineer the services and
          functions described in Attachment A hereto that are related to UPS'
          operations and to decrease the costs to UPS for those services and
          functions.

     3.   TI shall utilize the applications systems utilized by UPS at the UPS
          call centers as of the effective date of this Agreement, and shall, in
          conjunction and cooperation with UPS, develop and execute a plan to
          ensure a smooth interface between the TI call centers and UPS' other
          operations, including the UPS call centers.

     4.   TI shall assign a TI employee as Site Manager for each TI call center.
          The TI Site Manager shall coordinate the delivery of Services with
          those performed at UPS' call centers and shall provide a single point
          of contact for UPS' Site Manager.  The TI Site Manager also shall
          coordinate scripting with the UPS Site Manager; accept requirements
          for new programs and changes to existing programs; coordinate
          implementation of new programs and changes to existing programs;
          deliver to UPS the information described below; coordinate site visits
          by UPS personnel, and generally oversee TI's performance of Services
          pursuant to this Agreement.

     5.   TI shall create a call center organization consistent with the
          workforce model as defined in the Attachments hereto.  TI will staff
          the call centers with trained employees who will provide customer
          service support for UPS programs set forth in

                                        2

<PAGE>

          the Attachments hereto, and any other programs which UPS establishes
          which will be supported by the TI call center.

     6.   TI shall, together with UPS, establish and utilize a document change
          control process with respect to the Services to be provided by TI
          under this Agreement.  New programs and all changes to programs,
          systems, methods and procedures supported or used by TI at the TI call
          centers shall be implemented in accordance with such change control
          process.  From time to time, TI may, in accordance with the change
          control process, upgrade or enhance systems, methods and procedures to
          improve the efficiency and effectiveness of the TI call centers.

     7.   TI shall adopt the problem escalation and resolution procedures used
          by UPS.  TI and UPS may mutually agree to modify such procedures in
          accordance with the change control process.

     8.   TI shall cooperate with UPS' reasonable requests in connection with
          any periodic performance, operational and quality control reviews
          performed by UPS.  Such cooperation shall include providing UPS with
          information and explaining TI's procedures and operations, as
          reasonably requested by UPS.

     9.   TI shall monitor the performance of the TI employees using call
          monitoring systems and procedures.  TI shall conduct all monitoring in
          compliance with federal, state and local laws and regulations.  TI may
          enhance monitoring practices and frequency requirements to facilitate
          the achievement of quality standards.  TI shall provide monitoring
          statistics to UPS as hereinafter provided.  TI shall provide
          additional ad-hoc monitoring statistics to UPS as reasonably requested
          by UPS.  UPS shall have the option to participate in the monitoring
          process on a scheduled basis, subject to applicable federal, state and
          local laws and regulations.

     10.  TI agrees that its performance of the Services will meet or exceed
          each of the applicable UPS requirements herein.  In the event TI's
          performance of the Services fails to meet the applicable UPS
          requirements, UPS may seek all remedies available to it in law or
          equity, except as otherwise provided in this Agreement.  In any event,
          TI will use its best efforts to the extent commercially reasonable
          under the circumstances to meet or exceed all UPS requirements.

     11.  If requested by UPS, TI agrees to use commercially reasonable efforts
          to keep the technology utilized in providing the Services to UPS at a
          level that is comparable with the level of technological advancement
          generally attained in the CSR industry.  Should TI be unable to
          maintain such level of technological advancement because of
          limitations in UPS-provided technology and/or equipment, and provided
          TI provides UPS with notice of the effect of such limitations, TI will
          be relieved of this obligation to the extent UPS refuses to upgrade
          its technology and/or equipment.

                                        3

<PAGE>

     12.  Periodically, as appropriate, the parties will review the UPS
          requirements and, if mutually agreed by the parties, such requirements
          will be adjusted to reflect appropriate changes in circumstances,
          including without limitation, being made more stringent to reflect
          improved performance capabilities associated with advances in the
          technology and methods used generally to perform similar services.

     13.  TI will provide UPS with reasonable daily reports in a mutually agreed
          upon format as required by UPS to maintain service, call volumes,
          staffing hours, quality monitoring, process improvement and other
          reports needed to monitor performance against UPS requirements under
          this Agreement and its Attachments.  TI will provide UPS with a
          monthly performance report, in a form and with content mutually
          established by the parties, documenting TI's performance with respect
          to the UPS requirements.  In addition, TI will provide UPS with such
          other documentation and other information as may be reasonably
          requested by UPS from time to time in order to verify that TI's
          performance of the Services is in compliance with the applicable UPS
          requirements.

     14.  TI will use commercially reasonable efforts to efficiently use
          resources to perform the Services in accordance with the applicable
          UPS requirements.  Where appropriate, such efficient use shall include
          without limitation (i) making schedule adjustments (consistent with
          UPS' priorities and schedules for the Services), (ii) delaying the
          performance of non-critical functions within established limits, and
          (iii) tuning or optimizing the systems used to perform the Services.
          Once every twelve (12) months during the term of this Agreement, TI
          will permit an industry consultant selected and paid for by UPS and
          acceptable to TI, which acceptance shall not be unreasonably withheld,
          to review TI's operating practices and procedures with respect to
          resource utilization in connection with the performance of the
          Services during the prior year to determine whether TI is exercising
          reasonable procedures to control the resources utilized in providing
          the Services.  The industry consultant shall issue a written report to
          the parties setting forth its findings, conclusions and
          recommendations for changes in TI's practices.  The parties will
          review the industry consultant's report and work together in good
          faith to mutually agree on any appropriate adjustments to TI's
          operating practices and procedures.

     C.   UPS' Responsibilities

     1.   UPS shall supply the TI Site Manager, with general forecasting data
          related to programs supported by the TI call centers, to assist the TI
          Site Manager in workforce planning.

     2.   UPS shall provide TI with access to UPS' systems applicable to the UPS
          programs being supported by TI hereunder.  UPS shall be responsible
          for maintaining and enhancing such UPS systems.  UPS shall promptly
          provide to TI access to all maintenance of and enhancements to such
          UPS systems made by UPS.

                                        4

<PAGE>

     3.   UPS shall have the right to conduct reasonable periodic performance,
          operational and quality control reviews of TI's performance under this
          Agreement, provided that UPS shall provide no direct supervision of
          TI's call centers.  Such reviews shall be performed during business
          hours and may include visits to TI call centers for verification of
          Service quality levels and other activities reasonably related to
          obtaining information for quality control review purposes.  UPS shall
          schedule such reviews with TI in advance.

     4.   UPS shall provide to TI UPS' current tracking and reporting systems
          for the UPS call center, and make available for consultation with TI
          the UPS personnel responsible for such reporting.  UPS also shall
          provide to TI all available UPS documentation with respect to UPS'
          problem escalation and resolution procedures as described herein.

     5.   UPS shall, together with TI, establish and utilize a documented change
          control process with respect to the Services to be provided by TI
          under this Agreement.

     6.   UPS shall obtain and maintain all licenses, franchises, privileges,
          permits, consents, exemptions, certificates, registrations, orders,
          approvals, authorizations and similar documents and instruments that
          are required by any federal, state and local laws and regulations
          applicable to call centers and other operations under this Agreement.

     D.   Centers

          Except as expressly set forth herein, TI shall perform the Services at
          the following locations now owned, or leased, or to be leased, by UPS:

          1.   Greenville
          2.   Tucson
          3.   Tampa

          (collectively referred to as the "Centers" or "Call Centers").  UPS
          shall be solely responsible for and shall bear all costs and expenses
          with regard to the acquisition and/or leasing of the Centers, the
          maintenance of the Centers' structural components (including but not
          limited to foundation, walls, windows, parking areas, pipes, roofs,
          conduit, HVAC, mechanical, plumbing and electrical systems), repair
          and maintenance of the Centers, including maintenance of external
          grounds and parking, external lighting, obligations under the
          occupational Safety and Health Act (OSHA) and other similar laws
          applicable to it, the provision, acquisition, leasing and maintenance
          of all computer hardware, telecommunications equipment, and computer
          and telecommunications software (other than Work Product and TI
          Property, defined below in Section 25), and all employees or
          independent contractors of UPS fulfilling such responsibilities except
          TI, and shall indemnify and defend TI against all claims with respect
          thereto.  During the term, UPS covenants that the Centers shall be

                                        5

<PAGE>

          maintained and kept in good order, condition and repair, conducive to
          the efficient performance by CSR's of their duties.  Except as
          provided herein, UPS shall be solely responsible for and shall bear
          all costs and expenses with regard to facilities maintenance, and UPS-
          provided computer hardware, software and equipment required in the
          efficient performance of the Services (including but not limited to
          enhancements or add-ons thereto), telecommunication and usage charges,
          and reasonable support of training herein to the extent otherwise
          agreed to herein.  TI shall be solely responsible for and shall bear
          all expenses incurred in the rendition of the Services at the Centers
          (as herein defined) with respect to (i) wages and benefits of TI's
          employees, (ii) contracting for food services at the Centers, (iii)
          photocopiers, (iv) facsimile machines, postage mailing equipment, and
          meter equipment (excluding the cost of postage), (v) existing
          proprietary computer software utilized by TI solely in connection with
          its proprietary processes used by TI in the rendition of the Services,
          (vi) trash or refuse removal from Centers and (vii) prevention of
          property damage to the Centers and other UPS property, except to the
          extent of UPS' negligence.  TI shall be entitled to erect exterior and
          interior signage and banners solely in accordance with UPS' prior
          written authorization.

     E.   Commencement of Services

          TI shall commence hiring and training of CSR's and commence the
          operation of Services at each Center as provided below:


<TABLE>
<CAPTION>

                                                                        Date of                                 Date of
                                                                    Commencement of                        Commencement of
                                                                Administrative Training                         Services
                                                                -----------------------                    ---------------
                  <S>                                           <C>                                        <C>
                  Greenville Center                                  March 11, 1996                         April 4, 1996

                  Tucson Center                                      March 11, 1996                         April 4, 1996

                  Tampa Center                                        May 6, 1996                            June 3, 1996
</TABLE>


               *    In addition, if the requirement of an orderly transition
          requires additional time due to unexpected circumstances, the parties
          shall meet and discuss in good faith both the additional time and
          extra cost involved, with the goal of minimizing TI's unavoidable
          costs and UPS' expense for such additional delays.

     F.   Attrition




- ------------------
*    Omitted portion is subject to a confidential treatment request and has been
     filed separately with the Securities and Exchange Commission.


                                        6

<PAGE>

          Upon review of the termination experience (voluntary or involuntary)
          for CSR's for the initial ninety (90) day and the initial one hundred
          and eighty (180) day periods of delivery of Services for each Center,
          UPS and TI shall jointly establish an acceptable annual CSR turnover
          percentage (the Attrition Percentage") (i.e., a threshold percentage
          reflecting an acceptable percentage of all CSR's hired to render
          Services whose employment terminated in a given twelve (12) month
          period).

SECTION 2 - TERM

     A.   Term

          Subject to extension or termination as provided herein, the term of
          this Agreement shall commence on the day hereof and shall continue
          until June 1, 2001 (the "Term").

     B.   Extension of Term

          The  Term may be extended by mutual written agreement      *

               *

          2.  At the discretion of UPS ("Discretionary Extension"), which
          decision shall be communicated in writing to TI no less than six (6)
          months prior to the end of the Term or applicable Additional Term.

               *

SECTION 3 - RATES AND INVOICES


     A.   Base Rate

          UPS agrees to pay TI for the Services as follows:


- -----------------
*    Omitted portion is subject to a confidential treatment request and has been
     filed separately with the Securities and Exchange Commission.

                                        7

<PAGE>


          1.   TI will invoice UPS  *   for Services to be rendered during the
               week following the invoice date and UPS shall pay TI      *

          2.   Effective for      *     , the Base Rate shall be      *

          3.        *

     B.        *


SECTION 4 - NOTICE OF DELAY

     In the event of an actual or potential delay in TI's performance under this
     Agreement, TI shall immediately notify the UPS Site Manager by either fax
     or telephone, whichever is quicker, describing the cause, effect and
     expected duration of such delay or failure and thereafter shall immediately
     give notice to the UPS Site Manager of all changes to such conditions.

SECTION 5 - COVER

     In the event of any delay or failure of TI in performing hereunder arising
     from any cause, UPS may obtain like services elsewhere for the duration of
     such delay or failure without liability to TI, including liability for
     minimum payments to TI for such period.

SECTION 6 - DISPUTED INVOICED AMOUNTS

     If UPS in good faith questions any item(s) in any invoice, the following
     procedures will apply:  UPS may withhold the disputed amount; UPS will
     notify TI of the dispute in writing     *     , stating with specificity
     the reasons for the dispute and the parties will work in good faith to
     resolve the dispute      *     the date of the invoice.  Adjustments will
     be made on the next invoice immediately following resolution.  If the
     dispute cannot be resolved      *     , then, upon proper notice by TI to
     UPS as required in Section 32, either party can move directly to binding
     arbitration, as set out in Section 38 without going through the internal
     dispute resolution process outlined in Section 37.  UPS' willful breach of
     the payment provisions in this Agreement will nullify, at TI's discretion,
     the necessity of the dispute process(es) contained in this Agreement.

     TI shall provide UPS with such documentation and other written information
     with respect to each invoice as may be reasonably requested by UPS to
     verify that TI's charges to UPS are accurate, correct and valid and are in
     accordance with the provisions of this Agreement.

- -------------------
*    Omitted portion is subject to a confidential treatment request and has been
     filed separately with the Securities and Exchange Commission.

                                        8

<PAGE>

     TI shall submit    *   invoices to the UPS site manager at each Center.

SECTION 7 - TAXES

     A.   TI shall be solely responsible for taxes (including penalties and
          interest) levied, assessed or imposed on TI, based upon TI's gross
          receipts or net income or taxes imposed on TI, for the privilege of
          doing business or exercising a franchise.

     B.   UPS shall be solely responsible for paying any and all taxes, excises,
          duties and assessments in the nature of sales, use or similar taxes
          arising out of or related to its in-bound teleservices.

     C.   TI shall collect from UPS (as part of the prices charged under this
          Agreement) and pay any applicable taxes where such collection and
          payment by TI is required by law.  All such taxes shall be separately
          stated on TI's invoices.  TI and UPS shall cooperate in the
          preparation and filing of any tax returns.  Any penalties or interest
          associated with the failure upon the part of TI to timely collect or
          pay any tax shall be the responsibility of TI unless such failure was
          caused by UPS' direction or UPS' failure to pay tax to TI in
          accordance with this section.


     D.   In the case where a tax has been paid to a state other than the state
          in which the in-bound  teleservices were performed or delivered, TI
          shall cooperate with UPS in determining the amount of any credit
          against any applicable tax.

     E.   In its sole discretion and at its own expense, UPS has the right,
          either before or after payment of any tax, to contest the validity or
          application of such tax submitted by TI for payment by UPS.  Upon the
          written request of UPS, TI shall fully cooperate with UPS in
          contesting or protesting the validity or application of any such tax
          (including, but not limited to, permitting UPS to proceed in TI's name
          if required or permitted by law, provided, in each case, that such
          contest does not involve, or can be separated from, the contest of any
          tax or issues unrelated to transactions described in this Agreement).
          UPS shall also have the right to participate in any contest conducted
          by TI with respect to a tax or other charge indemnifiable under this
          section, including without limitation, the right to attend conferences
          with the taxing authority and the right to review submissions to the
          taxing authority or any court to the extent such contest does not
          involve, or can be separated from, the contest of any tax or issues
          unrelated to the transactions described in this Agreement.  In the
          event TI shall receive a refund of all or any part of such tax which
          UPS has paid and discharged, the amount of such refund shall promptly
          be remitted to UPS by TI.


- -----------------
*    Omitted portion is subject to a confidential treatment request and has been
     filed separately with the Securities and Exchange Commission.

                                        9
<PAGE>



     F.
     UPS shall be entitled to the benefit of any new jobs tax credit, enterprise
     zone tax credit, capital investment tax credit, or any other similar type
     of tax credit earned pursuant to this Agreement.  In the event the state
     law allowing for such tax credit provides that TI is the recipient of such
     tax credit, TI shall pass on the tax credit benefit to UPS in the form of a
     reduction in the amount of TI's invoice.  Under this provision, TI is
     deemed to receive benefit of the tax credit on the earlier of the due date
     of TI's return or estimated payment following the reasonable determination
     of a credit amount.  TI's next invoice will be reduced by the amount of the
     credit.  Tax credit computations and invoice reductions are subject to
     verification by UPS.

SECTION 8 - CUSTOMER RELATIONS

     In all contacts with UPS customers or callers (herein referred to
     collectively as "Customers") TI shall identify itself as "United Parcel
     Service" or "UPS." At no time will TI provide a vendor identification.


SECTION 9 - WARRANTY; LIMITATION OF WARRANTY; LIABILITY AND LIMITATION OF
LIABILITY

     A.
     TI warrants to UPS that (1) TI shall perform all Services in a good and
     professional manner and in accordance with the Agreement and Attachments,
     or any other applicable mutually agreed upon written specifications, and TI
     has the legal right to perform all TI Services.

     B.
     TI further warrants that neither TI proprietary software, nor that which it
     creates as Work Product hereunder which it shall employ to render Services
     herein shall infringe any United States copyright, patent, trademark or any
     other third party intellectual property rights, unless such infringement is
     caused solely by the combination, modification, enhancement or alteration
     by UPS or at UPS' specific written instruction.  In the event of an
     infringement claim, TI may, at its option and at its expense, either (1)
     defend such claim with competent counsel of its choosing; (2) procure the
     right to continue using such software to provide the Services; or (3)
     substitute for such hardware or software, other software which performs the
     same functions without any material loss of speed or functionality.

     C.
     UPS warrants that neither UPS proprietary hardware or software it supplies
     to TI to render Services hereunder, nor any modifications, enhancements,
     alterations or combinations to third party hardware or software UPS
     performs or performed, creates or created, or requires TI to perform or
     create upon written instructions, shall infringe upon any United States
     copyright, patent, trademark or any other third party

                                       10

<PAGE>

     intellectual property rights unless such infringement is caused solely by
     the combination, modification, enhancement or alteration of such hardware
     or software by TI without instruction from UPS.  In the event of an
     infringement claim, UPS may, at its option and at its expense, either (1)
     defend such claim with competent counsel of its choosing; (2) procure the
     right to continue using such hardware or software to provide the Services;
     or (3) substitute for such hardware or software, other hardware or software
     which performs the same functions without any material loss of speed or
     functionality.

     D.
     Except for the foregoing warranties, and such additional warranties as
     shall be expressly set forth herein, or in one or more Attachments hereto,
     neither party makes any other warranty of any kind, express or implied, for
     the Services, equipment, facilities or data furnished hereunder or under
     any Attachment hereto.  EACH PARTY SPECIFICALLY DISCLAIMS ALL IMPLIED
     WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  TI will
     pass through to UPS for UPS' benefit, any manufacturers' or other third
     party warranties which TI is permitted to pass through to UPS under TI's
     agreements with such manufacturers and third parties.

     E.
     This Section shall survive termination or expiration of this Agreement.

SECTION 10 - TI STAFFING

     A.
     UPS shall have the right to require that TI employees or agents who do not
     perform in accordance with the standards or UPS requirements in the
     Agreement above, shall be promptly retrained as necessary, and that
     employees or agents who flagrantly or repeatedly violate such standards or
     UPS requirements shall be removed immediately from all performance under
     this Agreement.

     B.
     If TI determines that UPS concerns are reasonable and well founded, TI will
     replace that employee with a person of suitable ability and qualifications.
     Nothing in this provision shall be deemed to give UPS the right to require
     TI to terminate any TI employee's employment; it is intended to give UPS
     only the right to request that TI discontinue using an employee in the
     performance of the Services.

SECTION 11 - COOPERATION WITH UPS AUDITS

     TI will provide such UPS auditors and inspectors as UPS may designate in
     writing upon reasonable notice with reasonable access to the TI's
     facilities at which TI is performing the Services, to TI's personnel, to
     UPS' existing data and work product

                                       11

<PAGE>

     and to that being developed by TI hereunder at such facilities, and to
     reasonable related documentation for the purpose of performing, at UPS'
     expense, those audits and inspections of TI's business reasonably requested
     by UPS, including without limitation, to the extent applicable to the TI's
     Services, audits of (i) software use practices and procedures, (ii)
     application and operating systems, (iii) general controls and security
     practices and procedures, (iv) general call monitoring, performance and
     procedures and (v) disaster recovery and back-up procedures.

SECTION 12 - SITE MANAGERS

     All operational issues relating to the Services performed pursuant to this
     Agreement shall be conducted exclusively between UPS' Site Manager(s) and
     TI's Site Manager(s).

SECTION 13 - PERSONNEL

          *

SECTION 14 - PERFORMANCE REVIEW

     A designated representative of TI and a designated representative of UPS
     will meet as often as shall reasonably be requested by either party hereto
     to review the performance of the parties under this Agreement.  Each party
     shall bear its own costs and expenses incurred in connection with such
     review.

SECTION 15 - INDEMNITY

     TI shall at all times be deemed to be performing as an independent
     contractor and not as an agent or employee of UPS.  Each party
     ("Indemnifying Party") to this Agreement agrees to indemnify, protect and
     hold the other party and its directors, officers and employees, agents,
     shareholders, partners, representatives (collectively, "Indemnified
     Parties") harmless from and against any and all claims (including, but not
     limited to losses, judgments, damages, settlements and expenses (including
     reasonable investigation expenses and reasonable attorneys' fees), for
     those actions to the extent they result from (i) the negligence or willful
     misconduct of the Indemnifying Party, including but not limited to third
     party claims for injury or death to persons, including Indemnifying Party's
     employees, or damage to property or business entities, and (ii) claims that
     such Indemnifying Party's product, including hardware, software or any
     combination thereof, constitutes an infringement of a United States patent,
     copyright, trade secret or other intellectual property right of any


- ---------------


*    Omitted portion is subject to a confidential treatment request and has been
     filed separately with the Securities and Exchange Commission.

                                       12

<PAGE>


     third party.  In addition, UPS, as the Indemnifying Party, shall indemnify,
     defend and hold the Indemnified Parties harmless from and against any
     losses incurred by or imposed or asserted against TI or other Indemnified
     Party in connection with (i) UPS' failure or alleged failure to provide
     services or products to customers, (ii) any alleged defect or deficiency in
     any products or services provided by UPS to customers, (iii) any "script"
     or other written or oral presentations furnished by UPS to TI or approved
     in writing by UPS for use by TI, (iv) any action taken by TI at the written
     request or upon the written instructions of UPS, and (v) building toxicity
     or so-called "sick building" syndrome(s).  The indemnity set forth in this
     Section and the limitation of liability set forth in the following Section
     hereof shall survive the expiration or termination of the Term or
     Additional Term of this Agreement.

SECTION 16 - LIMITATION OF LIABILITY

     A.   Neither Party shall be liable to the other for:

     1.   failure or delay in rendering performance arising out of the following
          causes:  Acts of God or the public enemy, wars, fires, floods,
          epidemics, quarantine, restrictions, or unusually severe weather and
          similar events.  Dates or times of performance shall be extended to
          the extent of delays excused by this Section, provided that the party
          whose performance is affected notifies the other party promptly of the
          existence and nature of such delay.

     2.   special, indirect, incidental or consequential damages, including
          without limitation damages for lost opportunities, even if such
          damages were foreseeable or result from a breach of this Agreement;

     B.   TI shall not have any liability to an Indemnified Party to the extent
          that such liability arises as a result of failure of UPS to fulfill
          its obligations hereunder.

     C.   TI is responsible to provide in writing to the UPS Site Manager a memo
          outlining how UPS has not fulfilled its responsibilities under this
          Agreement  *  .  In the event TI does not issue this memo, then UPS is
          conclusively deemed to have fulfilled its responsibilities.       *
          Failing resolution by such methodology, the dispute shall be subject
          to the Arbitration provisions of this Agreement.

     D.        *

     E.        *

- -------------
*    Omitted portion is subject to a confidential treatment request and has been
     filed separately with the Securities and Exchange Commission.

                                       13

<PAGE>


     SECTION 17 - INSURANCE

     TI shall, at its own cost and expense, obtain and maintain in full force
     and effect, with sound and reputable insurers, during the term of this
     Agreement, the following insurance coverages: (a) Workers' Compensation
     insurance as required by the law of the state of hire; (b) Employer's
     Liability Insurance with minimum limits of $1,000,000 of liability, and not
     less than $1,000,000 aggregate limit of liability per policy year for
     disease, including death at any time resulting therefrom, not caused by
     accident; (c) Comprehensive General Liability insurance against all hazards
     with a minimum limit of liability for personal injury, including death
     resulting therefrom, on an occurrence basis of $10,000,000 in the
     aggregate, and with a minimum limit of liability for property damage on an
     occurrence basis of $10,000,000 in the aggregate; (d) Automobile Liability
     insurance against liability arising from the maintenance or use of all
     owned, non-owned and hired automobiles and trucks with a minimum limit of
     liability for bodily injury of $5,000,000 in the aggregate, and with a
     minimum limit of liability for property damage of $5,000,000 per accident;
     (e) Fire Legal Liability Insurance of $1,000,000 and (f) Crime Insurance,
     including at a minimum fidelity coverage, computer theft and fraud covered
     with a minimum of $5,000,000.  TI's insurance shall be deemed primary.  TI
     shall provide UPS with certificates of insurance evidencing the coverages
     required hereunder within ten (10) days after execution of this Agreement
     and prior to commencement of operations.  Each policy required hereunder
     shall name UPS as an additional insured and shall provide that UPS shall
     receive thirty (30) days' advance written notice in the event of a
     cancellation or material change in such policy.  In the event that any
     Service under this Agreement is to be rendered by persons other than TI's
     employees, TI's insurance shall cover such persons under the same terms and
     conditions.

     SECTION 18 - TAX AND TRAINING INCENTIVES

     Subject to applicable law, and so long as UPS is in compliance with the
     terms of this Agreement, TI will reasonably cooperate with UPS to allow UPS
     to be eligible to receive available tax and training incentives based upon
     TI's performance of Services and the employ of employees by TI therefor.

     SECTION 19 - FORCE MAJEURE

     If either party to this Agreement shall be prevented, hindered, or delayed
     in the performance or observance of any of its obligations hereunder by
     reason of any circumstance as defined in Section 16.A.1, above, and such
     delay could not have been prevented by reasonable precautions and cannot
     reasonably be circumvented by the party through the use of alternate
     sources, work-around plans, or other means, then such party shall be
     excused from any further performance or observance of the obligation(s) so
     affected for as long as such circumstances prevail and such party continues
     to use its best efforts to recommence performance or observance whenever
     and to whatever extent possible without delay.  TI as the affected party
     shall not have the right to any additional

                                       14

<PAGE>

     payments from UPS as a result of any force majeure occurrence, nor shall
     UPS as the affected party have the right to any additional material
     Services from TI not encompassed by this Agreement.  The affected party
     shall immediately notify the other by telephone and confirm in writing
     within five (5) days of such call describing with specificity the reasons
     for such delay.  If TI is the affected party and UPS is thus prevented from
     conducting a significant portion of UPS' normal business operations at any
     Center for seven (7) days after notification, despite the parties' best
     efforts, then, at any time thereafter and until such time as TI is able to
     resume or so arrange for acceptable alternative performance, UPS may
     suspend this Agreement at that Center and seek alternative performance
     until such time as TI is able to continue.  Any such suspension by UPS
     shall be without penalty or termination charges and shall be effective as
     of a date specified by UPS in a written notice of termination to TI.  If
     either party is unable to perform at any Center under this Agreement due to
     force majeure causes for a period of sixty (60) days, then the other party
     may terminate this Agreement in whole or in part and such termination shall
     be considered for the convenience and benefit of both parties.

     SECTION 20 - CONFIDENTIALITY

     A.   In connection with the performance of the services, UPS may furnish TI
          with   *  .  UPS shall retain all rights in and to   *    provided by
          UPS to TI in addition to any information relating to      *
          developed by TI in the course of its performance of the Services.
          Further, UPS may, in its sole discretion, disclose to TI or TI may
          become aware of certain of its other confidential and proprietary
          information used in connection with UPS' business.  All such material
          is hereinafter called "UPS Proprietary Information."  UPS shall retain
          all rights in and to the UPS Proprietary Information.  TI agrees to
          maintain the UPS Proprietary Information in confidence with the same
          degree of care TI uses to protect its own information of like nature,
          but no less than a reasonable degree of care, and to refrain from the
          use of such information or the disclosure of such information to third
          parties without UPS' prior written consent.  TI will instruct its
          personnel assigned to work on UPS' premises that they do not remove
          any of UPS' documents or other UPS materials and they do not disclose,
          discuss, or publish, without prior written consent from UPS, any
          Proprietary Information to any unauthorized person outside the
          premises.  This obligation to protect UPS Proprietary Information
          shall continue for a period of three (3) years after the termination
          or expiration of this Agreement.

     B.   In connection with the performance of the Services, TI may, in its
          sole discretion, disclose to UPS or UPS may become aware of certain
          confidential and proprietary information used in connection with TI's
          business ("TI Proprietary Information").  TI shall retain all rights
          in and to the TI Proprietary Information and UPS agrees to

- --------------
*    Omitted portion is subject to a confidential treatment request and has been
filed separately with the Securities and Exchange Commission.


                                       15

<PAGE>

          maintain all such information in confidence with the same degree of
          care UPS uses to protect its own information of like nature, but no
          less than a reasonable degree of care, and to refrain from the use of
          such information or the disclosure of such information to third
          parties without TI's prior written consent.  This obligation to
          protect TI Proprietary Information shall continue for a period of
          three (3) years after the termination or expiration of this Agreement.

     C.   TI Proprietary Information and UPS Proprietary Information are
          sometimes referred to as "Proprietary Information."

     D.   "Proprietary Information" shall also mean  *  , as well as all other
          information provided to one party to this Agreement by the other party
          orally or in writing which is identified as confidential prior to
          disclosure or delivery to the recipient, and all information and
          matters which constitute trade secrets of the disclosing party, all of
          which are hereby agreed to be the property of and confidential to the
          owner and discloser of Proprietary Information.

     E.   The parties acknowledge that compliance with the covenants set forth
          in this Section 20 are necessary to protect the business, good will
          and Proprietary Information of the other party and that a breach of
          these restrictions will irreparably, irrevocably and continually
          damage the other party in a manner for which money damages may not be
          adequate.  Consequently, each party agrees that in the event that it
          breaches or threatens to breach any of these covenants, the other
          party shall be entitled to both (i) a temporary, preliminary and
          permanent injunction in order to prevent the continuation of such
          harm, and (ii) money damages insofar as they can be determined.
          Nothing in this Agreement, however, shall be construed to prohibit
          either party from also pursuing any other remedy available at law, in
          equity or otherwise, the parties having agreed that all remedies shall
          be cumulative.

     F.   The provisions of this Section 20 shall not apply to any information
          which (i) belongs to the recipient party, (ii) is already known by the
          recipient party without an obligation of confidentially other than
          under this Agreement, (iii) is publicly known or becomes publicly
          known through no unauthorized act of the recipient party, (iv) is
          rightfully received from a third party, (v) is independently developed
          by the recipient party without use of the disclosing party's
          Proprietary Information, or (vi) is required to be disclosed pursuant
          to a requirement of a governmental agency or law of the United States
          or a state thereof or any governmental or applicable subdivision
          thereof or any court of law, so long as the party required to disclose
          the information provides the other party with timely prior notice of
          such requirement and cooperates

- ---------------
*    Omitted portion is subject to a confidential treatment request and has been
     filed separately with the Securities and Exchange Commission.

                                       16

<PAGE>

          with such other party at its expense in any attempt by such other
          party to obtain a protective order regarding such information.

     G.   Each party shall (a) notify the other party promptly of any material
          unauthorized possession, use or knowledge, or attempt thereof, of the
          other party's Proprietary Information by any person or entity which
          may become known to such party, (b) promptly furnish to the other
          party full details of the unauthorized possession, use or knowledge,
          or attempt thereof, and assist the other party in investigating or
          preventing the reoccurrence of any unauthorized possession, use or
          knowledge thereof of Proprietary Information, (c) use reasonable
          efforts to cooperate with the other party in any litigation or
          investigation against third parties deemed necessary by the other
          party to protect its Proprietary Information and (d) promptly use all
          reasonable efforts to prevent a reoccurrence of any unauthorized
          possession, use or knowledge of Proprietary Information.  Each party
          shall bear the cost it incurs as a result of such compliance.

     H.   With respect to the Proprietary Information, each party shall (i) not
          provide or make available the Proprietary Information of the other
          party in any form to any people other than those of its employees who
          have a need to know consistent with the scope of services to be
          performed under this Agreement; (ii) not provide the Proprietary
          Information of the other party, except for use reasonably necessary in
          the performance of the services hereunder; (iii) not exploit or use
          the Proprietary Information of the other party, except as permitted by
          this Agreement; and (iv) return all Proprietary Information of the
          other party which is in written or graphic form and any copies thereof
          in its possession or control upon the request of the other party.

     I.   At the request of either party, the other shall have each of its
          employees assigned to perform the Services execute a nondisclosure
          agreement in a form mutually acceptable to UPS and TI.

     J.   The provision of this Section 20 shall survive the expiration or
          termination of this Agreement.

SECTION 21 - MISCELLANEOUS CONFIDENTIALITY REQUIREMENTS

     A.   Until the expiration or termination of this Agreement, and for a
          period of   *   , or with the written consent of the other party,
          neither UP nor TI will solicit or cause any third party to solicit
          any employee of the other or make such other contact with any such
          employee, the product of which contact which will or may yield the

- --------------
*    Omitted portion is subject to a confidential treatment request and has been
     filed separately with the Securities and Exchange Commission.

                                       17

<PAGE>

          termination of the employment relationship of such employee from such
          party, except as set out in Section 34, below.

     B.   *

     C.   Unless the written consent of UPS shall first be obtained, TI shall
          not at any time, notwithstanding the expiration of the term or the
          termination of this Agreement, in any manner advertise or publish or
          release for publication any statement mentioning UPS or the fact that
          TI is furnishing or has furnished or agreed to furnish services to
          UPS.

     D.   The provision of this Section 21 shall survive the termination or
          expiration of this Agreement.

SECTION 22 - KEY TI PERSONNEL

     The parties agree that      *      are critical to TI's successful
     performance of this Agreement and are key persons of TI ("Key Person" or
     "Key Personnel").  TI agrees that it will assign each Key Person to the
     performance of this Agreement during its term.  If because of termination,
     incapacitation or resignation any Key Person becomes unavailable for the
     performance of this Agreement, TI agrees to replace each such Key Person
     with a person of equal or better qualifications.  TI agrees to provide a
     new Key Person in the same method as it provides a Site Manager herein (see
     Section 1.B.4).

SECTION 23 - LAWS AND REGULATIONS

     TI agrees that it will comply with all laws and regulations applicable to
     TI's employees and telemarketing, including but not limited to the Fair
     Labor Standards Act, Title VII of the Civil Rights Act of 1964, the Age
     Discrimination in Employment Act of 1967, the Rehabilitation Act of 1973,
     the Immigration Reform and Control Act of 1986, the Americans with
     Disabilities Act of 1990, the Occupational Safety and Health Act (OSHA),
     the affirmative action responsibilities to comply with the office of
     Federal Contract Compliance Program (OFCCP) Guidelines and such other
     employment laws which may be enacted during the life of this Agreement, and
     other similar laws in effect or hereinafter enacted dealing with TI's
     workforce.  In performing Services and without limiting the generality of
     the foregoing, TI shall also comply with any and all rules and regulations
     promulgated pursuant to the Telemarketing and Consumer Fraud Prevention Act
     of 1994.  UPS will be responsible for the cost of implementing all
     necessary Americans With Disabilities Act (ADA) reasonable accommodations
     to facilities.

- ---------------
*    Omitted portion is subject to a confidential treatment request and has been
     filed separately with the Securities and Exchange Commission.

                                       18

<PAGE>

     Regarding equipment, UPS will be responsible for providing all equipment
     necessary to comply with the ADA up to an aggregate value of five thousand
     dollars ($5,000.00) per Center.

SECTION 24 - SECURITY FOR THE CENTERS

     Except to the extent of UPS' obligations hereunder, TI will be responsible
     for safe-guarding the work area,    *   and providing a safe working
     environment, investigating security breaches and taking all satisfactory
     remedial steps.   *   TI will also be responsible to properly safeguard
     all equipment and related materials.  This is to include UPS proprietary
     software, other UPS proprietary information and documents, and/or other
     related systems, phone/communications lines, and use or access thereof
     which could cause loss to UPS.  In the instance where equipment is owned by
     UPS, TI will ensure all equipment is inventoried and signed for by TI's
     authorized representative upon installation and acceptance.  At anytime
     thereafter, TI retains responsibility and liability for any equipment that
     is removed, exchanged, or modified, until such time that equipment is
     signed for by an authorized UPS representative releasing TI of liability.
     TI is required to maintain a current equipment inventory listing subject to
     UPS audit at any time.  TI's liability will include, but not be limited to,
     the replacement cost of any missing equipment or materials and/or loss due
     to misuse or unauthorized access or use of any materials, equipment or
     systems.  UPS personnel at all times will comply with TI's rules at the
     Centers.

SECTION 25 - PROPERTY AND PROPRIETARY RIGHTS

     A.   All work produced by TI under this Agreement, including, without
          limitation, all inventions, creations, expressions, improvements,
          computer programs, specifications, operating instructions and all
          other documentation, whether patentable or unpatentable, which are
          first conceived or made or first actually or constructively reduced to
          practice during the life of this Agreement or within six (6) months
          following the expiration or cancellation hereof, and which are
          conceived or made in response to matters related to the Services or
          based in whole or in part on or derived from information supplied by
          UPS or its Affiliated Companies, whether preliminary or final, and on
          whatever media rendered (collectively, the "Work Product"), shall be
          deemed work made for hire and made in the course of services rendered
          under this Agreement and shall be the exclusive property of UPS.  UPS
          shall have the unlimited right to make, have made, use, reconstruct,
          repair, modify, reproduce, publish, distribute and sell the Work
          Product, in whole or in part, or combine the

- ------------------
*    Omitted portion is subject to a confidential treatment request and has been
     filed separately with the Securities and Exchange Commission.

                                       19

<PAGE>

          Work Product with other matter, or not use the Work Product at all, as
          it sees fit    *   Prior to providing services under this Agreement
          pursuant to any Work Order, TI shall identify to UPS in writing any
          technology, information, computer programs or other documentation
          owned by or licensed to TI prior to the commencement of such services
          which will be useful or necessary to the Work Product ("TI Property").


          In consideration of UPS' payment to TI of amounts specified herein
          under this Agreement, and to the extent that title to any such Work
          Product may not, by operation of law, vest in UPS, or such Work
          Product may not be considered to be work made for hire, TI hereby (i)
          irrevocably transfers and assigns to UPS in perpetuity all worldwide
          right, title and interest in and to the patent rights, copyrights,
          trade secrets and other proprietary rights (including, without
          limitation, applications for registration thereof, and all priority
          rights therein under applicable international conventions for the
          protection of such rights) in, and ownership of, the Work Product that
          TI may have, as and when such rights arise, (ii) grants to UPS an
          unrestricted, irrevocable, nonexclusive, fully paid up, perpetual
          license, with the right to sublicense, in and to TI's proprietary
          rights to the TI Property integrated into and required for use in
          connection with the Work Product, and further agrees that other UPS
          outsourcing vendors may use these enhanced systems on UPS projects
          without paying a royalty.  Nothing herein shall be interpreted as
          granting any license or right in TI stand-alone Property or in TI
          third party Property.

     B.   TI shall cooperate fully in (i) vesting in UPS the ownership of the
          proprietary rights to the Work Product, and (ii) assisting UPS, at
          UPS' expense, in obtaining patent, copyright or any other intellectual
          property rights in the Work Product and in maintaining and protecting
          UPS'  proprietary rights, including, without limitation, executing any
          documents which UPS reasonably deems necessary for such purpose.

     C.   TI warrants that Work Product will perform in accordance with mutually
          agreed-upon previously established specifications for the term of this
          Agreement; provided, however, that such warranty shall specifically
          exclude any failure of Work Product caused by enhancements,
          modifications, alterations or combinations made by UPS or a third
          party to Work Product, or to any UPS software that performs in
          conjunction with Work Product.  TI SPECIFICALLY DISCLAIMS ANY OTHER
          WARRANTIES, WHETHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING ANY WARRANTIES OF
          MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.

- ---------------
*    Omitted portion is subject to a confidential treatment request and has been
     filed separately with the Securities and Exchange Commission.

                                       20

<PAGE>

     D.   Any TI-developed enhancements, modifications, additional porting,
          alterations or other changes to Work Product that: (i) are not a
          result of TI's compliance with Section 1.B.10 or Section 25.C., above,
          or Section 41, below; and (ii) are requested by UPS or agreed upon by
          UPS prior to development, shall be performed by TI at prices, terms
          and conditions as may be mutually agreed upon by the parties.

     E.   Title to all materials and documentation furnished by UPS to TI,
          including, without limitation, system specifications, shall remain in
          UPS.  TI  shall deliver to UPS any and all such Work Product and
          property, including all copies thereof on whatever media rendered,
          upon (i) UPS' request; (ii) completion of any Work Order, and (iii)
          the termination of this Agreement for any reason.

     F.   Each Party shall be free to use the residuals resulting from any work
          developed pursuant to this Agreement that is owned by the other party,
          and any ideas, concepts, know-how or techniques contained therein, for
          any purpose, except to prepare any other work substantially similar to
          such work.  For purposes of the foregoing, the term "residuals" means
          information in non-tangible form that is retained as mental
          impressions by individuals having access to the work.  Neither party
          shall have an obligation to pay royalties for any work resulting from
          such residuals.

SECTION 26 - UPS REPRESENTATIONS AND WARRANTIES


     UPS represents and warrants to TI as follows:

     A.   The execution, delivery and performance of this Agreement by UPS and
          the performance by UPS of the transactions contemplated hereby have
          been duly and validly authorized by all necessary action, corporate or
          otherwise on its part, and that this Agreement constitutes the valid,
          legal and binding obligation of UPS, enforceable against it in
          accordance with its terms.

     B.   Neither the execution, delivery nor performance of this Agreement with
          or without the giving of notice, the passage time or both will result
          in the violation or breach of any contract, agreement, instrument,
          undertaking, order, judgment, decree, rule, regulation, law or any
          other restriction to which UPS is a party or pursuant to which UPS or
          its assets are subject or otherwise.

     C.   No consent, approval or other action by or a notice to or filing with
          any person is required or necessary in connection with the execution,
          delivery and performance of this Agreement by UPS.

                                       21

<PAGE>


SECTION 27 - TI'S REPRESENTATIONS AND WARRANTIES

     TI represents and warrants to UPS as follows:

     A.   The execution, delivery and performance of this Agreement by TI and
          the performance by TI of the transactions contemplated hereby have
          been duly and validly authorized by all necessary action, corporate or
          otherwise on its part, and that this Agreement constitutes the valid,
          legal and binding obligation of TI, enforceable against it in
          accordance with its terms.

     B.   NEITHER the execution, delivery nor performance of this Agreement,
          with or without the giving of notice, the passage time or both, will
          result in the violation or breach of any contract, agreement,
          instrument, undertaking, order, judgment, decree, rule, regulation,
          law or any other restriction to which TI is a party or pursuant to
          which TI or its assets are subject or otherwise.

     C.   No consent, approval or other action by or a notice to or filing with
          any person is required or necessary in connection with the execution,
          delivery and performance of this Agreement by TI.

SECTION 28 - REVIEW AND REVISION OF UPS REQUIREMENTS

     Periodically, as appropriate, the parties will review the UPS requirements
     in this Agreement and, if mutually agreed by the parties, such standards
     will be adjusted to reflect appropriate changes in circumstances, including
     without limitation being (i) made more stringent to reflect improved
     performance capabilities associated with advances in the technology and
     methods used generally to perform similar services, or (ii) made less
     stringent to reflect service or resource reductions requested or approved
     in writing by UPS.

SECTION 29 - VERIFICATION OF COMPLIANCE

     TI will provide UPS with a monthly performance report, in a form and with
     content mutually  established by the parties, documenting TI's performance
     with respect to the UPS requirements herein.  In addition, TI will provide
     UPS with such documentation and other information as may be reasonably
     requested by UPS from time to time in order to verify that TI's performance
     of the Services is in compliance with the applicable UPS requirements.

SECTION 30 - TERMINATION FOR CHANGED LAWS

     Either party shall have the right to terminate this Agreement, without
     liability to the other, in the event of judicial, regulatory or legislative
     change rendering performance of this Agreement impossible or illegal.  Each
     party shall provide the other with written

                                       22

<PAGE>

     notice of such termination as promptly as possible, but in no event less
     than sixty (60) days prior to the termination date.

SECTION 31 - TERMINATION FOR CAUSE

     In the event that either party hereto (i) materially breaches any of its
     duties or obligations hereunder (except for a breach of UPS' payment
     obligations hereunder), which breach shall not be substantially cured
     within    *   after written notice is given to the breaching party
     specifying the breach, or (ii) commits a material breach in the
     performance of any of its duties or obligations hereunder which cannot
     reasonably be cured within    *      and fails to proceed promptly after
     being given written notice specifying the breach to commence curing said
     breach and thereafter to proceed with all due diligence to substantially
     cure the same, or (iii) repeatedly breaches any of its duties or
     obligations hereunder and fails to substantially cure and cease committing
     such repeated breaches within   *    after being given written notice
     specifying the breach, then the party not in breach may, by giving written
     notice thereof to the breaching party, terminate this Agreement as of a
     date specified in such notice of termination, and pursue whatever
     remedies it has under this Agreement, at law or in equity.

SECTION 32 - TERMINATION FOR NONPAYMENT

     In the event that UPS breaches its obligation to pay to TI any amount due
     to TI hereunder and does not cure such breach      *     , then TI may, by
     giving written notice thereof to UPS, terminate this Agreement as of a date
     specified in such notice of termination.  Notwithstanding the foregoing, TI
     may not terminate this Agreement pursuant to this Section for UPS' failure
     to pay to TI any amount that is reasonably disputed by UPS in good faith so
     long as UPS complies with the terms of Section 6, above, and pursue
     whatever remedies it has under this Agreement, at law or in equity.

SECTION 33 - TERMINATION FOR INSOLVENCY OR FOR FINANCIAL DIFFICULTY

     In the event that either party hereto is unable to pay its debts generally
     as they come due or is declared insolvent or bankrupt, is the subject of
     any proceedings relating to its liquidation, insolvency or for the
     appointment of a receiver or similar officer for it, makes an assignment
     for the benefit of all or substantially all of its creditors, or enters
     into an agreement for the composition, extension, or readjustment of all or
     substantially all of its obligations, then the other party hereto may, by
     giving written notice thereof to such party, terminate this Agreement as of
     a date specified in such notice of termination.       *

- ---------------
*    Omitted portion is subject to a confidential treatment request and has been
     filed separately with the Securities and Exchange Commission.

                                       23

<PAGE>


SECTION 34 - TERMINATION  ASSISTANCE

     A.   Commencing upon any notice of termination by either party pursuant to
          above Sections hereof or upon expiration of the Term or Additional
          Term of this Agreement, TI will provide to UPS or its designee any and
          all termination assistance reasonably requested by UPS to allow the
          Services to continue without interruption or adverse effect and to
          facilitate the orderly transfer of responsibility for the Services to
          UPS or its designee.  Should termination be initiated by TI for UPS'
          non-payment (other than non-payment pursuant to Section 6, above), UPS
          acknowledges and agrees that it will resume all payment for Services
          that TI continues to provide during the transition period and for all
          termination assistance.  If and to the extent that such assistance is
          provided prior to the termination date, TI will provide termination
          assistance at the Base Rate.  If and to the extent that such
          assistance is provided after the termination date or otherwise
          requires resources in addition to those resources then being regularly
          utilized in the performance of the Services, UPS will pay TI for such
          assistance on a time and materials basis at reasonable negotiated
          rates therefor or on any other mutually acceptable basis.  The
          termination assistance to be provided to UPS by TI shall include,
          without limitation, the following:

          1.   Continuing to perform, for a reasonable period following the
               termination date, any or all of the Services then being performed
               by TI.

          2.   Developing, with the assistance of UPS, a plan for the transition
               of operations from TI to UPS or its designee, which plan shall
               include, to the extent requested by UPS and not inconsistent with
               the provisions of this Agreement.

          3.   Providing training for personnel of UPS and its designee in the
               performance of the operations then being transitioned to UPS or
               its designee.

          4.   Entering into licensing arrangements with UPS or its designee  *
               Any dispute regarding reasonableness under subsections (i) and
               (ii), above, shall be subject to the provisions of Section 38,
               below.  Notwithstanding anything herein to the contrary, TI will
               be excused from granting the above-described licenses to UPS
               should UPS be held to have breached this Agreement under Sections
               31 or 32 as a result of an arbitration required under Section 38
               hereunder.

          5.   Making available to UPS or its designee, pursuant to mutually
               acceptable terms and conditions, any equipment owned or leased by
               TI that TI is required to provide under this Agreement.  UPS or
               its designee may purchase any such


- --------------
*    Omitted portion is subject to a confidential treatment request and has been
     filed separately with the Securities and Exchange Commission.

                                       24

<PAGE>
               equipment owned by TI at TI's then current book value and may
               assume TI's rights and obligations with respect to any such
               equipment leased by TI, but in no event less than any remaining
               outstanding loan on the equipment, provided that the equipment
               shall not be financed for greater than its fair market value.

          6.   Making available to UPS or its designee, pursuant to mutually
               acceptable terms and conditions, any third party services then
               being utilized by TI in the performance of the Services.

          7.   Allowing UPS or its designee to make offers of employment to all
               CSR's and call center supervisors.  For a period of  *  following
               the termination or expiration of this Agreement, should UPS
               desire to solicit and/or offer employment to any TI manager, it
               may do so only upon TI's prior written consent, which TI may
               withhold in its sole discretion.  In addition, and for the same
               period of time, UPS shall not knowingly solicit and hire, without
               TI's prior written consent     *        Should UPS breach this
               clause, it shall pay to TI an amount equal to      *      which
               the parties acknowledge shall constitute a reasonable estimate of
               TI's actual damages that cannot be fixed, and is not a penalty.

     B.   Prior to providing any of the foregoing termination assistance to UPS
          or its designee, TI shall be entitled to receive from such designee,
          in form and substance reasonably acceptable to TI, written assurances
          that (i) such designee will maintain at all times the confidentiality
          of any TI proprietary information, software or materials disclosed or
          provided to, or learned by such designee in connection therewith, and
          (ii) such designee will use such information, software or materials
          exclusively for purposes for which UPS is authorized to use such
          information, software or materials pursuant to this Agreement.  In the
          event this Agreement is terminated by TI pursuant to Sections 31 or
          32, above, UPS will pay TI     *      and as a condition to TI's
          obligation to provide termination assistance to UPS or its designee,
          an amount equal to TI's reasonable estimate of the reasonable amount
          payable to TI for such termination assistance for that month.       *
              This shall survive termination or expiration of this Agreement.

SECTION 35 - THIRD PARTY SOFTWARE

     TI will obtain UPS' approval prior to implementing any third party
     software, and related documentation, database management systems, data and
     technical information, in the performance of the Services which TI will not
     be able to license to UPS or its designee upon termination of this
     Agreement as contemplated herein, unless TI will be able to


- ----------------
*    Omitted portion is subject to a confidential treatment request and has been
     filed separately with the Securities and Exchange Commission.

                                       25

<PAGE>

provide UPS with an alternative that will permit UPS or its designee to continue
to perform the applicable Systems and Services after termination of this
Agreement without degradation of performance levels or reduction in
functionality.

SECTION 36 - INDEPENDENT CONTRACTOR

     TI shall act at all times as an independent contractor, and nothing
     contained herein shall be construed to create the relationship of principal
     and agent, or employer and employee, between TI and UPS.  TI employees
     assigned to perform the Services for UPS are solely the employees of TI.
     TI shall have sole authority and responsibility to counsel, discipline,
     review, evaluate, set the pay rates of, and terminate its employees who
     perform the Services.  TI will maintain all necessary payroll and personnel
     records, and compute wages and withhold applicable federal, state and local
     taxes and social security payments for TI personnel performing the
     Services.

SECTION 37 - DISPUTE RESOLUTION

     In the event any material dispute exists between the parties, including
     without limitation any dispute relating to the interpretation of this
     Agreement, or performance or non-performance hereunder, then each party
     will appoint a designated executive management representative who does not
     devote substantially all of his or her time to performance under this
     Agreement to resolve such dispute.  Such representatives shall discuss the
     problem and negotiate in good faith in an effort to resolve the dispute
     without the necessity of any formal proceeding relating thereto within
     thirty (30) days.  The parties hereby waive the expiration of any
     applicable statute of limitations during such thirty (30) day period.
     Except where clearly prevented by the nature of the dispute, both parties
     agree to continue performing their respective obligations under this
     Agreement during such thirty (30) days or for as long as the parties may
     mutually agree, unless and until this Agreement expires or is terminated in
     accordance herewith.  This provision shall not preclude either party from
     seeking immediate relief such as a preliminary injunction, temporary
     restraining order, or declaratory proceeding.  In addition, this provision
     shall not apply in the event of willful breach by either party.

SECTION 38 - ARBITRATION

     In the event a dispute cannot be resolved through the procedure outlined in
     Section 37, above, the parties agree that all remaining disputes which may
     arise under, out of, or in connection with the Agreement will be settled by
     arbitration conducted in     *   in accordance with the rules of the
     American Arbitration Association (AAA) as modified

- ----------------
*    Omitted portion is subject to a confidential treatment request and has been
     filed separately with the Securities and Exchange Commission.


                                       26

<PAGE>

herein:      *      the arbitrator shall not award punitive damages or multiply
the award pursuant to any statute that doubles, trebles or otherwise increases
damages and that forms the basis of any claim;     *     .  The losing party
shall be required to pay the reasonable legal fees and costs of the prevailing
party as determined by the arbitrator(s).

SECTION 39 - LOGOS AND TRADEMARKS

     Neither party will use the other's trademark in any employment
     advertisements placed to solicit the employment of CSR's or otherwise.
     Without the other party's prior written approval, neither party shall use
     the other's logo or trademarks in any internal or external written
     communication.

SECTION 40 - REGULAR EXECUTIVE REVIEWS

     Quarterly, during the Term, representatives of TI and UPS shall meet for
     review of the status of matters contemplated by this Agreement, including
     but not limited to service performance, quality performance, status of
     transition, enhancement to Services (as set forth in Section 1 hereof) and
     quality improvement processes.

SECTION 41 - GAIN SHARING INCENTIVES

     *

SECTION 42 - HOLIDAY OBSERVANCE

     At least one Center shall be operational each day of the year.   Within
     thirty (30) days prior to each of New Year's Day, Memorial Day, Fourth of
     July, Labor Day, Thanksgiving Day and Christmas Day, UPS shall advise TI of
     anticipated Service volumes for such dates and TI shall accordingly staff
     the Centers to reflect such needs.  UPS shall pay to TI an amount equal to
        *      for all CSR hours worked during the six (6) holidays set forth
     herein.

SECTION 43 -      *


     *

SECTION 44 - PURCHASE OF TRAINING PROGRAM

     UPS shall perform, or cause others to perform, an administrative and
     management training program, as more fully described in the Attachment
     hereto, at each Center on such date or date(s) as may be agreed between UPS
     and TI, but in the absence of any

                                       27

<PAGE>

     other agreement, for management training, commencing    *   prior to the
     commencement of the rendition of Services at a Center and for
     administrative training, commencing      *      prior to the commencement
     of the rendition of Services at a Center.  TI shall      *      in
     consideration of the performance of the administrative and management
     training program.  TI agrees to assume all instructional costs of training
     at its own expense after a period of      *      from the opening of each
     Center.

SECTION 45 - CERTAIN EMPLOYMENT REQUIREMENTS

     TI shall develop its own CSR screening, testing and hiring process to be
     implemented at each Center; prior to the implementation of such process, TI
     shall review applicable processes currently maintained by UPS.

SECTION 46 - NO JOINT VENTURE

     The relationship of TI and UPS hereunder shall in no way be construed to
     create a joint venture or partnership, it being agreed and understood the
     relationship between TI and UPS is an independent contractor relationship.

SECTION 47 - NOTICES

     All notices or requests required to be given under this Agreement and all
     other communications related to this Agreement shall be in writing and
     shall be deemed to have been duly given when personally delivered or sent
     by UPS Next Day Air Letter, or via United States Postal Service express
     mail in the event of a UPS work stoppage, addressed as follows:  If to UPS,
     United Parcel Service, 55 Glenlake Parkway, NE, Atlanta, Georgia 30328,
     Attention:  Raymond Vorbeck, and if to TI, TeleTech Holdings, Inc., 1700
     Lincoln Street, Denver, Colorado 80203-4514, Attention:  Kenneth Tuchman,
     President.  Either party may change its address, or the name or title of
     the individual to whom notices shall be directed by written notice issued
     and delivered as set forth above.

SECTION 48 - FIRST RIGHT OF REFUSAL

     If, during this Agreement, UPS decides to open an eighth domestic call
     center for the express purpose of customer service, customer care,
     teleservicing or the like, it shall award TI the contract for the
     management of such center       **

- ----------------
*    Omitted portion is subject to a confidential treatment request and has been
     filed separately with the Securities and Exchange Commission.

- ----------------
                                       28

<PAGE>

SECTION 49 - GENERAL PROVISIONS

     A.   This Agreement sets forth the entire understanding of the parties
          hereto and supersedes all prior oral and written agreements between
          the parties relative to the subject matter hereof and merges all prior
          and contemporaneous discussions between them.  Neither party shall be
          bound by any condition, representation, warranty, covenant or
          provision other than as expressly stated in or contemplated by this
          Agreement unless hereafter set forth in a written instrument executed
          by such party.  The parties to this Agreement may, by mutual written
          consent executed by them, amend, modify or supplement this Agreement.


     B.   The terms, covenants, representations and warranties of this Agreement
          may be waived only by a written instrument executed by the party
          waiving compliance.  The failure of either party at any time to
          require performance of any provision hereof shall, in no manner,
          affect the right at a later date to enforce the same.  No waiver by
          either party of any breach of any term, covenant, representation or
          warranty contained in this Agreement, whether by conduct or otherwise,
          in any one or more instances, shall be deemed to be or construed as a
          further or continuing waiver of any such breach or the breach of any
          other term, covenant, representation or warranty of this Agreement.

     C.   This Agreement shall be binding upon and inure to the benefit of the
          parties hereto and their respective successors and assigns.  The
          duties and obligations under this Agreement may not be assigned or
          delegated by either party without the written consent thereto of the
          other party, except that UPS may assign this Agreement to one of its
          Affiliated Companies.  Any assignment in contradiction of this clause
          shall be void.

     D.   In the event that there is a change of control in the ownership of TI,
          TI will provide UPS with at least      *      prior written notice and
          all information regarding said change (with appropriate
          confidentiality restrictions, as applicable) as may be reasonably
          requested by UPS.  UPS shall have the option to terminate this
          Agreement without penalty upon ninety days prior written notice if
          *     .

     E.   In the event that any one or more of the provisions contained in this
          Agreement shall for any reason be held to be invalid, illegal or
          unenforceable in any respect, such invalidity, illegality or
          unenforceability shall not affect any other provision of this
          Agreement, but this Agreement shall be construed as if such invalid,
          illegal or unenforceable provision had never been contained herein.
          Further, in the event that any provision of this Agreement shall be
          held to be invalid, illegal or unenforceable


**   Omitted portion is subject to a confidential treatment request and has been
     filed separately with the Securities and Exchange Commission.

                                       29

<PAGE>


          by virtue of its scope or period of time, but may be made enforceable
          by a limitation thereof, such provision shall be deemed to be amended
          to the minimum extent necessary to render it valid, legal and
          enforceable.


     F.   The Agreement may be executed in any number of counterparts, and each
          counterpart shall constitute an original instrument, but all such
          separate counterparts shall constitute one and the same agreement.

     G.   This Agreement shall be construed in accordance with the laws of the
          State of Georgia.

     H.   Both parties shall keep the existence and the terms of this Agreement
          confidential in accordance with Section 20, above.

     I.   Any terms hereunder that, by their very nature, would survive the
          termination or expiration of this Agreement shall so survive.

                                       30

<PAGE>

IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the parties hereto have executed this Agreement as of
the date first written above.

TELETECH HOLDINGS, INC.              UNITED PARCEL SERVICE GENERAL SERVICES CO.


By:  /s/ Kenneth Tuchman                          By:  /s/ John Alden
     -------------------                               --------------
     Kenneth D. Tuchman                                John Alden

Its:  President and Chief Executive Officer       Its:  Vice President


                                       31



<PAGE>


                                                                   EXHIBIT 10.17
                                MASTER LEASE AGREEMENT
LESSEE:

        Tele Tech Telecommunications, Inc., a California corporation
        ---------------------------------------------------------------------
        Name
        2130 N. Hollywood Way
        ---------------------------------------------------------------------
        Address
        Burbank,                            CA             91504
        ---------------------------------------------------------------------
        City                 County         State          Zip Code

        Teletech Teleservices, Inc., a Colorado corporation
        Teletech Holdings, Inc., Delaware corporation
        ---------------------------------------------------------------------
        Name
        1700 Lincoln Street, 14th Floor
        ---------------------------------------------------------------------
        Address
        Denver               Denver         CO             80203
        ---------------------------------------------------------------------
        City                 County         State          Zip Code
        Telefax #  303-894-4203
                    ------------

        Tax Identification #   Tele Tech Telecommunications, Inc. 95-3822608
                               ----------------------------------------------
                               Teletech Teleservices, Inc. 84-1218090
                               ----------------------------------------------
                               Teletech Holdings, Inc.   84-1291044
                               ----------------------------------------------

LESSEE'S BUSINESS FORM:        Proprietorship         General Partnership
                        ------                 ------
                           X   Corporations           Limited Partnership
                        ------                 ------
                               Other                  Limited Liability Company
                        ------                 ------

        This Master Lease Agreement ("Master Agreement") dated as of July 11,
1995, establishes the general terms and conditions under which FIRST INTERSTATE
BANK OF CALIFORNIA ("Lessor"), whose address is Equipment Leasing Department,
Regional Corporate Center, 1000 E. Garvey Avenue South, Suite 360, West Covina,
CA  91790, Telefax Number 818-916-1111, may, from time to time, lease equipment
and other personal property to Lessee.  The terms and conditions hereof shall be
deemed to form a part of each Equipment Schedule, the form of which is attached
hereto as Exhibit "A," executed by and between Lessor and Lessee that refers to
this Master Agreement (each a "Schedule" or "Equipment Schedule").  Each
Equipment Schedule shall constitute a separate lease agreement incorporating all
of the terms and conditions hereof. However, in the event of a conflict between
the express provisions of any Equipment Schedule and the terms and conditions of
this Master Agreement, the provisions of the respective Equipment Schedule shall
prevail. Each lease agreement evidenced by an executed Equipment Schedule,
together with all schedules, riders, addenda and/or exhibits that are attached
or refer to that Equipment Schedule, is individually referred to herein as a
"Lease," and all of the Leases are collectively referred to herein as the
"Leases."

        1.       LEASE.  By execution and delivery by Lessee to Lessor of an
Equipment Schedule in substantially the form attached hereto as Exhibit "A," and
upon acceptance thereof by Lessor and satisfaction by Lessee of all conditions
precedent set forth in this Master Agreement and such Equipment Schedule, Lessor
shall lease to Lessee, and Lessee shall hire from Lessor, the personal property
described on that Equipment Schedule, all on and subject to the terms and
conditions set forth therein and herein.  The personal property described in all
of such Equipment Schedules, together with all replacement parts, additions,
modifications, repairs and accessories incorporated therein and/or attached
thereto, is severally and collectively referred to herein as the "Equipment."
No Lease, and no renewals or extensions thereof, shall be cancelable or
terminable by Lessee except as provided in Section 12, below.  Lessee hereby
authorizes and empowers Lessor to unilaterally amend the Leases from time to
time by inserting information more fully identifying the Equipment or any part
thereof and irrevocably constitutes and appoints Lessor its true and lawful
attorney-in-fact for the purpose of executing and filing from time to time in
Lessee's name such financing statements describing the Equipment or any part
thereof as Lessor deems appropriate.


                                          1

<PAGE>

        2.       DELIVERY AND ACCEPTANCE OF EQUIPMENT.  Upon completion of
delivery of each item of Equipment (and, if such item of Equipment requires
installation, installation of such item of Equipment), Lessee will have no more
than 30 days to inspect and test the Equipment and, if the Equipment is in good
order and conforms with any applicable purchase order, Lessee will promptly
accept delivery of the Equipment on behalf of Lessor and shall execute and
deliver to Lessor a duly completed Certificate of Acceptance in form and content
acceptable to Lessor, which shall set forth, among other things, the date that
Lessee accepted delivery of the Equipment on behalf of Lessor and Lessee's
approval of the contract by which Lessor acquired the Equipment or the right to
possession and use of the Equipment (the "Certificate of Acceptance").

        3.       CONDITIONS PRECEDENT.  Nothing in this Master Agreement means
or shall be construed to mean or imply that Lessor has any commitment to enter
into any Lease; Lessor may refuse to do so for any reason or for no reason at
Lessor's sole discretion.  In no event shall Lessor have any obligation to
purchase any personal property and lease the same to Lessee until and unless,
prior to the "Acceptance Deadline" set forth in the applicable Equipment
Schedule, Lessee, at Lessee's cost, shall have satisfied all of the conditions
precedent set forth in the applicable Equipment Schedule and Lessee shall also
have delivered or caused to be delivered to Lessor, each of the following, in
form and substance acceptable to Lessor:

                 (a)      If Lessee or any Guarantor is a corporation,
partnership, trust or other business association, such resolutions or
authorizations and other such documents relating to the existence and good
standing of such corporation, partnership, trust or other business association
and the authority of any person executing this Master Agreement, any Equipment
Schedule and/or any other document, instrument or agreement executed, delivered
or undertaken on behalf of such corporation, partnership, trust or other
business association in connection with this Master Agreement and/or the Leases,
or any of them, as Lessor shall require;

                 (b)      A duly completed and executed Equipment Schedule
evidencing each Lease;

                 (c)      An Assignment of Purchase Order Agreement,  copy of
all sale or purchase contracts regarding the Equipment entered into between
Lessee and the manufacturer or vendor of the Equipment, a copy of all purchase
orders regarding the Equipment issued by the Lessee, the original invoices
regarding the Equipment issued by such manufacturer or vendor to Lessor, and the
original bill of sale, if any, issued by such manufacturer or vendor evidencing
the transfer of title to such Equipment to Lessor;

                 (d)      A duly completed and executed Certificate of
Acceptance regarding the Equipment which evidences, among other things, that
Lessee has approved the contract to acquire the Equipment and accepted delivery
thereof on behalf of Lessor on or prior to the "Acceptance Deadline" set forth
in the Equipment Schedule applicable thereto or such later date as is otherwise
agreed to in writing by Lessor;

                 (e)      Evidence of due compliance with the insurance
provisions of Section 11 hereof;


                 (f)      Duly executed and completed UCC-1 Financing
Statement(s) that describe the Equipment;

                 (g)      Such other documents and instruments as Lessor shall
in its reasonable discretion require, which may include, but shall not be
limited to, a Continuing Payment Guaranty or an opinion of legal counsel to
Lessee acceptable to Lessor as to such matters as Lessor shall require.

        If Lessee shall fail or refuse to satisfy all of the conditions
precedent set forth herein and in the applicable Equipment Schedule on or prior
to the "Acceptance Deadline" set forth in such applicable Equipment Schedule or
such later date as is otherwise agreed to in writing by Lessor, then (a) Lessor
may, at its option, terminate the Lease evidenced by such Equipment Schedule;
and (b) if the respective Lease is terminated by Lessor, then, without further
act (i) Lessee will thereupon be assigned all rights and shall assume all
obligations as purchaser of such Equipment and shall indemnify and hold Lessor
harmless from and against any and all claims of the manufacturer, vendor,
transporter or any other person in connection with the purchase, delivery and
failure or refusal to accept such Equipment; (ii) Lessee shall have all rights
as the purchaser of such Equipment and be


                                          2

<PAGE>

entitled to pursue any and all remedies that may be available against the
manufacturer, vendor, transporter or any other person for any failure or breach
in connection with the manufacture, shipment and delivery of the Equipment and
Lessor shall provide Lessee with any and all documentation, evidence and any
other reasonably requested information regarding the equipment; and (iii) if
Lessee shall fail or refuse to accept delivery of the Equipment even though such
Equipment is in good order and in conformance with any applicable purchase
order, Lessee shall be liable to Lessor for, and shall indemnify Lessor against,
all direct and consequential damages and/or costs incurred by Lessor in
connection with such failure or refusal.

        4.       TERM AND RENT.  The term of each Lease, and the respective
rental amounts and payment dates, are set forth in the respective Equipment
Schedules.  A late charge equal to the lesser of five percent (5%) of the
installment or the maximum amount allowable by law shall be due and payable
immediately without notice for each installment of rent not paid when due and
payable.

        5.       OWNERSHIP; PRECAUTIONARY GRANT OF SECURITY INTEREST.  It is
the intention of the parties hereto that the Equipment is and shall remain the
sole and exclusive property of Lessor, and Lessee shall have no right, title or
interest therein except the interest of Lessee arising under the Leases.  With
respect to replacement parts, additions, modifications, repairs and accessories
hereafter incorporated in and/or attached to the Equipment, title thereto shall
pass to Lessor without compensation upon such incorporation or attachment to the
Equipment.  The Equipment is and shall at all times be and remain personal
property, notwithstanding, if applicable, that the Equipment or any part thereof
may now be or hereafter become in any manner affixed or attached to or imbedded
in, or permanently resting upon, real property or any building thereon, or
attached in any manner to what is permanent by means of cement, plaster, nails,
bolts, screws, or otherwise.  Should, however, any Lease constitute a lease
intended as security within the meaning of the Colorado Uniform Commercial Code,
the Lessee does hereby grant to Lessor a security interest in all of its right,
title and interest in, to and arising under such Lease, the Equipment described
therein and the proceeds of both to secure the payment and performance by Lessee
of all of its liabilities and obligations arising under all of the Leases, and
Lessor shall have all of the rights and remedies of a secured party under
applicable law in addition to all of its rights and remedies under the terms and
conditions hereof and of the Leases.   Lessee agrees to execute and file Uniform
Commercial Code Financing Statements and any and all other instruments necessary
to perfect Lessor's interest in this Master Agreement, the Lease, and the
payments due thereunder.

        6.       REPRESENTATIONS, WARRANTIES AND COVENANTS OF LESSEE.  Lessee
represents, warrants and covenants to Lessor as follows:

                 (a)      If Lessee is a corporation, partnership, trust or
other business association, Lessee is, and throughout the terms of the Leases
shall remain, duly organized, validly existing and in good standing under the
laws of the state of its organization and qualified to do business and in good
standing in the States of California, Colorado and Delaware and in each other
state in which the failure to be so qualified and in good standing would have a
material adverse effect on the financial condition, operations or business of
the Lessee;

                 (b)      Lessee is fully authorized and permitted to enter
into this Master Agreement and all of the Leases entered into from time to time
and to execute any and all documentation required herein and therein, to lease
the Equipment upon the terms set forth herein and in the Leases and to perform
the terms of this Master Agreement, the Leases and all other documents executed
in connection therewith, none of which conflicts with any provision of law,
regulation, ordinances, or orders of public authorities applicable to Lessee;
this Master Agreement and the Leases, and all other documents executed or
delivered in connection therewith (including, without limitation, any guarantee
of the Leases), are, and throughout the terms of the Leases shall remain, valid
and binding legal obligations of Lessee or any guarantor of the Leases or any
Lease, as applicable, and each is and shall remain enforceable in accordance
with its terms;

                 (c)      The execution, delivery and performance by Lessee of
this Master Agreement and all of the Leases entered into from time to time, and
all other documents relating to this Master Agreement and the Leases (or any of
them), will not result in any breach of the terms or conditions of, or
constitute a default under Lessee's bylaws or articles of incorporation or any
agreement or instrument under which Lessee or any such


                                          3

<PAGE>

guarantor is a party or is obligated; Lessee is not in default in the
performance or observance of any obligations, covenants or conditions of any
such agreement or instrument;

                 (d)      No actions, suits or proceedings are pending or
threatened against Lessee or any such guarantor that might materially and
adversely affect the payment by Lessee or any such guarantor of the rental
payments under the Leases, the performance by Lessee or any such guarantor of
its other obligations arising under this Master Agreement, the Leases or any
documents executed in connection therewith or the financial condition, business
or operations of Lessee or any such guarantor;

                 (e)      All financial statements, profit and loss statements,
statements as to ownership, federal, state and local tax returns and other
statements or reports previously or at any time hereafter given to Lessor by or
on behalf of Lessee or any such guarantor are and shall be true, complete and
correct as of the date thereof and do and shall fairly present Lessee's
financial condition as of the date thereof; there has been no material adverse
change in the financial condition or the results of the operations of Lessee or
any such guarantor since the date of the latest financial statements of Lessee
or any such guarantor given to Lessor;

                 (f)      The Equipment will be used solely for commercial or
business purposes and NOT for personal, family or household purposes;

                 (g)      Lessee has no contingent or disputed liabilities or
unrealized or anticipated losses which in the aggregate are material or any
material commitments of an unusual or burdensome character;

                 (h)      Lessee shall not permit any pension plan maintained
by it to (i) engage in any "prohibited transaction" as such term is defined in
Section 4975 of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended, (ii) incur any
"accumulated funding deficiency" as such term is defined in Section 302 of
ERISA, or (iii) terminate any such plan in a manner which could result in the
imposition of a lien on the property of Lessee pursuant to Section 4068 or
ERISA;

                 (i)      In addition to notices required herein, Lessee shall
immediately give notice in writing to Lessor of (i) the occurrence of an Event
of Default, or any condition, event or act which with the giving of notice,
failure to cure or the passage of time or all the foregoing would constitute
such an Event of Default; and (ii) any change in the name or business of Lessee,
any change in its form, management or organizational structure and any change in
Lessee's address of principal location(s) of business or location of the
Equipment;

                 (j)      None of the financial statements or any certificate,
document or statement furnished to Lessor (or to be furnished to Lessor) by or
on behalf of Lessee in connection with any Lease, and none of the
representations and warranties in this Master Agreement, contains (or will
contain) any untrue statement of a material fact necessary in order to make the
statements contained therein or herein not misleading.  There is no fact which
materially adversely affects or in the future (so far as Lessee can now foresee)
may materially adversely affect the ability of Lessee to perform its obligations
which has not been set forth herein or in a certificate or opinion of counsel or
other written statement furnished to Lessor by or on behalf of Lessee.  There
has been no material adverse change in the creditworthiness or condition of
Lessee, financial or otherwise, or affairs of Lessee since the date of the most
recent financial statements given to Lessor with respect to Lessee;

                 (k)      Lessee is not subject to, or if subject to, is in
compliance with all federal, state and local laws, ordinance or regulation
relating to industrial hygiene or environmental conditions including but not
limited to the Resource Conservation and Recovery Act or the Comprehensive
Environmental Response, Compensation and Liability Act of 1980 as amended;

                 (l)      Lessee shall defend Lessor's title against, and keep
the Equipment free of, all levies, liens, claims and encumbrances of every kind
and description, and however and whenever arising, except those (if any) which
Lessor has created or to which Lessor has consented in writing.  At Lessor's
option, Lessee shall provide and affix to the Equipment, at Lessee's expense,
labels or other physical attachments satisfactory to Lessor clearly disclosing
Lessor's ownership interest in the Equipment.  Lessee shall not allow the
Equipment or any part thereof to become a fixture with respect to real property;


                                          4

<PAGE>

                 (m)      Lessee agrees that unless Lessor agrees otherwise in
writing, Lessee shall comply with all terms and covenants (financial or
otherwise) of that certain Loan Agreement dated April 12, 1995, between Lessee
and Lessor, as subsequently amended, whether or not any amounts remain
outstanding under such Loan Agreement or such Loan Agreement has been
terminated.

        Lessee shall be deemed to have made all of the foregoing
representations and warranties as of the date each respective Equipment Schedule
is executed and delivered by Lessee and also as of the "Commencement Date" of
each Lease evidenced thereby (as defined therein).

        7.       NO WARRANTIES BY LESSOR; MAINTENANCE; COMPLIANCE WITH LAWS.
LESSEE ACKNOWLEDGES THAT IT HAS SELECTED THE EQUIPMENT WITHOUT ANY ASSISTANCE
FROM LESSOR, ITS AGENTS OR EMPLOYEES. LESSEE ACKNOWLEDGES THAT LESSOR, NOT BEING
THE MANUFACTURER OR VENDOR OF THE EQUIPMENT, NOR MANUFACTURER'S OR VENDOR'S
AGENT, AND HAVING NO FAMILIARITY WITH THE EQUIPMENT WHATSOEVER, MAKES NO
WARRANTY OR REPRESENTATION, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, AS TO THE FITNESS FOR A
PARTICULAR PURPOSE, USE, VALUE, QUALITY, DESIGN, CONDITION, CAPACITY,
SUITABILITY, MERCHANTABILITY OR PERFORMANCE OF THE EQUIPMENT OR OF THE MATERIAL
OR WORKMANSHIP THEREOF OR THAT THE EQUIPMENT IS FREE OF ANY RIGHTFUL CLAIM OF
ANY THIRD PERSON BY WAY OF INFRINGEMENT OR INTERFERENCE OR THE LIKE.  IT IS
AGREED THAT LESSOR LEASES AND LESSEE HIRES THE EQUIPMENT "AS IS" AND THAT ALL
SUCH RISKS, AS BETWEEN THE LESSOR AND THE LESSEE, INCIDENT THERETO ARE TO BE
BORNE BY THE LESSEE AS ITS SOLE RISK AND EXPENSE.  LESSEE AGREES NOT TO ASSERT
ANY CLAIM WHATSOEVER AGAINST THE LESSOR BASED THEREON, INCLUDING, WITHOUT
LIMITATION, CLAIMS BASED ON ANY BREACH OF VENDOR'S OR MANUFACTURER'S WARRANTIES
OR ANY MALFUNCTIONING OF OR DEFECT OR DEFICIENCY IN THE EQUIPMENT OR PATENT
INFRINGEMENT OR SIMILAR CLAIMS OR LESSEE'S DISSATISFACTION WITH THE EQUIPMENT.
LESSEE FURTHER AGREES NOT TO ASSERT ANY CLAIM WHATSOEVER AGAINST THE LESSOR FOR
LOSS OF ANTICIPATORY PROFITS OR OTHER CONSEQUENTIAL OR INCIDENTAL  DAMAGES.
LESSOR SHALL NOT AT ANY TIME BE REQUIRED TO INSPECT THE EQUIPMENT OR ANY PART
THEREOF NOR SHALL ANY INSPECTION BY LESSOR BE DEEMED TO AFFECT OR MODIFY THE
PROVISIONS OF THIS SECTION 7.

        No oral agreement, guaranty, promise, condition, representation or
warranty to the contrary shall be binding; all prior conversations, agreements
or representations related hereto, to the Leases and/or to the Equipment are
integrated herein. Lessor makes no warranty whatsoever regarding the
characterization of the Leases, or any of them, for tax, accounting or other
purposes.

        Lessor shall have no obligation to install, erect, test, adjust or
service the Equipment.  Lessee agrees, unless otherwise expressly agreed to by
Lessor in writing, at Lessee's own cost and expense: (i) to pay all shipping
charges and other expenses incurred in connection with the shipment of the
Equipment by the seller thereof to Lessee; (ii) to pay all charges and expenses
in connection with the installation, deinstallation, use, operation and
maintenance of each item of Equipment; (iii) to comply with the Equipment
manufacturer's operating procedures, with all insurance and warranty
requirements, and with all governmental laws, ordinances, regulations,
requirements and rules with respect to the use, maintenance and operation of
each item of Equipment; (iv) to make all repairs and replacements required to be
made to maintain the Equipment in good condition and repair, reasonable wear and
tear excepted; and (v) to make no alterations in or to, and to affix no
attachments, accessories or additions to, the Equipment without Lessor's prior
written consent.  The Equipment shall not be used by unqualified operators nor
for purposes other than those for which it has been designed, nor shall it be
serviced or repaired by persons not authorized to do so by the manufacturer
thereof, if such authorized persons are reasonably available.  Lessor hereby
assigns to Lessee, without recourse for the term of each Lease, all
manufacturer's warranties and guaranties, express or implied, pertinent to the
Equipment, subject to Lessee's obligations to reassign to Lessor all such
warranties and guaranties upon Lessor's repossession of the Equipment.

        8.       NET LEASE.  It is understood and agreed that each Lease is a
net lease, and that, as between Lessor and Lessee, Lessee shall be responsible
for all costs and expenses of every nature whatsoever arising out of or in
connection with or related to each Lease and/or the Equipment.  Lessee's
obligation to pay all rental and other payments hereunder and under the Leases
shall be absolute and unconditional and shall not be affected by any
circumstances whatsoever, including, without limitation (i) any setoff,
counterclaim, recoupment, defense or


                                          5

<PAGE>

other right which Lessee may have against Lessor or any other person for any
reason whatsoever, (ii) any defect in the title, condition, design, operation or
fitness for use of, or any damage to or loss or destruction of, the Equipment,
or any interruption or cessation in the use or possession thereof by Lessee for
any reason whatsoever, or (iii) any other circumstance, happening or event
whatsoever, whether or not similar to the foregoing.  If for any reason
whatsoever this Master Agreement or any of the Leases shall be terminated in
whole or in part by operation of law or for any other reason whatsoever, except
as specifically provided herein or therein, or except as otherwise expressly
agreed to by Lessor in writing, Lessee nonetheless agrees, to the extent now or
then permitted by applicable laws, to pay to Lessor an amount equal to each
rental payment under such Leases and all other sums due thereunder and hereunder
at the time such payment would have become due and payable in accordance with
the terms hereof and thereof had this Master Agreement and such Leases not been
terminated in whole or in part.  Lessee hereby waives, and hereby agrees to
waive at any further time at the request of Lessor, to the extent now or then
permitted by applicable laws, any and all rights which it may now or hereafter
have or which at any time hereafter may be conferred upon it, by statute or
otherwise, to terminate, cancel, quit or surrender this Master Agreement or any
Lease except in accordance of the express terms of Section 12 hereof.

        9.       INDEMNITY.  Lessee shall indemnify Lessor against, and hold
Lessor harmless from, any and all claims, actions, suits, proceedings, costs,
expenses, damages and liabilities, at law or in equity of whatsoever kind and
nature, other than those relating to Lessor's negligent or wrongful acts or
omissions in contract or tort, including attorneys' fees, arising out of,
relating to, connected with, or resulting from this Master Lease or the
Equipment, including without limitation the manufacture, selection, purchase,
delivery, acceptance (or lack thereof), possession, condition, use, operation or
return thereof.  Specifically, without limiting the foregoing, Lessee shall
indemnify and hold Lessor harmless against all claims of trademark, patent and
copyright infringement, and of the wrongful use of trade secrets or proprietary
information in any form, against all claims for property damage, personal injury
or wrongful death, and against all claims that the Equipment or any part thereof
is or has become a fixture with respect to any real property.  Lessee's
obligations hereunder will survive the expiration of this Master Lease with
respect to events occurring or alleged to have occurred prior to the return of
the Equipment to Lessor at the end of the term of the applicable Lease.

        10.      FINANCIAL REPORTING REQUIREMENTS.  Lessee shall maintain, and
shall cause each guarantor of the Leases to maintain, a standard, modern system
of accounting that reflects the application of generally accepted accounting
principles consistently applied.  Lessee shall furnish to Lessor, and shall
cause each Guarantor of the Leases or any obligation thereunder to furnish to
Lessor, within one hundred twenty (120) days of the close of each Lessee fiscal
year, Lessee's and Guarantor's audited financial statements, balance sheet and
profit and loss statements.  Within sixty (60) days of the end of each Lessee
fiscal quarter, Lessee shall furnish to Lessor Lessee's quarterly financial
statements.  Lessee shall furnish Lessor such additional financial information,
including but not limited to statements as to ownership and federal, state and
local tax returns from time to time specified by Lessor in such form and with
such certifications as Lessor may require.

        11.      INSURANCE.  Throughout the terms of the Leases, and any
renewals or extensions thereof, and until the Lessor has received possession of
the Equipment upon its return to Lessor, Lessee, at its expense, shall (i) keep
the Equipment insured against loss, damage, fire and theft, with extended or
combined additional coverage, in such amounts as Lessor from time to time
reasonably may specify, (ii) maintain liability insurance in amounts
satisfactory to Lessor concerning any property damage, personal injury or
fatality that may result from the possession, use or operation of the Equipment,
and (iii) keep the Equipment insured against such other risks in such amounts as
Lessor from time to time reasonably may specify.  Such casualty insurance shall
name Lessor as loss payee and all such other insurance policies shall name
Lessor as an additional insured.  Lessee shall on reasonable request of Lessor
deliver to Lessor the policies or other evidence of such insurance reasonably
satisfactory to Lessor, with a standard (non-attribution) long form endorsement
attached thereto or indicated therein, showing loss proceeds, if any, payable
directly to Lessor, all in form satisfactory to Lessor, together with receipts
for the paid premiums thereunder.  The loss proceeds of such insurance shall be
paid directly to Lessor and such proceeds, less any costs and expenses incurred
or paid by Lessor in the collection thereof, shall be applied at the election of
Lessor either toward repair or replacement of the Equipment damaged, destroyed,
lost or stolen or to payment of any rental payment or other amount payable by
Lessee hereunder or under the Leases (including but not limited to any "Casualty
Payment," as defined below), whether or not then due.


                                          6

<PAGE>

        Lessee shall cause all insurance policies required under the terms of
this Section to (i) provide that no cancellation, change, lapse or expiration
thereof shall be effective as to Lessor for 10 days after receipt by Lessor of
written notice thereof; (ii) provide that the insurers shall hold harmless and
waive any rights of subrogation against Lessor; (iii) be primary without right
of contribution from any other insurance which is carried by Lessor; (iv) waive
any rights of setoff, counterclaim or other deduction against Lessor;
(v) provide that Lessor shall have no obligation or liability for premiums,
commissions, assessments or calls in connection with such insurance; and
(vi) provide that such policies will not be invalidated by any act or omission
of Lessee or any other additional insured, and shall insure Lessor and its
assigns, regardless of any breach or violation of any warranty, declaration,
condition or covenant contained in such policies by Lessee or any other
additional insured.

        12.      LOSS, DAMAGE OR DESTRUCTION OF EQUIPMENT.  Lessee shall bear
all risk of damage, destruction, loss of possession or theft of the Equipment or
any part thereof, and no such event shall cause any abatement or release
whatsoever in Lessee's liability to pay rent or to perform other covenants as
provided herein and in the Leases.  In the event that any Equipment is lost,
stolen, condemned by any governmental authority, totally destroyed, damaged
beyond repair or permanently rendered unfit for use (each an "Event of Loss"),
then Lessee shall promptly notify Lessor of the occurrence of such Event of Loss
and shall pay or cause to be paid to Lessor, not later than the earlier to occur
of (a) the date that is 120  days subsequent to the date such Event of Loss
occurred and (b) the date of receipt of insurance proceeds in respect of such
Event of Loss, a "Casualty Payment" (defined below) in respect of the Equipment
as to which there has occurred such Event of Loss.  In addition, Lessee shall
continue to pay all rental payments that become due and payable on such
Equipment after the date that such Event of Loss has occurred and prior to the
date that the Casualty Payment thereon is actually received by Lessor.  If
Lessee shall have timely paid all such rental payments on such Equipment, all
rental payments thereon that became due and payable prior to the date such Event
of Loss occurred, and the Casualty Payment that is due and payable with respect
thereto, then the liability of the Lessee to pay rent for such Equipment shall
be discharged.  For purposes of this Master Agreement and each Lease, "Casualty
Payment" means, with respect to any item of Equipment as to which an Event of
Loss has occurred, a payment in an amount equal to the "Stipulated Loss Value"
(defined below) of such Equipment determined as of the date such Casualty
Payment is due and payable less the net amount of recovery, if any, actually
received by Lessor on or prior to the date such Casualty Payment is due and
payable from insurance or otherwise in respect of such Event of Loss.

        13.      STIPULATED LOSS VALUE; SCHEDULE OF STIPULATED LOSS
PERCENTAGES. A "Schedule of Stipulated Loss Percentages" is attached to or
referred to in each Equipment Schedule.  For purposes of this Master Agreement
and each Lease, the term "Stipulated Loss Value" means, with respect to any item
of Equipment,  that amount equal to:  (i) the amount obtained by multiplying the
"Stipulated Loss Percentage" (defined below) of such item of Equipment times the
original cost thereof, as such original cost is set forth in the Equipment
Schedule pursuant to which such item of Equipment is leased, or if not set forth
therein, as reasonably determined by Lessor, less (ii) the aggregate amount of
prepayments of rent otherwise due and payable at the end of the Lease term, if
any are required under the applicable Equipment Schedule.  For purposes of this
Master Agreement and each Lease, the term "Stipulated Loss Percentage" means,
with respect to any item of Equipment, the percentage set forth in the Schedule
of Stipulated Loss Percentages attached to or referred to in the Equipment
Schedule that corresponds to the "Basic Rent Payment Date" (defined in such
Equipment Schedule) through which rental payments on such Equipment have
actually been paid (exclusive of prepayments of rent otherwise due and payable
at the end of the Lease term, if any such are required under the respective
Equipment Schedule) as of the date that the Stipulated Loss Value of such item
of Equipment is determined.  Under no circumstances shall the specification of
Stipulated Loss Values be construed, whether alone or in conjunction with any
other provisions hereof or of any Lease, to grant Lessee any right to purchase
the Equipment for the amount of any such Stipulated Loss Value.

        14.      TAXES.  Lessee shall pay all license fees, registration fees,
assessments, and sales, use, property, excise, and other taxes now or hereafter
imposed by any federal, state or local government on or against the Equipment
based on the ownership, lease, rental, sale, possession or use of the Equipment,
whether the charge is assessed against Lessor or Lessee, as well as any related
penalties or interest, unless such taxes, penalties or interest are due to
Lessor's failure for whatever reason, to notify Lessee of assessments charged
against Lessor, excluding, however, any tax or payment in lieu of tax imposed on
or measured by Lessor's net income, and Lessee will make all reasonable efforts
to do everything required of Lessor in connection with said


                                          7

<PAGE>

fees, assessments and taxes.  All billings and other notices regarding such
fees, assessments and taxes shall, at Lessor's option, be either in the name of
the Lessor and addressed to the Lessor, or in the name of the Lessee and in care
of the Lessor.  From time to time, when Lessor requests, Lessee shall provide
written proof of payment of all obligations mentioned in this section.  Personal
property and any other tax returns for the Equipment shall be filed by the
Lessor, either in the name of the Lessee or the Lessor, as determined by Lessor.
Lessee hereby agrees that Lessor shall have no duty or obligation whatsoever to
contest any license fees, registration fees, assessments, or sales, use, excise,
property or other taxes now or hereafter imposed by any federal, state or local
government on or against the Equipment based on the ownership, lease, rental,
sale, possession or use of the Equipment.  Lessee shall have the right to
contest in good faith by appropriate proceedings maintained in its own name or
in the name of Lessor any such personal property taxes if Lessee promptly
notifies Lessor in writing of the commencement of any such contest proceedings
and thereafter promptly responds in writing in an accurate and complete manner
to any inquiries that Lessor may have with respect thereto, PROVIDED, that
Lessee shall continue to have the right to contest such personal property taxes
only so long as such contest proceedings do not result in any enforcement,
collection, foreclosure or forfeiture proceeding, or any levy or execution,
which remains unstayed or unbonded for a period of 5 consecutive business days.
Lessee shall not have the right to contest any other fees, assessments or taxes
payable by Lessee hereunder without the prior written consent of Lessor.  It is
also expressly agreed that Lessee will obtain prior written permission from
Lessor before it asserts on either its or Lessor's behalf any tax immunity based
on Lessor's status as a national banking association.  This Section is not
intended to, and does not, transfer incidents of ownership from Lessor to
Lessee.

        15.      LESSEE'S FAILURE TO PAY TAXES, INSURANCE, ETC.  If Lessee
fails to make any payment or to do any act required hereunder or under any
Lease, then Lessor shall have the right, but not the obligation, to make the
payment or do the act, with notice to or demand on Lessee, and without releasing
Lessee from any contract obligation, and to pay, purchase, contest or compromise
any encumbrance, charge or lien which Lessor reasonably judges to affect the
Equipment or Lessor's rights therein.  In exercising such right, Lessor may
incur any reasonable liability and expend any amount which in its discretion it
deems reasonably necessary.  All sums Lessor so incurs or spends shall be,
immediately due and payable by Lessee to Lessor 30 days after written demand
therefore, and shall bear interest from the date so incurred or spent, whichever
is earlier, until paid in full to Lessor at the rate of 10.0% per annum.

        16.      TAX INDEMNITY.  The provisions of this Section 16 shall be
applicable only to Equipment for which Lessee is not granted any purchase option
or for which Lessee is granted only a Fair Market Value purchase option
(severally and collectively, the "Tax Indemnity Equipment").  The rental for Tax
Indemnity Equipment is determined by Lessor on the basis that Lessor and/or any
person to which Lessor assigns ownership to all or any portion of the Tax
Indemnity Equipment (for purposes of this Section 16, the "Owner") shall be
entitled to the federal and state income tax deductions, credits and other
benefits with respect thereto as are generally provided to an owner of rental
property (the "Tax Benefits"), including, without limitation, (i) accelerated
cost recovery or depreciation deductions on the Tax Indemnity Equipment under
the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended from time to time (the "Code"),
and under equivalent state income tax laws, based upon such depreciable lives,
averaging conventions, methods of depreciation and other methods as the Owner
elects for income tax purposes; (ii) the deduction under Section 163 of the Code
in the full amount of any interest paid or accrued by the Owner in accordance
with the Owner's method of accounting for tax purposes with respect to any
indebtedness incurred by the Owner in financing its purchase of the Equipment
and (iii) the timing and the amount of the income inclusion assumed by Owner for
the rent payable under Leases of Tax Indemnity Equipment.  (As used herein, the
term "Owner" includes Lessor to the extent Lessor has not assigned ownership to
the Tax Indemnity Equipment.)  If as a result of any act or failure to act of
Lessee or any other user of any Tax Indemnity Equipment (including but not
limited to any Event of Default, as defined below), the tax status of Lessee or
any such user, the location in which any Tax Indemnity Equipment is used, the
occurrence of any Event of Loss with respect to any Tax Indemnity Equipment, or
any modification or repair of any Tax Indemnity Equipment, (a) Owner shall lose,
have recaptured or disallowed or, in the good faith opinion of Owner, not be
entitled to the full use of the Tax Benefits or such Tax Benefits are delayed or
deferred, or (b) Owner shall have its federal or state income taxes increased or
accelerated on account of any recomputation, recapture or delay in the receipt
of such Tax Benefits in any year or years pursuant to the provisions of the Code
or equivalent state tax laws (including but not limited to any Event of Default,
as defined below), or (c) if Owner shall be obligated to include in income
during the term of any Lease of Tax Indemnity Equipment any amount other than
rent or (if applicable) a Casualty Payment, a payment


                                          8

<PAGE>

of liquidated damages pursuant to Subsection 23(g)(ii) hereof or a purchase
option payment or if Owner shall be required to include any such payments of
rent, Casualty Payment, liquidated damages or purchase option payment in income
earlier than the tax period in which such payments are actually received by
Lessor (each of the events referred to in (a), (b) and (c) above being referred
to as a "Tax Loss"), then Lessee shall pay to the Owner, upon demand, a lump sum
amount which, after deduction therefrom for all federal, state and local income
taxes payable by the Owner with respect to the receipt of such sum, shall be
sufficient under the federal and state tax laws then in effect to restore the
Owner to substantially the same after-tax economic position the Owner would have
been in had such Tax Loss not been incurred, after taking into account:  (i) the
amount of the Tax Benefits so lost, recaptured, delayed, disallowed, recomputed
or not so utilized for the current tax period and which are likely to be
similarly affected in future periods, (ii) the increase or acceleration in the
Owner's tax on account thereof (determined without regard to any losses or
deductions attributable to other Owners transactions), (iii) penalties, interest
or other charges imposed upon Owner, (iv) differences in tax years involved, and
(v) the present value of the any Tax Benefits Owner more likely than not can
expect to derive solely as a result of such Tax Loss.  Owner's good faith
determination of the amount of such indemnity payment shall be binding upon
Owner and Lessee.  Owner shall have no obligation to contest any Tax Loss.  The
provisions of this Section 16 shall survive the expiration or earlier
termination of any Lease of Tax Indemnity Equipment.  The obligation of Lessee
to make an indemnity payment on account of a Tax Loss shall occur upon the
earliest of (1) the happening of any event which may reasonably be expected to
result in such Tax Loss, in the good faith opinion of Owner, (2) the payment by
Owner to the Internal Revenue Service or any state tax authority of any tax
increase directly or indirectly arising from such Tax Loss, or (3) the
adjustment of any Owner  tax return that reflects such Tax Loss.  Lessee shall
not report or claim any of the Tax Benefits or otherwise adopt a tax filing
position inconsistent with Owner's full entitlement to the Tax Benefits.

        17.      LOCATION.  Lessee will not, without written  notice to Lessor
specifying a new location, permit the Equipment or any part thereof to be
removed from the location shown in (a) the respective Equipment Schedule
pursuant to which the Equipment is leased or (b) any prior consent.

        18.      INSPECTION AND NOTICE.  Lessor shall have the right to inspect
the Equipment at any time during business hours.  Lessee shall give Lessor
immediate notice of any attachment, garnishment, levy or other judicial process
affecting any of the Equipment and shall advise the Lessor, upon Lessor's
request, of the location of any Equipment.

        19.      ASSIGNMENT BY LESSOR.  Lessor may transfer or assign all or
any part of Lessor's right, title and interest in, under or to the Equipment, or
any portion thereof, and/or any Lease, and any or all sums due or to become due
pursuant to any such assigned Lease, for any reason to any third party (the
"Assignee").  Assignee may re-assign and transfer and such transferee shall also
be referred to as the "Assignee".  Lessee agrees that upon receipt of written
notice from Lessor of such assignment, together with a copy of a written
agreement duly executed by Lessor evidencing any such assignment, Lessee shall
perform all of its obligations relating to such assigned Lease for the benefit
of Assignee and, if so directed in writing, shall pay all sums due or to become
due under such assigned Lease directly to the Assignee or to any other party
designated in writing by the Assignee.  Lessee hereby waives and agrees not to
assert against the Assignee any defense, set-off, recoupment claim or
counterclaim which Lessee has or may at any time have against Lessor for any
reason whatsoever.  For purposes of this Master Agreement, the term "Lessor"
shall include any Assignee.

        Upon receipt of notice of any such assignment, Lessee agrees to execute
and deliver to Lessor, if requested, such documentation as Assignee may
reasonably require.  Lessee and Lessor hereby acknowledge and affirm that the
rights and obligations set forth in the terms and covenants contained in any
assigned Lease shall survive any such assignment.  Nothing contained in such
documentation required by Assignee shall be in derogation of any of the rights
granted to Lessee hereunder or under any such assigned Lease.  No such
assignment shall relieve Lessor of its obligations arising under this Master
Agreement or interfere with Lessee's right to quiet possession of the Equipment
under any assigned Lease.

        20.      RESTRICTIONS ON ASSIGNMENT BY LESSEE.  Except for assignments
to wholly-owned subsidiaries of Lessee (which such assignment shall not relieve
Lessee of its obligations under each Lease to Lessor) Lessee shall not, unless
Lessee shall have obtained the prior written consent from Lessor:  (a) assign,


                                          9

<PAGE>

transfer, pledge, hypothecate or grant or suffer to exist any lien or security
interest in this Master Agreement, any Lease, the Equipment or any part thereof,
or any interest therein, (b) sublet or lend the Equipment or any portion
thereof, or (c) permit the Equipment or any portion thereof to be used by anyone
other than Lessee's employees agents, contractors, subcontractors.

        21.      RETURN OF EQUIPMENT.  Subject to Lessee's purchase option, if
any, set forth in the respective Equipment Schedule, when each Lease expires or
otherwise terminates, in whole or in part, Lessee shall return all (or, at
Lessor's option, any part of) the Equipment leased thereunder to the Lessor in
good repair and condition, excepting ordinary wear and tear resulting from its
proper use, by deinstalling, packaging, and loading such Equipment, at Lessee's
cost, on a carrier specified by Lessor and shipping it, fully insured, at
Lessee's expense, freight prepaid by Lessee, to a site designated by Lessor.

        22.      DEFAULT.  The occurrence of any of the following events or
conditions shall constitute an event of default under all of the Leases (each is
referred to herein as an "Event of Default"):

                 (a)      Lessee shall fail to pay any rental payment required
under any Lease when and as due and payable; or

                 (b)      Lessee shall fail to pay any other sum required to be
paid by Lessee under this Master Agreement or any Lease when and as due and
payable; or

                 (c)      Lessee shall fail to carry and maintain in effect
insurance in accordance with Section 11 hereof; or

                 (d)      After written notice by Lessor to Lessee, Lessee
shall fail to timely perform or observe any other term, covenant or condition of
this Master Agreement, any Lease or any document executed in connection
therewith, and either

                          (i)      such failure cannot be remedied or

                          (ii)     such failure can be remedied, but such
failure continues unremedied for a period of twenty (20) days after it occurs;

                 (e)      The filing by Lessee or any Guarantor (or against
Lessee or any such Guarantor to which Lessee or any such Guarantor acquiesces or
which is not dismissed within  sixty (60) days after the filing thereof) of any
proceeding under the federal bankruptcy laws now or hereafter existing or any
other similar statute now or hereafter in effect; the entry of an order for
relief under such laws with respect to Lessee or any such Guarantor; or the
appointment of a receiver, trustee, custodian or conservator of all or any part
of the property of Lessee or any such Guarantor;

                 (f)      The insolvency of Lessee or any Guarantor; or the
execution by Lessee or any such Guarantor of an assignment for the benefit of
its creditors; or the convening by Lessee or any such Guarantor of a meeting of
its creditors, or any class thereof, for the purpose of effecting a moratorium
upon or extension or composition of its debt; or the failure of Lessee or of any
such Guarantor to pay its debts as they mature; or if Lessee or any such
Guarantor is generally not paying its debts as they mature; or the admission in
writing by Lessee or any such Guarantor that it is unable to pay its debts as
they mature or that it is generally not paying its debts as they mature;

                 (g)      The death or incapacity of Lessee or any Guarantor,
if an individual, or the merger, consolidation, acquisition, liquidation,
termination or dissolution of Lessee or any such Guarantor, if a corporation,
partnership or other business association, or if Lessee or any such Guarantor
shall sell or turn over the management or operation of all or any substantial
portion of its property, assets or business to any other person, corporation,
partnership or other business association;


                                          10

<PAGE>

                 (h)      Lessor's good faith determination in its sole
discretion that the Equipment or any portion thereof is in danger of theft,
conversion, loss, damage or destruction or is to be moved, transported, shipped
or stored without Lessor's prior written consent to or from a location or in a
manner other than in accordance with the provisions of this Master Agreement and
the Leases;

                 (i)      The occurrence of any adverse change in the financial
condition of Lessee or any Guarantor that Lessor, in its reasonable discretion,
deems material.

        23.      REMEDIES.  If any Event of Default shall occur, Lessor, at its
option, without notice or demand on Lessee (except as expressly provided in
subparagraph (g) below), in addition to any and all other remedies available to
Lessor under applicable law, may do any or all of the following:

                 (a)      Terminate all or any of the Leases and/or Lessee's
rights of possession and use of all or any portion of the Equipment under all or
any of the Leases;

                 (b)      Take possession of all or any portion of the
Equipment, wherever located, or render the same unusable;

                 (c)      Require the Lessee to assemble and return all or any
portion of the Equipment to Lessor (as more fully specified in Section 21
hereof);

                 (d)      Retain, hold, sell, lease or otherwise dispose of all
or any portion of the Equipment, in a public or private transaction, without
demand upon or notice to Lessee, and any such sale, lease or other disposition
shall be free and clear of any rights of Lessee;

                 (e)      Use, without cost to Lessor, Lessee's place of
business for the purpose of storing  all or any portion of the Equipment;

                 (f)      Apply the proceeds of any security deposits held in
connection with any of the Leases to payment of rentals thereunder or damages
incurred in connection therewith (any such security deposits are separate and
distinct from any prepayments of rent collected in connection with any Lease);

                 (g)      Recover other and further damages, which shall
include but not be limited to payment by Lessee immediately upon demand of the
following, each bearing interest until paid in full at the rate of 18% per annum
from the earlier of (A) the date such demand is made or (B) the date otherwise
due and payable:

                          (i)      all accrued and unpaid rent payments payable
under all or any of the Leases and all other costs, charges, fees and amounts
payable thereunder or hereunder;

                          (ii)     as liquidated damages for the loss of a
bargain, and not as a penalty, an amount equal to the aggregate Stipulated Loss
Value of all or any portion of the Equipment (after giving effect to the
application of all rent payments actually paid pursuant to subparagraph (g)(i)
of this Section 23), less the sum of:

                                   (A)      the proceeds of any security
deposits applied to payment of Lease rentals or damages incurred in connection
with the Leases (any such security deposits are separate and distinct from any
prepayments of rent collected in connection with any Lease), plus

                                   (B)      either the net proceeds of a public
or private sale or other disposition thereof, or, at Lessor's sole option, the
fair market value thereof as of the date possession of such Equipment is
returned to Lessor, which fair market value shall be determined by Lessor, in
the exercise of its reasonable discretion, and notice thereof given in writing
to Lessee or, if Lessee objects in writing within ten (10) days after receipt of
such written notice from the Lessor, then by a professional, third party
appraiser selected by Lessor, whose determination shall be final and
irrebuttable in the absence of manifest error;


                                          11

<PAGE>

                          (iii)    all of Lessor's reasonable costs and
expenses in connection with Lessee's breach of this Master Agreement, or any
Lease, or the enforcement of this Master Agreement or any Lease (including
reasonable attorneys' fees and expenses), or associated with the repossession,
reconditioning and sale, lease or other disposition of the Equipment; and

                          (iv)     payment of any and all amounts payable by
Lessee under Section 16 hereof.

Lessor's and Lessee's remedies hereinabove specified are cumulative, and may be
exercised by Lessor in any order or manner, as to all of the Leases and
Equipment or only a portion thereof, all as Lessor shall determine in its sole
discretion.  No exercise of any remedy available to Lessor and Lessee shall
constitute any election foreclosing Lessor from the subsequent exercise of any
other remedy.  In furtherance of its remedies, Lessor may and is hereby
irrevocably authorized by Lessee (and Lessee, at its sole cost and expense,
shall cause Lessor to be duly authorized by all necessary parties) to enter
without trespass or liability upon any premises on which the Equipment or any
portion thereof may be located. In the event that Lessor, at its option, shall
give Lessee notice of any proposed sale or other disposition of the Equipment or
any part thereof, Lessee hereby agrees that written notice given to Lessee in
accordance with the terms of this Master Agreement at least ten (10) days prior
to any such sale or other disposition shall be and be deemed to be commercially
reasonable notice.

        24.      OFFSET.  Lessee hereby waives all existing and future claims
and offsets against any rental or other payment that becomes due and payable
hereunder or under the Leases, and agrees that its obligations and liabilities
for the payment of all rental and other payments that become due and payable
hereunder or under the Leases shall be absolute and unconditional.

        25.      NO THIRD PARTY BENEFICIARIES.  This Master Agreement, each
Lease and all other documents executed in connection therewith are for the sole
and exclusive protection and benefit of the Lessor, any Assignees of Lessor, and
the Lessee, and no other person or entity shall have any right of action hereon
or thereon.

        26.      APPLICABLE LAW.  This Master Agreement and the Leases shall be
governed by and construed in accordance with the laws of the State of Colorado
applicable to contracts made and to be performed entirely within that State.

        27.      TIME OF THE ESSENCE.  Time is expressly made of the essence of
this Master Agreement and of the Leases.

        28.      NOTICES.  All notices required or permitted to be given
hereunder or under any Lease shall be in writing and may be given in person
(including express or courier service) or by United States mail, delivery
service or electronic transmission to the telecopier number set forth above. Any
notice directed to a party hereunder or under any Lease shall become effective
upon the earliest of the following:  (i) actual receipt by that party;
(ii) delivery to the address of that party first set forth above (or to such
other address as such party may from time to time designate in writing);
(iii) if given by United States mail, forty-eight (48) hours after deposit with
the United States Postal Service, postage prepaid, addressed to the address of
that party first set forth above (or to such other address as such party may
from time to time designate in writing); or (iv) if sent by electronic
transmission by telecopier, immediately upon transmission.

        29.      HEADINGS.  The headings or captions of Sections in this Master
Agreement are for convenience and reference only, and in no way define, limit or
describe the scope or intent of this Master Agreement or the provisions of such
Sections.

        30.      INTEGRATION AND MODIFICATION.  This Master Agreement,
including all Leases, schedules, and exhibits, executed in connection herewith,
constitute the entire agreement between the parties and may not be contradicted
by evidence of prior, contemporaneous, or subsequent oral agreements of the
parties.  All modifications, consents, amendments or waivers of any provision of
this Master Agreement or any Lease, or consent to any departure by Lessee
therefrom, shall be effective only if the same shall be in writing and signed by
Lessor.


                                          12

<PAGE>

        31.      WAIVER.  No failure to exercise, and no delay in exercising,
on either party's part any right hereunder or under any Lease shall operate as a
waiver thereof, nor shall any single or partial exercise thereof preclude any
other further exercise thereof or the exercise of any other right.  The rights
of both parties hereunder and under the Leases shall be in addition to all other
rights provided at law or equity except that Lessee's obligations shall not be
subject to defense or mitigation unless expressly provided in this Master
Agreement.  No notice or demand given in any case shall constitute a waiver of
the right to take other action in the same, similar or other instances without
such notice or demand.

        32.      ATTORNEY FEES.  In the event of any arbitration proceeding,
action at law or suit in equity in relation to this Master Lease or any
Equipment Schedule, the prevailing party will be entitled to reasonable
attorneys' fees.

        33.      SUSPENSION OF LESSOR'S OBLIGATION.  The obligation of Lessor
hereunder will be suspended (or, at Lessor's option, terminated) to the extent
that Lessor is hindered or prevented from complying therewith because of labor
disturbances, including but not limited to strikes and lockouts, acts of God,
fires, storms, accidents, failure of the manufacturer to deliver any item or
Equipment, governmental regulations or interference or any cause whatsoever not
within the sole and exclusive control of Lessor.

        34.      CHOICE OF FORUM; CONSENT TO PROCESS AND JURISDICTION.  Any
suit, action or proceeding against Lessee with respect to this Master Agreement,
the Equipment (or any portion thereof) and/or any Lease or any judgment entered
by any court in respect thereof, may be brought in the courts of the State of
Colorado, or in the United States District Court for the District of Colorado,
as Lessor in its sole discretion may elect, and Lessee hereby irrevocably
submits to the nonexclusive jurisdiction of such courts for the purpose of any
such suit, action or proceeding.  Lessee hereby irrevocably waives any
objections which it may now or hereafter have to the laying of venue of any
suit, action or proceeding arising out of or relating to this Master Agreement,
the Equipment (or any portion thereof) and/or any Lease brought in the courts
located in the State of Colorado, and hereby further irrevocably waives any
claim that any such suit, action or proceeding brought in any such court has
been brought in an inconvenient forum.

        35.      INVALID PROVISIONS.  If any provision of this Master Agreement
or any Lease is held to be illegal, invalid or unenforceable under present or
future laws during the term hereof or thereof, such provision shall be fully
severable; the document containing such provision shall be construed and
enforced as if such illegal, invalid or unenforceable provision had never
comprised a part of such document; and the remaining provisions of such document
shall remain in full force and effect and shall not be affected by the illegal,
invalid or unenforceable provision or by its severance from such document.
Furthermore, in lieu of each such illegal, invalid or unenforceable provision
there shall be added in writing as part of such document a provision mutually
agreeable to Lessor and Lessee as similar in terms to such illegal, invalid or
unenforceable provision as may be possible and be legal, valid and enforceable.

        36.      FURTHER ASSURANCES.  Lessee hereby agrees, from time to time,
upon the reasonable request of Lessor, to execute and deliver or cause to be
executed and delivered, such further documents and to do such other acts and
things as Lessor may reasonably request in order fully to effect the purposes of
this Master Agreement and the Leases, or any of them.

        37.      ARBITRATION.  Lessor and Lessee agree to bound by the terms of
the Arbitration Program attached hereto as Exhibit "B" and incorporated herein
by this reference, pursuant to which any and all disputes shall be resolved by
mandatory binding arbitration upon the request of either party.


                                          13

<PAGE>

        The undersigned agree to all terms and conditions set forth herein, and
in witness whereof, they hereby execute this Master Agreement as of the date
first set forth hereinabove.

LESSOR:                                     LESSEE:

FIRST INTERSTATE BANK OF CALIFORNIA         TELE TECH TELECOMMUNICATIONS, INC.
                                            a California corporation


By/s/ Jillee S. Graliau                     By/s/ Kenneth Tuchman
  -----------------------------               -------------------------------

Title Vice President                        Title President
     ------------------------------              ----------------------------

                                            TELETECH TELESERVICES, INC.
                                            a Colorado corporation


                                            By /s/ Kenneth Tuchman
                                              -------------------------------

                                            Title
                                                 ----------------------------


                                            TELETECH HOLDINGS, INC.
                                            a Delaware corporation


                                            By/s/ Kenneth Tuchman
                                              -------------------------------

                                            Title President
                                                 ----------------------------


                                          14

<PAGE>

                                     EXHIBIT "A"

                                  EQUIPMENT SCHEDULE
                            DATED ________________________
                                          TO
                                MASTER LEASE AGREEMENT
                            DATED ________________________


LESSEE:                                LESSOR:


- -----------------------------------    --------------------------------------
Name                                   Name

- -----------------------------------    --------------------------------------
Address                                Address

- -----------------------------------    --------------------------------------

        1.       MASTER LEASE:  The terms and conditions of that Master Lease
Agreement dated as of the date set forth above by and between the Lessor and
Lessee (the "Master Agreement") are by this reference incorporated herein as if
fully set forth herein and together with the terms and conditions hereof, and of
all schedules, riders, addenda and/or exhibits that are attached or refer to
this Equipment Schedule, constitute a single and severable agreement of lease
(this "Lease").  Subject to all of the terms and conditions of this Lease,
Lessor hereby leases to Lessee, and Lessee hereby hires from Lessor, the
personal property described below and on any supplemental Schedule "A" hereto
(hereinafter, together with all replacement parts, additions, modifications,
repairs and accessories incorporated therein and/or attached thereto, said
personal property is referred to as the "Equipment"):
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>

- -----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- -----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>      <C>                                                                                       <C>
 QTY.   DESCRIPTION OF EQUIPMENT - MAKE, KIND, MODEL NO., SERIAL NO., AND ANY OTHER PERTINENT     ORIGINAL
- -----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                                                                                   $
- -----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------

- -----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                                                                       Freight
- -----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
           *If additional space is required, attach Schedule A.            Total Original Cost     $
- -----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
 Location of Equipment (if additional space is required, attach Schedule A)
- -----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- -----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------

</TABLE>

        2.       ACCEPTANCE DEADLINE: ____________________________, 19___.

        3.       TERM:  The term of this Lease shall be a period of _____ months
and shall commence on the date that the Equipment is accepted by Lessee on
behalf of Lessor (the "Acceptance Date").

        4.       RENT COMMENCEMENT DATE:  The first day of the month immediately
following the Acceptance Date.

        5.       BASIC RENT PAYMENT DATE:  The first day of each month beginning
with the Rent Commencement Date.

        6.       RENT:


                                          15

<PAGE>

                 (a)      INTERIM RENT:  An amount equal to 1/30th of the Basic
Rent multiplied by the number of days elapsed from and including the Acceptance
Date but excluding the Rent Commencement Date and due and payable concurrently
with the delivery of the Certificate of Acceptance by Lessee to Lessor.

                 (b)      BASIC RENT:  For the term of this Lease, Lessee shall
pay Lessor Basic Rent of $__________ monthly plus applicable sales tax, payable
on each Basic Rent Payment Date.

        If the first day of each month during the term of this Lease is not a
business day, Basic Rent shall be due on the next subsequent business day.
Unless otherwise expressly agreed to in writing by Lessor, sales tax on each
rental payment received by Lessor under this Lease shall be due and payable by
Lessee to Lessor on each Basic Rent Payment Date.

                 (c)      OVERDUE RENT:  Lessee shall pay to Lessor an Overdue
Rent Charge of 5% of all Basic Rent payments not received by Lessor on or before
the Basic Rent Payment Date.

        7.       PURCHASE OPTION:  Provided that (i) an Event of Default does
not exist; (ii) this Lease has not previously been terminated; and (iii) Lessee
has given Lessor not less than sixty (60) days notice prior to the expiration of
the initial term of the Lease, Lessee shall have the option to purchase all (but
not less than all) of the Equipment on the original expiration date of this
Lease under the following terms and conditions:

        [Note - Choose alternative and delete the other.]

        [Lessee shall have the right to purchase the Equipment, on an "as-is,
where-is" basis, without representation or warranty of any kind, at the then
current FAIR MARKET VALUE thereof (assuming a sale for cash thereof by a ready,
willing and able seller to a ready, willing and able buyer (other than a scrap
or salvage dealer) in an arms length transaction where neither seller nor buyer
is under any compulsion to sell or buy, and assuming further that such Equipment
is then in the condition in which it is required to be maintained hereunder and
under the Master Agreement), provided that such right is further subject to
payment in full of the purchase price within twenty (20) days after
establishment of such fair market value.  Such fair market value of the
Equipment shall be established by Lessor, in the exercise of its reasonable
discretion, and disclosed in writing to Lessee or, if Lessee objects in writing
within ten (10) days after receipt of such written disclosure from the Lessor,
then, at Lessee's expense, by a third party professional appraiser selected by
Lessor, whose determination shall be final and irrebuttable in the absence of
manifest error.]

                                          OR

        [Lessee shall have the right to purchase the Equipment, on an "as-is,
where-is" basis, without representation or warranty of any kind, for
$_____________, provided that such right is further subject to payment in full
of the purchase price on or before the expiration of the initial term of this
Lease.]

Lessee shall pay or reimburse Lessor all of Lessor's reasonable costs and
expenses incurred in connection with such purchase and shall pay all taxes
imposed in connection with such sale (other than taxes imposed on or measured by
Lessor's net income).

        8.       MODIFICATION TO MASTER AGREEMENT:  All terms and conditions of
this Lease shall be as set forth above and in the Master Agreement, except (if
additional space is required, attach an Addendum to this Lease):
________________________________________________________________________________
________________________________________________________________________________
________________________________________________________________________________
________________

        9.       CONDITIONS PRECEDENT:  Lessor shall have no obligation to
purchase the Equipment and to lease the same to Lessee hereunder: (i) if the
actual cost of the Equipment exceeds the original cost thereof set forth
hereinabove; (ii) if there exists any Event of Default or event or condition
which, with the lapse of


                                          16

<PAGE>

time or the giving of notice or both, would constitute an Event of Default; or
(iii) unless prior to the Acceptance Deadline Lessee, at its expense, shall have
delivered or caused to be delivered to Lessor all of the documents required
under Section 3 of the Master Agreement and, in addition, Lessee, at its
expense, shall have fully satisfied all of the following additional conditions
precedent (if additional space is required, attach an Addendum to this Lease):
________________________________________________________________________________
________________________________________________________________________________
_________

        10.      SCHEDULE:  The "Schedule of Stipulated Loss Percentages" that
is attached or refers to this Equipment Schedule is by this reference expressly
incorporated herein as if fully set forth herein.

        11.      REAFFIRMATION:  By their execution and delivery of this
Equipment Schedule, the parties hereby reaffirm all of the terms and conditions
of the Master Agreement, except to the extent, if any, modified hereby.

        12.      COUNTERPARTS:  The Equipment Schedule evidencing this Lease
may be executed in more than one original counterpart.  However, only the
counterpart designated below as "Counterpart No. 1" shall evidence the monetary
obligation of Lessee with respect to this Lease.  To the extent, if any, that
this Lease constitutes "chattel paper," as that term is defined in the Colorado
Uniform Commercial Code, no security interest in this Lease may be created or
perfected by the transfer or possession of any counterpart hereof other than
said "Counterpart No. 1."

        THIS IS COUNTERPART NO. _____________ OF ________________ COUNTERPART
ORIGINALS.

        IN WITNESS WHEREOF, this Equipment Schedule has been executed,
delivered and accepted this _____ day of __________________, 19___.


LESSOR:                                LESSEE:

FIRST INTERSTATE BANK OF _____________ ______________________________________
N.A.


By                                     By
  ---------------------------------      ------------------------------------

Title                                  Title
     ------------------------------         ---------------------------------


                                          17

<PAGE>

                                 ARBITRATION PROGRAM

        (a)      BINDING ARBITRATION.  Upon the demand of Borrower or Bank
(collectively the "parties"), whether made before the institution of any
Judicial proceeding or not more than 60 days after service of a complaint, third
party complaint, cross-claim or counterclaim or any answer thereto or any
amendment to any of the above, any Dispute (as defined below) shall be resolved
by binding arbitration in accordance with the terms of this arbitration clause.
A "Dispute" shall include any action, dispute, claim, or controversy of any
kind, whether founded in contract, tort, statutory or common law, equity, or
otherwise, now existing or hereafter occurring between the parties arising out
of, pertaining to or in connection with this Agreement or any related
agreements, documents, or instruments (the "Documents").  The parties understand
that by this Agreement they have decided that the Disputes may be submitted to
arbitration rather than being decided through litigation in court and that once
decided by an arbitrator the claims involved cannot later be brought, filed, or
pursued in court.

        (b)      GOVERNING RULES.  Arbitrations conducted pursuant to this
Agreement, including selection of arbitrators, shall be administered by the
American Arbitration Association ("Administrator") pursuant to the Commercial
Arbitration rules of the Administrator.  Arbitrations conducted pursuant to the
terms hereof shall be governed by the laws of the State of Colorado, including
the provisions of CRS 13-22-201 et seq, and CRS 13-21-102(5). Judgment upon any
award rendered hereunder may be entered in any court having jurisdiction;
provided, however, that nothing contained herein shall be deemed to be a waiver
by any party that is a bank of the protections afforded to it under 12 U.S.C.
Section 91 or similar governing state law.  Any party who fails to submit to
binding arbitration following a lawful demand by the opposing party shall bear
all costs and expenses, including reasonable attorney's fees, incurred by the
opposing party in compelling arbitration of any Dispute.

        (c)      NO WAIVER, PRESERVATION OF REMEDIES, MULTIPLE PARTIES.  No
provision of, nor the exercise of any rights under, this arbitration clause
shall limit the right of any party to (1) foreclose against any real or personal
property collateral or other security, (2) exercise self-help remedies
(including repossession and setoff rights) or (3) obtain provisional or
ancillary remedies such as injunctive relief, sequestration, attachment,
replevin, garnishment, or the appointment of a receiver from a court having
Jurisdiction.  Such rights can be exercised at any time except to the extent
such action is contrary to a final award or decision in any arbitration
proceeding.  The institution and maintenance of an action as described above
shall not constitute a waiver of the right of any party, including the
plaintiff, to submit the Dispute to arbitration, nor render inapplicable the
compulsory arbitration provisions hereof.  Any claim or Dispute related to
exercise of any self-help, auxiliary or other exercise of rights under this
section (c) shall be a Dispute hereunder.

        (d)      ARBITRATOR POWERS AND QUALIFICATIONS; AWARDS.  Arbitrators
shall resolve all Disputes in accordance with the applicable substantive law.
Arbitrator(s) may make an award of attorneys' fees and expenses if permitted by
law or the agreement of the parties.  All statutes of limitation applicable to
any Dispute shall apply to any proceeding in accordance with this arbitration
clause.  Any arbitrator selected to act as the only arbitrator in a Dispute
shall be required to be a practicing attorney with not less than 10 years
practice in commercial law in the state of Colorado.  With respect to a Dispute
in which the claims or amounts in controversy do not exceed five hundred
thousand dollars ($500,000), a single arbitrator shall be chosen and shall
resolve the Dispute.  In such case the arbitrator shall have authority to render
an award up to but not to exceed five hundred thousand dollars ($500,000)
including all damages of any kind whatsoever, costs, fees and expenses.
Submission to a single arbitrator shall be a waiver of all parties' claims to
recover more than five hundred thousand dollars ($500,000).  A Dispute involving
claims or amounts in controversy exceeding five hundred thousand dollar
($500,000) shall be decided by a majority vote of a panel of three arbitration
("Arbitration Panel").  An Arbitration Panel shall be composed of one arbitrator
who would be qualified to sit as a single arbitrator in a Dispute decided by one
arbitrator, one who has at least ten years experience in commercial lending and
one who has at least ten years experience in the marketing/communications
industry.  Arbitrator(s) may, in the exercise of their discretion to, at the
written request of a party in any Dispute, 1) consolidate in a single proceeding
any multiple party claims that are substantially identical and all claims
arising out of a single loan or series of loans including claims by or against
borrower(s), guarantors, sureties and or owners of collateral if different from
the borrower, and 2) administer multiple arbitration claims as class actions in
accordance with Rule 23 of the Federal Rules of Civil Procedure.  The
arbitrator(s) shall be empowered to resolve any Dispute regarding the terms of
this Agreement or the arbitrability of any Dispute or any claim that all or any
part (including this provision) is void or voidable but shall have no power to
change or


<PAGE>

alter the terms of this Agreement.  The award of the arbitrator(s) shall be in
writing and shall specify the factual and legal basis for the award.

        (e)      MISCELLANEOUS.  To the maximum extent practicable, the
Administrator, the Arbitrator(s) and the parties shall take any action necessary
to require that an arbitration proceeding hereunder be concluded within 180 days
of the filing of the Dispute with the Administrator.  The Arbitrator(s) shall be
empowered to impose sanctions for any party's failure to proceed within the
times established herein.  Arbitration proceedings hereunder shall be conducted
in Denver, Colorado at a location determined by the Administrator.  In any such
proceeding a party shall state as a counterclaim any claim which arises out of
the transaction or occurrence or is in any way related to the Documents which
does not require the presence of a third party which could not be joined as a
party in the proceeding.  The provisions of this arbitration clause shall
survive any termination, amendment, or expiration of the Documents and repayment
in full of sums owed to Bank by Borrower unless the parties otherwise expressly
agree in writing. Each party agrees to keep all Disputes and arbitration
proceedings strictly confidential, except for disclosures of information
required in the ordinary course of business of the parties or as required by
applicable law or regulation.

                                      2


<PAGE>


                                                                EXHIBIT 10.19








                                       SUBLEASE
                                           
                                       Between
                                           
                     NORWEST BANK COLORADO, NATIONAL ASSOCIATION
                                    as Sublandlord
                                           
                                         and
                                           
                             TELETECH TELESERVICES, INC.,
                        TELETECH TELECOMMUNICATIONS, INC., AND
                               TELETECH HOLDINGS, INC.
                                           
                                     as Subtenant

<PAGE>

                     TABLE OF CONTENTS
                                           

SECTION                                               PAGE

1.  Sublease of Premises. . . . . . . . . . . . . .    2
2.  Term of Sublease. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .    2
3.  Rent. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .    2
4.  Subtenant Allowances. . . . . . . . . . . . . .    4
5.  Use . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .    4
6.  Condition of Premises . . . . . . . . . . . . .    5
7.  Assignment and Subletting . . . . . . . . . . .    6
8.  Alterations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .    7
9.  Heating, Ventilating and Air Conditioning . . .    7
10. Lease Terms Apply . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .    8
11. Insurance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .    9
12. Notice and Bills. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   11
13. Termination . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   12
14. Prohibition of the Use of Sublandlord's Name. .   12
15. Signage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   13
16. Parking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   13
17. Renewal Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   14
18. Indemnification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   14
19. Environmental Matters . . . . . . . . . . . . .   15
20. Attorneys' Fees . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   15
21. Use of Smoking Area . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   16
22. Building Security . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   16
23. Obligations Under the Master Lease. . . . . . .   16
24. Self-Help . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   16
25. Rights of Entry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   16
26. Condemnation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   17
27. Default by Subtenant. . . . . . . . . . . . . .   17
28. Default by Sublandlord. . . . . . . . . . . . .   19
29. Deposit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   19
30. Month to Month Tenancy. . . . . . . . . . . . .   20
31. Miscellaneous . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   20


LIST OF EXHIBITS

    Exhibit A:     Master Lease
    Exhibit B:     Description of Premises

<PAGE>

                                       SUBLEASE
                                           

    THIS SUBLEASE, dated as of September 28, 1995, is made between NORWEST BANK
COLORADO, NATIONAL ASSOCIATION, a national banking association ("Sublandlord"),
and TELETECH TELESERVICES, INC., a Colorado corporation, TELETECH HOLDINGS,
INC., a Delaware corporation, and TELETECH TELECOMMUNICATIONS, INC., a
California corporation (together, the "Subtenant").


                                      RECITALS:
                                           
    A.   United Bank of Denver National Association, a national banking
association, as Tenant, and 1700 Lincoln Limited, a Colorado limited
partnership, as Landlord ("Master Landlord"), entered into that certain Amended
and Restated Lease Agreement dated December 30, 1988, as amended on April 20,
1989, and July 20, 1994 ("Together the, "Master Lease").  The Master Lease
covers that certain office space (approximately 23,144 square feet of the total
Net Rentable Area) on the 21st Floor located at 1700 Lincoln Street, Denver,
Colorado (the "Premises"), as more fully described in the Master Lease and on
Exhibit B attached hereto and made a part hereof.

    B.   A true and correct copy of most of the provisions of the Master Lease
is attached hereto as Exhibit A and made a part hereof.  Sublandlord hereby
represents and warrants that those provisions which have been deleted from the
Master Lease do not and could not have any effect materially adverse to the
rights or obligations of Subtenant or the obligations of Sublandlord under this
Sublease.

    C.   Norwest Bank Colorado, National Association is successor in interest
to Norwest Bank Denver, National Association, formerly known as United Bank of
Denver National Association.

    D.   Subtenant desires to sublet the Premises and Sublandlord is willing to
sublet the Premises to Subtenant.

    E.   The consent of Master Landlord under the Master Lease is required for
this Sublease.

    F.   The capitalized terms used herein that are not defined herein but are
defined in the Master Lease shall have the meanings ascribed thereto in the
Master Lease.

                                      AGREEMENT
                                           
    NOW, THEREFORE, in consideration of the terms and conditions of this
Sublease, the parties agree as follows:


<PAGE>

    1.   SUBLEASE OF PREMISES.  Sublandlord hereby subleases the Premises to
Subtenant, and Subtenant hereby takes and subleases the Premises from
Sublandlord.

    2.   TERM OF SUBLEASE.  The term of this Sublease shall commence upon the
earlier of occupancy or February 1, 1996 ("Commencement Date") and shall end on
May 31, 2000,  unless sooner terminated as otherwise provided in this Sublease
or the Master Lease.  For the purpose of this Section 2, "occupancy" shall mean
the transaction or solicitation of any business by telephone or otherwise with
the general public, or the use of the Premises by any employee of Subtenant.  If
the term of this Sublease commences on a date earlier than February 1, 1996,
Sublandlord and Subtenant shall, at the request of either, execute a declaration
specifying the Commencement Date of the term of this Sublease.  In such event,
the stated term of, and rental under this Sublease will commence on the revised
Commencement Date, and the Base Rent will be increased accordingly and the
expiration date shall remain May 31, 2000.  

    3.   RENT.

         A.   BASE RENT.

              (1) Subtenant covenants and agrees to pay Sublandlord as Base
Rent for the Premises during the term of this Sublease the sum of $1,990,769.56
payable in monthly installments of $38,284.03.  All monthly payments shall be
due and payable on the first day of each calendar month during the term of this
Sublease.  All Base Rent due hereunder shall be prorated for any fractional
calendar month at the beginning and end of the term of this Sublease.  All Base
Rent and any Additional Rent as hereinafter defined (together, "Rent") shall be
paid without notice, demand, offset or deduction, in lawful money of the United
States of America at the address of Sublandlord as set forth hereinafter or at
such other place as Sublandlord may from time to time designate in writing.

              (2)  It is agreed between Sublandlord and Subtenant that any
monthly installment, or proration thereof, of Rent which shall not be paid by
the tenth (10th) day of each month, or any other payment required to be made by
Subtenant and not made when due, shall bear interest at the rate in effect from
time to time equal to four percentage points (4%) above the prime rate of
interest charged by Norwest Bank Colorado, National Association or its
successors, effective the day of any change from the date when the same became
due and payable by the terms hereof.  "Prime Rate" shall mean the rate of
interest announced to the general public by Norwest Bank Colorado, National
Association or its successor as its "prime" rate or "base" rate.

              (3) If Subtenant fails to pay any monthly Base Rent or Additional
Rent on the date they are due and payable, the unpaid 

                                          2

<PAGE>

amounts will be subject to a late payment charge equal to six percent (6%) of
the unpaid amounts.  This late payment charge is intended to compensate
Sublandlord for its additional administrative costs resulting from Subtenant's
failure, and has been agreed upon by Sublandlord and Subtenant, after
negotiation, as a reasonable estimate of the additional administrative costs
that will be incurred by Sublandlord as a result of Subtenant's failure.  The
actual cost in each instance is extremely difficult, if not impossible, to
determine. This late payment charge will constitute liquidated damages and will
be paid to Sublandlord together with such unpaid amounts.  The payment of this
late payment charge will not constitute a waiver by Sublandlord of any default
by Subtenant under this Sublease. 

         B.   ADDITIONAL RENT. 

              (1)  In addition to Base Rent, for each calendar year during the
term of this Sublease, Subtenant shall pay to Sublandlord "Additional Rent," the
amount of which shall be determined under this paragraph 3.B.  The per-square-
foot Variable Rent for the calendar year 1995, determined as set forth in
Sections 4.04 and 4.05(a) of the Master Lease, shall be referred to herein as
the "1995 Base Variable Rent."  Commencing January 1, 1996, the Additional Rent
payable by Subtenant to Sublandlord each year under this paragraph B shall be
the per-square-foot Variable Rent determined each year less the 1995 Base
Variable Rent, multiplied by 23,144.

              (2)  Commencing January 1, 1996 and each year thereafter, to the
extent the Additional Rent or that Master Landlord's estimated projections in
Section 4.04(b) of the Master Lease indicate that the annual Variable Rent will
exceed the annual 1995 Base Variable Rent, Subtenant shall pay, concurrently
with each payment of Base Rent, to Sublandlord such excess in accordance
therewith.  Further, Subtenant shall pay, upon demand, for any additional
services, as defined in paragraph 4 below, requested by Subtenant, and to the
extent the Master Lease requires Sublandlord to pay the operating expenses and
any pass throughs (set forth in paragraph 3 below) as incurred, Subtenant shall
also be so required.  In the event the Variable Rent exceeds the estimated
payments made by Subtenant under this paragraph (2) for the immediately
preceding calendar year, Subtenant shall pay Sublandlord, within thirty (30)
days of receipt of written notice, an amount equal to such difference.  In the
event that the estimated payments made by Subtenant under this paragraph (2) for
the immediately preceding calendar year exceeds the Variable Rent, Sublandlord
shall pay Subtenant, within thirty (30) days after issuance of a written
statement to that effect, an amount equal to such excess.

              (3)  For purposes of this Sublease, "operating expenses" shall
have the meaning given in Section 4.04 of the 

                                          3

<PAGE>

Master Lease and, in addition, any other pass through costs, expenses or charges
of any kind or nature attributed directly or indirectly to the Premises which
Sublandlord is obligated to pay under the Master Lease, including, without
limitation, additional janitorial services, chilled water, metered HVAC and
electrical.

              (4)  For the purpose of this Sublease, "additional services"
shall mean any supplies, services or repairs furnished by Master Landlord or
Sublandlord at the request of Subtenant that would not be included within the
definition of operating expenses, including, without limitation, building access
cards and monitoring, overtime HVAC charges, extra janitorial services, and
light bulbs and labor. 

              (5) If required by Master Landlord or Sublandlord, Sublandlord or
Master Landlord shall be entitled to install at Subtenant's sole cost and
expense, separate metering of utilities to the Premises.  Subtenant acknowledges
that the Premises currently contain the standard electrical capacity of 4 watts
per rentable square feet.  Electrical charges beyond building standard capacity
of 4 watts per rentable square feet (3 watts on high voltage 277 lighting, 1
watt on low voltage 120 one outlet), at Master Landlord's or Sublandlord's
discretion, may be metered and billed to Subtenant in accordance with this
Sublease.

    4.   SUBTENANT ALLOWANCES.  Providing Subtenant is not in default of the
terms of this Sublease or the Master Lease at the time payment is made and
providing Sublandlord has previously complied with Section 28 of this Sublease,
and the plans and specifications have been approved in accordance with Section
6D of this Sublease, Sublandlord will pay a tenant improvement allowance
("Tenant Improvement Allowance") in the amount of $500,144.84 for the
construction of tenant improvements in conformity with the plans and
specifications submitted to Sublandlord payable as follows: $250,072.42 upon the
execution of the Sublease by Sublandlord and Subtenant, and the Consent to
Sublease by Master Landlord, and the sum of $250,072.42 upon the Commencement
Date and the payment of the first month's Rent.

    5.   USE.  Subtenant shall use the Premises only for providing
telemarketing services and for no other purposes.  Subtenant shall conduct its
use of the Premises only in a manner which is consistent with the terms of the
Master Lease and the rules of the Building described in Section 23.01 of the
Master Lease, as the same may be amended in accordance with the Master Lease. 
Any approvals required for use of the Premises by Subtenant under the Master
Lease must be made by both Master Landlord and Sublandlord.

    6.   CONDITION OF PREMISES.

         A.   Subtenant accepts the Premises in its present "as is" condition. 
Subtenant, at Subtenant's own expense, shall keep, 

                                          4

<PAGE>

after the completion of the tenant improvements, the Premises in good order,
condition and repair, including all fixtures and equipment installed by
Subtenant. 

         B.   Subtenant warrants that the Tenant Improvement Allowance will be
used for the construction of tenant improvements made to the Premises pursuant
to the plans and specifications submitted to and approved by Sublandlord. 
Subtenant agrees to pay any tenant improvement expenses in excess of the Tenant
Improvement Allowance.  

         C.   During construction of the tenant improvements, Subtenant shall
not be required to pay any project construction fees or management fees to
Sublandlord or Master Landlord.

         D.   Sublandlord and Subtenant will cooperate with each other and
consistently act in a timely and diligent manner to permit Subtenant to complete
the tenant improvements approved by Sublandlord and Master Landlord.  Subtenant
will contract for and supervise all tenant improvement construction. All
preliminary and final construction drawings, construction timetables/schedules
and general/sub-contractors must be approved by Sublandlord (which consent shall
not be unreasonably withheld) and Master Landlord before any such construction
may commence.  All tenant improvements that will involve mechanical and
electrical engineering and structural changes must be approved by  Master
Landlord's Building engineers or other engineers selected by Master Landlord
(together, "Master Landlord's Engineers"). The current mechanical and electrical
Building Engineer is I. A. Naman, Houston, Texas.  After approval of the
construction drawings and the construction timetables/schedules, any material
changes to such drawings, timetables or schedules must be reviewed and approved
by Sublandlord and Master Landlord prior to the occurrence of such changes. 
Sublandlord and Master Landlord will use its best efforts to review such changes
within fourteen (14) days of the date of their receipt.  Subtenant specifically
agrees not to (i) begin construction of any kind on the Premises until the plans
and specifications have been approved by the aforementioned parties, and (ii)
occupy the Premises until the improvements have been completed in conformity
with plans and specifications as approved and inspected by I. A. Naman. 
Finally, Subtenant understands that by I. A. Naman approving the plans and
specifications that I. A. Naman may require additional work to be completed
related to Subtenant's tenant improvements.  Subtenant agrees to comply with any
requirements and complete the work described therein required by I. A. Naman.

         E.   Except as specifically set forth in this Section or elsewhere in
this Sublease,  Subtenant acknowledges that neither Master Landlord nor
Sublandlord nor their agents or employees have made any representations or
warranties as to the suitability or fitness of the Premises for the conduct of
Subtenant's business or 

                                          5

<PAGE>

for any other purpose, nor has Master Landlord or Sublandlord or their agents or
employees agreed to make any tenant improvements to the Premises.

    7.   ASSIGNMENT AND SUBLETTING.  

         A.   So long as an event of default under Section 27 of this Sublease
has not occurred and is continuing, Subtenant may assign this Sublease or sublet
all or any part of the Premises (any and all of the foregoing hereinafter shall
be referred to as a "transfer") to any of the wholly-owned subsidiaries of
TeleTech Holdings, Inc. without the prior written consent of Sublandlord,
provided prior written notice is delivered to Sublandlord within ten (10) days
before the date of such assignment or subletting setting forth the legal name of
the assignee or sublessee.

         B.   So long as an event of default under Section 27 of this Sublease
has not occurred and is continuing, Subtenant may transfer the Premises to a
third party with the prior written consent of Sublandlord; provided, however,
Sublandlord shall not unreasonably withhold its consent as to any proposed
sublease or assignment.  Sublandlord will respond to Subtenant's written request
made in accordance with this Sublease within fourteen (14) after receipt
thereof, and in the event Sublandlord fails to respond to Subtenant's request
within such time period, Subtenant's request shall be deemed to be denied,
provided, however, Master Landlord shall not be bound by any of matters
contained within this sentence.

         C.   Except as specifically permitted in paragraphs 7A and B above for
Sublandlord, any attempted transfer without Sublandlord's or Master Landlord's
prior written consent shall be void and shall confer no rights upon any third
person and/or parties and shall be a default of Subtenant under this Sublease. 
In addition to any other requirements which may be made by Sublandlord or Master
Landlord, any transfer shall be in accordance with Article XVI of the Master
Lease. In the event an assignment or subletting should occur in accordance with
paragraphs 7A or B above, Master Landlord's prior written consent must be
obtained, and Subtenant will not be released from its payment and performance
obligations under the Sublease, but rather Subtenant and its assignee will be
jointly and severally and primarily liable for all payment, term, covenants and
performance obligations under the Sublease.  A consent by Subtenant to any
particular sublease or assignment shall not constitute a consent to any
subsequent sublease or assignment.

         D.   For the purpose of this Section 7, any merger (in which the
Subtenant is not the surviving entity), dissolution, consolidation or other
reorganization of any Subtenant, or any sale (except for an offering of sale of
the capital stock to the general public through a nationally recognized stock
brokerage house), 

                                          6

<PAGE>

transfer, pledge or other disposition of any Subtenant's capital stock, shall be
deemed a transfer (whether the same occurs voluntarily, involuntarily, by
operation of law or otherwise).   

    8.   ALTERATIONS.  Subtenant covenants and agrees not to improve, alter,
add to, remove or demolish any improvements on the Premises, or use any
contractors or workmen to make alterations, without the prior written consent of
Sublandlord (which consent shall not be unreasonably withheld), and Master
Landlord, subject, however, to the terms and provisions of the Master Lease. 
Sublandlord and Master Landlord will use their best efforts to review any
written requests within fourteen (14) days of the date of their receipt. 

    9.   HEATING, VENTILATING AND AIR CONDITIONING. 

         A.   The Building hours of operation shall be as provided in the
Master Lease which currently are 7:00 a.m. to 6:00 p.m., Monday through Friday,
and 7:00 a.m. to 1:00 p.m. on Saturday.  Services which the Master Lease
provides shall be furnished only during normal business hours, and shall at
times other than those described herein, be furnished only upon request by
Subtenant to Master Landlord.  Subtenant shall bear the after-hour usage for
both zones of heating, ventilating and air conditioning located on the 21st
Floor at a rate of Twenty-Five Dollars ($25.00) per hour per zone and shall pay
Master Landlord, upon demand, directly at the address set forth hereinafter or
such other place as Master Landlord or Sublandlord may from time to time
designate in writing.  The only services to which Subtenant is entitled are
those to which Sublandlord is entitled as Tenant under the Master Lease.

         B.   Subject to the written consent of Sublandlord and Master
Landlord, Subtenant may install, at its sole cost and expense, additional air
conditioning equipment.  To the extent the foregoing should require separate
metering, as determined by Master Landlord or Sublandlord in their sole
discretion, Subtenant shall pay, upon demand, for the documented cost of the
meter, all reasonable and documented costs and expenses required for its
installation and the usage charges. 

    10.  LEASE TERMS APPLY.

         A.   This Sublease is subject and subordinate to the Master Lease,
except to the extent the Master Lease may be inconsistent with the terms hereof,
in which case the terms of this Sublease shall govern.  All of the terms,
covenants and conditions of the Master Lease except for Articles III, VI, XI,
XXI, XXII, XXVI, XXVIII, XXX, and Sections 2.02, 2.03, 4.01, 4.02, 7.1(a), 7.03,
7.05, 12.02, 13.01 (first paragraph),13.03, 14.02, 15.02, 16.02, 18.03, and
27.01(g) shall be applicable to and incorporated into this Sublease as if
Sublandlord were the "Landlord" under the Master Lease and Subtenant were the
"Tenant" thereunder, subject to 

                                          7

<PAGE>

the modifications set forth in Section 10B. below and elsewhere herein.  With
respect to the Premises, Subtenant hereby assumes and agrees to perform and
observe all covenants and obligations of Sublandlord as Tenant under the Master
Lease, except to the extent the Master Lease may be inconsistent with the terms
hereof, in which case the terms of this Sublease shall govern, and except for
Articles III, VI, XI, XXI, XXII, XXVI, XXVIII, XXX, and Sections 2.02, 2.03,
4.01, 4.02, 7.01(a) 7.03, 7.05, 12.02, 13.01 (first paragraph) 13.03, 14.02,
15.02, 16.02, 18.03, and 27.01(g).

         B.   The following modifications are made to the Articles and Sections
of the Master Lease that are incorporated into this Sublease:

              (1)  Section 8.01:  Master Landlord retains all obligations to
make repairs and perform any necessary maintenance, repairs, refurbishing, and
replacement, both to the Building and the Premises to the extent required by the
Master Lease; provided, however, that upon notification by Subtenant to
Sublandlord of the need for any such maintenance, repairs, refurbishing or
replacement, Sublandlord shall forthwith notify Master Landlord of the same.

              (2)  Section 9.01:  Subtenant acknowledges that Master Landlord
has sole responsibility for the repair or rebuilding of the Premises caused by
any damage or destruction, and for making the determination if there is
"Qualified Damage" (as defined in Article IX) so as not to rebuild.

              (3)  Article XXII:  Subtenant covenants and agrees not to abandon
or vacate the Premises.

         C.   Subtenant acknowledges that Master Landlord retains all of its
rights and remedies under the Master Lease with respect to the Premises to the
same extent as it would have if the Sublease did not exist.  Subtenant hereby
acknowledges that it has received a copy of, has read and is familiar with the
Master Lease, in the form attached hereto as EXHIBIT A.

         D.   Sublandlord, unless otherwise stated herein, has the same rights
as Master Landlord under the Master Lease to enforce obligations and covenants
with respect to the Premises, except to the extent waived by Master Landlord.

         E.   Subtenant agrees, in addition to any other requirements contained
in the Master Lease or this Sublease, that the Premises will be in compliance
with the Americans with Disabilities Act of 1990, as amended from time to time
(together, "ADA"), and with any other governmental rules, regulations or laws
applicable to Subtenant's work and working conditions within the Premises,
except to the extent written consent has been unreasonably denied by Sublandlord
or Master Landlord for 

                                          8

<PAGE>

alterations requested by Subtenant in accordance with Section 8 of this Sublease
for any improvements required in order to comply with ADA.

    11.  INSURANCE.

         A.   Subtenant shall not do or suffer any act upon the Premises or
bring into or keep upon the Premises any article which will affect the fire risk
or increase the rate of fire insurance or other insurance on the Building.
Subtenant shall comply with the rules and requirements of all boards of fire
underwriters, rating bureaus, bureaus of fire prevention and like bodies, and
with the requirements of all insurance companies having policies of any kind in
effect covering the Building, including policies insuring against tort
liability, and with the requirements of all companies which have at any time
been requested to issue such policies.  Should the rate of any type of insurance
on the Building be increased by reason of any action or omission by Subtenant,
Sublandlord, in addition to all other remedies, may pay the amount of such
increase, and the amount so paid shall become due and payable on demand as
additional rent.  In no event shall any flammable materials, except for kinds
and quantities required for ordinary office occupancy, or any explosives
whatsoever be taken into the Premises and the Building or retained therein.

         B.   Subtenant shall carry and maintain, at its own expense, with
insurance companies rated at least A-XII in Best's Insurance Guide, which are
authorized to do business in Colorado and are acceptable to Sublandlord: (i)
fire and extended coverage insurance covering  Subtenant's improvements to the
Premises (including vandalism, malicious mischief, water damage and sprinkler
leakage coverage) in amounts equal to at least the lesser of actual replacement
costs or eighty percent (80%) of the insurable value of the insurable portions
thereof; (ii) commercial general liability and property damage coverage,
including contractual liability and personal injury insurance applicable to the
Premises in minimum limits of liability of $5,000,000.00 combined single for
bodily injury and property damage liability; and (iii) appropriate Workers'
Compensation and Employer's Liability Insurance, with an insurance carrier
licensed to do business in the State of Colorado, covering all persons employed
by Subtenant or its contractors in connection with any work on or about the
Premises and satisfying the Workers' Compensation Act of the State of Colorado,
and (iv) Builder's Risk Insurance, with limits reasonably satisfactory to
Sublandlord, relative to any improvements made to the Premises.

         C.   Insurance required to be maintained by Subtenant pursuant to
Section 11 B of this Sublease shall name Sublandlord and Master Landlord as
additional insureds, and all of the policies shall provide that no cancellation
or substantial alteration thereof shall be effective until at least thirty (30)
days after 

                                          9

<PAGE>

receipt by Sublandlord of written notice thereof.  All commercial general
liability, property damage and other casualty policies shall be written as
primary policies, not contributing to and not in addition to coverage that
Sublandlord and Master Landlord may carry.

         D.   In the event either Sublandlord or Subtenant sustains a loss by
reason of fire, lightning and/or extended coverage perils or other perils, the
cause of which is covered by policies insuring the Premises maintained or
required to be maintained under this Sublease by the party suffering such loss,
then the party incurring such loss agrees to look solely to the insurance
proceeds, if any, accruing from its own insurance and such party shall have no
right of action against the other party to this Sublease or the agents,
employees or representatives of such other party, and no third party (including
an insurance carrier), shall have any such right by way of assignment,
subrogation or otherwise.  Sublandlord and Subtenant shall cause their
respective insurance policies to be endorsed to prevent the invalidity of the
policies due to the foregoing waivers.

         E.   Sublandlord covenants and agrees that Sublandlord will maintain
in force and effect at all times during the term of this Sublease insurance
required of Sublandlord under the terms of the Master Lease.  Subtenant
covenants and agrees that Subtenant will maintain in force at all times during
the term of this Sublease insurance covering Subtenant's improvements as
required by this Section of this Sublease.  Sublandlord shall not be required to
reinsure Subtenant's improvements.

         F.   Subtenant shall deliver to Sublandlord, prior to occupancy, and
prior to the expiration or replacement, adequate certificates of insurance
showing that insurance required by this Sublease is in full force and effect and
an endorsement showing Sublandlord and Master Landlord as additional insureds as
required by Section 11 of this Sublease.

    12.  NOTICE AND BILLS.  Any bill, statement, notice, demand or other
communication which either party may desire or be required to give shall be in
writing and shall be given by personally delivering a copy thereof to the person
specified below at the following address or by sending a copy thereof by
certified or registered United States mail, postage prepaid, with return receipt
requested, addressed as follows:

    If to Subtenant:    TeleTech Teleservices, Inc.
                        TeleTech Telecommunications, Inc.
                        TeleTech Holdings, Inc.
                        1700 Lincoln Street, Suite 1400
                        Denver, Colorado  80203

                        Attention:   Joseph D. Livingston

                                          10

<PAGE>


    If to Sublandlord:  Norwest Bank Colorado,
                        National Association
                        1740 Broadway
                        Denver, Colorado  80274-8607

                        Attention: Property Manager
                                  (One Norwest Center)

    If to Master Landlord:
                        
                        Building Manager
                        One Norwest Center
                        1700 Lincoln, Suite 2500
                        Denver, Colorado  80203  

                        1700 Lincoln Limited
                        c/o Gerald D. Hines Interests
                        2800 Post Oak Boulevard
                        Houston, Texas  77056

                        Attention:  Gerald D. Hines


    With copies to:     Mr. Michael Topham
                        Gerald D. Hines Interests
                        440 Three First National Plaza
                        Chicago, Illinois  60602

                        Mr. James A. Taylor
                        Baker & Botts
                        2001 Ross Avenue, Suite 800
                        Dallas, Texas  75201

                        Mr. August E. Shouse
                        Vinson & Elkins
                        3300 First City Tower
                        1001 Fannin
                        Houston, Texas  77002
                        Mr. John Moody
                        ARICO America Realestate
                        Investment Company
                        c/o Deutsche Bank
                        Capital Corporation
                        31 West 52nd Street
                        New York, New York  10019

    Any communication given as herein provided shall be deemed given when
personally delivered or when mailed.  Each party shall have the right to
designate a different address or a different person, or both, to which or to
whom communications shall be sent or delivered, by written notice given as
provided herein.

                                          11

<PAGE>

    13.  TERMINATION.  Subtenant, upon termination of this Sublease upon the
expiration of the term hereof or as herein otherwise provided, shall quit and
surrender the Premises in good order, condition and repair, reasonable wear and
tear excepted.  Subtenant shall have no right to remain in possession of any or
all of the Premises after expiration of the Term of Sublease set forth in
Section 2; and if Subtenant wrongfully holds over, Subtenant shall be liable to
Sublandlord for the Additional Rent plus an amount equal to three hundred
percent (300%) of the Base Rent that would be payable with respect to the
Premises if this Sublease were still in effect, plus any and all costs and
damages incurred by Sublandlord by reason of any breach of the Master Lease
occasioned by Subtenant's wrongful holding over, including, without limitation,
any damages or claims for damages occasioned by third parties who are entitled
to enter the Premises for the commencement of their tenant improvements or
otherwise.

    14.  PROHIBITION OF THE USE OF SUBLANDLORD'S TRADE NAME.

         A.   Subtenant acknowledges and agrees that it will not use the name
Norwest Bank Colorado, National Association, or any part thereof, or the Norwest
Corporation logo used in connection therewith, as part of its business name or
address or as part of its advertising, marketing or other sales brochures
without the written permission of Sublandlord or Norwest Corporation, or its
successors.

         B.   Subtenant acknowledges and understands that the name of the
Building ("One Norwest Center") and the logo used in conjunction therewith are
owned by Norwest Corporation and used by Master Landlord with the permission of
Norwest Corporation.  Subtenant agrees that it will not use said names or said
logo nor incorporate any part thereof as a part of its business name, or as part
of its advertising, marketing or other sales brochures without the written
permission of Norwest Bank Colorado, National Association or Norwest
Corporation, or its successors.  Notwithstanding the foregoing, Subtenant shall
be permitted to use the current or future name of the Building when referring to
its business address.  For example, Subtenant shall be permitted to use the
following address:

         TeleTech Teleservices, Inc.
         One Norwest Center, Suite  2100
         1700 Lincoln Street
         Denver, Colorado  80203

    15.  SIGNAGE.  Subtenant agrees that during the term hereof, no signs may
be placed on the Premises without the express written consent of Sublandlord,
which shall not be unreasonably withheld; provided, however, that Sublandlord
shall provide the standard Building signage at Subtenant's Premises and building
directory permitted by the Master Lease.


                                          12

<PAGE>

    16.  PARKING. 

         A.   Subtenant shall have the privilege to use one (1) nonreserved
parking space for every 1,000 rentable square feet leased by Subtenant under
this Sublease in the parking garage located at 1700 Sherman Street, Denver,
Colorado, for the use of Subtenant and Subtenant's customers.  At least 100 days
prior to the date Subtenant desires to take any or all of the foregoing parking
spaces, Subtenant shall advise Sublandlord in writing, how many parking spaces
Subtenant desires to pay for and utilize.  Subtenant shall be required to
continue to retain and pay for each parking space taken for at least one (1)
year after the date Subtenant takes such space.  After the one year period has
expired for each parking space, Subtenant may discontinue use of each space upon
forty-five (45) days prior written notice to Sublandlord.  Parking rates which
are currently $85.00 per month for unreserved parking and $125.00 per month for
reserved parking, are subject to change from time to time by the operator of the
parking garage.  Subtenant is solely responsible for the parking fee to be paid
directly to the manager of the parking garage.  Subtenant will comply in all
respects with any rules and regulations that may be promulgated by the operator
of the parking garage.

         B.   In the event any of the parking spaces covered by Section 16 A
are not available due to condemnation, fire or other casualty, Sublandlord shall
have no liability to Subtenant and Subtenant shall have no right to terminate
this Sublease on account thereof. 

    17.  RENEWAL OPTIONS.  Subtenant shall have no option or right to renew
this Sublease.

    18.  INDEMNIFICATION.

         A.   Subtenant shall indemnify Sublandlord, its agents, employees,
officers and directors and save it harmless from and against any and all losses,
claims, actions, damages, liability and expenses in connection with loss of
life, personal injury and damage to property arising from any occurrence in or
on the Premises or any part thereof occasioned wholly or in part by any act or
omission of Subtenant, its agents, employees, contractors, licensees or
invitees.  In case Sublandlord shall, without fault on its part, be made a party
to any litigation commenced by or against Subtenant, then Subtenant shall
protect and hold Sublandlord harmless from, and shall pay all costs, expenses
and reasonable attorneys' fees incurred or paid by Sublandlord in connection
with such litigation.

         B.   Subtenant shall neither hold nor attempt to hold Sublandlord
liable for any injury or damage, either proximate or remote, occurring through
or caused by any repairs (made by Master 

                                          13

<PAGE>

Landlord or its agents, employees or contractors), injury or accident to the
Premises, to adjacent premises or other parts of the Building not herein
demised, or for any injury or damage occasioned by gas, smoke, rain, snow, wind,
ice, hail, lightning, earthquake, war, civil disorder, strike, defective
electrical wiring, power outages, or the breaking or stoppage of the plumbing or
sewage upon or in the Building or adjacent premises, whether said breaking or
stoppage results from freezing or otherwise unless such occurrences are caused
in whole or in part by the gross negligence of Sublandlord, its employees,
agents or contractors. 

         C.   Subtenant shall indemnify and defend Sublandlord, and save it
harmless from and against all losses, claims, actions, damages, liability and
expenses in connection with any breach of the Master Lease arising as a result
of any breach of this Sublease by Subtenant, and Sublandlord shall indemnify and
defend Subtenant and save it harmless from and against all losses, claims,
actions, damages, liability and expenses in connection with any breach of the
Master Lease by Sublandlord.  

         D.   Subtenant shall neither hold nor attempt to hold Sublandlord
liable for Master Landlord's default of any of its covenants or obligations
under the Master Lease, except to the extent such a default results in the
breach of any of the covenants or obligations of Sublandlord under this
Sublease.

         E.   In case Subtenant shall, without fault on its part, be made a
party to any litigation commenced by or against Sublandlord, then Sublandlord
shall protect and hold Subtenant harmless from, and shall pay all costs,
expenses and reasonable attorneys' fees incurred or paid by Subtenant in
connection with such litigation.  

    19.  ENVIRONMENTAL MATTERS.  Subtenant, its agents, employees, and
contractors shall use the Premises and conduct any operations thereon in
compliance with all applicable federal, state and local environmental statutes,
regulations, ordinances and any permits, approvals or judicial or administrative
order issued thereunder.  Subtenant hereby agrees to indemnify, defend and hold
harmless Sublandlord and Master Landlord, their agents, affiliates, officers,
directors and employees (all such entities and persons being referred to herein
individually as "Indemnified Person" and collectively as the "Indemnified
Parties") from and against any and all liability, claims, demands, actions and
causes of action whatsoever (including without limitation reasonable attorneys'
fees and expenses, and costs and expenses reasonably incurred in investigating,
preparing or defending against any litigation or claim, action, suit, proceeding
or demand of any kind or character) to which any Indemnified Person may be
subject insofar as they arise out of or relate to any alleged contamination of
the Premises arising from any violation of Subtenant's obligations under this
Section.  The obligations of Subtenant set forth in this Section of 

                                          14

<PAGE>

this Sublease shall survive the expiration or termination of this Sublease or
the exercise by Sublandlord or Master Landlord of any of its rights hereunder.

    20.  ATTORNEYS' FEES.  If legal action shall be brought by either of the
parties hereto for the unlawful detainer of the Premises, for the recovery of
Rent due under the provisions of this Sublease, or because of the breach of any
term, covenant or provision hereof, the party prevailing in said action
(Subtenant or Sublandlord as the case may be) shall be entitled to recover from
the party not prevailing costs of suit and reasonable attorneys' fees. 

    21.  USE OF SMOKING AREA.  Master Landlord prohibits smoking in the
Building common areas and lobby.  All costs to design and construct a smoking
area in the Premises shall be incurred by Subtenant and must be approved by
Sublandlord, Master Landlord and Master Landlord's Engineers.  

    22.  BUILDING SECURITY.  After-hours access to the Building will be by card
key, to be provided at Subtenant's sole expense.  Master Landlord currently
provides security personnel within the Building on a twenty-four (24) basis.

    23.  OBLIGATIONS UNDER THE MASTER LEASE.

         A.   Subtenant shall conform to, and use the Premises in accordance
with, all the terms, covenants and conditions of the Master Lease contained in
Exhibit A, and will not by act or omission cause a violation of such terms,
covenants and conditions.  Subtenant shall perform all of the terms, covenants
and conditions of the Master Lease contained in Exhibit A on the part of
Sublandlord as Tenant thereunder to be performed (except for payment of the rent
provided for in the Master Lease and except as otherwise modified hereunder)
insofar as such terms, covenants and conditions relate to the Premises.

         B.   Except as provided herein, Subtenant shall be entitled to the
rights of Sublandlord as Tenant under the Master Lease, insofar as the same
relate to the Premises.  Sublandlord shall have no liability by reason of any
default by Master Landlord, except to the extent that such default results in a
breach by Sublandlord of the covenants and obligations of Sublandlord hereunder.

    24.  SELF-HELP.  If Subtenant shall default in the performance of any of
its obligations under this Sublease or the Master Lease, Sublandlord, at its
option, may perform such obligations and, if necessary, enter the Premises for
such purposes.  Subtenant shall pay to Sublandlord, within ten (10) days after
demand, the amount of all reasonable and documented costs and expenses incurred
by 

                                          15

<PAGE>

Sublandlord in curing the default, including Sublandlord's reasonable attorneys'
fees.  If Sublandlord shall default in the performance of its obligations under
this Sublease in accordance with Section 28 of this Sublease, then Subtenant
shall be entitled to cure such default in accordance with such section,
provided, however, to the extent Subtenant elects to cure the default by self-
help, Subtenant's rights cannot exceed those that are permitted under the Master
Lease.

    25.  RIGHTS OF ENTRY.  Master Landlord and its agents shall retain, and
Sublandlord and its agents shall assume, all of the rights of entry upon the
Premises as set forth in Section 17.01 of the Master Lease, upon giving the
Subtenant reasonable notice.

    26.  CONDEMNATION.

         A.   If, at any time during the term of the Sublease, all of the
Premises shall be taken for any public or quasi-public purpose, the term of the
Sublease shall cease upon the date upon which the Premises become unusable as a
result of such taking (such date is referred to hereinafter as the "date of
taking").

         B.   In the event that the Master Lease is terminated in accordance
with the terms thereof by reason of any taking for any public or quasi-public
purpose, the term of the Sublease shall cease upon the date of the termination
of the Master Lease.

         C.   In the event that less than all, but more than twenty-five
percent (25%), of the Net Rentable Area of the Premises shall be taken for any
public or quasi-public purpose, or rendered unusable by reason thereof, then
Subtenant, at its sole option, may terminate this Sublease as of the date of
taking by giving written notice to Sublandlord within ten (10) days after the
date of taking.  In the event that twenty-five percent (25%) or less of the Net
Rentable Area of the Premises shall be taken for any public or quasi-public
purpose, or rendered unusable by reason thereof, then this Sublease shall remain
in full force and effect with respect to the balance of the Premises not so
taken or rendered unusable.  In the event of any partial taking that does not
give rise to a termination of this Sublease, the Rent shall be abated as to any
portion of the Premises taken or rendered unusable, effective as of the date of
taking, and there shall be excluded from the Premises from and after the date of
taking any portions thereof so taken or rendered unusable, but otherwise the
Sublease shall remain in full force and effect.

         D.   In the event of any complete or partial taking, Subtenant shall
be entitled to receive a percentage of any lump sum condemnation award to which
Sublandlord is entitled , in an amount equal to the ratio of the Net Rentable
Area of the Premises so taken, divided by the Net Rentable Area of the total
Sublandlord's Leasehold Premises (including the Premises) so taken.



                                          16

<PAGE>

    27.  DEFAULT BY SUBTENANT. The first paragraph in Section 13.01 of the
Master Lease is not incorporated into this Sublease, provided, however,
subparagraphs (a) and (b) of Section 13.01 are incorporated into and applicable
to this Sublease and remain in full force and effect.  The occurrence of any of
the following shall entitle Sublandlord to pursue the remedies set forth in
Article XIII of the Master Lease.

         (a)  failure to pay any installment of Rent when due, provided,
however, in the event Subtenant shall fail to pay Rent as required in this
Sublease, Sublandlord will give Subtenant written notice of such failure and
Subtenant shall have two business days from the date such notice is given in
accordance with Section 12 of this Sublease to pay such Rent, however, Subtenant
will not be entitled to more than one (1) notice for default in payment of Rent
during any calendar year, and if, within such calendar year after such notice,
any Rent is not paid when due, an event of default will have occurred without
further notice;

         (b)  failure to perform any obligation of Subtenant hereunder for a
period of ten (10) days after written notice, except that if such obligation
cannot reasonably be performed within such period, Subtenant shall not be in
default if Subtenant shall commence such performance within such period and
shall thereafter prosecute the same with diligence and continuity;

         (c)  breach of any condition or other provision prohibiting certain
actions on Subtenant's part, if the effect of such breach shall not be entirely
removed within ten (10) days after notice;

         (d)  the issuance of any attachments, execution or other process
against Subtenant whereby the Premises shall be taken or occupied or attempted
to be taken or occupied by someone other than Subtenant unless such process
shall be discharged within fifteen (15) days;

         (e)  any assignment, mortgage or encumbrance of this Sublease not
permitted hereunder or any subletting prohibited hereunder;

         (f)  Subtenant shall (i) apply for or consent to the appointment of a
receiver, trustee or liquidator of Subtenant or of a substantial part of its
assets, (ii) make a general assignment for the benefit of creditors, or (iii)
file a voluntary petition in bankruptcy or a petition or an answer seeking
reorganization under any bankruptcy or insolvency law or an arrangement with
creditors, or take advantage of any insolvency law or file and answer admitting
the material allegations of a petition filed against Subtenant in any
bankruptcy, reorganization or insolvency proceeding; 

                                          17

<PAGE>

         (g)  an order, judgment or decree shall be entered, without the
application, approval or consent of Subtenant, by any court approving a petition
seeking reorganization of Subtenant under any bankruptcy or insolvency law or
appointing a receiver, trustee or liquidator of Subtenant or of all or a
substantial part of its assets, or adjudicating Subtenant a bankrupt or
insolvent, and such order, judgment or decree shall continue unstayed and in
effect for any period of thirty consecutive days; or

         (h)  Subtenant is dissolved as a corporation or ceases to be a
corporation under the laws of the State of Colorado.

    28.  DEFAULT BY SUBLANDLORD.  If Sublandlord should fail to materially
perform or observe any covenant, term, provision or condition of this Sublease
and such default should continue beyond a period of forty-five (45) calendar
days (or such longer period as is reasonable necessary to remedy such default,
provided Sublandlord shall reasonably and diligently pursue such remedy at all
times until such default is cured) as the same may be extended by Excusable
Delays, after (in each such case) written notice thereof is given by Subtenant
to Sublandlord, then, in any such event, Subtenant shall have the right to use
reasonable means to (i) cure such default, and Sublandlord shall reimburse
Subtenant for all reasonable and documented sums expended in so curing said
default, and (ii) to commence such actions at law or equity to which Tenant may
be entitled.

    29.  DEPOSIT.

         A.   Subtenant will place in a form and content satisfactory to
Sublandlord, as determined by Sublandlord in its sole discretion, committed
funds in the amount of $500,144.84 to be evidenced by a letter of credit naming
Sublandlord as beneficiary, bank deposit, Treasury Note or Certificate of
Deposit to reimburse Sublandlord for the payment made by Sublandlord of the
Tenant Improvement Allowance.  In furtherance of the foregoing, Subtenant agrees
to execute such documents as Sublandlord may require.  If Subtenant defaults in
its payment of Rent or the performance of its other obligations under this
Sublease and Sublandlord has delivered written notice of such default to
Subtenant, Sublandlord may use all of the funds for the reimburse of Sublandlord
for the Tenant Improvement Allowance.  Sublandlord may, at any time after
delivering written notice of a default to Subtenant, obtain possession of the
funds described herein and apply such funds to the reimbursement of Sublandlord
for the Tenant Improvement Allowance.  The foregoing shall not be construed to
be a limitation on Sublandlord's damages or other rights under this Sublease or
Master Lease or a payment of liquidated damages.

         B.   So long as Subtenant is not in default under Section 27 of this
Sublease or an event has occurred that with the passage of time would constitute
an event of default under such section, 

                                          18

<PAGE>

the following may occur; (i) to the extent a return is earned on the deposit
referenced in Section 29A above, Subtenant may directly receive such funds,
exclusive of any principal, (ii) except as set forth in subparagraph (iii)
below, to the extent permitted under the instrument, Sublandlord, upon written
request from Subtenant no earlier than forty-five (45) days prior to each
anniversary of February 1, 1996, shall make available to Subtenant the sum of
$125,036.21 of the deposit referenced in Section 29A or if a letter of credit is
issued, an amendment to the letter of credit decreasing Sublandlord's right to
draw by an amount equal to $125,036.21, and (iii) the last payment of the
deposited funds shall be made to Subtenant within thirty (30) days after the end
of the term of this Sublease.  In no event shall the aggregate amount of
deposited funds returned to Subtenant exceed $500,144.84.

    30.  MONTH TO MONTH TENANCY.

         A.   Subtenant may convert this Sublease to a month-to-month tenancy
subject to the following conditions: (i) Subtenant gives Sublandlord prior
written notice, no earlier than October 1, 1999, nor later than December 1,
1999, electing to have this Sublease become a month-to-month tenancy commencing
June 1, 2000; and (ii)  Subtenant, at the time such written notice is given to
Sublandlord and at anytime thereafter, Subtenant is not in default under the
terms of Section 27 of this Sublease, nor an event has occurred that with the
passage of time would constitute an event of default under such section.

         B.   If Subtenant complies with paragraph A above, the Sublease
commencing on June 1, 2000, shall constitute a month-to-month tenancy, and,
except as otherwise modified in this Section 30,  this Sublease shall remain in
full force and effect enforceable in accordance with its terms.

         C.   Either party may terminate the month-to-month tenancy upon
delivering written notice to the other in accordance with this Sublease to that
affect thirty (30) days in advance of the first day of any calendar month. 
Sublandlord or Subtenant may give notice to terminate the month-to-month tenancy
before the commencement date of June 1, 2000, by giving such notice to the other
party on or before May 1, 2000, in which case the month-to-month tenancy would
terminate on June 30, 2000.

    31.  MISCELLANEOUS.

         A.   SUCCESSORS AND ASSIGNS.  The covenants, conditions and agreements
contained in this Sublease shall bind and inure to the benefit of Sublandlord
and Subtenant and their respective successors and assigns.

         B.   ENTIRE AGREEMENT. The entire contract of the parties is contained
herein and all prior or contemporaneous negotiations, 

                                          19

<PAGE>

agreements, representations and understandings, whether oral or written, are
hereby superseded.

         C.   AMENDMENT AND MODIFICATION. This Sublease may be amended, altered
or modified only by an instrument in writing signed by both parties to be bound
thereby.

         D.   LAWS AND CONSTRUCTION. This Sublease shall be governed by and
construed in accordance with the laws of the State of Colorado.  If any
provision of this Sublease is for any reason and to any extent, invalid, illegal
or unenforceable in any respect, such invalidity, illegality or unenforceability
shall not affect any other provision hereof, and this Sublease shall be
construed as if such invalid, illegal or unenforceable provision had never been
contained herein.

         E.   NO OFFER.  This Sublease is submitted on the understanding that
it will not be considered an offer and will not bind either party in any way
until Subtenant has duly executed and delivered duplicate originals to
Sublandlord, Sublandlord has executed and delivered one of such originals to
Subtenant, and Master Landlord has consented to the terms hereof in writing.

         F.   NO CONSTRUCTION AGAINST DRAFTING PARTY.  Sub-landlord and
Subtenant acknowledge that each of them and their counsel have had an
opportunity to review this Sublease and that this Sublease will not be construed
against Sublandlord merely because Sublandlord has prepared it.

         G.   TIME OF THE ESSENCE.  Time is of the essence of each and every
provision of this Sublease.

         H.   ARBITRATION.  Sublandlord and Subtenant hereby agree that if an
arbitrable dispute arises under this Sublease, the matter shall, at the option
of either Sublandlord or Subtenant, be submitted to arbitration in accordance
with the procedures of Article XXIX of the Master Lease, provided that Master
Landlord, if a necessary party, can be joined in such arbitration.  The
arbitrators shall have no power to change any of the provisions of this Sublease
in any respect, nor shall they have any power to make an award of reformation,
and the jurisdiction of the arbitrators is hereby expressly limited accordingly.

         I.   NO WAIVER.  The waiver by either party of any breach by the other
party of any agreement, condition or provision contained in this Sublease shall
not be deemed to be a waiver of any subsequent breach of the same or any other
agreement, condition or provision contained in this Sublease, nor will any
custom or practice which may arise between the parties in the administration of
the terms of this Sublease be construed to waive or to lessen the right of
either party to insist upon the performance by the other party in strict
accordance with the terms of this Sublease.  

                                          20

<PAGE>

The subsequent acceptance of Rent by Sublandlord will not be deemed to be a
waiver of any preceding breach by Subtenant of any agreement, condition or
provision of this Sublease, other than the failure of the Subtenant to pay the
particular Rent so accepted, regardless of Sublandlord's knowledge of such
preceding breach at the time of acceptance of such Rent.

         J.   ESTOPPEL CERTIFICATES.  At any time and from time to time, but
within fifteen (15) days after prior written request by either party, the other
party shall execute, acknowledge and deliver to the other, promptly upon
request, a certificate certifying to the extent that it is true and accurate (1)
that this Sublease is unmodified and in full force and effect or, if there have
been modifications, that this Sublease is in full force and effect, as modified,
and stating the date and nature of each modification; (2) the date, if any, to
which Rent and other sums payable under this Sublease have been paid; (3) that
no written notice of any default has been delivered to either party which
default has not been cured, except as to defaults specifically specified in said
certificate; (4) that there is no default known  under the Sublease or an event
known to the other party which, with notice or the passage of time, or both,
would result in an event of default under this Sublease, except for defaults
specifically specified in said certificate; and (5) such other matters as may be
reasonably requested by the other party.  Any such certificate may be relied
upon by any prospective purchaser or existing or prospective mortgagee or
beneficiary under any deed of trust of the Premises or the Building or any
interest in the Building. Notwithstanding anything else to the contrary in this
paragraph J, Subtenant may only request from and receive a written response
relating to an estoppel certificate from Sublandlord one time during each
calendar year.

         K.   NO MERGER.  The voluntary or other surrender of this Sublease by
Subtenant or the cancellation of this Sublease by mutual agreement of Subtenant
and Sublandlord or the termination of this Sublease on account of Subtenant's
default will not work a merger. 

         L.   CONSENTS.  Whenever Subtenant requests Sublandlord to take any
action or give any consent or approval required or permitted under this
Sublease, such action, consent or approval will not be unreasonably withheld,
delayed or denied.  

         M.   BROKER.   Sublandlord and Subtenant respectively represent and
warrant to each other that neither of them has consulted or negotiated with any
broker or finder with regard to the Premises other than Grubb & Ellis. 
Sublandlord shall be responsible for paying the fee of Grubb & Ellis.
Sublandlord and Subtenant will each indemnify the other against and hold the
other 

                                          21

<PAGE>

harmless from any claims for fees or commissions from anyone with whom either of
them has consulted or negotiated with regard to the Premises except the above-
named Broker.

         N.   AUTHORITY.  Each party hereby represents to the other party that
the party executing this Sublease on its behalf is authorized to do so by
requisite action of the board of directors of such party, as applicable, and
agrees upon request to deliver to the other party a resolution or similar
document to that effect.

         O.   CAPTIONS.  The captions of the various Sections of this Sublease
are for convenience only and do not define, limit, describe or construe the
contents of such Sections.

         P.   COUNTERPART.  This Sublease may be executed in several
counterparts and all such executed counterparts shall constitute one (1)
agreement binding on all of the parties in spite of the fact that all of the
parties have not signed the same counterpart. 

    Executed and delivered as of the date first written above.


SUBLANDLORD:

NORWEST BANK COLORADO,
NATIONAL ASSOCIATION,
a national banking association,
successor in interest to 
Norwest Bank Denver, National
Association, formerly known as
United Bank of Denver National
Association




By: /S/ KIRBY D. MARTIN 
    ----------------------
    Kirby D. Martin
    Vice President


                         (signatures continued on next page)


                                          22

<PAGE>

SUBTENANT:


TELETECH TELESERVICES, INC.,
    a Colorado corporation



By: /S/ JOSEPH D. LIVINGSTON
    --------------------------
    Joseph D. Livingston
    Senior Vice President
    Chief Operating Officer
    
              
TELETECH TELECOMMUNICATIONS, INC.,
    a California corporation



By: /S/ JOSEPH D. LIVINGSTON
    --------------------------
    Joseph D. Livingston
    Senior Vice President
    Chief Operating Officer


TELETECH HOLDING, INC.,
    a Delaware corporation



By: /S/ JOSEPH D. LIVINGSTON
    --------------------------
    Joseph D. Livingston
    Senior Vice President
    Chief Operating Officer


STATE OF COLORADO  )
      CITY AND     )  ss.
COUNTY OF DENVER   )


    The foregoing instrument was acknowledged before me this 5th day of October
1995, by Kirby D. Martin, as Vice President of Norwest Bank Colorado, National
Association, a national banking association, on behalf of said association.

    My commission expires:   October 23, 1996

    SEAL                     /S/ ANITA C. JONES  
                              --------------------------
                                  Notary Public

                          (notaries continued on next page)

                                          23

<PAGE>

STATE OF COLORADO       )
    CITY AND            )  ss.
COUNTY OF DENVER        )


    The foregoing instrument was acknowledged before me this 3rd day of October
1995, by Joseph D. Livingston as Chief Operating Officer of TeleTech
Teleservices, Inc., a Colorado corporation, on behalf of said corporation.

    My commission expires:   1/27/99


         SEAL                /S/ MARIANNE MARI   
                             ------------------------------
                                  Notary Public


STATE OF ______________ )
                        )  ss.
COUNTY OF _____________ )


    The foregoing instrument was acknowledged before me this ___ day of   
___________, 1995, by ___________________ as ___________________________  of
TeleTech Holdings,, a Delaware corporation, on behalf of said corporation.


    My commission expires:   ________________________


         SEAL                ________________________
                                  Notary Public


STATE OF _______________     )
                             )  ss.
COUNTY OF ______________     )


    The foregoing instrument was acknowledged before me this ___ day of  
 _________ , 1995, by ________________________ as _____________________ of
TeleTech Telecommunications, Inc., a California corporation, on behalf of said
corporation.

    My commission expires:   ___________________________


         SEAL                ___________________________
                                  Notary Public


                                          24

<PAGE>

                                      EXHIBIT A
                                           
                     (Attached to and forming a part of Sublease,
                       dated as of September 28, 1995, between
                     Norwest Bank Colorado, National Association,
                                 as Sublandlord, and
            TeleTech Teleservices, Inc., TeleTech Telecommunications, Inc.
                      and TeleTech Holdings, Inc., as Subtenant)
                                           

                                     MASTER LEASE
                                           

    A true and correct copy of most of the provisions of the Master Lease as
described in the Sublease is attached hereto.

                                          25

<PAGE>

                                      EXHIBIT B
                                           
                     (Attached to and forming a part of Sublease,
                       dated as of September 28, 1995, between 
                     Norwest Bank Colorado, National Association,
                                 as Sublandlord, and
            TeleTech Teleservices, Inc., TeleTech Telecommunications, Inc.
                      and TeleTech Holdings, Inc., as Subtenant)
                                           
                                           
                               DESCRIPTION OF PREMISES
                                           

    Office space, encompassing approximately 23,144 rentable square feet
located on the 21st Floor in the Building located at 1700 Lincoln Street,
Denver, Colorado;

    and, as more specifically detailed on the drawing of the Premises as
attached.

                                          26

<PAGE>
                            CONSENT OF MASTER LANDLORD AND
                       REAFFIRMATION OF TENANT AND SUBLANDLORD
                                           
    The Master Landlord, having read the foregoing Sublease between Norwest
Bank Colorado, National Association and TeleTech Teleservices, Inc., TeleTech
Telecommunications, Inc., and TeleTech Holdings, Inc., hereby consents to such
Sublease, subject to the following condition:  both as Tenant and Sublandlord,
by execution of this instrument, Sublandlord reaffirms its liability for prompt
payment of all rent and performance of all other covenants and obligations of
the Tenant as set forth in the Master Lease, and acknowledges that neither the
Sublease, nor Master Landlord's consent thereto, shall release Sublandlord from
any obligations to Master Landlord under the Master Lease.

    Sublandlord agrees to indemnify and hold harmless Master Landlord from any
and all claims or demands of, or liabilities to Subtenant, arising from or
related to any actual or alleged breach of the Sublease by Subtenant, or from
Subtenant's occupancy or use of the Premises.

MASTER LANDLORD:

1700 LINCOLN LIMITED, a
Colorado limited partnership

By: Hines Colorado Limited,
    General Partner of
    1700 Lincoln Limited

    By:  Hines Colorado Corporation,
         a General Partner of
         Hines Colorado Limited

         By: /S/ DAVID MCGINNIS       
             ----------------------------
              O. David McGinnis
              Vice President


SUBLANDLORD:

NORWEST BANK COLORADO, NATIONAL
ASSOCIATION, successor in interest
to NORWEST BANK DENVER, NATIONAL
ASSOCIATION, a national banking
association


By: /S/ KIRBY D. MARTIN 
    ---------------------------
    Kirby D. Martin
    Vice President

                                          27

<PAGE>

STATE OF COLORADO       )
    CITY AND            )  ss.
COUNTY OF DENVER        )



    The foregoing instrument was acknowledged before me this ____ day of   
_________,  1995, by Kirby D. Martin as vice president  of Norwest Bank
Colorado, National Association, a national banking association, on behalf of
said association.

    Witness my hand and official seal.

    My commission expires:   ____________________


                        ______________________________
                        Notary Public



STATE OF                     )
                             )  ss.
COUNTY OF                    )

    The foregoing instrument was acknowledged before me this ____ day of 
_________, 1995, by ______________________ of 1700 Lincoln Limited, a Colorado
limited partnership, on behalf of such partnership.

    Witness my hand and official seal

    My commission expires:   _________________


                        ________________________________
                        Notary Public

                                          28



<PAGE>

                                                                   EXHIBIT 10.20



                                       SUBLEASE

                                       Between

                     NORWEST BANK COLORADO, NATIONAL ASSOCIATION
                                    as Sublandlord

                                         and

                        TELETECH TELECOMMUNICATIONS, INC. and
                           TELETECH TELESERVICES, INC., AND
                               TELETECH HOLDINGS, INC.
                                together, as Subtenant




<PAGE>

                                  TABLE OF CONTENTS
                                           

Section                                               Page
- -------                                               ----

1.  Sublease of Premises. . . . . . . . . . . . . .    2
2.  Term of Sublease. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .    2
3.  Rent. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .    2
4.  Use . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .    4
5.  Condition of Premises . . . . . . . . . . . . .    4
6.  Assignment and Subletting . . . . . . . . . . .    4
7.  Alterations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .    4
8.  Heating, Ventilating and Air Conditioning . . .    5
9.  Lease Terms Apply . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .    5
10. Insurance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .    7
11. Notice and Bills. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .    8
12. Termination . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .    9
13. Prohibition of the Use of Sublandlord's Name. .   10
14. Signage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   11
15. Parking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   11
16. Renewal Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   11
17. Indemnification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   11
18. Environmental Matters . . . . . . . . . . . . .   12
19. Attorneys' Fees . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   13
20. Use of Smoking Area . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   13
21. Building Security . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   13
22. Obligations Under the Master Lease. . . . . . .   13
23. Self-Help . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   13
24. Rights of Entry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   14
25. Condemnation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   14
26. Default by Subtenant. . . . . . . . . . . . . .   14
27. Default by Sublandlord. . . . . . . . . . . . .   15
28. Miscellaneous . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   16


List of Exhibits
- ----------------

    Exhibit A:     Master Lease
    Exhibit B:     Description of Premises


<PAGE>

                                       SUBLEASE

    THIS SUBLEASE, dated as of September 28, 1995, is made between NORWEST BANK
COLORADO, NATIONAL ASSOCIATION, a national banking association ("Sublandlord"),
and TELETECH TELECOMMUNICATIONS, INC., a California corporation, and TELETECH
TELESERVICES, INC., a Colorado corporation, and TELETECH HOLDINGS, INC., a
Delaware corporation (together, "Subtenant").

                                      RECITALS:
                                           
    A.   United Bank of Denver National Association, a national banking
association, as tenant, and 1700 Lincoln Limited, a Colorado limited
partnership, as landlord ("Master Landlord"), entered into that certain Amended
and Restated Lease Agreement dated December 30, 1988, as amended on April 20,
1989 and July 20, 1994 (together, the "Master Lease").  The Master Lease covers
that certain office space (approximately 10,704 square feet of the total Net
Rentable Area) on the 23rd level located at 1700 Lincoln Street, Denver,
Colorado (the "Premises"), as more fully described in the Master Lease and on
Exhibit B attached hereto and made a part hereof.

    B.   A true and correct copy of most of the provisions of the Master Lease
is attached hereto as Exhibit A and made a part hereof.  Sublandlord hereby
represents and warrants that those provisions which have been deleted from the
Master Lease do not and could not have any effect materially adverse to the
rights or obligations of Subtenant or the obligations of Sublandlord under this
Sublease.

    C.   Norwest Bank Colorado, National Association is successor in interest
to Norwest Bank Denver, National Association, formerly known as United Bank of
Denver National Association.

    D.   Subtenant desires to sublet the Premises and Sublandlord is willing to
sublet the Premises to Subtenant.

    E.   The consent of Master Landlord under the Master Lease is required for
this Sublease.

    F.   The capitalized terms used herein that are not defined herein but are
defined in the Master Lease shall have the meanings ascribed thereto in the
Master Lease.

                                      AGREEMENT

    NOW, THEREFORE, in consideration of the terms and conditions of this
Sublease, the parties agree as follows:

<PAGE>

    1.   SUBLEASE OF PREMISES.  Sublandlord hereby subleases the Premises to
Subtenant, and Subtenant hereby takes and subleases the Premises from
Sublandlord.

    2.   TERM OF SUBLEASE.

         A.   The term of this Sublease shall commence at midnight on October
1, 1995, and shall continue from month to month thereafter until canceled,
unless sooner terminated as otherwise provided in this Sublease or the Master
Lease.  Either party hereto may cancel this Sublease  by giving to the other
party written notice of its election to cancel this Sublease no less than thirty
(30) calendar days prior to the date on which cancellation is to be effective.

         B.   If for any reason the Premises are not available for occupancy on
the commencement date specified above, Sublandlord shall not be liable or
responsible for any claims, damages or liabilities in connection therewith or by
reason thereof.  In such event, the term of this Sublease shall commence at the
time that the Premises are available for occupancy by Tenant.  

    3.   RENT.

         A.   BASE RENT.

              (1) Subject to paragraph (2) below, Subtenant covenants and
agrees to pay Sublandlord as Base Rent the sum of $4,715.96 per month calculated
as follows:  5,912 Net Rentable Square feet at $9.21 per square foot and 357 Net
Rentable Square feet at $6.00 per square foot.  Subject to the terms and
conditions contained in this Sublease, Subtenant may have access to 4,435 Net
Rentable Square Feet known as the law library on the twenty-third floor of One
Norwest Center for the construction of tenant improvements. At such time as
Subtenant occupies the premises known as the law library, Subtenant shall pay to
Sublandlord the sum of $3,403.86 per month prorated at the rate of $113.46 per
day from the date of occupancy through the end of such month. Thereafter, as
part of the Base Rent and in accordance with this subparagraph (1), Subtenant
shall pay the sum of $3,403.86 per month calculated as follows:  4,435 Net
Rentable Square Feet at $9.21 per square foot.  For the purpose of this
subparagraph (1), "occupancy" shall mean the transaction or solicitation of any
business by telephone or otherwise with the general public, or the use of the
premises by any employee of Subtenant.  The total aggregate Base Rent of the
Premises when the law library is occupied is $8,119.82 per month.

All monthly payments shall be due and payable on the first day of each calendar
month during the term of this Sublease. All Base Rent due hereunder shall be
prorated for any fractional

                                          2

<PAGE>

calendar month at the beginning and end of the term of this Sublease.  All Base
Rent and any Additional Base Rent as hereinafter defined (together, "Rent")
shall be paid without notice, demand, offset or deduction, in lawful money of
the United States of America at the address of Sublandlord as set forth
hereinafter or at such other place as Sublandlord may from time to time
designate in writing.

              (2)  The following modification is for the purpose of adjusting
the Base Rent and for no other purpose. Commencing on December 1, 1995,
Subtenant covenants and agrees to pay Sublandlord in accordance with the terms
and conditions contained in this Sublease as Base Rent the sum of $11,172.19 per
month calculated as follows:  10,347 Net Rentable Square feet at $12.75  and 357
Net Rentable Square feet at $6.00 per square foot.

              (3) It is agreed between Sublandlord and Subtenant that any
monthly installment, or proration thereof, of Rent which shall not be paid by
the tenth (10th) day of each month, or any other payment required to be made by
Subtenant and not made when due, shall bear interest at the rate in effect from
time to time equal to four percentage points (4%) above the prime rate of
interest charged by Norwest Bank Colorado, National Association or its
successors, effective the day of any change from the date when the same became
due and payable by the terms hereof.  "Prime Rate" shall mean the rate of
interest announced to the genera public by Norwest Bank Colorado, National
Association or its successor as its "prime" rate or "base" rate. 

              (4) If Subtenant fails to pay any monthly rent or additional rent
on the date they are due and payable, the unpaid amounts will be subject to a
late payment charge equal to six percent (6%) of the unpaid amounts. This late
payment charge is intended to compensate Sublandlord for its additional
administrative costs resulting from Subtenant's failure, and has been agreed
upon by Sublandlord and Subtenant, after negotiation, as a reasonable estimate
of the additional administrative costs that will be incurred by Sublandlord as a
result of Subtenant's failure. The actual cost in each instance is extremely
difficult, if not impossible, to determine. This late payment charge will
constitute liquidated damages and will be paid to Sublandlord together with such
unpaid amounts. The payment of this late payment charge will not constitute a
waiver by Sublandlord of any default by Subtenant under this Sublease.

         B.   ADDITIONAL RENT.   In addition to Base Rent, Subtenant shall,
upon demand, pay to Sublandlord "Additional Rent," any amounts set forth in this
Sublease in addition to Base Rent, including, without limitation, building
access

                                          3

<PAGE>

cards and monitoring, overtime HVAC charges for services provided during other
than normal business hours, extra janitorial services, and light bulbs and
labor.

    4.   USE.  Subtenant shall use the Premises only for providing
telemarketing services and for no other purposes.  Subtenant shall conduct its
use of the Premises only in a manner which is consistent with the terms of the
Master Lease and the rules of the Building described in Section 23.01 of the
Master Lease, as the same may be amended in accordance with the Master Lease. 
Any approvals required for use of the Premises by Subtenant under the Master
Lease must be made by both Master Landlord and Sublandlord.  Subtenant shall not
exceed the designed floor load limit of 50 pounds per square foot.

    5.   CONDITION OF PREMISES.

         A.   Subtenant accepts the Premises in its present "as is" condition. 
Subtenant, at Subtenant's own expense, shall keep the Premises in good order,
condition and repair, including all fixtures and equipment installed by
Subtenant.

         B.   Except as specifically set forth in this Sublease,  Subtenant
acknowledges that neither Master Landlord nor Sublandlord nor their agents or
employees have made any representations or warranties as to the suitability or
fitness of the Premises for the conduct of Subtenant's business or for any other
purpose, nor has Master Landlord or Sublandlord or their agents or employees
agreed to make any tenant improvements to the Premises.

    6.   ASSIGNMENT AND SUBLETTING.  Subtenant shall not assign, mortgage or
encumber this Sublease or any interest herein or sublet all or any part of the
Premises or permit the Premises or any part thereof to be used by others (any
and all of which hereinafter shall be referred to as a "transfer"), without the
prior written consent of Sublandlord and Master Landlord.  Any attempted
transfer without Sublandlord's prior written consent shall be void and shall
confer no rights upon any third person and shall be a default of Subtenant under
this Sublease.

    7.   ALTERATIONS.  Subtenant covenants and agrees not to improve, alter,
add to, remove or demolish any improvements on the Premises, or use any
contractors or workmen to make alterations, without the prior written consent of
Sublandlord, subject, however, to the terms and provisions of the Master Lease. 
All preliminary and final construction drawings, construction
timetables/schedules and general/sub-contractors must be approved by Sublandlord
(which consent shall not be unreasonably withheld) and Master Landlord before
any such construction may commence.  All tenant improvements that will involve
mechanical and electrical engineering and structural

                                          4

<PAGE>

changes must be approved by  Master Landlord's Building engineers or other
engineers selected by Master Landlord (together, "Master Landlord's Engineers").
The current mechanical and electrical Building Engineer is I. A. Naman, Houston,
Texas.  After approval of the construction drawings and the construction
timetables/schedules, any material changes to such drawings, timetables or
schedules must be reviewed and approved by Sublandlord and Master Landlord prior
to the occurrence of such changes.  Subtenant specifically agrees not to (i)
begin construction of any kind in the law library until the plans and
specifications have been approved by the aforementioned parties, and (ii) occupy
the law library until the improvements have been completed in conformity with
plans and specifications as approved and inspected by I. A. Naman.  Finally,
Subtenant understands that by I. A. Naman approving the plans and specifications
that I. A. Naman may require additional work to be completed related to
Subtenant's tenant improvements.  Subtenant agrees to comply with any
requirements and complete the work described therein required by I. A. Naman.

    8.   HEATING, VENTILATING AND AIR CONDITIONING.  The Building hours of
operation shall be as provided in the Master Lease which currently are 7:00 a.m.
to 6:00 p.m., Monday through Friday, and 7:00 a.m. to 1:00 p.m. on Saturday. 
Services which the Master Lease provides shall be furnished only during normal
business hours, and shall at times other than those described herein, be
furnished only upon request by Subtenant to Master Landlord.  Subtenant shall
bear the after-hour usage at a rate of Twenty-Five Dollars ($25.00) per hour per
zone and shall pay Master Landlord, upon demand, directly at the address set
forth hereinafter or such other place as Master Landlord or Sublandlord may from
time to time designate in writing.  The only services to which Subtenant is
entitled are those to which Sublandlord is entitled as Tenant under the Master
Lease.

    9.   LEASE TERMS APPLY.

         A.   This Sublease is subject and subordinate to the Master Lease,
except to the extent the Master Lease may be inconsistent with the terms hereof,
in which case the terms of this Sublease shall govern.  All of the terms,
covenants and conditions of the Master Lease except for Articles II, III, IV,
VI, X, XI, XVI, XXI, XXII, XXVI, XXVIII, XXX, and Sections 7.01, 7.03, 7.04,
7.05, 12.02, 13.01 (first paragraph), 13.03, 14.02, 15.02, 18.02, 18.03, and
27.01(g) shall be applicable to and incorporated into this Sublease as if
Sublandlord were the "Landlord" under the Master Lease and Subtenant were the
"Tenant" thereunder, subject to the modifications set forth in Section 10B.
below and elsewhere herein. With respect to the Premises, Subtenant hereby
assumes and agrees to perform and observe all covenants and obligations of
Sublandlord as Tenant under the Master Lease, except to the extent the Master
Lease

                                          5

<PAGE>

may be inconsistent with the terms hereof, in which case the terms of this
Sublease shall govern, and except for Articles II, III, IV, VI, X, XI, XVI, XXI,
XXII, XXVI, XXVIII, XXX, and Sections 7.01, 7.03, 7.04, 7.05, 12.02, 13.01
(first paragraph), 13.03, 14.02, 15.02, 18.02, 18.03, and 27.01(g).

         B.   The following modifications are made to the Articles and Sections
of the Master Lease that are incorporated into this Sublease:

              (1)  Section 8.01:  Master Landlord retains all obligations to
make repairs and perform any necessary maintenance, repairs, refurbishing, and
replacement, both to the Building and the Premises to the extent required by the
Master Lease; provided, however, that upon notification by Subtenant to
Sublandlord of the need for any such maintenance, repairs, refurbishing or
replacement, Sublandlord shall forthwith notify Master Landlord of the same.

              (2)  Section 9.01:  Subtenant acknowledges that Master Landlord
has sole responsibility for the repair or rebuilding of the Premises caused by
any damage or destruction, and for making the determination if there is
"Qualified Damage" (as defined in Article IX) so as not to rebuild.

         C.   Subtenant acknowledges that Master Landlord retains all of its
rights and remedies under the Master Lease with respect to the Premises to the
same extent as it would have if the Sublease did not exist.  Subtenant hereby
acknowledges that it has received a copy of, has read and is familiar with the
Master Lease, in the form attached hereto as EXHIBIT A.

         D.   Sublandlord, unless otherwise stated herein, has the same rights
as Master Landlord under the Master Lease to enforce obligations and covenants
with respect to the Premises, except to the extent waived by Master Landlord.

         E.   Subtenant agrees, in addition to any other requirements contained
in the Master Lease or this Sublease, that the Premises will be in compliance
with the Americans with Disabilities Act of 1990, as amended from time to time
(together, "ADA"), and with any other governmental rules, regulations or laws
applicable to Subtenant's work and working conditions within the Premises,
except to the extent written consent has been unreasonably denied by Sublandlord
or Master Landlord for alterations requested by Subtenant in accordance with
Section 8 of this Sublease for any improvements required in order to comply with
ADA.

                                          6

<PAGE>

    10.  INSURANCE.

         A.   Subtenant shall not do or suffer any act upon the Premises or
bring into or keep upon the Premises any article which will affect the fire risk
or increase the rate of fire insurance or other insurance on the Building.
Subtenant shall comply with the rules and requirements of all boards of fire
underwriters, rating bureaus, bureaus of fire prevention and like bodies, and
with the requirements of all insurance companies having policies of any kind in
effect covering the Building, including policies insuring against tort
liability, and with the requirements of all companies which have at any time
been requested to issue such policies.  Should the rate of any type of insurance
on the Building be increased by reason of any action or omission by Subtenant,
Sublandlord, in addition to all other remedies, may pay the amount of such
increase, and the amount so paid shall become due and payable on demand as
additional rent.  In no event shall any flammable materials, except for kinds
and quantities required for ordinary office occupancy, or any explosives
whatsoever be taken into the Premises and the Building or retained therein.

         B.   Subtenant shall carry and maintain, at its own expense, with
insurance companies rated at least A-XII in Best's Insurance Guide, which are
authorized to do business in Colorado and are acceptable to Sublandlord: (i)
fire and extended coverage insurance covering  Subtenant's improvements to the
Premises (including vandalism, malicious mischief, water damage and sprinkler
leakage coverage) in amounts equal to at least the lesser of actual replacement
costs or eighty percent (80%) of the insurable value of the insurable portions
thereof; (ii) commercial general liability and property damage coverage,
including contractual liability and personal injury insurance applicable to the
Premises in minimum limits of liability of $5,000,000.00 combined single for
bodily injury and property damage liability; and (iii) appropriate Workers'
Compensation and Employer's Liability Insurance, with an insurance carrier
licensed to do business in the State of Colorado, covering all persons employed
by Subtenant or its contractors in connection with any work on or about the
Premises and satisfying the Workers' Compensation Act of the State of Colorado,
and (iv) Builder's Risk Insurance, with limits reasonably satisfactory to
Sublandlord, relative to any improvements made to the Premises.

         C.   Insurance required to be maintained by Subtenant pursuant to 
Section 11 B of this Sublease shall name Sublandlord and Master Landlord as
additional insureds, and all of the policies shall provide that no cancellation
or substantial alteration thereof shall be effective until at least thirty (30)
days after receipt by Sublandlord of written notice thereof.  All commercial
general liability, property damage and other casualty policies shall be written
as primary

                                          7

<PAGE>

policies, not contributing to and not in addition to coverage that Sublandlord
and Master Landlord may carry.

         D.   In the event either Sublandlord or Subtenant sustains a loss by
reason of fire, lightning and/or extended coverage perils or other perils, the
cause of which is covered by policies insuring the Premises maintained or
required to be maintained under this Sublease by the party suffering such loss,
then the party incurring such loss agrees to look solely to the insurance
proceeds, if any, accruing from its own insurance and such party shall have no
right of action against the other party to this Sublease or the agents,
employees or representatives of such other party, and no third party (including
an insurance carrier), shall have any such right by way of assignment,
subrogation or otherwise.  Sublandlord and Subtenant shall cause their
respective insurance policies to be endorsed to prevent the invalidity of the
policies due to the foregoing waivers.

         E.   Sublandlord covenants and agrees that Sublandlord will maintain
in force and effect at all times during the term of this Sublease insurance
required of Sublandlord under the terms of the Master Lease.  Subtenant
covenants and agrees that Subtenant will maintain in force at all times during
the term of this Sublease insurance covering Subtenant's improvements as
required by this Section of this Sublease.  Sublandlord shall not be required to
reinsure Subtenant's improvements.

         F.   Subtenant shall deliver to Sublandlord, prior to occupancy, and
prior to the expiration or replacement, adequate certificates of insurance
showing that insurance required by this Sublease is in full force and effect and
an endorsement showing Sublandlord and Master Landlord as additional insureds as
required by Section 11 of this Sublease.

    11.  NOTICE AND BILLS.  Any bill, statement, notice, demand or other
communication which either party may desire or be required to give shall be in
writing and shall be given by personally delivering a copy thereof to the person
specified below at the following address or by sending a copy thereof by
certified or registered United States mail, postage prepaid, with return receipt
requested, addressed as follows:

    If to Subtenant:    TeleTech Teleservices, Inc.
                        TeleTech Telecommunications, Inc.
                        TeleTech Holdings, Inc.
                        1700 Lincoln Street, Suite 1400
                        Denver, Colorado  80203
                        Attention:   Joseph D. Livingston

                                          8

<PAGE>

    If to Sublandlord:  Norwest Bank Colorado,
                        National Association
                        1740 Broadway
                        Denver, Colorado  80274-8607
                        Attention: Property Manager
                                  (One Norwest)

    If to Master Landlord:
                        Building Manager
                        One Norwest Center
                        1700 Lincoln, Suite 2500
                        Denver, Colorado  80203

                        1700 Lincoln Limited
                        c/o Gerald D. Hines Interests
                        2800 Post Oak Boulevard
                        Houston, Texas  77056

                        Attention:  Gerald D. Hines

    With copies to:     Mr. Michael Topham
                        Gerald D. Hines Interests
                        440 Three First National Plaza
                        Chicago, Illinois  60602

                        Mr. James A. Taylor
                        Baker & Botts
                        2001 Ross Avenue, Suite 800
                        Dallas, Texas  75201

                        Mr. August E. Shouse
                        Vinson & Elkins
                        3300 First City Tower
                        1001 Fannin
                        Houston, Texas  77002

                        Mr. John Moody
                        ARICO America Realestate
                        Investment Company
                        c/o Deutsche Bank
                        Capital Corporation
                        31 West 52nd Street
                        New York, New York  10019

    Any communication given as herein provided shall be deemed given when
personally delivered or when mailed.  Each party shall have the right to
designate a different address or a different person, or both, to which or to
whom communications shall be sent or delivered, by written notice given as
provided herein.

    12.  TERMINATION.  Subtenant, upon termination of this Sublease or upon the
expiration of the term hereof or as herein otherwise provided, shall quit and
surrender the

                                          9

<PAGE>

Premises in good order, broom clean, condition and repair, reasonable wear and
tear excepted and Subtenant shall repair any damage to the Premises.  Subtenant
shall have no right to remain in possession of any or all of the Premises after
expiration of the Sublease term; and if Subtenant wrongfully holds over,
Subtenant shall be liable to Sublandlord as set forth below:

         (1)  If Subtenant and Sublandlord have previously entered into a
Sublease for the twenty-first floor located in One Norwest Center, Subtenant
shall be liable to Sublandlord for an amount equal to the Additional Rent plus
the Base Rent that would be payable with respect to the Premises if this
Sublease were still in effect, plus any and all costs and damages incurred by
Sublandlord occasioned by Subtenant's wrongful holding over, including, without
limitation, any damages or claims for damages occasioned by third parties who
are entitled to enter the Premises for the commencement of their tenant
improvements or otherwise.

         (2)  If Subtenant and Sublandlord have not previously entered into a
Sublease for the twenty-first floor located in One Norwest Center, Subtenant
shall be liable to Sublandlord for the Additional Rent plus an amount equal to
three hundred percent (300%) of the Base Rent that would be payable with respect
to the Premises if this Sublease were still in effect, plus any and all costs
and damages incurred by Sublandlord occasioned by Subtenant's wrongful holding
over, including, without limitation, any damages or claims for damages
occasioned by third parties who are entitled to enter the Premises for the
commencement of their tenant improvements or otherwise.

    13.  PROHIBITION OF THE USE OF SUBLANDLORD'S TRADE NAME.

         A.   Subtenant acknowledges and agrees that it will not use the name
Norwest Bank Colorado, National Association, or any part thereof, or the Norwest
Corporation logo used in connection therewith, as part of its business name or
address or as part of its advertising, marketing or other sales brochures
without the written permission of Sublandlord or Norwest Corporation, or their
successors.

         B.   Subtenant acknowledges and understands that the name of the
Building ("One Norwest Center") and the logo used in conjunction therewith are
owned by Norwest Corporation and used by Master Landlord with the permission of
Norwest Corporation.  Subtenant agrees that it will not use said names or said
logo nor incorporate any part thereof as a part of its business name, or as part
of its advertising, marketing or other sales brochures without the written
permission of Norwest Bank Colorado, National Association or Norwest
Corporation, or their successors.  Notwithstanding the foregoing, Subtenant
shall be permitted to use the current or

                                          10

<PAGE>

future name of the Building when referring to its business address.  For
example, Subtenant shall be permitted to use the following address:

         TeleTech Telecommunications, Inc.
         One Norwest Center, Suite 2300
         1700 Lincoln Street
         Denver, Colorado  80203

    14.  SIGNAGE.  Subtenant agrees that during the term hereof, no signs may
be placed on the Premises without the express written consent of Sublandlord;
provided, however, that Sublandlord shall provide the standard Building signage
at Subtenant's Premises and building directory permitted by the Master Lease.

    15.  PARKING. Subtenant has no parking rights under this Sublease or the
Master Lease.

    16.  RENEWAL OPTIONS.  This is a month to month lease and subtenant shall
have no option or right to renew this Sublease.

    17.  INDEMNIFICATION.
    
         A.   Subtenant shall indemnify Sublandlord, its agents, employees,
officers and directors and save it harmless from and against any and all losses,
claims, actions, damages, liability and expenses in connection with loss of
life, personal injury and damage to property arising from any occurrence in or
on the Premises or any part thereof occasioned wholly or in part by any act or
omission of Subtenant, its agents, employees, contractors, licensees or
invitees.  In case Sublandlord shall, without fault on its part, be made a party
to any litigation commenced by or against Subtenant, then Subtenant shall
protect and hold Sublandlord harmless from, and shall pay all costs, expenses
and reasonable attorneys' fees incurred or paid by Sublandlord in connection
with such litigation.

         B.   Subtenant shall neither hold nor attempt to hold Sublandlord
liable for any injury or damage, either proximate or remote, occurring through
or caused by any repairs (made by Master Landlord or its agents, employees or
contractors), injury or accident to the Premises, to adjacent premises or other
parts of the Building not herein demised, or for any injury or damage occasioned
by gas, smoke, rain, snow, wind, ice, hail, lightning, earthquake, war, civil
disorder, strike, defective electrical wiring, power outages, or the breaking or
stoppage of the plumbing or sewage upon or in the Building or adjacent premises,
whether said breaking or stoppage results from freezing or otherwise unless such

                                          11

<PAGE>

occurrences are caused in whole or in part by the gross negligence of
Sublandlord, its employees, agents or contractors. 

         C.   Subtenant shall indemnify and defend Sublandlord, and save it
harmless from and against all losses, claims, actions, damages, liability and
expenses in connection with any breach of the Master Lease arising as a result
of any breach of this Sublease by Subtenant, and Sublandlord shall indemnify and
defend Subtenant and save it harmless from and against all losses, claims,
actions, damages, liability and expenses in connection with any breach of the
Master Lease by Sublandlord.  

         D.   Subtenant shall neither hold nor attempt to hold Sublandlord
liable for Master Landlord's default of any of its covenants or obligations
under the Master Lease, except to the extent such a default results in the
breach of any of the covenants or obligations of Sublandlord under this
Sublease.

         E.   In case Subtenant shall, without fault on its part, be made a
party to any litigation commenced by or against Sublandlord, then Sublandlord
shall protect and hold Subtenant harmless from, and shall pay all costs,
expenses and reasonable attorneys' fees incurred or paid by Subtenant in
connection with such litigation.  

    18.  ENVIRONMENTAL MATTERS.  Subtenant, its agents, employees, and
contractors shall use the Premises and conduct any operations thereon in
compliance with all applicable federal, state and local environmental statutes,
regulations, ordinances and any permits, approvals or judicial or administrative
order issued thereunder.  Subtenant hereby agrees to indemnify, defend and hold
harmless Sublandlord and Master Landlord, their agents, affiliates, officers,
directors and employees (all such entities and persons being referred to herein
individually as "Indemnified Person" and collectively as the "Indemnified
Parties") from and against any and all liability, claims, demands, actions and
causes of action whatsoever (including without limitation reasonable attorneys'
fees and expenses, and costs and expenses reasonably incurred in investigating,
preparing or defending against any litigation or claim, action, suit, proceeding
or demand of any kind or character) to which any Indemnified Person may be
subject insofar as they arise out of or relate to any alleged contamination of
the Premises arising from any violation of Subtenant's obligations under this
Section.  The obligations of Subtenant set forth in this Section of this
Sublease shall survive the expiration or termination of this Sublease or the
exercise by Sublandlord or Master Landlord of any of its rights hereunder.

                                          12

<PAGE>

    19.  ATTORNEYS' FEES.  If legal action shall be brought by either of the
parties hereto for the unlawful detainer of the Premises, for the recovery of
Rent due under the provisions of this Sublease, or because of the breach of any
term, covenant or provision hereof, the party prevailing in said action
(Subtenant or Sublandlord as the case may be) shall be entitled to recover from
the party not prevailing costs of suit and reasonable attorneys' fees. 

    20.  USE OF SMOKING AREA.  Master Landlord prohibits smoking in the
Building common areas and lobby.  All costs to design and construct a smoking
area in the Premises shall be incurred by Subtenant and must be approved by
Sublandlord, Master Landlord and Master Landlord's Engineers.  

    21.  BUILDING SECURITY.  After-hours access to the Building will be by card
key, to be provided at Subtenant's sole expense.

    22.  OBLIGATIONS UNDER THE MASTER LEASE.

         A.   Subtenant shall conform to, and use the Premises in accordance
with, all the terms, covenants and conditions of the Master Lease contained in
Exhibit A, and will not by act or omission cause a violation of such terms,
covenants and conditions.  Subtenant shall perform all of the terms, covenants
and conditions of the Master Lease contained in Exhibit A on the part of
Sublandlord as Tenant thereunder to be performed (except for payment of the rent
provided for in the Master Lease and except as otherwise modified hereunder)
insofar as such terms, covenants and conditions relate to the Premises.

         B.   Except as provided herein, Subtenant shall be entitled to the
rights of Sublandlord as Tenant under the Master Lease, insofar as the same
relate to the Premises.  Sublandlord shall have no liability by reason of any
default by Master Landlord, except to the extent that such default results in a
breach by Sublandlord of the covenants and obligations of Sublandlord hereunder.

    23.  SELF-HELP.  If Subtenant shall default in the performance of any of
its obligations under this Sublease or the Master Lease, Sublandlord, at its
option, may perform such obligations and, if necessary, enter the Premises for
such purposes.  Subtenant shall pay to Sublandlord, within ten (10) days after
demand, the amount of all reasonable and documented costs and expenses incurred
by Sublandlord in curing the default, including Sublandlord's reasonable
attorneys' fees.

    24.  RIGHTS OF ENTRY.  Master Landlord and its agents shall retain, and
Sublandlord and its agents shall assume, all of the rights of entry upon the
Premises as set forth in

                                          13

<PAGE>

Section 17.01 of the Master Lease, upon giving the Subtenant reasonable notice.

    25.  CONDEMNATION.

         A.   If, at any time during the term of the Sublease, all of the
Premises shall be taken for any public or quasi-public purpose, the term of the
Sublease shall cease upon the date upon which the Premises become unusable as a
result of such taking (such date is referred to hereinafter as the "date of
taking").

         B.   In the event that the Master Lease is terminated in accordance
with the terms thereof by reason of any taking for any public or quasi-public
purpose, the term of the Sublease shall cease upon the date of the termination
of the Master Lease.

         C.   In the event of any complete or partial taking, Subtenant shall
not be entitled to receive a percentage of any lump sum condemnation award to
which Sublandlord is entitled.

    26.  DEFAULT BY SUBTENANT. The first paragraph in Section 13.01 of the
Master Lease is not incorporated into this Sublease, provided, however,
subparagraphs (a) and (b) of Section 13.01 are incorporated into and applicable
to this Sublease and remain in full force and effect.  The occurrence of any of
the following shall entitle Sublandlord to pursue the remedies set forth in
Article XIII of the Master Lease.

         (a)  failure to pay any installment of Rent when due, provided,
however, Sublandlord shall provide written notice to Subtenant of such failure
and Subtenant shall have two business days from delivery of such notice to cure
the default;

         (b)  failure to perform any obligation of Subtenant hereunder for a
period of ten (10) days after written notice, except that if such obligation
cannot reasonably be performed within such period, Subtenant shall not be in
default if Subtenant shall commence such performance within such period and
shall thereafter prosecute the same with diligence and continuity;

         (c)  breach of any condition or other provision prohibiting certain
actions on Subtenant's part, if the effect of such breach shall not be entirely
removed within ten (10) days after notice;

         (d)  the issuance of any attachments, execution or other process
against Subtenant whereby the Premises shall be taken or occupied or attempted
to be taken or occupied by someone other than Subtenant unless such process
shall be discharged within fifteen (15) days;

                                          14

<PAGE>

         (e)  any assignment, mortgage or encumbrance of this Sublease not
permitted hereunder or any subletting prohibited hereunder;

         (f)  Subtenant shall (i) apply for or consent to the appointment of a
receiver, trustee or liquidator of Subtenant or of a substantial part of its
assets, (ii) make a general assignment for the benefit of creditors, or (iii)
file a voluntary petition in bankruptcy or a petition or an answer seeking
reorganization under any bankruptcy or insolvency law or an arrangement with
creditors, or take advantage of any insolvency law or file and answer admitting
the material allegations of a petition filed against Subtenant in any
bankruptcy, reorganization or insolvency proceeding; 

         (g)  an order, judgment or decree shall be entered, without the
application, approval or consent of Subtenant, by any court approving a petition
seeking reorganization of Subtenant under any bankruptcy or insolvency law or
appointing a receiver, trustee or liquidator of Subtenant or of all or a
substantial part of its assets, or adjudicating Subtenant a bankrupt or
insolvent, and such order, judgment or decree shall continue unstayed and in
effect for any period of thirty consecutive days; or

         (h)  Subtenant is dissolved as a corporation or ceases to be a
corporation under the laws of the State of Colorado or California, as
applicable.

    27.  DEFAULT BY SUBLANDLORD.  If Sublandlord should fail to materially
perform or observe any covenant, term, provision or condition of this Sublease
and such default should continue beyond a period of forty-five (45) calendar
days (or such longer period as is reasonable necessary to remedy such default,
provided Sublandlord shall reasonably and diligently pursue such remedy at all
times until such default is cured) as the same may be extended by Excusable
Delays, after (in each such case) written notice thereof is given by Subtenant
to Sublandlord, then, in any such event, Subtenant shall have the right to
terminate this Sublease immediately, without any further liability to
Sublandlord and Subtenant.


    28.  MISCELLANEOUS.

         A.   SUCCESSORS AND ASSIGNS.  The covenants, conditions and agreements
contained in this Sublease shall bind and inure to the benefit of Sublandlord
and Subtenant and their respective successors and assigns.

         B.   ENTIRE AGREEMENT. The entire contract of the parties is contained
herein and all prior or contemporaneous negotiations, agreements,
representations and understandings, whether oral or written, are hereby
superseded.

                                          15

<PAGE>

         C.   AMENDMENT AND MODIFICATION. This Sublease may be amended, altered
or modified only by an instrument in writing signed by both parties to be bound
thereby.

         D.   LAWS AND CONSTRUCTION. This Sublease shall be governed by and
construed in accordance with the laws of the State of Colorado.  If any
provision of this Sublease is for any reason and to any extent, invalid, illegal
or unenforceable in any respect, such invalidity, illegality or unenforceability
shall not affect any other provision hereof, and this Sublease shall be
construed as if such invalid, illegal or unenforceable provision had never been
contained herein.

         E.   NO OFFER.  This Sublease is submitted on the understanding that
it will not be considered an offer and will not bind either party in any way
until Subtenant has duly executed and delivered duplicate originals to
Sublandlord, Sublandlord has executed and delivered one of such originals to
Subtenant, and Master Landlord has consented to the terms hereof in writing.

         F.   NO CONSTRUCTION AGAINST DRAFTING PARTY.  Sub-landlord and
Subtenant acknowledge that each of them and their counsel have had an
opportunity to review this Sublease and that this Sublease will not be construed
against Sublandlord merely because Sublandlord has prepared it.

         G.   TIME OF THE ESSENCE.  Time is of the essence of each and every
provision of this Sublease.

         H.   ARBITRATION.  Sublandlord and Subtenant hereby agree that if an
arbitrable dispute arises under this Sublease, the matter shall, at the option
of either Sublandlord or Subtenant, be submitted to arbitration in accordance
with the procedures of Article XXIX of the Master Lease, provided that Master
Landlord, if a necessary party, can be joined in such arbitration.  The
arbitrators shall have no power to change any of the provisions of this Sublease
in any respect, nor shall they have any power to make an award of reformation,
and the jurisdiction of the arbitrators is hereby expressly limited accordingly.

         I.   NO WAIVER.  The waiver by either party of any breach by the other
party of any agreement, condition or provision contained in this Sublease shall
not be deemed to be a waiver of any subsequent breach of the same or any other
agreement, condition or provision contained in this Sublease, nor will any
custom or practice which may arise between the parties in the administration of
the terms of this Sublease be construed to waive or to lessen the right of
either party to insist upon the performance by the other party in strict
accordance with the terms of this Sublease.  The subsequent acceptance of Rent
by Sublandlord will not be deemed to be a

                                          16

<PAGE>

waiver of any preceding breach by Subtenant of any agreement, condition or
provision of this Sublease, other than the failure of the Subtenant to pay the
particular Rent so accepted, regardless of Sublandlord's knowledge of such
preceding breach at the time of acceptance of such Rent.

         J.   ESTOPPEL CERTIFICATES.  At any time and from time to time, but
within ten (10) days after prior written request by Sublandlord, Subtenant shall
execute, acknowledge and deliver to Sublandlord, promptly upon request, a
certificate certifying (1) that this Sublease is unmodified and in full force
and effect or, if there have been modifications, that this Sublease is in full
force and effect, as modified, and stating the date and nature of each
modification; (2) the date, if any, to which Rent and other sums payable under
this Sublease have been paid; (3) that no written notice of any default has been
delivered to Subtenant which default has not been cured, except as to defaults
specified in said certificate; (4) that there is no default known to Subtenant
under the Sublease or an event known to Subtenant which, with notice or the
passage of time, or both, would result in an event of default under this
Sublease, except for defaults specified in said certificate; and (5) such other
matters as may be reasonably requested by Sublandlord.  Any such certificate may
be relied upon by any prospective purchaser or existing or prospective mortgagee
or beneficiary under any deed of trust of the Premises or the Building or any
interest in the Building.

         K.   NO MERGER.  The voluntary or other surrender of this Sublease by
Subtenant or the cancellation of this Sublease by mutual agreement of Subtenant
and Sublandlord or the termination of this Sublease on account of Subtenant's
default will not work a merger. 

         L.   CONSENTS.  Whenever Subtenant requests Sublandlord to take any
action or give any consent or approval required or permitted under this
Sublease, such action, consent or approval will not be unreasonably withheld,
delayed or denied.  

         M.   BROKER.   Sublandlord and Subtenant respectively represent and
warrant to each other that neither of them has consulted or negotiated with any
broker or finder with regard to the Premises.  Sublandlord and Subtenant will
each indemnify the other against and hold the other harmless from any claims for
fees or commissions from anyone with whom either of them has consulted or
negotiated with regard to the Premises. 

         N.   AUTHORITY.  Each party hereby represents to the other party that
the party executing this Sublease on its behalf is authorized to do so by
requisite action of the board of directors of such party, as applicable, and
agrees upon

                                          17

<PAGE>

request to deliver to the other party a resolution or similar document to that
effect.

         O.   CAPTIONS.  The captions of the various Sections of this Sublease
are for convenience only and do not define, limit, describe or construe the
contents of such Sections.

         P.   COUNTERPART.  This Sublease may be executed in several
counterparts and all such executed counterparts shall constitute one (1)
agreement binding on all of the parties in spite of the fact that all of the
parties have not signed the same counterpart. 

    Executed and delivered the date first written above.


SUBLANDLORD:

NORWEST BANK COLORADO,
NATIONAL ASSOCIATION,
national banking association,
successor in interest to 
Norwest Bank Denver, National
Association, formerly known as
United Bank of Denver National
Association



By: /s/ Kirby D. Martin
    ---------------------
    Kirby D. Martin
    Vice President


SUBTENANT:

TELETECH TELECOMMUNICATIONS, INC.
 a California corporation



By: /s/ Joseph D. Livingston
    --------------------------
Title: Senior Vice President, Chief Operating Officer
       ----------------------------------------------

TELETECH TELESERVICES, INC.
    a Colorado corporation



By: /s/ Joseph D. Livingston
    --------------------------
Title: Senior Vice President, Chief Operating Officer
       ----------------------------------------------

                         (signatures continued on next page)

                                          18

<PAGE>

TELETECH HOLDINGS, INC.



By: /s/ Joseph D. Livingston
    --------------------------
Title: Senior Vice President, Chief Operating Officer
       ----------------------------------------------



STATE OF COLORADO  )
      CITY AND     )  ss.
COUNTY OF DENVER   )


    The foregoing instrument was acknowledged before me this 5th day of October
1995, by Kirby D. Martin, as Vice President of Norwest Bank Colorado, National
Association, a national banking association, on behalf of said association.


    My commission expires:   October 23, 1996
                             -----------------------------------


    SEAL                     /s/ Anita C. Jones
                             -----------------------------------
                                  Notary Public


STATE OF COLORADO       )
    CITY AND            )  ss.
COUNTY OF DENVER        )


    The foregoing instrument was acknowledged before me this 3rd day of
October, 1995, by Joseph D. Livingston as Chief Operating Officer of TeleTech
Teleservices, Inc., a Colorado corporation, on behalf of said corporation.

    My commission expires:   1/27/99


         SEAL                /s/ Marianne Mari
                             -----------------------------------
                                  Notary Public

                          (notaries continued on next page)

                                          19

<PAGE>

STATE OF COLORADO  )
                   )  ss.
COUNTY OF DENVER   )


The foregoing instrument was acknowledged before me this 3rd day of October,
1995, by Joseph D. Livingston as Chief Operating Officer of TeleTech Holdings,
a Delaware corporation, on behalf of said corporation.


    My commission expires:   1/27/99


         SEAL                /s/ Marianne Mari
                             -----------------------------------
                                  Notary Public


STATE OF COLORADO       )
                        )  ss.
COUNTY OF DENVER        )


    The foregoing instrument was acknowledged before me this 3rd day of
October, 1995, by Joseph D. Livingston as Chief Operating Officer of TeleTech
Telecommunications, Inc., a California corporation, on behalf of said
corporation.

    My commission expires:   1/27/99


         SEAL                /s/ Marianne Mari
                             -----------------------------------
                                  Notary Public

                                          20

<PAGE>

                                      EXHIBIT A


                     (Attached to and forming a part of Sublease,
                       dated as of September 28, 1995, between
                     Norwest Bank Colorado, National Association,
              as Sublandlord, and TeleTech Telecommunications, Inc. and
             TeleTech Teleservices, Inc., and TeleTech Holdings, Inc., as
                                      Subtenant)



                                     MASTER LEASE


    A true and correct copy of most of the provisions of the Master Lease as
described in the Sublease is attached hereto.

<PAGE>

                                      EXHIBIT B

                     (Attached to and forming a part of Sublease,
                       dated as of September 28, 1995, between 
                     Norwest Bank Colorado, National Association,
                as Sublandlord, and TeleTech Telecommunications, Inc.,
               TeleTech Teleservices, Inc., and TeleTech Holdings, Inc.
                               together, as Subtenant)


                               DESCRIPTION OF PREMISES


    Office space, encompassing approximately 10,347 Net Rentable Square feet
and 357 Net Rentable Square feet for storage space all located on the twenty
third Floor in the Building located at 1700 Lincoln Street, Denver, Colorado;

    and, as more specifically detailed on the drawing of the Premises as
attached.


<PAGE>
                                                                    EXHIBIT 16.1






                                  July 5, 1996



Securities and Exchange Commission
450 Fifth Street, N.W.
Washington, D.C.  20549

Ladies and Gentlemen:

     We have read the statements made by TeleTech Holdings, Inc. pursuant to
Item 304 of Regulation S-K, as part of Amendment No. 2 to the Company's
Registration Statement on Form S-1, which we understand will be filed with the
Commission on July 5, 1996.  We agree with the statements concerning our firm
made by TeleTech Holdings, Inc. in such Registration Statement.

                              Very truly yours,

                              /s/ Gumbiner, Savett, Finkel, Fingleson & Rose,
                              Inc.

                              GUMBINER, SAVETT, FINKEL, FINGLESON & ROSE, INC.
                              (formerly Gumbiner, Savett, Friedman & Rose, Inc.)


<PAGE>


                                                                    EXHIBIT 21.1

                               LIST OF SUBSIDIARIES OF
                               TELETECH HOLDINGS, INC.



       Name of Subsidiary *                      Jurisdiction of Organization
        ------------------                        ----------------------------

1.     TeleTech Telecommunications, Inc.         State of California

2.     TeleTech Teleservices, Inc.               State of Colorado

3.     TeleTech UK Limited                       United Kingdom

4.     Access 24 Service Corporation Pty         New South Wales, Australia
       Limited

       (a)    Access 24 (Service Corporation)    New Zealand
              Limited

       (b)    High Performance Healthcare        Queensland, Australia
              Limited

5.     Access 24 Limited                         United Kingdom



- --------------------------

       * Each of the subsidiaries conducts business under its legal corporate
       name listed above.


<PAGE>

                   CONSENT OF INDEPENDENT PUBLIC ACCOUNTANTS

     As independent public accountants, we hereby consent to the use of all our 
reports (and to all references to our Firm) included in or made a part of this 
Registration Statement.


                                       /s/ Arthur Andersen LLP

                                       ARTHUR ANDERSEN LLP
   
Denver, Colorado
July 5, 1996.
    



<PAGE>

                   GUMBINER, SAVETT, FINKEL, FINGLESON & ROSE, INC.








                           CONSENT OF INDEPENDENT AUDITORS



   
As independent public accountants, we hereby consent to the incorporation of 
our report dated April 13, 1994, with respect to the combined statements of 
income and cash flows of TeleTech Telecommunications, Inc. and TeleTech 
Teleservices, Inc. for the eleven months ended December 31, 1993 in Amendment 
No. 2 to the Registration Statement on Form S-1 to be filed by TeleTech 
Holdings, Inc. with the Securities and Exchange Commission, and to all 
references to our firm included therein.
    

/s/ Gumbiner, Savett, Finkel, Fingleson & Rose, Inc.
   
GUMBINER, SAVETT, FINKEL, FINGLESON & ROSE, INC.
(Formerly Gumbiner, Savett, Friedman & Rose, Inc.)
    


   
Santa Monica, California
July 5, 1996
    


© 2022 IncJournal is not affiliated with or endorsed by the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission